Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Honda
Model
Civic Sedan
Engine and year
L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations
Alarm Module: Locations
Rear of Radio
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Alarm
Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada > Page 9
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Lighting Relay: Locations
Upper Left Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 16
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 22
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 23
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 24
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 25
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 26
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 27
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 28
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 29
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 30
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 31
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 32
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 33
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 34
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 35
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 36
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 37
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 38
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 39
Integrated Control Unit: Electrical Diagrams
Integrated Control Unit Part 1 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 40
Integrated Control Unit Part 2 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 41
Integrated Control Unit (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 42
Integrated Control Unit (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 43
Integrated Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
All Systems
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated
Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 44
Intermittent Wiper System
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 48
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 53
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Front of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless)
With Keyless
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless) > Page 59
Keyless Door Lock Control Unit (USA Only)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 60
Power Door Lock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 61
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay
Moonroof Close Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay > Page 67
Moonroof Open Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof Close Relay
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Close Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof close relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof Close Relay > Page 70
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Open Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof open relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 75
Engine Compartment
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 76
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
ABS pump motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Torx Bolts ............................................................................................................................
............................................ 9.8 Nm (84 inch lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 82
Electronic Brake Control Module: Connector Locations
Connector A
Behind Right Kick Panel
Connector B
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 83
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Main Control
ABS Operation
The ABS control unit detects the wheel speed based on the wheel sensor signal it received, then it
calculates the vehicle speed based on the detected wheel speed. The control unit detects the
vehicle speed during deceleration based on the rate of deceleration. The ABS control unit
calculates the slip rate of each wheel, and it transmits the control signal to the modulator unit
solenoid valve when the slip rate is high. The pressure reduction control is a three-mode system,
that is pressure reduction, pressure retaining and pressure intensifying modes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control > Page 86
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Diagnosis Function
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
Since the anti-lock brake system modulates the braking pressure when a wheel is about to lock,
regardless of the driver's intention, the system operation and the braking power will be impaired if
there is a malfunction in the system. To prevent this possibility, the self-diagnosis function monitors
the main system functions. The ABS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub CPU The
CPUs check each other and the circuits of the system. When the CPUs detect failure, they shift to
the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode". When an abnormality is detected, the
ABS indicator light goes on.
CHECK MODE/BULB CHECK
There is also a check mode of the self-diagnosis system itself; when the ignition switch is first
turned on, the ABS indicator light comes on and stays on for a few seconds after the engine starts
to signify that the self-diagnosis system and indicator light are functional.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
When an abnormality is detected in the ABS control system by the self-diagnosis, the solenoid
operations are suspended to inhibit anti-lock brake system operation. Under these conditions, the
braking system functions just as an ordinary one, maintaining the necessary braking function.
When the ABS indicator light is turned on, it means the fail-safe is functioning.
SELF TEST - FAULT DETECTION
- The self-diagnosis can be classified into these four categories.
Initial Diagnosis - Performed right after the engine starts and until the ABS indicator light goes off.
Except ABS Control - Performed when the ABS is not functioning. During ABS Control - Performed
when the ABS is functioning. During Warning - Performed when the ABS indicator light is ON.
ABS Self-diagnosis
- The system performs the following controls when a problem is detected by the self-diagnosis.
> ABS indicator light ON
> Memory of Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
> Mode change to the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode".
1. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) is memorized when a problem is detected and the ABS
indicator light does not go off, or when the ABS
indicator light comes on. The DTC is not memorized when the ABS indicator light comes on unless
the CPU is activated.
2. The memory can hold any number of DTCs. However, when the same DTC is detected twice or
more, the later one is written over the old one.
Therefore, when the same problem is detected repeatedly, it is recorded as one DTC.
3. The DTCs are indicated in the order of ascending number, not in the order they occur. 4. The
DTCs are memorized in the EEPROM (non-volatile memory). Therefore, the memorized DTCs
cannot be canceled by disconnecting the
battery. Perform the specified procedures to erase. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock
Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Reading and Clearing Diagnostic
Trouble Codes/Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 87
Electronic Brake Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 88
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 89
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
1. Remove the right side kick panel. 2. Disconnect the ABS control unit connectors. 3. Remove the
ABS control unit. 4. Install the ABS control unit in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 94
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Radiator fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 99
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 104
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 107
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor High Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor high relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 112
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 113
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 114
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
When the ECM/PCM receives a demand for cooling from the air conditioning system, it delays the
compressor from being energized, and enriches the mixture to assure smooth transition to the A/C
mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 115
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
A/C compressor clutch relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 120
Fan Controls
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 121
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 122
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Condenser fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Module HVAC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 127
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 128
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 129
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 130
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 131
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 132
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 133
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 134
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 135
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 136
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 137
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 138
Control Module HVAC: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 139
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 140
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 141
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 142
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 143
Control Module HVAC: Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor Speed (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 144
Blower Motor Speed (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Panel Illumination Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 153
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 154
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 155
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
Daytime Running Lights Control Unit Input Test (Canada)
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the connectors from
the daytime running lights control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side Of Dash Panel - Photo 69
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Hazard Flasher Relay: Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 162
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 163
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View
Horn Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 168
Horn
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 169
Horn Relay: Locations Picture Location
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 170
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Horn relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 175
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 176
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 177
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 183
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 184
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 185
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 186
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 187
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 188
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 189
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 190
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 191
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 194
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 195
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 196
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Page 197
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear Of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 205
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 206
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 207
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 208
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 209
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 210
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 211
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 212
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 213
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 214
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 215
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 216
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 217
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 218
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 219
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 220
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated
Monitors
03-020
April 2, 2010
Applies To: All OBD II-equipped models except Passport
OBD II DTCs and Their Associated Monitors
(Supersedes 03-020, dated March 29, 2003, to revise the information marked by the black bars
and asterisks)
*REVISION SUMMARY
Numerous DTCs were added. Refer to the list for details.*
Following is a list of all OBD II DTCs and their associated monitors for all Honda automobiles with
OBD II. No one model has every DTC in the list.
DTC P0AA6 thru P0A9E
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 225
DTC P0A94 thru P0157
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 226
DTC P0158 thru P0400
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 227
DTC P0401 thru P0562
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 228
DTC P0563 thru P0748
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 229
DTC P0750 thru P0977
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 230
DTC P0979 thru P1193
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 231
DTC P1253 thru P1459
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 232
DTC P1486 thru P1585
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 233
DTC P1586 thru P1678
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 234
DTC P1679 thru P1860
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 235
DTC P1861 thru P2238
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 236
DTC P2240 thru U0073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 237
DTC U0100 thru U1288
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View > Page
240
Engine Control Module: Locations Picture View
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 243
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 244
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 245
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 246
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 247
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 248
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 249
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 250
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 251
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 252
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 253
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 254
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 255
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 256
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 257
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 258
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module: Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 261
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 266
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 269
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 270
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 271
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 272
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 273
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 274
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 275
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 276
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 277
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 278
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 279
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 280
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 281
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 282
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 283
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 284
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 285
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 286
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 287
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 288
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 289
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 295
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 296
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 297
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 298
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 299
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 300
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 301
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 302
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 303
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 304
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 305
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 306
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 307
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 308
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 309
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 310
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 311
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE AND OPERATION
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON, and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 312
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 313
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 314
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 319
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 322
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 323
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 324
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 325
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 326
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 327
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 328
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 329
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 330
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 331
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 332
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 333
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 334
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 335
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 336
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 337
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 338
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 339
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 340
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 341
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 342
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 348
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 349
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 350
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 351
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 352
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 353
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 354
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 355
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 356
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 357
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 358
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 359
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 360
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 361
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 362
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 363
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 364
Ignition Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- See Malfunction Indicator Lamp when the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is turned ON.
- Perform the following input test for the ignition control module (ICM) after finishing the
fundamental tests for the ignition system and the fuel and emissions systems.
INPUT TEST FOR THE IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM)
1. Remove the distributor ignition (DI) cap, the distributor ignition (DI) rotor and the leak cover
(TEC).
2. Disconnect the wires from the ICM. 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage
between the BLK/YEL wire and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check the BLK/YEL wire between the under-dash fuse/relay box and
the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage between the wire*1 and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check: the ignition coil.
- the wire*1 between the ignition coil and the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 5.
*1: BLU2 wire (HITACHI)
WHT/BLU wire (TEC)
5. Disconnect the ECM/PCM connector A (32P). Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire
between the ECM/PCM and the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 365
- There should be continuity.
6. Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
7. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire between the test tachometer connector and the ICM.
- There should be continuity.
8. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
9. If all the tests are normal, replace the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications
Air Bag Control Module: Specifications SRS Unit
SRS Unit
Torx Bolt(s) 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 370
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Behind Left Side of Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 371
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 372
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Take extra care when painting or doing body work in the area below the dashboard. Avoid direct
exposure of the SRS unit or wiring to heat guns, welding, or spraying equipment.
Disconnect the airbag connector(s) before disconnecting SRS harness connectors.
After any degree of frontal body damage, or after a collision without airbag deployment, inspect the
SRS unit for physical damage. If it is dented, cracked, or deformed, replace it.
Be sure the SRS unit is installed securely.
Do not disassemble the SRS unit.
Store the SRS unit in a cool (less than about 104 °F / 40 °C) and dry (less than 80% humidity, no
moisture) place. Do not spill water or oil on the SRS unit, and keep it away from dust.
During installation or replacement, be careful not to bump (impact wrench, hammer, etc.) the area
around the SRS unit. The airbag(s) could accidentally deploy and cause damage or injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 373
Air Bag Control Module: Application and ID
96 - 97 Model SRS Units
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 374
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 375
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Before disconnecting any part of the SRS wire harness, disconnect the airbag connector(s).
- During installation or replacement, do not bump (impact wrench, hammer etc.) the area near the
SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not damage the SRS unit terminals or connectors.
- Do not disassemble the SRS unit; it has no serviceable parts.
- Store the SRS unit in a clean, dry area.
- Do not use any SRS unit which has been subjected to water or shows signs of being dropped or
improperly handled, such as dents, cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag connector(s):
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
Driver's Side Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector
between the driver's airbag and cable reel.
Front Passenger's Side Disconnect the 2P connector between the front passenger's airbag and
SRS main harness.
3. Remove the right side cover from the SRS unit.
4. Remove the left side cover from the SRS unit, then disconnect the SRS main harness 18P
connector from the SRS unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 376
5. Remove the four Torx bolts from the SRS unit, then pull out the SRS unit from the driver's side.
6. Install the new SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not reuse a torx bolt that has red threads. Replace the bolt with a new one.
7. Connect the SRS main harness 8P connector to the SRS unit; push it into position until it clicks.
8. Install the SRS unit covers (right and left). Make sure the covers snap together in the middle. 9.
Reconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, then reinstall the
access panel on the steering wheel.
10. Reconnect the front passenger's airbag connector to the SRS main harness. 11. Reconnect the
battery positive cable, then the negative cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 377
12. After installing the SRS unit, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II);
the SRS indicator light should come on for about
six seconds and then go off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 382
Starting System
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 383
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Starter cut relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations > Page
389
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 393
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 394
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 395
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 396
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 402
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 403
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Power Relay Test
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Rear window defogger relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Windows
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Power Window Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 413
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 414
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Power window relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Wiper
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Wipers/Washers
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Wiper Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Integrated Control Unit Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
All Systems:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 422
Intermittent Wiper System:
Key-in/Seat Belt Reminder, Lights-on Reminder System:
Bulb Check System (Brake System Light):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the inner handle.
2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the door lock switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector A
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A > Page 432
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector B
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 433
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Without Defogger
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Without Defogger
1. Remove the switch as described in Function Test .
2. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Without Defogger > Page 436
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection With Defogger
1. Pry the switch out of the dashboard driver's lower cover. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector from
the switch.
Mirror Switch
Defogger Switch
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Lock Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations
Center of Trunk Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Open/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch > Page 444
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Tilt/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 445
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Adjustments
Switch Plate Adjustment (Fully Closed Position)
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Using the moon roof wrench, close the glass fully.
NOTE: Check the glass fit to the roof panel.
3. Using an open-end wrench, loosen the switch plate mounting bolts. 4. Adjust position of the
switch plate (switch cam) as shown. 5. Check the operation of the glass (from tilt-up position to fully
closed position, from the fully open position to the fully closed position) by
operating the moonroof switch.
NOTE: Check the glass height.
6. Close the glass fully, and check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Underside of Hatch Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Photo 22
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Photo 22
Left Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Photo 22 > Page 454
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Additional Image
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS, before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 455
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
The brake system indicator light comes on to alert the driver that the parking brake is applied, or
that the brake fluid level is low. It also comes on as a bulb test when the engine is cranked.
Brake Fluid Level
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied through fuse 25 to the brake
system light. If the brake fluid level is low, the brake fluid level switch closes, providing ground to
the circuit. The brake system light then comes on, alerting the driver to a low brake fluid level in the
brake master cylinder. (Check brake pad wear before you add fluid).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 456
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Braking Sensor/Switch: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Release Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Release Switch: Locations
Below Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Sensor Lock Bolts 7 ft.lb
Air Gap Front & Rear 0.02 - 0.04 in
For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 470
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications Toothed Ring
PULSER/WHEEL SENSOR AIR GAP *
Front & Rear Standard ........................................................................................................................
.................................................. 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 in)
* For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Front
Inside of Left Front Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front > Page 473
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Rear
Inside of Left Rear Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 474
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
Wheel Sensor
AC Current
The wheel sensors are the magnetic contactless type. As the gear pulser teeth rotate past the
wheel sensor's magnetic coil, AC current is generated. The AC frequency changes in accordance
with the wheel speed. The ABS control unit detects the wheel sensor signal frequency and thereby
detects the wheel speed. There are four wheel sensors, one for each wheel. The gear pulser has
50 teeth.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Toothed Ring
INSPECTION OF THE TOOTHED RING
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch), the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring > Page 477
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Wheel Speed Sensor
TESTING THE WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch) , the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 478
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE:
- Be careful when installing the sensors to avoid twisting the wires.
- The torque value of the bolts is 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgf.m, 7 ft. lbs.).
FRONT
REAR
1. Remove the hub bearing unit. 2. Remove the four backing plate bolts. 3. Pull the backing plate
away from the trailing arm, then remove the wheel sensor. It is not necessary to disconnect the
brake line.
NOTE: This illustration is drum brake type. The torque value of the disk type is same as drum type.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 487
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Fan Controls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 491
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Removing the ECT switch while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the ECT
switch.
NOTE: Bleed air from the cooling system after installing the ECT switch.
1 Remove the ECT switch from the thermostat housing.
2. Suspend the ECT switch in a container of water as shown. 3. Heat the water, and check the
temperature with a thermometer.
CAUTION: Do not let the thermometer touch the bottom of the hot container.
4. Measure the resistance between the A and B terminals according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise
Control) <--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] > Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise
Control) <--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 499
Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 503
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch (M/T)
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 509
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 510
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 513
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 514
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V, 3W - 18W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39 °F (2 - 4 °C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41 °F (4 - 5 °C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43 °F (4 - 6 °C) or less, and should come
on at 43 - 45 °F (6 - 7 °C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 530
Blower Motor Switch: Connector Locations
Underside of Heater Control Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Blower Motor Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 533
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 534
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 535
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 536
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 537
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 538
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 539
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 540
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 541
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 542
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 543
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 544
Blower Motor Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 545
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 546
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 547
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 548
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 549
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 550
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Coolant Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Photo 82
Behind Right Side Of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 557
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
The A/C thermostat is located on the evaporator housing. The A/C thermostat turns OFF the A/C
compressor clutch if the temperature at the evaporator goes below 3°C (37°F). This prevents
condensation from freezing on the evaporator fins and blocking the air delivery into the passenger
compartment. The blower motor will keep running when the sensor turns OFF the compressor. If
the temperature goes below 3°C (37°F) turning OFF the A/C thermostat, ground will be removed
from the condenser fan relay. This will deenergize the relay and remove voltage from voltage from
the condenser fan motor causing the fan to stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 558
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V,3 W-18 W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39°F (2 - 4°C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41°F (4 - 5°C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43°F (4 - 5°C) or less, and should come on
at 43 - 45°F (6 - 7°C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Component Locations
Left Front Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 563
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 564
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Battery voltage is supplied through fuse 56 to the A/C compressor clutch relay contacts at all times.
With the ignition switch in ON (II), voltage is applied to the coil of the A/C compressor clutch relay
through fuse 17. When you push the A/C switch ON , and the heater fan switch is in position 1, 2,
3, or 4, a "ground" input is provided to the engine control module (ECM) or powertrain control
module (PCM) through the A/C thermostat and the A/C pressure switch.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is grounded by the engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain
Control Module (PCM). When energized, the A/C compressor clutch relay allows battery voltage to
turn on the A/C compressor clutch.
The A/C ON indicator light comes on when the A/C system is requested.
A/C Pressure Switch
The A/C pressure switch is located in the condenser outlet line where refrigerant is in a high
temperature/high pressure liquid state. The switch will sense abnormally high or low pressure, and
open the circuit. This removes ground, and the compressor will stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ventilation Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 574
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 575
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 576
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 577
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 578
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 579
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 580
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 581
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 582
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 583
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 584
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 585
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 586
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 587
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 588
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 589
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 590
Dash Lights Brightness Controller
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dashlight Brightness
Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 591
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: The control unit is built into the dash brightness controller.
1. Carefully pry the controller out of the dashboard. 2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the
controller.
3. Inspect the connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. -
If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the controller must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch > Page 596
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Float Position E 1/2 F
USA,Canada Produced (ceramic Board Type) 105 - 108 ohms 29.5 - 35.5 ohms 3.5 - 5 ohms
Japan Produced (wire -Wound Type) 105 - 110 ohms 29.5 - 39.5 ohms 2 - 5 ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 600
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 601
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
NOTE: Refer to fuel gauge system circuit.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fusel relay box before testing.
2. Remove the access panel from the floor. 3. Disconnect the 3P connector from the fuel gauge
sending unit. 4. Connect the voltmeter positive probe to the No.2 terminal and the negative probe
to the No.1 terminal, then turn the ignition switch ON (II). There
should be between 5 and 8 V. If the voltage is as specified, go to step 5.
- If the voltage is not as specified, check for: an open in the YEL/BLK or BLK wire.
- poor ground (G552).
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 6. Attach a jumper wire between the No.1 and No.2 terminals, then
turn the ignition switch ON (II). 7. Check that the pointer of the fuel gauge starts moving toward the
"F" mark.
CAUTION: Turn the ignition switch OFF before the pointer reaches "F" on the gauge dial. Failure to
do so may damage the fuel gauge.
NOTE: The fuel gauge is a bobbin (cross-coil) type, hence the fuel level is continuously indicated
even when the ignition switch is OFF, and the pointer moves more slowly than that of a bimetal
type.
- If the pointer of the fuel gauge does not move at all, replace the gauge.
- If the gauge is OK, inspect the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 602
8. Remove the fuel gauge sending unit as shown.
9. Measure the resistance between the No.1 and No.2 terminals at E (EMPTY), 1/2 (HALF FULL)
and F (FULL) by moving the float.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 603
If the resistance readings are beyond the range, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Key Reminder Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 608
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 609
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 610
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 611
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 612
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 613
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 614
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 615
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 616
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 617
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 618
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 619
Key Reminder Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 620
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 621
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 622
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 623
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 624
Seat Belt & Ignition Key Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 625
Key Reminder Switch: Description and Operation
Ignition Key Warning
Battery voltage is supplied at all times to the seat belt reminder/key-on beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit. When you turn on the ignition key switch the integrated control unit senses
ground. If you open the driver's door, the door switch closes, causing the beeper to sound until the
door is closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Right Side of Engine Compartment (M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T) > Page 634
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (SI)
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect wiring at switch. 2. Loosen locknut and remove switch. 3. Reverse procedure to
install. Allow 0.039-0.196 inch (1-5 mm) brake pedal freeplay.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 646
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 647
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 648
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 649
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 650
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 656
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 657
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 658
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 659
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 660
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 663
Combination Switch: Connector Locations
Combination Light Switch Connector A
Left Side of Steering Column
Combination Light Switch Connector B
Left Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 664
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 665
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
-
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch.
- If there is no continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 666
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
Combination Switch Replacement
Honda does not provide a service procedure for this component.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch > Page 671
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 675
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 676
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the hazard warning switch or the center outlet panel when
prying the switch out.
1. Pry the hazard warning switch out of the center outlet panel. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the hazard warning switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 681
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 682
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 683
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 684
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 685
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 686
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 687
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 688
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 689
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 690
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 691
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 692
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 693
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 694
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 695
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 696
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 697
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 698
Part 2 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 699
Part 3 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 700
Part 4 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 701
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 702
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 706
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 717
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 718
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 719
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 720
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 721
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 722
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 723
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 724
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 725
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 726
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 732
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 733
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 734
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 735
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 736
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 737
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 738
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 739
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 740
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 741
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 746
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 747
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 748
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 749
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 750
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 751
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 752
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 753
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 754
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 755
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 756
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 757
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 758
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 759
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 760
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 761
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Locations
The Barometric Pressure Sensor (BARO) is built into the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 768
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations > Page 772
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 776
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 777
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 778
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 779
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 782
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 783
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 784
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 785
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 786
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 787
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 788
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 789
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 790
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 791
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 792
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 793
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 794
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 795
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 796
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 797
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
798
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the crankshaft pulley. 3. Remove the upper cover
and dipstick/tube. 4. Remove the lower cover and idler pulley bracket.
5. Disconnect the CKF sensor connector, then remove the CKF sensor. 6. Install the CKF sensor in
reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Electric Load Sensor: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Picture View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 803
Starter Cables/Battery Ground Cable/Engine Ground Cable A, Engine Compartment Overview Of
Power Terminals (T) And Grounds (G)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 804
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 805
Electric Load Sensor: Connector Locations
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Left Front Corner of Fuel Tank
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
Resistance
At 0°C (32°F) .......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 5.0 - 7.0 K Ohms At 40°C (104°F) ..........................................................
..................................................................................................................... 1.0 - 1.5 K Ohms At
100°C (212°F) .....................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.3 - 0.4 K Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 816
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 817
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The IAT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the intake air temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
With 5 in.Hg. ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 2.4 - 2.5 Volts With 15 in.Hg. ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 1.4 - 1.5
Volts With 25 in.Hg. .............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 0.5 - 0.6 Volts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 824
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 825
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The MAP sensor converts manifold absolute pressure into electrical signals and inputs the
ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 >
Page 834
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse
15
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse
15 > Page 840
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 841
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
OXYGEN SENSOR (WITH ANTI-SEIZE COMPOUND ON THREADS)
......................................................................................... 45 Nm (33 lb-ft)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 842
Oxygen Sensor: Locations
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 845
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 846
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 847
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 848
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 849
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 850
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 851
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 852
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 853
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 854
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 855
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 856
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 857
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 858
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 859
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 860
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 861
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses the O2 signal to fine tune the Fuel Injector duration to
maintain the correct fuel mixture.
OPERATION
The Primary HO2S (Sensor 1) is installed in the exhaust manifold with the sensor end extending
into the exhaust stream. It uses zirconia and platinum to compare exhaust oxygen content with that
of the outside air. When heated by the combination of its internal heater and exhaust gases, the
sensor supplies a low voltage signal (0.0 - 1.0 volt) to the ECM. The amount of voltage produced is
determined by the air/fuel mixture, A high voltage (0.7 - 1.0 volt) indicates a rich mixture, and a low
(0 - 0.3 volts) voltage indicates a lean mixture.
Oxygen sensor operation is monitored by the Engine Control Module (ECM) and a malfunction
should be accompanied by a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). Circuit and output testing procedures
are covered in detail in the Diagnostic Trouble Code Charts. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Oxygen Sensor malfunctions will cause increased emission output and smog check failure. Other
symptoms may include poor idle quality or poor fuel economy.
HINT: When monitoring oxygen sensor operation with an oscilloscope, watch for a sine wave with a
frequency of at least 8 cycles in 10 seconds. A "lazy" oxygen sensor will not always set a code, but
will usually cause abnormal emissions levels.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 862
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 863
Part 2 Of 2
The scan tool indicates Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0135: An electrical problem in the
Primary Heated Oxygen Sensor (Primary HO2S) (Sensor 1) Heater system. (Except D16Y5 engine
with M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 864
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
PRIMARY H02S:
1. Remove the primary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector, then remove the cover.
b. Remove the primary H02S.
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 865
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector then remove the primary H02S.
2. Install the primary H02S in reverse order of removal.
SECONDARY H02S:
1. Remove the secondary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the secondary H02S connector, then remove the secondary H02S.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 866
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
a. Remove the grommet, and pull out the secondary H02S connector, then disconnect the
secondary H02S connector.
b. Remove the secondary H02S.
2. Install the secondary H02S in reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 870
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 871
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 876
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 877
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 878
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 879
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 880
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 881
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 882
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 883
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 884
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 885
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 886
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 887
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 888
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 889
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 890
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 891
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 895
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 899
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 902
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 903
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 904
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 905
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 906
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 907
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 908
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 909
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 910
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 911
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 912
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 913
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 914
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 915
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 916
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 917
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 918
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 919
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 920
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 921
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 922
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing
Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing
Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1 > Page 927
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
> Page 934
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Picture View
Lower Right Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 937
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 938
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 939
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 940
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 941
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 942
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 943
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 944
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 945
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 946
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 947
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 948
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 949
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 950
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 951
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 952
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 953
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 15 and
the BLK/WHT and BLK/YEL wire to the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). The sensor is grounded by
the BLK wire to G101. The speedometer and other control units in the circuit supply about 5 volts to
the BLU/WHT wire. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) intermittently grounds the BLU/WHT wire
which generates a pulsed signal in it. The number of pulses per minute increases/decreases with
the speed of the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 954
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 955
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 961
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 962
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 963
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 964
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 965
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 966
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 967
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 968
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 969
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 970
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 971
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 972
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 973
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 974
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 975
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 976
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 981
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 982
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 983
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 984
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 985
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 986
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 987
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 988
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 989
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 990
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 991
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 992
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 993
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 994
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 995
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 996
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1000
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1005
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Hall Effect Sensor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition
System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition
System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The impact sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Safing Sensor, Air Bag
> Component Information > Locations
Safing Sensor: Locations
The safing sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Clutch Switch
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Clutch Switch > Page 1034
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Interlock Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1045
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1046
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch Signal <--> [Brake Switch - TCC] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1055
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 1059
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1063
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1066
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1067
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1068
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1069
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1070
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1071
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1072
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1074
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1075
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1076
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1077
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1078
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1079
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1080
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1081
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1082
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1083
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1084
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1085
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1086
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle
Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor >
Page 1093
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor >
Page 1094
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor >
Page 1095
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor >
Page 1096
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1097
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1103
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1104
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1105
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1106
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1107
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1108
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1109
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1110
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1111
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1112
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1113
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1114
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1115
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1116
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1117
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1118
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1119
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - CVT > Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle
Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rear window defogger switch or the center panel when
prying the switch out.
NOTE: Before testing, check for blown No.16 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fuse/relay box.
1. Pry the switch out of the center panel. 2. Disconnect the 5P connector from the switch.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and check the voltage between the BLK/BLU (+) and the BLK (-)
terminals. There should be battery voltage.
- If there is no voltage, check for an open in the BLK/BLU wire.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Connect a jumper wire between the BLK/BLU and the BLU/YEL terminals. 5. Turn the ignition
switch ON (II), and check that the rear window defogger works; if it does, replace the defogger
switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1131
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Testing and Inspection
Washer Level Switch Test (Canada)
1. Remove the front bumper.
2. Disconnect the 2P connectors from the washer.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each float position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1139
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Remove instrument panel lower cover. 3. Remove upper and lower steering column covers from
steering column. 4. Disconnect 8-P and 6-P connectors from wiper switch. 5. Remove two
attaching screws and slide wiper switch out of housing. 6. Reverse procedure to install. 7. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Right Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1143
Wiper/Washer Switch
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1144
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1145
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper cover. 5. Disconnect electrical connectors. 6. Remove wiper/washer switch attaching
screws, then the switch. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On models equipped with radio coded
theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1155
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1156
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1157
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1158
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1159
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1160
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1161
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1162
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1163
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1169
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1170
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1171
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1172
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1173
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1174
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1175
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1176
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 1177
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1178
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-068 Date: 090502
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1179
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1180
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1181
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1182
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1183
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1184
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1185
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1186
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1187
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-068 Date: 090502
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1188
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1189
to the right, attach the bracket and weights to the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the
maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel, and remove the weights until the vehicle drives
in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1190
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1191
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1192
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1193
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1194
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1195
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 1196
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1197
Alignment: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1198
Alignment: Service Precautions
CAUTION: When fasteners are removed, always reinstall them at the same location from which
they were removed. If a fastener needs to be replaced, use the correct part number fastener for
that application. If the correct part number fastener is not available, a fastener of equal size and
strength (or stronger) may be used. Fasteners that are not reused, and those requiring thread
locking compound will be called out. The correct torque value must be used when installing
fasteners that require it. If the above conditions are not followed, parts or system damage could
result.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > General
Description
Alignment: Description and Operation General Description
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
"Front End Alignment" refers to the angular relationship between the front wheels, the front
suspension attaching parts and the ground. Proper front end alignment must be maintained in
order to insure efficient steering, good directional stability and to prevent abnormal tire wear. The
most important factors of front end alignment are wheel toe-in, wheel camber and axle caster.
CAMBER:
Camber is the vertical tilting inward or outward of the front wheels. When the wheels tilt outward at
the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheels tilt inward at the top, the camber is negative
(-). The amount of tilt measured in degrees from the vertical is called the camber angle (1). If
camber is extreme or unequal between the wheels, improper steering and excessive tire wear will
result. Negative camber causes wear on the inside of the tire, while positive camber causes wear
to the outside.
CASTER:
This illustration shows view from the side of the vehicle. Caster (1) is the vertical tilting of the wheel
axis either forward or backward (when viewed from the side of the vehicle). A backward tilt is
positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). On the short and long arm type suspension you cannot
see a caster angle without a special instrument, but if you look straight down from the top of the
upper control arm to the ground, the ball joints do not line up (fore and aft) when a caster angle
other than 0 degree is present. With a positive angle, the lower ball joint would be slightly ahead
(toward the front of the vehicle) of the upper ball joint center line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > General
Description > Page 1201
TOE-IN:
This illustration shows view from the top of the vehicle. Toe-in is the measured amount the front
wheels are turn in. The actual amount of toe-in is normally a fraction of a degree. Toe-in is
measured from the center of the tire treads or from the inside of the tires. The purpose of toe-in is
to insure parallel rolling of the front wheels and to offset any small deflections of the wheel support
system which occurs when the vehicle is rolling forward. Incorrect toe-in results in excessive toe-in
and unstable steering. Toe-in is the last alignment to be set in the front end alignment procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > General
Description > Page 1202
Alignment: Description and Operation Camber
Camber is the inward or outward tilting of the front wheels from the vertical. When the wheels tilt
outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheels tilt inward at the top, the camber is
negative (-). The amount of tilt measured in degrees from the vertical is called the camber angle. If
camber is extreme or unequal between the wheels, improper steering and excessive tire wear will
result. Negative camber causes wear on the inside of the tire, while positive camber causes wear
to the outside.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > General
Description > Page 1203
Alignment: Description and Operation Caster
Caster is the tilting of the wheel axis either forward or backward from the vertical (when viewed
from the side of the vehicle). A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). On the
short and long arm type suspension you cannot see a caster angle without a special instrument,
but if you look straight down from the top of the upper control arm to the ground, the ball joints do
not line up (fore and aft) when a caster angle other than 0 degree is present. With a positive angle,
the lower ball joint would be slightly ahead (toward the front of the vehicle) of the upper ball joint
center line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > General
Description > Page 1204
Alignment: Description and Operation Toe-In
Toe-in is the turning of the front wheels. The actual amount of toe-in is normally a fraction of a
degree. Toe-in is measured from the center of the tire treads or from the inside of the tires. The
purpose of toe-in is to insure parallel rolling of the front wheels and to offset any small deflections
of the wheel support system which occurs when the vehicle is rolling forward. Incorrect toe-in
results in excessive toe-in and unstable steering. Toe-in is the last alignment to be set in the front
end alignment procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 1205
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Preliminary Checks
Alignment: Service and Repair Preliminary Checks
INSPECTION
Before making any adjustments affecting caster, camber or toe-in, the following front end
inspection should be made. 1. Inspect the tires for proper inflation pressure. 2. Inspect the front
wheel bearings for proper adjustment. 3. inspect the ball joints and tie rod ends. If excessive
looseness is noted, correct before adjusting. 4. Inspect the wheel and tires for run-out. 5. Inspect
the trim height. If not within specifications, the correction must be made before adjusting caster. 6.
Inspect the steering unit for looseness at the frame. 7. Inspect shock absorbers for leaks or any
noticeable noise. 8. Inspect the control arms or stabilizer bar attachment for looseness. 9. Inspect
the front end alignment using alignment equipment. Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
10. Alignment must be performed on a level surface.
- Check that the suspension is not modified.
- Check the tire size and tire pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Preliminary Checks >
Page 1208
Alignment: Service and Repair Alignment
Preliminary Checks
For proper inspection/adjustment of the wheel alignment check and adjust the following before
checking the alignment. Check that the suspension is not modified.
- Check the tire size and tire pressure.
- Check the runout of the wheels and tires.
- Check the suspension ball joints. (Hold a wheel with your hands and move it up and down and
right and left to check for wobbling.)
NOTE: Use commercially-available computerized four wheel alignment equipment to measure
wheel alignment (caster, camber, toe, and turning angle). Follow the equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Caster
1. Check the caster angle.
Caster angle: (1°40' ± 1°) +0.67° to +2.67°.
2. If out of specification, check for bent or damaged suspension components.
Camber
1. Check the camber angle.
Camber angle: -
Front: (0°00' ± 1) -1° to +1°.
- Rear: (-1° ± 1°) -2° to 0°.
2. If out of specification, check for bent or damaged suspension components.
Front Toe
1. Check the tire pressure. 2. Center steering wheel spokes. 3. Check the toe with the wheels
pointed straight ahead.
Front toe: (IN 1 ± 2 mm /IN 0.04 ± 0.08 inch) -0.12 to +0.04 inch
a. If adjustment is required, go on to step 4. b. If no adjustment is required, remove alignment
equipment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Preliminary Checks >
Page 1209
4. Loosen the tie-rod locknuts, and turn both tie-rods in the same direction until the front wheels are
in straight ahead position. 5. Turn both tie-rods equally until the toe reading on the turning radius
gauge is correct. 6. After adjusting, tighten the tie-rod locknuts.
NOTE: Reposition the tie-rod boot if it is twisted or displaced.
Rear Toe
1. Release parking brake.
NOTE: Measure difference in toe measurements with the wheels pointed straight ahead.
- If the parking brake is engaged, you may get an incorrect reading.
Rear toe-in: (2 minus 1 or plus 2 mm /0.08 minus 0.04 or plus 0.08 inch) -0.12 to 0 inch.
- If adjustment is required, go to step 2.
- If no adjustment is required, remove alignment equipment.
2. Before adjustment, note the locations of adjusting bolts on the right and left compensator arms.
3. Loosen the adjusting bolts, and slide the compensator arm in or out, as shown, to adjust the toe.
4. Tighten the adjusting bolts. Example: After the rear toe inspection, the wheel is 2 mm (0.08 inch)
out of the specification.
a. Move the arm so the adjusting bolt moves 2 mm (0.08 inch) inward from the position recorded
before the adjustment. b. The distance the adjusting bolt is moved should be equal to the amount
out-of-specification.
Turning Angle
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Preliminary Checks >
Page 1210
1. Turn the wheel right and left while applying the brake, and measure the turning angle of both
wheels.
Turning angle: Inward wheel: (39°50') 39.83°.
- Outward wheel (reference): (33°10') 33.17°.
2. If the turning angle is not within the specifications, check for bent or damaged suspension
components.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement
Parts
97-020
MAR 10, 1997
Applies To: ALL Models
New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
New Gauge
The fuel pressure gauge with 10" hose (T/N 07406-0040001) has been discontinued. The gauge
that replaces it (T/N 07406-004000A) has an easier-to-read face, a protective boot around the
gauge housing, and a 48" hose.
Replacement Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts > Page 1216
The replacement hose for the old gauge (24", T/N 07406-004020A) has also been discontinued. If
you need a replacement hose, order the new 48" hose (T/N 07406-004020B). The new hose
comes with an adapter so you can use it with the old fuel pressure gauge (T/N 07406-0040001).
Before connecting the hose to the vehicle, make sure the aluminum washer on the end of the hose
seals properly. If the aluminum washer doesn't seal, replace the washer.
Replacement washers come in a set of five (T/N 07406-0040300).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1217
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose disconnected
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm; 38 - 46 psi)
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose connected
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm; 28 - 36 psi)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1218
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1. Relieve fuel pressure.
2. Remove the service bolt on the fuel filter while holding the banjo bolt with another wrench. Attach
the special tool. 3. Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure with the engine idling and the
vacuum hose of the fuel pressure regulator disconnected from the fuel
pressure regulator and pinched. If the engine will not start, turn the ignition switch ON (II), wait for
two seconds, turn it off, then back on again and read the fuel pressure.
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38 - 46 psi)
4. Reconnect vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm, 28 - 36 psi)
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, first check the fuel pump. If the fuel pump is OK, check the
following: If the fuel pressure is higher than specified, Inspect for: Pinched or clogged fuel return hose or line.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- If the fuel pressure is lower than specified, inspect for: Clogged fuel filter.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- Fuel line leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
03-016
May 19, 2006
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord -ALL 1996-00 Civic -ALL 1997-01 CR-V - ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL
*1999-04 Odyssey - ALL*
Inspecting Idle Speed With the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic System
(Supersedes 03-016, dated March 25, 2003, to update the information marked by asterisks)
BACKGROUND
The ECM/PCM controls the vehicle's idle speed with the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve
and the air bleed screw (idle adjusting screw) work together to allow the proper amount of air into
the intake manifold when the throttle valve is closed (the accelerator pedal is released).
The ECM/PCM "learns" to work the IAC valve based on the total amount of air entering the intake
manifold. Air can enter the intake manifold from several sources, including the air bleed screw, but
only the air bleed screw is adjustable. If any changes are made that alter this airflow, specifically
with the air bleed screw, the ECM/PCM must learn new idle parameters.
When the air bleed screw is properly set, the ECM/PCM controls the engine's idle speed
seamlessly. But when the air bleed screw is not properly set, either of these symptoms may be
present:
^ Idle speed dips and then quickly recovers.
^ Engine stalls intermittently when it is just "off-idle." Here are the criteria for this symptom:
- The accelerator pedal is released but the driver's right foot rests over the pedal, causing just
enough pressure for the ECM/PCM to detect an input, yet there is little or no throttle valve opening
(the throttle valve is either not allowing any airflow or it is opened so slightly that more air supply is
needed).
- The engine speed is about 1,250 rpm or less.
- The lockup clutch (A/T models) or the clutch (M/T models) is disengaged.
- All during this time, the driver's foot does not move and stays resting over the accelerator pedal.
- The air bleed screw is not set properly and does not allow enough airflow.
- The amount of "air leakage" into the intake manifold is very low. (The normal amount of air let into
the intake manifold by sources other than the IAC valve, the air bleed screw, and normal operation
of the throttle body can vary slightly from vehicle to vehicle.)
NOTE:
"Air leakage" cannot be easily checked. If the first four criteria are met when the vehicle stalls, you
can assume the last two criteria are met as well.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
L4 Models and 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic
System (HDS) (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE A).
V6 Models except 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or HDS, and
clean out the throttle body if needed (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE B).
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Body Gasket (use only if needed): Refer to the parts catalog.
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 1223
PGM Tester with SN 320
or
Honda Diagnostic System with 1.006.004 or later software
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Carburetor Cleaner:
P/N 08732-0006, H/C 4713673
or
Throttle Plate and Induction Cleaner:
P/N 08732-9009, H/C 6204945
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Inspect Idle Speed (L4 and V6 Models)
Operation Number: 120301
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 07403
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Clean Throttle Body (V6 Models Except 1999-00 Odyssey)
Operation Number: 216001
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 08103
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
NOTE:
Warranty claims for these labor operations must be submitted separately. Do not combine them on
the same claim.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE A
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 1224
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey) or
you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of
counterclockwise turns you have made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in
step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then
go to step 9.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), and you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
10. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE B
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 7 or you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of counterclockwise turns you have
made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, and you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of
3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should never set the air bleed screw
counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If you set the screw further it could
work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Remove the throttle body (see the Fuel and Emissions
section of the appropriate service manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 1225
10. Open the throttle. Spray carburetor cleaner or throttle plate and induction cleaner into the
throttle body to clean out any contaminants. Make sure you spray the cleaner through the back of
the throttle body not the front, to avoid damaging the IAC valve.
11. Inspect the throttle body gasket, and replace it if needed. Reinstall the throttle body, making
sure all cables are properly adjusted, the accelerator pedal works properly, and all hoses and
cables are correctly routed.
12. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature. Make sure all electrical
items are turned off and the steering wheel is centered.
13. While watching the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw until the IAC count
reaches 7 or you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns.
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, leave the screw set at 3-1/2 turns. Go to step 14. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
14. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Manual Transmission
Idle Speed: Specifications Manual Transmission
Base Idle Speed ..................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 450 ± 50 rpm
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 670 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With Headlights On Low ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 850 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Manual Transmission > Page 1228
Idle Speed: Specifications Automatic Transmission
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 700 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 810 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With A/T
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA: D16Y5 engine with CVT, D16Y7 engine with A/T, D16YS engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: M/T 750 ± 50 rpm A/T 750 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be: M/T 810 ± 50 rpm A/T,CVT 810 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 1231
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With CVT
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA:
D16Y5 engine with CVT and D16Y7 engine with A/T and D16Y8 engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: 750 ± 50 rpm
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be (all): 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 1232
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With M/T
NOTE:
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
- (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights are off.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (transmission in neutral) until the
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Connect a tachometer.
3. Disconnect the IAC valve connector. 4. If the engine stalls, restart the engine with the
accelerator pedal slightly depressed. Stabilize the rpm at 1,000, then slowly release the pedal until
the engine idles.
5. Check idling in no-load conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air
conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be: 450 ± 50 rpm
Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw.
NOTE: After adjusting the idle speed in this step, recheck the ignition timing. If it is out of spec, go
back to step 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 7. Reconnect the 2P connector on the IAC valve, then do the ECM
reset procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 1233
8. Restart and idle the engine with no-load conditions for one minute, then check the idle speed.
NOTE: (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights
are off.
Idle speed should be:
(USA): 670 ± 50 rpm
(Canada): 750 ± 50 rpm
9. Idle the engine for one minute with headlights (Low) ON, and check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 750 ± 50 rpm
10. Turn the headlights off. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air
conditioner on, then check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Air Cleaner (ACL)
NOTE: Do not clean the ACL element it with compressed air (except dry type).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks
and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Ignition Timing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Cable: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1256
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1257
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1258
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1259
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1260
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1261
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1262
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1263
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1264
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1265
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1266
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1267
Ignition Cable: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1268
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1269
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1270
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1271
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 1272
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Carefully remove the ignition wires by pulling on the rubber boots. Do not bend the
wires; you might break them inside.
1. Check the condition of the ignition wire terminals. If any terminal is corroded, clean it, and if it is
broken or distorted, replace the ignition wire.
2. Connect ohmmeter probes and measure resistance. 3. If resistance exceeds 25 K Ohm, replace
the ignition wire.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1281
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1282
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1283
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1289
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1290
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 1291
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1292
Distributor: Locations
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Distributor: Exploded Views
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 1295
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 1296
Distributor: Service and Repair
Removal:
1. Disconnect the connector from the distributor. 2. Disconnect the ignition wires from the
distributor ignition (DI) cap.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the distributor, then remove the distributor from the cylinder
head.
Installation:
NOTE: Before you install the distributor, bring the No.1 piston to compression stroke TDC.
1. Coat a new O-ring with engine oil, then install it. 2. Slip the distributor into position.
NOTE: The lug on the end of the distributor and its mating grooves in the camshaft end are both
offset to eliminate the possibility of installing the distributor 180° out of time.
3. Install the mounting bolts, and tighten them lightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 1297
4. Connect the ignition wires to the distributor ignition (DI) cap as shown. 5. Connect the connector
to the distributor. 6. Set the ignition timing. 7. After setting the ignition timing, tighten the mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the electrodes and ceramic insulator for:
Burned or worn electrodes may be caused by: Advanced ignition timing
- Loose spark plug
- Plug heat range too low
- Insufficient cooling
Fouled plugs may be caused by: Retarded ignition timing
- Oil in combustion chamber
- Incorrect spark plug gap
- Plug heat range too high
- Excessive idling/low speed running
- Clogged air cleaner element
- Deteriorated ignition coil or ignition wires
2. D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engine:
- Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool, and replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded
as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1301
3. B16A2 engine:
- Do not adjust the gap of a platinum tip plug: replace the spark plug if the center electrode is
rounded or if the gap is not within the specifications.
NOTE: Use only the spark plugs listed.
4. Apply a small quantity of anti-seize compound to the plug threads, and screw the plugs into the
cylinder head finger-tight. Then torque them to 18
N.m (1.8 kg.m, 13 lb.ft).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Check compression with engine at normal operating temperature and throttle in wide open position.
Prior to performing test, disable ignition and fuel injection to prevent fuel from being sprayed into
cylinders while cranking engine. Ensure is fully charged and that cranking speed is 250 RPM.
Standard reading should be 135-184 psi. The maximum variation between cylinders is 28 psi.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.007-0.009 inches
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.009-0.011 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1308
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
NOTE: Valves should be adjusted only when the cylinder head temperature is less than 100°F (38°C).
- After adjusting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover.
3. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. The "UP" mark on the cam-shaft pulley should be at top, and the
TDC marks should align with the cylinder head
surface.
4. Adjust valves on No. 1 cylinder.
Intake: 0.18 - 0.22 mm (0.007 - 0.009 inch) Exhaust: 0.23 - 0.27 mm (0.009 - 0.011 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1309
5. Loosen the locknut, and turn the adjustment screw until the feeler gauge slides back and forth
with a slight amount of drag.
6. Tighten the locknut, and check the clearance again. Repeat the adjustment if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1310
7. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise (camshaft pulley turns 90°). The "UP" mark should
be on the exhaust side. Adjust valves on No. 3
cylinder.
8. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 4 piston to TDC. Both TDC grooves
are once again visible. Adjust valves on No. 4
cylinder.
9. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 2 piston to TDC. The "UP" mark should
be on the intake side. Adjust valves on No. 2
cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Timing Belt: Customer Interest Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise > Page 1319
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Timing Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise > Page 1325
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
1326
Timing Belt: Diagrams
NOTE: Refer to Service and Repair / Removal and Installation for procedure to position the crankshaft and
pulley before installing the belt.
- Mark the direction of rotation on the belt before removing.
- Do not use the upper cover and lower cover for storing removed items.
- Clean the upper cover and lower cover before installing.
- Replace the camshaft seals and crankshaft seals if there is oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: Replace the timing belt at 105,000 miles (168,000 km) according to the maintenance schedule
(normal conditions/severe conditions). If the vehicle is regularly driven in one or more of the
following conditions, replace the timing belt at 60,000 miles (U.S.A.) 100,000 km (Canada). In very high temperatures (over 110°F, 43°C).
- In very low temperatures (under -20°F, -29°C).
- Turn the crankshaft pulley so the No. 1 piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC) before removing the
belt.
- Inspect the water pump before installing the timing belt.
1. Remove the splash shield.
2. Loosen the mounting bolt and lock bolt, then remove the Power Steering (P/S) pump belt and
pump. 3. Loosen the idler pulley center nut and adjusting bolt, then remove the Air conditioning
(A/C) compressor belt.
4. Loosen the mounting nut and lock bolt, then remove the alternator belt.
5. Remove the dipstick, then remove the upper cover and idler pulley bracket.
NOTE: Do not use the upper cover to store removed items.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation > Page 1329
6. Remove the upper bracket.
NOTE: Use a jack to support the engine before the upper bracket is removed.
- Make sure to place a cushion between the oil pan and the jack.
7. Remove the crankshaft pulley.
8. Remove the lower cover and dipstick tube.
NOTE: Do not use the lower cover to store removed items.
9. Remove the CKF sensor from the oil pump.
10. Loosen the adjusting bolt 180°. Push the tensioner to remove tension from the timing belt, then
retighten the adjusting bolt. 11. Remove the timing belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation > Page 1330
INSTALLATION
Install the timing belt in the reverse order of removal; Only key points are described here.
1. Set the timing belt drive pulley so that the No. 1 piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC). Align the
groove on the timing belt drive pulley to the
pointer on the oil pump.
2. Set the camshaft pulley to TDC. Align the TDC marks on the camshaft pulley to the cylinder
head surface. 3. Install the timing belt tightly in the sequence shown. (1) Timing belt drive pulley
(crankshaft) -> (2) Adjusting pulley -> (3) Water pump pulley ->
(4) Camshaft pulley.
NOTE: Make sure the timing belt drive pulley and camshaft pulley are at TDC.
4. Loosen and retighten the adjusting bolt to tension the timing belt. 5. Install the lower cover and
upper cover.
NOTE: Clean the upper and lower covers before installation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation > Page 1331
6. Install the crankshaft pulley, then tighten the pulley bolt. 7. Rotate the crankshaft pulley about
five or six turns counterclockwise so that the timing belt positions on the pulleys. 8. Adjust the
timing belt tension.
9. Check that the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are both at TDC.
10. If the camshaft and crankshaft pulleys are not positioned at TDC, remove the timing belt and
adjust the position. Then reinstall the timing belt. 11. After installation, adjust the tension of each
belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation > Page 1332
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover. 3. Inspect the timing belt for
cracks and oil or coolant soaking.
NOTE: Replace the belt if oil or coolant soaked.
- Remove any oil or solvent that gets on the belt.
4. After inspecting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
TENSION ADJUSTMENT
CAUTION: Always adjust the timing belt tension with the engine cold.
NOTE: -
The tensioner is spring-loaded to apply tension to the belt automatically after making the following
adjustment.
- Always rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise when viewed from the pulley side. Rotating it
clockwise may result in improper adjustment of the belt tension.
- Inspect the timing belt before adjusting the belt tension.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover. 3. Rotate the crankshaft five or six
revolutions to set the belt. 4. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and
Installation > Page 1333
5. Loosen the adjusting bolt 180°. 6. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise three teeth on the
camshaft pulley. 7. Tighten the adjusting bolt. 8. After inspecting, retorque the crankshaft pulley
bolt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Bulletin No. 96-014
Issue Date Feb. 20, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To ALL
File Under SPECIAL TOOLS
Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Tensioning the engine belts properly with the belt tension gauge (T/N 07JGG-001010A) is critical to
bearing life of the A/C compressor, alternator, etc. Calibration of the belt tension gauge should be
checked regularly.
CALIBRATION
A Belt Tension Gauge Checker, needed for checking the calibration of the belt tension gauge, is
now available. One checker is being automatically shipped to each dealership. Additional checkers
may be ordered through normal parts ordering channels. The part number is 07TGG-001010A.
Procedure
1. Push the handle and slide the checker into the gauge. Position the checker as shown.
2. Release the handle and read the tension value on the Kg scale.
3. Compare your reading to the value etched on the checker. Your gauge is in calibration if it is
within +/- 3 kg of the checker value.
If your belt tension gauge is out of calibration, you cannot recalibrate it yourself. Contact America
Kowa Seiki about sending it for recalibration.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair > Page 1338
If your belt tension gauge is damaged, replacement parts are available from America Kowa Seiki.
They are:
REPAIR AND CALIBRATION INFORMATION
To order replacement parts for a gauge, contact:
America Kowa Seiki 20013 S. Rancho Way Rancho Dominguez, CA 90220
(800) 824-9655
To return your belt tension gauge for calibration:
^ Contact America Kowa Seiki for authorization and shipping instructions.
^ Pack the belt tension gauge in a suitable box. Use "bubble pack" to protect the gauge.
^ Ship according to their instructions.
America Kowa Seiki will charge a fixed fee to inspect, clean and calibrate the belt tension gauge,
and return it via UPS ground. Any repair parts needed are extra. The gauge will be returned within
15 days.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1339
Drive Belt: Specifications
NOTE: When using a new belt, adjust deflection or tension to new values. Run the engine for 5
minutes then turn it off. Readjust the deflection or tension to used belt values.
Deflection [1]:
With Used Belt
..............................................................................................................................................................
10.5 - 14.0 mm (0.41 - 0.55 inch) With New Belt .................................................................................
............................................................................... 7.5 - 10.0 mm (0.30 - 0.39 inch)
Tension [2]:
With Used Belt
................................................................................................................................................ 340 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 ft. lbs.) With New Belt
............................................................................................................................................... 640 780 N (65 - 80 kgf, 143 - 176 ft. lbs.)
[1] With 98 N (10 kgf, 22 ft. lbs.) between pulleys. [2] Measured with belt tension gauge.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor
Drive Belt: Adjustments A/C Compressor
Deflection Method
1. Apply a force of 98 N (10 kg, 22 lb), and measure the deflection between the A/C compressor
and the crankshaft pulley.
A/C Compressor Belt Used Belt: B16A2 engine
6.0 - 9.5 mm (0.24 - 0.37 in) Except B16A2 engine 7.5 - 9.5 mm (0.30 - 0.37 in)
New Belt: B16A2 engine 4.5 - 6.5 mm (0.18 - 0.26 in) Except B16A2 engine 5.0 - 6.5 mm (0.20 0.26 in)
Note these items when adjusting belt tension: If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- "Used belt" means a belt which has been used for five minutes or more.
- "New belt" means a belt which has been used for less than five minutes.
2. Loosen, the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt (DENSO). 3. Turn the adjusting bolt to get proper belt tension.
4. Retighten the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt
(DENSO).
5. Recheck the deflection of the A/C compressor belt.
Tension Gauge Method
1. Attach the special tool to the A/C compressor belt as shown below, and measure the tension of
the belt.
A/C Compressor Belt Used Belt: B16A2 engine
390 - 540 N (40 - 55 kg, 88 - 120 lb) Except B16A2 engine 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kg, 77 - 110 lb)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page
1342
New Belt: B16A2 engine
740 - 880 N (75 - 90 kg, 170 - 200 lb) Except B16A2 engine 690 - 830 N (70 - 85 kg, 150 - 190 lb)
Note these items when adjusting belt tension: Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the belt tension gauge.
- If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- "Used belt" means a belt which has been used for five minutes or more.
- "New belt" means a belt which has been used for less than five minutes.
2. Loosen the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt (DENSO). 3. Turn the adjusting bolt to get proper belt tension.
4. Retighten the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt
(DENSO).
5. Recheck the tension of the A/C compressor belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page
1343
Drive Belt: Adjustments Alternator
Deflection Method:
Apply a force of 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf), and measure the deflection between the alternator and the
crankshaft pulley.
Deflection 8.0-10.5 mm (0.31-0.41 in)
NOTE: On a brand-new belt (one that has been run for less than five minutes), the deflection
should be 6.0 - 8.5 mm (0.26-0.33 in) when first measured. If the belt is worn or damaged, replace
it.
If adjustment is necessary:
1. Loosen the lower mounting nut and the upper mounting bolt. 2. Move the alternator to obtain the
proper belt tension, then retighten the upper mounting bolt and the lower mounting nut to the
specified torques. 3. Recheck the deflection of the belt.
Belt Tension Gauge Method:
Following the gauge manufacturer's instructions, attach the special tool to the belt, and measure
the tension.
Tension 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 lbf)
NOTE: On a brand-new belt (one that has been run for less than five minutes), the tension should
be 540-740 N (55 - 75 kgf, 121 - 165 lbf) when first
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page
1344
measured. If the belt is worn or damaged, replace it.
If adjustment is necessary:
1. Loosen the lower mounting nut and the upper mounting bolt. 2. Move the alternator to obtain the
proper belt tension, then retighten the upper mounting bolt and the lower mounting nut to the
specified torques. 3. Recheck the tension of the belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page
1345
Drive Belt: Adjustments Power Steering
Pump Belt
NOTE: When using a new belt, first adjust the deflection or tension to the values for the new belt,
then readjust the deflection or tension to the values for the used belt after running engine for five
minutes.
Inspection
Attach the special tool to the belt and measure the tension of the belt. Tension:
'99-'00 models: B16A2 Engine Type only
Used Belt: 390 - 540 N (40 - 55 kgf, 88 - 120 lbs.) New Belt: 740 - 880 N (75 - 90 kgf, 170 - 200
lbs.)
'96-'00 models: Other Engine Types
Used Belt: 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 lbs.) New Belt: 640 - 780 N (65 - 80 kgf, 143 - 176
lbs.)
NOTE: If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the tension gauge.
Inspect the pump belt for cracks or any damage. Replace the belt with a new one if necessary.
Measurement without Belt Tension Gauge:
Apply a force of 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbs.) and measure the deflection between the power steering
pump and the crankshaft pulleys. Deflection:
'99-'00 models: B16A2 Engine Type only
Used Belt: 7.5 - 11.0 mm (0.30 - 0.43 inch) New Belt: 5.0 - 7.0 mm (0.20 - 0.28 inch)
'96-'00 models: Other Engine Types
Used Belt: 10.5 - 14.0 mm (0.41 - 0.55 inch) New Belt: 7.5 - 10.0 mm (0.30 - 0.39 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Air Cleaner (ACL)
NOTE: Do not clean the ACL element it with compressed air (except dry type).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service
and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
WARNING: After the engine has been run, the exhaust pipe will be hot; be careful when working around the
exhaust pipe.
- Be careful when loosening the drain bolt while the engine is hot. Burns can result because the oil
temperature is very high.
1. Remove the oil filter with the oil filter wrench.
2. Inspect the threads and rubber seal on the new filter. Wipe off the seat on the engine block, then
apply a light coat of oil to the new filter's rubber
seal.
NOTE: Use only filters with a built-in bypass system.
3. Install the oil filter by hand.
4. After the rubber seal seats, tighten the oil filter clockwise with the oil filter wrench.
Tighten: 7/8 turn clockwise. Tightening torque: 22 Nm (2.2 kgs.cm, 16 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 1358
Use this procedure to tighten the filter if eight numbers (1 to 8) are printed on the surface of the
filter. 1) Make a mark on the oil filter base under the number that shows at the bottom of the filter
when the rubber seal is seated. 2) Tighten the filter by turning it clockwise seven numbers from the
marked point. For example, if a mark is made under the number 2 when the
rubber seal is seated, the filter should be tightened until the number 1 comes up to the marked
point.
CAUTION: Using any procedure other than those shown could result in serious engine damage
due to oil leakage.
5. After installation, fill the engine with oil up to the specified level, run the engine for more than
three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications
Hose/Line HVAC: Mechanical Specifications
Discharge hose to the compressor 9.8 Nm
6 x 1.00 mm
Discharge hose to the condenser 9.8 Nm
Condenser pipe to the condenser 9.8 Nm
Condenser pipe to the receiver/dryer 9.8 Nm
Receiver pipe A to the receiver/dryer 9.8 Nm
Receiver pipe B to the receiver pipe A 13 Nm
Receiver pipe C to the receiver pipe B 13 Nm
Receiver pipe C to the Evaporator 9.8 Nm
Suction pipe B to the Evaporator 9.8 Nm
Suction pipe A to the Suction pipe B 31 Nm
Suction hose to the Suction pipe A 31 Nm
Suction hose to the Compressor 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications > Page 1364
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications > Page 1365
Hose/Line HVAC: Capacity Specifications
SANDEN Line or hose 10 mL
NIPPONDENSO Line or hose 10 mL
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications Power Steering Lines
Power Steering Lines
Outlet Hose to Pump 8 ft.lb
Cylinder Housing to Cylinder Lines 20 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Cylinder Lines 12 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Feed Line 27 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Return Line 20 ft.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1369
Power Steering Line/Hose: Testing and Inspection
- Inspect hoses for damage, leaks, interference or twisting.
- Inspect fluid lines for damage, rusting and leakage.
- Inspect for leaks at hose and line joints and connections.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1370
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Connect each hose to the corresponding pipe securely until it contacts the stop on the line.
Install the clamp or adjustable clamp at the specified
distance from the hose end as shown.
2. Add the power steering fluid to the specified level on the reservoir and check for leaks.
ADJUSTABLE HOSE CLAMP
1. Position the adjustable hose clamps at the points indicated (a) in the drawing above. 2. Slide the
hose over the line until it contacts the stop.
CAUTION: Check all clamps for deterioration or deformation; replace with the clamps new ones if
necessary.
HOSE CLAMP
1. Position the hose clamps at the points indicated (b) in the drawing above. 2. Slide the hose over
the line until it contacts the stop.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Fluid type DOT 3 or 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Quarts:
Man. Transmission ..............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 4.4 Auto. Transmission ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 4.5
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1379
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant/Anti-freeze Ethylene Glycol Based Coolant
Concentration Minimum 50 %
Maximum 60 %
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1380
Coolant: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When pouring engine coolant, be sure to shut the relay box lid and not to let coolant
spill on the electrical parts or the paint. If any coolant spills, rinse it off immediately.
1. Slide the heater temperature control lever to maximum heat. Make sure the engine and radiator
are cool to the touch. 2. Remove the radiator cap.
3. Loosen the drain plug, and drain the coolant.
4. Remove the drain bolt from the cylinder block. 5. Apply liquid gasket to the drain bolt threads,
then reinstall the bolt with a new washer and tighten it securely. 6. Tighten the radiator drain plug
securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1381
7. Remove, drain and reinstall the reservoir. Fill the tank halfway to the MAX mark with water, then
up to the MAX mark with antifreeze. 8. Mix the recommended antifreeze with an equal amount of
water in a clean container.
NOTE: Use only genuine Honda antifreeze/coolant.
- For best corrosion protection, the coolant concentration must be maintained year-round at 50%
minimum. Coolant concentrations less than 50% may not provide sufficient protection against
corrosion or freezing.
- Coolant concentrations greater than 60% will impair cooling efficiency and are not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix different brands of antifreeze/coolants.
- Do not use additional rust inhibitors or anti-rust products; they may not be compatible with the
coolant.
Engine Coolant Refill Capacity [including reservoir (0.4 (0.42 US quart. 0.35 Imp quart))].
9. Pour coolant into the radiator up to the base of the filler neck, and install the radiator cap loosely.
10. Start the engine and let it run until it warms up (the radiator fan comes on at least twice). 11.
Turn off the engine. Check the level in the radiator, add coolant if needed. 12. Put the radiator cap
on tightly, then run the engine again and check for leaks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Dry Fill .................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 5.9 liters (6.2 US qts.) Drain and Fill ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 2.7 liters (2.9 US
qts.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1386
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
................... Genuine Honda Premium Formula ATF
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1387
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
CAUTION: Keep all of the foreign particles out of the transmission.
NOTE: Check the fluid level with the engine at normal operating temperature (the radiator fan
comes on).
1. Park the vehicle on level ground. Turn off the engine.
2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth. 3. Insert
the dipstick into the transmission. 4. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be
between the upper and lower marks. 5. If the level is below the lower mark, pour the recommended
fluid* into the filler hole to bring it to the upper mark.
6. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission in the direction shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1388
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
CHECKING
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission.
1. Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature (the radiator fan comes on). 2. Park the
vehicle on the level ground, then turn off the engine. 3. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the
transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth.
4. Insert the dipstick into the transmission.
5. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be between the upper mark and lower
marks. 6. If the level is below the lower mark, pour the recommended fluid into the filler hole to
bring it to the upper mark. Always use Genuine Honda
Premium Formula Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift
quality.
7. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission in the direction shown.
CHANGING
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission.
1. Bring the transmission up to operating temperature (the radiator fan comes on) by driving the
vehicle. 2. Park the vehicle on the level ground, and turn the engine off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1389
3. Remove the drain plug, and drain the Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF).
NOTE: If a cooler flusher is to be used, refer to cooler flushing.
4. Reinstall the drain plug with a new sealing washer, then refill the transmission with the
recommended fluid into the filler hole to the upper mark on
the dipstick. Always use Genuine Honda Premium Formula Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF).
Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift quality.
Automatic Transmission Fluid Capacity:
2.7 L (2.4 Imp qt.) at changing 5.9 L ( 5.2 Imp qt.) at overhaul
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
S40 Fluid At Oil Change ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 1.8 l (1.9 US qt.) Fluid At Overhaul ........................................
................................................................................................................................................ 1.9 l 2.0
US qt.) S4C Fluid At Oil Change .........................................................................................................
.......................................................................... 2.2 l (2.3 US qt.) Fluid At Overhaul ...........................
............................................................................................................................................................
2.3 l (2.4 US qt.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1394
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
Genuine Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) preferred, or an API service SG, SH or SJ grade
motor oil with a viscosity of SAE 10W-30 or 10W-40 as a temporary replacement. An SG grade is
preferred but SH or SJ may be used if SG is not available. However, motor oil does not have the
proper additives and continued use may cause stiffer shifting. Drain and replace with Genuine
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) as soon as convenient.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1395
Fluid - M/T: Testing and Inspection
TRANSMISSION OIL CHECK
NOTE: Check the transmission oil with the engine OFF and the vehicle on level ground.
1. Remove the oil filler plug, then check the level and condition of the oil. 2. The oil level must be
up to the filler hole. If it is below the hole, add oil until it runs out, then reinstall the oil filler plug with
a new washer. 3. If the transmission oil is dirty, remove the drain plug and drain the oil. 4. Reinstall
the drain plug with a new washer, and refill the transmission with the recommended oil to the
proper level.
NOTE: The drain plug washer should be replaced at every oil change.
5. Reinstall the oil filler plug with a new washer. Oil Capacity
- 1.8 l (1.9 US qt.) at oil change
- 1.9 l 12.0 US qt.) at overhaul
NOTE: Always use Genuine Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF). Using motor oil can cause
stiffer shifting because it does not contain the proper additives.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Engine - Oil Recommendation GF-4 Standard
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Recommendation GF-4 Standard
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Use ONLY New GF-4 Standard Engine Oil
APPLIES TO: All Models
SERVICE TIP:
There's a new performance standard for engine oil: GF-4. It was jointly developed by automotive
and oil experts, and it represents a significant performance upgrade and improvement in fuel
economy. GF-4 engine oils must pass grueling tests totaling over 500 hours. On top of this, Honda
Genuine engine oils are also tested to ensure specific compatibility with Honda vehicles.
GF-4 engine oil is compatible with all current and earlier model year Honda cars and trucks. It also
provides these added benefits:
- Improved oxidation resistance (reduced thickening of the oil)
- Improved deposit protection and better wear protection
- Better low-temperature performance over the life of the oil
- Environmental protection by extending the life of emissions systems
While Honda has upgraded its engine oil to GF-4, other brands may not yet be at this new
standard. Keep in mind you must use Honda Genuine engine oil for all warranty repairs. If you use
some other brand of oil for non-warranty repairs, make sure that oil meets the GF-4 standard. We
recommend you stop using non-GF-4 engine oils and check with your supplier that you're
purchasing GF-4 oil.
Engine oil produced after April 1, 2005, that meets the GF-4 standard, must post this starburst
certification mark on the container. Always look for this mark; some oil container labels won't
specifically refer to GF-4.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
For D16Y7 engine (1.6 L SOHC)Engine For Engine Overhaul ...........................................................
.................................................................................................... 4.3 L (4.5 US qts. 3.8 Imp.qt) For
Oil Change, Including Filter
........................................................................................................................................... 3.6 L (3.8
US qts. 3.2 Imp.qts)
For D16Y5, D16Y8 (1.6 L VTEC DOHC)Engine For Engine Overhaul ...............................................
................................................................................................................ 3.7 L (3.9 US qts. 3.3
Imp.qt) For Oil Change, Including Filter
........................................................................................................................................... 3.3 L (3.5
US qts. 2.9 Imp.qts)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1402
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engien Oil
New standard for engine oil, GF-4. See TSB SN050109 for Honda Service News 050109 for
additional information.
API Classification .................................................................................................................................
................................ SH or SJ Energy Conserving II Viscosity ...........................................................
......................................................................................................... SAE 5W-30 (Preferred) SAE
10W-30
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1403
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Park the vehicle on level ground, and turn off the engine. Allow the oil a few minutes to drain
back into the oil pan so the dipstick will show the
actual level.
2. Make certain that the oil level indicated on the dipstick is between the upper and lower marks.
3. If the level has dropped close to the lower mark, add oil until it reaches the upper mark.
CAUTION: Insert the dipstick carefully to avoid bending it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Oil and Filter Service
ENGINE OIL
Inspection 1. Park the vehicle on level ground, and turn off the engine. Allow the oil a few minutes
to drain back into the oil pan so the dipstick will show the
actual level.
2. Make certain that the oil level indicated on the dipstick is between the upper and lower marks.
3. If the level has dropped close to the lower mark, add oil until it reaches the upper mark.
CAUTION: Insert the dipstick carefully to avoid bending it.
Replacement
CAUTION: Remove the drain bolt carefully while the engine is hot; the hot oil may cause scalding.
1. Warm up the engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1406
2. Drain the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1407
3. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer, and refill the engine with the recommended oil.
NOTE: Under normal conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at every other oil change. Under
severe conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at each oil change. The numbers in the middle of
the API Service label tell you the oil's SAE viscosity or weight. Select the oil for your car according
to this chart:
An oil with a viscosity of 5W - 30 is preferred for improved fuel economy and year-round protection
in the car. You may use a 10W - 30 oil if the climate in your area is limited to the temperature range
shown on the chart.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1408
4. Run the engine for more than three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
OIL FILTER
Replacement
WARNING: After the engine has been run, the exhaust pipe will be hot; be careful when working around the
exhaust pipe.
- Be careful when loosening the drain bolt while the engine is hot. Burns can result because the oil
temperature is very high.
1. Remove the oil filter with the oil filter wrench.
2. Inspect the threads and rubber seal on the new filter. Wipe off the seat on the engine block, then
apply a light coat of oil to the new filter's rubber
seal.
NOTE: Use only filters with a built-in bypass system.
3. Install the oil filter by hand.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1409
4. After the rubber seal seats, tighten the oil filter clockwise with the oil filter wrench.
Tighten: 7/8 turn clockwise. Tightening torque: 22 Nm (2.2 kgs.cm, 16 ft.lbs.)
Use this procedure to tighten the filter if eight numbers (1 to 8) are printed on the surface of the
filter. 1) Make a mark on the oil filter base under the number that shows at the bottom of the filter
when the rubber seal is seated. 2) Tighten the filter by turning it clockwise seven numbers from the
marked point. For example, if a mark is made under the number 2 when the
rubber seal is seated, the filter should be tightened until the number 1 comes up to the marked
point.
CAUTION: Using any procedure other than those shown could result in serious engine damage
due to oil leakage.
5. After installation, fill the engine with oil up to the specified level, run the engine for more than
three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1410
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Oil Service
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Remove the drain bolt carefully while the engine is hot; the hot oil may cause scalding.
1. Warm up the engine.
2. Drain the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1411
3. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer, and refill the engine with the recommended oil.
NOTE: Under normal conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at every other oil change. Under
severe conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at each oil change. The numbers in the middle of
the API Service label tell you the oil's SAE viscosity or weight. Select the oil for your car according
to this chart:
An oil with a viscosity of 5W - 30 is preferred for improved fuel economy and year-round protection
in the car. You may use a 10W - 30 oil if the climate in your area is limited to the temperature range
shown on the chart.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oil and
Filter Service > Page 1412
4. Run the engine for more than three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Type
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... Genuine Honda Power Steering Fluid-V or S
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1416
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
FLUID REPLACEMENT
NOTE: Check the reservoir at regular intervals, and add fluid as necessary.
CAUTION: Always use Genuine Honda Power Steering Fluid-V or S. Using any other type of power
steering fluid or automatic transmission fluid can cause increased wear and poor steering in cold
weather.
1. Raise the reservoir, then disconnect the return hose.
2. Connect a hose of suitable diameter to the disconnected return hose, and put the hose end in a
suitable container.
CAUTION: Take care not to spill the fluid on the body and parts. Wipe off any spilled fluid at once.
3. Start the engine, let it run at idle, and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times.
When fluid stops running out of the hose, shut off the
engine. Discard the fluid.
4. Refit the return hose on the reservoir.
5. Fill the reservoir to the upper level line. 6. Start the engine and run it at fast idle, then turn the
steering from lock-to-lock several times to bleed air from the system. 7. Recheck the fluid level and
add some if necessary.
CAUTION: Do not fill the reservoir beyond the upper level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection
07-030
October 12, 2007
Applies To: ALL Vehicles With Conventional A/C Compressors
A/C Leak Detection
(Supersedes 07-030, dated June 15, 2007, to update the information marked by asterisks)
The OPTIMAX Jr. (TM)A/C Leak Detection Kit for Honda vehicles, P/N TRP124893, is a new
required tool. The kit is used to add small amounts of dye to A/C systems to help locate smaller
leaks that an electronic leak detector might not find.
When searching for leaks, always begin by using an electronic leak detector. Refer to Service
Bulletin 97-027, Denso HLD-100 Halogen Leak Detector; for tips on using this tool, then follow up
with the OPTIMAX Jr.
This new detection kit complements but does not replace the electronic detector.
The kit contains:
^ TRP8640CS, OPTIMAX Jr. (TM) cordless, fluorescent leak detection flashlight lamp (includes 3
standard AA batteries)
^ TRP38600601, (6) 0.06 oz. (1.7 g) Tracer-Stick(R) R134a/PAG A/C dye capsules with ID labels
^ TRP3887, R-134a Universal Connect Set(TM)
^ TRP120884, GLO-AWAY(TM) dye cleaner
^ TRP9940, fluorescence-enhancing glasses
^ TRP1143, (1) empty Tracer-Stick dye capsule
ORDERING INFO
*One OPTIMAX Jr. A/C Leak Detection Kit was shipped to each current dealer as a required
special tool. Additional kits and replacement capsules may be ordered through the Honda Tool and
Equipment Program. On the iN, click on Service, Service Bay, Tool and Equipment Program,
Online Catalog tab, and Air Conditioning Equipment, or call.*
NOTICE
^ Do not use leak-trace dye in any Honda hybrid vehicle equipped with a dual-scroll compressor
This can increase the chance of electric shock. The compressor is easily identified by the orange
high-voltage cable that is connected to the compressor body.
^ Only Tracer-Stick single-dose fluorescent dye capsules from Tracer Products (Tracerline(R)) are
approved for use in Honda vehicles. Other dyes contain solvents that may contaminate the
system's refrigerant oil, leading to component failure.
^ Adding excessive amounts of dye can lead to compressor damage and failure.
USING THE OPTIMAX JR.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 1421
1. Before adding any leak-detection dye, check to see if there is dye in the system now.
^ Check for a label in the engine compartment indicating that fluorescent leak-detection dye has
been added to the system.
^ Dye may have been added even though no label is present. To confirm this:
- Put on the fluorescence-enhancing glasses, and remove the low-side service port sealing cap.
- Direct the ultraviolet lamp into the valve stem area. If dye has been previously added, the
lubricant traces will have a bright yellow fluorescent glow. You may need to press the port's valve
stem briefly to release some lubricant and dye from the system.
^ If there is no dye in the system, go to step 2.
^ If there is dye in the system, go to step 5. Do not add more dye.
2. Add the dye.
NOTE:
Air and moisture must be evacuated from the universal connect set if it is being used for the first
time, or if it has been stored with the control valve open. If the air and moisture have been
evacuated, go to step 3; otherwise do the following:
(a) Attach the empty dye capsule (provided in the dye kit) to the control valve fitting.
(b) Attach the service valve fitting (provided in the kit) to the empty dye capsule.
(c) Attach the low-side hose of the A/C recovery and charging station, and open the quick coupler's
hand-wheel valve. Then open the control valve (black knob) on the universal connect set.
(d) Following the manufacturer's instructions for your recovery and charging station, evacuate the
universal connect set for approximately 3 minutes.
(e) When evacuation is complete, be sure the set's control valve is closed (finger tight), and
disconnect the NC recovery and charging station.
(f) Remove the service valve fitting and the empty dye capsule from the set, and store them for
future use.
NOTE:
^ Check the refrigerant charge level. There must be enough refrigerant in the system to operate the
A/C compressor and to circulate refrigerant oil.
^ If the refrigerant charge is too low, recover the remaining amount and recharge the system before
adding any dye.
(g) Start the vehicle and operate the A/C system. Follow your A/C refrigerant recovery and
charging station's operating instructions for low-side charging to install the dye.
* NOTE:
Only 0.05 lb (0.02 kg) of refrigerant is needed to push the dye into the A/C system.*
(h) Once the refrigerant charge is programmed, open the control valve on the set to allow the dye
to enter the system.
(i) After the dye capsule clears, allow the low-side of the A/C system to reach its lowest operating
pressure, then quickly close both the service equipment's low-side coupler valve and the control
valve on the set.
(j) Remove the set from the vehicle by releasing its quick coupler. Remove the empty dye capsule
from the service valve fitting. Return the hose, control valve, and service-valve fitting to the storage
case.
* NOTE:
Store the hose with the control valve closed. This will retain a small amount of refrigerant in the
hose so it does not have to be evacuated the next time you use it.*
(k) Fill out an identification label (provided in the kit), and attach it to a location near the A/C charge
label.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 1422
3. Connect the universal connect set and the Tracer- Stick dye capsule:
(a) Be sure the quick coupler and control valves on the set are closed.
(b) Remove the low-side service port sealing cap, and connect the set to the low-side service port
using the quick coupler.
(c) Hold a new dye capsule so that the embossed arrow is pointing up. Remove the black end cap,
and carefully attach the capsule to the control valve fitting.
NOTE:
The capsule must be held with the embossed arrow pointing up or the dye will leak out of the
capsule.
(d) Turn the capsule so the embossed arrow is pointing down. Remove the orange end cap, and
carefully attach the service valve fitting provided in the kit (finger tight).
NOTE:
The capsule must be held with the embossed arrow pointing down or the dye will leak out.
4. Connect the NC service equipment:
With the universal connect set and dye capsule attached to the vehicle's low-side service port,
connect the A/C refrigerant recovery and charging station's low-side hose quick coupler to the
service valve fitting. Open the blue hand-wheel valves on both quick couplers. Leave the control
valve (black knob) on the universal connect set closed.
NOTE:
* ^ If you have recovered refrigerant to weigh it as part of your diagnostics, or if there is a low
charge, it is more efficient to recharge the system using normal procedures before installing the
universal connect set. Dye can then be added using approximately 0.05 lb (0.02 kg) of refrigerant.*
^ You do not need to connect the service equipment's high-side hose to the vehicle to install the
dye. If the high-side hose is connected, make sure its coupler valve is closed before proceeding.
^ Do not use the A/C recovery and charging station to recover or evacuate the A/C system when a
full dye capsule is attached. The dye will be drawn into the service equipment instead of being
added to the vehicle's A/C system.
5. Inspect the A/C system for leaks:
(a) Run the A/C system for at least 15 minutes to circulate the dye through the system. Large leaks
will be seen immediately as a fluorescent yellow glow. Smaller leaks may require at least 24 hours
of vehicle operation before they become visible. Operate the A/C system as much as possible
during this time to keep the dye circulating.
(b) Stop the vehicle's engine and inspect the system for leaks using the ultraviolet (UV) lamp and
fluorescence-enhancing glasses from the kit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 1423
Low ambient light conditions (a dark work area) will aid in locating the leak.
NOTE:
Not all UV lamps work well with all types of fluorescent dye. Use only the lamp provided in the kit to
inspect for leaks.
(c) Inspect the entire system. Be sure to check these locations:
^ damaged and corroded areas
^ fittings
^ hose-to-line couplings
^ refrigerant controls
^ service ports
^ brazed or welded areas
^ areas near attachment points
(d) Check for evaporator leaks by illuminating the evaporator drain tube area with the UV lamp and
glasses.
(e) After repairing a leak, remove any fluorescent residue using the GLO-AWAY dye cleaner from
the kit and hot water (follow the instructions on the bottle).
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
A/C Refrigerant Capacity 550 +0 -50 g
A/C Refrigerant Type R-134a
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1426
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
A/C Refrigerant Capacity 550 +0 -50 g
A/C Refrigerant Type R-134a
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Condensor 20 mL
Evaporator 45 mL
Line or hose 10 mL
Receiver/Dryer 10 mL
Leakage Repair 25 mL
Compressor (Sanden) 130 mL
Remove oil from new compressor equal to the amount drained
from the old compressor but not more than 50 ml.
Compressor (Denso) 130 mL
Remove oil from new compressor equal to the amount drained
from the old compressor but not more than 50 ml.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1431
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Oil Type ............................................................................................................................
......................................................................... SP-10 Honda PN .......................................................
........................................................................................................................................
38897-P13-A01AH Honda Code .........................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... 5023627
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Without
Anti-Lock Brakes
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without Anti-Lock Brakes
CAUTION:
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle, it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
NOTE: The reservoir on the master cylinder must be at the MAX (upper) level mark at the start of
the bleeding procedure and checked after bleeding each brake caliper. Add fluid as required.
1. Make sure the brake fluid level in the reservoir is at the MAX (upper) level line. 2. Have someone
slowly pump the brake pedal several times, then apply steady pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Without
Anti-Lock Brakes > Page 1436
3. Loosen the brake bleed screw to allow air to escape from the system. Then tighten the bleed
screw securely.
Brake Bleeding Sequence
4. Repeat the procedure for each wheel in the sequence shown until air bubbles no longer appear
in the fluid. 5. Refill the master cylinder reservoir to the MAX (upper) level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations > Page
1440
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
> Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
> Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 1443
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions
> Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 1444
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and
Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and
Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact > Page 1447
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1448
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1454
Fuse: Locations Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1455
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1456
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse: Application and ID Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1459
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1460
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1461
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1462
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1463
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1464
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1465
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Page 1466
Fuse: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off > Page
1475
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls
Off
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls
Off > Page 1481
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1484
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1485
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1486
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1487
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1488
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1489
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1490
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1491
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1494
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1495
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1496
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1497
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1498
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1503
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1504
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1505
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1506
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1507
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1508
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1509
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1510
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 1511
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1514
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1515
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 1516
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Page 1517
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
If equipped with maintenance reminder flag:
After completing the required service, the maintenance flags may be reset by inserting the ignition
key into the appropriate slot, on the instrument below the indicator flag. When the ignition key is
inserted into the slot, the indicator flag should change to green.
If equipped with maintenance reminder lamp:
1. Turn off the engine. 2. Press and hold the select/reset button(s) on the instrument panel, then
turn the ignition switch ON (Position II). 3. Hold the button(s) for at least 10 seconds, until the
indicator resets.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 1530
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr >
99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON
With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr >
99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 1536
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1537
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Does Not Come ON
NOTE: If this symptom is intermittent, check for a loose fuse No.25 (METER 7.5 A) in the
under-dash fuse/relay box, a poor connection at ECM/PCM terminal A18, or an intermittent open in
the GRN/ORN wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 1540
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Stays ON
Part 1 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 1541
Part 2 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 1542
Part 3 Of 3
NOTE:
- When there is no Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) stored, the MIL will stay on if the SCS service
connector is connected and the ignition switch is on.
- If this symptom is intermittent, check for: A loose FIE/M (15 A) fuse in the under-hood fuse/relay box
- A loose No.13 FUEL PUMP fuse (15 A) in the under-dash fuse/relay box
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (C7) and the service check connector
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D4) and the MAP sensor
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D10), the TP sensor, the EGR valve lift
sensor (D16Y5 engine) and/or the Fuel tank pressure sensor ('96 D16Y8 engine (coupe), '97
D16Y7 engine (coupe: KL model, sedan: KL (LX model), '97 D16Y8 engine (coupe: all models,
sedan: KL model), '98-all models)
- PGM-FI main relay See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating instructions.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information
06-082
December 15, 2006
Applies To: ALL
Tubeless Tire Repair Information
This service bulletin provides the resource information required to repair tubeless tires on Honda
automobiles and light trucks.
To properly repair a tire, follow the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) "Puncture Repair
Procedures for Passenger and Light Truck Tires" outlined on the RMA wall poster. One wall poster
has been provided to your dealership. Additional posters can be ordered through Helm, the RMA
website, www.rma.org, or the tire manufacturers.
Michelin(R) PAX System(TM), tires can be repaired using the same repair procedures described on
the RMA poster. Whenever you repair a PAX System tire, you must inspect the support ring. Refer
to the PAX System support ring section of this service bulletin for inspection procedures.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Refer to the tire manufacturer for warranty information.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
^ 1/8 inch Patch-plug with lead wire
^ 1/4 inch Patch-plug with lead wire
^ 1/8 inch Plugs (stem)*
^ 1/4 inch Plugs (stem)*
^ 1/4 inch Patches*
^ 3/4 inch Patches*
^ Chemical cement
^ Liquid buffer
^ Rim-bead sealer
^ Inner liner sealer
REQUIRED TOOLS
^ Tire stitcher, 1-1/2 inch wheel
^ Tire crayons
^ Tire test tank
^ Awl or probe
^ Flexible blade skiving knife
^ 1/8 inch Carbide tire tool with adapter
^ 1/4 inch Carbide tire tool with adapter
^ Low speed buffer with quick release chuck and exhaust hose
^ Carbide buffing wheel with adapter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information > Page 1548
^ Reversible drill motor (800 RPM MAX)
^ Tire spreader
^ Inspection lamp
* For repairable injuries that exceed 25 degrees
TIRE REPAIR GUIDELINES
Never repair tires worn below 2/32 inch of tread.
Never repair a tire without removing the tire from the wheel for internal inspection.
Never repair a tire with a tread injury larger than 1/4 inch (6 mm).
Never use only a plug (stem) or a patch only to repair a tire injury.
NOTE:
If the angle of the tire injury exceeds 25 degrees, you must use the two-piece repair system as
recommended by the RMA.
MICHELIN PAX SYSTEM SUPPORT RING INSPECTION
PAX System support rings are not repairable, under any circumstances, but they can be reused if
no damage is found during a thorough inspection. If a PAX System tire ran flat or underinflated,
dismount the tire from the wheel and inspect the wheel, tire, and support ring for damage. Refer to
the Michelin PAX Support Rings Technical Bulletin in ISIS. Enter SEARCH BY PUBLICATION,
select Job Aids, then select Michelin PAX Support Rings Technical Bulletin from the list.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information
Tires: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: This vehicle has a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). Refer to the SRS
component and wiring location view in order to determine whether you are performing service on or
near the SRS components or the SRS wiring. when you are performing service on or near the SRS
components or the SRS wiring, refer to the SRS service information. failure to follow warnings
could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SRS system
repairs.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Technician Safety Information > Page 1551
Tires: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener,
use ONLY the exact part number for that application. Honda will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. Honda will also call out the fasteners that require thread
lockers or thread sealant. Unless otherwise specified, do not use supplemental coatings (Paints,
greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint interfaces. Generally,
such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping force, and may damage
the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening sequence and specifications.
Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and systems.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Page 1552
Tires: Description and Operation
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Replacement wheels or tires must be equivalent to the originals in load capacity, specified
dimension and mounting configuration. Improper size or type may affect bearing life, brake
performance, speedometer/odometer calibration, vehicle ground clearance and tire clearance to
the body and chassis. All model are equipped with metric sized tubeless steel belted radial tires.
Correct tire pressures and driving habits have an important influence on tire life. Heavy cornering,
excessively rapid acceleration and unnecessary sharp braking increase premature and uneven
wear.
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
The original equipment tires have built-in tread wear indicators (1) to show when tires need
replacement. These indicators may appear as wide bands. When the indicators appear in two or
more grooves at three locations, tire replacement is recommended.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
Tires: Testing and Inspection Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
TYPICAL EXAMPLES OF ABNORMAL TIRE AHEAD WEAR AND MAJOR CAUSES:
CAUTION: Similar wear patterns can be caused by worn suspension parts, misalignment of wheels
and tires, and other suspension related problems.
Spotty Wear
Wear localized on shoulder sections, and in an extreme cases, the tire becomes polygonal in
shape. 1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Hub or knuckle out of round or distorted. 3. Play
in hub bearings or ball joint. 4. Rotating parts out of balance.
Tread Wear One-Sided
1. Rotating parts out of balance. 2. Tire or wheel out of round. 3. Hub or knuckle out of round or
distorted.
Localized Tread Wear
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1555
1. Once spotty wear develops in tread due to hard braking or abrupt starting, localized wear tends
to be promoted.
Shoulder Wear (Generally Wear Develops In Outer Shoulder):
1. Camber or toe-in incorrect. 2. Shoulder wear caused by repeated hard-cornering.
Wear In Shoulders At Points Opposed To Each Other
1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Play in bearings or ball joint.
Premature Wear In Shoulders
1. Flexing of tire excessive due to under-inflation.
One Sided Feather Edging
1. Wear caused by repeated hard cornering. 2. Camber or toe-in incorrect.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1556
Tires: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis By Symptom
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1557
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1558
Tires: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis List
If the following conditions are noted, rotation is required.
1. Front tire wear is different from rear. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3. Left
and right front tire wear is unequal. 4. Left and right rear tire wear is unequal.
If the following conditions are noted, check the wheel alignment.
1. Left and right front tire wear is unequal. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3.
Front tire treads have scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of tread ribs or blocks.
4. There is cupping, flat spotting etc.
Higher than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Hard ride. 2. Poor steering stability. 3. Rapid and uneven wear at center of the tread.
Lower than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Tire squeal on turns. 2. Hard steering. 3. Rapid and uneven wear on the edges of the tread. 4.
Tire rim bruises and rupture. 5. Tire cord breakage. 6. High tire temperatures. 7. Reduced handling.
8. Reduced fuel economy.
Unequal pressure on same axle can cause:
1. Uneven braking. 2. Steering lead. 3. Reduced handling. 4. Swerve on acceleration.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1559
Tires: Testing and Inspection Irregular and Premature Wear
Irregular and/or premature wear has many causes. Some of them are incorrect inflation pressures,
lack of tire rotation, poor driving habits or improper wheel alignment. Incorrect inflation is common
cause of tire premature wear.
NOTE: Due to their design, radial tires tend to wear faster in the shoulder area, particularly on the
front tires. This makes regular rotation especially necessary. After rotation, be sure to check wheel
nut torque, and set tire pressures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1560
Tires: Testing and Inspection
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
TYPICAL EXAMPLES OF ABNORMAL TIRE AHEAD WEAR AND MAJOR CAUSES:
CAUTION: Similar wear patterns can be caused by worn suspension parts, misalignment of wheels
and tires, and other suspension related problems.
Spotty Wear
Wear localized on shoulder sections, and in an extreme cases, the tire becomes polygonal in
shape. 1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Hub or knuckle out of round or distorted. 3. Play
in hub bearings or ball joint. 4. Rotating parts out of balance.
Tread Wear One-Sided
1. Rotating parts out of balance. 2. Tire or wheel out of round. 3. Hub or knuckle out of round or
distorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1561
Localized Tread Wear
1. Once spotty wear develops in tread due to hard braking or abrupt starting, localized wear tends
to be promoted.
Shoulder Wear (Generally Wear Develops In Outer Shoulder):
1. Camber or toe-in incorrect. 2. Shoulder wear caused by repeated hard-cornering.
Wear In Shoulders At Points Opposed To Each Other
1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Play in bearings or ball joint.
Premature Wear In Shoulders
1. Flexing of tire excessive due to under-inflation.
One Sided Feather Edging
1. Wear caused by repeated hard cornering. 2. Camber or toe-in incorrect.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1562
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1563
Part 2 Of 2
Diagnosis List
If the following conditions are noted, rotation is required.
1. Front tire wear is different from rear. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3. Left
and right front tire wear is unequal. 4. Left and right rear tire wear is unequal.
If the following conditions are noted, check the wheel alignment.
1. Left and right front tire wear is unequal. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3.
Front tire treads have scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of tread ribs or blocks.
4. There is cupping, flat spotting etc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1564
Higher than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Hard ride. 2. Poor steering stability. 3. Rapid and uneven wear at center of the tread.
Lower than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Tire squeal on turns. 2. Hard steering. 3. Rapid and uneven wear on the edges of the tread. 4.
Tire rim bruises and rupture. 5. Tire cord breakage. 6. High tire temperatures. 7. Reduced handling.
8. Reduced fuel economy.
Unequal pressure on same axle can cause:
1. Uneven braking. 2. Steering lead. 3. Reduced handling. 4. Swerve on acceleration.
Irregular and Premature Wear
Irregular and/or premature wear has many causes. Some of them are incorrect inflation pressures,
lack of tire rotation, poor driving habits or improper wheel alignment. Incorrect inflation is common
cause of tire premature wear.
NOTE: Due to their design, radial tires tend to wear faster in the shoulder area, particularly on the
front tires. This makes regular rotation especially necessary. After rotation, be sure to check wheel
nut torque, and set tire pressures.
Radial Tire Lead/Pull
"Lead/Pull" is vehicle deviation from a straight path, on a level road with no pressure on the
steering wheel. Lead is usually caused by:
1. Poorly manufactured radial tires. 2. Uneven brake adjustment. 3. Wheel alignment.
The way in which a tire is built can produce lead in a car. An example of this is placement of the
belt. Off-center belts on radial tires can cause the tire to develop a side force while rolling straight
down the road and the tire will tend to roll like a cone. The "Radial Tire Lead/Pull Correction" chart
should be used to make sure that front wheel alignment is not mistaken for tire lead. Rear tires will
not cause lead/pull.
Radial Tire Waddle
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 1565
Waddle is side-to-side movement at the front and/or rear of the car. It can be caused by the steel
belt not being straight within the tire, or by excessive lateral runout of the tire or wheel. It is most
noticeable at low speed, about 8 to 48 km/h (5 to 30 mph). It may also cause rough ride at 80 to
113 km/h (50 to 70 mph). The car can be road tested to see which end of the car has the faulty tire.
If the tire causing the waddle is on the rear, the rear end of the car will "waddle". From the driver's
seat, it feels as if someone is pushing on the side of the car. If the faulty tire is on the front, the
waddle is more easily seen. The front sheet metal appears to be moving back and forth. It feels as
if the driver's seat is the pivot point in the car. Another more time-consuming method of determining
the faulty tire is substituting tire and wheel assemblies that are known to be good. Follow these
steps:
1. Drive the car to determine if the waddle is coming from the front or rear. 2. Install tire and wheel
assemblies known to be good (from a similar car) in place of those on the end of the car which is
waddling. If the waddle
cannot be isolated to front or rear, start with the rear tires.
3. Road test again. If improvement is noted, install the original tire and wheel assemblies one at a
time until the faulty tire is found. If no
improvement is noted, install tires known to be good in place of all four. Then, install the originals
one at a time until the faulty tire is found.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Tires: Service and Repair Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Use a tire changing machine to demount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone to remove
the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or wheel rim could result. Follow the tire changing
machine manufacturer's instructions to properly separate the tire from the wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1568
Tires: Service and Repair Mounting the Tire on the Wheel
CAUTION: Recommended vehicle tire mounting and inflation procedures are especially important
with radial tires. Failure to follow these procedures can cause bead deformation in both tube type
and tubeless tires due to incorrect bead seating. Bead deformation may lead to chafing, lower
sidewall and bead area cracking, eccentric wear, ride vibration and nonretreadable casings. Only
use rims approved for radial tire usage by the rim manufacture.
1. Clean the rim. Remove all rust and other foreign material. 2. Lubricate tire beads and rim bead
seats with an approved rubber lubricant.
CAUTION: Do not use silicon base lubricants. This could cause the tire to slip on the wheel.
3. Attach the tire to the wheel.
a. Use a tire changing machine.
b. Align air valve and tire balancing match marks (about 8 mm diameter paint mark). Hold in this
position and inflate the until the tire beads are
firmly seated on the rim against the flanges (steel wheel model only).
4. Inflate the tire to operating pressure. 5. Check the bead seating.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1569
Tires: Service and Repair Balancing
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance:
a. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically
unbalanced cause a bouncing action called
tramp. This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear.
b. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that
when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
NOTE: Using wheel balancing equipment. Follow the tire balancing machine manufacturer's
instructions to properly balance wheel and tire. Balance weight for the wheel should not exceed
170 g in total, and 140 g is the maximum amount for either side.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1570
Tires: Service and Repair Tire Rotation
Tire rotation is recommended to equalize wear for longer life. If the following conditions are noted,
rotate the tires:
- Front tire wear is different from rear.
- Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire.
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Left and right rear tire wear is unequal. Check wheel alignment if the following conditions are
noted:
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Wear is uneven across the tread of any front tire.
- Front tire treads have a scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of the tread ribs or
blocks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1571
Tires: Service and Repair
Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Use a tire changing machine to demount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone to remove
the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or wheel rim could result. Follow the tire changing
machine manufacturer's instructions to properly separate the tire from the wheel.
Mounting the Tire on the Wheel
CAUTION: Recommended vehicle tire mounting and inflation procedures are especially important
with radial tires. Failure to follow these procedures can cause bead deformation in both tube type
and tubeless tires due to incorrect bead seating. Bead deformation may lead to chafing, lower
sidewall and bead area cracking, eccentric wear, ride vibration and nonretreadable casings. Only
use rims approved for radial tire usage by the rim manufacture.
1. Clean the rim. Remove all rust and other foreign material. 2. Lubricate tire beads and rim bead
seats with an approved rubber lubricant.
CAUTION: Do not use silicon base lubricants. This could cause the tire to slip on the wheel.
3. Attach the tire to the wheel.
a. Use a tire changing machine.
b. Align air valve and tire balancing match marks (about 8 mm diameter paint mark). Hold in this
position and inflate the until the tire beads are
firmly seated on the rim against the flanges (steel wheel model only).
4. Inflate the tire to operating pressure. 5. Check the bead seating.
Balancing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1572
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance:
a. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically
unbalanced cause a bouncing action called
tramp. This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear.
b. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that
when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
NOTE: Using wheel balancing equipment. Follow the tire balancing machine manufacturer's
instructions to properly balance wheel and tire. Balance weight for the wheel should not exceed
170 g in total, and 140 g is the maximum amount for either side.
Tire Rotation
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1573
Tire rotation is recommended to equalize wear for longer life. If the following conditions are noted,
rotate the tires:
- Front tire wear is different from rear.
- Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire.
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Left and right rear tire wear is unequal. Check wheel alignment if the following conditions are
noted:
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Wear is uneven across the tread of any front tire.
- Front tire treads have a scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of the tread ribs or
blocks.
Inflation of Tires
Tire pressure, in cold condition (after vehicle has set for three hours or more, and driven less than
one mile) should be checked monthly or before any extended trip. Tire pressure increases
approximately 15% when the tires become hot during driving. Tire pressure specification is shown
on the label located on the left door lock pillar.
NOTE: Check the tire pressure whenever irregular wear is found. Tire inflation greatly affects tire
wear. If the alignment check does not reveal any alignment problems, check the condition of the
shock absorbers and wheel/tire balance.
Tire Replacement
TIRE REPLACEMENT
When replacement is necessary, the original metric the size should be used. Most metric tire sizes
do not have exact corresponding alphanumeric tire sizes. It is recommended that new tires be
installed in pairs on the same axle. If necessary to replace only one tire, it should be paired with tire
having the most tread, to equalize braking traction.
CAUTION: Do not mix different types of tires such as radial, bias and bias-belted tires except in
emergencies, because vehicle handling may be seriously affected and may result in loss of control.
Tire Dismounting
Remove valve cap on valve step and deflate the tire. Then use a tire changing machine to mount or
dismount tires. Follow the equipment manufacturer's instruction. Do not use hand tools or tire lever
alone to change tires as they may damage the tire beads or wheel rim.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1574
Tire Mounting
Rim bead seats should be cleaned with a wire brush or coarse steel wool to remove lubricants, and
light rust. Before mounting a tire, the bead area should be well lubricated with an approved tire
lubricant. After mounting, inflate the tire to 196 kPa (28 psi) so that beads are completely seated.
Inflate the air to specified pressure and install valve cap to the stem.
WARNING: Never stand over tire when inflating. bead may break when bead snaps over rim's
safety hump and cause serious personal injury. never exceed 240 kPa (35 psi) pressure when
inflating. if 240 kPa (35 psi) pressure will not seat beads, deflate, re-lubricate and re-inflate. over
inflation may cause the bead to break and cause serious personal injury.
Tire Repair
There are many different materials on the market used to repair tires. Manufacturers have
published detailed instructions on how and when to repair tires. These instructions can be obtained
from the tire manufacturer if they are not included with the repair kit.
Wheel Inspection
Damaged wheels and wheels with excessive run-out must be replaced. Wheel run out at rim (Base
on hub Bore):
General Balance Procedure
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 1575
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight
around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically unbalanced cause a bouncing action called tramp.
This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of
weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Specifications
Wheels: Specifications Wheel Runout
Wheel Runout
Axial Runout Steel Wheel 0.0 to 1.0 mm
Aluminum Wheel 0.0 to 0.7 mm
Service Limit 2.0 mm
Maximum
Radial Runout Steel Wheel 0.0 to 1.0 mm
Aluminum Wheel 0.0 to 0.7 mm
Service Limit 1.5 mm
Maximum
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1579
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Check for bent or deformed wheels. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown. 4. Measure the wheel
runout by turning the wheel.
Front And Rear Wheel Axial Runout:
Standard: Steel Wheel: 0 -1.0 mm 10 - 0.04 inch)
- Aluminum Wheel: 0 - 0.7 mm (0 - 0.03 inch)
Service Limit: 2.0 mm (0.08 inch)
Front And Rear Wheel Radial Runout:
Standard: Steel Wheel: 0 -1.0 mm (0 - 0.04 inch)
- Aluminum Wheel: 0 - 0.7 mm (0 - 0.03 inch)
Service Limit: 1.5 mm (0.06 inch)
5. If the wheel runout is more than the service limit, replace the wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications End Play
End Play
End Play Front 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Rear 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1583
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Remove the wheels, then reinstall the wheel nuts. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown.
4. Measure the bearing end play by moving the disc in or outward. Front/Rear: Standard: 0 - 0.05
mm (0 - 0.002 inch) 5. If the bearing end play measurement is more than the standard, replace the
wheel bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1584
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Wheel bearings and hub on these models are an integral assembly and bearings cannot be
adjusted. If hub endplay exceeds 0.002 inch with spindle nut properly tightened, hub and bearing
assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint remover, 28 mm
- 07JAF-SH20110 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Pilot, 38 mm
- 07JAF-SH20120 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Shaft, 22.4 x 25.4 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm
- 07GAF-SE00401 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Base
- 07947-6340201 Driver Attachment 58 x 72 mm
- 07965-SD90100 Support Base
- 07GAF-SE00200 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Guide Attachment
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1587
2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1588
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1589
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1590
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1591
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1592
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1593
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Suspension > Page 1594
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
The rear bearing is to be serviced with the wheel wheel hub as one unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Nut ............................................................................................................................................
................................................... 110 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1609
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1610
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1611
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1612
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1613
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1614
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1615
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1616
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1617
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1618
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1619
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1620
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1621
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1622
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1623
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1624
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 14 - 30 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 1629
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1 > Page 1632
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 1633
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Disconnect the 1P connector from the VTEC solenoid valve.
2. Measure resistance between the terminal and body ground.
Resistance: 14 - 30 ohms
3. If the resistance is within specifications, remove the VTEC solenoid valve assembly from the
cylinder head, and check the VTEC solenoid valve
filter for clogging.
- If there is clogging, replace the engine oil filter and the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 1634
4. If the filter is not clogged, push the VTEC solenoid valve with your finger and check its
movement.
- If the VTEC solenoid valve is normal, check the engine oil pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Check compression with engine at normal operating temperature and throttle in wide open position.
Prior to performing test, disable ignition and fuel injection to prevent fuel from being sprayed into
cylinders while cranking engine. Ensure is fully charged and that cranking speed is 250 RPM.
Standard reading should be 135-184 psi. The maximum variation between cylinders is 28 psi.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft: Specifications
Maximum Journal Run-out 0.001 in
Camshaft Bearing Clearance 0.002-0.004 in
Camshaft End Play 0.002-0.006 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1642
Camshaft: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: Do not rotate the camshaft during inspection.
- Remove the rocker arms and rocker shafts.
1. Put the camshaft and the camshaft holders on the cylinder head, then tighten the bolts to the
specified torque.
Specified torque:
8 mm bolts: 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm 14 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads. 6 mm bolts: 12 Nm (1.2
kgs.cm 8.7 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads.
2. Seat the camshaft by pushing it toward the rear of the cylinder head.
3. Zero the dial indicator against the end of the camshaft. Push the camshaft back and forth, and
read the end play.
Camshaft End Play:
Standard (New): 0.05 - 0.15 mm (0.002 - 0.006 inch) Service Limit: 0.5 mm (0.02 inch)
4. Remove the bolts, then remove the camshaft holders from the cylinder head.
- Lift the camshaft out of the cylinder head, wipe it clean, then inspect the lip ramps. Replace the
camshaft if any lobes are pitted, scored, or excessively worn.
- Clean the camshaft bearing surfaces in the cylinder head, then set the camshaft back in place.
- Place a plastigage strip across each journal.
5. Install the camshaft holders, and tighten the bolts to the specified torque.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1643
6. Remove the camshaft holders, then measure the widest portion of the plastigage on each
journal.
Camshaft-to-Holder Oil Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.050 - 0.089 mm (0.002 - 0.004 inch) Service Limit: 0.15 mm (0.006 inch)
7. If the camshaft-to-holder oil clearance is out of tolerance:
- And the camshaft has already been replaced, you must replace the cylinder head.
- If the camshaft has not been replaced, first check the total runout with the camshaft supported on
V-blocks.
Camshaft Total Runout:
Standard (New): 0.03 mm (0.001 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.04 mm (0.002 inch)
- If the total runout of the camshaft is within tolerance, replace the cylinder head.
- If the total runout is out of tolerance, replace the camshaft and recheck the camshaft-to-holder oil
clearance. If the oil clearance is still out of tolerance, replace the cylinder head.
8. Check the cam lobe height wear.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1644
Cam lobe height standard (New)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1645
Camshaft: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
NOTE: For removal refer to Cylinder Head Assembly / Service and Repair.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
- Make sure that all rockers are in alignment with their valves when torquing the rocker assembly
bolts.
- Valve locknuts should be loosened and adjusting screws backed off before installation.
- To prevent the rocker arm assembly from coming apart, leave the camshaft holder bolts in the
holders.
1. After wiping down the camshaft, camshaft seal and journals in the cylinder head, lubricate both
surfaces and install the camshaft.
2. Clean and install the oil control orifice with a new O-ring. 3. Turn the camshaft until its keyway is
facing up (No. 1 piston Top Dead Center [TDC]).
4. Apply liquid gasket (Part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003, or equivalent) to the head mating
surfaces of the No. 1 and No. 5 camshaft holders.
- Apply liquid gasket to the shaded areas.
5. Set the rocker arm assembly in place and loosely install the bolts.
- Make sure that the rocker arms are properly positioned on the valve stems.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1646
6. Tighten each bolt two turns at a time in the sequence shown to ensure that the rockers do not
bind on the valves.
- Specified torque: 8 mm bolts: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.) apply engine oil to the threads.
- 6 mm bolts: 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.) apply engine oil to the threads.
NOTE: 6 mm bolts are identified by the numbers (11), (12), (13), (14).
7. Install the back cover, then install the camshaft pulley
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Service Tips
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1651
NOTE: Identify parts as they are removed to ensure reinstallation in original locations.
- Inspect rocker shafts and rocker arms.
- Rocker arms must be installed in the same position if reused.
- When removing or installing the rocker arm assembly, do not remove the camshaft holder bolts.
The bolts will keep the holders, springs and rocker arms on the shaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1652
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Loosen the adjusting screws.
2. Unscrew the camshaft holder bolts, then remove the rocker arm assembly.
NOTE: Unscrew the camshaft holder bolts two turns at a time, in a crisscross pattern, to prevent damaging
the valves or rocker arm assembly.
- When removing the rocker arm assembly, do not remove the camshaft holder bolts. The bolts will
keep the camshaft holders, the springs and the rocker arms on the shaft.
Camshaft Holder Bolts Loosening Sequence:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1653
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Inspection
Clearance Inspection
Clearance Inspection
Measure both the intake rocker shaft and exhaust rocker shaft.
1. Measure the diameter of the shaft at the first rocker location.
2. Zero the gauge to the shaft diameter.
3. Measure the inside diameter of the rocker arm and check for an out-of-round condition.
Rocker Arm-to-Shaft Clearance:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1654
Standard (New):
Intake: 0.017 - 0.050 mm (0.0007 - 0.0020 inch) Exhaust: 0.018 - 0.054 mm (0.0007 - 0.0021 inch)
Service Limit: 0.08 mm (0.003 inch)
4. Repeat these measurements on all the rockers.
- If the clearance is over the service limit, replace the rocker shaft and all over-tolerance rocker
arms.
Inspection Using Special Tools
CAUTION: Before using the Valve Inspection Tool, make sure that the air pressure gauge on the air
compressor indicates over 400 kPa (4 kgf.cm, 57 psi).
- Inspect the valve clearance before rocker arm inspection.
- Cover the timing belt with a shop towel to protect the belt.
- Check the intake primary rocker arm of each cylinder at TDC.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Plug the relief hole with the special tool.
3. Remove the sealing bolt from the inspection hole and connect an air pressure regulator with a 0
- 100 psi gauge.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1655
4. Loosen the regulator valve on the valve inspection tool and apply the specified air pressure.
Specified Air Pressure: 250 kPa (2.5 kgf.cm, 36 psi)
5. Make sure that the intake primary and secondary rocker arms are mechanically connected by
the piston and that the mid rocker arm does not move
when pushed manually.
6. If any intake mid rocker arm moves independently of the primary and secondary rocker arms,
replace the rocker arms as a set. 7. Remove the special tools.
8. Use a 10 mm diameter rod to depress each lost motion assembly through its full movement.
Replace any lost motion assembly that does move
smoothly.
9. After inspection, check that the MIL does not come on.
Manual Inspection
1. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. 2. Remove the cylinder head cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1656
3. Push the intake mid rocker arm on the No. 1 cylinder manually.
4. Check that the intake mid rocker arm moves independently of the primary and secondary intake
rocker arms. 5. Check the intake mid rocker arm of each cylinder at TDC.
- If the intake mid rocker arm does not move, remove the mid, primary and secondary intake rocker
arms as an assembly and check that the pistons in the mid and primary rocker arms move
smoothly.
- If any rocker arm needs replacing, replace the primary, mid, and secondary rocker arms as an
assembly.
Lost Motion Assemblies Inspection
Inspection
NOTE: When reassembling the primary rocker arm, carefully apply air pressure to the oil passage
of the rocker arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1657
1. Inspect the rocker arm piston. Push it manually.
- If it does not move smoothly, replace the rocker arm assembly.
NOTE: Apply oil to the pistons when reassembling.
- Bundle the rocker arms with a rubber band to prevent them from separating.
D16Y5 engine:
NOTE: Set the timing plate and return spring as shown below.
D16Y8 engine:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1658
2. Remove the lost motion assembly from the holder and inspect it. Test it by pushing the plunger
with your finger.
- If the lost motion assembly plunger does not move smoothly, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1659
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Assembly
CAMSHAFT, ROCKER ARMS AND CAMSHAFT SEAL/PULLEY INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Make sure that all rockers are in alignment with their valves when torquing the rocker assembly
bolts.
- Valve locknuts should be loosened and adjusting screws backed off before installation.
- To prevent the rocker arm assembly from coming apart, leave the camshaft holder bolts in the
holders.
1. After wiping down the camshaft, camshaft seal and journals in the cylinder head, lubricate both
surfaces and install the camshaft.
2. Clean and install the oil control orifice with a new O-ring. 3. Turn the camshaft until its keyway is
facing up (No. 1 piston TDC).
4. Apply liquid gasket (Part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003) to the head mating surfaces of the No.
1 and No. 5 camshaft holders.
- Apply liquid gasket to the shaded areas.
5. Set the rocker arm assembly in place and loosely install the bolts.
- Make sure that the rocker arms are properly positioned on the valve stems.
6. Tighten each bolt two turns at a time in the sequence shown to ensure that the rockers do not
bind on the valves.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1660
Specified torque:
8 mm bolts: 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads. 6 mm bolts: 12 Nm (1.2
kgs.cm, 8.7 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads. 6 mm bolts: (11), (12), (13), (14)
7. Install the back cover, then install the camshaft pulley.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1665
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1666
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1667
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1668
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1669
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1670
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1671
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1672
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1673
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1674
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1675
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1676
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1677
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1678
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1679
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1680
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Application and ID
Connecting Rod Bearing: Application and ID
CAUTION: If the codes are indecipherable because of an accumulation of dirt and dust, do not
scrub them with a wire brush or scraper. Clean them only with sol" vent or detergent.
NOTE: Numbers have been stamped on the side of each connecting rod as a code for the size of
the big end. Use them, and the letters stamped on the crankshaft (codes for rod journal size), to
choose the correct bearings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Application and ID > Page 1685
Connecting Rod Bearing: Testing and Inspection
CLEARANCE
1. Remove the connecting rod cap and bearing half.
2. Clean the crankshaft rod journal and bearing half with a clean shop towel.
3. Place plastigage across the rod journal.
4. Reinstall the bearing half and cap, and torque the nuts.
Torque
B16A2 engine: 40 Nm (4.1 kgs.cm, 30 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 31 Nm (3.2 kgs.cm,
23 ft.lbs.)
NOTE: Do not rotate the crankshaft during inspection.
5. Remove the rod cap and bearing half and measure the widest part of the plastigage.
Connecting Rod Bearing-to-Journal Oil Clearance:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.032 - 0.050 mm (0.0013 - 0.0020 inch) Service Limit: 0.06 mm (0.002 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.020 - 0.038 mm (0.0008 - 0.0015 inch) Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
6. If the plastigage measures too wide or too narrow, remove the upper half of the bearing, install a
new, complete bearing with the same color code
(select the color as shown in the right column), and recheck the clearance.
CAUTION: Do not file, shim, or scrape the bearings or the caps to adjust clearance.
7. If the plastigage shows the clearance is still incorrect, try the next larger or smaller bearing (the
color listed above or below that one), and check
clearance again.
NOTE: If the proper clearance cannot be obtained by using the appropriate larger or smaller
bearings, replace the crankshaft and start over.
SELECTION
CAUTION: If the codes are indecipherable because of an accumulation of dirt and dust, do not
scrub them with a wire brush or scraper. Clean them only with solvent or detergent.
Connecting Rod Code Location
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Application and ID > Page 1686
Numbers have been stamped on the side of each connecting rod as a code for the size of the big
end. Use them, and the letters stamped on the crankshaft (codes for rod journal size), to choose
the correct bearings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Connecting Rod Damage Information
Connecting Rod: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Connecting Rod Damage Information
Why Do Connecting Rods Break?
Curious why connecting rods break? Afier all, these are heavy-duty parts specifically designed to
endure punishing forces and temperatures. Yet, every once in a while they do bend or break and
wind up as cool conversation pieces for a coffee table or desk.
Connecting rods break only after they've gotten bent. And they won't get bent unless the engine
hydro-locks or the rod bearings fail.
When troubleshooting a bent or broken connecting rod, here are some things to consider:
^ The number one culprit for connecting rod breakage is hydro-lock. This happens when liquid
(water or fuel) entering the combustion chamber exceeds
the chamber's volume. Since liquids don't compress, that extra volume in the chamber causes the
rod to bend. You won't really notice anything wrong, until that bent rod finally gives out and breaks.
This could happen if you're driving through deep, standing water and someone coming the other
way splashes water over your hood. On very rare occasions, a bad ECM/PCM or fuel injector can
cause too much fuel to enter a cylinder, causing hydro-lock and resulting in a bent rod. Before this
happens, though, there are usually some kind of drive ability problems that crop up and remain
afier the engine is fixed.
A bent rod might not show any symptoms until it actually breaks. But bent rods leave a
wider-than-normal carbon witness line in the cylinder because they're shorter. Typically, a healthy
engine has a carbon line that's 6 mm deep. An engine that's suffering from bent rods has a second
carbon line that's 9 to 12 mm deep.
^ Connecting rod bearings fail for a number of reasons. To properly determine what actually
caused a rod bearing to fail, you've got to take apart all rod
bearings and main bearings and compare them side by side. If all or most of the bearings and
journals show similar damage (scoring, exposed copper, or heat discoloration) the likely cause is
oil starvation, poor maintenance, customer abuse, or running the engine with an aftermarket power
booster (nitrous oxide setup, supercharger, turbocharger). If only the bearing or journal for the
failed rod looks bad but all the other ones look good (no scoring, no exposed copper or heat
discoloration) and the crankshaft journals are smooth with no heat discoloration, then that particular
bearing/ clearance would be suspect.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1691
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Standard (New) Service Limit
Small End Bore Diameter 18.96 - 18.98 mm --Large End Bore Diameter (Nominal) 48.0 mm --End Play Installed on Crankshaft 015 - 0.30 mm 0.40 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection End Play
CONNECTING ROD
Connecting Rod End Play:
Standard (New): 0.15 - 0.30 mm (0.006 - 0.012 inch) Service Limit: 0.40 mm (0.016 inch)
- If out-of-tolerance, install a new connecting rod.
- If still out-of-tolerance, replace the crankshaft.
CRANKSHAFT
Push the crankshaft firmly away from the dial indicator, and zero the dial against the end of the
crankshaft. Then pull the crankshaft firmly back toward the indicator; dial reading should not
exceed service limit.
Crankshaft End Play:
Standard (New): 0.10 - 0.35 mm (0.004 - 0.014 inch) Service Limit: 0.45 mm (0.018 inch)
- If end play is excessive, inspect the thrust washers and thrust surface on the crankshaft. Replace
parts as necessary.
NOTE: Thrust washer thickness is fixed and must not be changed either by grinding or shimming.
Thrust washers are installed with grooved sides facing outward.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play > Page 1694
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection Selection
SELECTION
Each rod falls into one of four tolerance ranges (from 0 to + 0.024 mm (0 to + 0.0009 inch), in 0.006
mm (0.0002 inch) increments) depending on the size of its big end bore. It's then stamped with a
number (1, 2, 3, or 4) indicating the range. You may find any combination of 1, 2, 3, or 4 in any
engine.
Normal Bore Size: 48.0 mm (1.89 inch)
NOTE: Reference numbers are for big end bore size and do NOT indicate the position of the rod in the
engine.
- Inspect connecting rod for cracks and heat damage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1695
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair
Referal
For information regarding this component, and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Cylinder Block Assembly / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
First step:
25 Nm (2.5 kgs.cm, 18 ft.lbs.)
Second step:
B16A2 engine: 76 Nm (7.8 kgs.cm, 56 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 51 Nm (5.2 kgs.cm,
38 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1699
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Application and ID
CAUTION: If the codes are indecipherable because of an accumulation of dirt and dust, do not
scrub them with a wire brush or scraper. Clean them only with solvent or detergent.
NOTE:
- Letters have been stamped on the end of the block as a code for the size of each of the 5 main
journal bores.
- Use them, and the numbers stamped on the crankshaft (codes for main journal size), to choose
the correct bearings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1700
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Testing and Inspection
CLEARANCE
1. To check main bearing-to-journal oil clearance, remove the main caps and bearing halves.
2. Clean each main journal and bearing half with a clean shop towel.
3. Place one strip of plastigage across each main journal.
NOTE: If the engine is still in the car when you bolt the main cap down to check clearance, the
weight of the crankshaft and flywheel will flatten the plastigage further than just the torque on the
cap bolt, and give you an incorrect reading. For an accurate reading, support the crank with a jack
under the counterweights and check only one bearing at a time.
4. Reinstall the bearings and caps, then torque the bolts.
1st step: 25 Nm (2.5 kgs.cm, 18 ft.lbs.) Final step:
B16A2 engine: 76 Nm (7.8 kgs.cm, 56 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 51 Nm (5.2 kgs.cm,
38 ft.lbs.)
NOTE: Do not rotate the crankshaft during inspection.
5. Remove the cap and bearing again, and measure the widest part of the plastigage.
Main Bearing-to-Journal Oil Clearance:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New):
No.1, 2, 4, 5 Journals: 0.024 - 0.042 mm (0.0009 - 0.0017 inch) No.3 Journals: 0.030 - 0.048 mm
(0.0012 - 0.0019 inch)
Service Limit: 0.06 mm (0.002 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New):
No.1, 5 Journals: 0.018 - 0.036 mm (0.0007 - 0.0014 inch) No. 2,3,4 Journals: 0.024 - 0.042 mm
(0.0009 - 0.0017 inch)
Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
6. If the plastigage measures too wide or too narrow, (remove the engine if it's still in the car),
remove the crankshaft, and remove the upper half of
the bearing. Install a new, complete bearing with the same color code, and recheck the clearance.
CAUTION: Do not file, shim, or scrape the bearings or the caps to adjust clearance.
7. If the plastigage shows the clearance is still incorrect, try the next larger or smaller bearing (the
color listed above or below that one), and check
again.
NOTE: If the proper clearance cannot be obtained by using the appropriate larger or smaller
bearings, replace the crankshaft and start over.
SELECTION
CAUTION: If the codes are indecipherable because of an accumulation of dirt and dust, do not
scrub them with a wire brush or scraper. Clean them only with solvent or detergent.
Crankshaft Bore Code Location
B16A2 Engine:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1701
Letters have been stamped on the end of the block as a code for the size of each of the 5 main
journal bores.
Use them, and the numbers or bars stamped on the crank (codes for main journal size), to choose
the correct bearings.
D16Y5,D16Y7,D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1702
Letters have been stamped on the end of the block as a code for the size of each of the 5 main
journal bores.
Use them, and the numbers stamped on the crankshaft (codes for main journal size), to choose the
correct bearings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1703
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
Referal
For information regarding this component, and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Cylinder Block Assembly / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Out-Of-Round:
Standard (New)
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.0025 mm (0.0001 inch) Max. Service Limit ......................................................................................
................................................................................... 0.005 mm (0.0002 inch)
Runout:
Standard (New) ...................................................................................................................................
.............................. 0.03 mm (0.001 inch) Max. Service Limit .............................................................
................................................................................................................ 0.04 mm (0.002 inch)
Taper:
Standard (New)
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.0025 mm (0.0001 inch) Max.
Service Limit ........................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.005 mm (0.002 inch)
End Play:
Standard (New)
.......................................................................................................................................................
0.10-0.35 mm (0.004-0.014 inch) Service Limit ...................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 0.45 mm (0.018 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play
Crankshaft: Testing and Inspection End Play
CONNECTING ROD
Connecting Rod End Play:
Standard (New): 0.15 - 0.30 mm (0.006 - 0.012 inch) Service Limit: 0.40 mm (0.016 inch)
- If out-of-tolerance, install a new connecting rod.
- If still out-of-tolerance, replace the crankshaft.
CRANKSHAFT
Push the crankshaft firmly away from the dial indicator, and zero the dial against the end of the
crankshaft. Then pull the crankshaft firmly back toward the indicator; dial reading should not
exceed service limit.
Crankshaft End Play:
Standard (New): 0.10 - 0.35 mm (0.004 - 0.014 inch) Service Limit: 0.45 mm (0.018 inch)
- If end play is excessive, inspect the thrust washers and thrust surface on the crankshaft. Replace
parts as necessary.
NOTE: Thrust washer thickness is fixed and must not be changed either by grinding or shimming.
Thrust washers are installed with grooved sides facing outward.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play > Page 1709
Crankshaft: Testing and Inspection Main Bearing Inspection
CLEARANCE
1. To check main bearing-to-journal oil clearance, remove the main caps and bearing halves.
2. Clean each main journal and bearing half with a clean shop towel.
3. Place one strip of plastigage across each main journal.
NOTE: If the engine is still in the car when you bolt the main cap down to check clearance, the
weight of the crankshaft and flywheel will flatten the plastigage further than just the torque on the
cap bolt, and give you an incorrect reading. For an accurate reading, support the crank with a jack
under the counterweights and check only one bearing at a time.
4. Reinstall the bearings and caps, then torque the bolts.
1st step: 25 Nm (2.5 kgs.cm, 18 ft.lbs.) Final step:
B16A2 engine: 76 Nm (7.8 kgs.cm, 56 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 51 Nm (5.2 kgs.cm,
38 ft.lbs.)
NOTE: Do not rotate the crankshaft during inspection.
5. Remove the cap and bearing again, and measure the widest part of the plastigage.
Main Bearing-to-Journal Oil Clearance:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New):
No.1, 2, 4, 5 Journals: 0.024 - 0.042 mm (0.0009 - 0.0017 inch) No.3 Journals: 0.030 - 0.048 mm
(0.0012 - 0.0019 inch)
Service Limit: 0.06 mm (0.002 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New):
No.1, 5 Journals: 0.018 - 0.036 mm (0.0007 - 0.0014 inch) No. 2,3,4 Journals: 0.024 - 0.042 mm
(0.0009 - 0.0017 inch)
Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
6. If the plastigage measures too wide or too narrow, (remove the engine if it's still in the car),
remove the crankshaft, and remove the upper half of
the bearing. Install a new, complete bearing with the same color code, and recheck the clearance.
CAUTION: Do not file, shim, or scrape the bearings or the caps to adjust clearance.
7. If the plastigage shows the clearance is still incorrect, try the next larger or smaller bearing (the
color listed above or below that one), and check
again.
NOTE: If the proper clearance cannot be obtained by using the appropriate larger or smaller
bearings, replace the crankshaft and start over.
SELECTION
CAUTION: If the codes are indecipherable because of an accumulation of dirt and dust, do not
scrub them with a wire brush or scraper. Clean them only with solvent or detergent.
Crankshaft Bore Code Location
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play > Page 1710
B16A2 Engine:
Letters have been stamped on the end of the block as a code for the size of each of the 5 main
journal bores.
Use them, and the numbers or bars stamped on the crank (codes for main journal size), to choose
the correct bearings.
D16Y5,D16Y7,D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > End Play > Page 1711
Letters have been stamped on the end of the block as a code for the size of each of the 5 main
journal bores.
Use them, and the numbers stamped on the crankshaft (codes for main journal size), to choose the
correct bearings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Disassembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove the oil pan assembly.
2. Remove the right side cover. 3. Remove the oil screen.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1714
4. Remove the oil pump. 5. Remove the baffle plate (B16A2 engine).
6. Remove the bolts and the bearing caps.
CAUTION: To prevent warpage unscrew the bolts in sequence 1/3 turn at a time, repeat the
sequence until all bolts are loosened.
7. Remove the rod caps/bearings and main caps/bearings. Keep all caps/bearing in order.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1715
8. Lift the crankshaft out of the engine, being careful not to damage journals. 9. Remove the upper
bearing halves from the connecting rods and set them aside with their respective caps.
10. Reinstall the main caps and bearings on the engine in proper order.
11. If you can feel ridge of metal or hard carbon around the top of each cylinder, remove it with a
ridge reamer. Follow the reamer manufacturer's
instructions.
CAUTION: If the ridge is not removed, it may damage the pistons as they are pushed out.
12. Use the wooden handle of a hammer to drive the pistons out. 13. Reinstall the connecting rod
bearings and caps after removing each piston/connecting rod assembly. 14. Mark each
piston/connecting rod assembly with its cylinder number to avoid mix-up on reassembly.
NOTE: The existing number on the connecting rod does not indicate its position in the engine, it
indicates the rod bore size.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1716
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Inspection
INSPECTION
- Clean the crankshaft oil passages with pipe cleaners or a suitable brush.
- Check the keyway and threads.
ALIGNMENT
- Measure runout on all main journals to make sure the crank is not bent.
- The difference between measurements on each journal must not be more than the service limit.
Crankshaft Total Indicated Runout:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.020 mm (0.0008 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.030 mm (0.0012 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.03 mm (0.001 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.04 mm (0.002 inch)
OUT-OF-ROUND AND TAPER
- Measure out-of-round at the middle of each rod and main journal in two places.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1717
- The difference between measurements on each journal must not be more than the service limit.
Journal Out-of-Round:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.0004 mm (0.0002 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.006 mm (0.0002 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.0025 mm (0.0001 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.005 mm (0.0002 inch)
- Measure taper at the edges of each rod and main journal.
- The difference between measurements on each journal must not be more than the service limit.
Journal Taper:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.005 mm (0.0002 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.010 mm (0.004 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.0025 mm (0.0001 inch) max. Service Limit: 0.005 mm (0.0002 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1718
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Assembly
Before installing the crankshaft, apply a coat of engine oil to the main bearings and rod bearings.
1. Insert the bearing halves into the cylinder block and connecting rods.
2. Hold the crankshaft so the rod journals for cylinders No. 2 and No. 3 are straight down.
3. Lower the crankshaft into the block, seating the rod journals into connecting rods No. 2 and No.
3, and install the rod caps and nuts finger-tight.
4. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, seat journals into connecting rods No. 1 and No. 4, and install
the rod caps and nuts finger-tight.
NOTE: Install caps so the bearing recess is on the same side as the recess in the rod.
5. Check rod bearing clearance with plastigage, then torque the cap nuts. Apply engine oil to the
bolt threads.
Torque:
B16A2 engine: 40 Nm (4.1 kgs.cm, 30 ft.lbs.) D16Y5,D16Y7,D16Y8 engines: 31 Nm (3.2 kgs.cm,
23 ft.lbs.)
NOTE: Reference numbers on connecting rod are for big-end bore tolerance and do not indicate
the position of piston in the engine.
6. Install the thrust washers on the No. 4 journal. Oil the thrust washer surfaces.
7. Install the main bearing caps. Check clearance with plastigage, then tighten the bearing cap
bolts in 2 steps.
First step: 25 Nm (2.5 kgs.cm, 18 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1719
Second step:
B16A2 engine: 76 Nm (7.8 kgs.cm, 56 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 51 Nm (5.2 kgs.cm,
38 ft.lbs.)
NOTE: Coat the thrust washer surfaces and bolt threads with oil.
CAUTION: Whenever any crankshaft or connecting rod bearing is replaced, it is necessary after
reassembly to run the engine at idling speed until it reaches normal operating temperature, then
continue to run it for approximately 15 minutes.
NOTE: Use liquid gasket, part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003.
- Check that the mating surfaces are clean and dry before applying liquid gasket.
- Apply liquid gasket evenly, being careful to cover all the mating surface.
- To prevent oil leakage, apply liquid gasket to the inner threads of the bolt holes.
- Do not install the parts if five minutes or more have elapsed since applying the liquid gasket.
Instead reapply liquid gasket after removing the old residue.
- After assembly, wait at least 30 minutes before filling the engine with oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1720
8. Apply liquid gasket to the block mating surface of the right side cover, then install it on the
cylinder block.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1721
9. Apply liquid gasket to the oil pump mating surface of the block, then install the oil pump on the
cylinder block.
Apply grease to the lips of the oil seals. Then, align the inner rotor with the crankshaft and install
the oil pump. When the pump is in place, clean any excess grease off the crankshaft. Check that
the oil seal lips are not distorted.
NOTE: Apply a light coat of oil to the crankshaft and to the lip of seal.
- Use new O-rings and apply oil when installing them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1722
10. Install the oil screen.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
When installing and tightening the pulley, follow the procedure below.
Clean, remove any oil, and lubricate points shown.
Crankshaft pulley bolt size and torque value:
14 x 1.25 mm 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.) + 90°
NOTE: Do not use an impact wrench when installing.
1. Tighten the pulley bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1726
2. Use a felt tip pen to mark the pulley bolt head and washer.
3. Tighten the pulley bolt an additional 90°.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1727
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
When installing and tightening the pulley, follow the procedure below.
Clean, remove any oil, and lubricate points shown.
Crankshaft pulley bolt size and torque value: 14 x 1.25 mm 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.) + 90°
NOTE: Do not use an impact wrench when installing.
1. Tighten the pulley bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1728
2. Use a felt tip pen to mark the pulley bolt head and washer.
3. Tighten the pulley bolt an additional 90°.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Piston: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Check the piston for distortion or cracks.
NOTE: If a cylinder is bored, an oversized piston must be used.
2. Measure the piston diameter at a distance A from bottom of the skirt.
B16A2 engine:
A: 15 mm (0.6 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
A: 5 mm (0.2 inch)
Piston Diameter:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 80.980 - 80.990 mm (3.1882 - 3.1886 inch) Service Limit: 80.970 mm (3.1878
inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 74.980 - 74.990 mm (2.9520 - 2.9524 inch) Service Limit: 74.970 mm (2.9516
inch)
3. Calculate the difference between the cylinder bore diameter and the piston diameter.
Piston-to-Cylinder Clearance
Standard (New): 0.010 - 0.040 mm (0.0004 - 0.0016 inch) Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
If the clearance is near or exceeds the service limit, inspect the piston and cylinder block for
excessive wear.
Oversize Piston Diameter
B16A2 engine:
0.25: 81.23 - 81.24 mm (3.1980 - 3.1984 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1732
0.25: 75.23 - 75.24 mm (2.9618 - 2.9622 inch) 0.50: 75.48 - 75.49 mm (2.9716 - 2.9720 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Piston: Service and Repair Disassembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove the oil pan assembly.
2. Remove the right side cover. 3. Remove the oil screen.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1735
4. Remove the oil pump. 5. Remove the baffle plate (B16A2 engine).
6. Remove the bolts and the bearing caps.
CAUTION: To prevent warpage unscrew the bolts in sequence 1/3 turn at a time, repeat the
sequence until all bolts are loosened.
7. Remove the rod caps/bearings and main caps/bearings. Keep all caps/bearing in order.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1736
8. Lift the crankshaft out of the engine, being careful not to damage journals. 9. Remove the upper
bearing halves from the connecting rods and set them aside with their respective caps.
10. Reinstall the main caps and bearings on the engine in proper order.
11. If you can feel ridge of metal or hard carbon around the top of each cylinder, remove it with a
ridge reamer. Follow the reamer manufacturer's
instructions.
CAUTION: If the ridge is not removed, it may damage the pistons as they are pushed out.
12. Use the wooden handle of a hammer to drive the pistons out. 13. Reinstall the connecting rod
bearings and caps after removing each piston/connecting rod assembly. 14. Mark each
piston/connecting rod assembly with its cylinder number to avoid mix-up on reassembly.
NOTE: The existing number on the connecting rod does not indicate its position in the engine, it
indicates the rod bore size.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1737
Piston: Service and Repair Assembly
Before installing the pistons, apply a coat of engine oil to the ring grooves and cylinder bores.
1. If the crankshaft is already installed:
- Set the crankshaft to BDC for each cylinder.
- Remove the connecting rod caps, and slip short sections of rubber hose over the threaded ends
of the connecting rod bolts.
- Install the ring compressor, check that the bearing is securely in place, then position the piston in
the cylinder, and tap it in using the wooden handle of a hammer.
- Stop after the ring compressor pops free, and check the connecting rod-to-crank journal
alignment before pushing the piston into place.
- Apply engine oil to the bolt threads. Install the rod caps with bearings, and torque the nuts to:
B16A2 engine: 40 Nm (4.1 kgs.cm, 30 ft.lbs.) D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines: 31 Nm (3.2 kgs.cm,
23 ft.lbs.)
2. If the crankshaft is not installed:
- Remove the rod caps and bearings, install the ring compressor, then position the piston in the
cylinder, and tap it in using the wooden handle of a hammer.
- Position all pistons at top dead center.
NOTE: Maintain downward force on the ring compressor to prevent the rings from expanding
before entering the cylinder bore.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1738
Piston: Service and Repair Piston Pins
REMOVAL
1. Assemble the special tool as shown.
2. Assemble and adjust the length of the piston pin driver and shaft to 53 mm (2.1 inch) as shown.
3. Place the piston on the special tool and press the pin out with the special tools and a hydraulic
press.
INSPECTION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1739
1. Measure the diameter of the piston pin.
Piston Pin Diameter:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 20.994 - 21.000 mm (0.8265 - 0.8268 inch) Oversize: 20.997 - 21.003 (0.8267 0.8269 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 18.994 - 19.000 mm (0.7478 - 0.7480 inch) Oversize: 18.997 - 19.003 (0.7479 0.7481 inch)
NOTE: All replacement piston pins are oversize.
2. Zero the dial indicator to the piston pin diameter.
3. Measure the piston pin-to-piston clearance.
NOTE: Check the piston for distortion or cracks.
If the piston pin clearance is greater than 0.024 mm (0.0009 inch), remeasure using an oversized
piston pin.
Piston Pin-to-Piston Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.010 - 0.022 mm (0.0004 - 0.0009 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1740
4. Check the difference between the piston pin diameter and the connecting rod small end
diameter.
Piston Pin-to-Connecting Rod Interference:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.013 - 0.032 mm (0.0005 - 0.0013 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.014 - 0.040 mm (0.0006 - 0.0016 inch)
INSTALLATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1741
1. Use a hydraulic press for installation.
- When pressing the pin in or out, be sure you position the recessed flat on the piston against the
lugs on the base attachment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Piston Pin Diameter .............................................................................................................................
................................................ 0.7478-0.7480 inches
Piston Pin To Piston Clearance
............................................................................................................................................................
0.0004-0.0009 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1745
Piston Pin: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Assemble the special tool as shown.
2. Assemble and adjust the length of the piston pin driver and shaft to 53 mm (2.1 inch) as shown.
3. Place the piston on the special tool and press the pin out with the special tools and a hydraulic
press.
INSPECTION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1746
1. Measure the diameter of the piston pin.
Piston Pin Diameter:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 20.994 - 21.000 mm (0.8265 - 0.8268 inch) Oversize: 20.997 - 21.003 (0.8267 0.8269 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 18.994 - 19.000 mm (0.7478 - 0.7480 inch) Oversize: 18.997 - 19.003 (0.7479 0.7481 inch)
NOTE: All replacement piston pins are oversize.
2. Zero the dial indicator to the piston pin diameter.
3. Measure the piston pin-to-piston clearance.
NOTE: Check the piston for distortion or cracks.
If the piston pin clearance is greater than 0.024 mm (0.0009 inch), remeasure using an oversized
piston pin.
Piston Pin-to-Piston Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.010 - 0.022 mm (0.0004 - 0.0009 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1747
4. Check the difference between the piston pin diameter and the connecting rod small end
diameter.
Piston Pin-to-Connecting Rod Interference:
B16A2 engine:
Standard (New): 0.013 - 0.032 mm (0.0005 - 0.0013 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines:
Standard (New): 0.014 - 0.040 mm (0.0006 - 0.0016 inch)
INSTALLATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1748
1. Use a hydraulic press for installation.
- When pressing the pin in or out, be sure you position the recessed flat on the piston against the
lugs on the base attachment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston Diameter (Std.) .........................................................................................................................
................................................. 2.9520-2.9524 inches Piston Clearance ............................................
......................................................................................................................................
0.0004-0.0016 inches Piston Pin Diameter .........................................................................................
.................................................................................... 0.7478-0.7480 inches Piston Pin To Piston
Clearance
............................................................................................................................................................
0.0004-0.0009 inches Piston Ring End Gap:
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 0.006-0.012 inches Second .....................................................................
...................................................................................................................... 0.012-0.018 inches Oil ..
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................. 0.008-0.028 inches
Piston Ring To Groove Clearance
Top Ring ..............................................................................................................................................
...................................... 0.0014-0.0024 inches Second Ring .............................................................
.................................................................................................................. 0.0012-0.0022 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1752
Piston Ring: Service and Repair
END GAP
1. Using a piston, push a new ring into the cylinder bore 15 - 20 mm (0.6 - 0.8 inch) from the
bottom.
2. Measure the piston ring end-gap with a feeler gauge:
- If the gap is too small, check to see if you have the proper rings for your engine.
- If the gap is too large, recheck the cylinder bore diameter against the wear limits, See Cylinder
Block Assembly / Service and Repair / Inspection and Service. If the bore is over the service limit,
the cylinder block must be rebored.
Piston Ring End-Gap:
Top Ring
B16A2 engine
Standard (New): 0.20 - 0.35 mm (0.008 - 0.014 inch) Service Limit: 0.60 mm (0.024 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines
Standard (New): 0.15 - 0.30 mm (0.006 - 0.012 inch) Service Limit: 0.60 mm (0.024 inch)
Second Ring
B16A2 engine
Standard (New): 0.40 - 0.55 mm (0.016 - 0.022 inch) Service Limit: 0.70 mm (0.028 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines
Standard (New): 0.30 - 0.45 mm (0.012 - 0.018 inch) Service Limit: 0.70 mm (0.028 inch)
Oil Ring
B16A2 engine
Standard (New): 0.20 - 0.50 mm (0.008 - 0.020 inch) Service Limit: 0.70 mm (0.028 inch)
D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engines
Standard (New): 0.20 - 0.70 mm (0.008 - 0.028 inch) Service Limit: 0.80 mm (0.031 inch)
REPLACEMENT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1753
1. Using a ring expander, remove the old piston rings.
2. Clean all ring grooves thoroughly.
NOTE: Use a squared-off broken ring or ring groove cleaner with blade to fit piston grooves.
- Top ring groove is 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) wide.
- Second ring groove is 1.2 mm (0.047 inch) wide.
- Oil ring groove is 2.8 mm (0.11 inch) wide.
- File down the blade if necessary.
CAUTION: Do not use a wire brush to clean ring lands, or cut ring lands deeper with cleaning tool.
NOTE: If the piston is to be separated from the connecting rod, do not install new rings yet.
3. Install new rings in the proper sequence and position.
NOTE: Do not reuse old piston rings.
RING TO GROOVE CLEARANCE
After installing a new set of rings, measure ring-to-groove clearances:
Top Ring Clearance
Standard (New):
B16A2 engine: 0.045-0.070 mm (0.0018-0.0028 inch) D16Y5,D16Y7,D16Y8 engines: 0.035-0.060
mm (0.0014-0.0024 inch)
Service Limit: 0.13 mm (0.005 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1754
Second Ring Clearance
Standard (New):
B16A2 engine: 0.040-0.065 mm (0.0016-0.0026 inch) D16Y5,D16Y7,D16Y8 engines: 0.030-0.055
mm (0.0012-0.0022 inch)
Service Limit: 0.13 mm (0.005 inch)
ALIGNMENT
1. Install the rings as shown.
NOTE: The manufacturing marks must be facing upward.
2. Rotate the rings in their grooves to make sure they do not bind.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1755
3. Position the ring end gaps as shown:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.007-0.009 inches
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.009-0.011 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 1760
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
NOTE: Valves should be adjusted only when the cylinder head temperature is less than 100°F (38°C).
- After adjusting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover.
3. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. The "UP" mark on the cam-shaft pulley should be at top, and the
TDC marks should align with the cylinder head
surface.
4. Adjust valves on No. 1 cylinder.
Intake: 0.18 - 0.22 mm (0.007 - 0.009 inch) Exhaust: 0.23 - 0.27 mm (0.009 - 0.011 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 1761
5. Loosen the locknut, and turn the adjustment screw until the feeler gauge slides back and forth
with a slight amount of drag.
6. Tighten the locknut, and check the clearance again. Repeat the adjustment if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 1762
7. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise (camshaft pulley turns 90°). The "UP" mark should
be on the exhaust side. Adjust valves on No. 3
cylinder.
8. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 4 piston to TDC. Both TDC grooves
are once again visible. Adjust valves on No. 4
cylinder.
9. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 2 piston to TDC. The "UP" mark should
be on the intake side. Adjust valves on No. 2
cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Service Tips
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1770
NOTE: Identify parts as they are removed to ensure reinstallation in original locations.
- Inspect rocker shafts and rocker arms.
- Rocker arms must be installed in the same position if reused.
- When removing or installing the rocker arm assembly, do not remove the camshaft holder bolts.
The bolts will keep the holders, springs and rocker arms on the shaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1771
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Loosen the adjusting screws.
2. Unscrew the camshaft holder bolts, then remove the rocker arm assembly.
NOTE: Unscrew the camshaft holder bolts two turns at a time, in a crisscross pattern, to prevent damaging
the valves or rocker arm assembly.
- When removing the rocker arm assembly, do not remove the camshaft holder bolts. The bolts will
keep the camshaft holders, the springs and the rocker arms on the shaft.
Camshaft Holder Bolts Loosening Sequence:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1772
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Inspection
Clearance Inspection
Clearance Inspection
Measure both the intake rocker shaft and exhaust rocker shaft.
1. Measure the diameter of the shaft at the first rocker location.
2. Zero the gauge to the shaft diameter.
3. Measure the inside diameter of the rocker arm and check for an out-of-round condition.
Rocker Arm-to-Shaft Clearance:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1773
Standard (New):
Intake: 0.017 - 0.050 mm (0.0007 - 0.0020 inch) Exhaust: 0.018 - 0.054 mm (0.0007 - 0.0021 inch)
Service Limit: 0.08 mm (0.003 inch)
4. Repeat these measurements on all the rockers.
- If the clearance is over the service limit, replace the rocker shaft and all over-tolerance rocker
arms.
Inspection Using Special Tools
CAUTION: Before using the Valve Inspection Tool, make sure that the air pressure gauge on the air
compressor indicates over 400 kPa (4 kgf.cm, 57 psi).
- Inspect the valve clearance before rocker arm inspection.
- Cover the timing belt with a shop towel to protect the belt.
- Check the intake primary rocker arm of each cylinder at TDC.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover.
2. Plug the relief hole with the special tool.
3. Remove the sealing bolt from the inspection hole and connect an air pressure regulator with a 0
- 100 psi gauge.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1774
4. Loosen the regulator valve on the valve inspection tool and apply the specified air pressure.
Specified Air Pressure: 250 kPa (2.5 kgf.cm, 36 psi)
5. Make sure that the intake primary and secondary rocker arms are mechanically connected by
the piston and that the mid rocker arm does not move
when pushed manually.
6. If any intake mid rocker arm moves independently of the primary and secondary rocker arms,
replace the rocker arms as a set. 7. Remove the special tools.
8. Use a 10 mm diameter rod to depress each lost motion assembly through its full movement.
Replace any lost motion assembly that does move
smoothly.
9. After inspection, check that the MIL does not come on.
Manual Inspection
1. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. 2. Remove the cylinder head cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1775
3. Push the intake mid rocker arm on the No. 1 cylinder manually.
4. Check that the intake mid rocker arm moves independently of the primary and secondary intake
rocker arms. 5. Check the intake mid rocker arm of each cylinder at TDC.
- If the intake mid rocker arm does not move, remove the mid, primary and secondary intake rocker
arms as an assembly and check that the pistons in the mid and primary rocker arms move
smoothly.
- If any rocker arm needs replacing, replace the primary, mid, and secondary rocker arms as an
assembly.
Lost Motion Assemblies Inspection
Inspection
NOTE: When reassembling the primary rocker arm, carefully apply air pressure to the oil passage
of the rocker arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1776
1. Inspect the rocker arm piston. Push it manually.
- If it does not move smoothly, replace the rocker arm assembly.
NOTE: Apply oil to the pistons when reassembling.
- Bundle the rocker arms with a rubber band to prevent them from separating.
D16Y5 engine:
NOTE: Set the timing plate and return spring as shown below.
D16Y8 engine:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1777
2. Remove the lost motion assembly from the holder and inspect it. Test it by pushing the plunger
with your finger.
- If the lost motion assembly plunger does not move smoothly, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1778
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair Assembly
CAMSHAFT, ROCKER ARMS AND CAMSHAFT SEAL/PULLEY INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Make sure that all rockers are in alignment with their valves when torquing the rocker assembly
bolts.
- Valve locknuts should be loosened and adjusting screws backed off before installation.
- To prevent the rocker arm assembly from coming apart, leave the camshaft holder bolts in the
holders.
1. After wiping down the camshaft, camshaft seal and journals in the cylinder head, lubricate both
surfaces and install the camshaft.
2. Clean and install the oil control orifice with a new O-ring. 3. Turn the camshaft until its keyway is
facing up (No. 1 piston TDC).
4. Apply liquid gasket (Part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003) to the head mating surfaces of the No.
1 and No. 5 camshaft holders.
- Apply liquid gasket to the shaded areas.
5. Set the rocker arm assembly in place and loosely install the bolts.
- Make sure that the rocker arms are properly positioned on the valve stems.
6. Tighten each bolt two turns at a time in the sequence shown to ensure that the rockers do not
bind on the valves.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Service Tips > Page 1779
Specified torque:
8 mm bolts: 20 Nm (2.0 kgs.cm, 14 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads. 6 mm bolts: 12 Nm (1.2
kgs.cm, 8.7 ft.lbs.) Apply engine oil to the threads. 6 mm bolts: (11), (12), (13), (14)
7. Install the back cover, then install the camshaft pulley.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Cover: Service and Repair
Referal
For information regarding this component, and the system that it is a part of, please refer to
Cylinder Head Assembly / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Guide: Specifications
Cylinder Head Warpage Limit ..............................................................................................................
............................................................. 0.002 inches Cylinder Head Minimum Thickness ..................
................................................................................................................................................. 3.738
inches Valve Guides:
Standard Inside Diameter ....................................................................................................................
........................................... 0.217-0.218 inches Stem To Guide Clearance:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.001-0.002 inches Exhaust ...........................................................................
......................................................................................................... 0.002-0.003 inches
Valve Seats:
Seat Angle, Degrees ...........................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 45 Seat Width:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 0.033-0.045 Exhaust ...........................................................................
......................................................................................................... 0.049-0.061 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1786
Valve Guide: Testing and Inspection
Measure the guide-to-stem clearance with a dial indicator while rocking the stem in the direction of
normal thrust (wobble method).
Intake Valve Stem-to-Guide Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.04 - 0.10 mm (0.002 - 0.004 inch) Service Limit: 0.16 mm (0.006 inch)
Exhaust Valve Stem-to-Guide Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.10 - 0.16 mm (0.004 - 0.006 inch) Service Limit: 0.22 mm (0.009 inch)
- If the measurement exceeds the service limit, recheck using a new valve.
- If the measurement is now within the service limit, reassemble using a new valve.
- If the measurement still exceeds the limit, recheck using the alternate method below, then replace
the valve and guide, if necessary.
NOTE: An alternate method of checking guide to stem clearance is to subtract the O.D. of the valve
stem, measured with a micrometer, from the I.D. of the valve guide, measured with an inside
micrometer or ball gauge. Take the measurements in three places along the valve stem and three
places inside the valve guide. The difference between the largest guide measurement and the
smallest stem measurement should not exceed the service limit.
Intake Valve Stem-to-Guide Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.02 - 0.05 mm (0.001 - 0.002 inch) Service Limit: 0.08 mm (0.003 inch)
Exhaust Valve Stem-to-Guide Clearance:
Standard (New): 0.05- 0.08 mm (0.002 - 0.003 inch) Service Limit: 0.11 mm (0.004 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1787
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. As illustrated, use a commercially-available air-impact valve guide driver attachment modified to
fit the diameter of the valve guides. In most
cases, the same procedure can be done using the special tool and a conventional hammer.
2. Select the proper replacement guides, and chill them in the freezer section of a refrigerator for
about an hour.
3. Use a hot plate or oven to evenly heat the cylinder head to 300°F (150°C). Monitor the
temperature with a cooking thermometer.
CAUTION: Do not use a torch; it may warp the head.
- Do not get the head hotter than 300°F (150°C); excessive heat may loosen the valve seats.
- To avoid burns, use heavy gloves when handling the heated cylinder head.
4. Working from the camshaft side, use the driver and an air hammer to drive the guide about 2
mm (0.1 inch) towards the combustion chamber. This
will knock off some of the carbon and make removal easier.
CAUTION: Always wear safety goggles or a face shield when driving valve guides.
- Hold the air hammer directly in line with the valve guide to prevent damaging the driver.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1788
5. Turn the head over, and drive the guide out toward the camshaft side of the head.
If a valve guide still won't move, drill it out with a 8 mm (5/16 inch) bit, then try again.
CAUTION: Drill guides only in extreme cases; you could damage the cylinder head if the guide
breaks.
6. Remove the new guides from the freezer, one at a time, as you need them.
7. Apply a thin coat of clean engine oil to the outside of the new valve guide. Install the guide from
the camshaft side of the head; use the special tool
to drive the guide in to the specified installed height. If you have all 16 guides to do, you may have
to reheat the head.
Valve Guide Installed Height:
Intake: 17.85 - 18.35 mm (0.703 - 0.722 inch) Exhaust: 18.65 - 19.15 mm (0.734 - 0.754 inch)
REAMING
NOTE: For new valve guides only.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1789
1. Coat both the reamer and valve guide with cutting oil.
2. Rotate the reamer clockwise the full length of the valve guide bore. 3. Continue to rotate the
reamer clockwise while removing it from the bore. 4. Thoroughly wash the guide in detergent and
water to remove any cutting residue. 5. Check the clearance with a valve. Verify that the valve
slides in the valve guide without exerting pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications
Valve Seat: Specifications
Cylinder Head Warpage Limit ..............................................................................................................
............................................................. 0.002 inches Cylinder Head Minimum Thickness ..................
................................................................................................................................................. 3.738
inches Valve Guides:
Standard Inside Diameter ....................................................................................................................
........................................... 0.217-0.218 inches Stem To Guide Clearance:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.001-0.002 inches Exhaust ...........................................................................
......................................................................................................... 0.002-0.003 inches
Valve Seats:
Seat Angle, Degrees ...........................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 45 Seat Width:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 0.033-0.045 Exhaust ...........................................................................
......................................................................................................... 0.049-0.061 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1793
Valve Seat: Service and Repair
RECONDITIONING
1. Renew the valve seats in the cylinder head using a valve seat cutter.
NOTE: If the guides are worn, replace them before cutting the valve seats.
2. Carefully cut a 45° seat, removing only enough material to ensure a smooth and concentric seat.
3. Bevel the upper edge of the seat with the 30° cutter and the lower edge of the seat with the 60°
cutter. Check the width of the seat and adjust
accordingly.
4. Make one more very light pass with the 45° cutter to remove any possible burrs caused by the
other cutters.
Valve Seat Width:
Standard (New):
Intake: 0.85 -1.15 mm (0.033 - 0.045 inch) Exhaust: 1.25 - 1.55 mm (0.049 - 0.061 inch)
Service Limit:
Intake: 1.6 mm (0.063 inch) Exhaust: 2.0 mm (0.079 inch)
5. After resurfacing the seat, inspect for even valve seating: Apply Prussian Blue compound to the
valve face, and insert the valve in its original
location in the head, then lift and snap it closed against the seat several times.
6. The actual valve seating surface, as shown by the blue compound, should be centered on the
seat.
- If it is too high (closer to the valve stem), you must make a second cut with the 60° cutter to move
it down, then one more cut with the 45° cutter to restore seat width.
- If it is too low (closer to the valve edge), you must make a second cut with the 30° cutter to move
it up, then one more cut with the 45° cutter to restore seat width.
NOTE: The final cut should always be made with the 45° cutter.
7. Insert the intake and exhaust valves in the head and measure the valve stem installed height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1794
Intake, Exhaust Stem Installed Height:
Standard (New): 53.17 - 53.64 mm (2.093 - 2.112 inch) Service Limit: 53.89 mm (2.122 inch)
8. If the valve stem installed height is over the service limit, replace the valve and recheck. If its still
over the service limit, replace the cylinder head;
the valve seat in the head is too deep.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Free Length
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 2.280 inches Exhaust .....................................................................
................................................................................................................................ 2.310 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Disassembly
NOTE: Identify valves and valve springs as they are removed so that each item can be reinstalled
in its original position.
1. Using an appropriate-sized socket and plastic mallet, lightly tap the valve retainer to loosen the
valve keepers before installing the valve spring
compressor.
2. Install the spring compressor. Compress the spring and remove the valve keeper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1800
3. Install the valve guide seal remover.
4. Remove the valve seal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1801
Valve Dimensions
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1802
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Assembly
VALVES, VALVE SPRINGS AND VALVE SEALS INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with engine oil. Insert the valves in the valve guides.
NOTE: Make sure the valves move up and down smoothly.
2. Install the spring seats on the cylinder head.
3. Install the valve seals using the valve guide seal installer.
NOTE: Exhaust and intake valve seals are not interchangeable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1803
4. Install the valve spring and valve retainer, then install the valve spring compressor. Compress
the spring and install the valve keepers.
NOTE: Place the end of the valve spring with closely wound coils toward the cylinder head.
5. Lightly tap the end of each valve stem two or three times with a plastic mallet to ensure proper
seating of the valve and valve keepers.
NOTE: Tap the valve stem only along its axis so you do not bend the stem.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly
Valve: Service and Repair Disassembly
NOTE: Identify valves and valve springs as they are removed so that each item can be reinstalled
in its original position.
1. Using an appropriate-sized socket and plastic mallet, lightly tap the valve retainer to loosen the
valve keepers before installing the valve spring
compressor.
2. Install the spring compressor. Compress the spring and remove the valve keeper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1808
3. Install the valve guide seal remover.
4. Remove the valve seal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1809
Valve Dimensions
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1810
Valve: Service and Repair Assembly
VALVES, VALVE SPRINGS AND VALVE SEALS INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with engine oil. Insert the valves in the valve guides.
NOTE: Make sure the valves move up and down smoothly.
2. Install the spring seats on the cylinder head.
3. Install the valve seals using the valve guide seal installer.
NOTE: Exhaust and intake valve seals are not interchangeable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 1811
4. Install the valve spring and valve retainer, then install the valve spring compressor. Compress
the spring and install the valve keepers.
NOTE: Place the end of the valve spring with closely wound coils toward the cylinder head.
5. Lightly tap the end of each valve stem two or three times with a plastic mallet to ensure proper
seating of the valve and valve keepers.
NOTE: Tap the valve stem only along its axis so you do not bend the stem.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Bulletin No. 96-014
Issue Date Feb. 20, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To ALL
File Under SPECIAL TOOLS
Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair
Tensioning the engine belts properly with the belt tension gauge (T/N 07JGG-001010A) is critical to
bearing life of the A/C compressor, alternator, etc. Calibration of the belt tension gauge should be
checked regularly.
CALIBRATION
A Belt Tension Gauge Checker, needed for checking the calibration of the belt tension gauge, is
now available. One checker is being automatically shipped to each dealership. Additional checkers
may be ordered through normal parts ordering channels. The part number is 07TGG-001010A.
Procedure
1. Push the handle and slide the checker into the gauge. Position the checker as shown.
2. Release the handle and read the tension value on the Kg scale.
3. Compare your reading to the value etched on the checker. Your gauge is in calibration if it is
within +/- 3 kg of the checker value.
If your belt tension gauge is out of calibration, you cannot recalibrate it yourself. Contact America
Kowa Seiki about sending it for recalibration.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Belt Tension Gauge Calibration and Repair >
Page 1817
If your belt tension gauge is damaged, replacement parts are available from America Kowa Seiki.
They are:
REPAIR AND CALIBRATION INFORMATION
To order replacement parts for a gauge, contact:
America Kowa Seiki 20013 S. Rancho Way Rancho Dominguez, CA 90220
(800) 824-9655
To return your belt tension gauge for calibration:
^ Contact America Kowa Seiki for authorization and shipping instructions.
^ Pack the belt tension gauge in a suitable box. Use "bubble pack" to protect the gauge.
^ Ship according to their instructions.
America Kowa Seiki will charge a fixed fee to inspect, clean and calibrate the belt tension gauge,
and return it via UPS ground. Any repair parts needed are extra. The gauge will be returned within
15 days.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1818
Drive Belt: Specifications
NOTE: When using a new belt, adjust deflection or tension to new values. Run the engine for 5
minutes then turn it off. Readjust the deflection or tension to used belt values.
Deflection [1]:
With Used Belt
..............................................................................................................................................................
10.5 - 14.0 mm (0.41 - 0.55 inch) With New Belt .................................................................................
............................................................................... 7.5 - 10.0 mm (0.30 - 0.39 inch)
Tension [2]:
With Used Belt
................................................................................................................................................ 340 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 ft. lbs.) With New Belt
............................................................................................................................................... 640 780 N (65 - 80 kgf, 143 - 176 ft. lbs.)
[1] With 98 N (10 kgf, 22 ft. lbs.) between pulleys. [2] Measured with belt tension gauge.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor
Drive Belt: Adjustments A/C Compressor
Deflection Method
1. Apply a force of 98 N (10 kg, 22 lb), and measure the deflection between the A/C compressor
and the crankshaft pulley.
A/C Compressor Belt Used Belt: B16A2 engine
6.0 - 9.5 mm (0.24 - 0.37 in) Except B16A2 engine 7.5 - 9.5 mm (0.30 - 0.37 in)
New Belt: B16A2 engine 4.5 - 6.5 mm (0.18 - 0.26 in) Except B16A2 engine 5.0 - 6.5 mm (0.20 0.26 in)
Note these items when adjusting belt tension: If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- "Used belt" means a belt which has been used for five minutes or more.
- "New belt" means a belt which has been used for less than five minutes.
2. Loosen, the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt (DENSO). 3. Turn the adjusting bolt to get proper belt tension.
4. Retighten the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt
(DENSO).
5. Recheck the deflection of the A/C compressor belt.
Tension Gauge Method
1. Attach the special tool to the A/C compressor belt as shown below, and measure the tension of
the belt.
A/C Compressor Belt Used Belt: B16A2 engine
390 - 540 N (40 - 55 kg, 88 - 120 lb) Except B16A2 engine 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kg, 77 - 110 lb)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page 1821
New Belt: B16A2 engine
740 - 880 N (75 - 90 kg, 170 - 200 lb) Except B16A2 engine 690 - 830 N (70 - 85 kg, 150 - 190 lb)
Note these items when adjusting belt tension: Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the belt tension gauge.
- If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- "Used belt" means a belt which has been used for five minutes or more.
- "New belt" means a belt which has been used for less than five minutes.
2. Loosen the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt (DENSO). 3. Turn the adjusting bolt to get proper belt tension.
4. Retighten the center nut of the idler pulley (SANDEN), or the pivot bolt of the idler pulley bracket
and the lock nut of the adjusting bolt
(DENSO).
5. Recheck the tension of the A/C compressor belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page 1822
Drive Belt: Adjustments Alternator
Deflection Method:
Apply a force of 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf), and measure the deflection between the alternator and the
crankshaft pulley.
Deflection 8.0-10.5 mm (0.31-0.41 in)
NOTE: On a brand-new belt (one that has been run for less than five minutes), the deflection
should be 6.0 - 8.5 mm (0.26-0.33 in) when first measured. If the belt is worn or damaged, replace
it.
If adjustment is necessary:
1. Loosen the lower mounting nut and the upper mounting bolt. 2. Move the alternator to obtain the
proper belt tension, then retighten the upper mounting bolt and the lower mounting nut to the
specified torques. 3. Recheck the deflection of the belt.
Belt Tension Gauge Method:
Following the gauge manufacturer's instructions, attach the special tool to the belt, and measure
the tension.
Tension 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 lbf)
NOTE: On a brand-new belt (one that has been run for less than five minutes), the tension should
be 540-740 N (55 - 75 kgf, 121 - 165 lbf) when first
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page 1823
measured. If the belt is worn or damaged, replace it.
If adjustment is necessary:
1. Loosen the lower mounting nut and the upper mounting bolt. 2. Move the alternator to obtain the
proper belt tension, then retighten the upper mounting bolt and the lower mounting nut to the
specified torques. 3. Recheck the tension of the belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Adjustments > A/C Compressor > Page 1824
Drive Belt: Adjustments Power Steering
Pump Belt
NOTE: When using a new belt, first adjust the deflection or tension to the values for the new belt,
then readjust the deflection or tension to the values for the used belt after running engine for five
minutes.
Inspection
Attach the special tool to the belt and measure the tension of the belt. Tension:
'99-'00 models: B16A2 Engine Type only
Used Belt: 390 - 540 N (40 - 55 kgf, 88 - 120 lbs.) New Belt: 740 - 880 N (75 - 90 kgf, 170 - 200
lbs.)
'96-'00 models: Other Engine Types
Used Belt: 340 - 490 N (35 - 50 kgf, 77 - 110 lbs.) New Belt: 640 - 780 N (65 - 80 kgf, 143 - 176
lbs.)
NOTE: If there are cracks or any damage evident on the belt, replace it with a new one.
- Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the tension gauge.
Inspect the pump belt for cracks or any damage. Replace the belt with a new one if necessary.
Measurement without Belt Tension Gauge:
Apply a force of 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbs.) and measure the deflection between the power steering
pump and the crankshaft pulleys. Deflection:
'99-'00 models: B16A2 Engine Type only
Used Belt: 7.5 - 11.0 mm (0.30 - 0.43 inch) New Belt: 5.0 - 7.0 mm (0.20 - 0.28 inch)
'96-'00 models: Other Engine Types
Used Belt: 10.5 - 14.0 mm (0.41 - 0.55 inch) New Belt: 7.5 - 10.0 mm (0.30 - 0.39 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Accessory Bracket > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Accessory Bracket: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Accessory Bracket > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1828
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Idler Pulley: > 00-003 > May >
00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle
Idler Pulley: Customer Interest A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle
00-003
May 9, 2000
Applies To: 1996 - 99 Civic - ALL 1996 - 97 del Sol ALL 1996 - 97 CR-V - ALL
Growl From A/C Idler Pulley
SYMPTOM
A growl from the A/C idler pulley at, or just above, idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The A/C idler pulley bearing is faulty.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the A/C idler pulley.
PARTS INFORMATION
A/C Idler Pulley Kit (Civic CX, DX, LX, HX, EX; del Sol S, del Sol Si):
P/N 38950P2K-305, H/C 6254742
A/C Idler Pulley Kit (Civic Si, del Sol VTEC, CR-V):
P/N 38950-P3F-305, H/C 6334296
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the power steering belt
2. Remove the power steering pump, and set it aside with its hoses connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Idler Pulley: > 00-003 > May >
00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle > Page 1840
3. Loosen the idler pulley, then remove the belt and let it hang from the engine mount.
4. Remove the idler pulley assembly, then disassemble it and discard the pulley and parts shown.
5. Assemble the pulley with the parts from the appropriate kit listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
6. Reinstall the power steering pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Idler Pulley: > 00-003 > May >
00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle > Page 1841
7. Reinstall the belts, and adjust them to the tension specified in the appropriate service manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: >
00-003 > May > 00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle
Idler Pulley: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle
00-003
May 9, 2000
Applies To: 1996 - 99 Civic - ALL 1996 - 97 del Sol ALL 1996 - 97 CR-V - ALL
Growl From A/C Idler Pulley
SYMPTOM
A growl from the A/C idler pulley at, or just above, idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The A/C idler pulley bearing is faulty.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the A/C idler pulley.
PARTS INFORMATION
A/C Idler Pulley Kit (Civic CX, DX, LX, HX, EX; del Sol S, del Sol Si):
P/N 38950P2K-305, H/C 6254742
A/C Idler Pulley Kit (Civic Si, del Sol VTEC, CR-V):
P/N 38950-P3F-305, H/C 6334296
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the power steering belt
2. Remove the power steering pump, and set it aside with its hoses connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: >
00-003 > May > 00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle > Page 1847
3. Loosen the idler pulley, then remove the belt and let it hang from the engine mount.
4. Remove the idler pulley assembly, then disassemble it and discard the pulley and parts shown.
5. Assemble the pulley with the parts from the appropriate kit listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
6. Reinstall the power steering pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: >
00-003 > May > 00 > A/C Idler Pulley - Growling Noise at Idle > Page 1848
7. Reinstall the belts, and adjust them to the tension specified in the appropriate service manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Idler Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1849
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
- Engine Oil Pressure:
- At Idle: 69 kPa (10 psi) minimum
- At 3,000 rpm: 340 kPa (50 psi) minimum
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 1854
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
If the oil pressure warning light stays on with the engine running, check the engine oil level. If the
oil level is correct:
1. Connect a tachometer.
2. Remove the engine oil pressure switch, and install an oil pressure gauge.
3. Start the engine. Shut it off immediately if the gauge registers no oil pressure. Repair the
problem before continuing.
4. Allow the engine to reach operating temperature (fan comes on at least twice). The pressure
should be:
Engine Oil Temperature: 176°F (80°C) Engine Oil Pressure:
At Idle: 69 kPa (0.7 kgf.cm, 10 psi) minimum At 3,000 rpm: 340 kPa (3.5 kgf.cm, 50 psi) minimum
- If the oil pressure is within specifications, replace the oil pressure switch and recheck.
- If the oil pressure is NOT within specifications, inspect the oil pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube:
> 96017 > Feb > 96 > Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult to Remove
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult to Remove
Bulletin No. 96-017
Issue Date Feb. 26, 1996
File Under Engine
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Model 1996 CIVIC
Engine Oil Dipstick Is Difficult to Remove
SYMPTOM
The engine oil dipstick is difficult to remove from its tube.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The two O-rings that seal the dipstick are too thick.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door and 4-door (Ohio-built): Thru VIN ......... TL017657
3-door (Canada-built): Thru VIN ......... TH115012
4-door (Canada-built): Thru VIN ......... TH503194
PARTS INFORMATION
Oil level dipstick O-rings (2 per package): P/N 91312-S04-999, H/C 5028535
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 111103
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour
Failed part: P/N 15650-P2F-A00 H/C 4802377
Defect code: 030
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 96-017A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube:
> 96017 > Feb > 96 > Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult to Remove > Page 1863
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the dipstick O-rings with the ones listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
1. Pull the oil dipstick out of its tube, and wipe it clean with a shop towel.
2. Remove the O-rings with a seal pick, and discard them.
3. Clean the dipstick O-ring grooves with brake cleaner, then allow the dipstick to air-dry.
4. Roll the new O-rings into the grooves on the dipstick.
5. Insert and pull out the dipstick several times, making sure it fits snugly but moves smoothly in its
tube.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip
Stick Tube: > 96017 > Feb > 96 > Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult to Remove
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult
to Remove
Bulletin No. 96-017
Issue Date Feb. 26, 1996
File Under Engine
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Model 1996 CIVIC
Engine Oil Dipstick Is Difficult to Remove
SYMPTOM
The engine oil dipstick is difficult to remove from its tube.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The two O-rings that seal the dipstick are too thick.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door and 4-door (Ohio-built): Thru VIN ......... TL017657
3-door (Canada-built): Thru VIN ......... TH115012
4-door (Canada-built): Thru VIN ......... TH503194
PARTS INFORMATION
Oil level dipstick O-rings (2 per package): P/N 91312-S04-999, H/C 5028535
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 111103
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour
Failed part: P/N 15650-P2F-A00 H/C 4802377
Defect code: 030
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 96-017A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip
Stick Tube: > 96017 > Feb > 96 > Engine - Oil Dipstick Difficult to Remove > Page 1869
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the dipstick O-rings with the ones listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
1. Pull the oil dipstick out of its tube, and wipe it clean with a shop towel.
2. Remove the O-rings with a seal pick, and discard them.
3. Clean the dipstick O-ring grooves with brake cleaner, then allow the dipstick to air-dry.
4. Roll the new O-rings into the grooves on the dipstick.
5. Insert and pull out the dipstick several times, making sure it fits snugly but moves smoothly in its
tube.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Oil Recommendation GF-4 Standard
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Recommendation GF-4 Standard
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Use ONLY New GF-4 Standard Engine Oil
APPLIES TO: All Models
SERVICE TIP:
There's a new performance standard for engine oil: GF-4. It was jointly developed by automotive
and oil experts, and it represents a significant performance upgrade and improvement in fuel
economy. GF-4 engine oils must pass grueling tests totaling over 500 hours. On top of this, Honda
Genuine engine oils are also tested to ensure specific compatibility with Honda vehicles.
GF-4 engine oil is compatible with all current and earlier model year Honda cars and trucks. It also
provides these added benefits:
- Improved oxidation resistance (reduced thickening of the oil)
- Improved deposit protection and better wear protection
- Better low-temperature performance over the life of the oil
- Environmental protection by extending the life of emissions systems
While Honda has upgraded its engine oil to GF-4, other brands may not yet be at this new
standard. Keep in mind you must use Honda Genuine engine oil for all warranty repairs. If you use
some other brand of oil for non-warranty repairs, make sure that oil meets the GF-4 standard. We
recommend you stop using non-GF-4 engine oils and check with your supplier that you're
purchasing GF-4 oil.
Engine oil produced after April 1, 2005, that meets the GF-4 standard, must post this starburst
certification mark on the container. Always look for this mark; some oil container labels won't
specifically refer to GF-4.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
For D16Y7 engine (1.6 L SOHC)Engine For Engine Overhaul ...........................................................
.................................................................................................... 4.3 L (4.5 US qts. 3.8 Imp.qt) For
Oil Change, Including Filter
........................................................................................................................................... 3.6 L (3.8
US qts. 3.2 Imp.qts)
For D16Y5, D16Y8 (1.6 L VTEC DOHC)Engine For Engine Overhaul ...............................................
................................................................................................................ 3.7 L (3.9 US qts. 3.3
Imp.qt) For Oil Change, Including Filter
........................................................................................................................................... 3.3 L (3.5
US qts. 2.9 Imp.qts)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 1876
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engien Oil
New standard for engine oil, GF-4. See TSB SN050109 for Honda Service News 050109 for
additional information.
API Classification .................................................................................................................................
................................ SH or SJ Energy Conserving II Viscosity ...........................................................
......................................................................................................... SAE 5W-30 (Preferred) SAE
10W-30
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1877
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Park the vehicle on level ground, and turn off the engine. Allow the oil a few minutes to drain
back into the oil pan so the dipstick will show the
actual level.
2. Make certain that the oil level indicated on the dipstick is between the upper and lower marks.
3. If the level has dropped close to the lower mark, add oil until it reaches the upper mark.
CAUTION: Insert the dipstick carefully to avoid bending it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Oil and Filter Service
ENGINE OIL
Inspection 1. Park the vehicle on level ground, and turn off the engine. Allow the oil a few minutes
to drain back into the oil pan so the dipstick will show the
actual level.
2. Make certain that the oil level indicated on the dipstick is between the upper and lower marks.
3. If the level has dropped close to the lower mark, add oil until it reaches the upper mark.
CAUTION: Insert the dipstick carefully to avoid bending it.
Replacement
CAUTION: Remove the drain bolt carefully while the engine is hot; the hot oil may cause scalding.
1. Warm up the engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1880
2. Drain the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1881
3. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer, and refill the engine with the recommended oil.
NOTE: Under normal conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at every other oil change. Under
severe conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at each oil change. The numbers in the middle of
the API Service label tell you the oil's SAE viscosity or weight. Select the oil for your car according
to this chart:
An oil with a viscosity of 5W - 30 is preferred for improved fuel economy and year-round protection
in the car. You may use a 10W - 30 oil if the climate in your area is limited to the temperature range
shown on the chart.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1882
4. Run the engine for more than three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
OIL FILTER
Replacement
WARNING: After the engine has been run, the exhaust pipe will be hot; be careful when working around the
exhaust pipe.
- Be careful when loosening the drain bolt while the engine is hot. Burns can result because the oil
temperature is very high.
1. Remove the oil filter with the oil filter wrench.
2. Inspect the threads and rubber seal on the new filter. Wipe off the seat on the engine block, then
apply a light coat of oil to the new filter's rubber
seal.
NOTE: Use only filters with a built-in bypass system.
3. Install the oil filter by hand.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1883
4. After the rubber seal seats, tighten the oil filter clockwise with the oil filter wrench.
Tighten: 7/8 turn clockwise. Tightening torque: 22 Nm (2.2 kgs.cm, 16 ft.lbs.)
Use this procedure to tighten the filter if eight numbers (1 to 8) are printed on the surface of the
filter. 1) Make a mark on the oil filter base under the number that shows at the bottom of the filter
when the rubber seal is seated. 2) Tighten the filter by turning it clockwise seven numbers from the
marked point. For example, if a mark is made under the number 2 when the
rubber seal is seated, the filter should be tightened until the number 1 comes up to the marked
point.
CAUTION: Using any procedure other than those shown could result in serious engine damage
due to oil leakage.
5. After installation, fill the engine with oil up to the specified level, run the engine for more than
three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1884
Engine Oil: Service and Repair Oil Service
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION: Remove the drain bolt carefully while the engine is hot; the hot oil may cause scalding.
1. Warm up the engine.
2. Drain the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1885
3. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer, and refill the engine with the recommended oil.
NOTE: Under normal conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at every other oil change. Under
severe conditions, the oil filter should be replaced at each oil change. The numbers in the middle of
the API Service label tell you the oil's SAE viscosity or weight. Select the oil for your car according
to this chart:
An oil with a viscosity of 5W - 30 is preferred for improved fuel economy and year-round protection
in the car. You may use a 10W - 30 oil if the climate in your area is limited to the temperature range
shown on the chart.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oil and Filter Service > Page 1886
4. Run the engine for more than three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
WARNING: After the engine has been run, the exhaust pipe will be hot; be careful when working around the
exhaust pipe.
- Be careful when loosening the drain bolt while the engine is hot. Burns can result because the oil
temperature is very high.
1. Remove the oil filter with the oil filter wrench.
2. Inspect the threads and rubber seal on the new filter. Wipe off the seat on the engine block, then
apply a light coat of oil to the new filter's rubber
seal.
NOTE: Use only filters with a built-in bypass system.
3. Install the oil filter by hand.
4. After the rubber seal seats, tighten the oil filter clockwise with the oil filter wrench.
Tighten: 7/8 turn clockwise. Tightening torque: 22 Nm (2.2 kgs.cm, 16 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1890
Use this procedure to tighten the filter if eight numbers (1 to 8) are printed on the surface of the
filter. 1) Make a mark on the oil filter base under the number that shows at the bottom of the filter
when the rubber seal is seated. 2) Tighten the filter by turning it clockwise seven numbers from the
marked point. For example, if a mark is made under the number 2 when the
rubber seal is seated, the filter should be tightened until the number 1 comes up to the marked
point.
CAUTION: Using any procedure other than those shown could result in serious engine damage
due to oil leakage.
5. After installation, fill the engine with oil up to the specified level, run the engine for more than
three minutes, then check for oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
OIL PAN INSTALLATION
B16A2, D16Y7 Engines:
1. Apply liquid gasket on the oil pump and right side cover mating areas as shown below.
NOTE: Use liquid gasket, part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003.
- Check that the mating surfaces are clean and dry before applying liquid gasket.
- Apply liquid gasket as an even bead, centered between the edges of the mating surface.
- To prevent oil leakage, apply liquid gasket to the inner threads of the bolt holes.
- Do not install the parts if five minutes or more have elapsed since applying the liquid gasket.
Instead, reapply liquid gasket after removing the old residue.
- After assembly, wait at least 30 minutes before filling the engine with oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1894
2. Install the oil pan gasket and oil pan.
NOTE: Use a new oil pan gasket.
- Install the oil pan no more than five minutes after applying liquid gasket.
3. Tighten the bolts and nuts finger tight at six points as shown below.
4. Tighten all bolts and nuts, starting from nut (1), clock wise in three steps.
NOTE: Excessive tightening can cause distortion of the oil pan gasket and oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1895
Torque: 12 Nm 11.2 kgs.cm, 8.7 ft.lbs.)
D16Y5, D16Y8 Engines:
1. Install the oil pan gasket on the oil pan.
2. Apply liquid gasket to the block mating surfaces of the oil pan, then install it. Apply liquid gasket
to the shaded areas.
NOTE: Use liquid gasket part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003.
- Check that the mating surfaces are clean and dry before applying liquid gasket.
- Apply liquid gasket as an even bead, centered between the edges of the mating surface.
- To prevent leakage of oil, apply liquid gasket to the inner threads of the bolt holes.
- Do not install the parts if five minutes or more have elapsed since applying the liquid gasket.
Instead, reapply liquid gasket after removing the old residue.
- After assembly, wait at least 30 minutes before filling the engine with oil.
3. Tighten nuts finger-tight at six points as shown.
4. Tighten all bolts and nuts, starting from nut (1), clockwise in three steps.
NOTE: Excessive tightening can cause distortion of the oil pan gasket and oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 1896
Torque: 12 Nm (1.2 kgs.cm, 8.7 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1904
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1905
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1906
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1907
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1908
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1909
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1910
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1911
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1912
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1913
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1914
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1915
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1916
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1917
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1918
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1919
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Warning
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1920
Oil Pressure Indicator Light
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
- Engine Oil Pressure:
- At Idle: 69 kPa (10 psi) minimum
- At 3,000 rpm: 340 kPa (50 psi) minimum
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1925
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
If the oil pressure warning light stays on with the engine running, check the engine oil level. If the
oil level is correct:
1. Connect a tachometer.
2. Remove the engine oil pressure switch, and install an oil pressure gauge.
3. Start the engine. Shut it off immediately if the gauge registers no oil pressure. Repair the
problem before continuing.
4. Allow the engine to reach operating temperature (fan comes on at least twice). The pressure
should be:
Engine Oil Temperature: 176°F (80°C) Engine Oil Pressure:
At Idle: 69 kPa (0.7 kgf.cm, 10 psi) minimum At 3,000 rpm: 340 kPa (3.5 kgf.cm, 50 psi) minimum
- If the oil pressure is within specifications, replace the oil pressure switch and recheck.
- If the oil pressure is NOT within specifications, inspect the oil pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set
Intake Manifold: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1934
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1935
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1936
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1937
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1938
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1939
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1940
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1941
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1942
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1943
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
ON With Blow Fuse 15
Intake Manifold: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Intake Manifold: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 1948
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
Intake Manifold: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1954
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1955
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1956
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1957
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1958
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1959
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1960
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1961
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1962
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 1963
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Intake Manifold: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Intake Manifold: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 1968
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1969
Intake Manifold: Specifications
For the Specifications for Intake Manifold, go to Engine/Specifications.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1970
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair
NOTE: Use new O-rings and gaskets when reassembling.
CAUTION: Check for folds or scratches on the surface of the gasket.
- Replace with a new gasket if damaged.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1976
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1977
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1978
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1979
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1980
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1981
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1982
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1983
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1984
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1985
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1986
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1987
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1988
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1989
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1990
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1991
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Warning Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1992
Oil Pressure Indicator Light
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Customer Interest Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks
01-040
August 14, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 2001 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
* Civic Rear Main Oil Seal Leaks (Supersedes 01-040, 1996-2001 Civic Rear Main Seal Leak,
dated June 12, 2001) *
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
The engine leaks oil between the block and the transmission.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The rear main oil seal (crankshaft oil seal) is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
REQUIRED MATERIALS
PARTS INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks > Page 2002
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 91214-P7A-004 H/C 5618988
Defect Code: 051
Contention Code: B06
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
*DIAGNOSIS
Clean the area with a shop towel where the engine block and transmission meet. Start the engine,
and look for oil leakage from the area with the aid of a powdered leak detector.
^ If you see any signs of leakage, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If you see no signs of leakage, then what looked like leakage may have been excess residue
from a previous repair on another part. Continue with normal troubleshooting.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the transmission. Refer to section 13 or 14 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Remove and discard the rear main oil seal (crankshaft oil seal).
3. Install the new oil seal. Refer to page 7-29 of the '96-00 service manual or page 7-27 of the '01
service manual.
4. Reinstall the transmission.
5. Reinstall the drain plug with a new sealing washer.
6. Refill the transmission with the appropriate fluid.
7. 2001 models only Do the idle learn procedure:
^ Make sure all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.) are turned off, then start the
engine.
^ Let the engine warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles twice).
^ Let the engine idle (throttle fully closed with all electrical items turned off) for 10 minutes.
8. 2001 2-door EX and LX models only Drive the vehicle above 40 mph for 5 to 10 minutes with the
cruise control on. (This lets the cruise control actuator learn how much slack there is in the throttle
cable.)*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks > Page 2003
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks
01-040
August 14, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 2001 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
* Civic Rear Main Oil Seal Leaks (Supersedes 01-040, 1996-2001 Civic Rear Main Seal Leak,
dated June 12, 2001) *
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
The engine leaks oil between the block and the transmission.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The rear main oil seal (crankshaft oil seal) is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
REQUIRED MATERIALS
PARTS INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks > Page 2009
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 91214-P7A-004 H/C 5618988
Defect Code: 051
Contention Code: B06
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
*DIAGNOSIS
Clean the area with a shop towel where the engine block and transmission meet. Start the engine,
and look for oil leakage from the area with the aid of a powdered leak detector.
^ If you see any signs of leakage, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If you see no signs of leakage, then what looked like leakage may have been excess residue
from a previous repair on another part. Continue with normal troubleshooting.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the transmission. Refer to section 13 or 14 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Remove and discard the rear main oil seal (crankshaft oil seal).
3. Install the new oil seal. Refer to page 7-29 of the '96-00 service manual or page 7-27 of the '01
service manual.
4. Reinstall the transmission.
5. Reinstall the drain plug with a new sealing washer.
6. Refill the transmission with the appropriate fluid.
7. 2001 models only Do the idle learn procedure:
^ Make sure all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.) are turned off, then start the
engine.
^ Let the engine warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles twice).
^ Let the engine idle (throttle fully closed with all electrical items turned off) for 10 minutes.
8. 2001 2-door EX and LX models only Drive the vehicle above 40 mph for 5 to 10 minutes with the
cruise control on. (This lets the cruise control actuator learn how much slack there is in the throttle
cable.)*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 01-040 > Aug > 01 > Engine Rear Main Oil Seal - Leaks > Page 2010
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seals Installation
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Seals Installation
NOTE: Engine removal is not required.
- The crankshaft oil seal housing should be dry. Apply a light coat of grease to the crankshaft and
to the lips of the seals.
Front Crankshaft Seal
1. Using the special tool, drive in the timing pulley end seal until the driver bottoms against the oil
pump.
When the seal is in place, clean any excess grease off the crankshaft and check that the oil seal lip
is not distorted.
Rear Crankshaft Seal
2. Measure the flywheel-end seal thickness and the oil seal housing depth. Using the special tool,
drive the flywheel-end seal into the rear cover to the
point where the clearance between the bottom of the oil seal and the right side cover is 0.5 - 0.8
mm (0.02 - 0.03 inch).
NOTE: Align the hole in the driver attachment with the pin on the crankshaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seals Installation > Page 2013
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Rear Main Seal Installation
INSTALLATION
The seal surface on the block should be dry. Apply a light coat of oil to the crankshaft and to the lip
of the seal.
1. Drive the crankshaft oil seal squarely into the right side cover using the special tools.
2. Confirm that the clearance is equal all the way around with a feeler gauge.
Clearance: 0.5 - 0.8 mm (0.02 - 0.03 inch)
NOTE: Refer to Front Crankshaft Seal / Service and Repair for installation of the oil pump side
crankshaft oil seal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
NOTE: Engine removal is not required.
- The crankshaft oil seal housing should be dry. Apply a light coat of grease to the crankshaft and
to the lips of the seals.
Front Crankshaft Seal
1. Using the special tool, drive in the timing pulley end seal until the driver bottoms against the oil
pump.
When the seal is in place, clean any excess grease off the crankshaft and check that the oil seal lip
is not distorted.
Rear Crankshaft Seal
2. Measure the flywheel-end seal thickness and the oil seal housing depth. Using the special tool,
drive the flywheel-end seal into the rear cover to the
point where the clearance between the bottom of the oil seal and the right side cover is 0.5 - 0.8
mm (0.02 - 0.03 inch).
NOTE: Align the hole in the driver attachment with the pin on the crankshaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair On Vehicle Service
NOTE: Cylinder head removal is not required in this procedure.
The procedure shown below applies when using the in-car valve spring compressor (Snap-on
YA8845 with YA8845 - 2 A 7/8" attachment).
WARNING: Always wear approved eye protection when using the in-car valve spring compressor.
1. Turn the crankshaft so that the No. 1 and the No. 4 pistons are at Top Dead Center (TDC). 2.
Remove the cylinder head cover and the rocker arm assembly.
NOTE: When removing or installing the rocker arm assembly, do not remove the camshaft holder bolts.
The bolts will keep the holders, springs and rocker arms on the shaft.
3. Remove the fuel injectors and the wire harness.
4. Using the 8 mm bolts supplied with the tool, mount the two uprights to the cylinder head at the
end camshaft holders. The uprights fit over the
camshaft as shown.
5. Insert the cross shaft through the top hole of the two uprights.
Intake Valve Seals: 6. Select the 7/8 inch diameter short compressor attachment, and fasten the
attachment to the No. 4 hole of the lever arm with the speed pin supplied. 7. Insert an air adaptor
into the spark plug hole. Pump air into the cylinder to keep the valve closed while compressing
springs and removing the
valve keepers.
8. Put shop towels over the oil passages to prevent the valve keepers from falling into the cylinder
head.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2021
9. Position the lever arm under the cross shaft so the lever is perpendicular to the shaft and the
compressor attachment rests on top of the retainer for
the spring being compressed. Use the front position slot on the lever as shown.
10. Using a downward motion on the lever arm, compress the valve spring and remove the keepers
from the valve stem. Slowly release pressure on the
spring.
11. Remove the valve seals. 12. Install the valve seals. 13. Install the springs, the retainers and the
keepers in reverse order of removal.
Exhaust Valve Seals: 14. Select the 7/8 inch diameter short compressor attachment, and fasten the
attachment to the No. 2 hole of the lever arm with the speed pin supplied.
15. Position the lever arm under the cross shaft so the lever is perpendicular to the shaft and the
compressor attachment rests on top of the retainer for
the spring being compressed. Use the front position slot on the lever as shown.
16. Using a downward motion on the lever arm, compress the valve spring and remove the keepers
from the valve stem. Slowly release pressure on the
spring.
17. Remove the valve seals. 18. Install the valve seals. 19. Install the springs, the retainers and the
keepers in reverse order of removal. 20. Repeat steps 6 to 19 on the other cylinders.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2022
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Disassembly
NOTE: Identify valves and valve springs as they are removed so that each item can be reinstalled
in its original position.
1. Using an appropriate-sized socket and plastic mallet, lightly tap the valve retainer to loosen the
valve keepers before installing the valve spring
compressor.
2. Install the spring compressor. Compress the spring and remove the valve keeper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2023
3. Install the valve guide seal remover.
4. Remove the valve seal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2024
Valve Dimensions
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2025
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair Assembly
VALVES, VALVE SPRINGS AND VALVE SEALS INSTALLATION
1. Coat valve stems with engine oil. Insert the valves in the valve guides.
NOTE: Make sure the valves move up and down smoothly.
2. Install the spring seats on the cylinder head.
3. Install the valve seals using the valve guide seal installer.
NOTE: Exhaust and intake valve seals are not interchangeable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > On Vehicle Service > Page 2026
4. Install the valve spring and valve retainer, then install the valve spring compressor. Compress
the spring and install the valve keepers.
NOTE: Place the end of the valve spring with closely wound coils toward the cylinder head.
5. Lightly tap the end of each valve stem two or three times with a plastic mallet to ensure proper
seating of the valve and valve keepers.
NOTE: Tap the valve stem only along its axis so you do not bend the stem.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt
Noise
Timing Belt: Customer Interest Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt
Noise > Page 2040
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine Timing Belt Noise
Timing Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 > Engine Timing Belt Noise > Page 2046
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2047
Timing Belt: Diagrams
NOTE: Refer to Service and Repair / Removal and Installation for procedure to position the crankshaft and
pulley before installing the belt.
- Mark the direction of rotation on the belt before removing.
- Do not use the upper cover and lower cover for storing removed items.
- Clean the upper cover and lower cover before installing.
- Replace the camshaft seals and crankshaft seals if there is oil leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
NOTE: Replace the timing belt at 105,000 miles (168,000 km) according to the maintenance schedule
(normal conditions/severe conditions). If the vehicle is regularly driven in one or more of the
following conditions, replace the timing belt at 60,000 miles (U.S.A.) 100,000 km (Canada). In very high temperatures (over 110°F, 43°C).
- In very low temperatures (under -20°F, -29°C).
- Turn the crankshaft pulley so the No. 1 piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC) before removing the
belt.
- Inspect the water pump before installing the timing belt.
1. Remove the splash shield.
2. Loosen the mounting bolt and lock bolt, then remove the Power Steering (P/S) pump belt and
pump. 3. Loosen the idler pulley center nut and adjusting bolt, then remove the Air conditioning
(A/C) compressor belt.
4. Loosen the mounting nut and lock bolt, then remove the alternator belt.
5. Remove the dipstick, then remove the upper cover and idler pulley bracket.
NOTE: Do not use the upper cover to store removed items.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2050
6. Remove the upper bracket.
NOTE: Use a jack to support the engine before the upper bracket is removed.
- Make sure to place a cushion between the oil pan and the jack.
7. Remove the crankshaft pulley.
8. Remove the lower cover and dipstick tube.
NOTE: Do not use the lower cover to store removed items.
9. Remove the CKF sensor from the oil pump.
10. Loosen the adjusting bolt 180°. Push the tensioner to remove tension from the timing belt, then
retighten the adjusting bolt. 11. Remove the timing belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2051
INSTALLATION
Install the timing belt in the reverse order of removal; Only key points are described here.
1. Set the timing belt drive pulley so that the No. 1 piston is at Top Dead Center (TDC). Align the
groove on the timing belt drive pulley to the
pointer on the oil pump.
2. Set the camshaft pulley to TDC. Align the TDC marks on the camshaft pulley to the cylinder
head surface. 3. Install the timing belt tightly in the sequence shown. (1) Timing belt drive pulley
(crankshaft) -> (2) Adjusting pulley -> (3) Water pump pulley ->
(4) Camshaft pulley.
NOTE: Make sure the timing belt drive pulley and camshaft pulley are at TDC.
4. Loosen and retighten the adjusting bolt to tension the timing belt. 5. Install the lower cover and
upper cover.
NOTE: Clean the upper and lower covers before installation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2052
6. Install the crankshaft pulley, then tighten the pulley bolt. 7. Rotate the crankshaft pulley about
five or six turns counterclockwise so that the timing belt positions on the pulleys. 8. Adjust the
timing belt tension.
9. Check that the crankshaft pulley and camshaft pulley are both at TDC.
10. If the camshaft and crankshaft pulleys are not positioned at TDC, remove the timing belt and
adjust the position. Then reinstall the timing belt. 11. After installation, adjust the tension of each
belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2053
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover. 3. Inspect the timing belt for
cracks and oil or coolant soaking.
NOTE: Replace the belt if oil or coolant soaked.
- Remove any oil or solvent that gets on the belt.
4. After inspecting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
TENSION ADJUSTMENT
CAUTION: Always adjust the timing belt tension with the engine cold.
NOTE: -
The tensioner is spring-loaded to apply tension to the belt automatically after making the following
adjustment.
- Always rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise when viewed from the pulley side. Rotating it
clockwise may result in improper adjustment of the belt tension.
- Inspect the timing belt before adjusting the belt tension.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover. 3. Rotate the crankshaft five or six
revolutions to set the belt. 4. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 2054
5. Loosen the adjusting bolt 180°. 6. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise three teeth on the
camshaft pulley. 7. Tighten the adjusting bolt. 8. After inspecting, retorque the crankshaft pulley
bolt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Belt Tensioner: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 >
Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Timing Belt Tensioner: Customer Interest Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Timing Belt Tensioner: > 96-057 > Oct > 96 >
Engine - Timing Belt Noise > Page 2063
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt Tensioner: > 96-057 >
Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Timing Belt Tensioner: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Timing Belt Noise
Bulletin No. 96-057
Issue Date OCT 28, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under ENGINE
Timing Belt Noise
SYMPTOM
A whine or chirping noise can be heard coming from the front of the engine at idle or just above
idle.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The timing belt is tensioned too tight.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the timing belt tension according to the procedure given in this service bulletin.
NOTE:
This procedure applies only to 1996 Civics. The procedure in the service manual should be used
for all other years.
1. Start the engine. Let it run until it is warmed up (the cooling fan cycles on and off twice).
2. Turn off the engine. Connect the PGM tester and monitor the coolant temperature. Let the
coolant cool down to 135°F (57°C). (This should take about an hour in an ambient temperature of
about 75°F.)
3. Rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise until either the No. 1 or No. 4 piston is at TDC.
4. Remove the plug for the timing belt tensioner bolt.
5. Loosen the timing belt tensioner bolt 1/2 turn. Then torque the bolt to 44 N.m (33 lb-ft).
6. Install the plug.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 110371
Flat rate time: 0.3 hour
Failed part: P/N 14400-P2E-004 H/C 4837357
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-057A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Timing Belt Tensioner: > 96-057 >
Oct > 96 > Engine - Timing Belt Noise > Page 2069
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Belt Tensioner >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2070
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2079
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2080
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2081
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2082
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2083
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2084
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2085
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2086
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2087
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2088
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2089
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2090
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2091
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2092
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2093
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2094
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure Switch] > Component Information >
Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure Switch] > Component Information >
Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1 > Page 2099
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 14 - 30 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2104
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1 > Page 2107
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 2108
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Disconnect the 1P connector from the VTEC solenoid valve.
2. Measure resistance between the terminal and body ground.
Resistance: 14 - 30 ohms
3. If the resistance is within specifications, remove the VTEC solenoid valve assembly from the
cylinder head, and check the VTEC solenoid valve
filter for clogging.
- If there is clogging, replace the engine oil filter and the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 2109
4. If the filter is not clogged, push the VTEC solenoid valve with your finger and check its
movement.
- If the VTEC solenoid valve is normal, check the engine oil pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement
Parts
97-020
MAR 10, 1997
Applies To: ALL Models
New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
New Gauge
The fuel pressure gauge with 10" hose (T/N 07406-0040001) has been discontinued. The gauge
that replaces it (T/N 07406-004000A) has an easier-to-read face, a protective boot around the
gauge housing, and a 48" hose.
Replacement Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts >
Page 2115
The replacement hose for the old gauge (24", T/N 07406-004020A) has also been discontinued. If
you need a replacement hose, order the new 48" hose (T/N 07406-004020B). The new hose
comes with an adapter so you can use it with the old fuel pressure gauge (T/N 07406-0040001).
Before connecting the hose to the vehicle, make sure the aluminum washer on the end of the hose
seals properly. If the aluminum washer doesn't seal, replace the washer.
Replacement washers come in a set of five (T/N 07406-0040300).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2116
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose disconnected
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm; 38 - 46 psi)
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose connected
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm; 28 - 36 psi)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2117
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1. Relieve fuel pressure.
2. Remove the service bolt on the fuel filter while holding the banjo bolt with another wrench. Attach
the special tool. 3. Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure with the engine idling and the
vacuum hose of the fuel pressure regulator disconnected from the fuel
pressure regulator and pinched. If the engine will not start, turn the ignition switch ON (II), wait for
two seconds, turn it off, then back on again and read the fuel pressure.
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38 - 46 psi)
4. Reconnect vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm, 28 - 36 psi)
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, first check the fuel pump. If the fuel pump is OK, check the
following: If the fuel pressure is higher than specified, Inspect for: Pinched or clogged fuel return hose or line.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- If the fuel pressure is lower than specified, inspect for: Clogged fuel filter.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- Fuel line leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
03-016
May 19, 2006
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord -ALL 1996-00 Civic -ALL 1997-01 CR-V - ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL
*1999-04 Odyssey - ALL*
Inspecting Idle Speed With the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic System
(Supersedes 03-016, dated March 25, 2003, to update the information marked by asterisks)
BACKGROUND
The ECM/PCM controls the vehicle's idle speed with the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve
and the air bleed screw (idle adjusting screw) work together to allow the proper amount of air into
the intake manifold when the throttle valve is closed (the accelerator pedal is released).
The ECM/PCM "learns" to work the IAC valve based on the total amount of air entering the intake
manifold. Air can enter the intake manifold from several sources, including the air bleed screw, but
only the air bleed screw is adjustable. If any changes are made that alter this airflow, specifically
with the air bleed screw, the ECM/PCM must learn new idle parameters.
When the air bleed screw is properly set, the ECM/PCM controls the engine's idle speed
seamlessly. But when the air bleed screw is not properly set, either of these symptoms may be
present:
^ Idle speed dips and then quickly recovers.
^ Engine stalls intermittently when it is just "off-idle." Here are the criteria for this symptom:
- The accelerator pedal is released but the driver's right foot rests over the pedal, causing just
enough pressure for the ECM/PCM to detect an input, yet there is little or no throttle valve opening
(the throttle valve is either not allowing any airflow or it is opened so slightly that more air supply is
needed).
- The engine speed is about 1,250 rpm or less.
- The lockup clutch (A/T models) or the clutch (M/T models) is disengaged.
- All during this time, the driver's foot does not move and stays resting over the accelerator pedal.
- The air bleed screw is not set properly and does not allow enough airflow.
- The amount of "air leakage" into the intake manifold is very low. (The normal amount of air let into
the intake manifold by sources other than the IAC valve, the air bleed screw, and normal operation
of the throttle body can vary slightly from vehicle to vehicle.)
NOTE:
"Air leakage" cannot be easily checked. If the first four criteria are met when the vehicle stalls, you
can assume the last two criteria are met as well.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
L4 Models and 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic
System (HDS) (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE A).
V6 Models except 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or HDS, and
clean out the throttle body if needed (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE B).
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Body Gasket (use only if needed): Refer to the parts catalog.
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester >
Page 2122
PGM Tester with SN 320
or
Honda Diagnostic System with 1.006.004 or later software
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Carburetor Cleaner:
P/N 08732-0006, H/C 4713673
or
Throttle Plate and Induction Cleaner:
P/N 08732-9009, H/C 6204945
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Inspect Idle Speed (L4 and V6 Models)
Operation Number: 120301
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 07403
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Clean Throttle Body (V6 Models Except 1999-00 Odyssey)
Operation Number: 216001
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 08103
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
NOTE:
Warranty claims for these labor operations must be submitted separately. Do not combine them on
the same claim.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE A
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester >
Page 2123
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey) or
you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of
counterclockwise turns you have made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in
step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then
go to step 9.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), and you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
10. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE B
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 7 or you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of counterclockwise turns you have
made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, and you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of
3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should never set the air bleed screw
counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If you set the screw further it could
work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Remove the throttle body (see the Fuel and Emissions
section of the appropriate service manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester >
Page 2124
10. Open the throttle. Spray carburetor cleaner or throttle plate and induction cleaner into the
throttle body to clean out any contaminants. Make sure you spray the cleaner through the back of
the throttle body not the front, to avoid damaging the IAC valve.
11. Inspect the throttle body gasket, and replace it if needed. Reinstall the throttle body, making
sure all cables are properly adjusted, the accelerator pedal works properly, and all hoses and
cables are correctly routed.
12. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature. Make sure all electrical
items are turned off and the steering wheel is centered.
13. While watching the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw until the IAC count
reaches 7 or you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns.
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, leave the screw set at 3-1/2 turns. Go to step 14. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
14. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications > Manual Transmission
Idle Speed: Specifications Manual Transmission
Base Idle Speed ..................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 450 ± 50 rpm
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 670 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With Headlights On Low ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 850 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications > Manual Transmission > Page 2127
Idle Speed: Specifications Automatic Transmission
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 700 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 810 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With A/T
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA: D16Y5 engine with CVT, D16Y7 engine with A/T, D16YS engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: M/T 750 ± 50 rpm A/T 750 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be: M/T 810 ± 50 rpm A/T,CVT 810 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2130
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With CVT
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA:
D16Y5 engine with CVT and D16Y7 engine with A/T and D16Y8 engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: 750 ± 50 rpm
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be (all): 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2131
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With M/T
NOTE:
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
- (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights are off.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (transmission in neutral) until the
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Connect a tachometer.
3. Disconnect the IAC valve connector. 4. If the engine stalls, restart the engine with the
accelerator pedal slightly depressed. Stabilize the rpm at 1,000, then slowly release the pedal until
the engine idles.
5. Check idling in no-load conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air
conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be: 450 ± 50 rpm
Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw.
NOTE: After adjusting the idle speed in this step, recheck the ignition timing. If it is out of spec, go
back to step 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 7. Reconnect the 2P connector on the IAC valve, then do the ECM
reset procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2132
8. Restart and idle the engine with no-load conditions for one minute, then check the idle speed.
NOTE: (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights
are off.
Idle speed should be:
(USA): 670 ± 50 rpm
(Canada): 750 ± 50 rpm
9. Idle the engine for one minute with headlights (Low) ON, and check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 750 ± 50 rpm
10. Turn the headlights off. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air
conditioner on, then check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Air Cleaner (ACL)
NOTE: Do not clean the ACL element it with compressed air (except dry type).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Ignition Timing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Cable: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2155
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2156
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2157
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2158
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2159
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2160
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2161
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2162
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2163
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2164
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2165
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2166
Ignition Cable: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2167
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2168
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2169
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2170
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Cable > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2171
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Carefully remove the ignition wires by pulling on the rubber boots. Do not bend the
wires; you might break them inside.
1. Check the condition of the ignition wire terminals. If any terminal is corroded, clean it, and if it is
broken or distorted, replace the ignition wire.
2. Connect ohmmeter probes and measure resistance. 3. If resistance exceeds 25 K Ohm, replace
the ignition wire.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 >
Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 >
Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2180
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 >
Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2181
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 >
Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2182
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2188
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2189
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: >
05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2190
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2191
Distributor: Locations
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Distributor: Exploded Views
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 2194
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2195
Distributor: Service and Repair
Removal:
1. Disconnect the connector from the distributor. 2. Disconnect the ignition wires from the
distributor ignition (DI) cap.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the distributor, then remove the distributor from the cylinder
head.
Installation:
NOTE: Before you install the distributor, bring the No.1 piston to compression stroke TDC.
1. Coat a new O-ring with engine oil, then install it. 2. Slip the distributor into position.
NOTE: The lug on the end of the distributor and its mating grooves in the camshaft end are both
offset to eliminate the possibility of installing the distributor 180° out of time.
3. Install the mounting bolts, and tighten them lightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Distributor, Ignition > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2196
4. Connect the ignition wires to the distributor ignition (DI) cap as shown. 5. Connect the connector
to the distributor. 6. Set the ignition timing. 7. After setting the ignition timing, tighten the mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the electrodes and ceramic insulator for:
Burned or worn electrodes may be caused by: Advanced ignition timing
- Loose spark plug
- Plug heat range too low
- Insufficient cooling
Fouled plugs may be caused by: Retarded ignition timing
- Oil in combustion chamber
- Incorrect spark plug gap
- Plug heat range too high
- Excessive idling/low speed running
- Clogged air cleaner element
- Deteriorated ignition coil or ignition wires
2. D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engine:
- Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool, and replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded
as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2200
3. B16A2 engine:
- Do not adjust the gap of a platinum tip plug: replace the spark plug if the center electrode is
rounded or if the gap is not within the specifications.
NOTE: Use only the spark plugs listed.
4. Apply a small quantity of anti-seize compound to the plug threads, and screw the plugs into the
cylinder head finger-tight. Then torque them to 18
N.m (1.8 kg.m, 13 lb.ft).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Check compression with engine at normal operating temperature and throttle in wide open position.
Prior to performing test, disable ignition and fuel injection to prevent fuel from being sprayed into
cylinders while cranking engine. Ensure is fully charged and that cranking speed is 250 RPM.
Standard reading should be 135-184 psi. The maximum variation between cylinders is 28 psi.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.007-0.009 inches
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.009-0.011 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2207
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
NOTE: Valves should be adjusted only when the cylinder head temperature is less than 100°F (38°C).
- After adjusting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover.
3. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. The "UP" mark on the cam-shaft pulley should be at top, and the
TDC marks should align with the cylinder head
surface.
4. Adjust valves on No. 1 cylinder.
Intake: 0.18 - 0.22 mm (0.007 - 0.009 inch) Exhaust: 0.23 - 0.27 mm (0.009 - 0.011 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2208
5. Loosen the locknut, and turn the adjustment screw until the feeler gauge slides back and forth
with a slight amount of drag.
6. Tighten the locknut, and check the clearance again. Repeat the adjustment if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 2209
7. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise (camshaft pulley turns 90°). The "UP" mark should
be on the exhaust side. Adjust valves on No. 3
cylinder.
8. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 4 piston to TDC. Both TDC grooves
are once again visible. Adjust valves on No. 4
cylinder.
9. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 2 piston to TDC. The "UP" mark should
be on the intake side. Adjust valves on No. 2
cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Diagrams
Water Pump: Diagrams
NOTE: Use new O-rings when reassembling.
- Use liquid gasket, Part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2213
Water Pump: Service and Repair
INSPECTION
1. Remove the timing belt.
2. Turn the water pump pulley counterclockwise. Check that it turns freely. 3. Check for signs of
seal leakage.
NOTE: A small amount of "weeping" from the bleed hole is normal.
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the timing belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2214
2. Remove the water pump by removing five bolts.
NOTE: Inspect, repair and clean the O-ring groove and mating surface with the cylinder block.
3. Install the water pump in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Keep the O-ring in position when installing.
- Clean the spilled engine coolant.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Quarts:
Man. Transmission ..............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 4.4 Auto. Transmission ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 4.5
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2220
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant/Anti-freeze Ethylene Glycol Based Coolant
Concentration Minimum 50 %
Maximum 60 %
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2221
Coolant: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When pouring engine coolant, be sure to shut the relay box lid and not to let coolant
spill on the electrical parts or the paint. If any coolant spills, rinse it off immediately.
1. Slide the heater temperature control lever to maximum heat. Make sure the engine and radiator
are cool to the touch. 2. Remove the radiator cap.
3. Loosen the drain plug, and drain the coolant.
4. Remove the drain bolt from the cylinder block. 5. Apply liquid gasket to the drain bolt threads,
then reinstall the bolt with a new washer and tighten it securely. 6. Tighten the radiator drain plug
securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2222
7. Remove, drain and reinstall the reservoir. Fill the tank halfway to the MAX mark with water, then
up to the MAX mark with antifreeze. 8. Mix the recommended antifreeze with an equal amount of
water in a clean container.
NOTE: Use only genuine Honda antifreeze/coolant.
- For best corrosion protection, the coolant concentration must be maintained year-round at 50%
minimum. Coolant concentrations less than 50% may not provide sufficient protection against
corrosion or freezing.
- Coolant concentrations greater than 60% will impair cooling efficiency and are not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix different brands of antifreeze/coolants.
- Do not use additional rust inhibitors or anti-rust products; they may not be compatible with the
coolant.
Engine Coolant Refill Capacity [including reservoir (0.4 (0.42 US quart. 0.35 Imp quart))].
9. Pour coolant into the radiator up to the base of the filler neck, and install the radiator cap loosely.
10. Start the engine and let it run until it warms up (the radiator fan comes on at least twice). 11.
Turn off the engine. Check the level in the radiator, add coolant if needed. 12. Put the radiator cap
on tightly, then run the engine again and check for leaks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2229
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2230
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2231
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2232
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2233
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2234
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2235
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2236
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2237
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2238
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2239
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2240
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2241
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2242
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2243
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2244
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2245
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Electrical Diagrams
Fans (Part 1 of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2246
Fans (Part 2 of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2247
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan
Voltage is provided at all times to the radiator fan relay (contacts) through fuse 57. With the ignition
switch in ON (II), voltage is provided to the coil of the relay through fuse 17.
The radiator fan relay can be grounded through either the engine coolant temperature switch or the
engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The engine coolant temperature switch grounds the radiator fan relay (coil) when the engine
coolant temperature exceeds 199 °F (83 °C). The switch opens when coolant temperature
decreases 3 ° - 8 °C.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2248
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect electrical connector to fan motor. 2. Connect battery voltage across motor terminals
using suitable jumper wires. 3. If fan fails to operate, motor is defective.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2252
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Radiator fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Fan Controls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2256
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Removing the ECT switch while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the ECT
switch.
NOTE: Bleed air from the cooling system after installing the ECT switch.
1 Remove the ECT switch from the thermostat housing.
2. Suspend the ECT switch in a container of water as shown. 3. Heat the water, and check the
temperature with a thermometer.
CAUTION: Do not let the thermometer touch the bottom of the hot container.
4. Measure the resistance between the A and B terminals according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations > Page 2264
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Fan Controls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2268
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Removing the ECT switch while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the ECT
switch.
NOTE: Bleed air from the cooling system after installing the ECT switch.
1 Remove the ECT switch from the thermostat housing.
2. Suspend the ECT switch in a container of water as shown. 3. Heat the water, and check the
temperature with a thermometer.
CAUTION: Do not let the thermometer touch the bottom of the hot container.
4. Measure the resistance between the A and B terminals according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve
Cable > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows Hot Air
Heater Control Valve Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows
Hot Air
Heater Blows Cold Air; A/C Blows Warm Air
NOTE:
This article applies to all A/C-equipped Honda models that use a heater valve cable. Got a vehicle
in your shop that blows cold air from the heater or warm air from the A/C? The problem could just
be the heater valve cable has slipped off the heater valve arm.
There's a real easy fix for this problem. Slip the heater valve cable back onto the heater valve arm.
Then cut yourself a 10 mm length of 3.5 mm vacuum hose (P/N 95005-35008-10M, H/C 2325058),
and slide it onto the arm. This holds the cable on the arm nice and snug so it won't slip off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve
Cable > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows Hot Air > Page
2277
Heater Control Valve Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air, A/C Blows
Warm Air
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Heater Blows Cold Air, A/C Blows Warm Air
APPLIES TO: all A/C-equipped Honda models that use a heater valve cable.
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that blows cold air from the heater or warm air from the A/C ? The
problem could just be the heater valve cable has slipped off the heater valve arm. There's a real
easy fix for this problem. Slip the heater valve cable back onto the heater valve arm. Then cut
yourself a 10 mm length of 3.5 mm vacuum hose and slide it onto the arm. This holds the cable on
the arm nice and snug so it won't slip off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve
Cable > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2278
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Locations
Heater Core: Locations
96-98 Models
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Defroster-activated A/C System
Turning the defroster on activates the A/C and sets the air flow mode to FRESH. It is possible to
turn the A/C off or to change the air flow to RECIRCULATE by pressing the A/C button or the
FRESH/RECIRCULATE button.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Heater Core: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2284
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2285
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2286
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2287
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2288
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2289
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2290
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2291
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2292
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2293
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2294
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2295
Heater Core: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2296
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2297
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2298
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2299
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2300
Heater Core: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable, then drain cooling system.
3. Snap open cable clip, then disconnect heater valve cable from heater valve.
4. Disconnect heater hoses at heater, then remove heater unit mounting nut from engine
compartment side. 5. Remove instrument panel. 6. Remove heat duct or evaporator and steering
column bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2301
7. Remove clip, heater mounting nuts and heater assembly.
Fig. 16 Heater Core Removal
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2302
8. Remove heater core cover attaching screws, then the cover, Fig. 16. 9. Remove pipe clamp and
damper arm attaching screws.
10. Pull heater core from heater housing. Ensure care is taken not to bend inlet and outlet pipes
during removal. 11. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Do not interchange inlet and outlet hoses. b. Connect all cables and ensure they are properly
adjusted.
12. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming procedures.
On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for system
disarming and arming procedures.
13. After refilling cooling system, bleed cooling system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Locations > Page 2307
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
The engine coolant temperature gauge has two intersecting coils wound around a permanent
magnet rotor. Voltage applied to the coils, through fuse 25, generates a magnetic field. The
magnetic field, controlled by the coolant temperature sending unit, causes the rotor to rotate and
the gauge needle to move. As the resistance in the sending unit varies, current through the gauge
coils changes. The gauge needle moves toward the coil with the strongest magnetic field.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Locations > Page 2308
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
1. Check No. 15 (10A) fuse in under dash fuse/relay box before testing.
Fig. 1 Engine Coolant Temperature Unit
2. Ensure ignition switch is in Off position, then disconnect yellow/green wire from coolant
temperature sending unit, Fig. 1, and ground it with a
jumper wire.
3. Turn ignition switch to On position. 4. Check as needle of coolant temperature gauge starts
moving toward H mark. Turn ignition switch to Off position before pointer reaches H
mark on gauge dial. Failure to do so may damage gauge.
5. If pointer of gauge does not move, check the following:
a. Blown fuse in under dash fuse/relay box. b. Open in yellow/green wire, yellow or red wire. c. If
fuse and wiring are satisfactory, replace coolant temperature gauge.
6. If gauge is satisfactory, inspect sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Radiator: Testing and Inspection
1. Wait until the engine is cool, then carefully remove the radiator cap and fill the radiator with
engine coolant to the top of the filler neck.
2. Attach the pressure tester to the radiator and apply a pressure of 93-123 kPa (0.95 - 1.25
kgf.cm, 14 - 18 psi). 3. Inspect for engine coolant leaks and a drop in pressure. 4. Remove the
tester and reinstall the radiator cap.
NOTE: Check for engine oil in the coolant and/or coolant in the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 2312
Radiator: Service and Repair
1. Drain the engine coolant. 2. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses, and ATF cooler hoses.
3. Disconnect the fan motor connector. 4. Remove the radiator upper bracket, then pull up the
radiator. 5. Remove the fan shroud assemblies and other parts from the radiator.
Install the radiator in the reverse order of removal:
NOTE: Set the upper and lower cushions securely.
- Fill the radiator with engine coolant and bleed the air.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Specifications
Radiator Cap: Specifications
Radiator Cap Pressure Relief ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................... 14-18 psi
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2316
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the radiator cap, wet its seal with engine coolant, then install it on the pressure tester. 2.
Apply a pressure of 93-123 kPa (0.95 - 1.25 kgf.cm, 14 - 18 psi). 3. Check for a drop in pressure. 4.
If the pressure drops, replace the cap.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2321
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Radiator fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component Information >
Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2330
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Fan Controls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2334
Radiator Cooling Fan Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Removing the ECT switch while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you. Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the ECT
switch.
NOTE: Bleed air from the cooling system after installing the ECT switch.
1 Remove the ECT switch from the thermostat housing.
2. Suspend the ECT switch in a container of water as shown. 3. Heat the water, and check the
temperature with a thermometer.
CAUTION: Do not let the thermometer touch the bottom of the hot container.
4. Measure the resistance between the A and B terminals according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2341
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
The engine coolant temperature gauge has two intersecting coils wound around a permanent
magnet rotor. Voltage applied to the coils, through fuse 25, generates a magnetic field. The
magnetic field, controlled by the coolant temperature sending unit, causes the rotor to rotate and
the gauge needle to move. As the resistance in the sending unit varies, current through the gauge
coils changes. The gauge needle moves toward the coil with the strongest magnetic field.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2342
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
1. Check No. 15 (10A) fuse in under dash fuse/relay box before testing.
Fig. 1 Engine Coolant Temperature Unit
2. Ensure ignition switch is in Off position, then disconnect yellow/green wire from coolant
temperature sending unit, Fig. 1, and ground it with a
jumper wire.
3. Turn ignition switch to On position. 4. Check as needle of coolant temperature gauge starts
moving toward H mark. Turn ignition switch to Off position before pointer reaches H
mark on gauge dial. Failure to do so may damage gauge.
5. If pointer of gauge does not move, check the following:
a. Blown fuse in under dash fuse/relay box. b. Open in yellow/green wire, yellow or red wire. c. If
fuse and wiring are satisfactory, replace coolant temperature gauge.
6. If gauge is satisfactory, inspect sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Thermostat Opening Temperature
Starts Opening .....................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 169-176°F Fully Open ................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 194°F
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2346
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
Note: Replace the thermostat if it is open at room temperature.
Procedure to test a closed thermostat:
1. Suspend the thermostat in a container of water as shown.
2. Heat the water, and check the temperature with a thermometer. Check the temperature at which
the thermostat first opens, and at which it is fully
open.
CAUTION: Do not let the thermometer touch the bottom of the hot container.
3. Measure lift height of the thermostat when fully open.
STANDARD THERMOSTAT
Lift height: above 8.0 mm (0.31 inch) Starts opening: 169° - 176°F (76° - 80°C) Fully open: 194°F
{90°C)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2347
Thermostat: Service and Repair
NOTE: Use a new O-ring when reassembling.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Diagrams
Water Pump: Diagrams
NOTE: Use new O-rings when reassembling.
- Use liquid gasket, Part No. 08718-0001 or 08718-0003.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2351
Water Pump: Service and Repair
INSPECTION
1. Remove the timing belt.
2. Turn the water pump pulley counterclockwise. Check that it turns freely. 3. Check for signs of
seal leakage.
NOTE: A small amount of "weeping" from the bleed hole is normal.
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the timing belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 2352
2. Remove the water pump by removing five bolts.
NOTE: Inspect, repair and clean the O-ring groove and mating surface with the cylinder block.
3. Install the water pump in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Keep the O-ring in position when installing.
- Clean the spilled engine coolant.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2362
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2363
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2364
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2370
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2371
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2372
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > SN050508 > May > 05 > Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Noise
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Catalytic
Converter Noise
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Catalytic Converter Noise? Check the Heat Shield
APPLIES TO: All models
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that buzzes or rattles, and you suspect the catalytic converter is the
culprit? Before you start replacing the converter, first check the heat shield area. If there any stones
or debris trapped inside, they can cause buzzing or rattling.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Three Way
Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > SN050508 > May > 05 > Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Noise
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Catalytic
Converter Noise
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Catalytic Converter Noise? Check the Heat Shield
APPLIES TO: All models
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that buzzes or rattles, and you suspect the catalytic converter is the
culprit? Before you start replacing the converter, first check the heat shield area. If there any stones
or debris trapped inside, they can cause buzzing or rattling.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2382
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2383
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Three Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) is used to convert hydrocarbons (HC), carbon
monoxide (CO), and oxides of nitrogen (NOx) in the exhaust gas to carbon dioxide (CO 2),
dinitrogen (N2) and water vapor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter <-->
[Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2384
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Testing and Inspection
1. Using a flashlight, make a visual check for plugging, melting and cracking of the catalyst.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
BY ENGINE:
D16Y5, D16Y7 Exhaust Manifold Bolts ...............................................................................................
............................................................................... 23 Nm (17 lb ft)
Upper Cover Bolts ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 23 Nm (17 lb ft)
TWC Converter Cover Bolts ................................................................................................................
........................................................ 11 Nm (8 lb ft)
D16Y8 Exhaust Manifold Bolts ............................................................................................................
.................................................................. 31 Nm (23 lb ft)
Upper Cover Bolts ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 23 Nm (17 lb ft) Exhaust Pipe A to Manifold .................................
....................................................................................................................................... 54 Nm (40 lb
ft)
Exhaust Pipe A to TWC .......................................................................................................................
...................................................... 16 Nm (12 lb ft)
Exhaust Pipe B ....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 33 Nm (25 lb ft) Muffler to Pipe B ................................................
....................................................................................................................................... 22 Nm (16 lb
ft)
B1682
Upper Cover Bolts ...............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 23 Nm (17 lb ft) Exhaust Manifold Bolts .......................................
....................................................................................................................................... 31 Nm (23 lb
ft) Exhaust Pipe A to Manifold .............................................................................................................
........................................................... 54 Nm (40 lb ft)
Exhaust Pipe A to TWC .......................................................................................................................
...................................................... 16 Nm (12 lb ft)
Exhaust Pipe B ....................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 33 Nm (25 lb ft) Muffler to Pipe B ................................................
....................................................................................................................................... 22 Nm (16 lb
ft)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2388
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair
B16A2 DOHC VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2389
D16Y8 SOHC VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 2390
D16Y5 SOHC VTEC-E And D16Y7 SOHC Non-VTEC
NOTE: Use new gaskets and self-locking nuts when reassembling.
CAUTION: Check for folds or scratches on the surface of the gasket.
- Replace with a new gasket if damaged.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Exhaust Pipe: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing
Sound
Exhaust Pipe: Customer Interest Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound
98-014
February 23, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 98 Civic - ALL CX, DX, and LX models
Rattle or Buzz From Exhaust Pipe A
SYMPTOM
A rattling or buzzing sound from exhaust pipe A.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The heat shields around exhaust pipe A are cracked.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the heat shields at exhaust pipe A.
PARTS INFORMATION
Exhaust Pipe A Heat Shield Kit (includes 4 nuts):
P/N 06180-S01-000, H/C 5808001
Gasket:
P/N 18212-SF4-000, H/C 2691681
Self-Locking Nut (3 required):
P/N 90212-5A5-003, H/C 1169812
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 311116
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 06180-S01-000 H/C 5808001
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 98-014A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle, and allow the exhaust system to cool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Exhaust Pipe: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing
Sound > Page 2399
2. Remove and discard the three self-locking nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold.
3. Remove and retain the two nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the mounting bracket then lower the
pipe from the exhaust manifold.
4. Remove the heat shields from exhaust pipe A.
5. Install the new heat shields using the four nuts from the kit, and torque the nuts to 9.8 N.m (7.2
lb-ft).
6. Reinstall exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold using three new self-locking nuts and a new
gasket. Torque the nuts to 33 N.m (25 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the two nuts onto the mounting bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Exhaust Pipe: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe Rattling/Buzzing Sound
Exhaust Pipe: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound
98-014
February 23, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 98 Civic - ALL CX, DX, and LX models
Rattle or Buzz From Exhaust Pipe A
SYMPTOM
A rattling or buzzing sound from exhaust pipe A.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The heat shields around exhaust pipe A are cracked.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the heat shields at exhaust pipe A.
PARTS INFORMATION
Exhaust Pipe A Heat Shield Kit (includes 4 nuts):
P/N 06180-S01-000, H/C 5808001
Gasket:
P/N 18212-SF4-000, H/C 2691681
Self-Locking Nut (3 required):
P/N 90212-5A5-003, H/C 1169812
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 311116
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 06180-S01-000 H/C 5808001
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 98-014A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle, and allow the exhaust system to cool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Exhaust Pipe: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe Rattling/Buzzing Sound > Page 2405
2. Remove and discard the three self-locking nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold.
3. Remove and retain the two nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the mounting bracket then lower the
pipe from the exhaust manifold.
4. Remove the heat shields from exhaust pipe A.
5. Install the new heat shields using the four nuts from the kit, and torque the nuts to 9.8 N.m (7.2
lb-ft).
6. Reinstall exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold using three new self-locking nuts and a new
gasket. Torque the nuts to 33 N.m (25 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the two nuts onto the mounting bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heat Shield: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe Rattling/Buzzing Sound
Heat Shield: Customer Interest Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound
98-014
February 23, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 98 Civic - ALL CX, DX, and LX models
Rattle or Buzz From Exhaust Pipe A
SYMPTOM
A rattling or buzzing sound from exhaust pipe A.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The heat shields around exhaust pipe A are cracked.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the heat shields at exhaust pipe A.
PARTS INFORMATION
Exhaust Pipe A Heat Shield Kit (includes 4 nuts):
P/N 06180-S01-000, H/C 5808001
Gasket:
P/N 18212-SF4-000, H/C 2691681
Self-Locking Nut (3 required):
P/N 90212-5A5-003, H/C 1169812
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 311116
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 06180-S01-000 H/C 5808001
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 98-014A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle, and allow the exhaust system to cool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heat Shield: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust Pipe Rattling/Buzzing Sound > Page 2414
2. Remove and discard the three self-locking nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold.
3. Remove and retain the two nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the mounting bracket then lower the
pipe from the exhaust manifold.
4. Remove the heat shields from exhaust pipe A.
5. Install the new heat shields using the four nuts from the kit, and torque the nuts to 9.8 N.m (7.2
lb-ft).
6. Reinstall exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold using three new self-locking nuts and a new
gasket. Torque the nuts to 33 N.m (25 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the two nuts onto the mounting bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heat Shield: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust
Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound
Heat Shield: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound
98-014
February 23, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 98 Civic - ALL CX, DX, and LX models
Rattle or Buzz From Exhaust Pipe A
SYMPTOM
A rattling or buzzing sound from exhaust pipe A.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The heat shields around exhaust pipe A are cracked.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the heat shields at exhaust pipe A.
PARTS INFORMATION
Exhaust Pipe A Heat Shield Kit (includes 4 nuts):
P/N 06180-S01-000, H/C 5808001
Gasket:
P/N 18212-SF4-000, H/C 2691681
Self-Locking Nut (3 required):
P/N 90212-5A5-003, H/C 1169812
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 311116
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 06180-S01-000 H/C 5808001
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 98-014A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle, and allow the exhaust system to cool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heat Shield: > 98-014 > Feb > 98 > Exhaust
Pipe - Rattling/Buzzing Sound > Page 2420
2. Remove and discard the three self-locking nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold.
3. Remove and retain the two nuts securing exhaust pipe A to the mounting bracket then lower the
pipe from the exhaust manifold.
4. Remove the heat shields from exhaust pipe A.
5. Install the new heat shields using the four nuts from the kit, and torque the nuts to 9.8 N.m (7.2
lb-ft).
6. Reinstall exhaust pipe A to the exhaust manifold using three new self-locking nuts and a new
gasket. Torque the nuts to 33 N.m (25 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the two nuts onto the mounting bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear Of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2429
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2430
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2431
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2432
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2433
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2434
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2435
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2436
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2437
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2438
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2439
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2440
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2441
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2442
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2443
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2444
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated
Monitors
03-020
April 2, 2010
Applies To: All OBD II-equipped models except Passport
OBD II DTCs and Their Associated Monitors
(Supersedes 03-020, dated March 29, 2003, to revise the information marked by the black bars
and asterisks)
*REVISION SUMMARY
Numerous DTCs were added. Refer to the list for details.*
Following is a list of all OBD II DTCs and their associated monitors for all Honda automobiles with
OBD II. No one model has every DTC in the list.
DTC P0AA6 thru P0A9E
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2449
DTC P0A94 thru P0157
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2450
DTC P0158 thru P0400
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2451
DTC P0401 thru P0562
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2452
DTC P0563 thru P0748
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2453
DTC P0750 thru P0977
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2454
DTC P0979 thru P1193
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2455
DTC P1253 thru P1459
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2456
DTC P1486 thru P1585
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2457
DTC P1586 thru P1678
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2458
DTC P1679 thru P1860
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2459
DTC P1861 thru P2238
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2460
DTC P2240 thru U0073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 2461
DTC U0100 thru U1288
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
> Page 2464
Engine Control Module: Locations Picture View
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2467
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2468
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2469
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2470
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2471
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2472
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2473
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2474
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2475
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2476
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2477
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2478
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2479
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2480
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2481
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2482
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module: Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2485
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 2490
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2493
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2494
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2495
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2496
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2497
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2498
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2499
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2500
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2501
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2502
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2503
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2504
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2505
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2506
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2507
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2508
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2509
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2510
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2511
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2512
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2513
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2519
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2520
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2521
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2522
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2523
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2524
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2525
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2526
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2527
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2528
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2529
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2530
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2531
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2532
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2533
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2534
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2535
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE AND OPERATION
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON, and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2536
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2537
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2538
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 2543
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2546
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2547
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2548
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2549
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2550
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2551
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2552
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2553
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2554
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2555
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2556
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2557
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2558
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2559
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2560
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2561
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2562
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2563
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2564
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2565
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2566
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2572
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2573
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2574
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2575
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2576
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2577
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2578
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2579
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2580
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2581
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2582
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2583
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2584
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2585
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2586
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 2587
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2588
Ignition Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- See Malfunction Indicator Lamp when the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is turned ON.
- Perform the following input test for the ignition control module (ICM) after finishing the
fundamental tests for the ignition system and the fuel and emissions systems.
INPUT TEST FOR THE IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM)
1. Remove the distributor ignition (DI) cap, the distributor ignition (DI) rotor and the leak cover
(TEC).
2. Disconnect the wires from the ICM. 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage
between the BLK/YEL wire and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check the BLK/YEL wire between the under-dash fuse/relay box and
the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage between the wire*1 and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check: the ignition coil.
- the wire*1 between the ignition coil and the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 5.
*1: BLU2 wire (HITACHI)
WHT/BLU wire (TEC)
5. Disconnect the ECM/PCM connector A (32P). Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire
between the ECM/PCM and the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2589
- There should be continuity.
6. Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
7. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire between the test tachometer connector and the ICM.
- There should be continuity.
8. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
9. If all the tests are normal, replace the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2600
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2601
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2602
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2603
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2604
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2605
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2606
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2607
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2608
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 2609
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2615
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2616
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2617
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2618
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2619
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2620
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2621
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2622
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2623
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 2624
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2629
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2630
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2631
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2632
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2633
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2634
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2635
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2636
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2637
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2638
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2639
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2640
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2641
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2642
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2643
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2644
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Locations
The Barometric Pressure Sensor (BARO) is built into the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2651
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2655
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2659
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2660
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2661
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2662
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2665
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2666
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2667
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2668
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2669
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2670
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2671
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2672
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2673
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2674
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2675
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2676
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2677
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2678
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2679
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2680
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2681
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the crankshaft pulley. 3. Remove the upper cover
and dipstick/tube. 4. Remove the lower cover and idler pulley bracket.
5. Disconnect the CKF sensor connector, then remove the CKF sensor. 6. Install the CKF sensor in
reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Electric Load Sensor: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Picture View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2686
Starter Cables/Battery Ground Cable/Engine Ground Cable A, Engine Compartment Overview Of
Power Terminals (T) And Grounds (G)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2687
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2688
Electric Load Sensor: Connector Locations
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Left Front Corner of Fuel Tank
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
Resistance
At 0°C (32°F) .......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 5.0 - 7.0 K Ohms At 40°C (104°F) ..........................................................
..................................................................................................................... 1.0 - 1.5 K Ohms At
100°C (212°F) .....................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.3 - 0.4 K Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2699
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2700
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The IAT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the intake air temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
With 5 in.Hg. ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 2.4 - 2.5 Volts With 15 in.Hg. ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 1.4 - 1.5
Volts With 25 in.Hg. .............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 0.5 - 0.6 Volts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2707
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2708
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The MAP sensor converts manifold absolute pressure into electrical signals and inputs the
ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 >
Page 2717
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse
15
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse
15 > Page 2723
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2724
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
OXYGEN SENSOR (WITH ANTI-SEIZE COMPOUND ON THREADS)
......................................................................................... 45 Nm (33 lb-ft)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2725
Oxygen Sensor: Locations
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2728
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2729
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2730
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2731
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2732
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2733
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2734
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2735
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2736
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2737
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2738
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2739
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2740
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2741
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2742
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2743
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2744
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses the O2 signal to fine tune the Fuel Injector duration to
maintain the correct fuel mixture.
OPERATION
The Primary HO2S (Sensor 1) is installed in the exhaust manifold with the sensor end extending
into the exhaust stream. It uses zirconia and platinum to compare exhaust oxygen content with that
of the outside air. When heated by the combination of its internal heater and exhaust gases, the
sensor supplies a low voltage signal (0.0 - 1.0 volt) to the ECM. The amount of voltage produced is
determined by the air/fuel mixture, A high voltage (0.7 - 1.0 volt) indicates a rich mixture, and a low
(0 - 0.3 volts) voltage indicates a lean mixture.
Oxygen sensor operation is monitored by the Engine Control Module (ECM) and a malfunction
should be accompanied by a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). Circuit and output testing procedures
are covered in detail in the Diagnostic Trouble Code Charts. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection
Oxygen Sensor malfunctions will cause increased emission output and smog check failure. Other
symptoms may include poor idle quality or poor fuel economy.
HINT: When monitoring oxygen sensor operation with an oscilloscope, watch for a sine wave with a
frequency of at least 8 cycles in 10 seconds. A "lazy" oxygen sensor will not always set a code, but
will usually cause abnormal emissions levels.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2745
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2746
Part 2 Of 2
The scan tool indicates Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0135: An electrical problem in the
Primary Heated Oxygen Sensor (Primary HO2S) (Sensor 1) Heater system. (Except D16Y5 engine
with M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2747
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
PRIMARY H02S:
1. Remove the primary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector, then remove the cover.
b. Remove the primary H02S.
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2748
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector then remove the primary H02S.
2. Install the primary H02S in reverse order of removal.
SECONDARY H02S:
1. Remove the secondary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the secondary H02S connector, then remove the secondary H02S.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2749
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
a. Remove the grommet, and pull out the secondary H02S connector, then disconnect the
secondary H02S connector.
b. Remove the secondary H02S.
2. Install the secondary H02S in reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2753
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2754
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2759
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2760
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2761
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2762
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2763
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2764
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2765
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2766
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2767
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2768
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2769
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2770
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2771
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2772
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2773
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2774
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2778
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2782
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2785
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2786
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2787
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2788
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2789
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2790
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2791
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2792
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2793
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2794
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2795
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2796
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2797
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2798
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2799
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2800
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2801
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2802
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2803
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2804
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2805
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing
Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing
Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1 > Page 2810
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
> Page 2817
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Picture View
Lower Right Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2820
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2821
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2822
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2823
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2824
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2825
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2826
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2827
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2828
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2829
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2830
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2831
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2832
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2833
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2834
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2835
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2836
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 15 and
the BLK/WHT and BLK/YEL wire to the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). The sensor is grounded by
the BLK wire to G101. The speedometer and other control units in the circuit supply about 5 volts to
the BLU/WHT wire. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) intermittently grounds the BLU/WHT wire
which generates a pulsed signal in it. The number of pulses per minute increases/decreases with
the speed of the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2837
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2838
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2844
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2845
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2846
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2847
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2848
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2849
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2850
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2851
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2852
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2853
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2854
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2855
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2856
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2857
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2858
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2859
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2864
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2865
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2866
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2867
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2868
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2869
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2870
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2871
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2872
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2873
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2874
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2875
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2876
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2877
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2878
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2879
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2883
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2888
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Hall Effect Sensor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition
System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition
System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement
Parts
97-020
MAR 10, 1997
Applies To: ALL Models
New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
New Gauge
The fuel pressure gauge with 10" hose (T/N 07406-0040001) has been discontinued. The gauge
that replaces it (T/N 07406-004000A) has an easier-to-read face, a protective boot around the
gauge housing, and a 48" hose.
Replacement Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts > Page 2910
The replacement hose for the old gauge (24", T/N 07406-004020A) has also been discontinued. If
you need a replacement hose, order the new 48" hose (T/N 07406-004020B). The new hose
comes with an adapter so you can use it with the old fuel pressure gauge (T/N 07406-0040001).
Before connecting the hose to the vehicle, make sure the aluminum washer on the end of the hose
seals properly. If the aluminum washer doesn't seal, replace the washer.
Replacement washers come in a set of five (T/N 07406-0040300).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2911
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose disconnected
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm; 38 - 46 psi)
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose connected
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm; 28 - 36 psi)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2912
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1. Relieve fuel pressure.
2. Remove the service bolt on the fuel filter while holding the banjo bolt with another wrench. Attach
the special tool. 3. Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure with the engine idling and the
vacuum hose of the fuel pressure regulator disconnected from the fuel
pressure regulator and pinched. If the engine will not start, turn the ignition switch ON (II), wait for
two seconds, turn it off, then back on again and read the fuel pressure.
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38 - 46 psi)
4. Reconnect vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm, 28 - 36 psi)
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, first check the fuel pump. If the fuel pump is OK, check the
following: If the fuel pressure is higher than specified, Inspect for: Pinched or clogged fuel return hose or line.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- If the fuel pressure is lower than specified, inspect for: Clogged fuel filter.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- Fuel line leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
03-016
May 19, 2006
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord -ALL 1996-00 Civic -ALL 1997-01 CR-V - ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL
*1999-04 Odyssey - ALL*
Inspecting Idle Speed With the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic System
(Supersedes 03-016, dated March 25, 2003, to update the information marked by asterisks)
BACKGROUND
The ECM/PCM controls the vehicle's idle speed with the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve
and the air bleed screw (idle adjusting screw) work together to allow the proper amount of air into
the intake manifold when the throttle valve is closed (the accelerator pedal is released).
The ECM/PCM "learns" to work the IAC valve based on the total amount of air entering the intake
manifold. Air can enter the intake manifold from several sources, including the air bleed screw, but
only the air bleed screw is adjustable. If any changes are made that alter this airflow, specifically
with the air bleed screw, the ECM/PCM must learn new idle parameters.
When the air bleed screw is properly set, the ECM/PCM controls the engine's idle speed
seamlessly. But when the air bleed screw is not properly set, either of these symptoms may be
present:
^ Idle speed dips and then quickly recovers.
^ Engine stalls intermittently when it is just "off-idle." Here are the criteria for this symptom:
- The accelerator pedal is released but the driver's right foot rests over the pedal, causing just
enough pressure for the ECM/PCM to detect an input, yet there is little or no throttle valve opening
(the throttle valve is either not allowing any airflow or it is opened so slightly that more air supply is
needed).
- The engine speed is about 1,250 rpm or less.
- The lockup clutch (A/T models) or the clutch (M/T models) is disengaged.
- All during this time, the driver's foot does not move and stays resting over the accelerator pedal.
- The air bleed screw is not set properly and does not allow enough airflow.
- The amount of "air leakage" into the intake manifold is very low. (The normal amount of air let into
the intake manifold by sources other than the IAC valve, the air bleed screw, and normal operation
of the throttle body can vary slightly from vehicle to vehicle.)
NOTE:
"Air leakage" cannot be easily checked. If the first four criteria are met when the vehicle stalls, you
can assume the last two criteria are met as well.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
L4 Models and 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic
System (HDS) (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE A).
V6 Models except 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or HDS, and
clean out the throttle body if needed (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE B).
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Body Gasket (use only if needed): Refer to the parts catalog.
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 2917
PGM Tester with SN 320
or
Honda Diagnostic System with 1.006.004 or later software
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Carburetor Cleaner:
P/N 08732-0006, H/C 4713673
or
Throttle Plate and Induction Cleaner:
P/N 08732-9009, H/C 6204945
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Inspect Idle Speed (L4 and V6 Models)
Operation Number: 120301
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 07403
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Clean Throttle Body (V6 Models Except 1999-00 Odyssey)
Operation Number: 216001
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 08103
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
NOTE:
Warranty claims for these labor operations must be submitted separately. Do not combine them on
the same claim.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE A
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 2918
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey) or
you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of
counterclockwise turns you have made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in
step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then
go to step 9.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), and you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
10. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE B
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 7 or you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of counterclockwise turns you have
made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, and you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of
3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should never set the air bleed screw
counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If you set the screw further it could
work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Remove the throttle body (see the Fuel and Emissions
section of the appropriate service manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 2919
10. Open the throttle. Spray carburetor cleaner or throttle plate and induction cleaner into the
throttle body to clean out any contaminants. Make sure you spray the cleaner through the back of
the throttle body not the front, to avoid damaging the IAC valve.
11. Inspect the throttle body gasket, and replace it if needed. Reinstall the throttle body, making
sure all cables are properly adjusted, the accelerator pedal works properly, and all hoses and
cables are correctly routed.
12. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature. Make sure all electrical
items are turned off and the steering wheel is centered.
13. While watching the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw until the IAC count
reaches 7 or you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns.
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, leave the screw set at 3-1/2 turns. Go to step 14. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
14. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Manual Transmission
Idle Speed: Specifications Manual Transmission
Base Idle Speed ..................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 450 ± 50 rpm
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 670 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With Headlights On Low ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 850 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Manual Transmission > Page 2922
Idle Speed: Specifications Automatic Transmission
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 700 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 810 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With A/T
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA: D16Y5 engine with CVT, D16Y7 engine with A/T, D16YS engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: M/T 750 ± 50 rpm A/T 750 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be: M/T 810 ± 50 rpm A/T,CVT 810 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2925
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With CVT
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA:
D16Y5 engine with CVT and D16Y7 engine with A/T and D16Y8 engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: 750 ± 50 rpm
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be (all): 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2926
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With M/T
NOTE:
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
- (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights are off.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (transmission in neutral) until the
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Connect a tachometer.
3. Disconnect the IAC valve connector. 4. If the engine stalls, restart the engine with the
accelerator pedal slightly depressed. Stabilize the rpm at 1,000, then slowly release the pedal until
the engine idles.
5. Check idling in no-load conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air
conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be: 450 ± 50 rpm
Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw.
NOTE: After adjusting the idle speed in this step, recheck the ignition timing. If it is out of spec, go
back to step 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 7. Reconnect the 2P connector on the IAC valve, then do the ECM
reset procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 2927
8. Restart and idle the engine with no-load conditions for one minute, then check the idle speed.
NOTE: (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights
are off.
Idle speed should be:
(USA): 670 ± 50 rpm
(Canada): 750 ± 50 rpm
9. Idle the engine for one minute with headlights (Low) ON, and check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 750 ± 50 rpm
10. Turn the headlights off. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air
conditioner on, then check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Air Cleaner (ACL)
NOTE: Do not clean the ACL element it with compressed air (except dry type).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Ignition Timing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Cable: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2950
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2951
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2952
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2953
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2954
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2955
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2956
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2957
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2958
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2959
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2960
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2961
Ignition Cable: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2962
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2963
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2964
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2965
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Cable >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2966
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Carefully remove the ignition wires by pulling on the rubber boots. Do not bend the
wires; you might break them inside.
1. Check the condition of the ignition wire terminals. If any terminal is corroded, clean it, and if it is
broken or distorted, replace the ignition wire.
2. Connect ohmmeter probes and measure resistance. 3. If resistance exceeds 25 K Ohm, replace
the ignition wire.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2975
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2976
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2977
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2983
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2984
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 2985
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2986
Distributor: Locations
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views
Distributor: Exploded Views
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 2989
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2990
Distributor: Service and Repair
Removal:
1. Disconnect the connector from the distributor. 2. Disconnect the ignition wires from the
distributor ignition (DI) cap.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the distributor, then remove the distributor from the cylinder
head.
Installation:
NOTE: Before you install the distributor, bring the No.1 piston to compression stroke TDC.
1. Coat a new O-ring with engine oil, then install it. 2. Slip the distributor into position.
NOTE: The lug on the end of the distributor and its mating grooves in the camshaft end are both
offset to eliminate the possibility of installing the distributor 180° out of time.
3. Install the mounting bolts, and tighten them lightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Distributor, Ignition >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2991
4. Connect the ignition wires to the distributor ignition (DI) cap as shown. 5. Connect the connector
to the distributor. 6. Set the ignition timing. 7. After setting the ignition timing, tighten the mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the electrodes and ceramic insulator for:
Burned or worn electrodes may be caused by: Advanced ignition timing
- Loose spark plug
- Plug heat range too low
- Insufficient cooling
Fouled plugs may be caused by: Retarded ignition timing
- Oil in combustion chamber
- Incorrect spark plug gap
- Plug heat range too high
- Excessive idling/low speed running
- Clogged air cleaner element
- Deteriorated ignition coil or ignition wires
2. D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engine:
- Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool, and replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded
as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2995
3. B16A2 engine:
- Do not adjust the gap of a platinum tip plug: replace the spark plug if the center electrode is
rounded or if the gap is not within the specifications.
NOTE: Use only the spark plugs listed.
4. Apply a small quantity of anti-seize compound to the plug threads, and screw the plugs into the
cylinder head finger-tight. Then torque them to 18
N.m (1.8 kg.m, 13 lb.ft).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Check compression with engine at normal operating temperature and throttle in wide open position.
Prior to performing test, disable ignition and fuel injection to prevent fuel from being sprayed into
cylinders while cranking engine. Ensure is fully charged and that cranking speed is 250 RPM.
Standard reading should be 135-184 psi. The maximum variation between cylinders is 28 psi.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Valve Clearance
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.007-0.009 inches
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.009-0.011 inches
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3002
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
NOTE: Valves should be adjusted only when the cylinder head temperature is less than 100°F (38°C).
- After adjusting, retorque the crankshaft pulley bolt.
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the upper cover.
3. Set the No. 1 piston at TDC. The "UP" mark on the cam-shaft pulley should be at top, and the
TDC marks should align with the cylinder head
surface.
4. Adjust valves on No. 1 cylinder.
Intake: 0.18 - 0.22 mm (0.007 - 0.009 inch) Exhaust: 0.23 - 0.27 mm (0.009 - 0.011 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3003
5. Loosen the locknut, and turn the adjustment screw until the feeler gauge slides back and forth
with a slight amount of drag.
6. Tighten the locknut, and check the clearance again. Repeat the adjustment if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3004
7. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise (camshaft pulley turns 90°). The "UP" mark should
be on the exhaust side. Adjust valves on No. 3
cylinder.
8. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 4 piston to TDC. Both TDC grooves
are once again visible. Adjust valves on No. 4
cylinder.
9. Rotate the crankshaft 180° counterclockwise to bring No. 2 piston to TDC. The "UP" mark should
be on the intake side. Adjust valves on No. 2
cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3014
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3015
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3016
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3017
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3018
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3019
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3020
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3021
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3022
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug >
04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3023
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3029
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3030
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3031
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3032
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3033
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3034
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3035
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3036
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3037
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: >
04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set > Page 3038
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation
A/C Signal: Description and Operation
OPERATION
This signals the ECM/PCM when there is a demand for cooling from the air conditioning system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3042
A/C Signal: Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3043
This signals the ECM/PCM when there is a demand for cooling from the air conditioning system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3048
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3049
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3050
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3051
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3052
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3053
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3054
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3055
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3056
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3057
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3058
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3059
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3060
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3061
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3062
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3063
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
Resistance
At 0°C (32°F) .......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 5.0 - 7.0 K Ohms At 40°C (104°F) ..........................................................
..................................................................................................................... 1.0 - 1.5 K Ohms At
100°C (212°F) .....................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.3 - 0.4 K Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3067
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 3068
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The IAT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the intake air temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Locations
The Barometric Pressure Sensor (BARO) is built into the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear Of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3077
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3078
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3079
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3080
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3081
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3082
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3083
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3084
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3085
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3086
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3087
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3088
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3089
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3090
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3091
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <-->
[Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3092
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
Brake Signal: Locations
This signals the ECM/PCM when the brake pedal is depressed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3096
Brake Signal: Description and Operation
PURPOSE/OPERATION
This signals the Engine Control Module (ECM) when the Brake Pedal is depressed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3100
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3104
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Starter Switch Signal <-->
[Cranking Signal] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Starter Switch Signal: Description and Operation
OPERATION
This signals the ECM/PCM when the engine is cranking.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Starter Switch Signal <-->
[Cranking Signal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3108
Starter Switch Signal: Testing and Inspection
This signals the ECM/PCM when the engine is cranking.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3112
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3113
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3114
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3115
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3118
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3119
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3120
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3121
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3122
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3123
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3124
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3125
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3126
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3127
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3128
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3129
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3130
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3131
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3132
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3133
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3134
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the crankshaft pulley. 3. Remove the upper cover
and dipstick/tube. 4. Remove the lower cover and idler pulley bracket.
5. Disconnect the CKF sensor connector, then remove the CKF sensor. 6. Install the CKF sensor in
reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Photo View
Data Link Connector: Locations Photo View
Gray connector, below left side of dash panel, above kick panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Photo View > Page 3139
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3142
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3143
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3144
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3145
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3146
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3147
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3148
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3149
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3150
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3151
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3152
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3153
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3154
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3155
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3156
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3157
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3158
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Electric Load Sensor: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Picture View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3163
Starter Cables/Battery Ground Cable/Engine Ground Cable A, Engine Compartment Overview Of
Power Terminals (T) And Grounds (G)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3164
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3165
Electric Load Sensor: Connector Locations
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated
Monitors
03-020
April 2, 2010
Applies To: All OBD II-equipped models except Passport
OBD II DTCs and Their Associated Monitors
(Supersedes 03-020, dated March 29, 2003, to revise the information marked by the black bars
and asterisks)
*REVISION SUMMARY
Numerous DTCs were added. Refer to the list for details.*
Following is a list of all OBD II DTCs and their associated monitors for all Honda automobiles with
OBD II. No one model has every DTC in the list.
DTC P0AA6 thru P0A9E
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3170
DTC P0A94 thru P0157
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3171
DTC P0158 thru P0400
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3172
DTC P0401 thru P0562
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3173
DTC P0563 thru P0748
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3174
DTC P0750 thru P0977
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3175
DTC P0979 thru P1193
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3176
DTC P1253 thru P1459
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3177
DTC P1486 thru P1585
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3178
DTC P1586 thru P1678
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3179
DTC P1679 thru P1860
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3180
DTC P1861 thru P2238
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3181
DTC P2240 thru U0073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3182
DTC U0100 thru U1288
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View > Page 3185
Engine Control Module: Locations Picture View
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3188
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3189
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3190
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3191
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3192
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3193
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3194
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3195
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3196
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3197
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3198
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3199
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3200
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3201
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3202
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3203
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module: Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3206
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Left Front Corner of Fuel Tank
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 3.5 Nm (2.5 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3217
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3220
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3221
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3222
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3223
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3224
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3225
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3226
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3227
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3228
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3229
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3230
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3231
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3232
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3233
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3234
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3235
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3236
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control
Idle Air Control Valve (IAC Valve) When the engine is cold, the A/C compressor is on, the
transmission is in gear, the brake pedal is depressed, the P/S load is high, or the alternator Is
charging, the ECM/PCM controls current to the IAC Valve to maintain the correct idle speed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3241
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3242
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3243
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3244
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3245
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3246
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3247
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3248
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3249
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3250
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3251
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3252
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3253
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3254
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3255
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3256
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 3264
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3267
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3268
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3269
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3270
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3271
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3272
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3273
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3274
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3275
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3276
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3277
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3278
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3279
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3280
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3281
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3282
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3283
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3284
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3285
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3286
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3287
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 3296
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON
With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 3302
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 00-004
> Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads
Hood Latch: All Technical Service Bulletins Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads
00-004
March 6, 2001
*Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 2001 Civic 4-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L041276
- 4-door from VIN 2HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 2HGES....1L511373
- 2-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L035953*
Rattle From the Hood (Supersedes 00-004, dated January 25, 2000)
SYMPTOM
A rattle from the front of the vehicle when driving over rough roads or small bumps.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Excessive striker-to-latch clearance.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the hood edge cushions and the hood latch.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Adjust each hood edge cushion so only one thread is showing and the "80" on the top is in the
position shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 00-004
> Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads > Page 3308
2. Loosen the hood latch mounting bolts, and adjust the latch so it is flush with the top of the
bulkhead.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 00-004
> Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads > Page 3314
2. Loosen the hood latch mounting bolts, and adjust the latch so it is flush with the top of the
bulkhead.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3315
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Does Not Come ON
NOTE: If this symptom is intermittent, check for a loose fuse No.25 (METER 7.5 A) in the
under-dash fuse/relay box, a poor connection at ECM/PCM terminal A18, or an intermittent open in
the GRN/ORN wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 3318
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Stays ON
Part 1 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 3319
Part 2 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 3320
Part 3 Of 3
NOTE:
- When there is no Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) stored, the MIL will stay on if the SCS service
connector is connected and the ignition switch is on.
- If this symptom is intermittent, check for: A loose FIE/M (15 A) fuse in the under-hood fuse/relay box
- A loose No.13 FUEL PUMP fuse (15 A) in the under-dash fuse/relay box
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (C7) and the service check connector
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D4) and the MAP sensor
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D10), the TP sensor, the EGR valve lift
sensor (D16Y5 engine) and/or the Fuel tank pressure sensor ('96 D16Y8 engine (coupe), '97
D16Y7 engine (coupe: KL model, sedan: KL (LX model), '97 D16Y8 engine (coupe: all models,
sedan: KL model), '98-all models)
- PGM-FI main relay See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating instructions.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
With 5 in.Hg. ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 2.4 - 2.5 Volts With 15 in.Hg. ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 1.4 - 1.5
Volts With 25 in.Hg. .............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 0.5 - 0.6 Volts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3324
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3325
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The MAP sensor converts manifold absolute pressure into electrical signals and inputs the
ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 3334
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 3340
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3341
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
OXYGEN SENSOR (WITH ANTI-SEIZE COMPOUND ON THREADS)
......................................................................................... 45 Nm (33 lb-ft)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3342
Oxygen Sensor: Locations
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3345
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3346
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3347
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3348
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3349
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3350
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3351
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3352
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3353
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3354
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3355
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3356
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3357
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3358
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3359
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3360
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3361
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses the O2 signal to fine tune the Fuel Injector duration to
maintain the correct fuel mixture.
OPERATION
The Primary HO2S (Sensor 1) is installed in the exhaust manifold with the sensor end extending
into the exhaust stream. It uses zirconia and platinum to compare exhaust oxygen content with that
of the outside air. When heated by the combination of its internal heater and exhaust gases, the
sensor supplies a low voltage signal (0.0 - 1.0 volt) to the ECM. The amount of voltage produced is
determined by the air/fuel mixture, A high voltage (0.7 - 1.0 volt) indicates a rich mixture, and a low
(0 - 0.3 volts) voltage indicates a lean mixture.
Oxygen sensor operation is monitored by the Engine Control Module (ECM) and a malfunction
should be accompanied by a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). Circuit and output testing procedures
are covered in detail in the Diagnostic Trouble Code Charts. See: Testing and Inspection
Oxygen Sensor malfunctions will cause increased emission output and smog check failure. Other
symptoms may include poor idle quality or poor fuel economy.
HINT: When monitoring oxygen sensor operation with an oscilloscope, watch for a sine wave with a
frequency of at least 8 cycles in 10 seconds. A "lazy" oxygen sensor will not always set a code, but
will usually cause abnormal emissions levels.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3362
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3363
Part 2 Of 2
The scan tool indicates Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0135: An electrical problem in the
Primary Heated Oxygen Sensor (Primary HO2S) (Sensor 1) Heater system. (Except D16Y5 engine
with M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3364
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
PRIMARY H02S:
1. Remove the primary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector, then remove the cover.
b. Remove the primary H02S.
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3365
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector then remove the primary H02S.
2. Install the primary H02S in reverse order of removal.
SECONDARY H02S:
1. Remove the secondary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the secondary H02S connector, then remove the secondary H02S.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3366
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
a. Remove the grommet, and pull out the secondary H02S connector, then disconnect the
secondary H02S connector.
b. Remove the secondary H02S.
2. Install the secondary H02S in reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3370
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3371
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear Of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3378
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3379
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3380
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3381
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3382
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3383
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3384
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3385
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3386
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3387
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3388
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3389
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3390
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3391
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3392
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3393
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated
Monitors
03-020
April 2, 2010
Applies To: All OBD II-equipped models except Passport
OBD II DTCs and Their Associated Monitors
(Supersedes 03-020, dated March 29, 2003, to revise the information marked by the black bars
and asterisks)
*REVISION SUMMARY
Numerous DTCs were added. Refer to the list for details.*
Following is a list of all OBD II DTCs and their associated monitors for all Honda automobiles with
OBD II. No one model has every DTC in the list.
DTC P0AA6 thru P0A9E
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3398
DTC P0A94 thru P0157
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3399
DTC P0158 thru P0400
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3400
DTC P0401 thru P0562
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3401
DTC P0563 thru P0748
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3402
DTC P0750 thru P0977
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3403
DTC P0979 thru P1193
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3404
DTC P1253 thru P1459
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3405
DTC P1486 thru P1585
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3406
DTC P1586 thru P1678
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3407
DTC P1679 thru P1860
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3408
DTC P1861 thru P2238
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3409
DTC P2240 thru U0073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Emissions - OBD II DTC's And Associated Monitors > Page 3410
DTC U0100 thru U1288
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View > Page
3413
Engine Control Module: Locations Picture View
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3416
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3417
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3418
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3419
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3420
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3421
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3422
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3423
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3424
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3425
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3426
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3427
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3428
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3429
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3430
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3431
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module: Programming and Relearning
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3434
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
Engine Control Module (ECM)/Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reset Procedure
NOTE: Resetting the ECM/PCM will erase any stored DTCs and any freeze data. It will also restart
all readiness code monitors.
Either of the following actions will reset the ECM/PCM.
- Use the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester to clear the ECM's/PCM's memory.
NOTE: See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating
instructions.
- Turn the ignition switch OFF. Remove the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay
box for 10 seconds.
NOTE: Removing the BACK UP (7.5 A) fuse cancels the clock and the radio presets. Make note of
the customer's presets so you can reset them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 3439
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3442
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3443
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3444
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3445
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3446
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3447
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3448
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3449
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3450
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3451
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3452
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3453
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3454
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3455
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3456
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3457
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3458
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 3459
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 3460
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 3461
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 3462
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3472
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3473
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3474
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3475
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3476
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3477
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3478
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3479
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3480
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or P0108
Set > Page 3481
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
Absolute Pressure Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set
04-004
August 10, 2004
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord V6 - ALL 1996-00 Civic DX, LX - ALL 1999-00 Odyssey - ALL
Rough Idle at Cold Start; MIL Comes On With DTC P0107 or P0108 (Supersedes 04-004, dated
March 5, 2004)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 03214
Symptom Code: 09103
Skill Level: Repair Technician
SYMPTOM
In cold weather, the engine idles roughly after a cold start. The MIL may also come on with DTC
P0107 (MAP sensor circuit low voltage) or DTC P0108 (MAP sensor circuit high voltage) set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Moisture freezes inside the MAP sensor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the MAP sensor. For Japan-built Civics, also replace the intake manifold.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3487
PARTS INFORMATION
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Accord V6; 1998-00 Civic DX, LX; Odyssey
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3488
1996-97 Civic DX, LX
Failed Part: P/N 37830-PAA-500 H/C 5430319
Defect Code: 81400
Symptom Code: K4900
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
*1. Connect the Honda Diagnostic System (HDS) with version 1.012.023 or later software to the
16P data link connector (DLC).*
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II). Turn on the HDS.
3. At the screen prompts, enter the VIN and the odometer reading, and then verify the correct date
and time.
4. From the System Selection Menu screen, select PGM FI.
5. From the Mode Menu screen, select DTCs/Freeze Data.
6. Enter the repair order number when prompted, then read the screen.
Is DTC P0107 or P0108 set?
Yes - Go to step 7.
No - Go to step 8.
7. Press the freeze data (camera film strip) icon on the right side of the screen. Look at the IAT
SENSOR value.
Is the IAT value at or below 32°F (0°) (4.0 volts)? Yes - Press the red DTC icon on the right side of
the screen to clear the DTC. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0), and then turn off and disconnect
the HDS. Go to the appropriate *REPAIR PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
8. Find out from your customer the approximate ambient air temperature when the problem
happened.
Was the ambient air temperature at or below 32°F (0°C) when the problem happened? Yes - Go to
the appropriate REPAIR
* PROCEDURE.*
* No - Continue with normal troubleshooting.*
*REPAIR PROCEDURE - ACCORD V6, ODYSSEY*
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3489
Discard the instructions that came with the kit they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Unplug the 3P connector from the MAP sensor.
2. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
3. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
4. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to
transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector.
Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3490
6. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
*7. Accord V6 only: Remove and discard the throttle body cover.*
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
* NOTE:
For 1998-99 Accord V6 models, discard the sensor spacer from the kit, and use P/N
16442-P8F-A21, H/C 6562896, instead. Also, discard the adapter harness bracket from the kit.
This bracket cannot be mounted to the spacer on those models.*
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
*10. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Install the adapter harness bracket on the sensor spacer
(one flange bolt).*
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw).
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Then
plug the small (black) end of the adapter harness into the MAP sensor.
*13. Odyssey, 2000-02 Accord V6 only: Slide the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness
bracket until it clicks into place.*
*14. 1998-99 Accord V6 only: Use a wire tie to secure the engine harness 3P connector to any
nearby vacuum hose. Make sure the connector and the
harness do not interfere with the throttle cables and the wire tie does not pinch the vacuum hose.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3491
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (U.S.-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
3. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the 3P connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
4. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3492
5. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
7. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
8. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
9. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 8.
10. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
11. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3493
12. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
13. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
14. Clamp the engine harness in place.
15. Reinstall the air cleaner.
REPAIR PROCEDURE - CIVIC (JAPAN-BUILT)
NOTE:
Discard the instructions that came with the kit; they are incorrect for this repair. Follow this
procedure instead.
1. Remove the air cleaner.
2. Replace the intake manifold (see page 9-2 of the 1996-00 Civic Service Manual). Make sure you
replace the fuel pressure regulator 0-ring and the seal rings and rubber rings for the fuel injectors.
3. Release the engine harness from its clamp. Then unplug the 3P connector from the MAP
sensor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3494
4. Use a small, flat-tip screwdriver to pry out the retainer from the connector. Also, pry out the
retainer from the new 3P connector.
5. Remove the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) from the old 3P connector.
6. Insert the No. 1 terminal (YEL/RED wire) into the left (No. 1) cavity of the new 3P connector.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 2 terminal (GRN/WHT wire) to the center (No. 2) cavity
of the new 3P connector. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to transfer the No. 3 terminal (RED/GRN wire) to
the right (No. 3) cavity of the new 3P connector. Discard the old 3P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3495
8. Snap the retainer into place on the new 3P connector.
9. Remove the MAP sensor and the 0-ring from the throttle body (two washer-screws). Discard the
sensor and the 0-ring, but save the washer-screws.
10. Position the new 0-ring on the throttle body. Then install the sensor spacer with the
washer-screws you saved in step 9.
11. Install the new MAP sensor on the sensor spacer (one washer-screw). Then plug the small
(black) end of the adapter harness into the sensor.
12. Install the adapter harness bracket on the throttle body (one flange bolt).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Absolute Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Absolute Pressure Sensor: > 04-004 > Aug > 04 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0107or
P0108 Set > Page 3496
13. Plug the large (gray) end of the adapter harness into the engine harness 3P connector. Slide
the engine harness 3P connector onto the harness bracket until it clicks into place.
14. Models with cruise control: Reposition the vacuum hose and its clamp. Make sure the brake
booster vacuum hose and the fuel return line do not interfere with each other.
15. Clamp the engine harness in place.
16. Reinstall the air cleaner.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3501
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3502
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3503
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3504
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3505
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3506
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3507
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3508
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3509
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3510
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3511
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3512
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3513
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3514
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3515
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3516
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Locations
The Barometric Pressure Sensor (BARO) is built into the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3523
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3527
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ECT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the engine coolant temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3531
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3532
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3533
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3534
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3537
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3538
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3539
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3540
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3541
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3542
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3543
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3544
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3545
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3546
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3547
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3548
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3549
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3550
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3551
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3552
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3553
Crankshaft Fluctuation Sensor: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove the crankshaft pulley. 3. Remove the upper cover
and dipstick/tube. 4. Remove the lower cover and idler pulley bracket.
5. Disconnect the CKF sensor connector, then remove the CKF sensor. 6. Install the CKF sensor in
reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Electric Load Sensor: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Picture View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3558
Starter Cables/Battery Ground Cable/Engine Ground Cable A, Engine Compartment Overview Of
Power Terminals (T) And Grounds (G)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3559
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Electric Load Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3560
Electric Load Sensor: Connector Locations
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
Left Front Corner of Fuel Tank
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
Resistance
At 0°C (32°F) .......................................................................................................................................
............................................ 5.0 - 7.0 K Ohms At 40°C (104°F) ..........................................................
..................................................................................................................... 1.0 - 1.5 K Ohms At
100°C (212°F) .....................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.3 - 0.4 K Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3571
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3572
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The IAT Sensor is a temperature dependant resistor (thermistor). The resistance of the thermistor
decreases as the intake air temperature increases as shown above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
With 5 in.Hg. ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................... 2.4 - 2.5 Volts With 15 in.Hg. ...................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 1.4 - 1.5
Volts With 25 in.Hg. .............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 0.5 - 0.6 Volts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
3579
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
3580
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The MAP sensor converts manifold absolute pressure into electrical signals and inputs the
ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 3589
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 >
Page 3595
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3596
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
OXYGEN SENSOR (WITH ANTI-SEIZE COMPOUND ON THREADS)
......................................................................................... 45 Nm (33 lb-ft)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3597
Oxygen Sensor: Locations
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Below Rear of D16Y5 Eng.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3600
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3601
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3602
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3603
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3604
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3605
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3606
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3607
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3608
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3609
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3610
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3611
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3612
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3613
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3614
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3615
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3616
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses the O2 signal to fine tune the Fuel Injector duration to
maintain the correct fuel mixture.
OPERATION
The Primary HO2S (Sensor 1) is installed in the exhaust manifold with the sensor end extending
into the exhaust stream. It uses zirconia and platinum to compare exhaust oxygen content with that
of the outside air. When heated by the combination of its internal heater and exhaust gases, the
sensor supplies a low voltage signal (0.0 - 1.0 volt) to the ECM. The amount of voltage produced is
determined by the air/fuel mixture, A high voltage (0.7 - 1.0 volt) indicates a rich mixture, and a low
(0 - 0.3 volts) voltage indicates a lean mixture.
Oxygen sensor operation is monitored by the Engine Control Module (ECM) and a malfunction
should be accompanied by a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). Circuit and output testing procedures
are covered in detail in the Diagnostic Trouble Code Charts. See: Testing and Inspection
Oxygen Sensor malfunctions will cause increased emission output and smog check failure. Other
symptoms may include poor idle quality or poor fuel economy.
HINT: When monitoring oxygen sensor operation with an oscilloscope, watch for a sine wave with a
frequency of at least 8 cycles in 10 seconds. A "lazy" oxygen sensor will not always set a code, but
will usually cause abnormal emissions levels.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3617
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3618
Part 2 Of 2
The scan tool indicates Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) P0135: An electrical problem in the
Primary Heated Oxygen Sensor (Primary HO2S) (Sensor 1) Heater system. (Except D16Y5 engine
with M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3619
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
PRIMARY H02S:
1. Remove the primary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector, then remove the cover.
b. Remove the primary H02S.
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3620
a. Disconnect the primary H02S connector then remove the primary H02S.
2. Install the primary H02S in reverse order of removal.
SECONDARY H02S:
1. Remove the secondary H02S.
D16Y5, D16Y7 Engines:
a. Disconnect the secondary H02S connector, then remove the secondary H02S.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3621
B16A2, D16Y8 Engines:
a. Remove the grommet, and pull out the secondary H02S connector, then disconnect the
secondary H02S connector.
b. Remove the secondary H02S.
2. Install the secondary H02S in reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3625
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3626
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3631
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3632
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3633
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3634
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3635
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3636
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3637
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3638
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3639
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3640
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3641
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3642
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3643
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3644
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3645
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3646
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3650
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3654
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3657
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3658
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3659
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3660
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3661
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3662
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3663
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3664
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3665
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3666
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3667
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3668
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3669
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3670
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3671
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3672
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3673
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3674
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3675
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3676
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3677
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure
Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure
Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure Switch - 1 > Page 3682
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View > Page
3689
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Picture View
Lower Right Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3692
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3693
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3694
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3695
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3696
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3697
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3698
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3699
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3700
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3701
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3702
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3703
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3704
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3705
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3706
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3707
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3708
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 15 and
the BLK/WHT and BLK/YEL wire to the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). The sensor is grounded by
the BLK wire to G101. The speedometer and other control units in the circuit supply about 5 volts to
the BLU/WHT wire. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) intermittently grounds the BLU/WHT wire
which generates a pulsed signal in it. The number of pulses per minute increases/decreases with
the speed of the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3709
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3710
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3715
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3716
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3717
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3718
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3719
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3720
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3721
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3722
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3723
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3724
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3725
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3726
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3727
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3728
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3729
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3730
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3734
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3738
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3741
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3742
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3743
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3744
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3745
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3746
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3747
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3748
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3749
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3750
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3751
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3752
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3753
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3754
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3755
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3756
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3757
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3758
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3759
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3760
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/T Gear Position Signal <-->
[Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3761
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3766
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3767
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3768
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3769
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3770
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3771
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3772
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3773
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3774
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3775
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3776
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3777
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3778
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3779
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3780
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3781
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC)
Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure
Switch - 1
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing (VTEC)
Pressure Switch <--> [Variable Valve Timing Pressure Switch] > Component Information > Locations > VTEC Pressure
Switch - 1 > Page 3786
Variable Valve Timing (VTEC) Pressure Switch: Locations VTEC Pressure Switch - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 14 - 30 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3791
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Locations > VTEC Solenoid Valve - 1 > Page 3794
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Locations VTEC Solenoid Valve - 2
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3795
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Disconnect the 1P connector from the VTEC solenoid valve.
2. Measure resistance between the terminal and body ground.
Resistance: 14 - 30 ohms
3. If the resistance is within specifications, remove the VTEC solenoid valve assembly from the
cylinder head, and check the VTEC solenoid valve
filter for clogging.
- If there is clogging, replace the engine oil filter and the engine oil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3796
4. If the filter is not clogged, push the VTEC solenoid valve with your finger and check its
movement.
- If the VTEC solenoid valve is normal, check the engine oil pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Vehicle View > Page 3803
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations Picture View
Lower Right Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3806
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3807
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3808
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3809
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3810
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3811
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3812
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3813
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3814
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3815
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3816
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3817
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3818
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3819
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3820
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3821
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3822
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 15 and
the BLK/WHT and BLK/YEL wire to the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). The sensor is grounded by
the BLK wire to G101. The speedometer and other control units in the circuit supply about 5 volts to
the BLU/WHT wire. The vehicle speed sensor (VSS) intermittently grounds the BLU/WHT wire
which generates a pulsed signal in it. The number of pulses per minute increases/decreases with
the speed of the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3823
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3824
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Alternator FR Signal <-->
[Voltage Signal] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Alternator FR Signal: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This signals the ECM/PCM when the Alternator (ALT) is charging.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Alternator FR Signal <-->
[Voltage Signal] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3828
Alternator FR Signal: Testing and Inspection
This signals the ECM/PCM when the Alternator (ALT) is charging.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08
> Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08
> Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3838
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08
> Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3839
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-027 > Sep > 08
> Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3840
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3846
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3847
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 3848
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > SN050508 > May > 05 > Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Noise
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Catalytic
Converter Noise
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Catalytic Converter Noise? Check the Heat Shield
APPLIES TO: All models
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that buzzes or rattles, and you suspect the catalytic converter is the
culprit? Before you start replacing the converter, first check the heat shield area. If there any stones
or debris trapped inside, they can cause buzzing or rattling.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Three
Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: > SN050508 > May > 05 > Exhaust System - Catalytic Converter Noise
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Catalytic
Converter Noise
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Catalytic Converter Noise? Check the Heat Shield
APPLIES TO: All models
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that buzzes or rattles, and you suspect the catalytic converter is the
culprit? Before you start replacing the converter, first check the heat shield area. If there any stones
or debris trapped inside, they can cause buzzing or rattling.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3858
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3859
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Three Way Catalytic Converter (TWC) is used to convert hydrocarbons (HC), carbon
monoxide (CO), and oxides of nitrogen (NOx) in the exhaust gas to carbon dioxide (CO 2),
dinitrogen (N2) and water vapor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
<--> [Catalytic Converter] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3860
Three Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter: Testing and Inspection
1. Using a flashlight, make a visual check for plugging, melting and cracking of the catalyst.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > EVAP Canister Vent Shut Valve
Canister Purge Control Valve: Locations EVAP Canister Vent Shut Valve
Right Rear Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > EVAP Canister Vent Shut Valve > Page 3866
Canister Purge Control Valve: Locations Evaporative Emission Purge Control Solenoid Valve
Top Center Of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3867
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Purge Control Solenoid Valve*9
When the engine coolant temperature is above 154 °F (68 °C), the ECM/PCM controls the EVAP
purge control solenoid valve which controls vacuum to the EVAP purge control canister.
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Purge Control Solenoid Valve*4
When the engine coolant temperature above 154 °F (68 °C), intake air temperature above 32 °F (0
°C) and vehicle speed above 0 mile (0 kph) or [A/C compressor clutch on and intake air
temperature above 160 °F (41 °C)], the ECM/PCM controls the EVAP purge control solenoid valve
which controls vacuum to the EVAP purge control canister.
*9 '96 D16Y5 engine, '96 D16Y7 engine, '96 D16Y8 engine (Sedan), '97 D16Y5 engine, '97 D16Y7
engine (Coupe: KA, KC models, Sedan: KA, KC, KL, (LX) models, Hatchback: all models), '97
D16Y8 engine (Sedan: KA, KC model)
*4 '96 D16Y8 engine (Coupe), '97 D16Y7 engine (Coupe: KL model, Sedan: KL, (LX) model), '97
D16Y8 engine (Coupe: all models, sedan:KL model), '98 all models, '99 all models, '00 all models.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Bypass Solenoid Valve
Canister Purge Solenoid: Locations Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Bypass Solenoid Valve
Left Front Corner of Fuel Tank
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Bypass Solenoid Valve >
Page 3872
Canister Purge Solenoid: Locations Evaporative Emission Purge Control Solenoid Valve
Top Center of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Canister Purge Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3875
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3876
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3877
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3878
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3879
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3880
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3881
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3882
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3883
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3884
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3885
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3886
Canister Purge Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3887
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3888
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3889
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3890
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Two-Way Valve <--> [Evaporative Check Valve] > Component Information > Specifications
Two-Way Valve: Specifications
Should stabilize
Vacuum between
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.8 - 2.1 kPa (0.2 - 0.6 in.Hg.) Pressure between ...............................................................................
........................................................................................... 1.0 kPa (0.3 in.Hg.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Two-Way Valve <--> [Evaporative Check Valve] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3894
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Two-Way Valve <--> [Evaporative Check Valve] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3895
Two-Way Valve: Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Two Way Valve Testing
['96 D16Y5 engine, '96 D16Y7 engine, '96 D16Y8 engine (sedan), '97 D16Y5 engine, '97 D16Y7
engine (coupe: KA, KC models, sedan: (KA, KC, KL (DX) models, hatchback: all models), '97
D16Y8 engine (sedan: (KA, KC models)]:
1. Remove the fuel fill cap.
2. Remove the vapor line from the EVAP two way valve on the fuel tank, and connect it to a
T-fitting from a vacuum gauge and a vacuum pump as
shown.
3. Apply vacuum slowly and continuously while watching the gauge. The vacuum should stabilize
momentarily at 0.7-2.0 kPa (5-15 mmHg, 0.2-0.6
in.Hg). If the vacuum stabilizes (valve opens) below 0.7 kPa (5 mmHg, 0.2 in.Hg) or above 2.0 kPa
(15 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg), install a new valve and retest.
4. Move the vacuum pump hose from the vacuum fitting to the pressure fitting, and move the
vacuum gauge hose from the vacuum side to the
pressure side as shown.
5. Slowly pressurize the vapor line while watching the gauge. The pressure should stabilize at
1.3-4.7 kPa (0-35 mmHg, 0.4-1.4 in.Hg).
- If the pressure momentarily stabilizes (valve opens) at 1.3-4.7 kPa (10-35 mmHg, 0.4-in. Hg), the
valve is OK.
- If the pressure stabilizes below 1.3 kPa (10 mmHg, 0.4 in.Hg) or above 4.7 kPa (35 mmHg, 1.4
in.Hg), install a new valve and retest.
Evaporative Emission (EVAP) Two Way Valve Testing
['96 D16Y8 engine (coupe), '97 D16Y7 engine (coupe: KL model, sedan: KL (LX) model), '97
D16Y5 engine (coupe: all models, sedan: KL model, '98-all models)]:
1. Remove the fuel fill cap.
2. Remove the vapor line from the EVAP two way valve, and connect it to a T-fitting from a vacuum
gauge and a vacuum pump as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Two-Way Valve <--> [Evaporative Check Valve] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3896
3. Apply vacuum slowly and continuously while watching the gauge. The vacuum should stabilize
momentarily at 0.8-2.1 kPa (6-16 mmHg, 0.2-0.6
in.Hg). If the vacuum stabilizes (valve opens) below 0.8 kPa (6 mmHg, 0.2 in.Hg) or above 2.1 kPa
(16 mmHg, 0.6 in.Hg), install a new valve and retest.
4. Move the vacuum pump hose from the vacuum fitting to the pressure fitting, and move the
vacuum gauge hose from the vacuum side to the
pressure side as shown.
5. Slowly pressurize the vapor line while watching the gauge. The pressure should be stabilize
momentarily above 1.0 kPa (8 mmHg, 0.3 in.Hg).
- If the pressure momentarily stabilizes (valve opens) above 1.0 kPa (8 mmHg, 0.3 in.Hg), the valve
is OK.
- If the pressure stabilizes below 1.0 kPa (8 mmHg, 0.3 in.Hg), install a new valve and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3902
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3903
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3904
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3905
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3906
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3907
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3908
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3909
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3910
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3911
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3912
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3913
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3914
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3915
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3916
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 3917
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Solenoid, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Leak Detection Solenoid: Locations
Right Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Refueling Vapor Recovery System > Refueling Control Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Float Test
Refueling Control Valve: Testing and Inspection Float Test
Float Test
1. Make sure the fuel tank is less than half full. 2. Remove the fuel fill cap to relieve the fuel tank
pressure, then reinstall the cap.
3. Remove the fuel hose joint protector. Disconnect the ORVR vapor recirculation hose, and
connect a vacuum pump to the vapor recirculation hose. 4. Plug the hose port. 5. Apply vacuum to
the ORVR vapor recirculation hose.
- If the vacuum holds, replace the ORVR vent shut valve.
- If the vacuum does not hold, the float is OK.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Refueling Vapor Recovery System > Refueling Control Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Float Test > Page 3926
Refueling Control Valve: Testing and Inspection Valve Test
Valve Test
1. Make sure the fuel tank is less than half full. 2. Remove the fuel fill cap.
3. Remove the fuel hose joint protector. Disconnect the ORVR signal hose.
4. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP control canister, and then plug the port with a plug.
5. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the EVAP control canister vent shut valve, and connect a
vacuum pump to the vacuum hose. 6. Pump the vacuum pump 80 times.
- If the vacuum holds, go to step 7.
- If the vacuum does not hold, go to step 9.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Refueling Vapor Recovery System > Refueling Control Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Float Test > Page 3927
7. Connect a second vacuum pump to the ORVR signal hose. 8. Apply vacuum (1 pump) to the
ORVR signal hose, then check the vacuum on the pump in step 6.
- If the vacuum holds, replace the ORVR vent shut valve.
- If the vacuum is released, the 0RVR vent shut valve is OK.
9. Disconnect the ORVR quick disconnect from the EVAP canister, then plug the port on the
canister. Reapply vacuum (80 pumps).
- If the vacuum holds, replace the ORVR vent shut valve.
- If the vacuum does not hold, inspect the EVAP canister vent shut valve 0-ring. If the O-ring is OK,
replace the EVAP canister and repeat step 4.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Refueling Vapor Recovery System > Refueling Control Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 3928
Refueling Control Valve: Service and Repair
Replacement
1. Remove the fuel tank. 2. Remove the ORVR vent shut valve from the fuel tank.
3. Install parts in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) Control Solenoid <--> [EGR Control Solenoid] > Component Information > Locations
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Control Solenoid: Locations
Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
NOTE: The D16Y8 engine does not come equipped with an EGR valve
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) Control Solenoid <--> [EGR Control Solenoid] > Component Information > Locations > Page 3933
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Control Solenoid: Description and Operation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Control Solenoid Valve*7
When EGR is required for control of oxides of nitrogen (NOx) emissions, the ECM controls the
EGR control solenoid valve which supplies regulated vacuum to the EGR valve.
*7 CVT (D16Y5 engine)
NOTE: The D16Y8 engine does not come equipped with an EGR valve.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor
The fillpipe restrictor is used to prevent leaded fuel from being added to the fuel tank. The gasoline
pump for unleaded fuel has a smaller nozzle. The fillpipe restrictor will only allow the unleaded type
nozzle to be inserted into the fuel tank.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3937
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Remove the fuel filler cap and check the fillpipe restrictor for tampering. On models with more that
one fuel tank, check each tank filler tube.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3942
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. At idle, make sure there is a clicking sound from the PCV valve when the hose between PCV
valve and intake manifold in lightly pinched with
your fingers or pliers. If there is no clicking sound, check the PCV valve grommet for cracks and
damage. If the grommet is OK, replace the PCV valve and recheck.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement
Parts
97-020
MAR 10, 1997
Applies To: ALL Models
New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
New Gauge
The fuel pressure gauge with 10" hose (T/N 07406-0040001) has been discontinued. The gauge
that replaces it (T/N 07406-004000A) has an easier-to-read face, a protective boot around the
gauge housing, and a 48" hose.
Replacement Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts > Page 3948
The replacement hose for the old gauge (24", T/N 07406-004020A) has also been discontinued. If
you need a replacement hose, order the new 48" hose (T/N 07406-004020B). The new hose
comes with an adapter so you can use it with the old fuel pressure gauge (T/N 07406-0040001).
Before connecting the hose to the vehicle, make sure the aluminum washer on the end of the hose
seals properly. If the aluminum washer doesn't seal, replace the washer.
Replacement washers come in a set of five (T/N 07406-0040300).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3949
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose disconnected
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm; 38 - 46 psi)
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose connected
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm; 28 - 36 psi)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3950
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1. Relieve fuel pressure.
2. Remove the service bolt on the fuel filter while holding the banjo bolt with another wrench. Attach
the special tool. 3. Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure with the engine idling and the
vacuum hose of the fuel pressure regulator disconnected from the fuel
pressure regulator and pinched. If the engine will not start, turn the ignition switch ON (II), wait for
two seconds, turn it off, then back on again and read the fuel pressure.
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38 - 46 psi)
4. Reconnect vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm, 28 - 36 psi)
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, first check the fuel pump. If the fuel pump is OK, check the
following: If the fuel pressure is higher than specified, Inspect for: Pinched or clogged fuel return hose or line.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- If the fuel pressure is lower than specified, inspect for: Clogged fuel filter.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- Fuel line leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester
03-016
May 19, 2006
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord -ALL 1996-00 Civic -ALL 1997-01 CR-V - ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL
*1999-04 Odyssey - ALL*
Inspecting Idle Speed With the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic System
(Supersedes 03-016, dated March 25, 2003, to update the information marked by asterisks)
BACKGROUND
The ECM/PCM controls the vehicle's idle speed with the idle air control (IAC) valve. The IAC valve
and the air bleed screw (idle adjusting screw) work together to allow the proper amount of air into
the intake manifold when the throttle valve is closed (the accelerator pedal is released).
The ECM/PCM "learns" to work the IAC valve based on the total amount of air entering the intake
manifold. Air can enter the intake manifold from several sources, including the air bleed screw, but
only the air bleed screw is adjustable. If any changes are made that alter this airflow, specifically
with the air bleed screw, the ECM/PCM must learn new idle parameters.
When the air bleed screw is properly set, the ECM/PCM controls the engine's idle speed
seamlessly. But when the air bleed screw is not properly set, either of these symptoms may be
present:
^ Idle speed dips and then quickly recovers.
^ Engine stalls intermittently when it is just "off-idle." Here are the criteria for this symptom:
- The accelerator pedal is released but the driver's right foot rests over the pedal, causing just
enough pressure for the ECM/PCM to detect an input, yet there is little or no throttle valve opening
(the throttle valve is either not allowing any airflow or it is opened so slightly that more air supply is
needed).
- The engine speed is about 1,250 rpm or less.
- The lockup clutch (A/T models) or the clutch (M/T models) is disengaged.
- All during this time, the driver's foot does not move and stays resting over the accelerator pedal.
- The air bleed screw is not set properly and does not allow enough airflow.
- The amount of "air leakage" into the intake manifold is very low. (The normal amount of air let into
the intake manifold by sources other than the IAC valve, the air bleed screw, and normal operation
of the throttle body can vary slightly from vehicle to vehicle.)
NOTE:
"Air leakage" cannot be easily checked. If the first four criteria are met when the vehicle stalls, you
can assume the last two criteria are met as well.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
L4 Models and 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or Honda Diagnostic
System (HDS) (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE A).
V6 Models except 1999-00 Odyssey: Inspect the idle speed with the PGM Tester or HDS, and
clean out the throttle body if needed (see INSPECTION PROCEDURE B).
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Body Gasket (use only if needed): Refer to the parts catalog.
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 3958
PGM Tester with SN 320
or
Honda Diagnostic System with 1.006.004 or later software
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Carburetor Cleaner:
P/N 08732-0006, H/C 4713673
or
Throttle Plate and Induction Cleaner:
P/N 08732-9009, H/C 6204945
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Inspect Idle Speed (L4 and V6 Models)
Operation Number: 120301
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 07403
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Clean Throttle Body (V6 Models Except 1999-00 Odyssey)
Operation Number: 216001
Flat Rate Time: 0.6 hour
Failed Part: P/N 16400-PAA-A61 H/C 5429006
*Defect Code: 08103
Symptom Code: 08901*
Skill Level: Repair Technician
NOTE:
Warranty claims for these labor operations must be submitted separately. Do not combine them on
the same claim.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE A
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 3959
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey) or
you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of
counterclockwise turns you have made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in
step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then
go to step 9.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 1 (or 7 for '99-00 Odyssey), and you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
10. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE B
1. Access the air bleed screw on the throttle body.
2. Record the current setting of the screw:
^ Turn the screw clockwise, and count the number of turns (both full and partial) it takes to fully
seat the screw.
^ Turn the screw counterclockwise back to its original setting.
^ Subtract the number of clockwise turns it took to seat the screw from 3-1/2. Record that number.
Example: If it took two full turns to seat the screw, subtracting 3-1/2 from that gives you 1-1/2.
3. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature (the cooling fan cycles
twice).
4. Turn off all electrical items (A/C, audio unit, defogger, lights, etc.). Center the steering wheel so
there is no power steering load.
5. Connect the PGM Tester or HDS to the 16P data link connector (DLC).
6. Turn on the PGM Tester or HDS. Enter the VIN and odometer reading.
7. Follow the screen prompts on the PGM Tester or HDS to get to DATA LIST. Scroll down the list
to IAC.
8. While watching the IAC counts on the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw
(either counterclockwise or clockwise) until the IAC count reaches 7 or you have turned the screw
counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns. (Count the number of counterclockwise turns you have
made, and add that number to the screw setting you recorded in step 2.)
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, and you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of
3-1/2 turns, leave the screw set where it is. Go to step 9. You should never set the air bleed screw
counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If you set the screw further it could
work itself out of the throttle body over time.
9. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Remove the throttle body (see the Fuel and Emissions
section of the appropriate service manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Idle Speed Inspection With PGM Tester > Page 3960
10. Open the throttle. Spray carburetor cleaner or throttle plate and induction cleaner into the
throttle body to clean out any contaminants. Make sure you spray the cleaner through the back of
the throttle body not the front, to avoid damaging the IAC valve.
11. Inspect the throttle body gasket, and replace it if needed. Reinstall the throttle body, making
sure all cables are properly adjusted, the accelerator pedal works properly, and all hoses and
cables are correctly routed.
12. Start the engine, and let it warm up to its normal operating temperature. Make sure all electrical
items are turned off and the steering wheel is centered.
13. While watching the PGM Tester or HDS, slowly turn the air bleed screw until the IAC count
reaches 7 or you have turned the screw counterclockwise a total of 3-1/2 turns.
^ If you see an IAC count of 7, turn the screw clockwise 1/2 turn, and then go to step 14.
^ If you do not see an IAC count of 7, leave the screw set at 3-1/2 turns. Go to step 14. You should
never set the air bleed screw counterclockwise more than 3-1/2 turns from its seated position. If
you set the screw further it could work itself out of the throttle body over time.
14. Let the engine idle for 10 minutes to allow the ECM/PCM to learn the new idle parameters.
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0). Turn off and disconnect the PGM Tester or HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Manual Transmission
Idle Speed: Specifications Manual Transmission
Base Idle Speed ..................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. 450 ± 50 rpm
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 670 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With Headlights On Low ......................................................................................................................
............................................................ 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 850 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Manual Transmission > Page 3963
Idle Speed: Specifications Automatic Transmission
Controlled Idle Speed
USA .....................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 700 ± 50 rpm Canada ......................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 750 ± 50 rpm
With fan switch on HI and A/C On .......................................................................................................
............................................................ 810 ± 50 rpm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With A/T
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA: D16Y5 engine with CVT, D16Y7 engine with A/T, D16YS engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: M/T 750 ± 50 rpm A/T 750 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be: M/T 810 ± 50 rpm A/T,CVT 810 ± 50 rpm (in [N] or [P] position)
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 3966
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With CVT
Adjust the idle speed using a Honda PGM Tester if possible. If not, use the following procedure:
NOTE:
- Leave the IAC valve connected.
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
1. Connect a tachometer. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or
neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Check the idle speed with no-load
conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be:
USA:
D16Y5 engine with CVT and D16Y7 engine with A/T and D16Y8 engine with A/T: 700 ± 50 rpm (in
[N] or [P] position)
D16Y7 engine with M/T: 670 ± 50 rpm
Canada:
D16Y8 engine, D16Y7 engine: 750 ± 50 rpm
4. Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw
1/2-turn clockwise or counterclockwise.
5. After turning the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn, check the idle speed again. If it is out of spec, turn
the idle adjusting screw 1/2-turn again.
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw more than 1/2-turn without checking the idle speed.
6. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air conditioner on, then check the
idle speed.
Idle speed should be (all): 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: Do not turn the idle adjusting screw when the air conditioner is on.
- If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 3967
Idle Speed: Testing and Inspection With M/T
NOTE:
- Before setting the idle speed, check the following items: The MIL has not been reported on.
- Ignition timing
- Spark plugs
- Air cleaner
- PCV system
- (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights are off.
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (transmission in neutral) until the
radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Connect a tachometer.
3. Disconnect the IAC valve connector. 4. If the engine stalls, restart the engine with the
accelerator pedal slightly depressed. Stabilize the rpm at 1,000, then slowly release the pedal until
the engine idles.
5. Check idling in no-load conditions: headlights, blower fan, rear defogger, radiator fan, and air
conditioner are not operating.
Idle speed should be: 450 ± 50 rpm
Adjust the idle speed, if necessary, by removing the cap and turning the idle adjusting screw.
NOTE: After adjusting the idle speed in this step, recheck the ignition timing. If it is out of spec, go
back to step 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 7. Reconnect the 2P connector on the IAC valve, then do the ECM
reset procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> System Diagnosis > With A/T > Page 3968
8. Restart and idle the engine with no-load conditions for one minute, then check the idle speed.
NOTE: (Canada) Pull the parking brake lever up. Start the engine, then check that the headlights
are off.
Idle speed should be:
(USA): 670 ± 50 rpm
(Canada): 750 ± 50 rpm
9. Idle the engine for one minute with headlights (Low) ON, and check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 750 ± 50 rpm
10. Turn the headlights off. Idle the engine for one minute with heater fan switch at HI and air
conditioner on, then check the idle speed.
Idle speed should be: 810 ± 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not within specification, see Symptom Chart. See: Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Air Cleaner (ACL)
NOTE: Do not clean the ACL element it with compressed air (except dry type).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3977
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3978
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3979
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3980
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3981
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3982
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3983
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3984
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3985
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3986
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3987
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3988
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3989
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3990
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3991
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3992
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor
The fillpipe restrictor is used to prevent leaded fuel from being added to the fuel tank. The gasoline
pump for unleaded fuel has a smaller nozzle. The fillpipe restrictor will only allow the unleaded type
nozzle to be inserted into the fuel tank.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3996
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Remove the fuel filler cap and check the fillpipe restrictor for tampering. On models with more that
one fuel tank, check each tank filler tube.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
Relieving
Before disconnecting fuel pipes or hoses, release pressure from the system by loosening the 6 mm
service bolt on top of the fuel filter.
WARNING:
- Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames or sparks away from your
work area.
- Be sure to relieve fuel pressure while the ignition switch is off.
1. Write down the frequencies for the radio's preset buttons. 2. Disconnect the battery negative
cable from the battery negative terminal. 3. Remove the fuel fill cap. 4. Use a box end wrench on
the 6 mm service bolt at the fuel filter while holding the special banjo bolt with another wrench. 5.
Place a rag or shop towel over the 6 mm service bolt.
6. Slowly loosen the 6 mm service bolt one complete turn.
NOTE: A fuel pressure gauge can be attached at the 6 mm service bolt hole.
- Always replace the washer between the service bolt and the special banjo bolt whenever the
service bolt is loosened.
- Replace all washers whenever the bolts are removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations
Fuel Injector: Locations
Top Center of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Injector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4006
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4007
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4008
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4009
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4010
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4011
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4012
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4013
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4014
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4015
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4016
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4017
Fuel Injector: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4018
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4019
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4020
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4021
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4022
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
Fuel injector Timing and Duration
The ECM/PCM contains memories for the basic discharge durations at various engine speeds and
manifold air flow rates. The basic discharge duration, after being read out from the memory, is
further modified by signals sent from various sensors to obtain the final discharge duration.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4023
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
Replacement
WARNING: Do not smoke when working on the fuel system. Keep open flames away from your
work area.
1. Relieve the fuel pressure. 2. Disconnect the connectors from the fuel injectors. 3. Disconnect the
vacuum hoses from the fuel pressure regulator. Place a shop towel over the fuel return hose, then
disconnect it from the fuel
pressure regulator. Disconnect the vacuum hoses and 2P connector from the EVAP purge control
solenoid valve.
4. Remove the retainer nuts on the fuel rail. 5. Disconnect the fuel rail. 6. Remove the fuel injectors
from the intake manifold.
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4024
1.6L DOHC VTEC
7. Slide new cushion rings onto the fuel injectors. 8. Coat new O-rings with clean engine oil, and
put them on the fuel injectors. 9. Insert the fuel injectors into the fuel rail first.
10. Coat new seal rings with clean engine oil, and press them into the intake manifold.
11. To prevent damage to the 0-rings, install the fuel injectors in the fuel rail first, then install them
in the intake manifold. 12. Install and tighten the retainer nuts. 13. Connect the vacuum hoses and
fuel return hose to the fuel pressure regulator. Connect the vacuum hoses and 2P connector to the
EVAP purge
control solenoid valve.
14. Install the connectors on the fuel injectors. 15. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), but do not
operate the starter. After the fuel pump runs for approximately two seconds, the fuel pressure in the
fuel line rises. Repeat this two or three times, then check whether there is any fuel leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings <-->
[Fuel Line Coupler] > Component Information > Service Precautions
Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings: Service Precautions
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system Keep open flames away from your
work area.
The fuel tube/quick-connect fittings assembly connects the in-tank fuel pump with the fuel feed
pipe. For removing or installing the fuel pump and fuel tank, it is necessary to disconnect or
connect the quick-connect fittings. Pay attention to following:
- The fuel tube/quick-connect fittings assembly is not heat-resistant; be careful not to damage it
during welding or other heat-generating procedures.
- The fuel tube/quick-connect fittings assembly is not acid-proof; do not touch it with a shop towel
which was used for wiping battery electrolyte. Replace the fuel tube/quick-connect fittings assembly
if it came into contact with electrolyte or something similar.
- When connecting or disconnecting the fuel tube/quick-connect fittings assembly, be careful not to
bend or twist it excessively. Replace it if damaged.
A disconnected quick-connect fitting can be reconnected, but the retainer on the mating pipe
cannot be reused once it has been removed from the pipe. Replace the retainer when
- Replacing the fuel pump.
- Replacing the fuel feed pipe.
- It has been removed from the pipe.
- It is damaged.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings <-->
[Fuel Line Coupler] > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 4028
Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings: Service and Repair
Disconnection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames away from your
work area.
1. Relieve fuel pressure. 2. Check the fuel quick-connect fittings for dirt, and clean if necessary.
3. Hold the connector with one hand and press down the retainer tabs with the other hand, then
pull the connector off.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the pipe or other parts. Do not use tools.
- If the connector does not move, keep the retainer tabs pressed down, and alternately pull and
push the connector until it comes off easily.
- Do not remove the retainer from the pipe; once removed, the retainer must be replaced with a
new one.
4. Check the contact area of the pipe for dirt and damage.
- If the surface is dirty, clean it.
- If the surface is rusty or damaged, replace the fuel pump or fuel feed pipe.
5. To prevent damage and keep out foreign matter, cover the disconnected connector and pipe end
with plastic bags.
Connection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flames away from your
work area.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings <-->
[Fuel Line Coupler] > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 4029
1. Check the pipe contact area for dirt and damage, and clean if necessary.
2. Insert a new retainer into the connector if the retainer is damaged, or after
- replacing the fuel pump.
- replacing the fuel feed pipe.
- removing the retainer from the pipe.
Before connecting a new fuel tube/quick-connect fitting assembly, remove the old retainer from the
mating pipe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Quick-Connect Fittings <-->
[Fuel Line Coupler] > Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 4030
3. Align the quick-connect fittings with the pipe, and align the retainer locking pawls with the
connector grooves. Then press the quick-connect
fittings onto the pipe until both retainer pawls lock with a clicking sound.
NOTE: If it is hard to connect, put a small amount of new engine oil on the pipe end.
4. Make sure the connection is secure and the pawls are firmly locked into place; check visually
and by pulling the connector. 5. Reconnect the battery negative cable, and turn the ignition switch
ON (II). The fuel pump will run for about two seconds, and fuel pressure will
rise. Repeat two or three times, and check that there is no leakage in the fuel supply system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4035
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4036
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4037
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4038
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4039
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4040
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4041
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4042
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4043
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4044
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4045
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4046
Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4047
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4048
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4049
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Control Solenoid >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4050
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4054
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Testing and Inspection
Testing
WARNING: Do not smoke during the test. Keep open flames away from your work area.
1. Attach the special tool(s) to the service port on the fuel filter.
Pressure should be: Except 1.6L DOHC VTEC : 260-310 kPa (2.7-3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38-46 psi)
1.6L DOHC VTEC : 270-320 kPa (2.8-3.3 kg/Sq.cm, 40-47 psi)
(with the fuel pressure regulator vacuum hose disconnected and pinched)
2. Reconnect the vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator. 3. Check that the fuel pressure rises
when the vacuum hose from the fuel pressure regulator is disconnected again.
If the fuel pressure did not rise, replace the fuel pressure regulator.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4055
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
Replacement
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
1. Place a shop towel under the fuel pressure regulator, then relieve fuel pressure. 2. Disconnect
the vacuum hose and fuel return hose.
3. Remove the two 6 mm retainer bolts and the fuel pressure regulator. 4. Apply clean engine oil to
a new O-ring, and carefully install it into its proper position. 5. Install the fuel pressure regulator in
the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement
Parts
97-020
MAR 10, 1997
Applies To: ALL Models
New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts
New Gauge
The fuel pressure gauge with 10" hose (T/N 07406-0040001) has been discontinued. The gauge
that replaces it (T/N 07406-004000A) has an easier-to-read face, a protective boot around the
gauge housing, and a 48" hose.
Replacement Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - New Fuel Pressure Gauge and Replacement Parts > Page 4061
The replacement hose for the old gauge (24", T/N 07406-004020A) has also been discontinued. If
you need a replacement hose, order the new 48" hose (T/N 07406-004020B). The new hose
comes with an adapter so you can use it with the old fuel pressure gauge (T/N 07406-0040001).
Before connecting the hose to the vehicle, make sure the aluminum washer on the end of the hose
seals properly. If the aluminum washer doesn't seal, replace the washer.
Replacement washers come in a set of five (T/N 07406-0040300).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4062
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose disconnected
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm; 38 - 46 psi)
Condition: engine idling, regulator vacuum hose connected
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm; 28 - 36 psi)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4063
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1. Relieve fuel pressure.
2. Remove the service bolt on the fuel filter while holding the banjo bolt with another wrench. Attach
the special tool. 3. Start the engine. Measure the fuel pressure with the engine idling and the
vacuum hose of the fuel pressure regulator disconnected from the fuel
pressure regulator and pinched. If the engine will not start, turn the ignition switch ON (II), wait for
two seconds, turn it off, then back on again and read the fuel pressure.
Pressure should be: 260 - 310 kPa (2.7 - 3.2 kg/Sq.cm, 38 - 46 psi)
4. Reconnect vacuum hose to the fuel pressure regulator.
Pressure should be: 200 - 250 kPa (2.0 - 2.5 kg/Sq.cm, 28 - 36 psi)
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, first check the fuel pump. If the fuel pump is OK, check the
following: If the fuel pressure is higher than specified, Inspect for: Pinched or clogged fuel return hose or line.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- If the fuel pressure is lower than specified, inspect for: Clogged fuel filter.
- Faulty fuel pressure regulator.
- Fuel line leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4068
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4069
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4070
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4071
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4072
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4074
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4075
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4076
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4077
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4078
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4079
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4080
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4081
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4082
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4083
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4084
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE AND OPERATION
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON, and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4085
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4086
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4087
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4091
Fuel Return Line: Diagrams
NOTE: Check all hose clamps and retighten if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4092
Fuel Return Line: Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4093
Fuel Lines
Check fuel system lines, hoses, fuel filter, and other components for damage, leaks and
deterioration, and replace if necessary.
NOTE: Check all hose clamps and retighten if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Line: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4099
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4100
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4101
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4102
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4103
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4104
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4105
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4106
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4107
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4108
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4109
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4110
Fuel Line: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4111
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4112
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4113
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4114
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4115
Fuel Line: Exploded Views
NOTE: Check all hose clamps and retighten if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4116
Fuel Line: Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line <--> [Fuel Supply Line] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4117
Fuel Lines
Check fuel system lines, hoses, fuel filter, and other components for damage, leaks and
deterioration, and replace if necessary.
NOTE: Check all hose clamps and retighten if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Neck >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Float Position E 1/2 F
USA,Canada Produced (ceramic Board Type) 105 - 108 ohms 29.5 - 35.5 ohms 3.5 - 5 ohms
Japan Produced (wire -Wound Type) 105 - 110 ohms 29.5 - 39.5 ohms 2 - 5 ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4125
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4126
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
NOTE: Refer to fuel gauge system circuit.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fusel relay box before testing.
2. Remove the access panel from the floor. 3. Disconnect the 3P connector from the fuel gauge
sending unit. 4. Connect the voltmeter positive probe to the No.2 terminal and the negative probe
to the No.1 terminal, then turn the ignition switch ON (II). There
should be between 5 and 8 V. If the voltage is as specified, go to step 5.
- If the voltage is not as specified, check for: an open in the YEL/BLK or BLK wire.
- poor ground (G552).
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 6. Attach a jumper wire between the No.1 and No.2 terminals, then
turn the ignition switch ON (II). 7. Check that the pointer of the fuel gauge starts moving toward the
"F" mark.
CAUTION: Turn the ignition switch OFF before the pointer reaches "F" on the gauge dial. Failure to
do so may damage the fuel gauge.
NOTE: The fuel gauge is a bobbin (cross-coil) type, hence the fuel level is continuously indicated
even when the ignition switch is OFF, and the pointer moves more slowly than that of a bimetal
type.
- If the pointer of the fuel gauge does not move at all, replace the gauge.
- If the gauge is OK, inspect the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4127
8. Remove the fuel gauge sending unit as shown.
9. Measure the resistance between the No.1 and No.2 terminals at E (EMPTY), 1/2 (HALF FULL)
and F (FULL) by moving the float.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4128
If the resistance readings are beyond the range, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Gauge Sending Unit <-->
[Fuel Tank Unit] > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Gauge Sending Unit: Locations
Below Center of Rear Seat
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Idle Speed Control (Linkage): Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4136
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4137
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4138
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4139
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4140
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4141
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4142
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4143
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4144
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4145
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4146
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4147
Idle Speed Control (Linkage): Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4148
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4149
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4150
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed Control (Linkage) >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4151
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 3.5 Nm (2.5 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4155
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4158
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4159
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4160
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4161
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4162
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4163
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4164
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4165
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4166
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4167
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4168
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4169
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4170
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4171
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4172
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4173
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4174
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control
Idle Air Control Valve (IAC Valve) When the engine is cold, the A/C compressor is on, the
transmission is in gear, the brake pedal is depressed, the P/S load is high, or the alternator Is
charging, the ECM/PCM controls current to the IAC Valve to maintain the correct idle speed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 4179
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4182
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4183
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4184
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4185
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4186
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4187
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4188
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4189
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4190
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4191
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4192
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4193
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4194
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4195
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4196
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4197
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4198
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4199
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4200
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4201
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main
Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4202
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4208
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4209
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4210
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4211
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4212
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4213
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4214
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4215
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4216
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4217
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4218
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4219
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4220
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4221
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4222
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4223
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4224
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE AND OPERATION
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON, and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4225
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4226
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4227
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Locations > PGM-FI Mail Relay > Page 4232
PGM-FI Main Relay: Locations Main Relay (PGM-FI)
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4235
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4236
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4237
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4238
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4239
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4240
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4241
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4242
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4243
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4244
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4245
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4246
PGM-FI Main Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4247
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4248
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4249
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4250
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4251
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4252
PGM-FI Main Relay: Description and Operation
Description
The PGM-FI main relay actually contains two individual relays. This relay is located at the right side
of the cowl. One relay is energized whenever the ignition is on which supplies the battery voltage to
the ECM/PCM, power to the fuel injectors, and power for the second relay. The second relay is
energized for two seconds when the ignition is switched ON (II), and when the engine is running, to
supply power to the fuel pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4253
PGM-FI Main Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Testing
NOTE:
- If the engine starts and continues to run, the PGM-FI main relay is OK.
- Use the terminal numbers below; ignore the terminal numbers molded into the relay.
1. Remove the PGM-FI main relay.
2. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.2 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check for continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. If there is continuity, go on to step 3.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
3. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.5 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.3 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.7 terminal and No.6 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. -
If there is continuity, go on to step 4.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
4. Attach the battery positive terminal to the No.6 terminal and the battery negative terminal to the
No.1 terminal of the PGM-FI main relay. Then
check that there is continuity between the No.5 terminal and No.4 terminal of the PGM-FI main
relay. If there is continuity, the PGM-FI main relay is OK. If the fuel pump still does not work, go to
Harness Testing.
- If there is no continuity, replace the PGM-FI main relay and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4254
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > PGM-FI Main Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4255
Part 2 Of 2
Troubleshooting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4261
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4262
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4263
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4264
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4265
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4266
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4267
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4268
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4269
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4270
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4271
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4272
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4273
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4274
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4275
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4276
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4281
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4282
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4283
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4284
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4285
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4286
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4287
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4288
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4289
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4290
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4291
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4292
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4293
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4294
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4295
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4296
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4300
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications
Throttle Body: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 22 Nm (16 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4304
Throttle Body: Description and Operation
Description
The throttle body is either a single-barrel side-draft type (D16Y5, D16Y8, B16A2 engine) or a
down-draft type (D16Y7 engine). The lower portion of the throttle valve is heated by engine coolant
from the cylinder head. The idle adjusting screw which regulates the bypass air is located on the
top of the throttle body.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4305
Throttle Body: Testing and Inspection
Inspection
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
1.6L DOHC VTEC
1. Check that the throttle cable operates smoothly without binding or sticking.
If there are any abnormalities, check for. Excessive wear or play in the throttle valve shaft.
- Sticky or binding throttle lever at the fully closed position.
- Clearance between throttle stop screw and throttle lever at the fully closed position.
Replace the throttle body if there is excessive play in the throttle valve shaft or if the shaft is binding
or sticking.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Removal
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L DOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
NOTE:
- Do not adjust the throttle stop screw.
- After reassembly, adjust the throttle cable.
- The TP sensor is not removable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4308
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Disassembly
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4309
1.6L DOHC VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA99I002000 > May > 99 > Recall
99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: Recalls Recall 99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
This is not a safety defect in accordance with the Safety Act. However, it is deemed a safety
improvement campaign by the agency.
Vehicle Description: Passenger vehicles. The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you
press it.
It may feel like the car is not responding properly when traveling at low speeds and are required to
move the accelerator pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
Dealers will replace the throttle cable. Honda has decided to conduct a Product Improvement
Campaign to replace the throttle cable. Owners can contact Honda at 1-800-999-1009.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: Recalls Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement
99-047
May 24, 1999
Applies To: 1996 Civic - ALL
Product Update: Civic Throttle Cable
(Supersedes 96-029, Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal, dated June 10, 1996)
*BACKGROUND
The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you press it.
VEHICLES AFFECTED 2-door:
DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL069407 HX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...TL071119 EX - Thru VIN
1HGEJ8...TL070668
3-door: CX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH122085 DX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH121933
4-door: DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL051812
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544896
LX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL053313
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544755
EX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...TL050609
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...TH544644
CORRECTIVE ACTION Determine the lot number/production date of the throttle cable and, if
necessary, replace the cable.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION All owners of affected vehicles will be mailed a notification of this
campaign. An example of the customer notification is at the end of this service bulletin.*
PARTS INFORMATION Throttle Cable: LX - P/N 17910-501 -C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195 EX, HX - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
*Defect code: 338
Contention code: K62
Skill level: Repair Technician*
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4322
*1. Locate and write down the throttle cable production lot number stamped on the cable.
2. Does the lot number end in A?
YES - Continue to step 3.
NO - This vehicle is not affected. Center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the customer.
3. The fifth character (A0-S01 -ExxxA) is the production year code, E for 1995 and F for 1996.
^ If the cable was produced in 1995 (E), go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the cable was produced in 1996 (F), continue to step 4.
4. The three digits following the year are the date code for the date of production, 001 through 365.
^ If the date code is from 001 through 162, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the date code is 163 or greater, continue to step 5.
5. Check the operation of the accelerator pedal.
^ If the accelerator pedal does not move smoothly, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the accelerator pedal moves smoothly, center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the
customer.*
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4323
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4324
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4325
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > 99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4326
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
*9. Center-punch a completion mark above the first character of the engine compartment VIN.*
Example of Customer Letter
*May 1999
Product Update Campaign: Civic Throttle Cable
Dear Civic Owner:
We are sending this letter because we are interested in your satisfaction with your Civic. The
throttle cable may cause the accelerator pedal to begin to feel rough or notchy when you press on
it. Although this does not affect the operation of the throttle, it may feel like the car is not
responding properly when you are traveling at low speeds and are required to move the accelerator
pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
What is the Update?
An improved throttle cable is available that eliminates this rough or notchy feeling.
What should you do?
Call your local Honda dealer and make an appointment to have the car's throttle cable inspected
and, if necessary, replaced. This work will be done free of charge. If your car has the original
throttle cable, the dealer will replace it. If you had the throttle cable replaced under warranty, the
improved part may already have been installed. The dealer will inspect the cable and, if it is not the
improved part, replace it with the improved cable.
What to do if our information is incorrect.
This notice was mailed to you according to the latest information we have. If you no longer own this
car, or some information in this notice is incorrect, please fill out and return the included,
postage-paid Information Change Card.
If you have questions.
If you need assistance with locating a Honda dealer, or you have questions about this notice,
please call the Honda Consumer Affairs Office at (800) 999-1009.
Thank you for your cooperation. We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause you.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Throttle Cable: Customer Interest Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Bulletin No. 96-029
Issue Date JUNE 10, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under ENGINE
Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal
SYMPTOM
The accelerator pedal feels rough when you press it. Throttle body operation is not affected.
Many customers may think this problem is low-speed driveability and may not complain. Whenever
a vehicle within the affected VIN range comes in for service, inspect the throttle for smooth
operation.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The throttle cable.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the throttle cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4332
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4333
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4334
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4335
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Cable
LX - P/N 17910-S01-C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195
EX, HX: - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 216103
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
Defect code: 030
B99
Template ID: LX - 96-029A
CX, DX - 96-029B EX, HX - 96-029C
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement
99-047
May 24, 1999
Applies To: 1996 Civic - ALL
Product Update: Civic Throttle Cable
(Supersedes 96-029, Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal, dated June 10, 1996)
*BACKGROUND
The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you press it.
VEHICLES AFFECTED 2-door:
DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL069407 HX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...TL071119 EX - Thru VIN
1HGEJ8...TL070668
3-door: CX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH122085 DX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH121933
4-door: DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL051812
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544896
LX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL053313
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544755
EX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...TL050609
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...TH544644
CORRECTIVE ACTION Determine the lot number/production date of the throttle cable and, if
necessary, replace the cable.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION All owners of affected vehicles will be mailed a notification of this
campaign. An example of the customer notification is at the end of this service bulletin.*
PARTS INFORMATION Throttle Cable: LX - P/N 17910-501 -C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195 EX, HX - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
*Defect code: 338
Contention code: K62
Skill level: Repair Technician*
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4341
*1. Locate and write down the throttle cable production lot number stamped on the cable.
2. Does the lot number end in A?
YES - Continue to step 3.
NO - This vehicle is not affected. Center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the customer.
3. The fifth character (A0-S01 -ExxxA) is the production year code, E for 1995 and F for 1996.
^ If the cable was produced in 1995 (E), go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the cable was produced in 1996 (F), continue to step 4.
4. The three digits following the year are the date code for the date of production, 001 through 365.
^ If the date code is from 001 through 162, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the date code is 163 or greater, continue to step 5.
5. Check the operation of the accelerator pedal.
^ If the accelerator pedal does not move smoothly, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the accelerator pedal moves smoothly, center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the
customer.*
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4342
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4343
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4344
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4345
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
*9. Center-punch a completion mark above the first character of the engine compartment VIN.*
Example of Customer Letter
*May 1999
Product Update Campaign: Civic Throttle Cable
Dear Civic Owner:
We are sending this letter because we are interested in your satisfaction with your Civic. The
throttle cable may cause the accelerator pedal to begin to feel rough or notchy when you press on
it. Although this does not affect the operation of the throttle, it may feel like the car is not
responding properly when you are traveling at low speeds and are required to move the accelerator
pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
What is the Update?
An improved throttle cable is available that eliminates this rough or notchy feeling.
What should you do?
Call your local Honda dealer and make an appointment to have the car's throttle cable inspected
and, if necessary, replaced. This work will be done free of charge. If your car has the original
throttle cable, the dealer will replace it. If you had the throttle cable replaced under warranty, the
improved part may already have been installed. The dealer will inspect the cable and, if it is not the
improved part, replace it with the improved cable.
What to do if our information is incorrect.
This notice was mailed to you according to the latest information we have. If you no longer own this
car, or some information in this notice is incorrect, please fill out and return the included,
postage-paid Information Change Card.
If you have questions.
If you need assistance with locating a Honda dealer, or you have questions about this notice,
please call the Honda Consumer Affairs Office at (800) 999-1009.
Thank you for your cooperation. We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause you.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
NHTSA99I002000 > May > 99 > Recall 99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
This is not a safety defect in accordance with the Safety Act. However, it is deemed a safety
improvement campaign by the agency.
Vehicle Description: Passenger vehicles. The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you
press it.
It may feel like the car is not responding properly when traveling at low speeds and are required to
move the accelerator pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
Dealers will replace the throttle cable. Honda has decided to conduct a Product Improvement
Campaign to replace the throttle cable. Owners can contact Honda at 1-800-999-1009.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Bulletin No. 96-029
Issue Date JUNE 10, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under ENGINE
Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal
SYMPTOM
The accelerator pedal feels rough when you press it. Throttle body operation is not affected.
Many customers may think this problem is low-speed driveability and may not complain. Whenever
a vehicle within the affected VIN range comes in for service, inspect the throttle for smooth
operation.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The throttle cable.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the throttle cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4354
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4355
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4356
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4357
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Cable
LX - P/N 17910-S01-C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195
EX, HX: - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 216103
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
Defect code: 030
B99
Template ID: LX - 96-029A
CX, DX - 96-029B EX, HX - 96-029C
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough
Bulletin No. 96-029
Issue Date JUNE 10, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under ENGINE
Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal
SYMPTOM
The accelerator pedal feels rough when you press it. Throttle body operation is not affected.
Many customers may think this problem is low-speed driveability and may not complain. Whenever
a vehicle within the affected VIN range comes in for service, inspect the throttle for smooth
operation.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The throttle cable.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the throttle cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4363
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4364
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4365
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
96029 > Jun > 96 > Engine - Accelerator Pedal Feels Rough > Page 4366
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
PARTS INFORMATION
Throttle Cable
LX - P/N 17910-S01-C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195
EX, HX: - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 216103
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
Defect code: 030
B99
Template ID: LX - 96-029A
CX, DX - 96-029B EX, HX - 96-029C
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement
99-047
May 24, 1999
Applies To: 1996 Civic - ALL
Product Update: Civic Throttle Cable
(Supersedes 96-029, Rough Feel When Pressing the Accelerator Pedal, dated June 10, 1996)
*BACKGROUND
The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you press it.
VEHICLES AFFECTED 2-door:
DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL069407 HX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...TL071119 EX - Thru VIN
1HGEJ8...TL070668
3-door: CX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH122085 DX - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH121933
4-door: DX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL051812
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544896
LX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...TL053313
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH544755
EX - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...TL050609
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...TH544644
CORRECTIVE ACTION Determine the lot number/production date of the throttle cable and, if
necessary, replace the cable.
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION All owners of affected vehicles will be mailed a notification of this
campaign. An example of the customer notification is at the end of this service bulletin.*
PARTS INFORMATION Throttle Cable: LX - P/N 17910-501 -C03, H/C 5041157
CX, DX - P/N 17910-S01-G03, H/C 5038195 EX, HX - P/N 17910-S01-A02, H/C 5038138
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Failed part: P/N 17910-S01-A01 H/C 4810370
*Defect code: 338
Contention code: K62
Skill level: Repair Technician*
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4372
*1. Locate and write down the throttle cable production lot number stamped on the cable.
2. Does the lot number end in A?
YES - Continue to step 3.
NO - This vehicle is not affected. Center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the customer.
3. The fifth character (A0-S01 -ExxxA) is the production year code, E for 1995 and F for 1996.
^ If the cable was produced in 1995 (E), go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the cable was produced in 1996 (F), continue to step 4.
4. The three digits following the year are the date code for the date of production, 001 through 365.
^ If the date code is from 001 through 162, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the date code is 163 or greater, continue to step 5.
5. Check the operation of the accelerator pedal.
^ If the accelerator pedal does not move smoothly, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If the accelerator pedal moves smoothly, center-punch the VIN and return the vehicle to the
customer.*
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4373
1. Loosen the throttle cable locknut, and remove the cable from the bracket. Detach the inner cable
from the throttle link.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4374
2. Remove the cable from the guide brackets, then twist and pull the throttle cable grommet out of
the bulkhead.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4375
3. Under the dash, detach the inner cable end from the accelerator pedal bracket. Discard the old
throttle cable.
4. From the engine compartment, feed a new throttle cable (see PARTS INFORMATION) through
the bulkhead, then push and twist the grommet into place. Install the cable in its guide brackets.
5. Attach the inner cable end to the accelerator pedal.
6. Open the throttle valve fully, then attach the inner cable to the throttle link, and install the cable in
the bracket without tightening the locknut.
7. Turn the adjusting nut until you have 10 to 12 mm of cable deflection, then tighten the locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
99-047 > May > 99 > Campaign - Throttle Cable Replacement > Page 4376
8. Check the accelerator pedal; it should feel smooth when you operate it, and it should open the
throttle valve fully when you press it to the floor.
*9. Center-punch a completion mark above the first character of the engine compartment VIN.*
Example of Customer Letter
*May 1999
Product Update Campaign: Civic Throttle Cable
Dear Civic Owner:
We are sending this letter because we are interested in your satisfaction with your Civic. The
throttle cable may cause the accelerator pedal to begin to feel rough or notchy when you press on
it. Although this does not affect the operation of the throttle, it may feel like the car is not
responding properly when you are traveling at low speeds and are required to move the accelerator
pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
What is the Update?
An improved throttle cable is available that eliminates this rough or notchy feeling.
What should you do?
Call your local Honda dealer and make an appointment to have the car's throttle cable inspected
and, if necessary, replaced. This work will be done free of charge. If your car has the original
throttle cable, the dealer will replace it. If you had the throttle cable replaced under warranty, the
improved part may already have been installed. The dealer will inspect the cable and, if it is not the
improved part, replace it with the improved cable.
What to do if our information is incorrect.
This notice was mailed to you according to the latest information we have. If you no longer own this
car, or some information in this notice is incorrect, please fill out and return the included,
postage-paid Information Change Card.
If you have questions.
If you need assistance with locating a Honda dealer, or you have questions about this notice,
please call the Honda Consumer Affairs Office at (800) 999-1009.
Thank you for your cooperation. We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause you.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Cable: >
NHTSA99I002000 > May > 99 > Recall 99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
Throttle Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 99I002000: Throttle Cable Replacement
This is not a safety defect in accordance with the Safety Act. However, it is deemed a safety
improvement campaign by the agency.
Vehicle Description: Passenger vehicles. The accelerator pedal feels rough or notchy when you
press it.
It may feel like the car is not responding properly when traveling at low speeds and are required to
move the accelerator pedal to make slight speed adjustments.
Dealers will replace the throttle cable. Honda has decided to conduct a Product Improvement
Campaign to replace the throttle cable. Owners can contact Honda at 1-800-999-1009.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4381
Throttle Cable: Specifications
Throttle Cable Deflection
..........................................................................................................................................................
10 - 12 mm (0.39 - 0.47 in.)
Adjusting Lock Nut ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 9.8 Nm (7.2 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4382
Throttle Cable: Testing and Inspection
Inspection/Adjustment
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator
fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Check that the throttle cable operates smoothly with no binding or
sticking. Repair as necessary.
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
1.6L DOHC VTEC
3. Check cable free play at the throttle linkage. Cable deflection should be 10-12 mm (3/8-1/2 in.).
4. If deflection is not within specs, loosen the locknut, turn the adjusting nut until the deflection is as
specified, then retighten the locknut. 5. With the cable properly adjusted, check the throttle valve to
be sure it opens fully when you push the accelerator pedal to the floor. Also check the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4383
throttle valve to be sure it returns to the idle position whenever you release the accelerator pedal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4384
Throttle Cable: Adjustments
Inspection/Adjustment
1. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (in Park or neutral) until the radiator
fan comes on, then let it idle. 2. Check that the throttle cable operates smoothly with no binding or
sticking. Repair as necessary.
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
1.6L DOHC VTEC
3. Check cable free play at the throttle linkage. Cable deflection should be 10-12 mm (3/8-1/2 in.).
4. If deflection is not within specs, loosen the locknut, turn the adjusting nut until the deflection is as
specified, then retighten the locknut. 5. With the cable properly adjusted, check the throttle valve to
be sure it opens fully when you push the accelerator pedal to the floor. Also check the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4385
throttle valve to be sure it returns to the idle position whenever you release the accelerator pedal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4386
Throttle Cable: Service and Repair
Installation
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC, 1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC:
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
1. Open the throttle valve fully, then install the throttle cable in the throttle linkage, and install the
cable housing in the cable bracket. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load
(in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Hold the cable sheath,
removing all slack from the cable. 4. Set the locknut on the cable bracket. Adjust the adjusting nut
so that its free play is 0 mm.
1.6L SOHC VTEC-E, 1.6L SOHC VTEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable <--> [Throttle
Cable/Linkage] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4387
1.6L SOHC Non-VTEC
5. Remove the cable sheath from the throttle bracket, reset the adjusting nut and tighten the
locknut.
1.6L DOHC VTEC:
1. Open the throttle valve fully, then install the throttle cable in the throttle linkage, and install the
cable housing in the cable bracket. 2. Start the engine. Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load
(in Park or neutral) until the radiator fan comes on, then let it idle. 3. Hold the throttle link to the
throttle lever; there should be no clearance. 4. Hold the cable sheath, removing all slack from the
cable.
5. Turn the adjusting nut until it is 3 mm (1/8 in.) away from the cable bracket. 6. Tighten the
locknut. The cable deflection should now be 10 - 12 mm (3/8 - 1/2 in.). If not, see
Inspection/Adjustment.
See: Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4392
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4393
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4394
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4395
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4396
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4397
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4398
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4399
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4400
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4401
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4402
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4403
Throttle Full Open Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4404
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4405
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4406
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Full Open Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4407
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Throttle Position Sensor: Locations
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1 / Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Rear of D16Y8 Engine
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - 1.2 / Top of D16Y7 Engine
Top of D16Y7 Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4411
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The TP Sensor is a potentiometer. It is connected to the throttle valve shaft. As the throttle position
changes, the throttle position sensor varies the voltage signal to the ECM/PCM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators >
System Information > Locations
Ignition Timing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4426
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4435
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4436
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4437
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
Distributor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping
05-027
September 19, 2008
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic DX, LX, EX - ALL
MIL Is On With DTC P0420 or Engine Ping Under Load
(Supersedes 05-027, dated May 20, 2008, to update the information marked by black bars and
shown with asterisks.)
SYMPTOM
MIL is on with DTC P0420 (catalyst system efficiency below threshold) or the engine pings under
load. DTC P0301 (No. 1 cylinder misfire detected), P0302 (No. 2 cylinder misfire detected), P0303
(No. 3 cylinder misfire detected), or P0304 (No. 4 cylinder misfire detected), may also be set.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Poor connections at the igniter terminals.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Crimp the wires from the distributor subassembly, and install a new catalytic converter if code
P0420 is stored in the PCM/ECM.
PARTS INFORMATION
TOOL INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4443
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 30130-P06-006 H/C 4317988
Defect Code: 06401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a
decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the distributor assembly from the vehicle:
^ Refer to 1996-2000 Civic Service Manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword DISTRIBUTOR, and select Distributor Replacement from the list.
2. Remove the distributor cap, the rotor, and the cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4444
3. Use a diagonal cutter to cut away the side of the terminal boot as shown, and slide the boot
down the wire.
NOTE:
Steps 4 thru 5 are done for each terminal shown, one at a time. Use caution not to twist or bend the
terminals during removal. If you damage the terminals or the distributor, replace the distributor
subassembly.
4. Center the terminal in the opening of the crimping tool, and carefully crimp the terminal by
closing the tool completely.
5. Slide the boot back down over the terminal. The open end will not cause a problem.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for the other two terminals.
7. Reinstall the terminals. When reinstalling a terminal, do not insert it at an angle or wiggle it from
side to side. This can spread the terminal and cause a poor contact.
8. Reassemble the distributor, install a new O-ring, and install it in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Distributor: > 05-027 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0420/Engine Ping > Page 4445
If the terminals or wires are damaged, replace the distributor housing with the appropriate part
listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
9. Replace the catalytic converter if code P0420 was stored in the PCM/ECM.
^ See section 9 of the service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword EXHAUST, and select Exhaust Manifold Removal and Installation from the
list.
10. Start the vehicle. Check the ignition timing, and adjust it if necessary.
11. If the MIL was on, clear the code with the HDS.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4446
Distributor: Locations
Right Side of D16Y8 Engine (Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Diagrams > Exploded Views
Distributor: Exploded Views
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Diagrams > Exploded Views > Page 4449
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4450
Distributor: Service and Repair
Removal:
1. Disconnect the connector from the distributor. 2. Disconnect the ignition wires from the
distributor ignition (DI) cap.
3. Remove the mounting bolts from the distributor, then remove the distributor from the cylinder
head.
Installation:
NOTE: Before you install the distributor, bring the No.1 piston to compression stroke TDC.
1. Coat a new O-ring with engine oil, then install it. 2. Slip the distributor into position.
NOTE: The lug on the end of the distributor and its mating grooves in the camshaft end are both
offset to eliminate the possibility of installing the distributor 180° out of time.
3. Install the mounting bolts, and tighten them lightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Distributor, Ignition > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4451
4. Connect the ignition wires to the distributor ignition (DI) cap as shown. 5. Connect the connector
to the distributor. 6. Set the ignition timing. 7. After setting the ignition timing, tighten the mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Hall Effect Sensor, Ignition > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Cable: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4460
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4461
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4462
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4463
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4464
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4465
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4466
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4467
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4468
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4469
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4470
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4471
Ignition Cable: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4472
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4473
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4474
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4475
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Cable > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4476
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Carefully remove the ignition wires by pulling on the rubber boots. Do not bend the
wires; you might break them inside.
1. Check the condition of the ignition wire terminals. If any terminal is corroded, clean it, and if it is
broken or distorted, replace the ignition wire.
2. Connect ohmmeter probes and measure resistance. 3. If resistance exceeds 25 K Ohm, replace
the ignition wire.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Coil: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips > Page 4481
Ignition Coil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - DTC P1381 Set
SOURCE: Honda Service News July 2004
TITLE: DTC P1381 Set? Check the Ignition Coil Shield.
APPLIES TO: 1998-02 Accord L4 or 1996-00 Civic
SERVICE TIP: Troubleshooting a DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent interruption)? If you can't
find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M, then remove the
distributor cap, and make sure the coil shield is in place and it's correctly installed as shown. If the
coil shield installation looks OK, then the ignition coil is the probably faulty and should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4482
Ignition Coil: Specifications
HITACHI
TEC
NOTE: Resistance will vary with the coil temperature; specifications are at 68°F (20°C).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Coil: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4485
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4486
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4487
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4488
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4489
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4490
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4491
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4492
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4493
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4494
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4495
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4496
Ignition Coil: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4497
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4498
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4499
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4500
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4501
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
Ignition Coil Schematic Diagram
PURPOSE
The Ignition Coil transforms battery voltage into ignition voltage and delivers it in the form of a high
voltage surge to the secondary ignition components.
OPERATION
The ignition coil (located in the distributor) uses the principle of mutual induction to step up battery
(low) voltage to ignition (high) voltage. The ignition coil contains two sets of copper wire windings
around a soft iron core. The primary winding is made of a hundred or so turns of a heavy gage
wire. It is connected to the battery through the ignition switch (+) and to the ignition control module
(ignitor) (-) so that current flows through it, thus creating a magnetic field. The secondary winding is
connected to the coil output tower through the iron core. It contains several thousand turns of wire
wound directly onto the iron core. The ratio of the number of wraps in the secondary winding to the
number of wraps in the primary windings determines the output voltage of the coil. The ratio is
approx. 1 to 110. When current flow in the primary winding is stopped (by the ignitor breaking the
circuit ground), the collapse of the magnetic field causes a high voltage (20,000 volts or more) to
be induced in the secondary windings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4502
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection
HITACHI
TEC
Using an ohmmeter, measure resistance between the terminals. If the resistance is not within
specifications, replace the ignition coil.
NOTE: Resistance will vary with the coil temperature; specifications are at 68°F (20°C).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4507
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4508
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4509
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4510
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4511
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4512
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4513
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4514
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4515
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4516
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4517
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4518
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4519
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4520
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4521
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4522
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 4523
Ignition Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- See Malfunction Indicator Lamp when the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is turned ON.
- Perform the following input test for the ignition control module (ICM) after finishing the
fundamental tests for the ignition system and the fuel and emissions systems.
INPUT TEST FOR THE IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM)
1. Remove the distributor ignition (DI) cap, the distributor ignition (DI) rotor and the leak cover
(TEC).
2. Disconnect the wires from the ICM. 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage
between the BLK/YEL wire and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check the BLK/YEL wire between the under-dash fuse/relay box and
the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage between the wire*1 and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check: the ignition coil.
- the wire*1 between the ignition coil and the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 5.
*1: BLU2 wire (HITACHI)
WHT/BLU wire (TEC)
5. Disconnect the ECM/PCM connector A (32P). Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire
between the ECM/PCM and the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 4524
- There should be continuity.
6. Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
7. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire between the test tachometer connector and the ICM.
- There should be continuity.
8. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
9. If all the tests are normal, replace the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4533
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4534
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4535
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4536
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4537
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4538
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4539
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4540
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4541
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4542
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4543
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4544
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4545
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4546
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4547
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4548
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4549
Ignition Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- See Malfunction Indicator Lamp when the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is turned ON.
- Perform the following input test for the ignition control module (ICM) after finishing the
fundamental tests for the ignition system and the fuel and emissions systems.
INPUT TEST FOR THE IGNITION CONTROL MODULE (ICM)
1. Remove the distributor ignition (DI) cap, the distributor ignition (DI) rotor and the leak cover
(TEC).
2. Disconnect the wires from the ICM. 3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage
between the BLK/YEL wire and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check the BLK/YEL wire between the under-dash fuse/relay box and
the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Turn the ignition switch ON (II). Check for voltage between the wire*1 and body ground.
There should be battery voltage. If there is no battery voltage, check: the ignition coil.
- the wire*1 between the ignition coil and the ICM.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 5.
*1: BLU2 wire (HITACHI)
WHT/BLU wire (TEC)
5. Disconnect the ECM/PCM connector A (32P). Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire
between the ECM/PCM and the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4550
- There should be continuity.
6. Check for continuity on the YEL/GRN wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
7. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire between the test tachometer connector and the ICM.
- There should be continuity.
8. Check for continuity on the BLU1 wire to body ground.
- There should be no continuity.
9. If all the tests are normal, replace the ICM.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
HITACHI
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4555
TEC
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Hall
Effect Sensor, Ignition > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Ignition System - DTC P1381
Diagnostic Tips
Ignition Hall Effect Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - DTC P1381 Diagnostic
Tips
Troubleshooting Tips for
DTC P1381
Troubleshooting a '98-02 Accord L4 or '96-00 Civic with DTC P1381 (CYP sensor intermittent
interruption)? If you can't find anything wrong after following the procedure in the appropriate S/M,
then try this:
1. Remove the distributor cap, and make sure the ignition coil shield is there and it's correctly
installed.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation is right, go to step 2.
^ If the ignition coil shield installation isn't right, properly install the coil shield.
2. Unplug the 4P connector from the alternator
3. Test-drive the vehicle.
^ If DTC P1381 comes back with the alternator unplugged, replace the distributor housing.
^ If DTC P1381 doesn't come back, go to step 4.
4. Plug the 4P connector into the alternator, and use the HDS to do a charging system test. Look at
the alternator diode pattern on the display screen.
^ If the diode pattern doesn't look right, replace the alternator. A faulty diode can cause electrical
interference that sets this DTC.
^ If the diode pattern looks OK, press on with normal troubleshooting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Starting System Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Knock Sensor: Locations
Underside of Vehicle, Rear of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the electrodes and ceramic insulator for:
Burned or worn electrodes may be caused by: Advanced ignition timing
- Loose spark plug
- Plug heat range too low
- Insufficient cooling
Fouled plugs may be caused by: Retarded ignition timing
- Oil in combustion chamber
- Incorrect spark plug gap
- Plug heat range too high
- Excessive idling/low speed running
- Clogged air cleaner element
- Deteriorated ignition coil or ignition wires
2. D16Y5, D16Y7, D16Y8 engine:
- Adjust the gap with a suitable gapping tool, and replace the plug if the center electrode is rounded
as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 4575
3. B16A2 engine:
- Do not adjust the gap of a platinum tip plug: replace the spark plug if the center electrode is
rounded or if the gap is not within the specifications.
NOTE: Use only the spark plugs listed.
4. Apply a small quantity of anti-seize compound to the plug threads, and screw the plugs into the
cylinder head finger-tight. Then torque them to 18
N.m (1.8 kg.m, 13 lb.ft).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Tachometer Connector > Component Information
> Locations
Tachometer Connector: Locations
Left Rear Corner Of Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.8 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test > Page 4587
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Shift Lock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Connect battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.2 terminal of the solenoid
momentarily.
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No.2 (-) terminal (reverse polarity) or you will damage the
diode inside the solenoid.
4. Check that the shift lock releases when the release lever is pushed, and check that it locks when
the release lever is released. 5. If the solenoid does not work, replace the solenoid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 4596
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 4597
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st
Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 4603
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 4604
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4605
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Locations
Without CVT
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4606
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Shift control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and shift control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the shift control solenoid valve assembly, and install a new
shift control solenoid valve A/B with
a new filter/gasket and the clamp bracket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4611
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Alternative View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Alternative View > Page 4614
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Locations Photo 30
Lower Front Of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4615
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the linear solenoid connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 and the No. 2 terminals of the linear solenoid
connector.
STANDARD: 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the linear solenoid assembly. 4. Connect the No.
2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive terminal and connect the No. 1
terminal to the battery negative
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
5. If not, remove the linear solenoid assembly. 6. Check that the linear solenoid fluid passage for
dust or dirt. 7. Connect the No. 2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive
terminal and connect the No. 1 terminal to the battery negative
terminal. Check that the valve moves.
8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check that the valve releases.
NOTE: You can see the valve movement through the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
linear solenoid assembly.
9. If the valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or the linear solenoid does not operate, replace the linear
solenoid assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4616
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove the mounting bolts and the linear solenoid assembly. 2. Clean the mounting surface
and fluid passage of the linear solenoid assembly and transmission housing. 3. Install a new linear
solenoid assembly with a new gasket.
NOTE: Do not pinch the gasket when installing the linear solenoid; make sure that the gasket is
installed properly in the mounting groove of the linear solenoid.
4. Check the linear solenoid connector for rust, dirt or oil, and connect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Electrical Specifications
Without CVT
Solenoid Valve A
Between terminal 2 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Solenoid Valve B
Between terminal 1 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4621
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Mechanical Specifications
Without CVT
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4622
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Locations
Without CVT
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4623
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Testing and Inspection
Without CVT
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 2 terminal (solenoid valve A) of the lock-up control
solenoid valve connector and body ground, and
between the No. 1 terminal (solenoid valve B) and body ground.
STANDARD: 14 - 25 Ohms
3. Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if the resistance is out of specification. 4. If
the resistance is within the standard, connect the No. 1 terminal of the lock-up control solenoid
valve connector to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if no clicking sound is heard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4624
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Lock-up control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly, and install a
new lock-up control solenoid valve
A/B with a new filter/gasket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
SRS components are located in this area Review the SRS component locations precautions and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4632
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4633
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4634
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4635
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4636
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4637
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4638
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4639
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4640
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4641
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4642
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4643
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4644
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4645
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4646
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4647
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4648
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4649
Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4650
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
4651
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes ON. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come ON.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the Powertrain (except HX) or Transmission (HX) Control Module (PCM or TCM) detects an
abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request diagnostic trouble
codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4 (D for HX) indicator
light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 4654
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 4655
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 4656
Shift Indicator: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D4]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 4657
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral". 4. Move the shift lever
to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting nuts. 6.
Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when the shift
lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 4661
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4667
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4671
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4672
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4673
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4674
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch Signal <--> [Brake Switch - TCC] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4683
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component
Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4687
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4691
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4694
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4695
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4696
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4697
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4698
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4699
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4700
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4701
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4702
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4703
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4704
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4705
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4706
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4707
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4708
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4709
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4710
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4711
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4712
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4713
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4714
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 4721
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 4722
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 4723
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 4724
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4725
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4731
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4732
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4733
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4734
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4735
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4736
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4737
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4738
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4739
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4740
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4741
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4742
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4743
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4744
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4745
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4746
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4747
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock
Solenoid Test
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.8 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock
Solenoid Test > Page 4760
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Shift Lock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Connect battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.2 terminal of the solenoid
momentarily.
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No.2 (-) terminal (reverse polarity) or you will damage the
diode inside the solenoid.
4. Check that the shift lock releases when the release lever is pushed, and check that it locks when
the release lever is released. 5. If the solenoid does not work, replace the solenoid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page
4769
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page
4770
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st
Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set > Page 4776
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set > Page 4777
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns
Constant Velocity Joint: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed
Turns
91-029
January 26, 1999
Applies To: ALL 1988 and later Models*
Clicking Noise While Turning (Supersedes 91-029, dated April 17, 1992)
Updated information is shown with asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
A clicking noise is heard while making right or left turns at 10 mph or less.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Worn outboard driveshaft joint.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the noisy outboard driveshaft joint.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Failed part: Use the replacement Part Number
Skill level: Repair Technician
PARTS INFORMATION
REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS
DIAGNOSIS
(Driving method)
1. Drive the car in a circle in an open parking lot at approximately 10 mph with the brakes slightly
applied.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4783
2. Have an assistant stand in the center of the circle and listen for the clicking noise.
3. Drive the car in the opposite direction. The assistant should be able to tell which axle is making
the noise.
DIAGNOSIS
(On-hoist method)
1. Raise the car on a hoist and start the engine.
2. With the transmission in first gear (manual transmission) or D4 (automatic transmission),
increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm.
3. Apply the brakes to load the engine speed to 1,500 rpm while maintaining the same throttle
position.
4. Turn the wheels slowly to full left and full right positions. Have an assistant listen to determine
which axle is making the noise.
NOTE:
A driveshaft with a light degree of noise may not be detected by this on-hoist method.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the driveshaft as described in Section 16 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Use diagonal cutters to cut the two boot bands and the outboard joint boot, then remove them
from the driveshaft.
3. Wipe off the grease to expose the outboard joint. Measure and record distance "A" (from the
splined end of the driveshaft to the inner race) as a reference for reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4784
4. Carefully clamp the driveshaft in a vise.
5. *Remove the outboard joint using the threaded adapter (see REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS) and
a commercially available 5/8" x 18 slide hammer.*
6. Remove and discard the "C" clip from the driveshaft. Clean and inspect the driveshaft splines
and ring groove for burrs or other defects.
7. Install the new outboard joint boot provided in the kit. Slide it slowly onto the driveshaft to avoid
damaging the boot.
8. Install the new "C" clip onto the ring groove of the driveshaft.
9. Insert the driveshaft in the new outboard joint. Make sure the "C" clip is centered on the shaft
and is resting against the chamfered edge of the inner race.
10. Remove the driveshaft from the vise.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4785
11. To drive the outboard joint on the rest of the way, pick up the assembly and let it fall from about
10 cm (4 to 5 in.) onto a hard surface.
NOTICE
Do not use a hammer; excessive force may damage the driveshaft.
12. Measure distance "A" (from the splines to the inner race of the joint). If the distance is more
than your measurement in Step 3, repeat Step 11.
13. When distance "A" equals your measurement in Step 3, the "C" clip should be seated in the
joint. Tap on the inner race with a plastic hammer to make sure the joint does not move on the
driveshaft.
14. Fit the small end of the boot into the boot groove on the driveshaft.
15. Install the small boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
16. Pack the outboard boot with the grease included in the kit. Pack the outboard joint with the
remaining grease, then fit the boot over the outboard joint.
17. Install the large boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
18. Reinstall the driveshaft assembly into the car. Refer to Section 16 of the appropriate service
manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4791
2. Have an assistant stand in the center of the circle and listen for the clicking noise.
3. Drive the car in the opposite direction. The assistant should be able to tell which axle is making
the noise.
DIAGNOSIS
(On-hoist method)
1. Raise the car on a hoist and start the engine.
2. With the transmission in first gear (manual transmission) or D4 (automatic transmission),
increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm.
3. Apply the brakes to load the engine speed to 1,500 rpm while maintaining the same throttle
position.
4. Turn the wheels slowly to full left and full right positions. Have an assistant listen to determine
which axle is making the noise.
NOTE:
A driveshaft with a light degree of noise may not be detected by this on-hoist method.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the driveshaft as described in Section 16 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Use diagonal cutters to cut the two boot bands and the outboard joint boot, then remove them
from the driveshaft.
3. Wipe off the grease to expose the outboard joint. Measure and record distance "A" (from the
splined end of the driveshaft to the inner race) as a reference for reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4792
4. Carefully clamp the driveshaft in a vise.
5. *Remove the outboard joint using the threaded adapter (see REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS) and
a commercially available 5/8" x 18 slide hammer.*
6. Remove and discard the "C" clip from the driveshaft. Clean and inspect the driveshaft splines
and ring groove for burrs or other defects.
7. Install the new outboard joint boot provided in the kit. Slide it slowly onto the driveshaft to avoid
damaging the boot.
8. Install the new "C" clip onto the ring groove of the driveshaft.
9. Insert the driveshaft in the new outboard joint. Make sure the "C" clip is centered on the shaft
and is resting against the chamfered edge of the inner race.
10. Remove the driveshaft from the vise.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking
Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 4793
11. To drive the outboard joint on the rest of the way, pick up the assembly and let it fall from about
10 cm (4 to 5 in.) onto a hard surface.
NOTICE
Do not use a hammer; excessive force may damage the driveshaft.
12. Measure distance "A" (from the splines to the inner race of the joint). If the distance is more
than your measurement in Step 3, repeat Step 11.
13. When distance "A" equals your measurement in Step 3, the "C" clip should be seated in the
joint. Tap on the inner race with a plastic hammer to make sure the joint does not move on the
driveshaft.
14. Fit the small end of the boot into the boot groove on the driveshaft.
15. Install the small boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
16. Pack the outboard boot with the grease included in the kit. Pack the outboard joint with the
remaining grease, then fit the boot over the outboard joint.
17. Install the large boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
18. Reinstall the driveshaft assembly into the car. Refer to Section 16 of the appropriate service
manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4794
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Locations
Without CVT
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4795
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Shift control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and shift control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the shift control solenoid valve assembly, and install a new
shift control solenoid valve A/B with
a new filter/gasket and the clamp bracket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 4800
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View >
Page 4803
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Locations Photo 30
Lower Front Of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4804
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the linear solenoid connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 and the No. 2 terminals of the linear solenoid
connector.
STANDARD: 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the linear solenoid assembly. 4. Connect the No.
2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive terminal and connect the No. 1
terminal to the battery negative
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
5. If not, remove the linear solenoid assembly. 6. Check that the linear solenoid fluid passage for
dust or dirt. 7. Connect the No. 2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive
terminal and connect the No. 1 terminal to the battery negative
terminal. Check that the valve moves.
8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check that the valve releases.
NOTE: You can see the valve movement through the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
linear solenoid assembly.
9. If the valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or the linear solenoid does not operate, replace the linear
solenoid assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4805
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove the mounting bolts and the linear solenoid assembly. 2. Clean the mounting surface
and fluid passage of the linear solenoid assembly and transmission housing. 3. Install a new linear
solenoid assembly with a new gasket.
NOTE: Do not pinch the gasket when installing the linear solenoid; make sure that the gasket is
installed properly in the mounting groove of the linear solenoid.
4. Check the linear solenoid connector for rust, dirt or oil, and connect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Electrical Specifications
Without CVT
Solenoid Valve A
Between terminal 2 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Solenoid Valve B
Between terminal 1 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4810
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Mechanical Specifications
Without CVT
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4811
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Locations
Without CVT
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4812
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Testing and Inspection
Without CVT
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 2 terminal (solenoid valve A) of the lock-up control
solenoid valve connector and body ground, and
between the No. 1 terminal (solenoid valve B) and body ground.
STANDARD: 14 - 25 Ohms
3. Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if the resistance is out of specification. 4. If
the resistance is within the standard, connect the No. 1 terminal of the lock-up control solenoid
valve connector to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if no clicking sound is heard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4813
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Lock-up control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly, and install a
new lock-up control solenoid valve
A/B with a new filter/gasket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.8 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test > Page
4821
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Shift Lock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Connect battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.2 terminal of the solenoid
momentarily.
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No.2 (-) terminal (reverse polarity) or you will damage the
diode inside the solenoid.
4. Check that the shift lock releases when the release lever is pushed, and check that it locks when
the release lever is released. 5. If the solenoid does not work, replace the solenoid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 4830
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 4831
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st
Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 4837
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL
ON/DTC's Set > Page 4838
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
4839
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Locations
Without CVT
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
4840
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Shift control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and shift control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the shift control solenoid valve assembly, and install a new
shift control solenoid valve A/B with
a new filter/gasket and the clamp bracket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4845
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View > Page 4848
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Locations Photo 30
Lower Front Of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4849
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the linear solenoid connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 and the No. 2 terminals of the linear solenoid
connector.
STANDARD: 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the linear solenoid assembly. 4. Connect the No.
2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive terminal and connect the No. 1
terminal to the battery negative
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
5. If not, remove the linear solenoid assembly. 6. Check that the linear solenoid fluid passage for
dust or dirt. 7. Connect the No. 2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive
terminal and connect the No. 1 terminal to the battery negative
terminal. Check that the valve moves.
8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check that the valve releases.
NOTE: You can see the valve movement through the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
linear solenoid assembly.
9. If the valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or the linear solenoid does not operate, replace the linear
solenoid assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4850
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove the mounting bolts and the linear solenoid assembly. 2. Clean the mounting surface
and fluid passage of the linear solenoid assembly and transmission housing. 3. Install a new linear
solenoid assembly with a new gasket.
NOTE: Do not pinch the gasket when installing the linear solenoid; make sure that the gasket is
installed properly in the mounting groove of the linear solenoid.
4. Check the linear solenoid connector for rust, dirt or oil, and connect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Electrical Specifications
Without CVT
Solenoid Valve A
Between terminal 2 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Solenoid Valve B
Between terminal 1 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 4855
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Mechanical Specifications
Without CVT
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4856
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Locations
Without CVT
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4857
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Testing and Inspection
Without CVT
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 2 terminal (solenoid valve A) of the lock-up control
solenoid valve connector and body ground, and
between the No. 1 terminal (solenoid valve B) and body ground.
STANDARD: 14 - 25 Ohms
3. Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if the resistance is out of specification. 4. If
the resistance is within the standard, connect the No. 1 terminal of the lock-up control solenoid
valve connector to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if no clicking sound is heard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4858
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Lock-up control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly, and install a
new lock-up control solenoid valve
A/B with a new filter/gasket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Set Ring, 80 mm Thickness
P/N# 90414-689-000 ...........................................................................................................................
...................................... 2.50 mm (0.098 inch) P/N# 90415-689-000 .................................................
................................................................................................................ 2.60 mm (0.102 inch) P/N#
90416-689-000 ....................................................................................................................................
............................. 2.70 mm (0.106 inch) P/N# 90417-689-000 ..........................................................
....................................................................................................... 2.80 mm (0.110 inch) P/N#
90418-689-000 ....................................................................................................................................
............................. 2.90 mm (0.114 inch) P/N# 90419-PH8-000 .........................................................
....................................................................................................... 3.00 mm (0.118 inch)
Set Ring And Outer Race Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
................................ 0-0.15 mm (0-0.006 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing
Bell Housing: Service and Repair Torque Converter Housing Bearing
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07736-A01000A Adjustable Bearing Puller, 25-40 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm
- Or Equivalent
MAINSHAFT BEARING/OIL SEAL
1. Remove the mainshaft bearing and oil seal using the special tools as shown.
2. Drive in the new mainshaft bearing until it bottoms in the housing using the special tools as
shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4864
3. Install the new oil seal flush with the housing using the special tools as shown.
COUNTERSHAFT BEARING
1. Remove the countershaft bearing using the special tools as shown. 2. Install the ATF guide
plate.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4865
3. Drive the new bearing into the housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4866
Bell Housing: Service and Repair Torque Converter Oil Seal Replacement
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07746-0030100 Driver 40 mm I.D.
- 07JAD-PH80200 Pilot, 26 x 30 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07947-6110501 Driver Attachment, 68 mm
- 07JAD-PH80101 Driver Attachment
- Or Equivalent
REMOVAL
1. Remove the differential assembly.
2. Remove the oil seal from the transmission housing.
3. Remove the oil seal from the torque converter housing.
INSTALLATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4867
1. Install a 2.50 mm (0.098 inch) set ring, 80 mm in transmission housing.
NOTE: Do not install the oil seal yet.
2. Install the differential assembly into the torque converter housing using the special tool as
shown. 3. Install the transmission housing and tighten the bolts.
4. Tap on the transmission housing side of the differential assembly with the special tool to seat the
differential assembly in the torque converter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4868
housing.
5. Measure the clearance between the 80 mm set ring and outer race of the ball bearing in the
transmission housing. Standard: 0 - 0.15 mm (0 - 0.006
inch)
6. If the clearance is more than the standard, select a new 80 mm set ring from the following table
and install.
NOTE: If the 80 mm set ring-to-ball bearing outer race clearance measured in step 5 is less than
the specification, it is not necessary to perform steps 7 and 8.
7. Remove the transmission housing. 8. Replace the 2.50 mm (0.098 inch) 80 mm set ring with the
one of the correct thickness selected in step 5.
9. Install the new oil seal flush with the transmission housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Housing Bearing > Page 4869
10. Install the new oil seal flush with the torque converter housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch Signal <-->
[Brake Switch - TCC] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Case: Service and Repair
1. To remove the mainshaft and countershaft bearings from the transmission housing, expand each
snap ring with snap ring pliers, then push the
bearing out using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Do not remove the snap rings unless it's necessary to clean the grooves in the housing.
Mainshaft Bearing installation use: ATTACHMENT, 72 x 75 mm 07746 - 0010600. Countershaft
Bearing installation use: ATTACHMENT, 62 x 68 mm 07746 - 0010500.
2. Expand each snap ring with snap ring pliers, insert the new bearing part-way into the housing
using the special tools and a press as shown. Install
the bearing with the groove facing outside the housing.
NOTE: Coat all parts with ATF.
3. Release the pliers, then push the bearing down into the housing until the ring snaps in place
around it.
NOTE: Mainshaft Bearing Removal use: ATTACHMENT, 72 x 75 mm 07746 - 0010600.
Countershaft Bearing Removal use: ATTACHMENT,
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4876
62 x 68 mm 07746 - 0010500
4. After installing the bearing verify the following:
- The snap ring is seated in the bearing and housing grooves.
- The snap ring operates properly.
- The ring end gap is correct.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch: Description and Operation
GENERAL
Clutches The four-speed automatic transmission uses hydraulically-actuated clutches to engage or
disengage the transmission gears. When hydraulic pressure is introduced into the clutch drum, the
clutch piston moves. This presses the friction discs and steel plates together, locking them so they
don't slip. Power is then transmitted through the engaged clutch pack to its hub-mounted gear.
Likewise, when the hydraulic pressure is bled from the clutch pack, the piston releases the friction
discs and the steel plates, and they are free to slide past each other. This allows the gear to spin
independently on its shaft, transmitting no power.
1ST CLUTCH
The 1st clutch engages/disengages 1st gear, and is located at the end of the mainshaft, just behind
the right side cover. The 1st clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the
mainshaft.
2ND CLUTCH
The 2nd clutch engages/disengages 2nd gear, and is located at the middle of the mainshaft. The
2nd clutch is joined back-to-back to the 4th clutch. The 2nd clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure
through the mainshaft by a circuit connected to the internal hydraulic circuit.
3RD CLUTCH
The 3rd clutch engages/disengages 3rd gear, and is located at the end of the countershaft. The 3rd
clutch is supplied hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the countershaft.
4TH CLUTCH
The 4th clutch engages/disengages 4th gear, as well as reverse gear, and is located at the middle
of the mainshaft. The 4th clutch is joined back-to-back to the 2nd clutch. The 4th clutch is supplied
hydraulic pressure by its ATF feed pipe within the mainstay.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4880
ONE-WAY CLUTCH
The one-way clutch is positioned between the countershaft 1st gear and the parking gear, with the
parking gear splined to the countershaft. The 1st gear provides the outer race surface, and the
parking gear provides the inner race surface. The one-way clutch locks up when power is
transmitted from the mainshaft 1st gear to the countershaft 1st gear. The 1st clutch and gears
remain engaged in the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th gear ranges in the D3, D4 or 2 position. However, the
one-way clutch disengages when the 2nd, 3rd, or 4th clutches/gears are applied in the D4, D3, or 2
position. This is because the increased rotational speed of the gears on the countershaft overrides
the locking "speed range" of the one-way clutch. Thereafter, the one-way clutch free-wheels with
the 1st clutch still engaged.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 4881
Clutch: Service and Repair
One-Way Clutch, A/T
For information regarding the service and repair of this components, and the system that it is a part
of, please refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle; Service and Repair; Transmission Overhaul.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4885
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Countershaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Distance Collar, 28 mm Thickness
1-P/N# 90503-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.00 mm (1.535 inch) 2-P/N# 90504-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.10 mm (1.539 inch) 3-P/N# 90505-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.20 mm (1.543 inch) 4-P/N# 90507-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.30 mm (1.547 inch) 5-P/N# 90508-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.05 mm (1.537 inch) 6-P/N# 90509-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.15 mm (1.541 inch) 7-P/N# 90510-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
39.25 mm (1.545 inch) 8-P/N# 90511-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
38.90 mm (1.531 inch) 9-P/N# 90512-PC9-000
...........................................................................................................................................................
38.95 mm (1.533 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Locknut ................................................................................................................................................
............................................ 103 Nm (75.9 ft. lbs.) Speed Sensor ......................................................
................................................................................................................................. 12 Nm (8.7 ft.
lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4889
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4890
Countershaft: Testing and Inspection
CLEARANCE MEASUREMENT
NOTE: Lubricate all parts with ATF during assembly.
1. Remove the countershaft bearing from the transmission housing.
2. Install the parts below on the countershaft using the special tool and a press as described.
NOTE: Do not assemble the O-rings during inspection.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4891
3. Install the parts below on the countershaft subassembly, then torque the locknut to 29 Nm (22 ft.
lbs.).
NOTE: Countershaft locknut has left-hand threads.
4. Measure the clearance between the 2nd gear and the 28 mm distance collar with a feeler gauge.
NOTE: Take measurements in at least three places and use the average as the actual clearance.
Standard: 0.10 - 0.18 mm (0.004 - 0.007 inch).
5. If the clearance is out of tolerance, remove the 28 mm distance collar and measure the width.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4892
6. Select and install a new distance collar, then recheck. 7. After selecting a new distance collar,
recheck the clearance and make sure it is within tolerance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4893
Countershaft: Service and Repair
One-Way Clutch, A/T
For information regarding the service and repair of this components, and the system that it is a part
of, please refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle; Service and Repair; Transmission Overhaul.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Data Link Connector, A/T
> Component Information > Locations
Data Link Connector, A/T: Locations
Below Right Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Carrier Assembly, A/T > Carrier Bearings, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Carrier Bearings: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07746-0030100 Driver 40 mm I.D.
- Or Equivalent
NOTE: Check bearings for wear and rough rotation. If bearings are OK, removal is not necessary.
1. Remove bearings using a bearing puller.
2. Install new bearings using the special tool as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Ring Gear, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 101 Nm (74.5 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Dry Fill .................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 5.9 liters (6.2 US qts.) Drain and Fill ....................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 2.7 liters (2.9 US
qts.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4909
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
................... Genuine Honda Premium Formula ATF
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4910
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
CAUTION: Keep all of the foreign particles out of the transmission.
NOTE: Check the fluid level with the engine at normal operating temperature (the radiator fan
comes on).
1. Park the vehicle on level ground. Turn off the engine.
2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth. 3. Insert
the dipstick into the transmission. 4. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be
between the upper and lower marks. 5. If the level is below the lower mark, pour the recommended
fluid* into the filler hole to bring it to the upper mark.
6. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission in the direction shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4911
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
CHECKING
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission.
1. Warm up the engine to normal operating temperature (the radiator fan comes on). 2. Park the
vehicle on the level ground, then turn off the engine. 3. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the
transmission, and wipe it with a clean cloth.
4. Insert the dipstick into the transmission.
5. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid level. It should be between the upper mark and lower
marks. 6. If the level is below the lower mark, pour the recommended fluid into the filler hole to
bring it to the upper mark. Always use Genuine Honda
Premium Formula Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF). Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift
quality.
7. Insert the dipstick back into the transmission in the direction shown.
CHANGING
NOTE: Keep all foreign particles out of the transmission.
1. Bring the transmission up to operating temperature (the radiator fan comes on) by driving the
vehicle. 2. Park the vehicle on the level ground, and turn the engine off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4912
3. Remove the drain plug, and drain the Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF).
NOTE: If a cooler flusher is to be used, refer to cooler flushing.
4. Reinstall the drain plug with a new sealing washer, then refill the transmission with the
recommended fluid into the filler hole to the upper mark on
the dipstick. Always use Genuine Honda Premium Formula Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF).
Using a non-Honda ATF can affect shift quality.
Automatic Transmission Fluid Capacity:
2.7 L (2.4 Imp qt.) at changing 5.9 L ( 5.2 Imp qt.) at overhaul
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Line/Hose: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Brackets ...............................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.) Joint Bolt ..............................................................
................................................................................................................................ 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4916
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair
CONNECTION
1. Connect the Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) cooler hoses to the ATF cooler lines and ATF
cooler, and secure them with the clips as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Drive Gear ...........................................................................................................................................
...................... 0.105-0.133 mm (0.004-0.005 inch) Driven Gear .........................................................
...................................................................................................... 0.035-0.063 mm (0.001-0.002
inch) Drive/Driven Gear Thrust (Axial) Clearance:
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.03-0.05 mm (0.001-0.002 inch) Service Limit ..............................................................
............................................................................................................... 0.07 mm (0.003 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4920
Fluid Pump: Testing and Inspection
With A/T
1. Install the ATF pump gears and ATF pump driven gear shaft in the main valve body.
NOTE: Lubricate all parts with ATF during inspection.
- Install the ATF pump driven gear with its grooved and chamfered side facing up as shown.
2. Measure the side clearance of the ATF pump drive and driven gears. ATF Pump Gears Side
(Radial) Clearance: Standard (New):
- ATF Pump Drive Gear: 0.105 - 0.1325 mm (0.004 - 0.005 inch)
- ATF Pump Driven Gear: 0.035 - 0.0625 mm (0.0014 - 0.0025 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4921
3. Remove the ATF pump driven gear shaft. Measure the thrust clearance of the ATF pump driven
gear to-valve body. ATF Pump Drive/Driven Gear
Thrust (Axial) Clearance: Standard (New): 0.03 - 0.05 mm (0.001 - 0.002 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.07 mm (0.003 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Idler Gear, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Idler Gear: Service and Repair
One-Way Clutch, A/T
For information regarding the service and repair of this components, and the system that it is a part
of, please refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle; Service and Repair; Transmission Overhaul.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
SRS components are located in this area Review the SRS component locations precautions and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4931
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4932
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4933
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4934
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4935
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4936
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4937
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4938
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4939
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4940
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4941
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4942
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4943
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4944
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4945
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4946
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4947
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4948
Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4949
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4950
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes ON. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come ON.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the Powertrain (except HX) or Transmission (HX) Control Module (PCM or TCM) detects an
abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request diagnostic trouble
codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4 (D for HX) indicator
light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 4953
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 4954
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4955
Shift Indicator: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D4]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4956
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral". 4. Move the shift lever
to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting nuts. 6.
Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when the shift
lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 4960
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Mainshaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Thrust Washer 36.5 x 55 mm Thickness
1-P/N# 90441-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.00 mm (0.157 inch) 2-P/N# 90442-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.05 mm (0.159 inch) 3-P/N# 90443-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.10 mm (0.161 inch) 4-P/N# 90444-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.15 mm (0.163 inch) 5-P/N# 90445-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.20 mm (0.165 inch) 6-P/N# 90446-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.25 mm (0.167 inch) 7-P/N# 90447-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.30 mm (0.169 inch) 8-P/N# 90448-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.35 mm (0.171 inch) 9-P/N# 90449-P4P-010
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.40 mm (0.173 inch)
10-P/N# 90450-P4P-000
.............................................................................................................................................................
4.45 mm (0.175 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Locknut ................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 78 Nm (58 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4964
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4965
Mainshaft: Testing and Inspection
A/T Only
CLEARANCE MEASUREMENT
NOTE: Lubricate all parts with ATF during assembly.
1. Remove the mainshaft bearing from the transmission housing.
2. Assemble the parts below on the mainshaft.
NOTE: Do not assemble the O-rings during inspection.
3. Torque the mainshaft locknut to 29 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Mainshaft locknut has left-hand threads.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4966
4. Hold 2nd gear against the 2nd clutch, then measure the clearance between 2nd gear and 3rd
gear with a feeler gauge.
NOTE: Take measurements in at least three places, and use the average as the actual clearance.
Standard: 0.05 - 0.13 mm (0.002 - 0.005 inch)
5. If the clearance is out of tolerance, remove the thrust washer and measure the thickness.
6. Select and install a new washer, then recheck. 7. After replacing the thrust washer, make sure
the clearance is within tolerance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4967
Mainshaft: Service and Repair
One-Way Clutch, A/T
For information regarding the service and repair of this components, and the system that it is a part
of, please refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle; Service and Repair; Transmission Overhaul.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 4971
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations > Page 4976
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4980
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4981
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4982
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 4983
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Torque Converter Oil Seal - Installation Tool
Seals and Gaskets: Technical Service Bulletins Torque Converter Oil Seal - Installation Tool
00-022
March 7, 2000
Applies To: ALL Models With L4 or V6 Engine and A/T With 44 mm I.D. Torque Converter Oil Seal
Torque Converter Oil Seal Installation Tool
The service manual procedure for installing the torque converter oil seal requires you to
disassemble the transmission. A new required special tool, which attaches to your existing 40 mm
l.D. driver, lets you install this seal without removing the main shaft or disassembling the
transmission.
REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS
Seal Driver Attachment: T/N O7XAD-001000A (Shipped to all dealers March 2000 as a required
special tool)
40 mm I.D. Driver: T/N 07746-0030100
ORDERING INFORMATION
Additional seal driver attachments are available from American Honda using normal parts ordering
procedures.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This service bulletin is for information only.
PROCEDURE
1. Remove the transmission (see section 14 of the appropriate service manual).
2. Remove and discard the torque converter oil seal. Be careful not to damage the torque converter
housing.
3. Select the appropriate replacement seal.
4. Press the long end of the seal driver attachment into the driver. Press the new seal onto the
short end. Do not apply any type of sealer to the seal or
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Torque Converter Oil Seal - Installation Tool > Page 4988
the torque converter housing; you must install the seal dry.
5. Slide the tool over the mainshaft as far as it will go.
6. With a soft-face hammer, lightly tap the driver until the seal is fully seated in the torque converter
housing.
7. Reinstall the transmission.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch Signal <--> [Brake Switch - TCC] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4996
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5000
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5004
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5007
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5008
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5009
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5010
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5011
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5012
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5013
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5014
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5015
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5016
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5017
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5018
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5019
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5020
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5021
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5022
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5023
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5024
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5025
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5026
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5027
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed
Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5034
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5035
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5036
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5037
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5038
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5043
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5044
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5045
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5046
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.8 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test > Page 5052
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Shift Lock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Connect battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.2 terminal of the solenoid
momentarily.
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No.2 (-) terminal (reverse polarity) or you will damage the
diode inside the solenoid.
4. Check that the shift lock releases when the release lever is pushed, and check that it locks when
the release lever is released. 5. If the solenoid does not work, replace the solenoid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Park
Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Park
Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5056
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control
Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control
Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5065
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control
Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5066
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st
Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5072
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5073
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5074
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Locations
Without CVT
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Control Solenoid
Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5075
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Shift control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and shift control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the shift control solenoid valve assembly, and install a new
shift control solenoid valve A/B with
a new filter/gasket and the clamp bracket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5079
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation
The shift lever has six positions: P PARK, R REVERSE, N NEUTRAL, D4 1st through 4th gear
ranges, D3 1st through 3rd gear ranges, 2-2nd gear. Starting is possible only in P and N positions
through the use of a slide-type, neutral-safety switch. The A/T gear position indicator in the
instrument panel shows which gear has been selected without having to look down at the console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5080
Shifter A/T: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
1. Check that the index mark on the indicator aligns with the [N] mark on the shift indicator panel
when the transmission is in NEUTRAL. 2. If not aligned, remove the front console. 3. Remove the
shift indicator panel mounting screws and adjust by moving the panel.
NOTE: Whenever the shift indicator panel is removed, reinstall the panel as described above.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Cable: > 97-009 > Feb > 00
> Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed
Shift Cable: Customer Interest Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed
97-009
February 8, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All with Automatic Transmission
Key Cannot Be Removed From the Ignition Switch (Supersedes 97-009, dated January 26, 1999)
SYMPTOM
The ignition switch sometimes will not turn to the LOCK (0) position, and the key cannot be
removed.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The shift cable is out of adjustment, preventing the shift lever pin from engaging the key lock
switch.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the shift cable.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 214305
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 54315-504-A81 H/C 4778643
Defect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 97-009A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
1. Make sure the shift lever is in Park.
2. Remove the center console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Cable: > 97-009 > Feb > 00
> Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed > Page 5090
3. Inspect the key lock switch. If the pin is not in the switch, jiggle the shift lever back and forth
without taking it out of Park.
^ If the pin does not return and the key cannot be removed, continue with normal troubleshooting.
^ If the pin returns and the key can be removed, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Move the shift lever to Neutral.
2. Remove the lock pin from the shift cable adjuster.
3. Check the alignment of the hole in the adjuster with the hole in the shift cable. The holes should
exactly align.
4. Loosen the locknut on the adjuster. Turn the adjuster in or out until the holes exactly align.
Torque the locknut to 7 N.m (5 lb-ft).
5. Reinstall the lock pin. If the lock pin binds as you install it, the shift cable is still out of adjustment.
6. Move the shift lever to all the gear positions. Make sure the shift lever position indicator shows
each gear position.
7. Move the shift lever to Park. Make sure the key can be removed from the ignition switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Cable: > 97-009 > Feb > 00
> Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed > Page 5091
8. Insert the key in the shift lock release slot, and make sure the shift lever releases.
9. Reinstall the center console.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Cable: > 97-009 > Feb > 97
> A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck
Shift Cable: Customer Interest A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck
97-009
BODY
FEB 3, 1997
Applies To: 1996 Civic - with Automatic Transmission
Key Cannot Be Removed From the Ignition Switch
SYMPTOM The ignition switch sometimes will not return to the Lock position, and the key cannot
be removed.
PROBABLE CAUSE The shift cable is out of adjustment, preventing the pin from engaging in the
key lock switch.
DIAGNOSIS If the key will not come out of the ignition switch:
1. Make sure the shift lever is in Park.
2. Remove the center console.
3. Inspect the key lock switch. If the pin is not in the switch, move the shift lever back and forth
without taking it out of Park.
^ If the pin does not return and the key cannot be removed, continue with normal troubleshooting.
^ If the pin returns and the key can be removed, continue to CORRECTIVE ACTION.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Cable: > 97-009 > Feb > 97
> A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck > Page 5096
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the shift cable.
1. Move the shift lever to Neutral.
2. Remove the lock pin from the shift cable adjuster.
3. Check the alignment of the hole in the adjuster with the hole in the shift cable. They should align
perfectly.
4. Loosen the locknut on the adjuster. Turn the adjuster in or out until the holes align perfectly.
Tighten the locknut to 7 N.m (5 lb-ft).
5. Reinstall the lock pin. If the lock pin binds as you install it, the shift cable is still out of adjustment.
6. Move the shift lever to all the gear positions. Verify that the shift lever position indicator shows
each position.
7. Move the shift lever to Park. Verify that the key can be removed.
8. Insert the key in the shift lock release slot, and verify that the shift lever releases.
9. Reinstall the center console.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 214305
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 54315-S04-A81 H/C 4778643
Defect code: 074
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 97-009A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Cable: >
97-009 > Feb > 00 > Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed
Shift Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed
97-009
February 8, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All with Automatic Transmission
Key Cannot Be Removed From the Ignition Switch (Supersedes 97-009, dated January 26, 1999)
SYMPTOM
The ignition switch sometimes will not turn to the LOCK (0) position, and the key cannot be
removed.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The shift cable is out of adjustment, preventing the shift lever pin from engaging the key lock
switch.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the shift cable.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 214305
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 54315-504-A81 H/C 4778643
Defect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 97-009A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
1. Make sure the shift lever is in Park.
2. Remove the center console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Cable: >
97-009 > Feb > 00 > Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed > Page 5102
3. Inspect the key lock switch. If the pin is not in the switch, jiggle the shift lever back and forth
without taking it out of Park.
^ If the pin does not return and the key cannot be removed, continue with normal troubleshooting.
^ If the pin returns and the key can be removed, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Move the shift lever to Neutral.
2. Remove the lock pin from the shift cable adjuster.
3. Check the alignment of the hole in the adjuster with the hole in the shift cable. The holes should
exactly align.
4. Loosen the locknut on the adjuster. Turn the adjuster in or out until the holes exactly align.
Torque the locknut to 7 N.m (5 lb-ft).
5. Reinstall the lock pin. If the lock pin binds as you install it, the shift cable is still out of adjustment.
6. Move the shift lever to all the gear positions. Make sure the shift lever position indicator shows
each gear position.
7. Move the shift lever to Park. Make sure the key can be removed from the ignition switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Cable: >
97-009 > Feb > 00 > Ignition Switch - Key Cannot Be Removed > Page 5103
8. Insert the key in the shift lock release slot, and make sure the shift lever releases.
9. Reinstall the center console.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Cable: >
97-009 > Feb > 97 > A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck
Shift Cable: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck
97-009
BODY
FEB 3, 1997
Applies To: 1996 Civic - with Automatic Transmission
Key Cannot Be Removed From the Ignition Switch
SYMPTOM The ignition switch sometimes will not return to the Lock position, and the key cannot
be removed.
PROBABLE CAUSE The shift cable is out of adjustment, preventing the pin from engaging in the
key lock switch.
DIAGNOSIS If the key will not come out of the ignition switch:
1. Make sure the shift lever is in Park.
2. Remove the center console.
3. Inspect the key lock switch. If the pin is not in the switch, move the shift lever back and forth
without taking it out of Park.
^ If the pin does not return and the key cannot be removed, continue with normal troubleshooting.
^ If the pin returns and the key can be removed, continue to CORRECTIVE ACTION.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Cable: >
97-009 > Feb > 97 > A/T - Shift Cable Adj./Ignition Key Stuck > Page 5108
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the shift cable.
1. Move the shift lever to Neutral.
2. Remove the lock pin from the shift cable adjuster.
3. Check the alignment of the hole in the adjuster with the hole in the shift cable. They should align
perfectly.
4. Loosen the locknut on the adjuster. Turn the adjuster in or out until the holes align perfectly.
Tighten the locknut to 7 N.m (5 lb-ft).
5. Reinstall the lock pin. If the lock pin binds as you install it, the shift cable is still out of adjustment.
6. Move the shift lever to all the gear positions. Verify that the shift lever position indicator shows
each position.
7. Move the shift lever to Park. Verify that the key can be removed.
8. Insert the key in the shift lock release slot, and verify that the shift lever releases.
9. Reinstall the center console.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 214305
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 54315-S04-A81 H/C 4778643
Defect code: 074
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 97-009A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5109
Shift Cable: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Adjuster Locknut ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 7 Nm (60 inch lbs.) Shift Cable Bracket Bolt .......................................
........................................................................................................................ 9.8 Nm (86.4 inch lbs.)
Shift Cable Cover Bolt .........................................................................................................................
................................................ 22 Nm (16 Ft. lbs.) Control Lever Bolt ................................................
................................................................................................................................ 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.)
Shift Cable Holder Bolt ........................................................................................................................
........................................ 12 Nm (104.4 inch lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5110
Shift Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL / INSTALLATION
WARNING: Make sure lifts are placed properly.
1. Remove the front console.
2. Shift to [N] position, then remove the lock pin from the adjuster.
3. Remove the shift cable bracket. 4. Remove the shift cable holder. 5. Remove the shift cable
cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5111
6. Remove the control lever from the control shaft, then remove the shift cable. Take care not to
bend the cable when removing/installing it. 7. Install the shift cable in the reverse order of removal.
8. Check the cable adjustment on reassembly.
ADJUSTMENT
WARNING: Make sure lifts are placed properly.
1. Remove the front console.
2. Shift to [N] position, then remove the lock pin from the adjuster.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5112
3. Check that the hole in the adjuster is perfectly aligned with the hole in the shift cable. There are
two holes in the adjuster. They are positioned 90,
apart to allow cable adjustment in 1/4 turn increments.
4. If the hole is not perfectly aligned, loosen the locknut on the adjuster and adjust as required. 5.
Tighten the locknut to 7 Nm (5 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the lock pin on the adjuster. If you feel the lock pin
binding as you reinstall it, the cable is still out of adjustment and must be readjusted. 7. Make sure
the lock pin is seated in the adjuster securely. 8. Move the shift lever to each gear, and verify that
the shift position indicator follows the automatic transaxle gear position switch. 9. Start the engine,
and check the shift lever in all gears. If any gear does not work properly, refer to troubleshooting.
10. Insert the ignition key into the key cylinder on the A/T gear position indicator panel, and verify
that the shift lock lever is released.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5118
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Alternative View > Page 5121
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Locations Photo 30
Lower Front Of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5122
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the linear solenoid connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 and the No. 2 terminals of the linear solenoid
connector.
STANDARD: 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the linear solenoid assembly. 4. Connect the No.
2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive terminal and connect the No. 1
terminal to the battery negative
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
5. If not, remove the linear solenoid assembly. 6. Check that the linear solenoid fluid passage for
dust or dirt. 7. Connect the No. 2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive
terminal and connect the No. 1 terminal to the battery negative
terminal. Check that the valve moves.
8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check that the valve releases.
NOTE: You can see the valve movement through the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
linear solenoid assembly.
9. If the valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or the linear solenoid does not operate, replace the linear
solenoid assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5123
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove the mounting bolts and the linear solenoid assembly. 2. Clean the mounting surface
and fluid passage of the linear solenoid assembly and transmission housing. 3. Install a new linear
solenoid assembly with a new gasket.
NOTE: Do not pinch the gasket when installing the linear solenoid; make sure that the gasket is
installed properly in the mounting groove of the linear solenoid.
4. Check the linear solenoid connector for rust, dirt or oil, and connect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Converter Clutch: > 97-025 >
Mar > 97 > A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
Torque Converter Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
97-025
March 24, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - All with A/T (except HX) 1996-97 Accord - All with A/T (except V6)
Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
SYMPTOM
The torque converter doesn't lock up in cold weather.
PROBABLE CAUSE
A faulty thermostat keeps the engine from reaching normal operating temperature in cold weather.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the thermostat.
PARTS INFORMATION
Thermostat and Gasket Kit:
P/N 19301-P08-316, H/C 4286167
Honda Antifreeze/Coolant:
P/N CU08730, H/C 1066588
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 114150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 19301-F10-307 H/C 4344792
Defect code: 030
Contention code: D02
Template ID: 97-025A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Torque Converter Clutch: > 97-025 >
Mar > 97 > A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up > Page 5132
1. Wait until the engine is cool, then connect the Honda PGM Tester to the 1 6P Data Link
Connector (DLC) located under the driver's side of the dashboard next to the kick panel.
2. Turn on the ignition switch, then follow the prompts on the PGM Tester until you reach the Data
List.
3. Start the engine.
4. While test-driving, check the engine coolant temperature. If it does not reach 176°F (80°C) within
10 minutes, proceed to the next step. If it does, disregard this bulletin, and follow the
troubleshooting procedures on page 14-50 of the 1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
NOTE:
This procedure only works if the outside temperature is below 30°F.
5. Wait until the engine is cool; then replace the thermostat and gasket (refer to page 10-9 of the
1996-97 Civic Service Manual). Refill the radiator with a 50/50 mix of genuine Honda
antifreeze/coolant and water.
6. Test-drive the vehicle with the PGM Tester to confirm the engine reaches normal operating
temperature. When it does, scroll to the A/T Data List and make sure the torque converter lock-up
solenoid turns ON. If it does not, follow the troubleshooting procedures on page 14-50 of the
1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Converter Clutch: >
97-025 > Mar > 97 > A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
Torque Converter Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
97-025
March 24, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - All with A/T (except HX) 1996-97 Accord - All with A/T (except V6)
Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up
SYMPTOM
The torque converter doesn't lock up in cold weather.
PROBABLE CAUSE
A faulty thermostat keeps the engine from reaching normal operating temperature in cold weather.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the thermostat.
PARTS INFORMATION
Thermostat and Gasket Kit:
P/N 19301-P08-316, H/C 4286167
Honda Antifreeze/Coolant:
P/N CU08730, H/C 1066588
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 114150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 19301-F10-307 H/C 4344792
Defect code: 030
Contention code: D02
Template ID: 97-025A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Torque Converter Clutch: >
97-025 > Mar > 97 > A/T - Torque Converter Does Not Lock Up > Page 5138
1. Wait until the engine is cool, then connect the Honda PGM Tester to the 1 6P Data Link
Connector (DLC) located under the driver's side of the dashboard next to the kick panel.
2. Turn on the ignition switch, then follow the prompts on the PGM Tester until you reach the Data
List.
3. Start the engine.
4. While test-driving, check the engine coolant temperature. If it does not reach 176°F (80°C) within
10 minutes, proceed to the next step. If it does, disregard this bulletin, and follow the
troubleshooting procedures on page 14-50 of the 1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
NOTE:
This procedure only works if the outside temperature is below 30°F.
5. Wait until the engine is cool; then replace the thermostat and gasket (refer to page 10-9 of the
1996-97 Civic Service Manual). Refill the radiator with a 50/50 mix of genuine Honda
antifreeze/coolant and water.
6. Test-drive the vehicle with the PGM Tester to confirm the engine reaches normal operating
temperature. When it does, scroll to the A/T Data List and make sure the torque converter lock-up
solenoid turns ON. If it does not, follow the troubleshooting procedures on page 14-50 of the
1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lock Up Control Solenoid
Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Electrical Specifications
Without CVT
Solenoid Valve A
Between terminal 2 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Solenoid Valve B
Between terminal 1 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lock Up Control Solenoid
Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications >
Page 5143
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Mechanical Specifications
Without CVT
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lock Up Control Solenoid
Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5144
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Locations
Without CVT
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lock Up Control Solenoid
Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5145
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Testing and Inspection
Without CVT
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 2 terminal (solenoid valve A) of the lock-up control
solenoid valve connector and body ground, and
between the No. 1 terminal (solenoid valve B) and body ground.
STANDARD: 14 - 25 Ohms
3. Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if the resistance is out of specification. 4. If
the resistance is within the standard, connect the No. 1 terminal of the lock-up control solenoid
valve connector to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if no clicking sound is heard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lock Up Control Solenoid
Valves <--> [Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5146
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Lock-up control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly, and install a
new lock-up control solenoid valve
A/B with a new filter/gasket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information
Use Worm-Style Clamps With the ATF Cooler Cleaner
The spring-style clamps used on the ATF cooler lines are made to hold the cooler lines to the ATF
cooler under normal operating conditions. The ATF Cooler Cleaner (P/N GHTTTCF6H) uses high
pressure (100 psi) to do its job. With the pump motor running, the spring-style clamps can walk off
or disconnect, and you'll wind up with a real mess to clean up in your shop.
In March of this year, we sent each Honda dealership a pair of high-quality worm-style clamps to
replace the original spring-style clamps. These clamps were part of a cooler cleaner update kit, and
securely hold the cooler line in place. They've got a blue cap for easy identification. Need some
more? Just call G-TFC, Inc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information > Page 5151
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Cooler Flushing Equipment Information
89-022
May 16, 2008
Applies To: Vehicles With an In-Radiator ATF Cooler - ALL
ATF Cooler Cleaner
(Supersedes 89-022, dated June 18, 2004, to update the information marked by asterisks)
Before installing an overhauled or remanufactured A/T, you must thoroughly clean the ATF cooler
to prevent system contamination. Failure to do so could cause a repeat A/T failure. The ATF Cooler
Cleaner (PIN GTHTTCF6H) is a portable, electrically operated special tool that cleans the ATF
cooler with high- pressure, heated ATF. This cleaning action melts down waxy varnish residue left
by burnt ATF and purges metal particles, clutch material, and other contaminants. The ATF Cooler
Cleaner has these features:
^ Quick-connect fittings and color-coded hoses for easy hookup.
^ Uses about 9.5 gallons of Honda ATF-Z1, which gets filtered and recirculated.
^ Heats ATF to a temperature of 1400 to 150°F and then pumps it through the ATF cooler at high
pressure (100 psi) using a pulsating action and air purging. Switching the hoses cleans the ATF
cooler in the reverse direction.
^ Two magnetic nonbypass spin-on filters to trap purged contaminants.
^ Built-in tool tray.
This service bulletin gives you information for ordering and servicing this special tool, and guides
you through the entire ATF cooler cleaning process.
*REQUIRED MATERIALS
Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001
Magnetic Nonbypass Spin-On Filter:
T/N GTHNBP12 (12-pack) T/N GTHNBP2 (6-pack) T/N GTHGNBP22 (2-pack)
ORDERING INFORMATION
Additional ATF cooler cleaners or magnetic nonbypass spin-on filters can be ordered through the
Honda Tool and Equipment Program. To order on the iN, click on SERVICE, then Service Bay,
then Tool and Equipment Program. From the Tool and Equipment Program menu, click on the
Online Catalog tab, and then search for the desired filter pack by part number.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information > Page 5152
TOOL DESCRIPTION
CLEANING PROCEDURE
The cleaning procedure involves hot fluid under high pressure. Check the security of all hoses and
connections. Always wear safety glasses or a face shield, gloves, and protective clothing. If you get
ATF in your eyes or on your skin, rinse with water immediately.
Improper use of the ATF cooler cleaner can result in burns and other serious injuries.
Always wear eye protection and protective clothing, and follow all instructions in this bulletin.
1. Plug the ATF cooler cleaner into a 110 V grounded electrical outlet.
NOTICE
Make sure the outlet has no other appliances (light fixtures, drop lights, extension cords) plugged
into it. Also, never plug the cooler cleaner into an extension cord or drop light cord; you would
damage the unit.
2. Flip the HEAT toggle switch to ON. Wait 1 hour for the cooler cleaner to reach its operating
temperature. (The cooler cleaner is ready to use when the temperature gauge reads 140° to
150°F.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information > Page 5153
3. Connect the appropriate fittings to the ATF cooler inlet and outlet lines. Connect the red hose to
the cooler outlet line (the line going to the external filter). Connect the blue hose to the cooler inlet
line.
4. Connect a shop air hose to the air purge valve.
NOTICE
The quick connect fitting has a one-way check valve to keep ATF from entering your shop's air
system. Do not remove or replace the fitting. Attach the coupler provided with the cooler cleaner to
your shop air line if your coupler is not compatible.
5. Flip the MOTOR toggle switch to ON, and let the pump run for 5 minutes. While the pump is
running, open and close the air purge valve periodically to cause agitation and improve the
cleaning process.
6. Flip the MOTOR toggle switch to OFF with the air purge valve open. Leave the air purge valve
open for at least 15 seconds to purge the lines of residual ATF.
7. Disconnect the red and blue hoses from the ATF cooler, then connect the red hose to the cooler
inlet line.
8. Connect the blue hose to the cooler outlet line.
9. Flip the MOTOR toggle switch to ON, and let the pump run for 5 minutes. While the pump is
running, open and close the air purge valve periodically.
10. Flip the MOTOR toggle switch to OFF with the air purge valve open. Leave the air purge valve
open for at least 15 seconds to purge the lines of residual ATF.
11. Disconnect the red and blue hoses from the ATF cooler lines. Connect the red and blue hoses
to each other.
12. Disconnect the shop air from the air purge valve. Disconnect and stow the coupler if used.
13. Disconnect and stow the fittings from the ATF cooler inlet and outlet lines.
14. Unplug the cooler cleaner from the 110 V outlet.
TOOL MAINTENANCE
Follow these instructions to keep the ATF cooler cleaner working properly:
*^ Replace the two magnetic nonbypass spin-on filters every 20 hours, based on hour meter
reading. For more information on filter replacement, see the
January 2008 Honda ServiceNews article, Hour Meter Tells You When to Replace ATF Cooler
Cleaner Filters.*
^ Fill the tank so the ATF is 4.5 inches from the top of the filler hole; do not overfill.
NOTE:
If the fluid level is low, the red indicator above the HEAT toggle switch comes on and the tank
heater will not work.
^ Replace the ATF in the tank when it looks dark or dirty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information > Page 5154
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5155
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair
COOLER FLUSHING
WARNING: To prevent injury to face and eyes, always wear safety glasses or a face shield when
using the transmission flusher.
NOTE: This procedure should be performed before reinstalling the transmission.
1. Check the tool and hoses for wear and cracks before using. If wear or cracks are found, replace
the hoses before using. 2. Using the measuring cup fill the tank with 21 ounces (approximately 2/3
full) of biodegradable flushing fluid (J35944-20). Do not substitute with
any other fluid. Follow the handling procedure on the fluid container.
3. Secure the flusher filler cap, and pressurize the tank with compressed air to between 550 - 829
kpa (80 - 120 psi).
NOTE: The air line should be equipped with a water trap to ensure a dry air system.
4. Hang the tool under the vehicle. 5. Attach the tank's discharge hose to the return line of the
transmission cooler using a clamp.
6. Connect the drain hose to the inlet line on the transmission cooler using a clamp.
IMPORTANT: Securely clamp the opposite end of the drain hose to a bucket or floor drain.
7. With the water and air valves off, attach the water and air supplies to the flusher. (Hot water if
available.) 8. Turn on the flusher water valve so water will flow through the cooler for 10 seconds.
NOTE: If water does not flow through the cooler, it is completely plugged, cannot be flushed, and
must be replaced.
9. Depress the trigger to mix the flushing fluid into the water flow. Use the wire clip to hold the
trigger down.
10. While flushing with the water and flushing fluid for two minutes, turn the air valve on for five
seconds every 15 - 20 seconds to create a surging
action.
AIR PRESSURE: MAX 845 kpa (120 psi)
11. Turn the water valve off. Release the trigger, then reverse the hoses to the cooler so you can
flush in the opposite direction. Repeat steps 8 through
10.
12. Release the trigger, and rinse the cooler with water only for one minute.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5156
13. Turn the water valve off, and turn off the water supply. 14. Turn the air valve on to dry the
system out with air for two full minutes or until no moisture is visible leaving the drain hose.
CAUTION: Residual moisture in the cooler or pipes can damage the transmission.
15. Remove the flusher from the cooler line. Attach the drain hose to a container. 16. Install the
transmission, and leave the drain hose attached to the cooler line. 17. Make sure the transmission
is in the [P] position. Fill the transmission with Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF), and run the
engine for 30
seconds or until approximately 0.95 L (0.8 Imp qt.) is discharged.
18. Remove the drain hose, and reconnect the cooler return hose to the transmission. 19. Refill the
transmission with ATF to the proper level.
Tool Maintenance 1. Empty and rinse after each use. Fill the can with water and pressurize the
can. Flush the discharge line to ensure that the unit is clean. 2. If discharge liquid does not foam,
the orifice may be blocked.
3. To clean, disconnect the plumbing from the tank at the large coupling nut. 4. Remove the in-line
filter from the discharge side and clean if necessary. 5. The fluid orifice is located behind the filter.
Clean it with the pick stored in the bottom of the tank handle, or blow it clean with air. Securely
reassemble all parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5160
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5164
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5167
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5168
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5169
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5170
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5171
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5172
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5173
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5174
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5175
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5176
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5177
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5178
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5179
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5180
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5181
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5182
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5183
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5184
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5185
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5186
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > A/T Gear Position Signal
<--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5187
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5194
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5195
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5196
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5197
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5198
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Body: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Relief Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.1 mm (0.043 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 8.6 mm (0.342 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 37.1 mm (1.461 inch)
Modulator Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.4 mm (0.055 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 9.4 mm (0.374 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 35.0 mm (1.378 inch)
CPB Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 8.1 mm (0.322 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 47.2 mm (1.858 inch)
1-2 Shift Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 7.6 mm (0.302 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 41.3 mm (1.626 inch)
2nd Orifice Control Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.7 mm (0.028 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 6.6 mm (0.262 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 34.8 mm (1.370 inch)
Servo Control Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 8.1 mm (0.322 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 52.1 mm (2.051 inch)
3-4 Shift Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................. 7.6 mm (0.302 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 57.0 mm (2.244 inch)
2-3 Shift Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 7.6 mm (0.302 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 57.0 mm (2.244 inch)
4th Exhaust Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 6.1 mm (0.242 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 36.4 mm (1.433 inch)
3-4 Orifice Control Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.7 mm (0.028 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 6.6 mm (0.262 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 37.5 mm (1.476 inch)
Regulator Valve Spring A
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.8 mm (0.071 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 14.7 mm (0.584 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 87.8 mm (3.457 inch)
Regulator Valve Spring B
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.8 mm (0.071 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 9.6 mm (0.381 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 44.0 mm (1.732 inch)
Stator Reaction Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 4.5 mm (0.177 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 35.4 mm (1.407 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5202
Free Length .........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 30.3 mm (1.193 inch)
Cooler Relief Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 8.4 mm (0.334 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 33.8 mm (1.331 inch)
Torque Converter Check Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.0 mm 90.039 inch) O.D. ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................................. 8.4 mm (0.334 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
............................. 33.8 mm 91.331 inch)
Lock-Up Control Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.7 mm (0.028 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 6.6 mm (0.262 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 38.0 mm (1.496 inch)
1st Accumulator Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.1 mm (0.083 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 16.0 mm (0.636 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 89.1 mm (3.508 inch)
4th Accumulator Spring A
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.6 mm (0.102 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 17.0 mm (0.676 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 87.0 mm (3.508 inch)
4th Accumulator Spring B
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.3 mm (0.091 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 10.2 mm (0.402 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 51.6 mm (2.031 inch)
3rd Accumulator Spring A
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.8 mm (0.110 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 17.5 mm (0.695 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 89.3 mm (3.516 inch)
3rd Accumulator Spring B
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.2 mm (0.087 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 31.0 mm (1.220 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 35.1 mm (1.382 inch)
2nd Accumulator Spring C
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.2 mm (0.087 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 14.5 mm (0.576 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 68.0 mm (2.677 inch)
2nd Accumulator Spring A
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 2.4 mm (0.094 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................... 29.0 mm (1.152 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 39.0 mm (1.535 inch)
2nd Accumulator Spring B
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 1.6 mm (0.063 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 9.0 mm (0.358 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 20.7 mm (0.815 inch)
Lock-Up Shift Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 7.6 mm (0.302 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 73.7 mm (2.902 inch)
Lock-Up Timing Valve Spring
Wire Diameter ......................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.9 mm (0.035 inch) O.D. ............................................................................
................................................................................................................. 8.1 mm (0.319 inch) Free
Length ..................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 80.7 mm (3.177 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5203
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Lock-Up Bolts ......................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.) Regulator Bolts .....................................................
............................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Main Bolts ............................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.) Secondary Bolts ....................................................
............................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Servo Bolts ..........................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Main
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Main > Page 5206
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Main > Page 5207
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Main > Page 5208
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Main > Page 5209
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Valve Body: Service and Repair Removal
NOTE: Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air.
Blow out all passages. When removing the valve body, replace the O-ring.
1. Remove the ATF feed pipes from the servo body, secondary valve body and main valve body. 2.
Remove the ATF strainer and servo detent base (two bolts). 3. Remove the servo body and servo
separator plate (seven bolts). 4. Remove the secondary valve body, shaft stop and secondary
separator plate (three bolts). 5. Remove the lock-up valve body and separator plate (seven bolts).
6. Remove the regulator valve body (one bolt). 7. Remove the stator shaft and stop shaft. 8.
Remove the detent spring from the detent arm, then remove the control shaft from the torque
converter housing. 9. Remove the detent arm and detent arm shaft from the main valve body.
10. Remove the main valve body (five bolts).
NOTE: Do not let the eight check balls fall out of the main valve body when removing the main
valve body.
11. Remove the ATF pump driven gear shaft, then remove the ATF pump gears. 12. Remove the
main separator plate and two dowel pins.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5212
13. Clean the inlet opening of the ATF strainer thoroughly with compressed air, then check that it is
in good condition, and the inlet opening is not
clogged.
14. Test the filter by pouring clean ATF fluid through the inlet opening. Replace the ATF strainer if it
is clogged or damaged.
NOTE: The ATF strainer can be reused if it is not clogged.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5213
Valve Body: Service and Repair Repair
NOTE: This repair is only necessary if one or more of the valves in a valve body do not slide
smoothly in their bores. You may use this procedure to free the valves in the valve bodies.
1. Soak a sheet of #600 abrasive paper in ATF for about 30 minutes. 2. Carefully tap the valve
body so the sticking valve drops out of its bore.
CAUTION: It may be necessary to use a small screwdriver to pry the valve free. Be careful not to
scratch the bore with the screwdriver.
3. Inspect the valve for any scuff marks. Use the ATF soaked #600 paper to polish off any burrs
that are on the valve, then wash the valve in solvent
and dry it with compressed air.
4. Roll up half a sheet of ATF soaked paper, and insert it in the valve bore of the sticking valve.
Twist the paper slightly, so that it unrolls and fits the
bore tightly, then polish the bore by twisting the paper as you push it in and out.
CAUTION: The valve body is aluminum and doesn't require much polishing to remove any burrs.
5. Remove the #600 paper and thoroughly wash the entire valve body in solvent, then dry it with
compressed air.
6. Coat the valve with ATF, then drop it into its bore. It should drop to the bottom of the bore under
its own weight. If not, repeat step 4, then retest. 7. Remove the valve, then thoroughly clean it and
the valve body with solvent. Dry all parts with compressed air, then reassemble using ATF as a
lubricant.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5214
Valve Body: Service and Repair Overhaul
ATF Pump
With A/T
1. Install the ATF pump gears and ATF pump driven gear shaft in the main valve body.
NOTE: Lubricate all parts with ATF during inspection.
- Install the ATF pump driven gear with its grooved and chamfered side facing up as shown.
2. Measure the side clearance of the ATF pump drive and driven gears. ATF Pump Gears Side
(Radial) Clearance: Standard (New):
- ATF Pump Drive Gear: 0.105 - 0.1325 mm (0.004 - 0.005 inch)
- ATF Pump Driven Gear: 0.035 - 0.0625 mm (0.0014 - 0.0025 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5215
3. Remove the ATF pump driven gear shaft. Measure the thrust clearance of the ATF pump driven
gear to-valve body. ATF Pump Drive/Driven Gear
Thrust (Axial) Clearance: Standard (New): 0.03 - 0.05 mm (0.001 - 0.002 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.07 mm (0.003 inch)
Main
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5216
Part 2 Of 2
NOTE:
- Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. Blow out
all passages.
- Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
- Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, see Valve Body Repair.
- Coat all parts with ATF during assembly.
CAUTION: Do not use a magnet to remove the check balls; it may magnetize the balls.
Secondary
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5217
NOTE:
- Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. Blow out
all passages.
- Replace the secondary valve body kit, P/N 27700 - P4R - 305 (The secondary valve body kit
includes the linear solenoid assembly) if any parts are worn or damaged.
- Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, see Valve Body Repair.
- Coat all parts with ATF during assembly.
- The CPC valve is installed in the secondary valve body, held in place by the lock bolt.
Regulator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5218
NOTE:
- Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. Blow out
all passages.
- Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
- Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, see Valve Body Repair.
1. Hold the regulator spring cap in place while removing the stop bolt. Once the stop bolt is
removed, release the spring cap slowly.
CAUTION: The regulator spring cap can pop out when the stop bolt is removed.
2. Reassembly is the reverse order of the disassembly procedure.
NOTE: Coat all parts with ATF during assembly.
- Align the hole in the regulator spring cap with the hole in the valve body, then press the spring
cap into the valve body, and tighten the stop bolt.
Lock-Up
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5219
NOTE:
- Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. Blow out
all passages.
- Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
- Check all valves for free movement. If any fail to slide freely, see Valve Body Repair.
- Coat all parts with ATF during assembly.
Servo
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5220
NOTE:
- Clean all parts thoroughly in solvent or carburetor cleaner, and dry with compressed air. Blow out
all passages
- Replace the valve body as an assembly if any parts are worn or damaged.
- Coat all parts with ATF during assembly.
- Replace the O-rings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5221
Valve Body: Service and Repair Assembly
NOTE: Coat all parts with ATF before assembly.
1. Install the valve, valve spring and cap in the valve body and secure with the roller.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5222
2. Set the spring in the valve and install it in the valve body. Push the spring in with a screwdriver,
then install the spring seat.
3. Install the valve, spring and cap in the valve body. Push the cap, then install the clip.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5223
Valve Body: Service and Repair Lower Valve Body Replacement
REPLACEMENT
WARNING: Make sure lifts, jacks, and safety stands are placed properly.
CAUTION: While removing and installing the lower valve body assembly, be sure not to allow dust
and other foreign particles to enter into the transmission.
1. Raise the front of the vehicle, and support it with safety stands. 2. Set the parking brake, and
block both rear wheels securely. 3. Remove the drain plug, and drain the Continuously Variable
Transmission (CVT) fluid. Reinstall the drain plug with a new sealing washer.
CAUTION: Keep all of other foreign particles out of the transmission.
4. Disconnect the 8P connector from the solenoid harness connector. 5. Remove the Automatic
Transmission Fluid (ATF) cooler hoses at the ATF cooler lines. Turn the ends of the ATF cooler
hoses up to prevent ATF
from flowing out, then plug the ATF cooler hoses.
CAUTION: Keep all of other foreign particles out of the transmission.
6. Remove the right front mount/bracket. 7. Remove the ATF cooler outlet line. 8. Remove the ATF
cooler line bracket bolt. 9. Remove the ATF pan (fourteen bolts).
10. Remove the ATF strainer (two bolts). 11. Remove the one bolt securing the solenoid harness
connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5224
12. Remove the lower valve body assembly (eight bolts). 13. Install the new lower valve body in the
reverse order of the removal procedure.
CAUTION: Keep all of other foreign particles out of the transmission.
NOTE: Replace the following parts:
- O-rings on the solenoid harness connector and the ATF strainer
- ATF pan gasket
- Sealing washers
- If the ATF cooler inlet line bracket is bent or warped, put it back to the original position.
14. Perform the start clutch calibration procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair
1. Remove fluid with syringe, disconnect clutch pipe and reservoir hose from master cylinder, then
plug clutch pipe and reservoir hose. 2. Pry out cotter pin and remove pedal pin yoke, then remove
nuts and master cylinder. 3. Reverse procedure to install. Bleed hydraulic system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect and plug clutch hydraulic hose from slave cylinder. 2. Remove slave cylinder to
clutch housing attaching bolts, then slave cylinder. 3. Reverse procedure to install. Bleed hydraulic
system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Clutch Switch
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Clutch Switch > Page 5237
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Interlock Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5244
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5245
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5246
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5247
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5248
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5249
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5250
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5251
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5252
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5253
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5254
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5255
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5256
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5257
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5258
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5259
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5260
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Cooler, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF Cooler Cleaner Information
Use Worm-Style Clamps With the ATF Cooler Cleaner
The spring-style clamps used on the ATF cooler lines are made to hold the cooler lines to the ATF
cooler under normal operating conditions. The ATF Cooler Cleaner (P/N GHTTTCF6H) uses high
pressure (100 psi) to do its job. With the pump motor running, the spring-style clamps can walk off
or disconnect, and you'll wind up with a real mess to clean up in your shop.
In March of this year, we sent each Honda dealership a pair of high-quality worm-style clamps to
replace the original spring-style clamps. These clamps were part of a cooler cleaner update kit, and
securely hold the cooler line in place. They've got a blue cap for easy identification. Need some
more? Just call G-TFC, Inc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5273
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5274
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5275
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5276
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5277
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5278
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5279
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5280
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5281
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5282
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5283
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5284
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5285
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5286
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5287
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5288
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5289
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor
Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Carrier Bearings > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Carrier Bearings: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07746-0030100 Driver, 40 mm I.D.
- Or Equivalent
NOTE: Check bearings for wear and rough rotation. If the bearings are OK, removal is not
necessary.
1. Remove the ball bearings using a bearing puller as shown.
2. Install new ball bearings using the special tool as shown.
NOTE: Drive the bearings squarely until they bottom against the carrier.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications
Axle Shaft: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs. Spindle Nut .........................................................
.............................................................................................................................................................
134
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5303
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair
NOTE: Replacement procedures for left and right driveshafts are the same.
1. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove front wheels. 2. Drain transaxle. 3. Raise locking
tab on spindle nut, then remove nut. 4. Remove damper fork, then the cotter pin from lower arm
ball joint castle nut and remove nut. 5. Install hex nut on ball joint. Ensure nut is flush with ball joint
pin end, or threaded section of ball joint pin might be damaged by ball joint
remover.
6. Separate ball joint and lower arm using ball joint remover tool No. 07MAC-SL00100, or
equivalent. Be careful not to damage ball joint boot. 7. Pry driveshaft assembly with screwdriver to
force set ring at driveshaft end past groove. 8. Pull on inboard joint and remove driveshaft from
differential case or bearing support as an assembly. Do not pull on driveshaft, as inboard joint
may come apart. Use care when prying out assembly, and pull it straight to avoid damaging
differential oil seal or intermediate shaft outer seal.
9. Pull knuckle outward and remove driveshaft outboard joint from front wheel hub using plastic
hammer.
10. Reverse procedure to install.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Constant Velocity
Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns
Constant Velocity Joint: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns
91-029
January 26, 1999
Applies To: ALL 1988 and later Models*
Clicking Noise While Turning (Supersedes 91-029, dated April 17, 1992)
Updated information is shown with asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
A clicking noise is heard while making right or left turns at 10 mph or less.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Worn outboard driveshaft joint.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the noisy outboard driveshaft joint.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Failed part: Use the replacement Part Number
Skill level: Repair Technician
PARTS INFORMATION
REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS
DIAGNOSIS
(Driving method)
1. Drive the car in a circle in an open parking lot at approximately 10 mph with the brakes slightly
applied.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Constant Velocity
Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5312
2. Have an assistant stand in the center of the circle and listen for the clicking noise.
3. Drive the car in the opposite direction. The assistant should be able to tell which axle is making
the noise.
DIAGNOSIS
(On-hoist method)
1. Raise the car on a hoist and start the engine.
2. With the transmission in first gear (manual transmission) or D4 (automatic transmission),
increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm.
3. Apply the brakes to load the engine speed to 1,500 rpm while maintaining the same throttle
position.
4. Turn the wheels slowly to full left and full right positions. Have an assistant listen to determine
which axle is making the noise.
NOTE:
A driveshaft with a light degree of noise may not be detected by this on-hoist method.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the driveshaft as described in Section 16 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Use diagonal cutters to cut the two boot bands and the outboard joint boot, then remove them
from the driveshaft.
3. Wipe off the grease to expose the outboard joint. Measure and record distance "A" (from the
splined end of the driveshaft to the inner race) as a reference for reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Constant Velocity
Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5313
4. Carefully clamp the driveshaft in a vise.
5. *Remove the outboard joint using the threaded adapter (see REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS) and
a commercially available 5/8" x 18 slide hammer.*
6. Remove and discard the "C" clip from the driveshaft. Clean and inspect the driveshaft splines
and ring groove for burrs or other defects.
7. Install the new outboard joint boot provided in the kit. Slide it slowly onto the driveshaft to avoid
damaging the boot.
8. Install the new "C" clip onto the ring groove of the driveshaft.
9. Insert the driveshaft in the new outboard joint. Make sure the "C" clip is centered on the shaft
and is resting against the chamfered edge of the inner race.
10. Remove the driveshaft from the vise.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Constant Velocity
Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5314
11. To drive the outboard joint on the rest of the way, pick up the assembly and let it fall from about
10 cm (4 to 5 in.) onto a hard surface.
NOTICE
Do not use a hammer; excessive force may damage the driveshaft.
12. Measure distance "A" (from the splines to the inner race of the joint). If the distance is more
than your measurement in Step 3, repeat Step 11.
13. When distance "A" equals your measurement in Step 3, the "C" clip should be seated in the
joint. Tap on the inner race with a plastic hammer to make sure the joint does not move on the
driveshaft.
14. Fit the small end of the boot into the boot groove on the driveshaft.
15. Install the small boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
16. Pack the outboard boot with the grease included in the kit. Pack the outboard joint with the
remaining grease, then fit the boot over the outboard joint.
17. Install the large boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
18. Reinstall the driveshaft assembly into the car. Refer to Section 16 of the appropriate service
manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Constant Velocity Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns
Constant Velocity Joint: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed
Turns
91-029
January 26, 1999
Applies To: ALL 1988 and later Models*
Clicking Noise While Turning (Supersedes 91-029, dated April 17, 1992)
Updated information is shown with asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
A clicking noise is heard while making right or left turns at 10 mph or less.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Worn outboard driveshaft joint.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the noisy outboard driveshaft joint.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Defect code: 042
Contention code: B07
Failed part: Use the replacement Part Number
Skill level: Repair Technician
PARTS INFORMATION
REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS
DIAGNOSIS
(Driving method)
1. Drive the car in a circle in an open parking lot at approximately 10 mph with the brakes slightly
applied.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Constant Velocity Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5320
2. Have an assistant stand in the center of the circle and listen for the clicking noise.
3. Drive the car in the opposite direction. The assistant should be able to tell which axle is making
the noise.
DIAGNOSIS
(On-hoist method)
1. Raise the car on a hoist and start the engine.
2. With the transmission in first gear (manual transmission) or D4 (automatic transmission),
increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm.
3. Apply the brakes to load the engine speed to 1,500 rpm while maintaining the same throttle
position.
4. Turn the wheels slowly to full left and full right positions. Have an assistant listen to determine
which axle is making the noise.
NOTE:
A driveshaft with a light degree of noise may not be detected by this on-hoist method.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the driveshaft as described in Section 16 of the appropriate service manual.
2. Use diagonal cutters to cut the two boot bands and the outboard joint boot, then remove them
from the driveshaft.
3. Wipe off the grease to expose the outboard joint. Measure and record distance "A" (from the
splined end of the driveshaft to the inner race) as a reference for reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Constant Velocity Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5321
4. Carefully clamp the driveshaft in a vise.
5. *Remove the outboard joint using the threaded adapter (see REQUIRED SPECIAL TOOLS) and
a commercially available 5/8" x 18 slide hammer.*
6. Remove and discard the "C" clip from the driveshaft. Clean and inspect the driveshaft splines
and ring groove for burrs or other defects.
7. Install the new outboard joint boot provided in the kit. Slide it slowly onto the driveshaft to avoid
damaging the boot.
8. Install the new "C" clip onto the ring groove of the driveshaft.
9. Insert the driveshaft in the new outboard joint. Make sure the "C" clip is centered on the shaft
and is resting against the chamfered edge of the inner race.
10. Remove the driveshaft from the vise.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Constant Velocity Joint: > 91-029 > Jan > 99 > Drivetrain - Clicking Noise On Low Speed Turns > Page 5322
11. To drive the outboard joint on the rest of the way, pick up the assembly and let it fall from about
10 cm (4 to 5 in.) onto a hard surface.
NOTICE
Do not use a hammer; excessive force may damage the driveshaft.
12. Measure distance "A" (from the splines to the inner race of the joint). If the distance is more
than your measurement in Step 3, repeat Step 11.
13. When distance "A" equals your measurement in Step 3, the "C" clip should be seated in the
joint. Tap on the inner race with a plastic hammer to make sure the joint does not move on the
driveshaft.
14. Fit the small end of the boot into the boot groove on the driveshaft.
15. Install the small boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
16. Pack the outboard boot with the grease included in the kit. Pack the outboard joint with the
remaining grease, then fit the boot over the outboard joint.
17. Install the large boot band provided in the kit. Bend both sets of locking tabs over, then lightly
tap them flat.
18. Reinstall the driveshaft assembly into the car. Refer to Section 16 of the appropriate service
manual.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5323
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Front Drive Assembly
NOTE: Prior to disassemble, mark rollers and roller grooves. Refer to Fig. 1 for driveshaft service.
1. Remove set ring from inboard joint. 2. Remove boot band by prying up locking tabs with
screwdriver and raising end of band. 3. Remove inboard joint, then remove rollers from spider. 4.
Remove circlip, then the spider from shaft using suitable bearing remover. 5. Remove stopper ring.
6. Wrap splines on driveshaft with vinyl tape to prevent damaging boots and dynamic damper, then
remove boot band and inboard boot. 7. Remove dynamic damper band and dynamic damper. 8.
Remove boot bands and outboard boot, then the vinyl tape. 9. Reverse procedure to install, noting
the following:
a. Pack inboard and outboard joints with molybdenum disulfide grease. b. Install rollers on spider
shafts, then slide spider assembly into inboard shaft joint. Avoid getting grease on rubber parts. c.
Position boots and install small end bands, then expand and compress boots until they return to
their normal shape and length. d. Install large end bands.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Revised CV Joint Boot
Band/Installation
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Revised CV Joint Boot
Band/Installation
98-018
July 22, 2003
Applies To: ALL Models
Driveshaft Boot Band Tool
(Supersedes 98-018, Boot Band Tool, dated April 14, 1998)
Updated information is shown by asterisks.
The replacement boot bands for the driveshaft CV joint boots have changed. The replacement
bands are a double loop type that require a special tool for proper installation.
* TOOL INFORMATION
Boot Band Tool: T/N KD-3191
This tool is already at your dealership. To order additional tools, call the Honda Tool and
Equipment Program at 1-888-424-6857. Phone lines are open Monday through Friday from 7:30
a.m. to 7:00 p.m. CT.*
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the old boot band(s). Take care not to damage the boot.
2. Remove and inspect the boot. Replace the boot if it is worn or damaged.
3. Install the boot, and fill it with the specified amount and type of grease. Refer to section 16 of the
appropriate service manual for the grease amount and type.
4. Adjust the driveshaft to the proper length. Refer to section 16 of the appropriate service manual.
5. Install the replacement boot band onto the large end of the boot with the end of the band facing
toward the front of the vehicle.
6. Take up the slack in the boot band by hand, and hold the boot band in place.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Revised CV Joint Boot
Band/Installation > Page 5328
7. Measure and mark the band with a felt-tip pen at the specified distance from the clip:
^ If you are installing a new boot, mark the band approximately 10 to 14 mm (0.4 to 0.6 in.) from
the clip.
^ If you are reinstalling the original boot, mark the band 10 mm (0.4 in.) from the clip.
8. Thread the free end of the band through the nose section of the boot band tool and into the slot
on the winding mandrel.
9. Take up the slack in the boot band by hand, then slowly turn the winding mandrel with a wrench.
Tighten the band until the mark you made in step 7 meets the edge of the clip.
10. Raise up the boot band tool to bend the free end of the band 90 degrees, then center-punch
the clip to hold the band temporarily.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Drivetrain - Revised CV Joint Boot
Band/Installation > Page 5329
11. Unwind the boot band tool, and cut off the excess 5 to 10 mm (0.2 to 0.4 in.) from the clip.
12. Secure the end of the boot band by tapping it down over the clip with a hammer.
13. Make sure that the boot band and clip do not interfere with anything and that the band does not
move.
14. If necessary, repeat steps 5 through 13 to install the boot band on the small end of the boot.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications End Play
End Play
End Play Front 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Rear 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5333
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Remove the wheels, then reinstall the wheel nuts. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown.
4. Measure the bearing end play by moving the disc in or outward. Front/Rear: Standard: 0 - 0.05
mm (0 - 0.002 inch) 5. If the bearing end play measurement is more than the standard, replace the
wheel bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5334
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Wheel bearings and hub on these models are an integral assembly and bearings cannot be
adjusted. If hub endplay exceeds 0.002 inch with spindle nut properly tightened, hub and bearing
assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint remover, 28 mm
- 07JAF-SH20110 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Pilot, 38 mm
- 07JAF-SH20120 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Shaft, 22.4 x 25.4 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm
- 07GAF-SE00401 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Base
- 07947-6340201 Driver Attachment 58 x 72 mm
- 07965-SD90100 Support Base
- 07GAF-SE00200 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Guide Attachment
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5337
2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5338
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5339
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5340
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5341
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5342
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5343
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 5344
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
The rear bearing is to be serviced with the wheel wheel hub as one unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Drive Plate Bolts ..................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 74 Nm (54 ft.lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5352
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
Remove the six drive plate bolts, then separate the drive plate from the crankshaft flange. After
installation, tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications
Flywheel: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5356
Flywheel: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the ring gear teeth for wear and damage. 2. Inspect the clutch disc mating surface on the
flywheel for wear, cracks, and burning.
3. Measure the flywheel runout using a dial indicator through at least two full turns. Push against
the flywheel each time you turn it to take up the
crankshaft thrust washer clearance.
NOTE: The runout can be measured with engine installed. Standard (New): 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
max. Service Limit: 0.15 mm (0.006 inch) If the runout exceeds the service limit, replace the
flywheel.
4. Turn the inner race of the ball bearing with your finger. The bail bearing should turn smoothly
and quietly. Check that the ball bearing outer race
fits tightly in the flywheel. If the inner race does not turn smoothly, quietly, or fit tight in the flywheel,
replace the ball bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5357
Flywheel: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07LAB-PV00100 Ring Gear Holder
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010100 Attachment, 32x35 mm
- Or Equivalent
1. Install the special tool. 2. Remove the flywheel mounting bolts in a crisscross pattern in several
steps as shown, and remove the flywheel.
3. Remove the ball bearing from the flywheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5358
4. Drive the new ball bearing into the flywheel using the special tools as shown. 5. Align the hole in
the flywheel with the crankshaft dowel pin and install the flywheel. Install the mounting bolts
finger-tight.
6. Install the special tool, then torque the flywheel mounting bolts in a crisscross pattern in several
steps as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
SRS components are located in this area Review the SRS component locations precautions and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5366
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5367
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5368
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5369
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5370
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5371
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5372
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5373
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5374
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5375
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5376
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5377
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5378
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5379
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5380
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5381
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5382
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5383
Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5384
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5385
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes ON. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come ON.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the Powertrain (except HX) or Transmission (HX) Control Module (PCM or TCM) detects an
abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request diagnostic trouble
codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4 (D for HX) indicator
light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 5388
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 5389
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5390
Shift Indicator: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D4]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5391
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral". 4. Move the shift lever
to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting nuts. 6.
Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when the shift
lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5395
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Bell Housing: Service and Repair
1. Remove the oil seal from the clutch housing.
2. Install the oil seal into the clutch housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Set Screw ............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.) Sealing Bolt .........................................................
................................................................................................................................. 25 Nm (18 ft.
lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Housing Replacement
Case: Service and Repair Transmission Housing Replacement
REMOVAL
NOTE: Place the clutch housing on two pieces of wood thick enough to keep the mainshaft from
hitting the workbench.
1. Remove the back-up light switch.
2. Remove transmission hanger.
3. remove the setting screws, washers, springs, and steel balls. 4. Loosen the transmission
housing attaching bolts in a crisscross pattern in several steps, then remove them. 5. Remove the
32 mm sealing bolt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Housing Replacement > Page 5405
6. Expand the snap ring on the countershaft ball bearing, and remove it from the groove using a
pair of snap ring pliers. 7. Separate the transmission housing from the clutch housing, and wipe it
clean of the sealant.
8. Remove the thrust shim, oil guide plate, and oil gutter plate from the transmission housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Housing Replacement > Page 5406
Case: Service and Repair Transmission Housing Seal Replacement
1. Remove the oil seal from the transmission housing.
2. Install the oil seal into the transmission housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Counter Gear Bearing, M/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Counter Gear Bearing: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07736-A01000A Adjustable Bearing Puller, 25-40 mm
- 07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm
- 07746-0010400 Attachment, 52 x 55 mm
- Or Equivalent
1. Remove the needle bearing using the special tool as shown, then remove the oil guide plate.
2. Install the oil guide plate, then drive the needle bearing into the clutch housing using the special
tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Countershaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Countershaft Standard Dimensions
A: 30.00-30.015 mm (1.1811-1.1817 inch) B: 35.984-36.00 mm (1.4167-1.4173 inch) C:
24.980-24.993 mm (0.9835-0.9840 inch)
Countershaft Service Limit Dimensions
A: 29.950 mm (1.1791 inch) B: 35.930 mm (1.4146 inch) C: 24.930 mm (0.9815 inch)
Countershaft Runout
Standard (Max): 0.02 mm (0.001 inch) Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
Clearance Between Countershaft And 1st Gear
Standard 0.03-0.10 mm (0.001-0.004 inch) Service Limit 0.22 mm (0.009 inch)
1st Gear Thickness
Standard 30.41-30.44 mm (1.197-1.198 inch) Service Limit 30.36 mm (1.195 inch)
Clearance Between 2nd And 3rd Gears
Standard 0.04-0.12 mm (0.002-0.005 inch) Service Limit 0.24 mm (0.009 inch)
2nd Gear Spacer Collar Thickness
Standard 32.03-32.06 mm (1.261-1.262 inch) Service Limit 32.01 mm (1.260 inch)
2nd Gear Thickness
Standard 31.92-31.97 mm (1.257-1.259 inch) Service Limit 31.85 mm (1.254 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5413
Locknut (Tighten in 3 steps)
First 108 Nm (79.6 ft. lbs.) Second Back Off to 0 Third 108 Nm (79.6 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5414
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5415
Countershaft: Testing and Inspection
CLEARANCE INSPECTION
NOTE: If replacement is required, always replace the synchro sleeve and hub as a set.
1. Measure the clearance between the countershaft and 1st gear.
- Standard: 0.03 - 0.10 mm (0.001 - 0.004 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.22 mm (0.009 inch)
2. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the thickness of 1st gear.
- Standard: 30.41 - 30.44 mm (1.197 - 1.198 inch)
- Service Limit: 30.36 mm (1.195 inch)
- If the thickness of 1st gear is less than the service limit, replace 1st gear with a new one.
- If the thickness of 1 st gear is within the service limit, replace the 1st/2nd synchro hub with a new
one.
3. Measure the clearance between 2nd and 3rd gears.
- Standard: 0.04 - 0.12 mm (0.002 - 0.005 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.24 mm (0.009 inch)
4. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the thickness of the spacer collar.
Standard: 32.03 - 32.06 mm (1.261 - 1.262 inch) 5. If the thickness is less than the service limit,
replace the spacer collar with a new one. If the thickness is within the service limit, measure the
thickness of 2nd gear. Standard: 31.92 - 31.97 mm (1.257 - 1.259 inch)
- Service Limit: 31.85 mm (1.254 inch)
- If the thickness of 2nd gear is less than the service limit, replace 2nd gear with a new one.
- If the thickness of 2nd gear is within the service limit, replace the 1st/2nd synchro hub with a new
one.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Countershaft, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 5416
Countershaft: Service and Repair
For information regarding the service and repair of this components, and the system that it is a part
of, please refer to Manual Transmission/Transaxle; Service and Repair; Transmission Overhaul.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Ring Gear, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 101 Nm (74.5 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Ring Gear, M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5421
Ring Gear: Service and Repair
1. Remove the bolts in a crisscross pattern in several steps, then remove the final driven gear from
the differential carrier.
NOTE: The final driven gear bolts have left-hand threads.
2. Install the final driven gear by tightening the bolts in a crisscross pattern in several steps.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Plug .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fill Plug, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Fill Plug: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Plug .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 44 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
S40 Fluid At Oil Change ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 1.8 l (1.9 US qt.) Fluid At Overhaul ........................................
................................................................................................................................................ 1.9 l 2.0
US qt.) S4C Fluid At Oil Change .........................................................................................................
.......................................................................... 2.2 l (2.3 US qt.) Fluid At Overhaul ...........................
............................................................................................................................................................
2.3 l (2.4 US qt.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5432
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission/Transaxle Fluid
Genuine Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) preferred, or an API service SG, SH or SJ grade
motor oil with a viscosity of SAE 10W-30 or 10W-40 as a temporary replacement. An SG grade is
preferred but SH or SJ may be used if SG is not available. However, motor oil does not have the
proper additives and continued use may cause stiffer shifting. Drain and replace with Genuine
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF) as soon as convenient.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5433
Fluid - M/T: Testing and Inspection
TRANSMISSION OIL CHECK
NOTE: Check the transmission oil with the engine OFF and the vehicle on level ground.
1. Remove the oil filler plug, then check the level and condition of the oil. 2. The oil level must be
up to the filler hole. If it is below the hole, add oil until it runs out, then reinstall the oil filler plug with
a new washer. 3. If the transmission oil is dirty, remove the drain plug and drain the oil. 4. Reinstall
the drain plug with a new washer, and refill the transmission with the recommended oil to the
proper level.
NOTE: The drain plug washer should be replaced at every oil change.
5. Reinstall the oil filler plug with a new washer. Oil Capacity
- 1.8 l (1.9 US qt.) at oil change
- 1.9 l 12.0 US qt.) at overhaul
NOTE: Always use Genuine Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF). Using motor oil can cause
stiffer shifting because it does not contain the proper additives.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Synchronizer
Hub, M/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Synchronizer Hub: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect gear teeth on all synchro hubs and synchro sleeves for rounded off corners, which
indicate wear.
2. Install each synchro hub in its mating synchro sleeve, and check for freedom of movement.
NOTE: If replacement is required, always replace the synchro sleeve and synchro hub as a set.
3. When assembling the synchro sleeve and synchro hub, be sure to match the three sets of longer
teeth (120 degrees apart) on the synchro sleeve
with the three sets of deeper grooves in the synchro hub.
CAUTION: Do not install the synchro sleeve with its longer teeth in the synchro hub slots because
it will damage the spring ring.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Synchronizer
Hub, M/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5438
Synchronizer Hub: Service and Repair
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect gear teeth on all synchro hubs and synchro sleeves for rounded off corners, which
indicate wear.
2. Install each synchro hub in its mating synchro sleeve, and check for freedom of movement.
NOTE: If replacement is required, always replace the synchro sleeve and synchro hub as a set.
3. When assembling the synchro sleeve and synchro hub, be sure to match the three sets of longer
teeth (120 degrees apart) on the synchro sleeve
with the three sets of deeper grooves in the synchro hub.
CAUTION: Do not install the synchro sleeve with its longer teeth in the synchro hub slots because
it will damage the spring ring.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Synchronizer
Ring, M/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Synchronizer Ring: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the synchro ring and gear.
- A: Inspect the inside of the synchro ring for wear.
- B: Inspect the synchro sleeve teeth and matching teeth on the synchro ring for wear (rounded off).
- C: Inspect the synchro sleeve teeth and matching teeth on the gear for wear (rounded off).
- D: Inspect the gear hub thrust surface for wear.
- E: Inspect the cone surface for wear and roughness.
- F: Inspect the teeth on all gears for uneven wear, scoring, galling, and cracks.
2. Coat the cone surface of the gear with oil, and place the synchro ring on the matching gear.
Rotate the synchro ring, making sure that it does not
slip. Measure the clearance between the synchro ring and gear all the way around.
NOTE: Hold the synchro ring against the gear evenly while measuring the clearance. Synchro
Ring-to-Gear Clearance:
- Standard: 0.73 - 1.18 mm (0.029 - 0.046 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Synchronizer
Ring, M/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5442
- Service Limit: 0.4 mm (0.02 inch)
- If the clearance is less than the service limit, replace the synchro ring and synchro cone.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft Bearing/Bushing,
M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Mainshaft Bearing/Bushing: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07736-A01000A Adjustable Bearing Puller, 25-40 mm
- 07746-0010300 Attachment, 42 x 47 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010400 Attachment, 52 x 55 mm
- Or Equivalent
1. Remove the ball bearing using the special tool as shown.
2. Remove the oil seal from the clutch housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft Bearing/Bushing,
M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5446
3. Drive the new oil seal into the clutch housing using the special tools as shown.
4. Drive the ball bearing into the clutch housing using the special tools as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Mainshaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Clearance Between 2nd And 3rd Gears
Standard 0.06-0.21 mm (0.002-0.008 inch) Service Limit 0.33 mm (0.013 inch)
Clearance Between 4th Gear And Spacer Collar
Standard 0.06-0.19 mm (0.002-0.007 inch) Service Limit 0.31 mm (0.012 inch)
Clearance Between Spacer Collar And 5th Gear
Standard 0.06-0.19 mm (0.002-0.007 inch) Service Limit 0.31 mm (0.012 inch)
3rd Gear Thickness
Standard 30.22-30.27 mm (1.190-1.192 inch) service Limit 30.15 mm (1.187 inch)
4th Gear Spacer Collar Distance
Standard 22.82-22.86 mm (0.898-0.900 inch) Service Limit 22.81 mm (0.898 inch)
4th Gear Thickness
Standard 30.12-30.17 mm (1.186-1.188 inch) Service Limit 30.05 mm (1.183 inch)
5th Gear Space Collar Distance
Standard 23.53-23.56 mm (0.926-0.928 inch) Service Limit 23.51 mm (0.926 inch)
5th Gear Thickness
Standard 28.42-28.47 mm (1.119-1.121 inch) Service Limit 28.35 mm (1.116 inch)
Mainshaft Standard Dimensions
A: 21.987-22.000 mm (0.8656-0.8661 inch) B: 26.980-26.993 mm (1.0622-1.0627 inch) C:
33.984-34.000 mm (1.3380-1.3386 inch) D: 25.977-25.990 mm (1.0227-1.0232 inch)
Mainshaft Service Limit Dimensions
A: 21.930 mm (0.8634 inch) B: 26.930 mm (1.0602 inch) C: 33.930 mm (1.3358 inch) D: 25.920
mm (1.0205 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5450
Mainshaft Runout
Standard: 0.02 mm (0.001 inch) Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5451
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5452
Mainshaft: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: If replacement is required, always replace the synchro sleeve and hub as a set.
1. Measure the clearance between 2nd and 3rd gears.
- Standard: 0.06 - 0.21 mm (0.002 - 0.008 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.33 mm (0.013 inch)
2. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the thickness of 3rd gear.
- Standard: 30.22 - 30.27 mm (1.190 - 1.192 inch)
- Service Limit: 30.15 mm (1.187 inch)
- If the thickness of 3rd gear is less than the service limit, replace 3rd gear with a new one.
- If the thickness of 3rd gear is within the service limit, replace the 3rd/4th synchro hub with a new
one.
3. Measure the clearance between 4th gear and the spacer collar.
- Standard: 0.06 - 0.19 mm (0.002 - 0.007 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.31 mm (0.012 inch)
4. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure distance (A) on the spacer collar.
- Standard: 22.82 - 22.86 mm (0.898 - 0.900 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5453
- Service Limit: 22.81 mm (0.898 inch)
5. If distance (A) is less than the service limit, replace the spacer collar with a new one. If distance
(A) is within the service limit, measure the
thickness of 4th gear. Standard: 30.12 - 30.17 mm (1.186 - 1.188 inch)
- Service limit: 30.05 mm (1.183 inch)
- If the thickness of 4th gear is less than the service limit, replace 4th gear with a new one.
- If the thickness of 4th gear is within the service limit, replace the 3rd/4th synchro hub with a new
one.
6. Measure the clearance between the spacer collar and 5th gear.
- Standard: 0.06 - 0.19 mm (0.002 - 0.007 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.31 mm (0.012 inch)
7. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure distance (B) on the spacer collar.
- Standard: 23.53 - 23.56 mm (0.926 - 0.928 inch)
- Service Limit: 23.51 mm (0.926 inch)
8. If distance (B) is less than the service limit, replace the spacer collar with a new one. If distance
(B) is within the service limit, measure thickness
of 5th gear. Standard: 28.42 - 28.47 mm (1.119 - 1.121 inch)
- Service Limit: 28.35 mm (1.116 inch)
- If the thickness of 5th gear is less than the service limit, replace 5th gear with a new one.
- If the thickness of 5th gear is within the service limit, replace the 5th synchro hub with a new one.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5454
Mainshaft: Adjustments
1. Remove the thrust shim and oil guide plate from the transmission housing
2. Install the 3rd/4th synchro hub, spacer collar, 5th synchro hub, ball bearing, and thrust washer
on the mainshaft. Install the assembly in the
transmission housing.
3. Measure the distance (B) between the end of the transmission housing and thrust washer.
NOTE: Use a straight edge and vernier caliper.
- Measure at three locations and average the readings.
4. Measure the distance (C) between the surfaces of the clutch housing and bearing inner race.
NOTE: Use a straight edge and depth gauge.
- Measure at three locations and average the readings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5455
5. Select the proper shim on the basis of the following calculations:
NOTE: Use only one thrust shim. (Basic Formula) = (B) + (C) - 0.95 = shim thickness. Example of
calculation: Distance (B) (2.00 mm) + Distance (C) (0.09 mm) = 2.09 mm subtract the spring
washer height (0.95 mm) = the required thrust shim (1.14 mm)
6. Install the oil guide plate and selected thrust shim in the transmission housing.
NOTE: Clean the thrust washer, spring washer and thrust shim thoroughly before installation.
- Install the thrust washer, spring washer and thrust shim properly.
7. Install the thrust washer and spring washer in the mainshaft. 8. Install the mainshaft in the clutch
housing. 9. Place the transmission housing over the mainshaft and onto the clutch housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5456
10. Tighten the clutch and transmission housings with several 8 mm bolts.
NOTE: It is not necessary to use sealing agent between the housings. 8 x 1.25 mm to 27 Nm (20 ft.
lbs.)
11. Tap the mainshaft with a plastic hammer.
12. Check the thrust clearance in the manner described below:
CAUTION: Measurement should be made at room temperature.
a. Slide the mainshaft base and the collar over the mainshaft.
b. Attach the mainshaft holder to the mainshaft as follows:
NOTE: Back-out the mainshaft holder bolt and loosen the two hex bolts.
- Fit the holder over the mainshaft so its lip is toward the transmission.
- Align the mainshaft holder's lip around the groove at the inside of the mainshaft splices, then
tighten the hex bolts.
c. Seat the mainshaft fully by tapping on the end with a plastic hammer. d. Thread the mainshaft
holder bolt in until it just contacts the wide surface of the mainshaft base.
e. Zero a dial gauge on the end of the mainshaft. f.
Turn the mainshaft holder bolt clockwise; stop turning when the dial gauge has reached its
maximum movement. The reading on the dial gauge is the amount of mainshaft end play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5457
CAUTION: Turning the mainshaft holder bolt more than 60 degrees after the needle of the dial
gauge stops moving may damage the transmission.
g. If the reading is within the standard, the clearance is correct. If the reading is not within the
standard, recheck the shim thickness. Standard:
0.11 - 0.18 mm (0.004 - 0.007 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5458
Mainshaft: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07746-0030100 Driver, 40 mm I.D.
- 07746-0030400 Attachment, 35 mm I.D.
- 07746-0030300 Attachment, 30 mm I.D.
- Or Equivalent
DISASSEMBLE
NOTE: Before disassembling, inspect the gear clearances. See: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the interlock guide bolt from under the clutch housing. 2. Remove the shift arm B
attaching bolt.
3. Remove the mainshaft and countershaft assemblies with the shift fork from the clutch housing.
NOTE: Before removing the mainshaft and countershaft assemblies, tape the mainshaft splines to
protect the seal.
4. Inspect mainshaft assembly clearance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5459
5. Remove the ball bearing using a bearing puller as shown.
CAUTION: Remove the synchro hubs using a press and steel blocks as shown. Use of a jaw-type
puller can cause damage to the gear teeth.
6. Support 4th gear on steel blocks, and press the main shaft out of the 5th synchro hub as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5460
7. Support the 3rd gear on steel blocks, and press the mainshaft out of the 3rd/4th synchro hub as
shown.
INSPECT
1. Inspect the gear surface and bearing surface for wear and damage, then measure the mainshaft
at points A, B. C, and D.
Standard:
A: 21.987 - 22.000 mm (0.8656 - 0.8661 inch) B: 26.980 - 26.993 mm (1.0622 - 1.0627 inch) C:
33.984 - 34.000 mm (1.3380 - 1.3386 inch) D: 25.977 - 25.990 mm (1.0227 - 1.0232 inch)
Service Limit:
A: 21.930 mm (0.8634 inch) B: 26.930 mm (1.0602 inch) C: 33.930 mm (1.3358 inch) D: 25.920
mm (1.0205 inch)
NOTE: If any part of the mainshaft is less than the service limit, replace it with a new one.
2. Inspect for runout.
- Standard (max): 0.02 mm (0.001 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.05 mm (0.002 inch)
NOTE: Support the mainshaft at both ends as shown. If the runout is more than the service limit,
replace the mainshaft with a new one.
ASSEMBLE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5461
CAUTION: When installing the 3rd/4th and 5th synchro hubs, support the shaft on steel blocks, and
install the synchro hubs using a press.
NOTE: Refer to disassemble for reassembly sequence.
1. Support 2nd gear on steel blocks, then install the 3rd/4th synchro hub using the special tools and
a press as shown.
2. Install the 3rd/4th synchro sleeve by aligning the stops of the 3rd/4th synchro sleeve and hub.
NOTE: After installing, Check the operation of the 3rd/4th synchro hub set.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Mainshaft, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5462
3. Install the 5th synchro hub using the special.tools and a press as shown.
4. Install the ball bearing using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Install the ball bearing with the tapered end facing down.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Reverse Idler Gear >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Reverse Idler Gear: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the reverse shift holder.
2. Remove the reverse idler gear shaft and reverse idler gear.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Shift Fork: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Reverse Shift Fork And 5th/Reverse Shift Piece Pin Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.05-0.35 mm (0.002-0.014 inch) Service Limit ..............................................................
................................................................................................................... 0.5 mm (0.02 inch)
Reverse Shift Fork And Reverse Idler Gear Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................ 0.5-1.1 mm (0.02-0.04 inch) Service Limit ..............................................................
................................................................................................................... 1.8 mm (0.07 inch)
Reverse Fork Width
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 12.7-13.0 mm (0.500-0.512 inch)
Reverse Shift Fork Groove Width
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 7.05-7.25 mm (0.278-0.285 inch)
Shift Fork And Matching Synchro Sleeve Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.35-0.65 mm (0.014-0.026 inch) Service Limit ..............................................................
................................................................................................................... 1.0 mm (0.04 inch)
Shift Fork Fingers Thickness
3rd/4th .................................................................................................................................................
........................ 7.4-7.6 mm (0.291-0.299 inch) 1st/2nd, 5th ...............................................................
................................................................................................... 6.2-6.4 mm (0.244-0.252 inch)
Shift Fork And Shift Arm Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................ 0.2-0.5 mm (0.008-0.020 inch) Service Limit ..............................................................
................................................................................................................. 0.8 mm (0.030 inch)
Shift Fork Groove
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................... 13.2-13.4 mm (0.520-0.528 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5469
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MBS Shift Piece
Shift Fork: Testing and Inspection MBS Shift Piece
1. Measure the width of the MBS shift piece.
- Standard: 6.9 - 7.1 mm (0.272 - 0.280 inch)
- Service Limit: 6.8 mm (0.268 inch)
2. If the width of the MBS shift piece is less than the service limit, replace the MBS shift piece.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MBS Shift Piece > Page 5472
Shift Fork: Testing and Inspection Reverse Shift Holder
CLEARANCE
1. Measure the clearance between the reverse shift fork and 5th/reverse shift piece pin.
- Standard: 0.05 - 0.35 mm (0.002 - 0.014 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.5 mm (0.02 inch)
2. If the clearances are more than the service limit, measure the widths of the groove in the reverse
shift fork. Standard: 7.05 - 7.25 mm (0.278 0.285 inch) If the widths of the grooves are not within the standard, replace the reverse shift holder with a new
one.
- If the width of the grooves are within the standard, replace the 5th/reverse shift piece with a new
one.
3. Measure the clearance between the reverse idler gear and the reverse shift fork.
- Standard: 0.5 - 1.1 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
- Service Limit: 1.8 mm (0.07 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MBS Shift Piece > Page 5473
4. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the width of the reverse shift fork.
Standard: 12.7 - 13.0 mm (0.500 - 0.512 inch)
- If the width is not within the standard, replace the reverse shift holder with a new one.
- If the width is within the standard, replace the reverse idler gear with a new one.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MBS Shift Piece > Page 5474
Shift Fork: Testing and Inspection Shift Fork Clearance
NOTE: The synchro sleeve and the synchro hub should be replaced as a set.
1. Measure the clearance between each shift fork and its matching synchro sleeve.
- Standard: 0.35 - 0.65 mm (0.014 - 0.026 inch)
- Service Limit: 1.0 mm (0.04 inch)
2. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the thickness of the shift fork fingers.
Standard:
- 3rd/4th: 7.4 - 7.6 mm (0.291 - 0.299 inch)
- 1st/2nd, 5th: 6.2 - 6.4 mm (0.244 - 0.252 inch)
- If the thickness of the shift fork fingers is not within the standard, replace the shift fork with a new
one.
- If the thickness of the shift fork fingers is within the standard, replace the synchro sleeve with a
new one.
3. Measure the clearance between the shift piece or shift fork and the shift arm B.
- Standard: 0.2 - 0.5 mm (0.008 - 0.02 inch)
- Service Limit: 0.8 mm (0.03 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MBS Shift Piece > Page 5475
4. If the clearance is more than the service limit, measure the groove of the shift piece or shift fork.
Standard: 13.2 - 13.4 mm (0.520 - 0.528 inch).
NOTE: If the groove of the shift piece or shift fork is not within the standard, replace the shift piece
or shift fork with a new one. If the groove of the shift piece or shift fork is within the standard,
replace the shift arm B with a new one.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Selector
Shaft, M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Selector Shaft: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
NOTE: The steel balls are all of the same size (5/16 inch).
1. Remove the differential assembly. 2. Remove the 28 mm plug bolt and 1st/2nd select spring. 3.
Remove the shift arm C attaching bolt. 4. Remove the shift arm shaft.
NOTE: Be careful not to lose the steel ball.
5. Remove the steel ball, spring, and collar. 6. Remove shift arms C and B. and the interlock, then
remove the reverse select spring and retainer. 7. Remove the shift arm A attaching bolt, the set ball
spring bolt, set spring, and steel ball. 8. Remove the shift rod, then remove the shift arm A. 9.
Remove the reverse lock cam.
10. Remove the magnet.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] > Component Information > Locations > Page
5485
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5489
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5490
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5491
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5492
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch Signal <--> [Brake Switch - TCC] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5501
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component Information > Locations > Page 5505
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5509
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5512
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5513
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5514
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5515
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5516
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5517
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5518
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5519
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5520
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5521
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5522
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5523
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5524
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5525
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5526
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5527
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5528
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5529
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5530
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5531
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5532
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
> Page 5539
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
> Page 5540
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
> Page 5541
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
> Page 5542
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 5543
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5549
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5550
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5551
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5552
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5553
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5554
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5555
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5556
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5557
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5558
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5559
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5560
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5561
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5562
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5563
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5564
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5565
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - CVT > Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.8 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Key Interlock Solenoid Test > Page 5578
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection Shift Lock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the shift lock solenoid 2P connector.
3. Connect battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.2 terminal of the solenoid
momentarily.
NOTE: Do not connect power to the No.2 (-) terminal (reverse polarity) or you will damage the
diode inside the solenoid.
4. Check that the shift lock releases when the release lever is pushed, and check that it locks when
the release lever is released. 5. If the solenoid does not work, replace the solenoid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's
Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5587
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: > 00-012 > Jun >
01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5588
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st
Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set
00-012
June 26, 2001
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED 1997-99 CR-V - See VEHICLES
AFFECTED
Harsh Shifting Automatic Transmission (Supersedes 00-012, dated June 20, 2000)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and black bars.
SYMPTOM
*The transmission shifts harshly, or it may stay in first gear. The harsh shifting is more noticeable
on the 1-2 and 2-3 upshifts under light throttle. It is not affected by operating temperature. The MIL
may be on with DTC P0730 or P0715 stored.*
PROBABLE CAUSE
*Contamination of the linear solenoid and its associated passages inside the transmission, or a
broken spring internal to the transmission.*
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CORRECTIVE ACTION
*Flush the transmission with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1, then replace the linear solenoid. If shift feel
is not affected, replace the transmission.*
PARTS INFORMATION
Linear Solenoid Assembly: P/N 28250-P4R-315, H/C 5317219
Drain Bolt Washer: P/N 90471-PX4-000, H/C 3300936
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1: P/N 08200-9001, H/C 6512628
Civic and 2WD CR-V - 11.6 quarts required 4WD CR-V - 12.4 quarts required
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5594
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Drain the transmission. Refill it with Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
3. Start the engine.
4. With your foot on the brake pedal, shift the transmission to D4
5. Release the brake pedal. Press on the accelerator, and bring the speedometer up to 50 mph.
Make sure the transmission shifts through the first three lower gears and into fourth, and that the
torque converter locks up.
6. Apply the brakes to stop the front wheels.
7. Shift to reverse, and then to neutral.
8. Repeat the shifting procedure (steps 4 through 7) four more times.
9. Turn off the engine.
10. Repeat the above drain, refill, and shifting procedure (steps 2 through 9) two more times.
11. Drain the transmission. Reinstall the drain bolt with a new washer. Refill the transmission with
Genuine Honda ATF-Z1.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Shift Control Solenoid Valve: >
00-012 > Jun > 01 > A/T - Harsh Shifts/Stays in 1st Gear/MIL ON/DTC's Set > Page 5595
12. Disconnect the linear solenoid electrical connector. Remove the mounting bolts, then remove
the linear solenoid.
13. Inspect the linear solenoid mounting surface on the transmission. Remove any contamination.
14. Install the new linear solenoid. Reconnect the electrical connector.
15. Use the PGM Tester to erase any DTCs in the powertrain control module (PCM).
*16. Test-drive the vehicle to check the shift feel. If it still shifts harshly, install a remanufactured
transmission.*
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5596
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Locations
Without CVT
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Control Solenoid Valve <--> [Shift Solenoid, A/T] >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5597
Shift Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Shift control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and shift control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the shift control solenoid valve assembly, and install a new
shift control solenoid valve A/B with
a new filter/gasket and the clamp bracket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Resistance ...........................................................................................................................................
............................................................ 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5602
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Alternative View
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Alternative View > Page 5605
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Locations Photo 30
Lower Front Of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5606
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the linear solenoid connector.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 1 and the No. 2 terminals of the linear solenoid
connector.
STANDARD: 4.0 - 9.0 Ohms
3. If the resistance is out of specification, replace the linear solenoid assembly. 4. Connect the No.
2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive terminal and connect the No. 1
terminal to the battery negative
terminal. A clicking sound should be heard.
5. If not, remove the linear solenoid assembly. 6. Check that the linear solenoid fluid passage for
dust or dirt. 7. Connect the No. 2 terminal of the linear solenoid connector to the battery positive
terminal and connect the No. 1 terminal to the battery negative
terminal. Check that the valve moves.
8. Disconnect one of the battery terminals and check that the valve releases.
NOTE: You can see the valve movement through the fluid passage in the mounting surface of the
linear solenoid assembly.
9. If the valve binds, or moves sluggishly, or the linear solenoid does not operate, replace the linear
solenoid assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5607
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove the mounting bolts and the linear solenoid assembly. 2. Clean the mounting surface
and fluid passage of the linear solenoid assembly and transmission housing. 3. Install a new linear
solenoid assembly with a new gasket.
NOTE: Do not pinch the gasket when installing the linear solenoid; make sure that the gasket is
installed properly in the mounting groove of the linear solenoid.
4. Check the linear solenoid connector for rust, dirt or oil, and connect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Electrical Specifications
Without CVT
Solenoid Valve A
Between terminal 2 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Solenoid Valve B
Between terminal 1 and ground
..............................................................................................................................................................
14 - 25 Ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 5612
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Mechanical Specifications
Without CVT
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 12 Nm (8.7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5613
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Locations
Without CVT
Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5614
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Testing and Inspection
Without CVT
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly.
2. Measure the resistance between the No. 2 terminal (solenoid valve A) of the lock-up control
solenoid valve connector and body ground, and
between the No. 1 terminal (solenoid valve B) and body ground.
STANDARD: 14 - 25 Ohms
3. Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if the resistance is out of specification. 4. If
the resistance is within the standard, connect the No. 1 terminal of the lock-up control solenoid
valve connector to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Connect the No. 2 terminal to the battery positive terminal.
- A clicking sound should be heard.
- Replace the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly if no clicking sound is heard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves <--> [Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5615
Lock Up Control Solenoid Valves: Service and Repair
Without CVT
NOTE: Lock-up control solenoid valves A and B must be removed/replaced as an assembly.
1. Remove the mounting bolts and lock-up control solenoid valve A/B assembly. 2. Clean the
mounting surface and fluid passages of the lock-up control solenoid valve assembly, and install a
new lock-up control solenoid valve
A/B with a new filter/gasket.
3. Check the connector for rust, dirt or oil, and reconnect it securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
SRS components are located in this area Review the SRS component locations precautions and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5623
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5624
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5625
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5626
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5627
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5628
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5629
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5630
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5631
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5632
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5633
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5634
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5635
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5636
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5637
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5638
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5639
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5640
Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5641
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5642
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes ON. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come ON.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the Powertrain (except HX) or Transmission (HX) Control Module (PCM or TCM) detects an
abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request diagnostic trouble
codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4 (D for HX) indicator
light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 5645
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 5646
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5647
Shift Indicator: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D4]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 5648
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral". 4. Move the shift lever
to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting nuts. 6.
Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when the shift
lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 5652
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) <--> [Control Module, A/T] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5658
Powertrain Control Module (PCM): Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5662
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5663
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5664
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock System
Shift Lock System
1. Disconnect the 8P connector from the interlock control unit. 2. Inspect the connector and socket
terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Shift Interlock Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5665
- If all the input tests prove OK, substitute a known-good control unit, and recheck the system. If the
check is OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
NOTE: If the shift lock solenoid clicks when the ignition switch is turned ON (II) and you step on the
brake pedal (with the shift lever in [P]), the shift lock system is electronically normal; if the shift
lever cannot be shifted from [P], test the A/T gear position switch, park pin switch.
Reconnect the 8P connector to the interlock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch Signal <--> [Brake Switch - TCC] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Mainshaft Sensor: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bolt ......................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Mainshaft Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5674
Mainshaft Sensor: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component
Information > Locations
Park Pin Switch: Locations
Left Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Park Pin Switch <--> [Shift Interlock Switch] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5678
Park Pin Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the park pin switch. 3. Check for
continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with:
- the shift lever any position other than [P], or
- the push button pushed in [P].
There should be continuity.
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals with the shift lever in [P] and the push
button released. There should be no continuity.
If necessary, replace the park pin switch.
NOTE: Park pin switch 4P connector No.1 and No.2 terminals are for A/T gear position console
light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications
A/T Gear Position Signal: Specifications
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 ft.lb.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5682
A/T Gear Position Signal: Locations
Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5685
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5686
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5687
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5688
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5689
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5690
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5691
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5692
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5693
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5694
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5695
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5696
A/T Gear Position Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5697
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5698
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5699
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5700
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5701
All Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5702
A/T Gear Position Signal: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes on. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come on.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the powertrain (all except '96-'98 CVT) or transmission ('96-'98 CVT) control module (PCM
or TCM) detects an abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request
diagnostic trouble codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4
(D for CVT) indicator light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5703
A/T Gear Position Signal: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5704
A/T Gear Position Signal: Adjustments
1. Shift to the P position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of D4 or D position
[within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No. 1 and No. 7 terminals
in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket.
- If there is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position N in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > A/T Gear Position Signal <--> [Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5705
A/T Gear Position Signal: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown above. 4.
Move the shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two
mounting nuts. 6. Test the switch in the P and N position of the shift lever. The engine should start
when the shift lever is in position P anywhere in the range of free
play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Driven Pulley Speed Sensor
Top of Transmission (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5712
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Drive Pulley Speed Sensor
Right Side Lower Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5713
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Mainshaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Front of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5714
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Countershaft Speed Sensor
Lower Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Driven Pulley Speed Sensor > Page 5715
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Secondary Gear Shaft Speed Sensor
Right Side Rear of Engine Compartment (CVT)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5716
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the 6 mm bolt and the countershaft speed sensor from the right side cover. 2. Remove
the 6 mm bolt and the mainshaft speed sensor from the transmission housing. 3. Replace the
0-ring with a new one before installing the countershaft speed sensor or the mainshaft speed
sensor.
NOTE: Install the mainshaft speed sensor washer on the mainshaft speed sensor. The mainshaft
speed sensor washer is used on models with the D16Y7 engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5722
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5723
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5724
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5725
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5726
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5727
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5728
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5729
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5730
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5731
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5732
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5733
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5734
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5735
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5736
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5737
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, CVT > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5738
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - CVT > Transmission Speed Sensor, CVT > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation Precautions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Vehicle Speed Sensor Installation
Precautions
Install VSS Properly to Avoid Reman A/T Damage
We can't emphasize enough how important it is to follow, to the letter, the installation instructions
that come with a reman A/T. These instructions help ensure that you avoid damaging the A/T and
score a successful repair.
This is particularly true when it comes to installing the vehicle speed sensor (VSS). Step 6 of the
instructions tells you to make sure its gear is fully engaged and the VSS is fully seated before you
tighten the retaining bolt.
If you don't install the VSS properly, the speed sensor gear will get stripped and the A/T will be
seriously damaged. So don't take risks with your customer's vehicle. Always follow these
instructions to the letter. You can rest assured you're doing the job right.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
1. The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) indicator light comes on when the ABS control unit detects a
problem in the system. However, even though
the system is normal, the ABS indicator light can come on, too, under the following conditions: Signal disturbance
- Wheel spin
- Only drive wheels rotate
- Battery voltage fluctuates
2. When a problem is detected and the ABS indicator light comes on, the indicator light can stay on
until the ignition switch is turned off, or it can
automatically go off, depending on the mode. Light stays on until the ignition switch is turned off: When the system is in the system down mode.
- Light automatically goes off: When the system is in the control inhibition mode.
3. The ABS indicator light stays on when the system is reactivated without erasing the Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC), but it goes off after starting
the vehicle. When the wheel sensor system is faulty and the ABS indicator light comes on, the
algorithm of the system automatically turns off the ABS indicator light after the wheel speed signal
returns to the normal speed. Also, when the DTC is erased, the CPU is reset and the ABS indicator
light goes off when the system checked out normal by the initial diagnosis. Therefore, test-drive the
vehicle after servicing the wheel sensor system, and be sure that the ABS indicator light does not
come on.
4. When the ABS control unit outputs battery voltage to gauge assembly, the ABS indicator light
goes off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
> Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Pump: Locations
Right Side of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 5754
Engine Compartment
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid Pump
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 5755
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
ABS pump motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Braking Sensor/Switch: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations
Diagnostic Connector - ABS: Locations
SCS Service Connector
Below Right Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Torx Bolts ............................................................................................................................
............................................ 9.8 Nm (84 inch lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5767
Electronic Brake Control Module: Connector Locations
Connector A
Behind Right Kick Panel
Connector B
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 5768
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Main Control
ABS Operation
The ABS control unit detects the wheel speed based on the wheel sensor signal it received, then it
calculates the vehicle speed based on the detected wheel speed. The control unit detects the
vehicle speed during deceleration based on the rate of deceleration. The ABS control unit
calculates the slip rate of each wheel, and it transmits the control signal to the modulator unit
solenoid valve when the slip rate is high. The pressure reduction control is a three-mode system,
that is pressure reduction, pressure retaining and pressure intensifying modes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control > Page 5771
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Diagnosis Function
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
Since the anti-lock brake system modulates the braking pressure when a wheel is about to lock,
regardless of the driver's intention, the system operation and the braking power will be impaired if
there is a malfunction in the system. To prevent this possibility, the self-diagnosis function monitors
the main system functions. The ABS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub CPU The
CPUs check each other and the circuits of the system. When the CPUs detect failure, they shift to
the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode". When an abnormality is detected, the
ABS indicator light goes on.
CHECK MODE/BULB CHECK
There is also a check mode of the self-diagnosis system itself; when the ignition switch is first
turned on, the ABS indicator light comes on and stays on for a few seconds after the engine starts
to signify that the self-diagnosis system and indicator light are functional.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
When an abnormality is detected in the ABS control system by the self-diagnosis, the solenoid
operations are suspended to inhibit anti-lock brake system operation. Under these conditions, the
braking system functions just as an ordinary one, maintaining the necessary braking function.
When the ABS indicator light is turned on, it means the fail-safe is functioning.
SELF TEST - FAULT DETECTION
- The self-diagnosis can be classified into these four categories.
Initial Diagnosis - Performed right after the engine starts and until the ABS indicator light goes off.
Except ABS Control - Performed when the ABS is not functioning. During ABS Control - Performed
when the ABS is functioning. During Warning - Performed when the ABS indicator light is ON.
ABS Self-diagnosis
- The system performs the following controls when a problem is detected by the self-diagnosis.
> ABS indicator light ON
> Memory of Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
> Mode change to the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode".
1. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) is memorized when a problem is detected and the ABS
indicator light does not go off, or when the ABS
indicator light comes on. The DTC is not memorized when the ABS indicator light comes on unless
the CPU is activated.
2. The memory can hold any number of DTCs. However, when the same DTC is detected twice or
more, the later one is written over the old one.
Therefore, when the same problem is detected repeatedly, it is recorded as one DTC.
3. The DTCs are indicated in the order of ascending number, not in the order they occur. 4. The
DTCs are memorized in the EEPROM (non-volatile memory). Therefore, the memorized DTCs
cannot be canceled by disconnecting the
battery. Perform the specified procedures to erase. See: Testing and Inspection/Reading and
Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes/Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5772
Electronic Brake Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5773
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5774
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
1. Remove the right side kick panel. 2. Disconnect the ABS control unit connectors. 3. Remove the
ABS control unit. 4. Install the ABS control unit in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications
Power Unit: Specifications
MODULATOR *
Flare Nuts ............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 15 Nm (11 lb.ft.) Torx Bolts ...................................................................
....................................................................................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 lb.ft.) 8 mm
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
................................... 22 Nm (16 lb.ft.)
* For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5778
Power Unit: Locations
Right Side Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5779
Power Unit: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- Take care not to damage or deform the brake lines during removal and installation.
- To prevent the brake fluid from flowing, plug and cover the hose ends and joints with a shop towel
or equivalent material.
WARNING:
- Accumulator retains brake fluid under high pressure. Relieve high pressure through maintenance
bleeder prior to performing service on the ABS Modulator or Power unit, otherwise personal injury
may result.
- The ABS Accumulator contains high pressure nitrogen gas. Do not puncture, expose to the flame,
or attempt to disassemble the accumulator or it may explode, resulting in severe personal injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5780
Power Unit: Description and Operation
MODES OF OPERATION
The ABS modulator consists of the inlet solenoid valve, outlet solenoid valve, reservoir, pump,
pump motor and the damping chamber. The modulator reduces the caliper fluid pressure directly,
and it is also referred to as a circulating type because the brake fluid circulates through the caliper,
reservoir and the master cylinder. The hydraulic control has three modes: pressure reduction,
pressure retaining and pressure intensifying. The hydraulic circuit is the independent four channel
type, one channel for each wheel.
ABS Modulator Schematic
Pressure Intensifying Mode - Inlet valve open, outlet valve closed Master cylinder fluid is pumped
out to the caliper.
Pressure Retaining Mode - Inlet valve closed, outlet valve closed Caliper fluid is retained by the
inlet valve and outlet valve.
Pressure Reduction Mode - Inlet valve closed, outlet valve open Caliper fluid flows through the
outlet valve to the reservoir.
Motor Operation Mode - When starting the pressure reduction mode, the pump motor is ON. When
stopping ABS operation, the pump motor is OFF. The reservoir fluid is pumped out by the pump,
through the damping chamber, to the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5781
Wheel Speed And Modulator Control Schematic
WHEEL SPEED AND MODULATOR CONTROL
When the wheel speed drops sharply below the vehicle speed, the inlet valve closes to retain the
caliper fluid pressure. When the wheel speed drops further, the outlet valve opens momentarily to
reduce the caliper fluid pressure. The pump motor starts at this time. As the wheel speed is
restored, the inlet valve opens momentarily to increase the caliper fluid pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Power Unit <-->
[Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5782
Power Unit: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- Take care not to damage or deform the brake lines during removal and installation.
- To prevent the brake fluid from flowing, plug and cover the hose ends and joints with a shop towel
or equivalent material.
NOTE: Tighten the flare nuts to 15 Nm (1.5 kgf.m, 11 ft. lbs.) .
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the modulator unit 10P and pump motor 2P connectors. 2. Disconnect the brake
lines, then remove the modulator unit.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the modulator unit, then connect the brake lines. 2. Connect the modulator unit 10P and
pump motor 2P connectors. 3. Bleed the brake system. 4. Start the engine, and check that the ABS
indicator light goes off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Sensor Lock Bolts 7 ft.lb
Air Gap Front & Rear 0.02 - 0.04 in
For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 5787
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications Toothed Ring
PULSER/WHEEL SENSOR AIR GAP *
Front & Rear Standard ........................................................................................................................
.................................................. 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 in)
* For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Front
Inside of Left Front Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front > Page 5790
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Rear
Inside of Left Rear Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5791
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
Wheel Sensor
AC Current
The wheel sensors are the magnetic contactless type. As the gear pulser teeth rotate past the
wheel sensor's magnetic coil, AC current is generated. The AC frequency changes in accordance
with the wheel speed. The ABS control unit detects the wheel sensor signal frequency and thereby
detects the wheel speed. There are four wheel sensors, one for each wheel. The gear pulser has
50 teeth.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Toothed Ring
INSPECTION OF THE TOOTHED RING
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch), the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring > Page 5794
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Wheel Speed Sensor
TESTING THE WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch) , the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 5795
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE:
- Be careful when installing the sensors to avoid twisting the wires.
- The torque value of the bolts is 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgf.m, 7 ft. lbs.).
FRONT
REAR
1. Remove the hub bearing unit. 2. Remove the four backing plate bolts. 3. Pull the backing plate
away from the trailing arm, then remove the wheel sensor. It is not necessary to disconnect the
brake line.
NOTE: This illustration is drum brake type. The torque value of the disk type is same as drum type.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Without Anti-Lock Brakes
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without Anti-Lock Brakes
CAUTION:
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle, it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
NOTE: The reservoir on the master cylinder must be at the MAX (upper) level mark at the start of
the bleeding procedure and checked after bleeding each brake caliper. Add fluid as required.
1. Make sure the brake fluid level in the reservoir is at the MAX (upper) level line. 2. Have someone
slowly pump the brake pedal several times, then apply steady pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Without Anti-Lock Brakes > Page 5800
3. Loosen the brake bleed screw to allow air to escape from the system. Then tighten the bleed
screw securely.
Brake Bleeding Sequence
4. Repeat the procedure for each wheel in the sequence shown until air bubbles no longer appear
in the fluid. 5. Refill the master cylinder reservoir to the MAX (upper) level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Pedal Assy: Specifications
Standard Pedal Height (with carpet removed)
M/T ......................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 156.5 mm (6.16 in) A/T .............................................................................
...................................................................................................................... 161 mm (6.33 in)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5804
Brake Pedal Assy: Testing and Inspection
PEDAL FREE PLAY
1. With the engine off, inspect the play on the pedal pad by pushing the pedal by hand.
Free Play: 1 - 5 mm (1/16 - 3/16 inch)
Pedal Free Play
2. If the pedal free play is out of specification, adjust the brake switch.
CAUTION: If the pedal free play is insufficient, it may result in brake drag.
PEDAL HEIGHT
1. Disconnect the brake switch connector, loosen the brake switch locknut, and back off the brake
switch until it is no longer touching the brake
pedal.
2. At the carpet cutout, measure the pedal height from the right side center of the pedal pad.
Standard Pedal Height (with carpet removed):
M/T: 156.5 mm (6.16 inch) A/T, CVT: 161 mm (6 5/16 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5805
Brake Pedal Assy: Adjustments
PEDAL HEIGHT
1. Disconnect the brake switch connector, loosen the brake switch locknut, and back off the brake
switch until it is no longer touching the brake
pedal.
2. At the carpet cutout, measure the pedal height from the right side center of the pedal pad.
Standard Pedal Height (with carpet removed):
M/T: 156.5 mm (6.16 inch) A/T, CVT: 161 mm (6 5/16 inch)
3. Loosen the pushrod locknut, and screw the pushrod in or out with pliers until the standard pedal
height from the floor is reached. After adjustment,
tighten the locknut firmly.
NOTE: Do not adjust the pedal height with the pushrod depressed.
4. Screw in the brake switch until its plunger is fully depressed (threaded end touching the pad on
the pedal arm). Then back off the switch 1/4 turn to
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 5806
make 0.3 mm (0.01 inch) of clearance between the threaded end and pad. Tighten the locknut
firmly. Connect the brake switch connector.
CAUTION: Make sure that the brake lights go off when the pedal is released.
5. Check the brake pedal free play as described below.
PEDAL FREE PLAY
1. With the engine off, inspect the play on the pedal pad by pushing the pedal by hand.
Free Play: 1 - 5 mm (1/16 - 3/16 inch)
Pedal Free Play
2. If the pedal free play is out of specification, adjust the brake switch.
CAUTION: If the pedal free play is insufficient, it may result in brake drag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Front 5410 Type * Mounting Bolt 80 ft.lb
Model No. stamped on caliper body
Bleeder Screw 78 in.lb
Attaching Bolts 24 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
2056 Type * Mounting Bolt 80 ft.lb
Model No. stamped on caliper body
Bleeder Screw 78 in.lb
Attaching Bolts 20 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
Rear Arm Attaching Bolts 17 ft.lb
Mounting Bolts 17 ft.lb
Bracket Mounting Bolts 28 ft.lb
Bleed Screw 78 in.lb
Parking Nut 20 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Diagrams > Front
Brake Caliper: Diagrams Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Diagrams > Front > Page 5813
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Diagrams > Front > Page 5814
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Brake Caliper: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 5817
Brake Caliper: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Page 5818
Brake Caliper: Application and ID
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers. The Calipers can be identified by the "5410" or
"2056" stamped on the caliper body. Check the type of brake caliper before servicing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Front
Type 5410
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
1. Remove the banjo bolt, and disconnect the brake hose from the caliper. 2. Remove the caliper
bolts, then remove the caliper from the bracket.
3. Remove the caliper pins and pin boots from the caliper bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5821
4. If necessary, apply compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet to get the piston out. Place a shop rag
or wooden block as shown to cushion the piston
when it is expelled. Use low pressure air in short spurts.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston.
- Do not use high air pressure; use an OSHA approved 30 PSI nozzle.
5. Remove the piston from the caliper, and check the piston for scoring.
6. Remove the boot clip, piston boot and piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
Type 2056
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5822
1. Remove the banjo bolt, and disconnect the brake hose from the caliber. 2. Remove caliper bolt
B. pivot the caliper up out of the way, then remove the caliper from the bracket.
3. Remove the guide pin boot from sleeve A on the caliper bracket.
4. Remove the pin boot, sleeve B and sleeve boot from the caliber body.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5823
5. If necessary, apply compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet to get the piston out. Place a shop rag
or wooden block as shown to cushion the piston
when it is expelled. Use low pressure air in short spurts.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston.
- Do not use high air pressure; use an OSHA approved 30 PSI nozzle.
6. Remove the piston from the caliper, and check the piston for scoring.
Removing Clip, Boot And Seal
7. Remove the boot clip, piston boot and piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
Type 5410
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5824
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss
of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
1. Clean the piston and caliper bore with brake fluid, and inspect for wear and damage. 2. Coat the
new piston seal with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install the seal in
the cylinder groove.
3. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and inside of a
new piston boot, and secure install it in the caliper with
the new boot clip.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the caliper cylinder wall.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5825
4. Lubricate the caliper and piston with brake fluid, then install the piston in the cylinder with the
dished end facing in. 5. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding
surface of the pins and the inside of the new pin boots.
6. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the caliper bracket properly. 7. Insert pin A and pin B into
the caliper bracket. 8. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the pins properly. 9. Install the brake
pads in their original positions.
10. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads, and install the caliper. 11. Tighten
the caliper bolts.
12. Connect the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt. 13.
Fill the brake reservoir and bleed the brake system. 14. Perform the following checks.
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check for brake hoses for interference and twisting.
Type 2056
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5826
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss
of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow Out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and Other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or Other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
NOTE:
- Coat the piston, piston seal, and caliper bore with clean brake fluid.
- Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
1. Clean the piston and caliper bore with brake fluid, and inspect for wear and damage. 2. Coat a
new piston seal with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install the seal in
the cylinder groove.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5827
3. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and inside of a
new piston boot, and secure install it in the caliper with
a new boot clip.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the caliper cylinder wall.
4. Lubricate the caliper and piston with brake fluid, then install the piston in the cylinder with the
dished end facing in. 5. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding
surface of sleeve B and the inside of the new pin and sleeve boots.
6. Install the new sleeve and pin boots and sleeve B on the caliper.
NOTE: Be sure to install the boots into the grooves in the caliper and sleeve B properly.
7. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding surface of sleeve A and
the inside of a new guide pin boot. 8. Install the guide pin boot into the groove in the sleeve A.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5828
9. Make sure that the brake pad retainers and brake pads are in their original positions.
10. Install the caliper onto sleeve A, and pivot it down into position.
NOTE: Install the guide pin boot into the groove in the caliper properly.
11. Connect the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt.
12. Tighten the caliper bolt B. 13. Fill the brake reservoir and bleed the brake system. 14. Perform
the following checks.
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check for brake hoses for interference and twisting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5829
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Rear
Disassembly
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
1. Remove the caliper shield.
2. Remove the lock pin and clevis pin. Remove the cable clip, and disconnect the cable from the
arm. 3. Remove the banjo bolt and two sealing washers.
4. Remove the two caliper mounting bolts and caliper body from the bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5830
5. Remove the pins and pin boots from the caliper bracket.
6. Remove the pad spring from the caliper body.
7. Remove the piston by rotating the piston counterclockwise with the tool, and remove the piston
boot.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the piston.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5831
8. Remove the piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
9. Install the special tool between the caliper body and spring cover.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the inside of the caliper cylinder during caliper disassembly.
10. Position the locknuts as shown, then turn the shaft until the plate just contacts the caliper body.
NOTE: Do not compress the spring under the spring cover.
11. Turn the shaft clockwise 1/4 - 1/2 turn to compress adjusting spring B in the caliper body.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5832
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the inner components, do not turn the shaft more than 1/2 turn.
12. Lower the locknuts fully, and tighten them securely.
NOTE: Keep the locknuts in this position until you reinstall the circlip.
13. Remove the circlip with snap ring pliers.
Removing Adjusting Bolt
14. Hold the plate with your fingers, and turn the shaft counterclockwise. Remove the special tool
from the caliper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5833
15. Remove the adjusting bolt. 16. Remove the spring cover, adjusting spring B. spacer, bearing A,
and cup from the adjusting bolt.
17. Remove the sleeve piston, and remove the pin from the cam in the caliper body.
18. Remove the return spring. 19. Remove the parking lever and cam as an assembly from the
caliper body.
CAUTION: Do not loosen the parking nut with the cam installed in the caliper body. If the lever and
shaft must be separated, hold the lever in a vise, and loosen the parking nut.
20. Remove the cam boot.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5834
Assembly
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, install them in their original positions to prevent loss of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; It may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
1. Pack all cavities of the needle bearing with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal
set.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5835
2. Coat a new cam boot with recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install it in
the caliper body. 3. Apply recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set to the pin contacting
area of the cam, and install the cam and lever assembly into the
caliper body.
4. Install the return spring.
CAUTION: When the cam and lever were separated, be sure to assemble them before installing the cam in the
caliper body. Install the lever and spring washer, apply locking agent to the threads, and tighten the
parking nut while holding the lever with a vise.
- Avoid damaging the cam boot since it must be installed before the cam.
- When installing the cam, do not allow the cam boot lips to turn outside in.
5. Install the pin in the cam. 6. Install a new O-ring on the sleeve piston. 7. Install the sleeve piston
so that the hole in the bottom of the piston is aligned with the pin in the cam, and the two pins on
the piston are aligned
with the holes in the caliper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5836
8. Coat a new cup with recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install it with its
groove facing the bearing A side of the adjusting
bolt.
9. Fit the bearing A, spacer, adjusting spring B. and spring cover on the adjusting bolt, and install
them in the caliper cylinder.
10. Install the special tool onto the spring cover, and turn the shaft until the locknut contacts the
plate. 11. Check that the flared end of the spring cover is below the circlip groove.
12. Install the circlip into the groove, then remove the special tool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5837
NOTE: Check that the circlip is seated in the groove properly.
13. Coat a new piston seal with recommended silicone grease in the caliper seal set, and install it
in the caliper. 14. Apply recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and
inside of a new piston boot, and install it in the caliper.
15. Coat the outside of the piston with brake fluid, and install it onto the adjusting bolt while rotating
it clockwise with the tool.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the piston and piston boot.
16. Install the pad spring onto the caliper. 17. Apply the recommended pin grease in the caliper
seal set to the sliding surface of the pins and inside of the new pin boots.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5838
18. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the caliper bracket properly. 19. Insert pin A and pin B
into the caliper bracket. 20. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the pins properly. 21. Install the
brake pad retainers and brake pads. 22. Align the cutout in the piston with the tab on the inner pad.
23. Install the caliper onto the caliper bracket, and tighten the caliper mounting bolts. 24. Connect
the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt.
25. Insert the cable through the arm, and connect the cable to the lever with the clevis pin and lock
pin. Install the cable clip securely. 26. Install the caliper shield.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5839
27. Fill the brake reservoir, and bleed the brake system. 28. Operate the brake pedal several times,
then adjust the parking brake. 29. After installation, perform the following checks:
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check the parking brake lever for operation, and adjust it if necessary.
- Check for brake hose for interference or twisting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > With Rear Disc Brakes
Brake Pad: Specifications
Front Pad 5410 Stamped On The Caliper Body: Standard 9.5 - 10.5 mm
Service Limit 1.6 mm
2056 Stamped On The Caliper Body: Standard 8.5 - 9.5 mm
Service Limit 1.6 mm
Rear Pad Standard 7.0 - 8.0 mm
Service Limit 1.6 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > With Rear Disc Brakes > Page 5844
Brake Pad: Specifications
Pad Thickness 5410 Stamped On The Caliper Body: Standard 9.5 - 10.5 mm
Service Limit 1.6 mm
2056 Stamped On The Caliper Body: Standard 8.5 - 9.5 mm
Service Limit 1.6 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Customer Safety Information
Brake Pad: Customer Safety Information
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads
.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service Precautions > Customer Safety Information > Page 5847
Brake Pad: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front
Brake Pad: Testing and Inspection Front
Type 2056
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake hose bracket from the knuckle.
3. Remove the caliper bolt B, and pivot the caliper up out of the way.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage and deterioration.
4. Remove the pad shim, pad retainers, and pads.
NOTE: When replacing the pads, replace the shim together with the pads as a set.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5850
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness.
Brake Pad Thickness:
Standard: 8.5 - 9.5 mm (0.33 - 0.37 inch) Service Limit: 1.6 mm (0.06 inch)
6. If the brake pad thickness is less than the service limit, replace the front pads as a set. 7. Clean
the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust, and check for grooves and cracks. 8. Check the brake disc
for damage and cracks.
9. Install the pad retainers.
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrows in the following illustration:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad and caliper body contact surface
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5851
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and pad shim correctly.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
NOTE: Install the pad with the wear indicator on the inside.
12. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads. Make sure that the piston boot is in
position to prevent damaging it when pivoting the
caliper down.
13. Pivot the caliper down into position, then install caliper bolt B and tighten it. 14. Install the brake
hose bracket on the knuckle.
NOTE: Inspect the brake hose for interference and twisting.
15. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure the brakes work, then road-test.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require a greater pedal stroke immediately after the brake
pads have been replaced as a set. Several applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal stroke.
16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if
necessary.
Type 5410
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake hose bracket from the knuckle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5852
3. Remove the caliper bolt, and pivot the caliper up out of the way.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage and deterioration.
4. Remove the pad shim, pad retainers, and pads.
NOTE: When the caliper is equipped with an outer pad shim, replace the shim together with the
pads as a set.
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness.
Brake Pad Thickness:
Standard: 9.5 - 10.5 mm (0.37 - 0.41 inch) Service Limit: 1.6 mm (0.06 inch)
6. If the brake pad thickness is less than the service limit, replace the front pads as a set. 7. Clean
the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust, and check for grooves and cracks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5853
8. Check the brake disc for damage and cracks. 9. Install the pad retainers.
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrows in the following illustration:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad and caliper body contact surface
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and pad shim correctly.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
NOTE: Install the pad with the wear indicator on the inside.
12. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads. Make sure that the piston boot is in
position to prevent damaging it when pivoting the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5854
caliper down.
13. Pivot the caliper down into position, then install the caliper bolt and tighten it.
CAUTION: Be careful not damage the pin boot when pivoting the caliper down.
14. Install the brake hose bracket on the knuckle.
NOTE: Inspect the brake hose for interference or twisting.
15. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure the brakes work, then test-drive.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require a greater pedal stroke immediately after the brake
pads have been replaced as a set. Several applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal stroke.
16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints or connections, and retighten if
necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5855
Brake Pad: Testing and Inspection Rear
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Block the front wheels, loosen the rear wheel nuts slightly, support the rear of the vehicle on
safety stands, then remove the rear wheels.
Caliper Shield Removal
2. Release the parking brake, and remove the caliper shield.
3. Remove the brake hose clamp bolt from the trailing arm first, then remove the two caliper
mounting bolts and the caliper from the bracket.
CAUTION: Thoroughly clean the outside of the caliper to prevent dust and dirt from entering inside.
- Support the caliper with a piece of wire so that it does not hang from the brake hose.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage or deterioration.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5856
4. Remove the outer pad shim, pads, and pad retainers.
Checking Pad Thickness
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness. 6. If the pad thickness is less than the service limit,
replace the pads and shims together as a set. 7. Clean the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust,
and check for grooves and cracks. 8. Check the brake disc for damage and cracks.
9. Make sure that the pad retainers are installed in their correct positions.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5857
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrow in the following drawing:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and outer pad shim on the caliper bracket. Install the inner pad with its
wear indicator facing downward.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
12. Rotate the caliper piston clockwise into the cylinder, then align the cutout in the piston with the
tab on the inner pad by turning the piston back.
CAUTION: Lubricate the boot with rubber grease to avoid twisting the piston boot. If the piston boot
is twisted, back it out so it sits properly.
13. Install the brake hose clamp on the trailing arm. 14. Install and tighten the caliper mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5858
Removing Caliper Shield
15. Install the caliper shield. 16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints and
connections, and retighten if necessary. 17. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure
the brakes work, then test-drive.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require greater pedal travel immediately after the brake pads
have been replaced as a set. Several light applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal travel. Greater than normal pedal travel may damage the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
Type 2056
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake hose bracket from the knuckle.
3. Remove the caliper bolt B, and pivot the caliper up out of the way.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage and deterioration.
4. Remove the pad shim, pad retainers, and pads.
NOTE: When replacing the pads, replace the shim together with the pads as a set.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5861
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness.
Brake Pad Thickness:
Standard: 8.5 - 9.5 mm (0.33 - 0.37 inch) Service Limit: 1.6 mm (0.06 inch)
6. If the brake pad thickness is less than the service limit, replace the front pads as a set. 7. Clean
the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust, and check for grooves and cracks. 8. Check the brake disc
for damage and cracks.
9. Install the pad retainers.
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrows in the following illustration:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad and caliper body contact surface
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5862
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and pad shim correctly.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
NOTE: Install the pad with the wear indicator on the inside.
12. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads. Make sure that the piston boot is in
position to prevent damaging it when pivoting the
caliper down.
13. Pivot the caliper down into position, then install caliper bolt B and tighten it. 14. Install the brake
hose bracket on the knuckle.
NOTE: Inspect the brake hose for interference and twisting.
15. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure the brakes work, then road-test.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require a greater pedal stroke immediately after the brake
pads have been replaced as a set. Several applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal stroke.
16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if
necessary.
Type 5410
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake hose bracket from the knuckle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5863
3. Remove the caliper bolt, and pivot the caliper up out of the way.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage and deterioration.
4. Remove the pad shim, pad retainers, and pads.
NOTE: When the caliper is equipped with an outer pad shim, replace the shim together with the
pads as a set.
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness.
Brake Pad Thickness:
Standard: 9.5 - 10.5 mm (0.37 - 0.41 inch) Service Limit: 1.6 mm (0.06 inch)
6. If the brake pad thickness is less than the service limit, replace the front pads as a set. 7. Clean
the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust, and check for grooves and cracks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5864
8. Check the brake disc for damage and cracks. 9. Install the pad retainers.
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrows in the following illustration:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad and caliper body contact surface
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and pad shim correctly.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
NOTE: Install the pad with the wear indicator on the inside.
12. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads. Make sure that the piston boot is in
position to prevent damaging it when pivoting the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5865
caliper down.
13. Pivot the caliper down into position, then install the caliper bolt and tighten it.
CAUTION: Be careful not damage the pin boot when pivoting the caliper down.
14. Install the brake hose bracket on the knuckle.
NOTE: Inspect the brake hose for interference or twisting.
15. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure the brakes work, then test-drive.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require a greater pedal stroke immediately after the brake
pads have been replaced as a set. Several applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal stroke.
16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints or connections, and retighten if
necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5866
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
1. Block the front wheels, loosen the rear wheel nuts slightly, support the rear of the vehicle on
safety stands, then remove the rear wheels.
Caliper Shield Removal
2. Release the parking brake, and remove the caliper shield.
3. Remove the brake hose clamp bolt from the trailing arm first, then remove the two caliper
mounting bolts and the caliper from the bracket.
CAUTION: Thoroughly clean the outside of the caliper to prevent dust and dirt from entering inside.
- Support the caliper with a piece of wire so that it does not hang from the brake hose.
NOTE: Check the hoses and pin boots for damage or deterioration.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5867
4. Remove the outer pad shim, pads, and pad retainers.
Checking Pad Thickness
5. Using vernier calipers, measure the thickness of each brake pad lining. The measurement does
not include the pad backing plate thickness. 6. If the pad thickness is less than the service limit,
replace the pads and shims together as a set. 7. Clean the caliper thoroughly; remove any rust,
and check for grooves and cracks. 8. Check the brake disc for damage and cracks.
9. Make sure that the pad retainers are installed in their correct positions.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5868
10. Apply grease to the points indicated by the arrow in the following drawing:
NOTE: Use the pad grease included in the pad set or Molykote M77 grease, and apply a thin coat
of grease evenly to the designated points.
- Piston end and inner pad contact surface
- Pad and caliper bracket contact surface
- Outer pad shim and outer pad contact surface
- Outer pad shim and caliper body contact surface
11. Install the brake pads and outer pad shim on the caliper bracket. Install the inner pad with its
wear indicator facing downward.
WARNING: When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss of
braking efficiency.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability. Keep grease off the discs and pads.
12. Rotate the caliper piston clockwise into the cylinder, then align the cutout in the piston with the
tab on the inner pad by turning the piston back.
CAUTION: Lubricate the boot with rubber grease to avoid twisting the piston boot. If the piston boot
is twisted, back it out so it sits properly.
13. Install the brake hose clamp on the trailing arm. 14. Install and tighten the caliper mounting
bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 5869
Removing Caliper Shield
15. Install the caliper shield. 16. After installation, check for leaks at hose and line joints and
connections, and retighten if necessary. 17. Depress the brake pedal several times to make sure
the brakes work, then test-drive.
NOTE: Engagement of the brake may require greater pedal travel immediately after the brake pads
have been replaced as a set. Several light applications of the brake pedal will restore the normal
pedal travel. Greater than normal pedal travel may damage the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information
Brake Rotor/Disc: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information
00-088
July 14, 2010
Applies To: ALL Models
Brake Disc Refinishing Guidelines
(Supersedes 00-088, dated October 6, 2006, to revise the information marked with the black bars)
*REVISION SUMMARY
The requirement to refinish new brake discs was removed.*
American Honda does not allow replacement of brake discs under warranty unless the brake disc
is beyond its service limit for refinishing. If the brake disc is within its service limit, you must refinish
it. Maximum refinishing limits may be found in the Conventional Brakes section of the appropriate
service manual.
*Refinish brake discs only when they are scored or out of specification for runout or parallelism.
See the appropriate service manual for the specifications.*
American Honda requires refinishing of the front brake discs with an on-car brake lathe that mounts
to the steering knuckle. Use of an on-car, steering knuckle- mounted lathe is critical because it
corrects runout of the hub and disc as an assembly. Experience has shown that very small
amounts of runout, not felt as brake pulsation initially, will grow and become noticeable as the discs
are subjected to heat and wear over time and mileage. Two on-car brake lathes are recommended.
The Kwik-Lathe, model number KWY-108000501, is supported with automatic shipments of
adapters for new models, when required. The Accu-turn On-car Brake Lathe, model
ACCHONOCLPKG, is also recommended.
A power driver is required for the 82000 and is highly recommended for all other models. The
Kwik-Lathe power driver model number is KWY-108012005; the Accu-turn lathe includes a power
driver. Here are some advantages of using power drivers:
^ The disc is rotated at the optimum speed for a smooth and consistent cut.
^ There is no need to climb in and out of the vehicle to start and stop the engine or to shift the
transmission.
^ Securing the opposite wheel with a tie-down strap is not required.
^ There is no waiting for the engine to return to idle and no concern about engine speed changes
that can adversely affect brake disc cut and finish.
^ The Traction Control System (TCS) is not involved.
^ Consistent cutting speed increases cutting tool life.
ORDERING INFORMATION
Order brake lathes and power drivers through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program. To place
an order, call or use the fax order form provided in your Honda Tool and Equipment Program
Catalog. Phone lines are open Monday thru Friday from 7:30 a.m. to 7:00 p.m. Central Time. You
can also order online through the Interactive Network (iN). Click on Service, Tool and Equipment,
and then Online Catalog. Click on Alignment, Wheel, and Brake Equipment, and then On-Car
Brake Lathes.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None, this bulletin is for information only.
FRONT BRAKE DISCS
The following guidelines show the Kwik-Way lathe setup, the Accu-turn lathe setup is similar.
Setting Up the Vehicle
Put the transmission in Neutral. If you are not using the power drive system, start the engine, and
let it warm up to its normal operating temperature so the idle speed will stabilize to its lowest rpm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5874
Raise the vehicle on a lift.
Check for loose wheel bearings. You must replace loose wheel bearings before you refinish the
brake discs. If you do not, the brake lathe will not correct for brake disc runout, resulting in an
uneven finish and brake pulsation.
Remove the front wheels, then reinstall the wheel nuts with flat washers to compensate for the
removed wheel. Torque the wheel nuts to the required specification (see the appropriate service
manual).
Remove the caliper assembly. Use a wire or a S-hook to hold the caliper to the spring or damper
tower. Do not kink the brake hose or use it to support the caliper. If you are not using the power
drive system and the vehicle has ICS or VSA, make sure you install a brake pad spreader between
the pads on the hanging caliper. Also, make sure the ICS or VSA is turned off anytime the engine
is started. If the system is not turned off, the brakes could activate, causing the brake pads on the
hanging caliper to hit each other or the caliper pistons to fall out.
Install the vibration damper on the brake disc. If you are not using the power drive system, make
sure you install the protective band around the wheel nuts.
If you are not using the power drive system, use a fabric tie-down strap to secure the brake disc
that is opposite to the one you are refinishing. If you are working on a Prelude with ATTS, do not
use a tie-down strap; let both wheels turn freely.
Mounting the Brake Lathe
Remove the tool bed from the brake lathe, then mount the brake lathe to the steering knuckle with
a Honda 1-piece speed mount. These mounts provide quicker, more accurate mounting, and can
be ordered through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program (see ORDERING INFORMATION).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5875
Honda 1-Piece Speed Mounts
P/N KWY-108006000 (for most models), P/N KWY-108007500 (Odysseys, Pilots, and Ridgelines
with two-piston calipers)
Attaching the Power Drive System
1. Make sure the drive motor assembly on the power drive system is level with the brake disc.
2. Attach the mounting yoke to the brake disc, and secure it with one of the wheel nuts. Torque the
wheel nut to the required specification (see the
appropriate service manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5876
3. Attach the driveshaft on the drive motor assembly to the mounting yoke, making sure the center
line of the driveshaft is level with the spindle nut on
the wheel hub.
4. Set the lower toggle switch on the drive motor assembly to FWD (counterclockwise rotation) or
REV (clockwise rotation).
Setting Up and Adjusting the Brake Lathe
Use Kwik-Way cutting bits, P/N KWY-109109223, and the holding screws that come with them.
These bits are stamped KW and are available through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program
(see ORDERING INFORMATION).
Before you use the brake lathe, inspect the tips of the cutting bits with a magnifying glass to make
sure the tips are not worn out. Each bit has three tips. If a tip is worn, rotate the bit, and use a new
tip. A worn tip produces a poor finish and may cause chattering.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5877
Reinstall the tool bed on the brake lathe with the top of the cutting bits facing up and the feed
knobs facing down. Adjust the tool bed until the brake disc is centered between the cutting bits. For
proper refinishing, the brake disc must turn toward the top of the cutting bits.
Do not set the cutting depth on the brake lathe to more than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.). This is two
divisions on the cutting knob. Make sure you start your cut at least 3 mm (0.12 in.) beyond the worn
area on the brake disc.
If you are cutting larger diameter brake discs, make sure you use the 150 cutting bit holders. These
bit holders, available through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program (see ORDERING
INFORMATION), supersede the original bit holders and provide better cutting coverage for larger
diameter brake discs. Each bit holder is clearly marked for proper installation on the tool holder.
Cutting the Brake Disc
To get the smoothest cut and the best brake disc finish, always use the slowest feed speed on the
tool bed feed motor. Place the drive belt on the smallest pulley of the feed motor and on the largest
pulley of the hand wheel.
Make sure the lower toggle switch on the power drive system drive motor assembly is set to the
proper rotation to turn the brake disc toward the top of the cutting bits. Plug the tool bed feed motor
into the power outlet on the drive motor assembly, then turn on the drive motor with the upper
toggle switch on the assembly.
If you are not using the power drive system, make sure the transmission is in 1st gear (2nd gear on
Preludes with ATTS) or Reverse and the engine is idling, but not at a fast idle. If the transmission
and engine are at higher gears and speeds, you will damage the cutting bits.
Turn on the tool bed feed motor, and snap it into place; there should be tension on the feed belt.
Cut the brake disc until the cutting bits clear the outer edge of the disc. The cutting bits should
produce a smooth, consistent finish with no chatter marks or grooves.
If the disc did not clean up entirely on the first pass, reset the brake lathe and make a second pass.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5878
Finishing the Job
Remove the vibration damper and the protective band (if used). Use a micrometer to measure the
thickness of the brake disc. Make sure the thickness is within the service manual specifications.
Clean the brake disc with soapy water or brake cleaner, then wipe it dry. Use a vacuum cleaner to
remove any dust or chips, but do not use compressed air.
Unplug the tool bed feed motor from the drive motor assembly, and remove the mounting yoke
from the brake disc. Remove the speed mount from the steering knuckle.
Apply a small amount of Molykote 77 grease to the brake pad shims. Reinstall the caliper
assembly. (If you did not use the power drive system, use the brake pad spreader to push the
pistons back into the caliper.)
Torque the nuts and bolts to the required specification (see the appropriate service manual).
Refinish the other front brake disc using the same guidelines.
Check the brake fluid level, then test-drive the vehicle to make sure the brake pedal is firm and
does not pulsate. Lightly apply the brakes about 20 times during the test-drive to seat the brake
pads.
REAR BRAKE DISCS
It is possible to use an on-car lathe on some models if the rear caliper mounts are low enough to
clear the vehicle body. A power driver is needed for front drive models. Refinish rear brake discs on
bench-mounted equipment if necessary.
Follow the same guidelines you used for refinishing front brake discs, noting these differences:
^ Mount the brake lathe to the rear knuckle with the Honda 2-Piece Adapter (P/N KWY-1
08102504). You can order the 2-piece adapter through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program
(see ORDERING INFORMATION).
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5879
Brake Rotor/Disc: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Disc Refinishing Procedure
Bulletin No. 86-020
Issue Date May 27, 1997
Model ALL
Applicable To ALL Except 2WD Passport
File Under BRAKES
Brake Disc Refinishing (Supersedes 86-020, dated October 3, 1986)
[NEW]
* Brake disc replacement under warranty is not allowed unless the disc is beyond its maximum
refinishing limit. If a disc is within its limit, it must be refinished. For front and rear brake disc
maximum refinishing limit specifications, refer to section 19 of the appropriate service manual
(section 5A2 for Passports).
Front Brake Discs Whenever a front brake disc is replaced, it must be refinished on the car.
Refinishing new front discs is included in the flat-rate time for disc replacement.
To avoid brake vibration, always refinish front brake discs on the car with the Kwik-Way or Snap-on
brake lathe. Purchasing information for these lathes is in Service Bulletin 87-034, Front Brake Disc
Refinishing Equipment, filed in the Special Tools section.
Follow these tips to get the best results from your on-car brake lathe. (For detailed instructions,
refer to the lathe's operating manual.)
^ Before refinishing, warm the engine to normal operating temperature.
^ On 2WD vehicles, lift both front wheels off the ground. On 4WD vehicles, lift all four wheels off
the ground.
^ On 4WD Passports, make sure that the hub nut is properly adjusted (with no end play) and the
transmission is in 4H.
^ On Preludes with ATTS (Active Torque Transfer System), let both front wheels turn freely On
other vehicles, use a tie-down strap to secure the disc opposite to the one being refinished.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5880
^ Install the vibration damper on the disc, and install the protective band around the wheel lug nuts.
^ Mount the lathe to the caliper bracket with Honda Quick-Mount Adapters. The adapters can be
ordered through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program; contact Special Tools at 800-346-6327.
The advantage of using the adapters is that they don't have to be removed from the lathe once
they are installed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Brake Disc Refinishing Information > Page 5881
^ Use the aligning bar tool to ensure that the lathe moves square to the center of the brake disc.
The disc should turn toward the cutting bits.
^ Use "Kwik-Way" cutting bits (P/N KW109-1092-23, H/C 5418866) and the holding screws that
come with them. These bits are stamped "K W." They can be purchased from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures, or by contacting a Kwik-Way distributor. The Kwik-Way
P/N is 109-1092-23.
^ Before using the lathe, inspect the tips of the cutting bits with a magnifying glass to make sure
they are not worn out. Each bit has three tips.
^ Do not set the cutting depth on the lathe to more than 0.2 mm (0.008 in.) This is two divisions on
the cutting knob.
^ To refinish, the transmission must be in first gear (D3 or D4, if the shift selector doesn't have a
first gear position; second gear on Preludes with ATTS), with the engine at idle (not fast idle). If the
transmission and engine are at higher gears and speeds, you will damage the cutting bits.
Rear Brake Discs
Refinish rear brake discs off the car with conventional disc refinishing equipment.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION [NEW] None; information only.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Front
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Nominal Thickness 0.820 in
Minimum Refinish Thickness 0.740 in
Thickness Variation Parallelism 0.0006 in
Lateral Runout 0.006 in
Minimum Pad Thickness 0.060 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Specifications > Front > Page 5884
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Nominal Thickness 0.350 in
Minimum Refinish Thickness 0.320 in
Thickness Variation Parallelism 0.0006 in
Lateral Runout 0.004 in
Minimum Pad Thickness 0.060 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection Front
ROTOR INSPECTION
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake pads. 3. Inspect the disc surface for damage and
cracks. Clean the disc thoroughly and remove all rust.
4. Use wheel nuts and suitable plain washers to hold the disc securely against the hub, then mount
a dial indicator as shown, and measure the runout
at 10 mm (0.4 inch) from the outer edge of the disc.
Brake Disc Runout:
Service Limit: 0.10 mm (0.004 inch)
5. Using a micrometer, measure disc thickness at eight points, approximately 45° apart and 10 mm
(0.4 inch) in from the outer edge of the disc.
Brake Disc Thickness:
Standard: 20.9 - 21.8 mm (0.82 - 0.86 inch) Max. Refinishing Limit: 19.0 mm (0.75 inch)
NOTE: Replace the brake disc if the smallest measurement is less than the max. refinishing limit.
Brake Disc Parallelism: 0.015 mm (0.0006 inch) max.
NOTE: This is the maximum allowable difference between the thickness measurements.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5887
6. If the disc is beyond the service limit, refinish the brake disc with an on-car brake lathe. The
Kwik-Lathe produced by Kwik-way manufacturing
Co. and the Front Brake Disc Lathe" offered by Snap-on Tools Co. are approved for this operation.
Max. Refinish Limit: 19.0 mm (0.75 inch)
NOTE: A new disc should be refinished if its runout is greater than 0.10 mm (0.004 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5888
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection Rear
ROTOR INSPECTION
1. Loosen the front wheel nuts slightly, then raise the vehicle, and support it on safety stands.
Remove the front wheels. 2. Remove the brake pads. 3. Inspect the disc surface for damage and
cracks.
Clean the disc thoroughly, and remove all rust.
4. Use wheel nuts and suitable plain washers to hold the disc securely against the hub, then mount
a dial indicator as shown, and measure the runout
at 10 mm (0.4 inch) from the outer edge of the disc.
NOTE: A new disc should be refinished if its runout is greater than 0.10 mm (0.004 inch).
5. Using a micrometer, measure disc thickness at eight points, approximately 45° apart and 10 mm
(0.4 inch) in from the outer edge of the disc.
Replace the brake disc if the smallest measurement is less than the max. refinishing limit.
Brake Disc Thickness:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front > Page 5889
Standard: 8.9 - 9.1 mm (0.350 - 0.358 inch) Max. Refinishing Limit: 8.0 mm (0.31 inch)
Brake Disc Parallelism: 0.015 mm (0.0006 inch) Max.
NOTE: This is the maximum allowable difference between the thickness measurements.
6. If the disc is beyond the service limit, refinish the brake disc.
Max. Refinishing Limit: 8.0 mm (0.31 inch)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Front
Removal
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in
the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel.
4. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 5. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5892
6. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 7. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
8. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
Installation
1. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5893
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair Rear
Removal
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in
the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Remove the 6 mm flange bolts and the caliper shield. 5.
Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the caliper
assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
9. Remove the brake disc.
Installation
1. Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component Information
> Specifications
Backing Plate: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Backing Plate .......................................................................................................................................
................................................. 64 Nm (47 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Automatic Transaxle
Brake Drum: Specifications
Brake Drum Standard Inside Diameter 7.87 in
Brake Drum Service Limit 7.91 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Automatic Transaxle > Page 5902
Brake Drum: Specifications
Brake Drum Standard Inside Diameter 7.09 in
Brake Drum Service Limit 7.13 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5903
Brake Drum: Testing and Inspection
1. Check the wheel cylinder for leakage. 2. Check the brake linings for cracking, glazing, wear, and
contamination.
3. Measure the brake lining thickness.
Brake Lining Thickness:
Standard: 4.0 mm (0.157 inch) Service Limit: 2.0 mm (0.08 inch)
NOTE: Measurement does not include brake shoe thickness.
4. If the brake lining thickness is less than the service limit, replace the brake shoes as a set. 5.
Check the bearings in the hub unit for smooth operation.
6. Measure the inside diameter of the brake drum using the inside vernier calipers.
Drum Inside Diameter:
Standard: 199.9 - 200.0 mm (7.870 - 7.874 inch) Service Limit: 201.0 mm (7.913 inch)
7. If the inside diameter of the brake drum is more than the service limit, replace the brake drum. 8.
Check the brake drum for scoring, grooves, and cracks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5904
Brake Drum: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake linings or drums reduce stopping ability.
- Block the front wheels before jacking up the rear of the vehicle.
1. Block the front wheels, loosen the rear wheel nuts slightly, support the rear of the vehicle on
safety stands, then remove the rear wheels. 2. Release the parking brake, and remove the rear
brake drum.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Shoe: Specifications
Lining Thickness Standard 0.157 in
Service Limit 0.08 in
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5908
Brake Shoe: Testing and Inspection
Rear Drum Brakes Components
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake linings or drums reduce stopping ability.
- Block the front wheels before jacking up the rear of the vehicle.
NOTE:
- Block the front wheels, loosen the rear wheel nuts slightly, support the rear of vehicle on safety
stands, then remove the rear wheels.
- Release the parking brake, and remove the rear brake drum.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5909
Wheel Cylinder & Linings
- Measure the brake lining thickness.
Specs: Brake Lining Thickness*
Standard 4.0 mm (0.157 in) Service Limit 2.0 mm (0.08 in)
- If the brake lining thickness is less than service limit, replace the brake shoes as a set.
- Check the bearings in the hub unit for smooth operation.
* Measurement does not include brake shoe thickness.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Disassembly
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Disassembly
Tension Pin Removal
1. Remove the tension pins by pushing the retainer springs and turning them. 2. Lower the brake
shoe assembly, and remove the lower return spring.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the dust cover on the wheel cylinder.
3. Remove the brake shoe assembly. 4. Disconnect the parking brake cable from the parking brake
lever.
5. Remove the upper return spring, self-adjuster lever, and self-adjuster spring, and separate the
brake shoes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 5912
6. Remove the wave washer, parking brake lever, and pivot pin from the brake shoe by removing
the U-clip.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 5913
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair Assembly
1. Apply brake cylinder grease (P/N: 08733 - B020E) or equivalent rubber grease to the sliding
surface of the pivot pin, and insert the pin into the
brake shoe.
2. Install the parking brake lever and wave washer on the pivot pin and secure them with the U-clip.
NOTE: Pinch the U-clip securely to prevent the pivot pin from coming out of the brake shoe.
3. Connect the parking brake cable to the parking brake lever. 4. Apply grease on each sliding
surface.
WARNING: Contaminated brake linings reduce stopping ability. Keep grease or oil off the brake
linings. Wipe any excess grease off the parts.
Lubricating Sliding Surfaces
- Apply brake cylinder grease (P/N: 08733 - B020E) or equivalent rubber grease to the sliding
surfaces as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Disassembly > Page 5914
Brake Shoe Lubrication Points
- Apply Molykote 44MA to the brake shoe ends and opposite edges of the shoes as shown.
5. Clean the threaded portions of clevises A and B. Coat the threads of the Devises with grease. To
shorten the clevises, turn the adjuster bolt. 6. Hook the self-adjuster spring to the self-adjuster lever
first, then to the brake shoe. 7. Install the clevises and upper return spring, noting the installation
direction.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the wheel cylinder dust covers.
8. Install the lower return spring.
9. Install the tension pins and retaining springs.
10. Install the brake drum. 11. If the wheel cylinder has been removed, bleed the brake system,
and check for leaks at brake line connections, and retighten if necessary. 12. Depress the brake
pedal several times to set the self-adjusting brake. 13. Adjust the parking brake.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Bleeder Screw 60 in.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5918
Wheel Cylinder: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid. Use only clean DOT 3 or 4 brake fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5919
Wheel Cylinder: Testing and Inspection
Wheel Cylinder Assemblies
CAUTION: Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does
contact the paint, wash it off immediately with water.
NOTE:
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system. Coat the piston, piston cup, and wheel cylinder bore
with clean brake fluid. Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5920
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid. Use only clean DOT 3 or 4 brake fluid.
Removing Wheel Cylinder From Backing Plate
1. Remove the brake shoes. See: Brake Shoe/Service and Repair 2. Disconnect the brake line
from the wheel cylinder. 3. Remove the wheel cylinder mounting bolts and the wheel cylinder from
the backing plate. 4. Apply sealant between the wheel cylinder and backing plate and install the
wheel cylinder.
Specs: Bleed Screw 7 Nm (5.1 lb.ft.) Brake Line Nut 15 Nm (11 lb.ft.) Wheel Cylinder Bolts 9 Nm
(6.5 lb.ft.)
5. Install the brake shoes. See: Brake Shoe/Service and Repair 6. Bleed brakes. See: Brake
Bleeding/Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Without Anti-Lock Brakes
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without Anti-Lock Brakes
CAUTION:
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle, it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
NOTE: The reservoir on the master cylinder must be at the MAX (upper) level mark at the start of
the bleeding procedure and checked after bleeding each brake caliper. Add fluid as required.
1. Make sure the brake fluid level in the reservoir is at the MAX (upper) level line. 2. Have someone
slowly pump the brake pedal several times, then apply steady pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Without Anti-Lock Brakes > Page 5926
3. Loosen the brake bleed screw to allow air to escape from the system. Then tighten the bleed
screw securely.
Brake Bleeding Sequence
4. Repeat the procedure for each wheel in the sequence shown until air bubbles no longer appear
in the fluid. 5. Refill the master cylinder reservoir to the MAX (upper) level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Front 5410 Type * Mounting Bolt 80 ft.lb
Model No. stamped on caliper body
Bleeder Screw 78 in.lb
Attaching Bolts 24 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
2056 Type * Mounting Bolt 80 ft.lb
Model No. stamped on caliper body
Bleeder Screw 78 in.lb
Attaching Bolts 20 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
Rear Arm Attaching Bolts 17 ft.lb
Mounting Bolts 17 ft.lb
Bracket Mounting Bolts 28 ft.lb
Bleed Screw 78 in.lb
Parking Nut 20 ft.lb
Banjo Bolt 25 ft.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front
Brake Caliper: Diagrams Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front > Page 5932
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front > Page 5933
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Brake Caliper: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 5936
Brake Caliper: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service Precautions > Page 5937
Brake Caliper: Application and ID
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers. The Calipers can be identified by the "5410" or
"2056" stamped on the caliper body. Check the type of brake caliper before servicing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Front
Type 5410
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
1. Remove the banjo bolt, and disconnect the brake hose from the caliper. 2. Remove the caliper
bolts, then remove the caliper from the bracket.
3. Remove the caliper pins and pin boots from the caliper bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5940
4. If necessary, apply compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet to get the piston out. Place a shop rag
or wooden block as shown to cushion the piston
when it is expelled. Use low pressure air in short spurts.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston.
- Do not use high air pressure; use an OSHA approved 30 PSI nozzle.
5. Remove the piston from the caliper, and check the piston for scoring.
6. Remove the boot clip, piston boot and piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
Type 2056
Front Brake Calipers
NOTE: There are two types of front brake calipers: The caliper types can be identified by the
"5410" or "2056" stamped on the caliper body as shown. Check the type of the brake caliper before
servicing.
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5941
1. Remove the banjo bolt, and disconnect the brake hose from the caliber. 2. Remove caliper bolt
B. pivot the caliper up out of the way, then remove the caliper from the bracket.
3. Remove the guide pin boot from sleeve A on the caliper bracket.
4. Remove the pin boot, sleeve B and sleeve boot from the caliber body.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5942
5. If necessary, apply compressed air to the caliper fluid inlet to get the piston out. Place a shop rag
or wooden block as shown to cushion the piston
when it is expelled. Use low pressure air in short spurts.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston.
- Do not use high air pressure; use an OSHA approved 30 PSI nozzle.
6. Remove the piston from the caliper, and check the piston for scoring.
Removing Clip, Boot And Seal
7. Remove the boot clip, piston boot and piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
Type 5410
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5943
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss
of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
1. Clean the piston and caliper bore with brake fluid, and inspect for wear and damage. 2. Coat the
new piston seal with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install the seal in
the cylinder groove.
3. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and inside of a
new piston boot, and secure install it in the caliper with
the new boot clip.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the caliper cylinder wall.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5944
4. Lubricate the caliper and piston with brake fluid, then install the piston in the cylinder with the
dished end facing in. 5. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding
surface of the pins and the inside of the new pin boots.
6. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the caliper bracket properly. 7. Insert pin A and pin B into
the caliper bracket. 8. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the pins properly. 9. Install the brake
pads in their original positions.
10. Push in the piston so that the caliper will fit over the pads, and install the caliper. 11. Tighten
the caliper bolts.
12. Connect the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt. 13.
Fill the brake reservoir and bleed the brake system. 14. Perform the following checks.
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check for brake hoses for interference and twisting.
Type 2056
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5945
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, always reinstall the brake pads in their original positions to prevent loss
of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow Out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and Other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or Other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
NOTE:
- Coat the piston, piston seal, and caliper bore with clean brake fluid.
- Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
1. Clean the piston and caliper bore with brake fluid, and inspect for wear and damage. 2. Coat a
new piston seal with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install the seal in
the cylinder groove.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5946
3. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and inside of a
new piston boot, and secure install it in the caliper with
a new boot clip.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the caliper cylinder wall.
4. Lubricate the caliper and piston with brake fluid, then install the piston in the cylinder with the
dished end facing in. 5. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding
surface of sleeve B and the inside of the new pin and sleeve boots.
6. Install the new sleeve and pin boots and sleeve B on the caliper.
NOTE: Be sure to install the boots into the grooves in the caliper and sleeve B properly.
7. Apply the recommended seal grease in the caliper seal set to the sliding surface of sleeve A and
the inside of a new guide pin boot. 8. Install the guide pin boot into the groove in the sleeve A.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5947
9. Make sure that the brake pad retainers and brake pads are in their original positions.
10. Install the caliper onto sleeve A, and pivot it down into position.
NOTE: Install the guide pin boot into the groove in the caliper properly.
11. Connect the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt.
12. Tighten the caliper bolt B. 13. Fill the brake reservoir and bleed the brake system. 14. Perform
the following checks.
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check for brake hoses for interference and twisting
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5948
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Rear
Disassembly
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
1. Remove the caliper shield.
2. Remove the lock pin and clevis pin. Remove the cable clip, and disconnect the cable from the
arm. 3. Remove the banjo bolt and two sealing washers.
4. Remove the two caliper mounting bolts and caliper body from the bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5949
5. Remove the pins and pin boots from the caliper bracket.
6. Remove the pad spring from the caliper body.
7. Remove the piston by rotating the piston counterclockwise with the tool, and remove the piston
boot.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the piston.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5950
8. Remove the piston seal.
CAUTION: Take care not to damage the cylinder bore.
9. Install the special tool between the caliper body and spring cover.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the inside of the caliper cylinder during caliper disassembly.
10. Position the locknuts as shown, then turn the shaft until the plate just contacts the caliper body.
NOTE: Do not compress the spring under the spring cover.
11. Turn the shaft clockwise 1/4 - 1/2 turn to compress adjusting spring B in the caliper body.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5951
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the inner components, do not turn the shaft more than 1/2 turn.
12. Lower the locknuts fully, and tighten them securely.
NOTE: Keep the locknuts in this position until you reinstall the circlip.
13. Remove the circlip with snap ring pliers.
Removing Adjusting Bolt
14. Hold the plate with your fingers, and turn the shaft counterclockwise. Remove the special tool
from the caliper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5952
15. Remove the adjusting bolt. 16. Remove the spring cover, adjusting spring B. spacer, bearing A,
and cup from the adjusting bolt.
17. Remove the sleeve piston, and remove the pin from the cam in the caliper body.
18. Remove the return spring. 19. Remove the parking lever and cam as an assembly from the
caliper body.
CAUTION: Do not loosen the parking nut with the cam installed in the caliper body. If the lever and
shaft must be separated, hold the lever in a vise, and loosen the parking nut.
20. Remove the cam boot.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5953
Assembly
WARNING:
- Never use an air hose or dry brush to clean brake assemblies.
- Use an OSHA-approved vacuum cleaner to avoid breathing brake dust.
- Contaminated brake discs or pads reduce stopping ability.
- When reusing the pads, install them in their original positions to prevent loss of braking efficiency.
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; It may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system.
1. Pack all cavities of the needle bearing with the recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal
set.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5954
2. Coat a new cam boot with recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install it in
the caliper body. 3. Apply recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set to the pin contacting
area of the cam, and install the cam and lever assembly into the
caliper body.
4. Install the return spring.
CAUTION: When the cam and lever were separated, be sure to assemble them before installing the cam in the
caliper body. Install the lever and spring washer, apply locking agent to the threads, and tighten the
parking nut while holding the lever with a vise.
- Avoid damaging the cam boot since it must be installed before the cam.
- When installing the cam, do not allow the cam boot lips to turn outside in.
5. Install the pin in the cam. 6. Install a new O-ring on the sleeve piston. 7. Install the sleeve piston
so that the hole in the bottom of the piston is aligned with the pin in the cam, and the two pins on
the piston are aligned
with the holes in the caliper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5955
8. Coat a new cup with recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set, and install it with its
groove facing the bearing A side of the adjusting
bolt.
9. Fit the bearing A, spacer, adjusting spring B. and spring cover on the adjusting bolt, and install
them in the caliper cylinder.
10. Install the special tool onto the spring cover, and turn the shaft until the locknut contacts the
plate. 11. Check that the flared end of the spring cover is below the circlip groove.
12. Install the circlip into the groove, then remove the special tool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5956
NOTE: Check that the circlip is seated in the groove properly.
13. Coat a new piston seal with recommended silicone grease in the caliper seal set, and install it
in the caliper. 14. Apply recommended rubber grease in the caliper seal set to the sealing lips and
inside of a new piston boot, and install it in the caliper.
15. Coat the outside of the piston with brake fluid, and install it onto the adjusting bolt while rotating
it clockwise with the tool.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the piston and piston boot.
16. Install the pad spring onto the caliper. 17. Apply the recommended pin grease in the caliper
seal set to the sliding surface of the pins and inside of the new pin boots.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5957
18. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the caliper bracket properly. 19. Insert pin A and pin B
into the caliper bracket. 20. Install the pin boots into the grooves in the pins properly. 21. Install the
brake pad retainers and brake pads. 22. Align the cutout in the piston with the tab on the inner pad.
23. Install the caliper onto the caliper bracket, and tighten the caliper mounting bolts. 24. Connect
the brake hose to the caliper with new sealing washers, and tighten the banjo bolt.
25. Insert the cable through the arm, and connect the cable to the lever with the clevis pin and lock
pin. Install the cable clip securely. 26. Install the caliper shield.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5958
27. Fill the brake reservoir, and bleed the brake system. 28. Operate the brake pedal several times,
then adjust the parking brake. 29. After installation, perform the following checks:
- Check for leaks at hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary.
- Check the parking brake lever for operation, and adjust it if necessary.
- Check for brake hose for interference or twisting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Fluid type DOT 3 or 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Photo 22
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Photo 22
Left Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Photo 22 > Page 5966
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Additional Image
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS, before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5967
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
The brake system indicator light comes on to alert the driver that the parking brake is applied, or
that the brake fluid level is low. It also comes on as a bulb test when the engine is cranked.
Brake Fluid Level
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied through fuse 25 to the brake
system light. If the brake fluid level is low, the brake fluid level switch closes, providing ground to
the circuit. The brake system light then comes on, alerting the driver to a low brake fluid level in the
brake master cylinder. (Check brake pad wear before you add fluid).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 5968
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications
Brake Hose/Line: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Line-to-Hose ........................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.) Line-to-ABS Modulator Unit .................................
............................................................................................................................... 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
Proportioning Control Valve-to-Line
................................................................................................................................................... 15
Nm (11 ft. lbs.) Master Cylinder-to-Line ...............................................................................................
........................................................................ 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5972
Brake Hose/Line: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect the brake hoses for damage, deterioration, leaks, interference, and twisting. 2. Check the
brake lines for damage, rusting, and leakage. Also check for bent brake lines. 3. Check for leaks at
hose and line joints and connections, and retighten if necessary. 4. Check the master cylinder and
ABS modulator unit for damage and leakage.
CAUTION: Replace the brake hose din whenever the brake hose is serviced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5973
Brake Hose/Line: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
1. Replace the brake hose if the hose is twisted, cracked, or if it leaks.
2. Disconnect the brake hose from the brake line using a 10 mm flare nut wrench.
3. Remove and discard the brake hose clip from the brake hose. 4. Remove the banjo bolt, and
disconnect the brake hose from the caliper. 5. Remove the brake hose bracket from the knuckle.
6. Install the brake hose bracket and brake hose onto the knuckle first, then connect the brake
hose to the caliper with the banjo bolt and new sealing
washers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Hose/Line > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5974
7. Install the brake hose onto the upper brake hose bracket with a new brake hose clip. 8. Connect
the brake line to the brake hose. 9. After installing the brake hose, bleed the brake system.
10. Perform the following checks:
- Check the brake hose and line joint for leaks, and tighten if necessary.
- Check the brake hoses for interference and twisting.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Brake Line ...........................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Proportioning/Combination
Valve > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5978
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair
The dual portioning valve is not a serviceable component and must be replaced if found to be
faulty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications
Power Unit: Specifications
MODULATOR *
Flare Nuts ............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 15 Nm (11 lb.ft.) Torx Bolts ...................................................................
....................................................................................................................... 9.8 Nm (7 lb.ft.) 8 mm
Bolts .....................................................................................................................................................
................................... 22 Nm (16 lb.ft.)
* For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5982
Power Unit: Locations
Right Side Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5983
Power Unit: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- Take care not to damage or deform the brake lines during removal and installation.
- To prevent the brake fluid from flowing, plug and cover the hose ends and joints with a shop towel
or equivalent material.
WARNING:
- Accumulator retains brake fluid under high pressure. Relieve high pressure through maintenance
bleeder prior to performing service on the ABS Modulator or Power unit, otherwise personal injury
may result.
- The ABS Accumulator contains high pressure nitrogen gas. Do not puncture, expose to the flame,
or attempt to disassemble the accumulator or it may explode, resulting in severe personal injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5984
Power Unit: Description and Operation
MODES OF OPERATION
The ABS modulator consists of the inlet solenoid valve, outlet solenoid valve, reservoir, pump,
pump motor and the damping chamber. The modulator reduces the caliper fluid pressure directly,
and it is also referred to as a circulating type because the brake fluid circulates through the caliper,
reservoir and the master cylinder. The hydraulic control has three modes: pressure reduction,
pressure retaining and pressure intensifying. The hydraulic circuit is the independent four channel
type, one channel for each wheel.
ABS Modulator Schematic
Pressure Intensifying Mode - Inlet valve open, outlet valve closed Master cylinder fluid is pumped
out to the caliper.
Pressure Retaining Mode - Inlet valve closed, outlet valve closed Caliper fluid is retained by the
inlet valve and outlet valve.
Pressure Reduction Mode - Inlet valve closed, outlet valve open Caliper fluid flows through the
outlet valve to the reservoir.
Motor Operation Mode - When starting the pressure reduction mode, the pump motor is ON. When
stopping ABS operation, the pump motor is OFF. The reservoir fluid is pumped out by the pump,
through the damping chamber, to the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5985
Wheel Speed And Modulator Control Schematic
WHEEL SPEED AND MODULATOR CONTROL
When the wheel speed drops sharply below the vehicle speed, the inlet valve closes to retain the
caliper fluid pressure. When the wheel speed drops further, the outlet valve opens momentarily to
reduce the caliper fluid pressure. The pump motor starts at this time. As the wheel speed is
restored, the inlet valve opens momentarily to increase the caliper fluid pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Power Unit <--> [Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 5986
Power Unit: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- Take care not to damage or deform the brake lines during removal and installation.
- To prevent the brake fluid from flowing, plug and cover the hose ends and joints with a shop towel
or equivalent material.
NOTE: Tighten the flare nuts to 15 Nm (1.5 kgf.m, 11 ft. lbs.) .
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the modulator unit 10P and pump motor 2P connectors. 2. Disconnect the brake
lines, then remove the modulator unit.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the modulator unit, then connect the brake lines. 2. Connect the modulator unit 10P and
pump motor 2P connectors. 3. Bleed the brake system. 4. Start the engine, and check that the ABS
indicator light goes off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-078 > Oct > 03 > Brakes - Brake Indicator
Comes ON/Goes OFF
Brake Master Cylinder: Customer Interest Brakes - Brake Indicator Comes ON/Goes OFF
03-078
October 28, 2003
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 1997-01 CR-V-ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL *1998-02 Accord ALL*
Brake System Indicator Comes On and Goes Off
(Supersedes 03-078, dated October 17, 2003)
Updated information is shown with asterisks.
SYMPTOM
The brake system indicator comes on after a cold start, then goes off after a few minutes of driving.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The master cylinder reservoir filter is not allowing the cap to vent properly, causing the fluid level in
the filter to change.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the master cylinder reservoir filter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Master Cylinder Reservoir Filter:
P/N 46666-S04-J02, H/C 7602899
Float:
P/N 46662-S84-999, H/C 5896766
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 46666-S04-J02
H/C 7602899
Defect Code: 05401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
1. Make sure the brake master cylinder fluid is at its proper level.
2. Release the parking brake.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 03-078 > Oct > 03 > Brakes - Brake Indicator
Comes ON/Goes OFF > Page 5995
3. Check the movement of the float in the reservoir:
^ If the float moves up and down freely, go to step 4.
^ If the float does not move freely, replace the cap and recheck the symptom.
4. Check that the float does float in brake fluid:
^ If it floats, go to step 5.
^ If it sinks, replace the float and recheck the symptom.
5. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cap. You should find no continuity when the
float is up, and continuity when the float is down.
^ If continuity is correct, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If continuity is not correct, replace the cap and recheck the symptom.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the brake master cylinder cap.
2. Remove and discard the old filter.
3. Install the new filter in the master cylinder.
4. Reinstall the brake master cylinder cap.
5. Check that the brake system indicator is off.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Master Cylinder: >
SN041214 > Dec > 04 > Brake System - Don't Skip Diagnosis Steps in 03-078
Brake Master Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins Brake System - Don't Skip Diagnosis Steps
in 03-078
SOURCE: Honda Service News December 2004
TITLE: Don't Skip DIAGNOSIS Steps in S/B 03-078
APPLIES TO: All Models
SERVICE TIP: We can't emphasize enough how important it is to do all the steps called out in
DIAGNOSIS for S/B 03-078, Brake System Indicator Comes On and Goes Off. It's particularly
important that you're checking the movement of the float in the master cylinder reservoir and you're
doing the continuity check for the reservoir cap. If you skip these steps, it could lead to needless
replacement of the float and cap, and a future come-back from your customer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Master Cylinder: > 03-078
> Oct > 03 > Brakes - Brake Indicator Comes ON/Goes OFF
Brake Master Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Brake Indicator Comes ON/Goes
OFF
03-078
October 28, 2003
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 1997-01 CR-V-ALL 1997-01 Prelude - ALL *1998-02 Accord ALL*
Brake System Indicator Comes On and Goes Off
(Supersedes 03-078, dated October 17, 2003)
Updated information is shown with asterisks.
SYMPTOM
The brake system indicator comes on after a cold start, then goes off after a few minutes of driving.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The master cylinder reservoir filter is not allowing the cap to vent properly, causing the fluid level in
the filter to change.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the master cylinder reservoir filter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Master Cylinder Reservoir Filter:
P/N 46666-S04-J02, H/C 7602899
Float:
P/N 46662-S84-999, H/C 5896766
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 46666-S04-J02
H/C 7602899
Defect Code: 05401
Symptom Code: 03205
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
DIAGNOSIS
1. Make sure the brake master cylinder fluid is at its proper level.
2. Release the parking brake.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Master Cylinder: > 03-078
> Oct > 03 > Brakes - Brake Indicator Comes ON/Goes OFF > Page 6005
3. Check the movement of the float in the reservoir:
^ If the float moves up and down freely, go to step 4.
^ If the float does not move freely, replace the cap and recheck the symptom.
4. Check that the float does float in brake fluid:
^ If it floats, go to step 5.
^ If it sinks, replace the float and recheck the symptom.
5. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cap. You should find no continuity when the
float is up, and continuity when the float is down.
^ If continuity is correct, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
^ If continuity is not correct, replace the cap and recheck the symptom.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the brake master cylinder cap.
2. Remove and discard the old filter.
3. Install the new filter in the master cylinder.
4. Reinstall the brake master cylinder cap.
5. Check that the brake system indicator is off.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Brake Master Cylinder: > SN041214 >
Dec > 04 > Brake System - Don't Skip Diagnosis Steps in 03-078
Brake Master Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins Brake System - Don't Skip Diagnosis Steps
in 03-078
SOURCE: Honda Service News December 2004
TITLE: Don't Skip DIAGNOSIS Steps in S/B 03-078
APPLIES TO: All Models
SERVICE TIP: We can't emphasize enough how important it is to do all the steps called out in
DIAGNOSIS for S/B 03-078, Brake System Indicator Comes On and Goes Off. It's particularly
important that you're checking the movement of the float in the master cylinder reservoir and you're
doing the continuity check for the reservoir cap. If you skip these steps, it could lead to needless
replacement of the float and cap, and a future come-back from your customer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Master Cylinder
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications Master Cylinder
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Master Cylinder > Page 6013
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications Master Cylinder Push Rod
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Piston-to-Pushrod Clearance
..................................................................................................................................................... 0 0.4 mm (0 - 0.02 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Locknut ................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6014
Brake Master Cylinder: Adjustments
NOTE:
- The master cylinder pushrod-to-piston clearance must be checked and adjustments made, if
necessary, before installing the master cylinder.
- ABS type is shown, conventional brake type is similar.
1. Set the special tool on the master cylinder body; push in the center shaft until the top of it
contacts the end of the secondary piston by turning the
adjusting nut.
2. Without disturbing the center shaft's position, install the special tool upside down on the booster.
3. Install the master cylinder nuts, and tighten to the specified torque. 4. Connect the booster in-line
with a vacuum gauge 0 - 101 kPa (0 - 760 mmHg, 30 in.Hg) to the booster's engine vacuum
supply, and maintain an
engine speed that will deliver 66 kPa (500 mmHg, 20 in.Hg) vacuum.
5. With a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the gauge body and the adjusting nut as
shown.
Clearance: 0 - 0.4 mm (0 - 0.02 inch)
NOTE: If the clearance between the gauge body and adjusting nut is 0.4 mm (0.02 inch), the
pushrod-to-piston clearance is 0 mm. However, if the clearance between the gauge body and
adjusting nut is 0 mm, the pushrod-to-piston clearance is 0.4 mm (0.02 inch) or more. Therefore, it
must be adjusted and rechecked.
6. If clearance is incorrect, loosen the star locknut, and turn the adjuster in or out to adjust.
NOTE: Adjust the clearance while the specified vacuum is applied to the booster.
- Hold the clevis while adjusting.
7. Tighten the star locknut securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6015
8. Remove the special tool.
Brake Booster Length With Booster Removed
9. Adjust the pushrod length as shown if the booster is removed.
10. Install the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6016
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Be careful not to bend or damage the brake lines when removing the master cylinder.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
1. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch connectors. 2. Remove the reservoir cap from the master
cylinder. 3. The brake fluid may be sucked out through the top of the master cylinder reservoir with
a syringe. 4. Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder. 5. Remove the master cylinder
mounting nuts and washers. 6. Remove the master cylinder from the brake booster. 7. Disconnect
the vacuum hose from the brake booster. 8. Remove the cotter pin and clevis pin from the clevis.
CAUTION: Do not disconnect the clevis by removing it from the operating rod of the brake booster.
If the clevis is loosened, adjust the pushrod length before installing the brake booster.
9. Remove the four booster mounting nuts.
10. Pull the brake booster forward until the clevis is clear of the bulkhead. 11. Remove the brake
booster from the engine compartment. 12. Install the brake booster and master cylinder in the
reverse order of removal.
CAUTION: -
When connecting the brake lines, make sure that there is no interference between the brake lines
and other parts.
- Be careful not to bend or damage the brake lines when installing the master cylinder.
NOTE: If replacing the master cylinder or brake booster, check and adjust the pushrod clearance
before installing the master cylinder.
13. Fill the master cylinder reservoir, and bleed the brake system. 14. After installation, check the
brake pedal height and brake pedal free play and adjust if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Bleeder Screw 60 in.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6020
Wheel Cylinder: Service Precautions
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid. Use only clean DOT 3 or 4 brake fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6021
Wheel Cylinder: Testing and Inspection
Wheel Cylinder Assemblies
CAUTION: Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does
contact the paint, wash it off immediately with water.
NOTE:
- Clean all parts in brake fluid and air dry; blow out all passages with compressed air.
- Before reassembling, check that all parts are free of dust and other foreign particles.
- Replace parts with new ones whenever specified to do so.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid.
- Always use Genuine Honda DOT 3 Brake Fluid. Using a non-Honda brake fluid can cause
corrosion and decrease the life of the system. Coat the piston, piston cup, and wheel cylinder bore
with clean brake fluid. Replace all rubber parts with new ones whenever disassembled.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6022
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Do not spill brake fluid on the car; it may damage the paint if brake fluid does contact the paint,
wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
- Make sure no dirt or other foreign matter is allowed to contaminate the brake fluid.
- Do not mix different brands of brake fluid as they may not be compatible.
- Do not reuse the drained fluid. Use only clean DOT 3 or 4 brake fluid.
Removing Wheel Cylinder From Backing Plate
1. Remove the brake shoes. See: Drum Brake System/Brake Shoe/Service and Repair 2.
Disconnect the brake line from the wheel cylinder. 3. Remove the wheel cylinder mounting bolts
and the wheel cylinder from the backing plate. 4. Apply sealant between the wheel cylinder and
backing plate and install the wheel cylinder.
Specs: Bleed Screw 7 Nm (5.1 lb.ft.) Brake Line Nut 15 Nm (11 lb.ft.) Wheel Cylinder Bolts 9 Nm
(6.5 lb.ft.)
5. Install the brake shoes. See: Drum Brake System/Brake Shoe/Service and Repair 6. Bleed
brakes. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Parking Brake Cable: Testing and Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6027
CAUTION: The parking brake cables must not be bent or distorted. This will lead to stiff operation
and premature cable failure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6028
Parking Brake Cable: Adjustments
1. Pull the parking brake lever with 196 N (20 kgf, 44 lbs.) force to fully apply the parking brake.
The parking brake lever should be locked within
the specified notches.
Lever Locked Notches: 6 - 9
2. Adjust the parking brake if the lever notches are out of specification.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6029
Parking Brake Cable: Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6030
CAUTION: The parking brake cables must not be bent or distorted. This will lead to stiff operation
and premature cable failure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Lever > Component
Information > Specifications
Parking Brake Lever: Specifications
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
Play In Stroke [1] .................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 6 - 9 Notches[2]
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Parking Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
................................................. 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
[1] At 196 N (20 kgf, 44 ft. lbs.) lever force. [2] To be locked when pulled.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Automatic Transmission
Parking Brake Pedal: Specifications Automatic Transmission
Pedal Height [1] ...................................................................................................................................
................................................ 161 mm (6 5/16 inch) Free Play .........................................................
............................................................................................................................ 1 - 5 mm (1/16 3/16 inch)
[1] With floor mat removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications > Automatic Transmission > Page 6038
Parking Brake Pedal: Specifications Manual Transmission
Pedal Height [1] ...................................................................................................................................
................................................ 156.5 mm (6.16 inch) Free Play .........................................................
............................................................................................................................ 1 - 5 mm (1/16 3/16 inch)
[1] With floor mat removed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Release Switch: Locations
Below Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
............................................ 13 Nm (108 inch lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6049
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
FUNCTIONAL TEST
1. With the engine stopped, depress the brake pedal several times to deplete the vacuum reservoir,
then depress the pedal hard and hold it for 15
seconds. If the pedal sinks, either the master cylinder is bypassing internally, or the brake system
(master cylinder, lines, modulator, proportioning control valve, or caliper) is leaking.
2. Start the engine with the pedal depressed. If the pedal sinks slightly, the vacuum booster is
operating normally. If the pedal height does not vary,
the booster or check valve is faulty.
3. With the engine running, depress the brake pedal lightly. Apply just enough pressure to hold
back automatic transmission creep. If the brake pedal
sinks more than 25 mm (1.0 inch) in three minutes, the master cylinder is faulty. A slight change in
pedal height when the A/C compressor cycles on and off if normal. (The A/C compressor load
changes the vacuum available to the booster.)
LEAK TEST
1. Depress the brake pedal with the engine running, then stop the engine. If the pedal height does
not vary while depressed for 30 seconds, the
vacuum booster is OK. If the pedal rises, the booster is faulty.
2. With the engine stopped, depress the brake pedal several times using normal pressure. When
the pedal is first depressed, it should be low. On
consecutive applications, the pedal height should gradually rise. If the pedal position does not vary,
check the booster check valve.
BOOSTER CHECK VALVE TEST
1. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose at the booster. 2. Start the engine and let it idle.
There should be vacuum. If no vacuum is available, the check valve is not working properly.
Replace the brake
booster vacuum hose and check valve, and retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6050
Vacuum Brake Booster: Adjustments
NOTE:
- The master cylinder pushrod-to-piston clearance must be checked and adjustments made, if
necessary, before installing the master cylinder.
- ABS type is shown, conventional brake type is similar.
1. Set the special tool on the master cylinder body; push in the center shaft until the top of it
contacts the end of the secondary piston by turning the
adjusting nut.
2. Without disturbing the center shaft's position, install the special tool upside down on the booster.
3. Install the master cylinder nuts, and tighten to the specified torque. 4. Connect the booster in-line
with a vacuum gauge 0 - 101 kPa (0 - 760 mmHg, 30 in.Hg) to the booster's engine vacuum
supply, and maintain an
engine speed that will deliver 66 kPa (500 mmHg, 20 in.Hg) vacuum.
5. With a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the gauge body and the adjusting nut as
shown.
Clearance: 0 - 0.4 mm (0 - 0.02 inch)
NOTE: If the clearance between the gauge body and adjusting nut is 0.4 mm (0.02 inch), the
pushrod-to-piston clearance is 0 mm. However, if the clearance between the gauge body and
adjusting nut is 0 mm, the pushrod-to-piston clearance is 0.4 mm (0.02 inch) or more. Therefore, it
must be adjusted and rechecked.
6. If clearance is incorrect, loosen the star locknut, and turn the adjuster in or out to adjust.
NOTE: Adjust the clearance while the specified vacuum is applied to the booster.
- Hold the clevis while adjusting.
7. Tighten the star locknut securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6051
8. Remove the special tool.
Brake Booster Length With Booster Removed
9. Adjust the pushrod length as shown if the booster is removed.
10. Install the master cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6052
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Be careful not to bend or damage the brake lines when removing the master cylinder.
- Do not spill brake fluid on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if brake fluid does contact the
paint, wash it off immediately with water.
- To prevent spills, cover the hose joints with rags or shop towels.
1. Disconnect the brake fluid level switch connectors. 2. Remove the reservoir cap from the master
cylinder. 3. The brake fluid may be sucked out through the top of the master cylinder reservoir with
a syringe. 4. Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder. 5. Remove the master cylinder
mounting nuts and washers. 6. Remove the master cylinder from the brake booster. 7. Disconnect
the vacuum hose from the brake booster. 8. Remove the cotter pin and clevis pin from the clevis.
CAUTION: Do not disconnect the clevis by removing it from the operating rod of the brake booster.
If the clevis is loosened, adjust the pushrod length before installing the brake booster.
9. Remove the four booster mounting nuts.
10. Pull the brake booster forward until the clevis is clear of the bulkhead. 11. Remove the brake
booster from the engine compartment. 12. Install the brake booster and master cylinder in the
reverse order of removal.
CAUTION: -
When connecting the brake lines, make sure that there is no interference between the brake lines
and other parts.
- Be careful not to bend or damage the brake lines when installing the master cylinder.
NOTE: If replacing the master cylinder or brake booster, check and adjust the pushrod clearance
before installing the master cylinder.
13. Fill the master cylinder reservoir, and bleed the brake system. 14. After installation, check the
brake pedal height and brake pedal free play and adjust if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: > 96032 > Jun >
96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking
Technical Service Bulletin # 96032 Date: 960614
Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking
Bulletin No. 96-O32
Issue Date JUNE 14, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BRAKES
Safety Recall: Civic Power Brake Booster Check Valve
BACKGROUND
The brake booster check valve in certain 1996 Civics may stick, which could result in a loss of the
brake's power assist. A loss of power assist would require greater than normal brake pedal force,
resulting in a reduction in braking performance.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Owners of affected vehicles will be contacted by mail and asked to take the car to a dealership for
repair. The text of the customer letter is at the end of this service bulletin.
If any affected vehicles are in the dealership's inventory, repair them before they are sold or put
into use as demonstrators.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Operation number: 413304
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 46402-S01-A11 H/C 4932018
Defect code: 251
Contention code: K11
Template ID: 96-032A
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Clean the brake booster vacuum hose and check valve.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: > 96032 > Jun >
96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6061
1. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose from the car.
2. Take the hose to the sink. Turn on the hot water tap on the faucet. Let the water run until it gets
as hot as possible.
3. Hold the brake booster end of the vacuum hose with a pair of pliers. Place that end under the
water stream, and let the water flow through the hose for one minute.
NOTE:
Make sure you are holding the correct end of the hose under the water stream. The check valve
allows the water to flow only one way.
4. Without draining the water from the hose, place the hose in a large container filled with hot
water. Make sure the check valve is sitting horizontally. Leave the hose immersed in the container
for five minutes.
5. Remove the hose from the container. As before, hold the brake booster end under the hot water
stream from the faucet, and flow water through the hose for one minute. Make sure water comes
out of the engine end of the hose.
6. Remove the hose from the water stream, and shake as much water as you can out of the hose.
Blow compressed air into the brake booster end of
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: > 96032 > Jun >
96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6062
the hose to remove the remaining water.
7. Reinstall the vacuum hose on the car.
8. Start the engine, and let it run until it reaches normal operating temperature.
9. Turn off the engine. Fully depress and release the brake pedal five times. You will feel the brake
pedal get harder to push each time you depress it.
10. Press on the brake pedal as you start the engine. The pedal should go down at least another
inch as the engine starts. If it does not, diagnose the problem using normal troubleshooting
procedures.
11. Center-punch a completion mark above the last character of the engine compartment VIN.
Customer Letter
Example of Customer Letter
June 1996
Safety Recall: Civic Power Brake Booster Check Valve
Dear Civic Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. has determined that a defect which relates to motor
vehicle safety exists in the brake booster vacuum hose of certain 1996 Civics. Our records indicate
that you may own one of the affected vehicles.
what Is the defect?
The brake booster check valve in certain 1996 Civics may stick, which could result in a loss of the
brake's power assist without prior warning. A loss of power assist would require greater than
normal brake pedal force, resulting in a reduction in braking performance. This could lead to a
vehicle crash.
what should you do?
Call any authorized Honda automobile dealer and make an appointment to have your car repaired.
They will clean the brake booster vacuum hose to prevent this problem from happening. This
procedure will be done free of charge. No parts are required. This procedure takes approximately
half an hour; but please plan to leave your car with the dealership for half a day to allow them
flexibility in scheduling.
Check your brakes. Until the dealer repairs your car, you and anyone else who drives your car
must check the brakes every time before you begin driving.
1. Before starting the engine. fully depress and release the brake pedal five times.
^ You will feel the brake pedal get harder to push each time you depress it.
2. Then, press on the brake pedal as you start the engine.
^ The pedal should go down at least another inch as the engine starts.
- If it does, the check valve is working and you may drive the car.
- If it does not, and the pedal is still very hard to depress, the check valve is stuck. contact your
Honda dealer, and do not drive the car.
WARNING
Have your car fixed as soon as possible. until you do, you must check the brakes every time before
driving. Failure to do so could result in a crash in which you could be seriously hurt or killed.
Who to contact If you experience problems.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: > 96032 > Jun >
96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6063
If you are not satisfied with the service you receive from your Honda dealer, you may write to:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc. Customer Information Service, Mail Stop 540-2S-2A 1919
Torrance Blvd., Torrance, CA 90501-2746
If you believe that American Honda or the dealer has failed or is unable to remedy the defect in
your car, without charge, within a reasonable period of time (60 days from the date you first contact
the dealer for an appointment), you may submit a complaint to:
Administrator National Highway Traffic Safety Administration 400 Seventh St, S.W. Washington,
D.C. 20590
Or call the toll-free Auto Safety Hotline at (800) 424-9393 (residents of Washington D.C. should call
366-0123).
what to do if you feel this notice is in error.
This notice was mailed to you according to the most current information we have available. If you
no longer own a Civic, or the name and address information in this notice is incorrect, please fill out
and return the included Information Change Card. This will help us to update our records.
If you have questions.
If you are not sure how to contact a Honda dealer, or have questions about this notice, please call
the Honda Customer Information Service Office at (800) 999-1009.
We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: >
NHTSA96V106000 > Jun > 96 > Recall 96V106000: Brake Booster Check Valve
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: Recalls Recall 96V106000: Brake Booster Check Valve
A SOAPY LUBRICANT WAS USED TO INSERT THE CHECK VALVE INTO THE VACUUM HOSE
WHICH CAUSES THE BRAKE BOOSTER CHECK VALVE TO STICK.
THIS CONDITION CAN CAUSE A LOSS OF THE BRAKE'S POWER ASSIST RESULTING IN A
REDUCTION IN BRAKING PERFORMANCE INCREASING THE POTENTIAL FOR A VEHICLE
ACCIDENT.
DEALERS WILL CLEAN THE CHECK VALVE BY WASHING THE VACUUM HOSE WITH HOT
WATER.
SYSTEM: BRAKES; HYDRAULIC; POWER ASSIST; CHECK VALVE.
VEHICLE DESCRIPTION: SEDANS, HATCHBACKS AND COUPE MODEL PASSENGER
VEHICLES.
OWNER NOTIFICATION: OWNER NOTIFICATION IS EXPECTED TO BEGIN JUNE 21, 1996.
NOTE: OWNERS WHO TAKE THEIR VEHICLES TO AN AUTHORIZED DEALER ON AN
AGREED UPON SERVICE DATE AND DO NOT RECEIVE THE FREE REMEDY WITHIN A
REASONABLE TIME SHOULD CONTACT HONDA AT 1-800-999-1009. ALSO CONTACT THE
NATIONAL HIGHWAY TRAFFIC SAFETY ADMINISTRATION'S AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT
1-800-424-9393.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster Check
Valve: > 96032 > Jun > 96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking
Technical Service Bulletin # 96032 Date: 960614
Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking
Bulletin No. 96-O32
Issue Date JUNE 14, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BRAKES
Safety Recall: Civic Power Brake Booster Check Valve
BACKGROUND
The brake booster check valve in certain 1996 Civics may stick, which could result in a loss of the
brake's power assist. A loss of power assist would require greater than normal brake pedal force,
resulting in a reduction in braking performance.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
CUSTOMER NOTIFICATION
Owners of affected vehicles will be contacted by mail and asked to take the car to a dealership for
repair. The text of the customer letter is at the end of this service bulletin.
If any affected vehicles are in the dealership's inventory, repair them before they are sold or put
into use as demonstrators.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Operation number: 413304
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 46402-S01-A11 H/C 4932018
Defect code: 251
Contention code: K11
Template ID: 96-032A
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Clean the brake booster vacuum hose and check valve.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster Check
Valve: > 96032 > Jun > 96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6073
1. Remove the brake booster vacuum hose from the car.
2. Take the hose to the sink. Turn on the hot water tap on the faucet. Let the water run until it gets
as hot as possible.
3. Hold the brake booster end of the vacuum hose with a pair of pliers. Place that end under the
water stream, and let the water flow through the hose for one minute.
NOTE:
Make sure you are holding the correct end of the hose under the water stream. The check valve
allows the water to flow only one way.
4. Without draining the water from the hose, place the hose in a large container filled with hot
water. Make sure the check valve is sitting horizontally. Leave the hose immersed in the container
for five minutes.
5. Remove the hose from the container. As before, hold the brake booster end under the hot water
stream from the faucet, and flow water through the hose for one minute. Make sure water comes
out of the engine end of the hose.
6. Remove the hose from the water stream, and shake as much water as you can out of the hose.
Blow compressed air into the brake booster end of
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster Check
Valve: > 96032 > Jun > 96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6074
the hose to remove the remaining water.
7. Reinstall the vacuum hose on the car.
8. Start the engine, and let it run until it reaches normal operating temperature.
9. Turn off the engine. Fully depress and release the brake pedal five times. You will feel the brake
pedal get harder to push each time you depress it.
10. Press on the brake pedal as you start the engine. The pedal should go down at least another
inch as the engine starts. If it does not, diagnose the problem using normal troubleshooting
procedures.
11. Center-punch a completion mark above the last character of the engine compartment VIN.
Customer Letter
Example of Customer Letter
June 1996
Safety Recall: Civic Power Brake Booster Check Valve
Dear Civic Owner:
This notice is sent to you in accordance with the requirements of the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. has determined that a defect which relates to motor
vehicle safety exists in the brake booster vacuum hose of certain 1996 Civics. Our records indicate
that you may own one of the affected vehicles.
what Is the defect?
The brake booster check valve in certain 1996 Civics may stick, which could result in a loss of the
brake's power assist without prior warning. A loss of power assist would require greater than
normal brake pedal force, resulting in a reduction in braking performance. This could lead to a
vehicle crash.
what should you do?
Call any authorized Honda automobile dealer and make an appointment to have your car repaired.
They will clean the brake booster vacuum hose to prevent this problem from happening. This
procedure will be done free of charge. No parts are required. This procedure takes approximately
half an hour; but please plan to leave your car with the dealership for half a day to allow them
flexibility in scheduling.
Check your brakes. Until the dealer repairs your car, you and anyone else who drives your car
must check the brakes every time before you begin driving.
1. Before starting the engine. fully depress and release the brake pedal five times.
^ You will feel the brake pedal get harder to push each time you depress it.
2. Then, press on the brake pedal as you start the engine.
^ The pedal should go down at least another inch as the engine starts.
- If it does, the check valve is working and you may drive the car.
- If it does not, and the pedal is still very hard to depress, the check valve is stuck. contact your
Honda dealer, and do not drive the car.
WARNING
Have your car fixed as soon as possible. until you do, you must check the brakes every time before
driving. Failure to do so could result in a crash in which you could be seriously hurt or killed.
Who to contact If you experience problems.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster Check
Valve: > 96032 > Jun > 96 > Recall - Brake Booster Check Valve Sticking > Page 6075
If you are not satisfied with the service you receive from your Honda dealer, you may write to:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc. Customer Information Service, Mail Stop 540-2S-2A 1919
Torrance Blvd., Torrance, CA 90501-2746
If you believe that American Honda or the dealer has failed or is unable to remedy the defect in
your car, without charge, within a reasonable period of time (60 days from the date you first contact
the dealer for an appointment), you may submit a complaint to:
Administrator National Highway Traffic Safety Administration 400 Seventh St, S.W. Washington,
D.C. 20590
Or call the toll-free Auto Safety Hotline at (800) 424-9393 (residents of Washington D.C. should call
366-0123).
what to do if you feel this notice is in error.
This notice was mailed to you according to the most current information we have available. If you
no longer own a Civic, or the name and address information in this notice is incorrect, please fill out
and return the included Information Change Card. This will help us to update our records.
If you have questions.
If you are not sure how to contact a Honda dealer, or have questions about this notice, please call
the Honda Customer Information Service Office at (800) 999-1009.
We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Vacuum Brake Booster Check
Valve: > NHTSA96V106000 > Jun > 96 > Recall 96V106000: Brake Booster Check Valve
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 96V106000: Brake
Booster Check Valve
A SOAPY LUBRICANT WAS USED TO INSERT THE CHECK VALVE INTO THE VACUUM HOSE
WHICH CAUSES THE BRAKE BOOSTER CHECK VALVE TO STICK.
THIS CONDITION CAN CAUSE A LOSS OF THE BRAKE'S POWER ASSIST RESULTING IN A
REDUCTION IN BRAKING PERFORMANCE INCREASING THE POTENTIAL FOR A VEHICLE
ACCIDENT.
DEALERS WILL CLEAN THE CHECK VALVE BY WASHING THE VACUUM HOSE WITH HOT
WATER.
SYSTEM: BRAKES; HYDRAULIC; POWER ASSIST; CHECK VALVE.
VEHICLE DESCRIPTION: SEDANS, HATCHBACKS AND COUPE MODEL PASSENGER
VEHICLES.
OWNER NOTIFICATION: OWNER NOTIFICATION IS EXPECTED TO BEGIN JUNE 21, 1996.
NOTE: OWNERS WHO TAKE THEIR VEHICLES TO AN AUTHORIZED DEALER ON AN
AGREED UPON SERVICE DATE AND DO NOT RECEIVE THE FREE REMEDY WITHIN A
REASONABLE TIME SHOULD CONTACT HONDA AT 1-800-999-1009. ALSO CONTACT THE
NATIONAL HIGHWAY TRAFFIC SAFETY ADMINISTRATION'S AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT
1-800-424-9393.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6080
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Brake Booster Vacuum Hose
- Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose at the booster or at the booster side of the valve.
- Start the engine and let it idle. There should be vacuum. If no vacuum is available, the check
valve is not working properly. Replace the brake booster vacuum hose and check valve, then
retest.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6085
Engine Compartment
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6086
Brake Fluid Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
ABS pump motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Torx Bolts ............................................................................................................................
............................................ 9.8 Nm (84 inch lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6092
Electronic Brake Control Module: Connector Locations
Connector A
Behind Right Kick Panel
Connector B
Behind Right Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6093
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Main Control
ABS Operation
The ABS control unit detects the wheel speed based on the wheel sensor signal it received, then it
calculates the vehicle speed based on the detected wheel speed. The control unit detects the
vehicle speed during deceleration based on the rate of deceleration. The ABS control unit
calculates the slip rate of each wheel, and it transmits the control signal to the modulator unit
solenoid valve when the slip rate is high. The pressure reduction control is a three-mode system,
that is pressure reduction, pressure retaining and pressure intensifying modes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Main Control > Page 6096
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Diagnosis Function
SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION
Since the anti-lock brake system modulates the braking pressure when a wheel is about to lock,
regardless of the driver's intention, the system operation and the braking power will be impaired if
there is a malfunction in the system. To prevent this possibility, the self-diagnosis function monitors
the main system functions. The ABS control unit is equipped with a main CPU and a sub CPU The
CPUs check each other and the circuits of the system. When the CPUs detect failure, they shift to
the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode". When an abnormality is detected, the
ABS indicator light goes on.
CHECK MODE/BULB CHECK
There is also a check mode of the self-diagnosis system itself; when the ignition switch is first
turned on, the ABS indicator light comes on and stays on for a few seconds after the engine starts
to signify that the self-diagnosis system and indicator light are functional.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
When an abnormality is detected in the ABS control system by the self-diagnosis, the solenoid
operations are suspended to inhibit anti-lock brake system operation. Under these conditions, the
braking system functions just as an ordinary one, maintaining the necessary braking function.
When the ABS indicator light is turned on, it means the fail-safe is functioning.
SELF TEST - FAULT DETECTION
- The self-diagnosis can be classified into these four categories.
Initial Diagnosis - Performed right after the engine starts and until the ABS indicator light goes off.
Except ABS Control - Performed when the ABS is not functioning. During ABS Control - Performed
when the ABS is functioning. During Warning - Performed when the ABS indicator light is ON.
ABS Self-diagnosis
- The system performs the following controls when a problem is detected by the self-diagnosis.
> ABS indicator light ON
> Memory of Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
> Mode change to the "system down mode" or the "control inhibition mode".
1. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) is memorized when a problem is detected and the ABS
indicator light does not go off, or when the ABS
indicator light comes on. The DTC is not memorized when the ABS indicator light comes on unless
the CPU is activated.
2. The memory can hold any number of DTCs. However, when the same DTC is detected twice or
more, the later one is written over the old one.
Therefore, when the same problem is detected repeatedly, it is recorded as one DTC.
3. The DTCs are indicated in the order of ascending number, not in the order they occur. 4. The
DTCs are memorized in the EEPROM (non-volatile memory). Therefore, the memorized DTCs
cannot be canceled by disconnecting the
battery. Perform the specified procedures to erase. See: Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes/Clearing
Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6097
Electronic Brake Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6098
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6099
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
1. Remove the right side kick panel. 2. Disconnect the ABS control unit connectors. 3. Remove the
ABS control unit. 4. Install the ABS control unit in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Photo 22
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Photo 22
Left Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Photo 22 > Page 6105
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations Additional Image
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS, before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6106
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
The brake system indicator light comes on to alert the driver that the parking brake is applied, or
that the brake fluid level is low. It also comes on as a bulb test when the engine is cranked.
Brake Fluid Level
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied through fuse 25 to the brake
system light. If the brake fluid level is low, the brake fluid level switch closes, providing ground to
the circuit. The brake system light then comes on, alerting the driver to a low brake fluid level in the
brake master cylinder. (Check brake pad wear before you add fluid).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6107
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Braking Sensor/Switch: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Release Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Release Switch: Locations
Below Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Sensor Lock Bolts 7 ft.lb
Air Gap Front & Rear 0.02 - 0.04 in
For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Wheel Speed Sensor > Page 6121
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications Toothed Ring
PULSER/WHEEL SENSOR AIR GAP *
Front & Rear Standard ........................................................................................................................
.................................................. 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 in)
* For EX with optional ABS
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Front
Inside of Left Front Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Front > Page 6124
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Rear
Inside of Left Rear Wheel (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6125
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
Wheel Sensor
AC Current
The wheel sensors are the magnetic contactless type. As the gear pulser teeth rotate past the
wheel sensor's magnetic coil, AC current is generated. The AC frequency changes in accordance
with the wheel speed. The ABS control unit detects the wheel sensor signal frequency and thereby
detects the wheel speed. There are four wheel sensors, one for each wheel. The gear pulser has
50 teeth.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Toothed Ring
INSPECTION OF THE TOOTHED RING
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch), the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Toothed Ring > Page 6128
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection Wheel Speed Sensor
TESTING THE WHEEL SPEED SENSOR
1. Check the front and rear pulser for chipped or damaged teeth.
2. Measure the air gap between the wheel sensor and pulser all the way around while rotating the
pulser.
Standard: 0.4 - 1.0 mm (0.02 - 0.04 inch)
NOTE: If the gap exceeds 1.0 mm (0.04 inch) , the probability is a distorted suspension arm which
should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6129
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
NOTE:
- Be careful when installing the sensors to avoid twisting the wires.
- The torque value of the bolts is 9.8 Nm (1.0 kgf.m, 7 ft. lbs.).
FRONT
REAR
1. Remove the hub bearing unit. 2. Remove the four backing plate bolts. 3. Pull the backing plate
away from the trailing arm, then remove the wheel sensor. It is not necessary to disconnect the
brake line.
NOTE: This illustration is drum brake type. The torque value of the disk type is same as drum type.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Clutch Switch
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Clutch Switch > Page 6136
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Interlock Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6146
Starting System
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6147
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Starter cut relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Battery Replacement Precautions
Battery Cable: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Replacement Precautions
Replacing a Battery? Don't Disconnect the Cables
With the
Engine Running
When replacing a battery, many service techs disconnect the battery cables with the engine
running to keep the data alive in volatile memory. This practice worked fine back in the day when
vehicles were pretty much a box on wheels, but with so many of today's vehicles sporting a
impressive array of cool, high tech hardware, it's not recommended. Here's why:
^ The battery works as a capacitor to prevent sudden swings in voltage. With the battery cables
disconnected, the alternator voltage regulator tries to
stabilize the system voltage, but it can only do so by turning the alternator on and off.
^ When solenoids or relays are turned on and of{ they produce a very high voltage spike that
travels through the 12-volt system. This voltage spike can
fry sensitive solid state components or corrupt the data that's stored in volatile memory for such
components as the gauge control module, the radio, and the various control units.
The best way to keep data alive in volatile memory when replacing a battery is to hook up a Honda
Computer Memory Saver to the 16P data link connector (DLC). This portable tool works as a
secondary 12-volt source. It saves you the hassle of writing down your customer's audio presets,
resetting the clock, or even doing the idle learn procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Battery Replacement Precautions > Page 6153
The Honda Computer Memory Saver is indeed a real time saver, but here's a word of caution:
Don't let the positive battery cable touch any body ground. It will cause a short that will either blow
the fuse in the tool or cause a drop in system voltage resulting in the loss of any data that 5 in
volatile memory.
The Honda Computer Memory Saver is available through the Honda Tool and Equipment Program.
To order one, just call and ask for FZRMS4000H.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Alternator Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Alternator Bearing: Service and Repair
Removing The Alternator Rear Bearing
1. Pull off the rear bearing.
- Make sure the tips of the bearing puller jaws are thin enough to fit between the bearing and the
slip rings.
- Do not reuse the bearing.
2. Use a hand press to install the new bearing. Apply pressure only on the inner race to avoid
damaging the bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Rectifier Diode / Bridge, Alternator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Rectifier Diode / Bridge: Service and Repair
1. Remove the four through bolts.
2. Heat the rear bearing seat with a 1,000 W hair drier for about five minutes (120 - 140 °F, 50 - 60
°C).
3. Separate the rear housing from the drive-end housing by inserting a flat tip screwdriver into the
openings and prying them a part. Be careful not to
damage the stator with the tip of the screwdriver.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Rectifier Diode / Bridge, Alternator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6162
4. Separate the rear housing and drive-end housing with the stator attached to the rear housing.
5. Separate the rear housing from the stator/rectifier assembly by removing the four screws and the
terminal nut.
6. Unsolder the rectifier from the stator leads.
- To avoid damaging the diodes with heat, pinch the stator leads between pliers to carry heat off,
and apply the soldering iron only long enough to separate the leads from the rectifier.
- Use a 100 W soldering iron.
7. Install the new rectifier in the reverse order of removal.
- Apply the soldering iron only long enough to ensure a good connection so the heat will not
damage the diodes.
- Use only a rosin core type solder or solder joints will corrode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Clutch Switch
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Clutch Switch > Page 6168
Clutch Switch: Locations Clutch Interlock Switch
Behind Left Side of Dash
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Ignition Lock: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6173
Ignition Lock: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.6 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Lock > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6174
Ignition Lock: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Remove:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then wire down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 model) 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the driver's
dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 4. Disconnect the 5P connector from the under-dash
fuse/relay box and the 7P connector from the main wire harness. 5.Remove the steering column
covers, then remove the mounting bolts and nuts from the steering column. 6. Lower the steering
column assembly.
7. Center-punch each of the two shear bolts, then drill their heads off with a 5 mm (3/16 in) drill bit.
CAUTION: Do not damage the steering lock body.
8. Remove the shear bolts and the steering lock assembly.
Installation:
1. Install the new steering lock assembly without the key inserted. 2. Loosely tighten the new shear
bolts. 3. Insert the ignition key, and check for proper operation of the steering wheel lock and that
the ignition key turns freely.
4. Tighten the shear bolts until the hex heads twist off. 5. Install in the reverse order of removal. 6.
Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In
Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Locations
Starter Motor: Locations
Lower Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection
Starter Motor: Testing and Inspection Starter Inspection
NOTE: The air temperature must be between 59 and 100 °F (15 and 38 °C) before testing.
Recommended Procedure:
- Use a starter system tester.
- Connect and operate the equipment in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.
- Test and troubleshoot as described.
Alternate Procedure:
- Use the following equipment: Ammeter, 0 - 400 A
- Voltmeter, 0 - 20 V (accurate within 0.1 volt)
- Tachometer, 0 - 1,200 rpm
- Hook up a voltmeter and ammeter as shown.
NOTE: After this test, or any subsequent repair, reset the ECM/PCM to clear any codes.
Check the Starter Engagement:
1. Remove the No.44 (15A) fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. 2. Turn the ignition switch to
START (III) with the shift lever in [N] or [P] position (A/T) or with the clutch pedal depressed (M/T).
The starter
should crank the engine. If the starter does not crank the engine, go to step 3.
- If it cranks the engine erratically or too slowly, go to "Check for Wear and Damage".
3. Check the battery, battery positive cable, ground, starter cut relay, and the wire connections for
looseness and corrosion. Test again. If the starter
still does not crank the engine, go to step 4.
4. Unplug the connector (BLK/WHT wire and solenoid terminal) from the starter.
5. Connect a jumper wire from the battery positive (+) terminal to the solenoid terminal.
The starter should crank the engine.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6189
- If the starter still does not crank the engine, remove it, and diagnose its internal problem.
- If the starter cranks the engine, go to step 6.
6. Check the ignition switch. 7. Check the starter cut relay and clutch interlock switch. 8. Check the
A/T gear position switch. 9. Check for an open in the wire between the ignition switch and starter.
Check for Wear and Damage
The starter should crank the engine smoothly and steadily, If the starter engages, but cranks the
engine erratically, remove it, and inspect the starter drive gear and torque converter or flywheel ring
gear for damage.
- Check the drive gear overrunning clutch for binding or slipping when the armature is rotated with
the drive gear held. If damaged, replace the gears.
Check Cranking Voltage and Current Draw
Cranking voltage should be no less than 8.5 volts. Current draw should be no more than 350
amperes.
If cranking voltage is too low, or current draw too high, check for:
- dead or low battery.
- open circuit in starter armature commutator segments.
- starter armature dragging.
- shorted armature winding.
- excessive drag in engine.
Check Cranking rpm
Engine speed during cranking should be above 100 rpm.
If speed is too low, check for:
- loose battery or starter terminals.
- excessively worn starter brushes.
- open circuit in commutator segments.
- dirty or damaged helical spline or drive gear.
- defective drive gear overrunning clutch.
Check Starter Disengagement
With the shift lever in [N] or [P] position (A/T) or with the clutch pedal depressed (M/T), turn the
ignition switch to START (III), and release to ON (II). The starter drive gear should disengage from
the torque converter or flywheel ring gear when you release the key.
If the drive gear hangs up on the torque converter or flywheel ring gear, check for:
- solenoid plunger and switch malfunction.
- dirty drive gear assembly or damaged overrunning clutch.
Starter Solenoid Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6190
1. Check the hold-in coil for continuity between the S terminal and the armature housing (ground).
The coil is OK if there is continuity. 2. Check the pull-in coil for continuity between the S and M
terminals. The coil is OK if there is continuity.
Armature Inspection and Test
Armature Inspection
1. Inspect the armature for wear or damage due to contact with the permanent magnet or field
winding.
- If there is wear or damage, replace the armature.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6191
Checking The Commutator Diameter
2. Check commutator surface and diameter.
- If the surface is dirty or burnt, resurface with emery cloth or a lathe within the following
specifications, or recondition with #500 or #600 sandpaper.
- If commutator diameter is below the service limit, replace the armature.
3. Measure the commutator runout.
- If the commutator runout is within the service limit, check the commutator for carbon dust or brass
chips between the segments.
- If the commutator runout is not within the service limit, replace the armature.
4. Check for mica depth. If necessary, undercut mica with a hacksaw blade to achieve proper
depth. If service limit cannot be maintained, replace the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6192
armature.
Checking For Continuity
5. Check for continuity between the segments of the commutator. If an open circuit exists between
any segments, replace the armature.
6. Place the armature on an armature tester. Hold a hacksaw blade on the armature core.
- If the blade is attracted to the core or vibrates while the core is turned, the armature is shorted.
Replace the armature.
Commutator And Armature Continuity Check
7. Check with an ohmmeter that no continuity exists between the commutator and armature coil
core, and between the commutator and armature
shaft. If there is continuity, replace the armature.
Brush Holder Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6193
1. Check that there is no continuity between the (+) and (-) brush holders.
If there is continuity, replace the brush holder assembly.
2. Insert the brush into the brush holder, and bring the brush into contact with the commutator, then
attach a spring scale to the spring. Measure the
spring tension at the moment the spring lifts off the brush.
Brush Inspection
Measure the brush length. If not within the service limit, replace the brush (or brush holder
assembly).
NOTE: To seat new brushes after installing them in their holders, slip a strip of #500 or #600
sandpaper, with the grit side up, over the commutator and smoothly rotate the armature. The
contact surface of the brushes will be sanded to the same contour as the commutator.
Overrunning Clutch Inspection
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6194
1. Slide the overrunning clutch along the shaft. Does it move freely? If not, replace it.
Overrunning Clutch Inspection
2. Rotate the overrunning clutch both ways. Does it lock in one direction and rotate smoothly in
reverse? If it does not lock in either direction or it
locks in both directions, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6195
Starter Motor: Testing and Inspection Starter Performance Test
NOTE: Before starting the following checks, disconnect the wire from terminal M, and make a
connection as described below using as heavy a wire as possible (preferably equivalent to the wire
used for the car).
Pull-In Coil Test
Pull-in Coil Test:
Connect the battery as shown. If the starter pinion pops out, it is working properly.
CAUTION: Do not leave the battery connected for more than 10 seconds.
Hold-In Coil Test
Hold-in Coil Test:
Disconnect the battery from the M terminal. If the pinion does not retract, the hold-in coil is working
properly.
CAUTION: Do not leave the battery connected for more than 10 seconds.
Retracting Test:
Disconnect the battery also from the body. If the pinion retracts immediately, it is working properly.
CAUTION: Do not leave the battery connected for more than 10 seconds.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Starter Inspection > Page 6196
Starter No-load Test:
1. Clamp the starter firmly in a vise.
Starter No-Load Test
2. Connect the starter to the battery as described in the diagram and confirm that the motor starts
and keeps rotating. 3. If the electric current and motor speed meet the specifications when the
battery voltage is at 11.5 V, the starter is working properly.
Specifications: 80 A or less (Electric current), 2,600 rpm or more (Motor-speed)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
3. Disconnect the starter cable from the B terminal on the solenoid, then disconnect the BLK/WHT
wire from the S terminal. 4. Remove the two bolts holding the starter, then remove the starter.
Starter Cable Installation
5. Install in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: When installing the starter cable, make sure that the crimped side of the ring terminal is
facing out.
6. Connect the battery positive cable and negative cable to the battery. 7. Enter the anti-theft code
for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6199
Starter Motor: Service and Repair Disassembly and Reassembly
Starter Brush Holder Assembly
1. Pry back each brush spring with a screwdriver, then position the brush about halfway out of its
holder, and release the spring to hold it there.
Installation Of Brush Housing Onto The Armature
2. Install the armature in the housing. Next, pry back each brush spring again, and push the brush
down until it seats against the commutator, then
release the spring against the end of the brush.
3. Install the end cover on the brush holder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 6203
Starting System
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 6204
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Starter cut relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Specifications
Starter Solenoid: Specifications Mounting Nut Torque
Mounting Nut Torque
B Terminal Mounting Nut Torque 9 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6208
Starter Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Starter Solenoid Test
1. Check the hold-in coil for continuity between the S terminal and the armature housing (ground).
The coil is OK if there is continuity.
2. Check the pull-in coil for continuity between the S and M terminals. The coil is OK if there is
continuity.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Locations
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations
Behind Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6215
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6216
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6217
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6218
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6219
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6220
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6221
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6222
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6223
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6224
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6225
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6226
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6227
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6228
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6229
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6230
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6231
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6236
Fuse: Locations Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6237
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6238
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse: Application and ID Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6241
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6242
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6243
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6244
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6245
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6246
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6247
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Page 6248
Fuse: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls
Off
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls
Off > Page 6257
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box
Cover - Falls Off
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box
Cover - Falls Off > Page 6263
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6266
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6267
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6268
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6269
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6270
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6271
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6272
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6273
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6276
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6277
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6278
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6279
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Application and ID > Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6280
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6286
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6287
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6288
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6289
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6290
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6291
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6292
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6293
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6294
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page
6297
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page
6298
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page
6299
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 6300
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6305
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6306
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6307
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6308
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6309
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6310
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6311
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6312
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 6313
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6316
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6317
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6318
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information
> Application and ID > Page 6319
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Locations
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Locations
Behind Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6326
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6327
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6328
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6329
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6330
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6331
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6332
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6333
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6334
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6335
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6336
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6337
Auxiliary Power Outlet: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6338
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6339
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6340
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6341
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6342
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Under-Dash
Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Under-Dash
Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6347
Fuse: Locations Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Under-Dash
Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6348
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Under-Dash
Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6349
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse: Application and ID Under Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6352
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6353
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6354
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6355
Fuse: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6356
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6357
Fuse: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Under
Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6358
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Page
6359
Fuse: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
Fuse Block: Customer Interest Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off > Page 6368
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
Fuse Block: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off
00-007
February 15, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Fuse Box Cover Falls Off
PROBLEM The cover for the under-dash fuse box (to the left of the steering column) falls off.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the spring clip on the cover.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
PARTS INFORMATION Spring Clip: P/N 90666-SD4-003, H/C 2601532
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 841125
Flat Rate Time: 0.2 hour
Failed Part: P/N 90666-SD4-003 H/C 2601532
Defect Code: 004
Contention Code: A02
Template ID: 00-007A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the fuse box cover from the dashboard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuse Block: > 00-007 > Feb > 00 > Fuse Box Cover - Falls Off > Page 6374
2. Use a small screwdriver to remove the clip from the fuse box cover. Discard the clip.
3. Install the new spring clip on the cover.
4. Install the cover in the dashboard and check that it fits securely. If it does not, bend the arm on
the spring clip up slightly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6377
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6378
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6379
Fuse Block: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6380
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6381
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6382
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6383
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6384
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6387
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6388
Fuse Block: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6389
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6390
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuse-to-Component Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6391
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6397
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6398
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6399
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6400
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6401
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6402
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6403
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6404
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6405
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6408
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6409
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6410
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution >
Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Page 6411
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Relay Box: Component Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6416
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6417
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6418
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6419
Relay Box: Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6420
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6421
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6422
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6423
Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6424
Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6427
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood ABS Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6428
Relay Box: Application and ID Under-Hood Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Under-Dash Fuse/Relay Box > Page 6429
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Page 6430
Relay Box: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Removal:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the airbag connectors. 4. Remove
the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
5. Remove the two mounting nuts, and pull the under-dash fuse/relay box out from under the dash.
6. Disconnect the connectors from the under-dash fuse/relay box, and take out the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
Installation:
1. Connect the connectors to the under-dash fuse/ relay box, then install the under-dash fuse/relay
box in the reverse order of removal. 2. Install the driver's dashboard lower cover. 3. Connect the
airbag connectors. 4. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable. 5. Enter
the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets ('99 - 00 models). 6.
Confirm that all systems work properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
Alignment: Customer Interest Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6440
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6441
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6442
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6443
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6444
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6445
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6446
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6447
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page 6448
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6454
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6455
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6456
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6457
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6458
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6459
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6460
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6461
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 06-068 > May > 09 > Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right > Page
6462
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6463
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-068 Date: 090502
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6464
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls to the right, attach the bracket and weights to
the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel,
and remove the weights until the vehicle drives in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6465
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6466
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6467
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6468
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6469
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6470
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6471
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6472
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Technical Service Bulletin # 06-068 Date: 090502
Steering/Suspension - Vehicle Pulls Left/Right
06-068
May 2, 2009
Applies To: ALL
*Vehicle Pulls or Drifts, and/or Steering Wheel Is Off-Center (Supersedes 06-068, Vehicle Pulling
or Drifting, dated October 4, 2007, to revise the information marked by asterisks) (Replaces
90-011, Steering Wheel Off-Center Adjustment at PDI)*
*REVISION SUMMARY
The title description was revised.*
SYMPTOM
While driving on a straight road, the vehicle pulls or drifts to the right or left.
BACKGROUND
New tools were developed to help you diagnose and correct a pulling and/or steering wheel
off-center issue. There is a diagnosis worksheet included to take on your test-drive and record your
findings. These values are used to build the 15-digit DTC (diagnostic trouble code) that is required
for your warranty claim. The last step in each repair procedure helps you create the correct code.
In the rare case that you have to repair a vehicle that pulls and has the steering wheel off-center,
use REPAIR PROCEDURE B to file your warranty claim.
For more information, refer to Training Module SSC 44 - Steering Drift or Pull Interactive Service
Bulletin.
PROBABLE CAUSES
Several conditions can cause the vehicle to pull or drift:
^ Wheel alignment
^ Tires
^ Off-center steering wheel (no pulling or drifting, but a customer may believe this is the case)
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Diagnose the problem using the special tools and the worksheet on page 4 that guides you to one
of four repair procedures.
TOOL INFORMATION
Centering Tape (enough to diagnose 240 vehicles):
T/N O7AAJ-001A300
Steering Drift Set Level: T/N 07AAJ-00100
Steering Drift Set: T/N O7MJ-001A140
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6473
Replacement Weight for Steering Drift Set:
T/N 07AAJ-001A400
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: P/N 53560-SDA-AO1 H/C 7139652
Defect Code: 07406
Symptom Code: 03602
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Diagnostic Trouble Code:
To create the 15-digit DTC, see the applicable repair procedure.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
TOOL DESCRIPTIONS
The holding force gauge measures the amount of pull on the vehicle. It is a bracket that counts as
one weight, plus five removable weights.
During the test-drive, attach the bracket and the weights to the steering wheel on the side opposite
the pulling direction. For example, if the vehicle pulls
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6474
to the right, attach the bracket and weights to the left side of the steering wheel. Start with the
maximum amount of weight on the steering wheel, and remove the weights until the vehicle drives
in a straight line.
When recording the pull on the worksheet, write down the direction of the pull (lefi or right) and the
number of weights required to balance the pull (one through six). For example, if you have the
bracket and two weights on the steering wheel, then record this as three weights.
NOTE:
The bracket counts as one weight.
The road crown gauge measures the amount of road crown. Almost all roads have a crown to help
drain water during rainstorms. Use the suction cup to attach the road crown gauge bracket to the
vehicle in a vertical position. If necessary, bend the bracket until the gauge is vertical. Once you
attach and align the road crown gauge, calibrate the gauge to zero. There are two ways to calibrate
the gauge:
^ Park the vehicle on a level surface, such as an alignment rack, and calibrate the gauge by
moving the gauge until the ball is on the zero mark.
^ If you do not have a perfectly flat surface, park the vehicle on a reasonably flat surface and note
the gauge reading. Turn the vehicle 1800 and, with the tires in the same spot, note the new gauge
reading. Then move the gauge half of the difference. For example, if your first reading is +3 and,
after moving the vehicle, the gauge reads -1, then the difference is 4 degrees. Position the gauge
to read +1.
NOTE:
You must calibrate the gauge with the same weight in the vehicle that you will use for the test-drive.
If you plan to have an assistant help you during the test-drive, calibrate the gauge while both of you
are sitting in the vehicle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6475
The steering wheel offset gauge is a sticker that attaches to the steering wheel and the steering
column cover. Place the sticker on the steering wheel when the steering wheel is straight. When
you test-drive the vehicle, you can read how many millimeters the steering wheel is off-center.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is pulling, repairing the pull may correct the steering wheel offset.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6476
DIAGNOSTIC WORKSHEET
REPAIR PROCEDURE A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6477
NOTE:
Do this repair procedure if, after doing step 10 of the test-drive, the vehicle pulled in the opposite
direction after you swapped the front tires.
1. Swap wheels 2 and 4 on the passenger's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 2, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, put wheels 2 and 4 back to their original positions, and go to step 2.
2. Swap wheels 1 and 3 on the driver's side of the vehicle, and test-drive again.
^ If the pull goes away, replace the tire on wheel 1, then go to step 3.
^ If the pull does not go away, use a known-good tire in position 1 and continue diagnosis.
3. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6478
1. Place the vehicle on a commercially available, computerized, four-wheel alignment rack, and
record the following measurements. Follow the
equipment manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
2. If any measurement is out of specification, inspect the front suspension for any damage. Repair
any damaged parts before continuing your diagnosis.
3. Determine how the front wheel camber is affecting the pull. Pick the combination of left- and
right-front camber that best matches the vehicle you are
repairing, then note the camber thrust direction for that combination:
NOTE:
^ If the camber of both front wheels is negative, but one wheel is grossly more negative than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be opposite the wheel with more negative camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more negative, the camber thrust direction is right).
^ If the camber of both front wheels is positive, but one wheel is grossly more positive than the
other, the camber thrust direction will be the same as the wheel with more positive camber (for
example, if the left-front wheel is more positive, the camber thrust direction is left).
4. Determine how the camber needs to be adjusted.
5. Adjust the camber as needed.
Front Camber Adjustment, Double Wishbone Suspension
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6479
^ Loosen the front subframe bolts. See the applicable service manual for more information.
NOTE:
The front wheels are being viewed from the rear of the vehicle.
^ Depending which way you need to shift the subframe, insert a pry bar between the subframe and
body at both the front and rear positions of the subframe.
NOTE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle. You could bend and damage the frame and/or body if you
apply too much pressure.
^ Press on both pry bars to shift the subframe. It will move only a few millimeters. This should
adjust the camber about 0.2-0.5°.
^ While holding the subframe in place, have an assistant torque the subframe bolts to their proper
torque.
Front Camber Adjustment, Strut Suspension
^ Raise the vehicle, and remove the front tires.
^ Loosen the damper pinch bolts and the flange nuts.
^ Adjust the camber by moving the bottom of the damper within the range of the damper pinch bolt
free play.
NOTE:
Some vehicles have special pinch bolts that allow more adjustment. For more information, refer to
the parts catalog.
^ Tighten the damper pinch bolts to the specified torque.
^ Reinstall the front wheels and lower the vehicle. Bounce the front of the vehicle several times to
stabilize the suspension.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6480
6. Test-drive the vehicle to make sure it no longer pulls. If the steering wheel is now off-center by
more than 2 mm, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE C.
7. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
NOTE:
Enter each reading in decimal degrees. Example 30' = 0.50.
REPAIR PROCEDURE C
1. Make sure the steering wheel is centered.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the right until it stops.
^ Turn the steering wheel all the way to the left, and count the number of revolutions until it stops.
^ Divide the number of revolutions in half, and turn the steering wheel until it is centered. For
example, if it takes four revolutions of the steering wheel to go from lock to lock, then two turns is
centered.
^ If the steering wheel is off-center by a large amount (20 mm or more), it may not be centered on
the steering column shaft. Reinstall the steering wheel before going to step 2.
2. Place the vehicle on a lift, turn the steering wheel until it is centered, and then raise the vehicle.
3. Adjust the tie-rods. Use your measurements from question 13 of the test-drive to make your
adjustment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 6481
^ If the wheels are pointed to the right, shorten the driver's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
passenger's side.
^ If the wheels are pointed to the left, shorten the passenger's side tie-rod, and lengthen the
driver's side.
^ Each 360° turn of the tie-rod equals about 8 mm of steering wheel adjustment. For example, a
steering wheel is off-center by 4 mm with the front wheels pointed right (when the steering wheel is
centered). To correct the off-center, shorten the driver's side tie-rod by a half-turn, and lengthen the
passenger's side tie-rod by a half-turn.
4. Use your diagnosis worksheet to fill in the following table and build your 15-digit DTC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 6482
Alignment: Specifications
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 6483
Alignment: Service Precautions
CAUTION: When fasteners are removed, always reinstall them at the same location from which
they were removed. If a fastener needs to be replaced, use the correct part number fastener for
that application. If the correct part number fastener is not available, a fastener of equal size and
strength (or stronger) may be used. Fasteners that are not reused, and those requiring thread
locking compound will be called out. The correct torque value must be used when installing
fasteners that require it. If the above conditions are not followed, parts or system damage could
result.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
General Description
Alignment: Description and Operation General Description
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
"Front End Alignment" refers to the angular relationship between the front wheels, the front
suspension attaching parts and the ground. Proper front end alignment must be maintained in
order to insure efficient steering, good directional stability and to prevent abnormal tire wear. The
most important factors of front end alignment are wheel toe-in, wheel camber and axle caster.
CAMBER:
Camber is the vertical tilting inward or outward of the front wheels. When the wheels tilt outward at
the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheels tilt inward at the top, the camber is negative
(-). The amount of tilt measured in degrees from the vertical is called the camber angle (1). If
camber is extreme or unequal between the wheels, improper steering and excessive tire wear will
result. Negative camber causes wear on the inside of the tire, while positive camber causes wear
to the outside.
CASTER:
This illustration shows view from the side of the vehicle. Caster (1) is the vertical tilting of the wheel
axis either forward or backward (when viewed from the side of the vehicle). A backward tilt is
positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). On the short and long arm type suspension you cannot
see a caster angle without a special instrument, but if you look straight down from the top of the
upper control arm to the ground, the ball joints do not line up (fore and aft) when a caster angle
other than 0 degree is present. With a positive angle, the lower ball joint would be slightly ahead
(toward the front of the vehicle) of the upper ball joint center line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 6486
TOE-IN:
This illustration shows view from the top of the vehicle. Toe-in is the measured amount the front
wheels are turn in. The actual amount of toe-in is normally a fraction of a degree. Toe-in is
measured from the center of the tire treads or from the inside of the tires. The purpose of toe-in is
to insure parallel rolling of the front wheels and to offset any small deflections of the wheel support
system which occurs when the vehicle is rolling forward. Incorrect toe-in results in excessive toe-in
and unstable steering. Toe-in is the last alignment to be set in the front end alignment procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 6487
Alignment: Description and Operation Camber
Camber is the inward or outward tilting of the front wheels from the vertical. When the wheels tilt
outward at the top, the camber is positive (+). When the wheels tilt inward at the top, the camber is
negative (-). The amount of tilt measured in degrees from the vertical is called the camber angle. If
camber is extreme or unequal between the wheels, improper steering and excessive tire wear will
result. Negative camber causes wear on the inside of the tire, while positive camber causes wear
to the outside.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 6488
Alignment: Description and Operation Caster
Caster is the tilting of the wheel axis either forward or backward from the vertical (when viewed
from the side of the vehicle). A backward tilt is positive (+) and a forward tilt is negative (-). On the
short and long arm type suspension you cannot see a caster angle without a special instrument,
but if you look straight down from the top of the upper control arm to the ground, the ball joints do
not line up (fore and aft) when a caster angle other than 0 degree is present. With a positive angle,
the lower ball joint would be slightly ahead (toward the front of the vehicle) of the upper ball joint
center line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
General Description > Page 6489
Alignment: Description and Operation Toe-In
Toe-in is the turning of the front wheels. The actual amount of toe-in is normally a fraction of a
degree. Toe-in is measured from the center of the tire treads or from the inside of the tires. The
purpose of toe-in is to insure parallel rolling of the front wheels and to offset any small deflections
of the wheel support system which occurs when the vehicle is rolling forward. Incorrect toe-in
results in excessive toe-in and unstable steering. Toe-in is the last alignment to be set in the front
end alignment procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation >
Page 6490
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Preliminary Checks
Alignment: Service and Repair Preliminary Checks
INSPECTION
Before making any adjustments affecting caster, camber or toe-in, the following front end
inspection should be made. 1. Inspect the tires for proper inflation pressure. 2. Inspect the front
wheel bearings for proper adjustment. 3. inspect the ball joints and tie rod ends. If excessive
looseness is noted, correct before adjusting. 4. Inspect the wheel and tires for run-out. 5. Inspect
the trim height. If not within specifications, the correction must be made before adjusting caster. 6.
Inspect the steering unit for looseness at the frame. 7. Inspect shock absorbers for leaks or any
noticeable noise. 8. Inspect the control arms or stabilizer bar attachment for looseness. 9. Inspect
the front end alignment using alignment equipment. Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
10. Alignment must be performed on a level surface.
- Check that the suspension is not modified.
- Check the tire size and tire pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Preliminary Checks > Page 6493
Alignment: Service and Repair Alignment
Preliminary Checks
For proper inspection/adjustment of the wheel alignment check and adjust the following before
checking the alignment. Check that the suspension is not modified.
- Check the tire size and tire pressure.
- Check the runout of the wheels and tires.
- Check the suspension ball joints. (Hold a wheel with your hands and move it up and down and
right and left to check for wobbling.)
NOTE: Use commercially-available computerized four wheel alignment equipment to measure
wheel alignment (caster, camber, toe, and turning angle). Follow the equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Caster
1. Check the caster angle.
Caster angle: (1°40' ± 1°) +0.67° to +2.67°.
2. If out of specification, check for bent or damaged suspension components.
Camber
1. Check the camber angle.
Camber angle: -
Front: (0°00' ± 1) -1° to +1°.
- Rear: (-1° ± 1°) -2° to 0°.
2. If out of specification, check for bent or damaged suspension components.
Front Toe
1. Check the tire pressure. 2. Center steering wheel spokes. 3. Check the toe with the wheels
pointed straight ahead.
Front toe: (IN 1 ± 2 mm /IN 0.04 ± 0.08 inch) -0.12 to +0.04 inch
a. If adjustment is required, go on to step 4. b. If no adjustment is required, remove alignment
equipment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Preliminary Checks > Page 6494
4. Loosen the tie-rod locknuts, and turn both tie-rods in the same direction until the front wheels are
in straight ahead position. 5. Turn both tie-rods equally until the toe reading on the turning radius
gauge is correct. 6. After adjusting, tighten the tie-rod locknuts.
NOTE: Reposition the tie-rod boot if it is twisted or displaced.
Rear Toe
1. Release parking brake.
NOTE: Measure difference in toe measurements with the wheels pointed straight ahead.
- If the parking brake is engaged, you may get an incorrect reading.
Rear toe-in: (2 minus 1 or plus 2 mm /0.08 minus 0.04 or plus 0.08 inch) -0.12 to 0 inch.
- If adjustment is required, go to step 2.
- If no adjustment is required, remove alignment equipment.
2. Before adjustment, note the locations of adjusting bolts on the right and left compensator arms.
3. Loosen the adjusting bolts, and slide the compensator arm in or out, as shown, to adjust the toe.
4. Tighten the adjusting bolts. Example: After the rear toe inspection, the wheel is 2 mm (0.08 inch)
out of the specification.
a. Move the arm so the adjusting bolt moves 2 mm (0.08 inch) inward from the position recorded
before the adjustment. b. The distance the adjusting bolt is moved should be equal to the amount
out-of-specification.
Turning Angle
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Preliminary Checks > Page 6495
1. Turn the wheel right and left while applying the brake, and measure the turning angle of both
wheels.
Turning angle: Inward wheel: (39°50') 39.83°.
- Outward wheel (reference): (33°10') 33.17°.
2. If the turning angle is not within the specifications, check for bent or damaged suspension
components.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6501
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6502
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Knuckle to
Upper Arm ...........................................................................................................................................
................................ 39-47 Nm (29-35 ft. lbs.) Lower Arm ..................................................................
......................................................................................................... 49-59 Nm (36-43 ft. lbs.)
Splash Guard .......................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4.9 Nm (3.6 ft. lbs.) Caliper Mounting Bolts .........................................
............................................................................................................................. 108 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6507
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6508
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in
the proper locations.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6509
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6510
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6511
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6512
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6513
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6514
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6515
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
When a power steering pump or gear has been installed, or an oil line has been disconnected, the
air that has entered the system must be bled out before the vehicle is operated. If air is allowed to
remain in the power steering fluid system, noisy and unsatisfactory operation of the system may
result. When bleeding the system, and any time fluid is added to the power steering system, be
sure to use only automatic transmission fluid labeled "DEXRON-IIE".
1. Fill the pump fluid reservoir to the proper label and let the fluid settle for at least two minutes. 2.
Start the engine and let it run for a few seconds. Do not turn the steering wheel. Then turn the
engine off. 3. Add fluid if necessary. 4. Repeat the above procedure until the fluid level remains
constant after running the engine. 5. Raise the front end of the vehicle so that the front wheels are
off the ground. 6. Start the engine. Slowly turn the steering wheel right and left, lightly contacting
the wheel stops. 7. Add power steering fluid if necessary. 8. Bring down the vehicle, set the
steering wheel at the straight forward position after turning it to its full steer positions 2 or 3 times,
and stop the
engine.
9. Stop the engine. Check the fluid level and refill as required.
10. If the fluid is extremely foamy, allow the vehicle to stand a few minutes and repeat the above
procedure. 11. Inspect:
a. Belt for tightness. b. Pulley for looseness or damage. The pulley should not wobble with the
engine running. c. Hoses so they are not touching any other parts of the vehicle. d. Fluid level and
fill to the proper level.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
Power Steering Fluid Type
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... Genuine Honda Power Steering Fluid-V or S
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6523
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
FLUID REPLACEMENT
NOTE: Check the reservoir at regular intervals, and add fluid as necessary.
CAUTION: Always use Genuine Honda Power Steering Fluid-V or S. Using any other type of power
steering fluid or automatic transmission fluid can cause increased wear and poor steering in cold
weather.
1. Raise the reservoir, then disconnect the return hose.
2. Connect a hose of suitable diameter to the disconnected return hose, and put the hose end in a
suitable container.
CAUTION: Take care not to spill the fluid on the body and parts. Wipe off any spilled fluid at once.
3. Start the engine, let it run at idle, and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times.
When fluid stops running out of the hose, shut off the
engine. Discard the fluid.
4. Refit the return hose on the reservoir.
5. Fill the reservoir to the upper level line. 6. Start the engine and run it at fast idle, then turn the
steering from lock-to-lock several times to bleed air from the system. 7. Recheck the fluid level and
add some if necessary.
CAUTION: Do not fill the reservoir beyond the upper level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications Power Steering Lines
Power Steering Lines
Outlet Hose to Pump 8 ft.lb
Cylinder Housing to Cylinder Lines 20 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Cylinder Lines 12 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Feed Line 27 ft.lb
Valve Body Unit to Return Line 20 ft.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6527
Power Steering Line/Hose: Testing and Inspection
- Inspect hoses for damage, leaks, interference or twisting.
- Inspect fluid lines for damage, rusting and leakage.
- Inspect for leaks at hose and line joints and connections.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 6528
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair
REPLACEMENT
1. Connect each hose to the corresponding pipe securely until it contacts the stop on the line.
Install the clamp or adjustable clamp at the specified
distance from the hose end as shown.
2. Add the power steering fluid to the specified level on the reservoir and check for leaks.
ADJUSTABLE HOSE CLAMP
1. Position the adjustable hose clamps at the points indicated (a) in the drawing above. 2. Slide the
hose over the line until it contacts the stop.
CAUTION: Check all clamps for deterioration or deformation; replace with the clamps new ones if
necessary.
HOSE CLAMP
1. Position the hose clamps at the points indicated (b) in the drawing above. 2. Slide the hose over
the line until it contacts the stop.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Power Steering Pump: Mechanical Specifications
Mounting bolts 17 ft.lb
Pulley Nut 47 ft.lb
Flow Control Valve Cap 36 ft.lb
Flange Bolts 14 ft.lb
Outlet Line 8 ft.lb
Inlet Joint Flange Bolts 8 ft.lb
Operating pressure at idle 213 psi
Or less.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 6533
Power Steering Pump: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Mounting bolts 17 ft.lb
Pulley Nut 47 ft.lb
Flow Control Valve Cap 36 ft.lb
Flange Bolts 14 ft.lb
Outlet Line 8 ft.lb
Inlet Joint Flange Bolts 8 ft.lb
Operating pressure at idle 213 psi
Or less.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6534
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6535
Power Steering Pump: Description and Operation
CONSTRUCTION
The pump is a vane-type incorporating a flow control valve (with an integrated relief valve) and is
driven by a POLY-V-belt from the crank pulley. The pump features 10 vanes. Each vane performs
two intake/discharge operations for every rotation of the rotor. This means that the hydraulic fluid
pressure pulse becomes extremely small during discharge.
OPERATION
The belt-driven pulley rotates the rotor through the drive shaft. As the rotor rotates, the hydraulic
pressure is applied to the vane chamber of the rotor and the vanes will rotate while being pushed
onto the inner circumference of the cam ring. The inner circumference of the cam ring has an
extended portion with respect to the center of the shaft, so the vanes move downward in the axial
direction as the rotor rotates. As a result of this roller movement, the internal volume of the vane
chamber will change, resulting in fluid intake and discharge.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6536
The flow control valve and sub-valve in the pump performs the following steps 1 through 4 to
control the flow of fluid, that is to increase the discharge volume when engine speed is low, and to
decrease it when the engine speed increases. The assistance thrust of the steering gearbox
changes in compliance with the change in the discharge volume.
1. When the engine starts, fluid discharged from the discharge port starts to flow through oil
passage A, the fixed orifice and the variable orifice to
the steering gearbox. When the engine speed is extremely low, the return port is closed by the flow
control valve. Fluid pressure discharged from the discharge port is applied to the top of the
sub-valve, and the fluid pressure that passed through oil passage A is applied to the bottom of the
sub-valve. When this happens, the pressure difference between the ends of oil passage A, which is
caused by the resistance oil passage A when the fluid flows through the passage, is applied to the
sub-valve. However, the pressure difference applied to the sub-valve, that is the force that pushes
the sub-valve down, is too small to overcome the spring force, and the variable orifice is fully open
when the engine speed is extremely low.
2. Because the fluid volume flowing through the fixed orifice and variable orifice increases, a
pressure difference is created between the ends of these
orifices, and it increases in proportion to the engine speed. As the fluid pressure that passed the
fixed orifice and variable orifice is directed to the bottom of the flow control valve, a pressure
difference is created between the top and bottom of the valve, which pushes down the flow control
valve and opens the return port. As a result, part of the fluid discharged from the discharge port
returns to the pump suction port, keeping the discharge volume constant. In this condition, the
sub-valve does not move, and the variable orifice stays fully open.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6537
3. The fluid volume that flows thorough oil passage A and the pressure difference applied to the
sub-valve increase in proportion to the engine speed.
The sub-valve lowers overcoming the spring force, and it starts to close the variable orifice to
regulate the discharge volume. When this happens, the fluid volume flowing to the steering
gearbox decreases as the engine speed increases. At the same time, the flow control valve
continues to control the fluid volume to the return port.
4. As the engine speed increases further, the pressure difference at the sub-valve increases further
as well. The sub-valve then closes the variable
orifice completely, regulating the discharge volume further. When this happens, the fluid volume
discharged from the pump to the steering gearbox is regulated and maintained at a given level until
the engine speed reaches the high speed range. The flow control valve functions continues to
control the fluid volume to the return port.
PRESSURE RELIEF
Pressure at the discharge side of the fixed orifice is directed to the bottom of the flow control valve.
When the pressure builds up, the relief valve in the flow control valve opens to release the pressure
at the bottom of the valve. This allows the flow control valve to be pushed back by the pressure
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6538
difference, and the fluid volume to the pump return port increases. As explained above, the system
keeps the pump discharge pressure (relief pressure) from exceeding the given level by controlling
the volume of the fluid to the pump return port.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6539
Power Steering Pump: Testing and Inspection
Pump Pressure Check
Check the fluid pressure as follows to determine whether the trouble is in the pump or gearbox.
NOTE: First check the power steering fluid level and pump belt tension.
CAUTION: Disconnect the high pressure hose with care so as not to spill the power steering fluid
on the frame and other parts.
1. Disconnect the outlet line from the pump outlet fitting, then install the P/S joint adaptor (pump) on
the pump outlet. 2. Connect the P/S joint adaptor (hose) to the power steering pressure gauge,
then connect the outlet hose to the adaptor.
3. Install the power steering pressure gauge to the P/S joint adaptor (pump) as shown. 4. Open the
shut off valve fully. 5. Open the pressure control valve fully. 6. Start the engine and let it idle. 7.
Turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times to warm the fluid to operating temperature.
8. Measure steady-state fluid pressure while idling. If the pump is in good condition, the gauge
should read less than 1500 kPa (15 kgf/cm2, 213
psi). If it reads high, check the outlet line or valve body unit (see General Troubleshooting 17-22).
9. Close the pressure control valve, then close the shut-off valve gradually until the pressure gauge
needle is stable. Read the pressure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6540
10. Immediately open the pressure control valve fully.
CAUTION: Do not keep the pressure control valve closed more then 5 seconds or the pump could
be damaged by over-heating.
If the pump is in good condition, the gauge should read at least 6,400 - 7,400 kPa (65 - 75 kgf/cm2,
920 - 1,070 psi). A low reading means pump output is too low for full assist. Repair or replace the
pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Removal/Installation
NOTE: Before disconnecting the hoses from the pump, place a suitable container under the
vehicle.
1. Remove the belt by loosening the pump mounting bolts and adjusting bolt ('99-'00 models:
B16A2 Engine Type only). 2. Cover the A/C compressor with several shop towels to protect it from
spilled power steering fluid. 3. Disconnect the inlet hose and the outlet line from the pump, and plug
them.
NOTE: Take care not to spill the fluid on the body or parts. Wipe off any spilled fluid at once.
4. Remove the pump mounting bolts and adjusting bolt ('99-'00 models: B16A2 Engine Type only),
then remove the pump.
NOTE: Do not turn the steering wheel with the pump removed.
- Wrap the opening of the pump with a piece of tape to prevent foreign material from entering the
pump.
5. Connect the inlet hose and the outlet line. Tighten the pump fittings securely. 6. Loosely install
the pump in the pump bracket with mounting bolts and adjusting bolt ('99-'00 models: B16A2
Engine Type only).
7. Install the pump belt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6543
CAUTION: Make sure that the power steering belt is properly positioned on the pulleys.
- Do not get power steering fluid or grease in the power steering belt or pulley faces. Clean off any
fluid or grease before installation.
8. Adjust the pump belt. 9. Fill the reservoir to the upper level line.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6544
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Overhaul
Disassembly
CAUTION: The power steering components are made of aluminum. Avoid damaging the
components during assembly.
NOTE: Clean the disassembled parts with a solvent, and dry them with compressed air. Do not dip the
rubber parts in a solvent.
- Always replace the O-rings and rubber seals with new ones before assembly.
- Apply recommended power steering fluid to the parts indicated in the assembly procedures.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the power steering system.
- Replace the pump as an assembly if the parts indicated with asterisk (*) are worn or damaged.
1. Drain the fluid from the pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6545
2. Hold the steering pump in a vise with soft jaws, hold the pulley with the special tool, and remove
the pulley nut and pulley.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the pump housing with the jaws of the vise and extension bar.
3. Loosen the flow control valve cap with a hex wrench and remove it. 4. Remove the O-ring, flow
control valve and spring. 5. Remove the inlet joint and O-ring. 6. Remove the pump cover and
pump cover seal. 7. Remove the outer side plate, pump cam ring, pump rotor, pump vanes, side
plate and O-rings. 8. Remove the snap ring, then remove the sub-valve from the pump housing. 9.
Remove the circlip, then remove the pump drive shaft by tapping the shaft end with the plastic
hammer.
10. Remove the pump seal spacer and pump seal.
Inspection
Flow Control Valve:
1. Check the flow control valve for wear, burrs, and other damage to the edges of the grooves in
the valve. 2. Inspect the bore the flow control valve for scratches or wear.
3. Slip the valve back in the pump, and check that it moves in and out smoothly.
If OK, go on step 4; if not, replace the pump as an assembly. The flow control valve is not available
separately.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6546
4. Attach a hose to the end of the valve as shown.
5. Submerge the valve in a container of power steering fluid or solvent, and blow in the hose. If air
bubbles leak through the valve at less than 98 kPa
(1.0 kgf/cm2, 14.2 psi), repair it as follows.
6. Hold the bottom end of the valve with an open end wrench.
7. Unscrew the seat in the top end of the valve, and remove any shims, the relief check ball, relief
valve and relief valve spring. 8. Clean all the parts in solvent, dry them off, then reassemble and
retest the valve. If the flow control valve tests OK, reinstall it in the pump. If the
flow control valve still leaks air, replace the pump as an assembly. The flow control valve is not
available separately.
NOTE: If necessary, relief pressure is adjusted at the factory by adding shims under the check ball
seat. If you found shims in your valve, be sure you reinstall as many as you took out.
Ball Bearing:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6547
1. Inspect the ball bearing by rotating the outer race slowly. If any play or roughness is felt, replace
the ball bearing. 2. Remove and discard the ball bearing using a press as shown. 3. Install the new
ball bearing using a press as shown.
Ball Bearing Replacement:
Reassembly
1. Align the pin of the sub-valve with the oil passage in pump housing, and push down the
sub-valve. Install the snap ring properly. 2. Install the new pump seal in the pump housing by hand,
then install the pump seal spacer.
NOTE: Insert the pump seal with its grooved side facing in.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6548
3. Position the pump drive shaft in the pump housing, then drive it in using a special tool as shown.
4. Install the 40 mm circlip with its radiused side facing out. 5. Coat the pump cover seal and the
cover bushing with the power steering fluid, then install the pump cover seal into the groove in the
pump cover.
6. Install the outer side plate over the two rollers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6549
7. Set the pump cam ring over the two rollers with the " - " mark on the cam ring upward. 8.
Assemble pump rotor to the pump cover with the " - " marks on the rotor facing down.
9. Set the 10 vanes in the grooves in the rotor.
NOTE: Be sure that the round ends of the vanes are in contact with the sliding surface of the cam
ring.
10. Coat the O-ring with power steering fluid, and install it into the grooves in the side plate.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6550
11. Install the side plate on the cam ring by aligning the roller set holes in the side plate with the
rollers. 12. Coat the O-ring with power steering fluid, and position it into the pump housing.
13. Install the pump cover assembly in the pump housing. 14. Coat the flow control valve with
power steering fluid. 15. Install the flow control valve and spring on the pump housing. 16. Coat the
O-ring with power steering fluid, and install it on the flow control valve cap.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6551
17. Install the flow control valve cap on the pump housing and tighten it. 18. Coat the O-ring with
power steering fluid, and install it into the grooves in the inlet joint.
19. Install the inlet joint on the pump housing.
20. Install the pulley as shown below, then loosely install the pulley nut. Hold the steering pump in
a vise with soft jaws.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the pump housing with the jaws of the vise.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 6552
21. Hold the pulley with the special tool, and tighten the pulley nut. 22. Check that the pump turns
smoothly by turning the pulley by hand.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Pressure Control
Control Valve Body Unit: Description and Operation Pressure Control
LOW ASSIST AT HIGHER SPEEDS
When steering resistance is low, such as when driving at high speeds, or when driving straight
ahead, the input shaft is near or in the neutral position, so there is little or no flow to any of the
power cylinder orifices. Most of the feed pressure from the pump is bypassed to the reservoir.
Because of this, the pressure stays the same in both sides of the power cylinder, resulting in low or
no assist.
HIGH ASSIST AT LOWER SPEEDS
When steering resistance is high, such as when driving at low speeds, or when turning the wheel
with the vehicle stopped, the difference in angle created between the input shaft and the valve
opens the fluid passage on one side, and closes the fluid passage on the other side, at each pair of
orifices. The fluid pressure increases in the side of the power cylinder fed by the larger fluid
passage. This increased pressure pushes on the rack piston, allowing the steering wheel to be
turned with light effort. On the other side of the power cylinder, the return passage opens allowing
the steering fluid to return through the input shaft to the reservoir. The fluid passages to the power
cylinder automatically change in size, increasing as the steering resistance increases. In other
words, the passages become larger and power assist increases when the steering effort would
normally be high, (for example, when parking or making low speed turns), and the passages
become smaller and power assist decreases when the steering effort would normally be low, (for
example, when driving at high speeds or straight ahead).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Pressure Control > Page 6557
Control Valve Body Unit: Description and Operation Valve Body
Inside the valve body unit is the valve, which is coaxial with the pinion shaft, controls the steering
fluid pressure. The valve housing is connected with the fluid line from the pump, the return line to
the reservoir, and the two cylinder lines from the respective power cylinder. The pinion shaft is
double structured with the input shaft connected to the pinion gear, both of which are
interconnected with the torsion bar. The pin inserted in the valve and the pinion shaft groove
engage; this allows the pinion shaft to rotate together with the valve. Because of this construction,
the difference in angle in the circumferential direction between the input shaft and the valve
becomes larger according to the torsional strength of the pinion or steering resistance. However,
maximum torsion between the shafts is regulated by the engaged splines of the shafts at the pin
engagement section to hold the torsion bar within the set value. This allows the steering system to
function as an ordinary rack-and-pinion type steering if the steering fluid is not pressurized because
of a faulty pump.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Control Valve Body Unit: Service and Repair Removal
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint Remover, 28 mm
NOTE: Using solvent and a brush, wash any oil and dirt off the valve body unit its lines, and the
end if the gearbox. Blow dry with compressed air.
1. Drain the power steering fluid. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it on safety stands in the
proper locations. 3. Remove the front wheels. 4. Remove the driver's airbag assembly, and
steering wheel.
5. Remove the steering joint cover.
6. Remove the steering joint lower bolt, and disconnect the steering joint by moving the joint toward
the column.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6560
7. Remove the cotter pin from the castle nut and remove the nut. 8. Install the 10 mm hex nut on
the ball joint. Be sure that the 10 mm hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the threaded
section of the ball
joint pin might be damaged by the special tool.
NOTE: Remove the ball joint using the special tool.
9. Separate the tie-rod ball joint and knuckle using the special tool.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the ball joint boot.
10. Remove the left tie-rod end, then slide the rack all the way to the right. 11. Separate the
exhaust pipe A or TWC. 12. Disconnect the shift linkage. 13. Loosen the 14 mm flare nut and
disconnect the feed line. 14. Loosen the adjustable hose clamp and disconnect the return hose.
15. Loosen the 16 mm flare nut and remove the return hose joint from the valve body unit.
CAUTION: After disconnecting the hose and line, plug or seal the hose and line with a piece of
tape or equivalent to prevent foreign Materials from entering the valve body unit.
NOTE: Do not loosen the cylinder line A and B between the valve body unit and cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6561
16. Remove the stiffener plate.
NOTE: Some stiffener plate attaching bolts are also used as gearbox mounting bolts. The gearbox
will tilt to side when these bolts are removed.
17. Remove the mounting brackets. 18. Pull the steering gearbox all the way down to clear the
pinion shaft from the bulkhead, then remove the pinion shaft grommet.
19. Move the steering gearbox to right so the left rack end clears the rear beam, then tilt the left
side down to remove it from the vehicle.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend or damage the feed line and cylinder lines when removing the
gearbox.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6562
20. Remove air tube and clips.
21. Remove cylinder lines A and B from the gearbox. 22. Drain the fluid from the cylinder fittings by
slowly moving the steering rack back and forth.
23. Remove the two flange bolts, then remove the valve body unit from the gearbox.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6563
Control Valve Body Unit: Service and Repair Disassembly
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07NAD-SR3020A Cylinder End Seal Remover Attachment
- 07GAF-PH70100 Pilot Collar
NOTE:
- Clean the disassembled parts with a solvent, and dry them with compressed air. Do not dip the
rubber parts in a solvent.
- Always replace the Wrings and rubber seals with new ones before assembly.
1. Before removing the valve housing, apply vinyl tape to splines of the pinion shaft.
2. Separate the valve housing from the pinion shaft/valve using a press.
3. Check the inner wall of the valve housing where the seal ring slides with your finger. If there is a
step in the wall, the valve housing is worn.
Replace the valve housing.
NOTE: There may be the sliding marks from the seal ring on the wall of the valve housing. Replace the
valve housing only if the wall is stepped.
- When the valve housing is replaced, install new shim(s) on the bearing surface of the housing to
adjust the thickness.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6564
4. Check for wear, burrs and other damage to the edges of the grooves in the sleeve.
NOTE: The pinion shaft and sleeve are a precision matched set. If either the pinion shaft or sleeve
must be replaced, replace both parts as a set.
5. Remove the circlip and pinion shaft sleeve from the pinion shaft.
6. Using a cutter or an equivalent tool, cut and remove the four seal rings from the sleeve.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the edges of the sleeve grooves and outer surface when
removing the seal rings.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6565
7. Using a cutter or an equivalent tool, cut the valve seal ring and O-ring at the groove the pinion
shaft. Remove the valve seal ring and O-ring.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the edges of the pinion shaft groove and outer surface when
removing the valve seal ring and O-ring.
8. Remove the valve oil seal and backup ring from the pinion shaft.
NOTE: Inspect the ball bearing by rotating the outer race slowly. If there is any excessive play, replace the
pinion shaft and sleeve as an assembly.
- The pinion shaft and sleeve are a precise fit; do not intermix old and new pinion shafts and
sleeves.
9. Press the valve oil seal and roller bearing out of the valve housing using a hydraulic press and
special tool shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6566
Control Valve Body Unit: Service and Repair Assembly
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07NAG-SR30900 Piston Seal Ring
- 07974-SA50200 Sleeve Seal Ring Sizing Tool
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010100 Attachment, 32 x 35 mm
- 07GAG-SD40100 Piston Seal Ring Guide
- 07GAG-SD40200 Piston Seal Ring Sizing Tool
NOTE:
- Clean the disassembled parts with a solvent, and dry them with compressed air. Do not dip the
rubber parts in a solvent.
- Always replace the Wrings and rubber seals with new ones before assembly.
- Apply the recommended power steering fluid to the parts indicated in the assembly procedures.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the power steering system.
- Use the appropriate special tools where necessary.
1. Apply vinyl tape to the stepped portion of the pinion shaft, and coat the surface of the vinyl tape
with the power steering fluid. 2. Install the backup ring with its tapered side as shown below. 3.
Coat the inside surface of the new valve oil seal with power steering fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6567
4. Slide the valve oil seal over the pinion shaft, being careful not to damage the sealing lip.
CAUTION: Install the valve oil seal with its grooved side facing opposite the hearing.
5. Apply vinyl tape to the splines and stepped portion of the shaft, and coat the surface of the vinyl
tape with the power steering fluid. 6. Fit the new O-ring in the groove of the pinion shaft. Then slide
the new valve seal ring over the shaft and the groove in on the pinion shaft.
7. Remove the vinyl tape from the pinion shaft. 8. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the
valve seal ring that was installed on the pinion shaft. 9. Apply power steering fluid to the inside of
the special tool. Set the larger diameter end of the special tool over the valve seal ring.
10. Move the special tool up and down several times to make the valve seal ring fit in the pinion
shaft. 11. Remove the special tool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6568
12. Turn the special tool over, and set the smaller diameter end of the special tool over the valve
seal ring. Move the special tool up and down several
times to make the valve seal ring fit snugly in the pinion shaft.
13. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the special tool. Set the new seal rings over the
special tool from the smaller diameter end of the tool,
and expand the seal rings. Do two rings at a time from each end of the sleeve.
NOTE: Do not over-expand the seal ring. Install the resin seal rings with care so as not to damage them.
After installation, be sure to contract the seal rings using the special tool (sizing tool).
- There are two types of sleeve seal rings: black and brown. Do not mix the different types of
sleeve seal rings as they are not compatible.
14. Set the special tool in the grooves in the sleeve, and set each ring in each groove securely.
NOTE: After installation, compress the seal rings with your fingers temporarily.
15. Apply power steering fluid to the seal rings on the sleeve, and to the entire inside surface of the
special tool. 16. Insert the sleeve into the special tool slowly.
17. Move the sleeve each direction several times to make the seal rings snugly fit in the sleeve.
NOTE: Be sure that the seal rings are not turned up.
18. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the pinion shaft. Assemble the sleeve over the
pinion shaft by aligning the locating pin on the inside of
the sleeve with the cutout in the shaft. Then install the new circlip securely in the pinion shaft
groove.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the valve seal ring when inserting the sleeve.
- Install the circlip with its radiused side toward the sleeve.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6569
19. Apply power steering fluid to the seal ring lip of the valve oil seal, then install the seal in the
valve housing using a hydraulic press and special
tools as shown.
CAUTION: Install the valve oil seal with its grooved side facing the tool.
20. Press the new bearing into the valve housing using a hydraulic press and special tool as
shown.
NOTE: Place the roller bearing on the valve housing with the stamped letter facing up towards the
valve side.
21. Apply vinyl tape to the pinion shaft, then coat the vinyl tape with power steering fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6570
22. Insert the pinion shaft into the valve housing.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the valve seal rings.
23. Remove the vinyl tape from the pinion shaft.
24. Press the pinion shaft/sleeve using a hydraulic press as shown.
NOTE: Check that the pinion shaft/sleeve turns smoothly by turning the pinion shaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6571
Control Valve Body Unit: Service and Repair Installation
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend or damage the feed line and cylinder lines when installing the
gearbox.
1. Select the 32 mm shim(s).
NOTE: Only reinstall the original 32 mm shim(s) when the steering gearbox is reassembled without
replacing the pinion shaft, valve housing, and gearbox housing with new ones. If the pinion shaft,
valve housing, and gearbox housing are replaced, select the new shim(s) as follows.
Shim Selection:
a. Set the four 32 mm shims on the bearing surface of the gearbox housing. Total thickness of the
four shims should equal no more than 0.70
mm. Shim set: four 32 mm shims (Thickness: 0.10 mm, 0.15 mm, 0.20 mm, 0.25 mm respectively)
CAUTION: The four 32 mm shims do not have thickness identification marks. Measure the
thickness of each shim using a micrometer, and mark the shim for identification.
b. Install the valve body unit on the gearbox, and tighten the flange bolts to the specified torque.
c. Measure the clearance between the gearbox and valve body unit using a feeler gauge as shown.
NOTE: Measure the clearance at the point midway between the two mounting bolts.
d. Determine the required thickness-of the 32 mm shims by subtracting the clearance obtained in
the step "c" from the total thickness of the
four shims. (Total thickness of the 4 shims) - (Clearance) = Required thickness of the shims
NOTE: Select the shims so that the total thickness is close to, but less than, the required thickness.
Example: Measurement is 0.28 mm (0.011 inch): 0.70 - 0.28 = 0.42 mm (0.028 - 0.011 = 0.017
inch). The selected shims should be 0.25 mm (0.010 inch) and 0.15 mm (0.006 inch) in thickness.
If the required shim thickness is 0.10 mm or less, no shims are necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6572
2. Set the selected 32 mm shims on the bearing surface of the gearbox housing. 3. Coat the new
O-ring with grease, and carefully fit it on the valve housing. 4. Apply grease to the needle bearing in
the gearbox housing. 5. Install the valve body unit on the gearbox housing by engaging the gears.
NOTE: Note the valve body unit installation position (direction of line connection).
6. Tighten the flange bolts to the specified torque.
7. Install the cylinder lines A and B.
8. Before installing the gearbox, slide the rack ail the way to right. 9. Install the mounting cushion
on the steering gearbox.
10. Install the pinion shaft grommet, then insert the pinion shaft up through the bulkhead.
NOTE: Align the notch in the pinion shaft grommet with the tab on the valve housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6573
11. Install the mounting bracket over the mounting cushion, then install two gearbox mounting
bolts.
12. Install the stiffener plate with the two gearbox mounting bolts arid stiffener plate attaching bolts.
CAUTION: Be sure the air tube is not caught or pinched by stiffener plate.
NOTE: Install the bolts loosely first, then tighten them securely.
13. Install the return hose joint by tightening the 16 mm flare nut. 14. Connect the return hose
securely, and tighten the adjustable hose clamp from the engine compartment.
15. Connect the feed line and tighten the 14 mm flare nut.
NOTE: Make sure that there is no interference between the fluid lines, the rear beam or any other
parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6574
16. Center the steering rack within its stroke.
17. Slip the lower end of the steering joint onto the pinion shaft (line up the bolt hole with the
groove around the shaft), and tighten the lower bolt.
NOTE: Connect the steering shaft and pinion with the cable reel and steering rack centered.
- Be sure that the lower steering joint bolt is securely in the groove in the steering gearbox pinion.
- If the steering wheel and rack are not centered, reposition the serrations at lower end of the
steering joint.
18. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise
(approximately two turns) until the arrow mark on
the label points straight up. Reinstall the steering wheel.
19. Install the steering joint cover with the clamps and a clip.
20. Reconnect the tie-rod ends to the steering knuckles, tighten the castle nut to the specified
torque, and install new cotter pins.
NOTE: Before connecting the tie-rod ends, wipe off any grease contamination from the ball joint
tapered section and threads.
CAUTION: Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to
align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Control Valve Body Unit <--> [Power
Steering Valve] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6575
21. Install the exhaust pipe A or TWC. 22. Connect the shift linkage. 23. Install the front wheels. 24.
Fill the system with power steering fluid, and bleed air from the system. 25. After installation,
perform the following checks.
a. Start the engine, allow it to idle, and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times to
warm up the fluid. Check the gearbox for leaks. b. Adjust the front toe. See: Alignment c. Check the
steering wheel spoke angle. Adjust by turning the right and left tie-rods, if necessary.
NOTE: Turn the right and left tie-rods equally.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Locations
Lower Left Rear of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6580
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6581
Part 2 Of 2
This signals the ECM/ PCM when the power steering load is high.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Locations > Page 6586
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6589
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6590
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact > Page 6593
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6594
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Key Reminder Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6599
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6600
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6601
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6602
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6603
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6604
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6605
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6606
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6607
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6608
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6609
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6610
Key Reminder Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6611
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6612
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6613
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6614
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6615
Seat Belt & Ignition Key Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 6616
Key Reminder Switch: Description and Operation
Ignition Key Warning
Battery voltage is supplied at all times to the seat belt reminder/key-on beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit. When you turn on the ignition key switch the integrated control unit senses
ground. If you open the driver's door, the door switch closes, causing the beeper to sound until the
door is closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Locations
Steering Column Lock: Locations
Right Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6620
Steering Column Lock: Testing and Inspection
Key Interlock Solenoid Test
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster.
2. Disconnect the 7P connector from the main wire harness.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each key position according to the table. 4. Check
that the key cannot be removed with power and ground connected to the No.7 and No.6 terminals.
- If the key cannot be removed, the key interlock solenoid is OK.
- If the key can be removed, replace the steering lock assembly (the interlock solenoid is not
available separately).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Lock > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6621
Steering Column Lock: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
Remove:
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then wire down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 model) 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable. 3. Remove the driver's
dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 4. Disconnect the 5P connector from the under-dash
fuse/relay box and the 7P connector from the main wire harness. 5.Remove the steering column
covers, then remove the mounting bolts and nuts from the steering column. 6. Lower the steering
column assembly.
7. Center-punch each of the two shear bolts, then drill their heads off with a 5 mm (3/16 in) drill bit.
CAUTION: Do not damage the steering lock body.
8. Remove the shear bolts and the steering lock assembly.
Installation:
1. Install the new steering lock assembly without the key inserted. 2. Loosely tighten the new shear
bolts. 3. Insert the ignition key, and check for proper operation of the steering wheel lock and that
the ignition key turns freely.
4. Tighten the shear bolts until the hex heads twist off. 5. Install in the reverse order of removal. 6.
Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information >
Specifications
Steering Gear: Specifications Steering Rack
Steering Rack
Steering Effort 15 Nm
Front wheels off ground.
Tightening Torque Rack guide locknut 25 Nm
Mounting brackets 39 Nm
Stiffener plate attaching bolts 38 Nm
Steering joint lower bolt 22 Nm
Tie-rod end nut 40 to 48 Nm
Valve Housing Flange Bolts 14 ft.lb
Cylinder End 51 ft.lb
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6625
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6626
Steering Gear: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- To avoid rendering the SRS inoperative, which could lead to personal injury or death in the event
of severe frontal collision, all SRS service work must be performed by an authorized mechanic.
- Improper service procedures, including incorrect removal and installation of the SRS, could lead
to personal injury caused by unintentional activation of the air bags.
- Do not bump the SRS unit. Otherwise, the system may fail in cause of a collision, or the ai bags
may deploy when the ignition switch is ON (II).
- All SRS electrical wiring harnesses are covered with yellow insulation. Related components are
located in the steering column, front console, dashboard lower panel, and in the dashboard above
the glove box. Do not use electrical test equipment on these circuits.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6627
Steering Gear: Description and Operation
The rack-and-pinion type steering gearbox has a valve body unit incorporated with the pinion to
control the steering fluid pressure. Steering fluid from the pump is regulated by a rotary valve in the
valve body unit and is sent through the cylinder line to the power cylinder, where hydraulic pressure
is applied. The steering fluid in the other side of the power cylinder returns through the cylinder line
and valve body unit to the reservoir.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Adjustments
> Manual Steering
Steering Gear: Adjustments Manual Steering
NOTE: Perform the rack guide adjustment with the wheels in the straight ahead position.
1. Loosen the rack guide screw locknut with the special tool, then loosen the rack guide screw. 2.
Tighten the rack guide screw until it compresses the spring and seats against the rack guide, then
loosen it. 3. Retighten the rack guide screw to 4 Nm (2.9 ft. lbs.), then back it off to specified angle.
Specified Return Angle: 30° max. 4. Tighten the locknut while holding the rack guide screw. 5.
Check for tight or loose steering through the complete turning travel. 6. Recheck steering effort.
See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics/Steering Operation
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Adjustments
> Manual Steering > Page 6630
Steering Gear: Adjustments Power-Assisted
Rack Guide Adjustment
NOTE: Perform rack guide adjustment with the wheels in the straight ahead position.
1. Loosen the rack guide screw locknut with the special tool.
'96-'97 models: Loosen the rack guide screw. '98-'00 models: Remove the rack guide screw and
remove the old sealant off of the threaded section. Apply new sealant all around the threads.
Loosely install the rack guide screw.
2. Tighten the rack guide screw to 25 Nm (2.5 kgf-m, 18 ft. lbs.), then loosen it. 3. Retighten the
rack guide screw to 3.9 Nm (0.4 kgf-m, 2.9 ft. lbs.), then back it off to specified angle.
Specified Return Angle: 20° max.
4. Tighten the locknut while holding the rack guide screw. 5. Check for tight or loose steering
through the complete turning travel. 6. Perform following inspections:
- Steering operation.
- Power assist with vehicle parked.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Power Steering
Removal
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint Remover, 28 mm
NOTE: Using solvent and a brush, wash any oil and dirt off the valve body unit its lines, and the
end if the gearbox. Blow dry with compressed air.
1. Drain the power steering fluid. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it on safety stands in the
proper locations. 3. Remove the front wheels. 4. Remove the driver's airbag assembly, and
steering wheel.
5. Remove the steering joint cover.
6. Remove the steering joint lower bolt, and disconnect the steering joint by moving the joint toward
the column.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6633
7. Remove the cotter pin from the castle nut and remove the nut. 8. Install the 10 mm hex nut on
the ball joint. Be sure that the 10 mm hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the threaded
section of the ball
joint pin might be damaged by the special tool.
NOTE: Remove the ball joint using the special tool.
9. Separate the tie-rod ball joint and knuckle using the special tool.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the ball joint boot.
10. Remove the left tie-rod end, then slide the rack all the way to the right. 11. Separate the
exhaust pipe A or TWC. 12. Disconnect the shift linkage. 13. Loosen the 14 mm flare nut and
disconnect the feed line. 14. Loosen the adjustable hose clamp and disconnect the return hose.
15. Loosen the 16 mm flare nut and remove the return hose joint from the valve body unit.
CAUTION: After disconnecting the hose and line, plug or seal the hose and line with a piece of
tape or equivalent to prevent foreign Materials from entering the valve body unit.
NOTE: Do not loosen the cylinder line A and B between the valve body unit and cylinder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6634
16. Remove the stiffener plate.
NOTE: Some stiffener plate attaching bolts are also used as gearbox mounting bolts. The gearbox
will tilt to side when these bolts are removed.
17. Remove the mounting brackets. 18. Pull the steering gearbox all the way down to clear the
pinion shaft from the bulkhead, then remove the pinion shaft grommet.
19. Move the steering gearbox to right so the left rack end clears the rear beam, then tilt the left
side down to remove it from the vehicle.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend or damage the feed line and cylinder lines when removing the
gearbox.
Steering Gear Disassembly
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07NAD-SR3020A Cylinder End Seal Remover Attachment
- 07GAF-PH70100 Pilot Collar
NOTE:
- Before disassemble the gearbox, wash it off with solvent and a brush.
- Do not dip seals and O-rings in solvent.
1. Remove the steering gearbox.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6635
2. Remove the tie-rod end and locknut.
3. Remove air tube and clips.
4. Remove the boot bands and tie-rod clips. Pull the boots away from the ends of the gearbox.
5. Hold the steering rack with a wrench, and unscrew the rack end with another wrench.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rack surface with the wrench.
6. Loosen the locknut, then remove the rack guide screw and O-ring.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6636
7. Remove the spring and the rack guide from the gear housing.
8. Remove cylinder lines A and B from the gearbox. 9. Drain the fluid from the cylinder fittings by
slowly moving the steering rack back and forth.
10. Remove the two flange bolts, then remove the valve body unit from the gearbox.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6637
11. Drill a 3 mm (0.12 inch) diameter hole approximately 2.5 - 3.0 mm (0.10 - 0.12 inch) in depth in
the staked point on the cylinder.
CAUTION: Do not allow metal shavings to enter the cylinder housing.
- After removing the cylinder end, remove any burrs at the staked point.
12. Hold the steering gearbox using a C-clamp as shown. 13. Loosen and remove the cylinder end.
14. Assemble a 12 x 1.25 mm flange nut onto a 12 x 175 mm grade 10 flange bolt as shown.
NOTE: Wrap the flange portion of the bolt with vinyl tape to protect the cylinder.
15. Install the flange bolt into the end of the steering rack until it bottoms in the hole, then back the
flange bolt out 1/4 turn. Hold the flange bolt, and
tighten the flange nut against the rack by hand.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6638
16. Install the bearing separator on the gearbox housing as shown. 17. Set the gearbox in a press
so the gear housing point upward, then press the cylinder end seal and steering rack out of the
gearbox.
NOTE: Hold the steering rack to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
CAUTION: Be careful not damage to inner surface of the cylinder housing with the flange bolt.
- Do not place your fingers under the steering rack.
18. Remove the 12 mm bolt and nut from the steering rack.
19. Remove the cylinder end seal from the steering rack. 20. Insert a 24" long, 3/8" drive extension
and the special tool into the cylinder from the gearbox side.
NOTE: Make sure that the special tool is securely positioned on the backup ring edges.
CAUTION: Be careful not damage to inner surface of the cylinder housing with the special tool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6639
21. Set the gearbox in a press, then press out the cylinder end seal and backup ring from the
gearbox.
CAUTION: Keep the tool straight to avoid damaging the cylinder wall. Check the tool angle, and correct it if
necessary, when removing the cylinder end seal.
- Use a press to remove the cylinder end seal. Do not try to remove the seal by striking the tool. It
will break the backup ring, and the cylinder end seal will remain in the gearbox.
22. Carefully pry the piston seal ring and O-ring off the piston rack.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the inside of seal ring groove and piston edges when
removing the seal ring.
23. Before removing the valve housing, apply vinyl tape to splines of the pinion shaft.
24. Separate the valve housing from the pinion shaft/valve using a press.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6640
25. Check the inner wall of the valve housing where the seal ring slides with your finger. If there is
a step in the wall, the valve housing is worn.
Replace the valve housing.
NOTE: There may be the sliding marks from the seal ring on the wall of the valve housing. Replace the
valve housing only if the wall is stepped.
- When the valve housing is replaced, install new shim(s) on the bearing surface of the housing to
adjust the thickness.
26. Check for wear, burrs and other damage to the edges of the grooves in the sleeve.
NOTE: The pinion shaft and sleeve are a precision matched set. If either the pinion shaft or sleeve
must be replaced, replace both parts as a set.
27. Remove the circlip and pinion shaft sleeve from the pinion shaft.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6641
28. Using a cutter or an equivalent tool, cut and remove the four seal rings from the sleeve.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the edges of the sleeve grooves and outer surface when
removing the seal rings.
29. Using a cutter or an equivalent tool, cut the valve seal ring and O-ring at the groove the pinion
shaft. Remove the valve seal ring and O-ring.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the edges of the pinion shaft groove and outer surface when
removing the valve seal ring and O-ring.
30. Remove the valve oil seal and backup ring from the pinion shaft.
NOTE: Inspect the ball bearing by rotating the outer race slowly. If there is any excessive play, replace the
pinion shaft and sleeve as an assembly.
- The pinion shaft and sleeve are a precise fit; do not intermix old and new pinion shafts and
sleeves.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6642
31. Press the valve oil seal and roller bearing out of the valve housing using a hydraulic press and
special tool shown below.
Steering Gear Assembly
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07NAG-SR30900 Piston Seal Ring
- 07974-SA50800 Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide
- 07974-SA50200 Sleeve Seal Ring Sizing Tool
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010100 Attachment, 32 x 35 mm
- 07GAG-SD40100 Piston Seal Ring Guide
- 07GAG-SD40200 Piston Seal Ring Sizing Tool
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6643
NOTE:
- Clean the disassembled parts with a solvent, and dry them with compressed air. Do not dip the
rubber parts in a solvent.
- Always replace the Wrings and rubber seals with new ones before assembly.
- Apply the recommended power steering fluid to the parts indicated in the assembly procedures.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the power steering system.
- Use the appropriate special tools where necessary.
1. Apply vinyl tape to the stepped portion of the pinion shaft, and coat the surface of the vinyl tape
with the power steering fluid. 2. Install the backup ring with its tapered side as shown below. 3.
Coat the inside surface of the new valve oil seal with power steering fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6644
4. Slide the valve oil seal over the pinion shaft, being careful not to damage the sealing lip.
CAUTION: Install the valve oil seal with its grooved side facing opposite the hearing.
5. Apply vinyl tape to the splines and stepped portion of the shaft, and coat the surface of the vinyl
tape with the power steering fluid. 6. Fit the new O-ring in the groove of the pinion shaft. Then slide
the new valve seal ring over the shaft and the groove in on the pinion shaft.
7. Remove the vinyl tape from the pinion shaft. 8. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the
valve seal ring that was installed on the pinion shaft. 9. Apply power steering fluid to the inside of
the special tool. Set the larger diameter end of the special tool over the valve seal ring.
10. Move the special tool up and down several times to make the valve seal ring fit in the pinion
shaft. 11. Remove the special tool.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6645
12. Turn the special tool over, and set the smaller diameter end of the special tool over the valve
seal ring. Move the special tool up and down several
times to make the valve seal ring fit snugly in the pinion shaft.
13. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the special tool. Set the new seal rings over the
special tool from the smaller diameter end of the tool,
and expand the seal rings. Do two rings at a time from each end of the sleeve.
NOTE: Do not over-expand the seal ring. Install the resin seal rings with care so as not to damage them.
After installation, be sure to contract the seal rings using the special tool (sizing tool).
- There are two types of sleeve seal rings: black and brown. Do not mix the different types of
sleeve seal rings as they are not compatible.
14. Set the special tool in the grooves in the sleeve, and set each ring in each groove securely.
NOTE: After installation, compress the seal rings with your fingers temporarily.
15. Apply power steering fluid to the seal rings on the sleeve, and to the entire inside surface of the
special tool. 16. Insert the sleeve into the special tool slowly.
17. Move the sleeve each direction several times to make the seal rings snugly fit in the sleeve.
NOTE: Be sure that the seal rings are not turned up.
18. Apply power steering fluid to the surface of the pinion shaft. Assemble the sleeve over the
pinion shaft by aligning the locating pin on the inside of
the sleeve with the cutout in the shaft. Then install the new circlip securely in the pinion shaft
groove.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the valve seal ring when inserting the sleeve.
- Install the circlip with its radiused side toward the sleeve.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6646
19. Apply power steering fluid to the seal ring lip of the valve oil seal, then install the seal in the
valve housing using a hydraulic press and special
tools as shown.
CAUTION: Install the valve oil seal with its grooved side facing the tool.
20. Press the new bearing into the valve housing using a hydraulic press and special tool as
shown.
NOTE: Place the roller bearing on the valve housing with the stamped letter facing up towards the
valve side.
21. Apply vinyl tape to the pinion shaft, then coat the vinyl tape with power steering fluid.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6647
22. Insert the pinion shaft into the valve housing.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the valve seal rings.
23. Remove the vinyl tape from the pinion shaft.
24. Press the pinion shaft/sleeve using a hydraulic press as shown.
NOTE: Check that the pinion shaft/sleeve turns smoothly by turning the pinion shaft.
25. Coat the piston seal ring guide with power steering fluid, then slide it onto the rack, big end first.
26. Position the new O-ring and new piston seal ring on the special tool, then slide them down
toward the big end of the tool.
NOTE: Do not over expand the resin seal rings. Install the resin seal rings with care so as not to damage
them. After installation, be sure to contract the seal ring using the special tool (sizing tool).
- Replace the piston's O-ring and seal ring as a set.
27. Pull the O-ring off into the piston groove, then pull the piston seal ring off into the piston groove
on top of the O-ring. 28. Coat the piston seal ring and the inside of the special tool with power
steering fluid. 29. Carefully slide the tool onto the rack and over the piston seal ring.
30. Move the special tool back and forth several times to make the piston seal ring fit snugly in the
piston.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6648
31. Wrap vinyl tape around the rack teeth and rack end edges, then coat the surface of the tape
with the power steering fluid.
NOTE: Make sure that the vinyl tape is wrapped carefully so that there is no stepped portion.
32. Coat the inside surface of the new cylinder end seal with power steering fluid.
33. Install the cylinder end seal onto the steering rack with its grooved side toward the piston.
CAUTION: When installing the cylinder end seal, be careful not damage the sealing lip face of the
seal with the edges or teeth of the steering rack.
34. Remove the vinyl tape from the steering rack.
NOTE: Remove any residue of take adhesive.
35. Install the new backup ring on the steering rack, then place the cylinder end seal to piston.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6649
36. Grease the steering rack teeth, then insert the steering rack into the gear housing.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage to inner surface of the cylinder housing with the rack edges.
37. Install the flange bolt into the end of the steering rack until it bottoms in the hole, then back the
flange bolt out 1/4 turn. Hold the flange bolt and
tighten the flange nut against the rack by hand.
38. Install the cylinder end seal into the bottom of the cylinder by pressing on the bolt with a press
as shown.
CAUTION: Do not push on the bolt with excessive force as it may damage the cylinder end seal.
39. Remove the flange bolt, and center the steering rack.
40. Wrap vinyl tape around the rack end edges, and coat the surface of the tape with the power
steering fluid.
NOTE: Make sure that the vinyl tape is wrapped carefully so that there is no stepped portion.
41. Coat the inside surface of the new cylinder end seal with power steering fluid. 42. Install the
cylinder end seal onto the steering rack with its grooved side toward the piston.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6650
43. Push in the cylinder end seal with your finger.
CAUTION: When installing the cylinder end seal, be careful not damage the sealing face of the
seal with the threads and burrs at the staked position of the cylinder housing.
44. Remove the vinyl tape from the steering rack.
NOTE: Remove any residue of tape adhesive.
45. Hold the steering gearbox using a C-clamp as shown. 46. Coat the inside surface of the
cylinder end with power steering fluid, then install the cylinder end by screwing it into the cylinder
housing. 47. Remove the C-clamp from the steering gearbox.
48. After tightening the cylinder end, stake the point of the cylinder housing shown below.
NOTE: Stake the cylinder in the position opposite from where the stake was removed during
disassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6651
49. Select the 32 mm shim(s).
NOTE: Only reinstall the original 32 mm shim(s) when the steering gearbox is reassembled without
replacing the pinion shaft, valve housing, and gearbox housing with new ones. If the pinion shaft,
valve housing, and gearbox housing are replaced, select the new shim(s) as follows.
Shim Selection:
a. Set the four 32 mm shims on the bearing surface of the gearbox housing. Total thickness of the
four shims should equal no more than 0.70
mm. Shim set: four 32 mm shims (Thickness: 0.10 mm, 0.15 mm, 0.20 mm, 0.25 mm respectively)
CAUTION: The four 32 mm shims do not have thickness identification marks. Measure the
thickness of each shim using a micrometer, and mark the shim for identification.
b. Install the valve body unit on the gearbox, and tighten the flange bolts to the specified torque.
c. Measure the clearance between the gearbox and valve body unit using a feeler gauge as shown.
NOTE: Measure the clearance at the point midway between the two mounting bolts.
d. Determine the required thickness-of the 32 mm shims by subtracting the clearance obtained in
the step "c" from the total thickness of the
four shims. (Total thickness of the 4 shims) - (Clearance) = Required thickness of the shims
NOTE: Select the shims so that the total thickness is close to, but less than, the required thickness.
Example: Measurement is 0.28 mm (0.011 inch): 0.70 - 0.28 = 0.42 mm (0.028 - 0.011 = 0.017
inch). The selected shims should be 0.25 mm (0.010 inch) and 0.15 mm (0.006 inch) in thickness.
If the required shim thickness is 0.10 mm or less, no shims are necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6652
50. Set the selected 32 mm shims on the bearing surface of the gearbox housing. 51. Coat the new
O-ring with grease, and carefully fit it on the valve housing. 52. Apply grease to the needle bearing
in the gearbox housing. 53. Install the valve body unit on the gearbox housing by engaging the
gears.
NOTE: Note the valve body unit installation position (direction of line connection).
54. Tighten the flange bolts to the specified torque.
55. Install the cylinder lines A and B.
NOTE: Clean the joints of the cylinder lines A and B thoroughly. The joints must be free of foreign material.
- Install the cylinder lines A and B by fighting the flare nuts by hand first, then tighten the flare nuts
to the specified torque.
56. Grease the sliding surface of the rack guide, and install it onto the gear housing. 57. Apply a
thin coat of grease to the new O-ring, and install it on the rack guide screw. 58. Install the spring,
rack guide screw and locknut on the gear housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6653
59. Adjust the rack guide screw.
NOTE: After adjusting, check that the rack moves smoothly by sliding the rack right and left.
60. Install the new lockwasher in the groove in the steering rack. 61. Screw each rack ends into the
rack.
62. Hold the steering rack with a wrench, and tighten the rack ends.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rack surface with the wrench.
63. After tightening the rack ends, stake the four sections of lock washer with a drift and a mallet.
a. Place the wood block on the press table, then set the lock washer section of the rack end on the
wood block securely. b. Be sure the tool is aligned with the flat sections of the steering rack end
before pressing. c. Stake the lock washer in the center of the flat section of the steering rack end.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6654
64. Apply grease to the circumference of the rack end housing. 65. Apply a light coat of silicone
grease to the boot grooves on the rack ends.
66. Install the boots in the rack end with the tie-rod clips.
NOTE: Install the boots with the rack in the straight ahead position (right and left tie-rods are equal
in length).
67. Adjust the air hose fitting position of the boots by turning it as shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6655
68. Install new boot bands on the boot, and bend both sets of locking tabs.
CAUTION: Stake the band locking tabs firmly.
69. Lightly tap on the doubled-over portions to reduce their height. 70. Slide the rack right and left
to be certain that the boots are not deformed or twisted. 71. Connect the air tube between the right
and left boot.
72. Install the clips on the cylinder lines, then clamp the air tube with the clips.
Installation
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend or damage the feed line and cylinder lines when installing the
gearbox.
1. Before installing the gearbox, slide the rack ail the way to right. 2. Install the mounting cushion
on the steering gearbox.
3. Install the pinion shaft grommet, then insert the pinion shaft up through the bulkhead.
NOTE: Align the notch in the pinion shaft grommet with the tab on the valve housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6656
4. Install the mounting bracket over the mounting cushion, then install two gearbox mounting bolts.
5. Install the stiffener plate with the two gearbox mounting bolts arid stiffener plate attaching bolts.
CAUTION: Be sure the air tube is not caught or pinched by stiffener plate.
NOTE: Install the bolts loosely first, then tighten them securely.
6. Install the return hose joint by tightening the 16 mm flare nut. 7. Connect the return hose
securely, and tighten the adjustable hose clamp from the engine compartment.
8. Connect the feed line and tighten the 14 mm flare nut.
NOTE: Make sure that there is no interference between the fluid lines, the rear beam or any other
parts.
9. Center the steering rack within its stroke.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6657
10. Slip the lower end of the steering joint onto the pinion shaft (line up the bolt hole with the
groove around the shaft), and tighten the lower bolt.
NOTE: Connect the steering shaft and pinion with the cable reel and steering rack centered.
- Be sure that the lower steering joint bolt is securely in the groove in the steering gearbox pinion.
- If the steering wheel and rack are not centered, reposition the serrations at lower end of the
steering joint.
11. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise
(approximately two turns) until the arrow mark on
the label points straight up. Reinstall the steering wheel.
12. Install the steering joint cover with the clamps and a clip.
13. Reconnect the tie-rod ends to the steering knuckles, tighten the castle nut to the specified
torque, and install new cotter pins.
NOTE: Before connecting the tie-rod ends, wipe off any grease contamination from the ball joint
tapered section and threads.
CAUTION: Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to
align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
14. Install the exhaust pipe A or TWC.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6658
15. Connect the shift linkage. 16. Install the front wheels. 17. Fill the system with power steering
fluid, and bleed air from the system. 18. After installation, perform the following checks.
a. Start the engine, allow it to idle, and turn the steering wheel from lock-to-lock several times to
warm up the fluid. Check the gearbox for leaks. b. Adjust the front toe. c. Check the steering wheel
spoke angle. Adjust by turning the right and left tie-rods, if necessary.
NOTE: Turn the right and left tie-rods equally.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6659
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Manual Steering
Removal and Installation
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint Remover, 28 mm
NOTE: Using solvent and a brush, to wash any oil and dirt off the gearbox. Blow dry with
compressed air.
REMOVAL
1. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it on safety stands in the proper locations. 2. Remove the
front wheels. 3. Remove the steering wheel.
4. Remove the steering joint cover.
5. Remove the steering joint lower bolt, and disconnect the steering joint by moving the joint toward
the column.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6660
6. Remove the cotter pin from the castle nut and remove the newt 7. Install the 10 mm hex nut on
the ball joint. Be sure that the 10 mm hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the threaded
section of the ball
joint pin might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
NOTE: Remove the ball joint using the special tool. Refer to section 18 for how to use the ball joint
remover.
8. Separate the tie-rod ball joint and knuckle using the special tool.
CAUTION: Avoid damaging the ball joint boot.
9. Remove the left tie-rod end, then slide the rack all the way to the right.
10. Separate the exhaust pipe A or TWC. 11. Disconnect the shift linkage.
12. Remove the stiffener plate.
13. Remove the mounting bracket. 14. Pull the steering gearbox all the way down to clear the
pinion shaft from the bulkhead, then remove the pinion shaft grommet.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6661
15. Move the steering gearbox to right so the left rack end clears the rear beam, then tilt the left
side down to remove it from the car.
INSTALLATION
1. Slide the rack all the way to the right.
2. Install the pinion shaft grommet, and insert the pinion shaft up through the bulkhead.
NOTE: Align the notch in the pinion shaft grommet with the tab on the gear housing.
3. Install the mounting brackets with the two gearbox mounting bolts on the cushion.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6662
4. Install the stiffener plate with the two gearbox mounting bolts and stiffener plate attaching bolts.
NOTE: Install the bolts loosely first, then tighten them securely.
5. Center the steering rack within its stroke.
6. Slip the lower end of the steering joint onto the pinion shaft (line up the bolt hole with the groove
around the shaft), and tighten the lower bolt.
NOTE: Connect the steering shaft and pinion with the steering wheel and steering rack centered.
- Be sure that the lower steering joint bolt is securely in the groove in the steering gearbox pinion.
- If the steering wheel and rack are not centered, reposition the serrations at lower end of the
steering joint.
7. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise
(approximately two turns) until the arrow mark on
the label points straight up. Reinstall the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6663
8. Install the steering joint cover with the clamps and clips.
9. Reconnect the tie-rod ends to the steering knuckles, then tighten the castle nut to the specified
torque, and install new cotter pins.
NOTE: Before connecting the tie-rod ends, wipe off any grease contamination from the ball joint
tapered section and threads.
CAUTION: Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to
align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
10. Install the exhaust pipe A or TWC. 11. Connect the shift linkage. 12. Install the front wheels. 13.
After installation, perform the following checks.
a. Adjust the front toe. b. Check the steering wheel spoke angle. Adjust by turning the right and led
tie-rods, if necessary.
NOTE: Turn the right and left tie-rods equally.
Overhaul
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07746-0020100 Driver, 22 mm I.D.
- Roll Pin Drift
DISASSEMBLE
1. Place the gearbox in a vise with a soft jaws, then clamp the gearbox at the mount bracket or
gear housing.
CAUTION: Be careful not to distort the gear housing by clamping it too tight in the vise incorrectly.
2. Remove the tie-rod end and locknut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6664
3. Remove the boot bands and tie-rod clips. Pull the boots away from the ends of the gearbox.
4. Hold the steering rack with one wrench, and unscrew the rack end with another wrench.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rack surface with the wrench.
5. Push the right end of the rack back into the cylinder housing so the smooth surface that rides
against the seal won't be damaged. 6. Loosen the locknut, and remove the rack guide screw.
7. Remove the disc washer, spring and rack guide from the gear housing. 8. Remove the pinion
dust seal and the 35 mm snap ring.
9. Hold the pinion shaft with a vise securely. Remove the pinion by tapping evenly around the
flanged section of the gearbox with a plastic hammer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6665
CAUTION: Do not tap on the steering rack.
NOTE: Do not reuse the removed pinion.
10. Slide the steering rack out of the cylinder housing.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the bushing in the cylinder housing.
11. Remove the rack end bushing.
12. Replace the gearbox mounting cushion if necessary:
a. To remove the cushion, use a sharp knife and make a cut down the length of the cushion. Be
careful not to damage the paint on the outside of
the cylinder housing. Remove the old cushion.
b. Apply weatherstrip adhesive to the inside of the new cushion. Install the cushion onto the
cylinder housing and position it 20 - 22 mm (0.79 0.87 inch) from the end of the cylinder housing as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6666
NOTE: After installing the cushion, wipe off any excess adhesive that may have dripped into the
inside of the cylinder housing.
ASSEMBLE
NOTE: Clean the disassembled parts with solvent, and dry them with compressed air. Do not dip the
rubber parts in solvent.
- Always replace the non-reuseable parts with new ones before assembly.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the steering gearbox.
1. Apply a thin coat of grease to the inside surface of the rack end bushing. Grease quantity: 1 - 3g
(0.04 - 0.1 oz).
CAUTION: Do not fill the slots with grease; they must remain open to serve as air passages.
2. Install the rack end bushing by aligning the round projection on the bushing with the hole in the
cylinder housing 3. Grease the steering rack teeth.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6667
4. Install the steering rack into the cylinder housing carefully to avoid damaging the rack end
bushing.
5. Drive in the steering pinion in the gear housing with the special tools. 6. Install the 35 mm snap
ring securely in the gear housing groove. 7. Apply vinyl tape to the pinion shaft, then coat the vinyl
tape with grease. 8. Install the pinion dust seal on the gear housing until it seats properly, then
remove the tape. 9. Grease the sliding surface of the rack guide, and install it on to the gear
housing.
10. Install the spring, disc washer and rack guide screw on the gear housing.
NOTE: Install the disc washer with its convex side facing in.
11. Adjust the rack guide screw. 12. Install the new lock washer in the groove in the steering rack.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6668
13. Install the steering rack end into the rack. 14. Hold the steering rack with a wrench and tighten
the rack end with another.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rack surface with the wrench.
15. After tightening the rack ends, stake the four sections of the lock washer with a roll pin drift and
a mallet.
a. Place the wood block on the press table, then set the lock washer section of the rack end on the
wood block securely. Be sure the tool is
aligned with the flat sections of the steering rack end before pressing.
b. Stake the lock washer in the center of the flat section of the steering rack end.
16. Apply grease to the circumference of the rack end housing. 17. Apply a light coat of silicone
grease to the boot grooves on the rack ends.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6669
18. Install the boots in the rack end with the tie-rod clips.
NOTE: Install the boot band with the rack in the straight ahead position (right and led tie-rods are
equal in length).
19. Install the boot band so that the locking tabs of the band (stake points) are in the range shown
below. (Tabs should face up and slightly forward.) 20. Bend both sets of locking tabs.
21. Lightly tap on the doubled-over portions to reduce their height.
CAUTION: Stake the band locking tabs firmly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Power Steering > Page 6670
22. Slide the rack right and left to be certain that the boots are not deformed or twisted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications
Steering Wheel: Specifications
Free play 0 to 10 mm
Steering Wheel Nut 49 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6674
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Steering Wheel: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not disassemble the airbags. it has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has been deployed, it
cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag during service, please observe the following precautions.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury.
Store the removed airbag with the pad surface up. Never put any things on the removed airbag.
Keep free from any oil, grease, detergent, or water to prevent damage to the airbag.
Store the removed airbag on a secure, flat surface away from any high heat source (exceeding
200° F / 93° C).
Never perform electrical inspections to the airbags, such as measuring resistance
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6677
Do not position yourself in front of the airbag assembly during removal, inspection, or replacement.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal Procedures (see "Damaged Airbag Special Procedure") for disposing of
the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6678
Steering Wheel: Service Precautions Deployed Air Bag
Put on a pair of shop gloves and safety glasses to protect your hands and eyes from possible
irritation and heat when handling the deployed air bag assembly.
Driver Airbag Assembly
After the air bag assembly has been deployed, the surface of the air bag may contain a powdery
residue. This powder consists primarily of cornstarch (used to lubricate the bag as it inflates) and
by products of the chemical reaction. Sodium hydroxide dust (similar to lye soap) is produced as a
by product of the deployment reaction. The sodium hydroxide then quickly reacts with atmospheric
moisture and is converted to sodium carbonate and sodium bicarbonate (baking soda). Therefore,
it is unlikely that sodium hydroxide will be present after deployment.
Passenger Airbag Assembly
The passenger inflator requires no special precaution after deployment. 95% of the particulate
emission are potassium chloride (KCL), which is commonly sold as an edible salt-substitutes. even
if water is applied. Post deployment products are relatively pH neutral. Disposing the inflator by
burying it in a landfill will not products any hazardous products. As with any dusty environment,
safety goggles, dust mask and gloves should be worn.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6679
Steering Wheel: Service Precautions Undeployed Air Bag
During the course of a vehicle's useful life, certain situations may arise which will necessitate the
disposal of a live (undeployed) air bag assembly. This information covers proper procedures for
disposing of a live air bag assembly. Before a live air bag assembly can be disposed of, it must be
deployed. A live air bag assembly must not be disposed of through normal refuse channels.
Special care is necessary when handling and storing a live (undeployed) air bag assembly. The
rapid gas generation produced during deployment of the air bag could cause the air bag assembly,
or an object in front of the air bag assembly, to be thrown through the air in the unlikely event of an
accidental deployment.
WARNING: FAILURE TO FOLLOW PROPER SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) AIR
BAG ASSEMBLY DISPOSAL PROCEDURES CAN RESULT IN AIR BAG DEPLOYMENT WHICH
MAY CAUSE PERSONAL INJURY. AN UNDEPLOYED AIR BAG ASSEMBLY MUST NOT BE
DISPOSED OF THROUGH NORMAL REFUSE CHANNELS. THE UNDEPLOYED AIR BAG
ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SUBSTANCES THAT CAN CAUSE SEVERE ILLNESS OR PERSONAL
INJURY IF THE SEALED CONTAINER IS DAMAGED DURING DISPOSAL. DISPOSAL IN ANY
MANNER INCONSISTENT WITH PROPER PROCEDURES MAY BE A VIOLATION OF
FEDERAL, STATE, AND / OR LOCAL LAW.
In situations which require deployment of a live air bag assembly, deployment may be
accomplished inside or outside the vehicle. The method employed
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6680
depends upon the final disposition of the particular vehicle, as noted in "Deployment Outside
Vehicle" and "Deployment Inside Vehicle".
WARNING: WHEN CARRYING A LIVE AIR BAG ASSEMBLY, MAKE SURE THE BAG OPENING
IS POINTED AWAY FROM YOU. IN CASE OF AN ACCIDENTAL DEPLOYMENT, THE BAG WILL
THEN DEPLOY WITH MINIMAL CHANCE OF INJURY. NEVER CARRY THE AIR BAG
ASSEMBLY BY THE WIRES OR CONNECTOR ON THE UNDERSIDE OF THE MODULE.
Handling/Installation/Diagnosis
1. Air bag assembly should not be subjected to temperatures above 65° C (150° F). 2. Air bag
assembly, and SDM should not be used if they have been dropped from a height of 100
centimeters (3.28 feet) or more. 3. When a SDM is replaced, it must be oriented with the arrow on
the SDM pointing toward the front of the vehicle. It is very important for the SDM
to be located flat on the mounting surface, parallel to the vehicle datum line. It is important that the
SDM mounting surface is free of any dirt or other foreign material.
4. Do not apply power to the SRS unless all components are connected or a diagnostic chart
requests it, as this will set a diagnostic trouble code. 5. The "SRS Diagnostic System Check" must
be the starting point of any SRS diagnostics. The "SRS Diagnostic System Check" will verify proper
"AIR BAG" warning lamp operation and will lead you to the correct chart to diagnose any SRS
malfunctions. Bypassing these procedures may result in extended diagnostic time, incorrect
diagnosis, and incorrect parts replacements.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 6681
Steering Wheel: Service Precautions Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
NOTE: To avoid misalignment of the steering wheel or airbag on reassembly, make sure the
wheels are turned straight ahead before removing the steering wheel.
Rotate the cable reel clockwise unit it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise (approximately two
and a half turns) until the arrow mark on the cable reel label points straight up.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6682
Steering Wheel: Adjustments
Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
NOTE: To avoid misalignment of the steering wheel or airbag on reassembly, make sure the
wheels are turned straight ahead before removing the steering wheel.
Rotate the cable reel clockwise unit it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise (approximately two
and a half turns) until the arrow mark on the cable reel label points straight up.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair Removal
NOTE: Before removing the steering wheel, align the front wheels straight ahead.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the driver's airbag assembly from the steering wheel. Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts.
2. Disconnect the horn connector and cruise control switches connector.
3. Remove the steering wheel nut. 4. Remove the steering wheel by rocking it slightly from
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
CAUTION: Do not tap on the steering wheel or steering column shaft when installing the steering
wheel.
NOTE: Before installing the steering wheel, align the front wheels straight ahead.
.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 6685
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing the steering wheel, center the cable reel. Do this by first rotating the cable reel
clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it
counterclockwise approximately two turns. The arrow mark on the cable reel label should points
straight up.
2. Install the steering wheel with the steering wheel nut.
NOTE: Be sure the steering wheel shaft engages the cable reel and canceling sleeve.
3. Attach the cruise control switches connector to the steering wheel clip. 4. Connect the horn
connector. 5. Install the driver's airbag assembly, and confirm proper system operation. 6. Check
the horn and cruise control switches for proper operations.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod Boot > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Tie Rod Boot: Service and Repair
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07974-SA50800 Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the boot set ring and the boot.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the boot installation section with grease.
2. Pack the interior of the boot and lip with grease. 3. Wipe the grease off the sliding surface of the
ball pin, then pack the lower area with fresh grease.
CAUTION: Keep grease off the boot installation section and the tapered section of the ball pin.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the boot.
4. Install the boot in the groove of the boot installation section securely, then bleed the air from the
boot. 5. Adjust the special tool with the adjusting bolt until the end of the tool aligns with the groove
on the boot. Slide the set ring over the tool and into
position.
CAUTION: After installing the boot, check the ball pin tapered section for grease contamination and
wipe it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Specifications
Tie Rod End: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Nut .......................................................................................................................................
................................................ 44 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Lower
Ball Joint: Specifications Lower
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Castle Nut ............................................................................................................................................
................................... 49 - 59 Nm (36 - 43 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Lower > Page 6698
Ball Joint: Specifications Upper
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Castle Nut Upper..................................................................................................................................
................................... 39 - 47 Nm (29 - 35 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 6699
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Grasp tire at top and bottom. 3. Shake tire back and forth, check
for any side to side movement in ball joint. 4. Replace ball joint if there is any side to side
movement.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Dust Cover, Wheel Hub
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07GAG-SD40700 Upper Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide
- 07974-SA50700 Lower Ball Boot Clip Guide
1. Remove the set ring and the boot.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the boot installation section with grease.
2. Pack the interior of the boot and lip with grease. 3. Wipe the grease off the sliding surface of the
ball pin and pack with fresh grease.
CAUTION: Keep grease off the boot installation section and the tapered section of the ball pin.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the boot.
4. Install the boot in the groove of the boot installation section securely, then bleed air.
5. Install the upper and lower ball joint boot set rings using the special tools as follows: Lower ball
joint: Adjust the special tool with the adjusting
bolt until the end of the tool aligns with the groove on the boot. Slide the set ring over the tool and
into position.
CAUTION: After installing the boot, check the ball pin tapered section for grease contamination and
wipe it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Page 6702
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Lower Ball Joint
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07974-SA50700 Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide
- 07965-SB00100 Ball Joint Remover/Installer
- 07965-SB00200 Ball Joint Installer Base
1. Remove the knuckle. 2. Remove the boot by prying the set ring off. 3. Check the boot for
deterioration and damage, replace if necessary. 4. Install the special tools on the ball joint and
tighten the castle nut.
5. Position the special tools over the ball joint as shown, then set the assembly in a vise. Press the
ball joint out of the knuckle. 6. Place the ball joint in position by hand.
7. Install the special tools over the ball joint as shown, then press the ball joint in.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Page 6703
8. Install the ball joint boot and set ring using the special tool. 9. Install the knuckle in the reverse
order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Dust Cover, Wheel Hub > Page 6704
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Upper Ball Joint
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07GAG-SD40700 Upper Ball Joint Boot Clip Guide
- 07974-SA50700 Lower Ball Boot Clip Guide
1. Remove the set ring and the boot.
CAUTION: Do not contaminate the boot installation section with grease.
2. Pack the interior of the boot and lip with grease. 3. Wipe the grease off the sliding surface of the
ball pin and pack with fresh grease.
CAUTION: Keep grease off the boot installation section and the tapered section of the ball pin.
- Do not allow dust, dirt, or other foreign materials to enter the boot.
4. Install the boot in the groove of the boot installation section securely, then bleed air.
5. Install the upper and lower ball joint boot set rings using the special tools as follows: Lower ball
joint: Adjust the special tool with the adjusting
bolt until the end of the tool aligns with the groove on the boot. Slide the set ring over the tool and
into position.
CAUTION: After installing the boot, check the ball pin tapered section for grease contamination and
wipe it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair
Upper Control Arms, Rear
1. Remove the upper arm bushing and inner bushing as shown. 2. Mark a scribe line on the upper
arm inner bushing so that it is in line with the bolt mounting surface.
3. Mark on the upper arm at two points so that they are in line and make a right angle with the arm
as shown. 4. Drive in the upper arm inner bushing with the marks aligned.
5. Drive the upper arm bushing into the upper arm.
NOTE: Drive in the upper arm bushing and inner bushing until their leading edges are flush with the
upper arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Description and Operation
Rear Cross-Member: Description and Operation
Description
The rear floor cross-member position is critical for rear wheel alignment. During replacement,
check the position of the rear beam and the rear damper base, and position the rear floor
cross-member properly. Weld securely following the welder manufacturer's instructions to maintain
rigidity. Use of the positioning jig is recommended.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications
Front Steering Knuckle: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Knuckle to
Upper Arm ...........................................................................................................................................
................................ 39-47 Nm (29-35 ft. lbs.) Lower Arm ..................................................................
......................................................................................................... 49-59 Nm (36-43 ft. lbs.)
Splash Guard .......................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4.9 Nm (3.6 ft. lbs.) Caliper Mounting Bolts .........................................
............................................................................................................................. 108 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6716
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6717
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly. 2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in
the proper locations.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6718
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6719
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6720
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6721
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6722
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6723
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6724
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation
Front Strut / Shock Tower: Description and Operation
Description
The front wheelhouse component is constructed as a unit with the front damper housing.
Therefore, replacement of the component affects the front wheel alignment. When assembling it,
either use a positioning jig or follow dimensions on the frame repair chart for positioning. Weld
carefully.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6729
Front Strut / Shock Tower: Service and Repair
Replacement
1. Remove the related parts.
- Parts to be removed when removing the front bulkhead
- Parts on passenger side of lower dashboard which are especially flammable
- Electrical accessories in engine compartment and wire harnesses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6730
2. Pull out and straighten the damaged area to approximately the original shape.
- Attach the car to the frame straightener by tightening the underbody clamps at the horizontal
pinch weld points.
- Before cutting off the damaged sections, pull them out so that they are restored to the original
shape.
- Do not pull out more than necessary.
- Pull out and straighten the damaged area of the lower dashboard, front pillar, and other parts.
- After pulling, check the damper housing position using the body dimensional drawings and
positioning jig.
NOTE: Check the condition of the door and hinges.
3. Peel off the undercoat.
Heat the undercoat at the weld areas of the wheelhouse and front side frame with a gas torch, and
peel off the undercoat with a metal spatula.
CAUTION: Be careful not to burn the fittings inside the passenger compartment and dashboard
insulator when heating.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6731
4. When replacing the front wheelhouse.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints on the front side frame and damper housing.
- Drill holes in the center punched areas using a spot cutter.
- Using a chisel, pry off the welded flange.
- Level and finish the burrs on the welding surfaces with a sander.
5. When replacing the damper housing and front wheelhouse as an assembly.
-1 Remove the wheelhouse upper member.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints.
- Use the special spot cutter to drill holes at the spot weld nuggets.
- Remove the MIG weld flange with a disc sander.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding.
- Using a chisel, pry off the welded flange from the front pillar and damper housing.
NOTE: Remove the wheelhouse upper member carefully so they can be reused.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6732
-2 Using a spot cutter, drill holes in the spot welded area on the front side frame and dashboard
upper side member.
-3 From the passenger compartment side, drill holes in the spot welded area with as mm (0.2 in).
NOTE: Drill holes completely through the parts since the replacement damper housing will be
welded by MIG welding.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6733
6. Mold the related parts.
- Level and finish the burrs left on the welding surfaces with a sander.
- Fill all drilled holes by MIG or gas welding.
- Use a hammer and dolly to even out the welded areas of the lower dashboard, front side frame
and dashboard upper side member.
7. Set the new front wheelhouse and damper housing.
- Apply body paint to both sides of the new front wheelhouse and damper housing.
- See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Remove the undercoat from both sides of the welding section and expose the steel plate using a
disc sander
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding
- Clamp to the front side frame with vise-grips and squill vises.
NOTE: Apply the spot sealer to the welding surface when spot welding.
- Clamp the front bulkhead with vise-grips.
- Measure the front compartment diagonally.
NOTE: Use of a positioning jig is recommended.
- Spot weld several points in the clamped sections, and temporarily attach the front wheelhouse
and damper housing
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6734
8. Check the dimensions, temporarily install the hood, front fender and headlight, and check for
differences in level and clearance.
- Check the engine and transmission mount brackets position.
9. Perform the main welding.
- Weld as much as possible with the jig still mounted.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
- Make 20% to 30% more spot welds than there were holes drilled.
- Plug weld the holes areas of the dashboard lower and damper housing with a MIG welder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower >
System Information > Description and Operation > Page 6735
10. Weld the wheelhouse upper member.
When the upper member is to be reused, make MIG welds at the drilled holes.
11. Finish the welded area.
Use a hammer and dolly to even out the side bulkhead and front side frame flanges for close fit
with the surface of the front wheelhouse and damper housing.
12. Apply the sealer.
Apply sealer to the mating surfaces of the lower dashboard and front side frame, etc.
13. Apply the paint.
See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
14. Apply the undercoat.
Undercoat the front floor, etc, and apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the welding section of the
front side frame, lower dashboard, and upper member.
15. Install the related parts.
Install in the reverse order in which they were removed.
16. Inspect, check and make adjustment.
- Measure the front wheel alignment.
- Inspect the brake system.
- Adjust the headlight aim.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Subframe > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Sub-frame Torque Sequence
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair Front Coil Spring
TOOL REQUIRED
- Spring Strut Compressor
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front wheels.
2. Remove the damper pinch bolt from the top of damper fork. 3. Remove the damper fork bolt and
self-locking nut from the bottom of the damper fork, then remove damper fork.
4. Remove the damper by removing the two nuts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6743
5. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the nut.
6. Release the pressure from the spring compressor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
2. Assemble the damper in reverse order of removal except the damper mounting washer and self
locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring. 5. Install the damper mounting rubber, damper mounting washer and a new 10 mm
self-locking nut.
6. Hold the damper shaft and tighten the 10 mm self-locking nut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6744
7. Loosely install the damper on the frame with the aligning tab facing inside, then loosely install
the two flange nuts.
8. Install the damper fork over the driveshaft and onto the lower arm. Install the front damper in the
damper fork so the aligning tab is aligned with
the slot in the damper fork.
9. Loosely install the damper pinch bolt on the top of the damper fork.
10. Loosely install the damper fork bolt and a new self-locking nut on the bottom of the damper
fork. 11. Raise the knuckle with a floor jack until the vehicle just lifts off the safety stand. The floor
jack must be securely positioned or personal injury may
result.
12. Tighten the damper pinch bolt. 13. Tighten the damper fork bolt and self-locking nut. 14.
Tighten the flange nuts on top of the damper. 15. Install the brake hose mounts with the brake hose
mounting bolts. 16. Install the front wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6745
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair Rear Coil Spring
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear wheels. 2. Remove the speaker cover and speaker (Hatchback) Sedan and
Coupe: Remove the trunk side pane.
3. Remove the two flange nuts.
4. Remove the flange bolt from the damper. 5. Remove the flange bolt that connects the lower arm
to the trailing arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6746
6. Lower the rear suspension, and remove the damper.
7. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the self-locking nut.
8. Release the pressure from the spring compressor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6747
INSTALLATION
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
NOTE: Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
2. Assemble the rear damper in reverse order of disassembly except the damper mounting washer
and self-locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6748
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring with the spring compressor. 5. Install the damper mounting washer, and loosely install a new
self-locking nut.
6. Hold the damper shaft with a hex wrench and tighten the self-locking nut.
7. Lower the rear suspension, and position the damper with the spring stop pointed toward the left
side of the vehicle.
8. Loosely install the two flange nuts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Coil Spring > Page 6749
9. Loosely install the flange bolt.
10. Raise the rear suspension with a floor jack until the vehicle just lifts off the safety stand.
WARNING: The floor jack must be securely positioned or personal injury may result.
11. Tighten the flange bolt. 12. Tighten the two flange nuts on top of the damper to the specified
torque. 13. Check the rear wheel alignment and adjust if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Specifications > Strut
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Specifications Strut
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Upper Bolt ............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) Lower Bolt .............................................................
............................................................................................................................... 64 Nm (47 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Specifications > Strut > Page 6754
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Specifications Shock
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Upper Self-Locking Nut .......................................................................................................................
................................................ 29 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Upper Flange Nut ..................................................
............................................................................................................................... 49 Nm (36 ft. lbs.)
Rear Lower Bolt ...................................................................................................................................
................................................ 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6755
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Application and ID
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............... Telescopic, Hydraulic Nitrogen Gas Filled
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Removal and Replacement Strut
Front Strut
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front wheels.
2. Remove the damper pinch bolt from the top of damper fork. 3. Remove the damper fork bolt and
self-locking nut from the bottom of the damper fork, then remove damper fork.
4. Remove the damper by removing the two nuts.
DISASSEMBLE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6758
1. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the nut.
2. Release the pressure from the spring compressor, then disassemble the damper as shown in
the next column.
INSPECTION
1. Reassemble all parts, except the spring.
2. Push on the damper assembly as shown. 3. Check for smooth operation through a full stroke,
both compression and extension.
NOTE: The damper should move smoothly. If it does not (no compression or no extension), the gas
is leaking, and the damper should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6759
4. Check for oil leaks, abnormal noises or binding during these tests.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
2. Assemble the damper in reverse order of removal except the damper mounting washer and self
locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6760
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring. 5. Install the damper mounting rubber, damper mounting washer and a new 10 mm
self-locking nut.
6. Hold the damper shaft and tighten the 10 mm self-locking nut.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install the damper on the frame with the aligning tab facing inside, then loosely install
the two flange nuts.
2. Install the damper fork over the driveshaft and onto the lower arm. Install the front damper in the
damper fork so the aligning tab is aligned with
the slot in the damper fork.
3. Loosely install the damper pinch bolt on the top of the damper fork. 4. Loosely install the damper
fork bolt and a new self-locking nut on the bottom of the damper fork. 5. Raise the knuckle with a
floor jack until the vehicle just lifts off the safety stand. The floor jack must be securely positioned or
personal injury may
result.
6. Tighten the damper pinch bolt. 7. Tighten the damper fork bolt and self-locking nut. 8. Tighten
the flange nuts on top of the damper. 9. Install the brake hose mounts with the brake hose
mounting bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6761
10. Install the front wheel.
Rear Strut
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear wheels. 2. Remove the speaker cover and speaker (Hatchback) Sedan and
Coupe: Remove the trunk side pane.
3. Remove the two flange nuts.
4. Remove the flange bolt from the damper. 5. Remove the flange bolt that connects the lower arm
to the trailing arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6762
6. Lower the rear suspension, and remove the damper.
DISASSEMBLE
1. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the self-locking nut.
2. Release the pressure from the spring compressor, then disassemble.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6763
INSPECTION
1. Reassemble all parts, except the spring.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6764
2. Push on the damper as shown. 3. Check for smooth operation through a full stroke, both
compression and extension.
NOTE: The damper should move smoothly. If it does not (no compression or no extension), the gas
is leaking, and the damper should be replaced.
4. Check for oil leaks, abnormal noises and binding during these tests.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
NOTE: Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
2. Assemble the rear damper in reverse order of disassembly except the damper mounting washer
and self-locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring with the spring compressor. 5. Install the damper mounting washer, and loosely install a new
self-locking nut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6765
6. Hold the damper shaft with a hex wrench and tighten the self-locking nut.
INSTALLATION
1. Lower the rear suspension, and position the damper with the spring stop pointed toward the left
side of the vehicle.
2. Loosely install the two flange nuts.
3. Loosely install the flange bolt. 4. Raise the rear suspension with a floor jack until the vehicle just
lifts off the safety stand.
WARNING: The floor jack must be securely positioned or personal injury may result.
5. Tighten the flange bolt. 6. Tighten the two flange nuts on top of the damper to the specified
torque. 7. Check the rear wheel alignment and adjust if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6766
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Removal and Replacement Shock
Front Shock
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front wheels.
2. Remove the damper pinch bolt from the top of damper fork. 3. Remove the damper fork bolt and
self-locking nut from the bottom of the damper fork, then remove damper fork.
4. Remove the damper by removing the two nuts.
DISASSEMBLE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6767
1. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the nut.
2. Release the pressure from the spring compressor, then disassemble the damper as shown in
the next column.
INSPECTION
1. Reassemble all parts, except the spring.
2. Push on the damper assembly as shown. 3. Check for smooth operation through a full stroke,
both compression and extension.
NOTE: The damper should move smoothly. If it does not (no compression or no extension), the gas
is leaking, and the damper should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6768
4. Check for oil leaks, abnormal noises or binding during these tests.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
2. Assemble the damper in reverse order of removal except the damper mounting washer and self
locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6769
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring. 5. Install the damper mounting rubber, damper mounting washer and a new 10 mm
self-locking nut.
6. Hold the damper shaft and tighten the 10 mm self-locking nut.
INSTALLATION
1. Loosely install the damper on the frame with the aligning tab facing inside, then loosely install
the two flange nuts.
2. Install the damper fork over the driveshaft and onto the lower arm. Install the front damper in the
damper fork so the aligning tab is aligned with
the slot in the damper fork.
3. Loosely install the damper pinch bolt on the top of the damper fork. 4. Loosely install the damper
fork bolt and a new self-locking nut on the bottom of the damper fork. 5. Raise the knuckle with a
floor jack until the vehicle just lifts off the safety stand. The floor jack must be securely positioned or
personal injury may
result.
6. Tighten the damper pinch bolt. 7. Tighten the damper fork bolt and self-locking nut. 8. Tighten
the flange nuts on top of the damper. 9. Install the brake hose mounts with the brake hose
mounting bolts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6770
10. Install the front wheel.
Rear Shock
REMOVAL
1. Remove the rear wheels. 2. Remove the speaker cover and speaker (Hatchback) Sedan and
Coupe: Remove the trunk side pane.
3. Remove the two flange nuts.
4. Remove the flange bolt from the damper. 5. Remove the flange bolt that connects the lower arm
to the trailing arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6771
6. Lower the rear suspension, and remove the damper.
DISASSEMBLE
1. Compress the damper spring with the spring compressor according to the manufacturer's
instructions, then remove the self-locking nut.
CAUTION: Do not compress the spring more than necessary to remove the self-locking nut.
2. Release the pressure from the spring compressor, then disassemble.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6772
INSPECTION
1. Reassemble all parts, except the spring.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6773
2. Push on the damper as shown. 3. Check for smooth operation through a full stroke, both
compression and extension.
NOTE: The damper should move smoothly. If it does not (no compression or no extension), the gas
is leaking, and the damper should be replaced.
4. Check for oil leaks, abnormal noises and binding during these tests.
ASSEMBLE
1. Install the damper unit on a spring compressor.
NOTE: Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
2. Assemble the rear damper in reverse order of disassembly except the damper mounting washer
and self-locking nut.
NOTE: Align the bottom of damper spring and spring lower seat as shown.
3. Position the damper mounting base on the damper unit as shown. 4. Compress the damper
spring with the spring compressor. 5. Install the damper mounting washer, and loosely install a new
self-locking nut.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement Strut > Page 6774
6. Hold the damper shaft with a hex wrench and tighten the self-locking nut.
INSTALLATION
1. Lower the rear suspension, and position the damper with the spring stop pointed toward the left
side of the vehicle.
2. Loosely install the two flange nuts.
3. Loosely install the flange bolt. 4. Raise the rear suspension with a floor jack until the vehicle just
lifts off the safety stand.
WARNING: The floor jack must be securely positioned or personal injury may result.
5. Tighten the flange bolt. 6. Tighten the two flange nuts on top of the damper to the specified
torque. 7. Check the rear wheel alignment and adjust if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 > Suspension Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps
Trailing Arm Bushing: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps
00-006
March 31, 2006
Applies To: *1988-00 Civic - ALL 1997-01 CR-V-ALL 1993-97 Del Sol - ALL*
Clunk or Squeak From Rear Suspension
(Supersedes 00-006, dated December 11, 2001, to update the information marked by the black
bars and asterisks)
SYMPTOM
A clunk or squeak from the rear suspension when going over rough or bumpy roads.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Broken rear trailing arm bushing(s).
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the rear trailing arm bushing(s).
PARTS INFORMATION
*Rear Trailing Arm Bushing:
1988-00 Civic and 1993-97 Del Sol
P/N 52385-SR3-000, H/C 4098299
1997-01 CR-V:
P/N 52385-SR3-003, H/C 7424773
TOOL INFORMATION
Trailing Arm Bushing Installation Set:
T/N 07AAF-SK7A130, H/C 8283822
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: 1988-00 Civic and 1993-97 Del Sol:
P/N 52385-SR3-000 H/C 4098299
1997-01 CR-V:
P/N 52385-SR3-003 H/C 7424773
Defect Code: 01801
Symptom Code: 04205*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 > Suspension Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps > Page 6784
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
*NOTE:
ISIS online service manual information is only available for vehicles 1990 and newer.
1. Remove the rear trailing arm:
^ Refer to the suspension section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword REAR SUSPENSION, then select Suspension Arms Replacement from
the list.*
2. Mark the trailing arm at the arrow on the bottom of the bushing.
3. Place the arm on a hydraulic press, supported by the hub base, with the spindle facing up.
4. With the hub driver, press the old bushing out of the trailing arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 > Suspension Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps > Page 6785
5. Install the new bushing with the short end toward the outside of the vehicle. Align the arrow with
the mark you made on the trailing arm.
6. Press the new bushing into the trailing arm until its edge is 10 to 12 mm above the surface of the
arm.
7. Reinstall the trailing arm.
8. If necessary, repeat steps 1 thru 7 to install a new bushing in the other rear trailing arm.
9. Bleed the brake system:
* ^ Refer to the brakes section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword BLEED, then select Brake System Bleeding from the list.
10. Check the wheel alignment, and adjust it if needed:
^ Refer to the suspension section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword WHEEL ALIGNMENT, then select Wheel Alignment - Rear Toe
Inspection/Adjustment from the list.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps
Trailing Arm Bushing: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak
On Bumps
00-006
March 31, 2006
Applies To: *1988-00 Civic - ALL 1997-01 CR-V-ALL 1993-97 Del Sol - ALL*
Clunk or Squeak From Rear Suspension
(Supersedes 00-006, dated December 11, 2001, to update the information marked by the black
bars and asterisks)
SYMPTOM
A clunk or squeak from the rear suspension when going over rough or bumpy roads.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Broken rear trailing arm bushing(s).
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the rear trailing arm bushing(s).
PARTS INFORMATION
*Rear Trailing Arm Bushing:
1988-00 Civic and 1993-97 Del Sol
P/N 52385-SR3-000, H/C 4098299
1997-01 CR-V:
P/N 52385-SR3-003, H/C 7424773
TOOL INFORMATION
Trailing Arm Bushing Installation Set:
T/N 07AAF-SK7A130, H/C 8283822
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed Part: 1988-00 Civic and 1993-97 Del Sol:
P/N 52385-SR3-000 H/C 4098299
1997-01 CR-V:
P/N 52385-SR3-003 H/C 7424773
Defect Code: 01801
Symptom Code: 04205*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps > Page 6791
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Parts and Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request
consideration, and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
*NOTE:
ISIS online service manual information is only available for vehicles 1990 and newer.
1. Remove the rear trailing arm:
^ Refer to the suspension section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword REAR SUSPENSION, then select Suspension Arms Replacement from
the list.*
2. Mark the trailing arm at the arrow on the bottom of the bushing.
3. Place the arm on a hydraulic press, supported by the hub base, with the spindle facing up.
4. With the hub driver, press the old bushing out of the trailing arm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Trailing Arm Bushing > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Trailing Arm Bushing: > 00-006 > Mar > 06 >
Suspension - Rear Suspension Clunk/Squeak On Bumps > Page 6792
5. Install the new bushing with the short end toward the outside of the vehicle. Align the arrow with
the mark you made on the trailing arm.
6. Press the new bushing into the trailing arm until its edge is 10 to 12 mm above the surface of the
arm.
7. Reinstall the trailing arm.
8. If necessary, repeat steps 1 thru 7 to install a new bushing in the other rear trailing arm.
9. Bleed the brake system:
* ^ Refer to the brakes section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword BLEED, then select Brake System Bleeding from the list.
10. Check the wheel alignment, and adjust it if needed:
^ Refer to the suspension section of the appropriate service manual, or
^ Online, enter keyword WHEEL ALIGNMENT, then select Wheel Alignment - Rear Toe
Inspection/Adjustment from the list.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications End Play
End Play
End Play Front 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Rear 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6796
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Remove the wheels, then reinstall the wheel nuts. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown.
4. Measure the bearing end play by moving the disc in or outward. Front/Rear: Standard: 0 - 0.05
mm (0 - 0.002 inch) 5. If the bearing end play measurement is more than the standard, replace the
wheel bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6797
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Wheel bearings and hub on these models are an integral assembly and bearings cannot be
adjusted. If hub endplay exceeds 0.002 inch with spindle nut properly tightened, hub and bearing
assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint remover, 28 mm
- 07JAF-SH20110 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Pilot, 38 mm
- 07JAF-SH20120 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Shaft, 22.4 x 25.4 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm
- 07GAF-SE00401 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Base
- 07947-6340201 Driver Attachment 58 x 72 mm
- 07965-SD90100 Support Base
- 07GAF-SE00200 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Guide Attachment
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6800
2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6801
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6802
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6803
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6804
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6805
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6806
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6807
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
The rear bearing is to be serviced with the wheel wheel hub as one unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information
06-082
December 15, 2006
Applies To: ALL
Tubeless Tire Repair Information
This service bulletin provides the resource information required to repair tubeless tires on Honda
automobiles and light trucks.
To properly repair a tire, follow the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) "Puncture Repair
Procedures for Passenger and Light Truck Tires" outlined on the RMA wall poster. One wall poster
has been provided to your dealership. Additional posters can be ordered through Helm, the RMA
website, www.rma.org, or the tire manufacturers.
Michelin(R) PAX System(TM), tires can be repaired using the same repair procedures described on
the RMA poster. Whenever you repair a PAX System tire, you must inspect the support ring. Refer
to the PAX System support ring section of this service bulletin for inspection procedures.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Refer to the tire manufacturer for warranty information.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
^ 1/8 inch Patch-plug with lead wire
^ 1/4 inch Patch-plug with lead wire
^ 1/8 inch Plugs (stem)*
^ 1/4 inch Plugs (stem)*
^ 1/4 inch Patches*
^ 3/4 inch Patches*
^ Chemical cement
^ Liquid buffer
^ Rim-bead sealer
^ Inner liner sealer
REQUIRED TOOLS
^ Tire stitcher, 1-1/2 inch wheel
^ Tire crayons
^ Tire test tank
^ Awl or probe
^ Flexible blade skiving knife
^ 1/8 inch Carbide tire tool with adapter
^ 1/4 inch Carbide tire tool with adapter
^ Low speed buffer with quick release chuck and exhaust hose
^ Carbide buffing wheel with adapter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Tires - Tubless Tire Repair Information > Page 6817
^ Reversible drill motor (800 RPM MAX)
^ Tire spreader
^ Inspection lamp
* For repairable injuries that exceed 25 degrees
TIRE REPAIR GUIDELINES
Never repair tires worn below 2/32 inch of tread.
Never repair a tire without removing the tire from the wheel for internal inspection.
Never repair a tire with a tread injury larger than 1/4 inch (6 mm).
Never use only a plug (stem) or a patch only to repair a tire injury.
NOTE:
If the angle of the tire injury exceeds 25 degrees, you must use the two-piece repair system as
recommended by the RMA.
MICHELIN PAX SYSTEM SUPPORT RING INSPECTION
PAX System support rings are not repairable, under any circumstances, but they can be reused if
no damage is found during a thorough inspection. If a PAX System tire ran flat or underinflated,
dismount the tire from the wheel and inspect the wheel, tire, and support ring for damage. Refer to
the Michelin PAX Support Rings Technical Bulletin in ISIS. Enter SEARCH BY PUBLICATION,
select Job Aids, then select Michelin PAX Support Rings Technical Bulletin from the list.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information
Tires: Technician Safety Information
WARNING: This vehicle has a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). Refer to the SRS
component and wiring location view in order to determine whether you are performing service on or
near the SRS components or the SRS wiring. when you are performing service on or near the SRS
components or the SRS wiring, refer to the SRS service information. failure to follow warnings
could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded SRS system
repairs.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Technician Safety Information > Page 6820
Tires: Vehicle Damage Warnings
CAUTION: Always use the correct fastener in the proper location. When you replace a fastener,
use ONLY the exact part number for that application. Honda will call out those fasteners that
require a replacement after removal. Honda will also call out the fasteners that require thread
lockers or thread sealant. Unless otherwise specified, do not use supplemental coatings (Paints,
greases, or other corrosion inhibitors) on threaded fasteners or fastener joint interfaces. Generally,
such coatings adversely affect the fastener torque and the joint clamping force, and may damage
the fastener. When you install fasteners, use the correct tightening sequence and specifications.
Following these instructions can help you avoid damage to parts and systems.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 6821
Tires: Description and Operation
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Replacement wheels or tires must be equivalent to the originals in load capacity, specified
dimension and mounting configuration. Improper size or type may affect bearing life, brake
performance, speedometer/odometer calibration, vehicle ground clearance and tire clearance to
the body and chassis. All model are equipped with metric sized tubeless steel belted radial tires.
Correct tire pressures and driving habits have an important influence on tire life. Heavy cornering,
excessively rapid acceleration and unnecessary sharp braking increase premature and uneven
wear.
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
The original equipment tires have built-in tread wear indicators (1) to show when tires need
replacement. These indicators may appear as wide bands. When the indicators appear in two or
more grooves at three locations, tire replacement is recommended.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
Tires: Testing and Inspection Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
TYPICAL EXAMPLES OF ABNORMAL TIRE AHEAD WEAR AND MAJOR CAUSES:
CAUTION: Similar wear patterns can be caused by worn suspension parts, misalignment of wheels
and tires, and other suspension related problems.
Spotty Wear
Wear localized on shoulder sections, and in an extreme cases, the tire becomes polygonal in
shape. 1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Hub or knuckle out of round or distorted. 3. Play
in hub bearings or ball joint. 4. Rotating parts out of balance.
Tread Wear One-Sided
1. Rotating parts out of balance. 2. Tire or wheel out of round. 3. Hub or knuckle out of round or
distorted.
Localized Tread Wear
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6824
1. Once spotty wear develops in tread due to hard braking or abrupt starting, localized wear tends
to be promoted.
Shoulder Wear (Generally Wear Develops In Outer Shoulder):
1. Camber or toe-in incorrect. 2. Shoulder wear caused by repeated hard-cornering.
Wear In Shoulders At Points Opposed To Each Other
1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Play in bearings or ball joint.
Premature Wear In Shoulders
1. Flexing of tire excessive due to under-inflation.
One Sided Feather Edging
1. Wear caused by repeated hard cornering. 2. Camber or toe-in incorrect.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6825
Tires: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis By Symptom
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6826
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6827
Tires: Testing and Inspection Diagnosis List
If the following conditions are noted, rotation is required.
1. Front tire wear is different from rear. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3. Left
and right front tire wear is unequal. 4. Left and right rear tire wear is unequal.
If the following conditions are noted, check the wheel alignment.
1. Left and right front tire wear is unequal. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3.
Front tire treads have scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of tread ribs or blocks.
4. There is cupping, flat spotting etc.
Higher than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Hard ride. 2. Poor steering stability. 3. Rapid and uneven wear at center of the tread.
Lower than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Tire squeal on turns. 2. Hard steering. 3. Rapid and uneven wear on the edges of the tread. 4.
Tire rim bruises and rupture. 5. Tire cord breakage. 6. High tire temperatures. 7. Reduced handling.
8. Reduced fuel economy.
Unequal pressure on same axle can cause:
1. Uneven braking. 2. Steering lead. 3. Reduced handling. 4. Swerve on acceleration.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6828
Tires: Testing and Inspection Irregular and Premature Wear
Irregular and/or premature wear has many causes. Some of them are incorrect inflation pressures,
lack of tire rotation, poor driving habits or improper wheel alignment. Incorrect inflation is common
cause of tire premature wear.
NOTE: Due to their design, radial tires tend to wear faster in the shoulder area, particularly on the
front tires. This makes regular rotation especially necessary. After rotation, be sure to check wheel
nut torque, and set tire pressures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6829
Tires: Testing and Inspection
Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes
TYPICAL EXAMPLES OF ABNORMAL TIRE AHEAD WEAR AND MAJOR CAUSES:
CAUTION: Similar wear patterns can be caused by worn suspension parts, misalignment of wheels
and tires, and other suspension related problems.
Spotty Wear
Wear localized on shoulder sections, and in an extreme cases, the tire becomes polygonal in
shape. 1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Hub or knuckle out of round or distorted. 3. Play
in hub bearings or ball joint. 4. Rotating parts out of balance.
Tread Wear One-Sided
1. Rotating parts out of balance. 2. Tire or wheel out of round. 3. Hub or knuckle out of round or
distorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6830
Localized Tread Wear
1. Once spotty wear develops in tread due to hard braking or abrupt starting, localized wear tends
to be promoted.
Shoulder Wear (Generally Wear Develops In Outer Shoulder):
1. Camber or toe-in incorrect. 2. Shoulder wear caused by repeated hard-cornering.
Wear In Shoulders At Points Opposed To Each Other
1. Tire or wheel out of round or distorted. 2. Play in bearings or ball joint.
Premature Wear In Shoulders
1. Flexing of tire excessive due to under-inflation.
One Sided Feather Edging
1. Wear caused by repeated hard cornering. 2. Camber or toe-in incorrect.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6831
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6832
Part 2 Of 2
Diagnosis List
If the following conditions are noted, rotation is required.
1. Front tire wear is different from rear. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3. Left
and right front tire wear is unequal. 4. Left and right rear tire wear is unequal.
If the following conditions are noted, check the wheel alignment.
1. Left and right front tire wear is unequal. 2. Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire. 3.
Front tire treads have scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of tread ribs or blocks.
4. There is cupping, flat spotting etc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6833
Higher than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Hard ride. 2. Poor steering stability. 3. Rapid and uneven wear at center of the tread.
Lower than recommended pressure can cause:
1. Tire squeal on turns. 2. Hard steering. 3. Rapid and uneven wear on the edges of the tread. 4.
Tire rim bruises and rupture. 5. Tire cord breakage. 6. High tire temperatures. 7. Reduced handling.
8. Reduced fuel economy.
Unequal pressure on same axle can cause:
1. Uneven braking. 2. Steering lead. 3. Reduced handling. 4. Swerve on acceleration.
Irregular and Premature Wear
Irregular and/or premature wear has many causes. Some of them are incorrect inflation pressures,
lack of tire rotation, poor driving habits or improper wheel alignment. Incorrect inflation is common
cause of tire premature wear.
NOTE: Due to their design, radial tires tend to wear faster in the shoulder area, particularly on the
front tires. This makes regular rotation especially necessary. After rotation, be sure to check wheel
nut torque, and set tire pressures.
Radial Tire Lead/Pull
"Lead/Pull" is vehicle deviation from a straight path, on a level road with no pressure on the
steering wheel. Lead is usually caused by:
1. Poorly manufactured radial tires. 2. Uneven brake adjustment. 3. Wheel alignment.
The way in which a tire is built can produce lead in a car. An example of this is placement of the
belt. Off-center belts on radial tires can cause the tire to develop a side force while rolling straight
down the road and the tire will tend to roll like a cone. The "Radial Tire Lead/Pull Correction" chart
should be used to make sure that front wheel alignment is not mistaken for tire lead. Rear tires will
not cause lead/pull.
Radial Tire Waddle
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Abnormal Tire Ahead Wear and Major Causes > Page 6834
Waddle is side-to-side movement at the front and/or rear of the car. It can be caused by the steel
belt not being straight within the tire, or by excessive lateral runout of the tire or wheel. It is most
noticeable at low speed, about 8 to 48 km/h (5 to 30 mph). It may also cause rough ride at 80 to
113 km/h (50 to 70 mph). The car can be road tested to see which end of the car has the faulty tire.
If the tire causing the waddle is on the rear, the rear end of the car will "waddle". From the driver's
seat, it feels as if someone is pushing on the side of the car. If the faulty tire is on the front, the
waddle is more easily seen. The front sheet metal appears to be moving back and forth. It feels as
if the driver's seat is the pivot point in the car. Another more time-consuming method of determining
the faulty tire is substituting tire and wheel assemblies that are known to be good. Follow these
steps:
1. Drive the car to determine if the waddle is coming from the front or rear. 2. Install tire and wheel
assemblies known to be good (from a similar car) in place of those on the end of the car which is
waddling. If the waddle
cannot be isolated to front or rear, start with the rear tires.
3. Road test again. If improvement is noted, install the original tire and wheel assemblies one at a
time until the faulty tire is found. If no
improvement is noted, install tires known to be good in place of all four. Then, install the originals
one at a time until the faulty tire is found.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Tires: Service and Repair Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Use a tire changing machine to demount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone to remove
the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or wheel rim could result. Follow the tire changing
machine manufacturer's instructions to properly separate the tire from the wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6837
Tires: Service and Repair Mounting the Tire on the Wheel
CAUTION: Recommended vehicle tire mounting and inflation procedures are especially important
with radial tires. Failure to follow these procedures can cause bead deformation in both tube type
and tubeless tires due to incorrect bead seating. Bead deformation may lead to chafing, lower
sidewall and bead area cracking, eccentric wear, ride vibration and nonretreadable casings. Only
use rims approved for radial tire usage by the rim manufacture.
1. Clean the rim. Remove all rust and other foreign material. 2. Lubricate tire beads and rim bead
seats with an approved rubber lubricant.
CAUTION: Do not use silicon base lubricants. This could cause the tire to slip on the wheel.
3. Attach the tire to the wheel.
a. Use a tire changing machine.
b. Align air valve and tire balancing match marks (about 8 mm diameter paint mark). Hold in this
position and inflate the until the tire beads are
firmly seated on the rim against the flanges (steel wheel model only).
4. Inflate the tire to operating pressure. 5. Check the bead seating.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6838
Tires: Service and Repair Balancing
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance:
a. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically
unbalanced cause a bouncing action called
tramp. This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear.
b. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that
when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
NOTE: Using wheel balancing equipment. Follow the tire balancing machine manufacturer's
instructions to properly balance wheel and tire. Balance weight for the wheel should not exceed
170 g in total, and 140 g is the maximum amount for either side.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6839
Tires: Service and Repair Tire Rotation
Tire rotation is recommended to equalize wear for longer life. If the following conditions are noted,
rotate the tires:
- Front tire wear is different from rear.
- Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire.
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Left and right rear tire wear is unequal. Check wheel alignment if the following conditions are
noted:
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Wear is uneven across the tread of any front tire.
- Front tire treads have a scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of the tread ribs or
blocks.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6840
Tires: Service and Repair
Separating the Tire From the Wheel
Use a tire changing machine to demount tires. Do not use hand tools or tire irons alone to remove
the tire from the wheel. Damage to the tire beads or wheel rim could result. Follow the tire changing
machine manufacturer's instructions to properly separate the tire from the wheel.
Mounting the Tire on the Wheel
CAUTION: Recommended vehicle tire mounting and inflation procedures are especially important
with radial tires. Failure to follow these procedures can cause bead deformation in both tube type
and tubeless tires due to incorrect bead seating. Bead deformation may lead to chafing, lower
sidewall and bead area cracking, eccentric wear, ride vibration and nonretreadable casings. Only
use rims approved for radial tire usage by the rim manufacture.
1. Clean the rim. Remove all rust and other foreign material. 2. Lubricate tire beads and rim bead
seats with an approved rubber lubricant.
CAUTION: Do not use silicon base lubricants. This could cause the tire to slip on the wheel.
3. Attach the tire to the wheel.
a. Use a tire changing machine.
b. Align air valve and tire balancing match marks (about 8 mm diameter paint mark). Hold in this
position and inflate the until the tire beads are
firmly seated on the rim against the flanges (steel wheel model only).
4. Inflate the tire to operating pressure. 5. Check the bead seating.
Balancing
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6841
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance:
a. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically
unbalanced cause a bouncing action called
tramp. This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear.
b. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that
when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
NOTE: Using wheel balancing equipment. Follow the tire balancing machine manufacturer's
instructions to properly balance wheel and tire. Balance weight for the wheel should not exceed
170 g in total, and 140 g is the maximum amount for either side.
Tire Rotation
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6842
Tire rotation is recommended to equalize wear for longer life. If the following conditions are noted,
rotate the tires:
- Front tire wear is different from rear.
- Uneven wear exists across the tread of any tire.
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Left and right rear tire wear is unequal. Check wheel alignment if the following conditions are
noted:
- Left and right front tire wear is unequal.
- Wear is uneven across the tread of any front tire.
- Front tire treads have a scuffed appearance with "feather" edges on one side of the tread ribs or
blocks.
Inflation of Tires
Tire pressure, in cold condition (after vehicle has set for three hours or more, and driven less than
one mile) should be checked monthly or before any extended trip. Tire pressure increases
approximately 15% when the tires become hot during driving. Tire pressure specification is shown
on the label located on the left door lock pillar.
NOTE: Check the tire pressure whenever irregular wear is found. Tire inflation greatly affects tire
wear. If the alignment check does not reveal any alignment problems, check the condition of the
shock absorbers and wheel/tire balance.
Tire Replacement
TIRE REPLACEMENT
When replacement is necessary, the original metric the size should be used. Most metric tire sizes
do not have exact corresponding alphanumeric tire sizes. It is recommended that new tires be
installed in pairs on the same axle. If necessary to replace only one tire, it should be paired with tire
having the most tread, to equalize braking traction.
CAUTION: Do not mix different types of tires such as radial, bias and bias-belted tires except in
emergencies, because vehicle handling may be seriously affected and may result in loss of control.
Tire Dismounting
Remove valve cap on valve step and deflate the tire. Then use a tire changing machine to mount or
dismount tires. Follow the equipment manufacturer's instruction. Do not use hand tools or tire lever
alone to change tires as they may damage the tire beads or wheel rim.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6843
Tire Mounting
Rim bead seats should be cleaned with a wire brush or coarse steel wool to remove lubricants, and
light rust. Before mounting a tire, the bead area should be well lubricated with an approved tire
lubricant. After mounting, inflate the tire to 196 kPa (28 psi) so that beads are completely seated.
Inflate the air to specified pressure and install valve cap to the stem.
WARNING: Never stand over tire when inflating. bead may break when bead snaps over rim's
safety hump and cause serious personal injury. never exceed 240 kPa (35 psi) pressure when
inflating. if 240 kPa (35 psi) pressure will not seat beads, deflate, re-lubricate and re-inflate. over
inflation may cause the bead to break and cause serious personal injury.
Tire Repair
There are many different materials on the market used to repair tires. Manufacturers have
published detailed instructions on how and when to repair tires. These instructions can be obtained
from the tire manufacturer if they are not included with the repair kit.
Wheel Inspection
Damaged wheels and wheels with excessive run-out must be replaced. Wheel run out at rim (Base
on hub Bore):
General Balance Procedure
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Separating the Tire From the Wheel > Page 6844
Deposits of mud, etc. must be cleaned from the inside of the rim. The tire should be inspected for
the following: match mount paint marks, bent rims, bulges, irregular tire wear, proper wheel size
and inflation pressure. Then balance according to the equipment manufacturer's recommendations.
There are two types of wheel and tire balance. Static balance is the equal distribution of weight
around the wheel. Assemblies that are statically unbalanced cause a bouncing action called tramp.
This condition will eventually cause uneven tire wear. Dynamic balance is the equal distribution of
weight on each side of the wheel center-line so that when the tire spins there is no tendency for the
assembly to move from side to side. Assemblies that are dynamically unbalanced may cause
shimmy.
WARNING: Stones should be removed from the tread to avoid operator injury during spin
balancing and to obtain a good balance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheels: Specifications Wheel Runout
Wheel Runout
Axial Runout Steel Wheel 0.0 to 1.0 mm
Aluminum Wheel 0.0 to 0.7 mm
Service Limit 2.0 mm
Maximum
Radial Runout Steel Wheel 0.0 to 1.0 mm
Aluminum Wheel 0.0 to 0.7 mm
Service Limit 1.5 mm
Maximum
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6848
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Check for bent or deformed wheels. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown. 4. Measure the wheel
runout by turning the wheel.
Front And Rear Wheel Axial Runout:
Standard: Steel Wheel: 0 -1.0 mm 10 - 0.04 inch)
- Aluminum Wheel: 0 - 0.7 mm (0 - 0.03 inch)
Service Limit: 2.0 mm (0.08 inch)
Front And Rear Wheel Radial Runout:
Standard: Steel Wheel: 0 -1.0 mm (0 - 0.04 inch)
- Aluminum Wheel: 0 - 0.7 mm (0 - 0.03 inch)
Service Limit: 1.5 mm (0.06 inch)
5. If the wheel runout is more than the service limit, replace the wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications End Play
End Play
End Play Front 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Rear 0.0 to 0.5 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6852
Wheel Bearing: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise the vehicle off the ground, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations. 2.
Remove the wheels, then reinstall the wheel nuts. 3. Attach the dial gauge as shown.
4. Measure the bearing end play by moving the disc in or outward. Front/Rear: Standard: 0 - 0.05
mm (0 - 0.002 inch) 5. If the bearing end play measurement is more than the standard, replace the
wheel bearing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6853
Wheel Bearing: Adjustments
Wheel bearings and hub on these models are an integral assembly and bearings cannot be
adjusted. If hub endplay exceeds 0.002 inch with spindle nut properly tightened, hub and bearing
assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Suspension
TOOL REQUIRED
- 07MAC-SL00200 Ball Joint remover, 28 mm
- 07JAF-SH20110 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Pilot, 38 mm
- 07JAF-SH20120 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Shaft, 22.4 x 25.4 mm
- 07749-0010000 Driver
- 07746-0010500 Attachment, 62 x 68 mm
- 07GAF-SE00401 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Base
- 07947-6340201 Driver Attachment 58 x 72 mm
- 07965-SD90100 Support Base
- 07GAF-SE00200 Wheel Hub Dis/Assembly Guide Attachment
CAUTION:
- Replace the self-locking nuts after removal.
- The vehicle should be on the ground before any bolts or nuts connected to rubber mounts or
bushings are tightened.
- Torque the castle nut to the lower torque specification, then tighten it only far enough to align the
slot with the pin hole. Do not align the nut by loosening.
NOTE:
- Use only genuine Honda wheel weights for aluminum wheels. Non-genuine wheel weights may
corrode and damage the aluminum wheels.
- On the aluminum wheels, remove the center cap from the inside of the wheel after removing the
wheel.
- Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and brake disc.
- Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surfaces of the brake disc and wheel.
- Wipe off the grease before tightening the nut at the ball joint.
1. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6856
2. Raise the front of vehicle, and support it with safety stands in the proper locations.
3. Remove the wheel nuts and wheel. 4. Raise the locking tab on the spindle nut, then remove the
nut.
5. Remove the brake hose mounting bolts. 6. Remove the caliper mounting bolts and hang the
caliper assembly to one side.
CAUTION: To prevent accidental damage to the caliper assembly or brake hose, use a short piece
of wire to hang the caliper from the undercarriage.
7. Remove the 6 mm brake disc retaining screws. 8. Screw two 8 x 1.25 mm bolts into the disc to
push it away from the wheel hub.
NOTE: Turn each bolt two turns at a time to prevent cocking the disc excessively.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6857
9. Remove the brake disc from the knuckle.
10. Check the front wheel hub for damage and cracks.
11. Remove the wheel sensor from the knuckle (for cars with ABS).
NOTE: Do not disconnect the wheel sensor connector. Use the special tool to separate the ball
joints from the suspension or steering arm.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the ball joint boot.
12. Clean any dirt or grease off the ball joint. 13. Remove the cotter pin from the steering arm and
remove the nut.
14. Apply grease to the special tool on the areas shown. This will ease installation of the tool and
prevent damage to the pressure bolt threads. 15. Install a 10 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure
that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end to prevent damage to the threaded end of the
ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6858
16. Install the special tool as shown. Insert the jaws carefully, making sure you do not damage the
ball joint boot. Adjust the jaw spacing by turning
the pressure bolt.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
17. Once the special tool is in place, turn the adjusting bolt as necessary to make the jaws parallel.
Then hand-tighten the pressure bolt, and recheck
the jaws to make sure they are still Parallel.
NOTE: After making the adjustment to the adjusting bolt, be sure the head of the adjusting bolt is in
this position to the allow the jaw to pivot.
18. With a wrench, tighten the pressure bolt until the ball joint shaft pops loose from the steering
arm. Wear eye protection. The ball joint can break
loose suddenly and scatter dirt or other debris in your eyes.
19. Remove the tool, then remove the nut from the end of the ball joint and pull the ball joint out of
the steering/suspension arm. Inspect the ball joint
boot and replace it if damaged.
20. Remove the cotter pin from the lower arm ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 21. Install a
12 mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
22. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and lower arm.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6859
23. Remove the cotter pin from the upper ball joint castle nut, and remove the nut. 24. Install the 12
mm hex nut on the ball joint. Be sure that the hex nut is flush with the ball joint pin end, or the
threaded section of the ball joint pin
might be damaged by the ball joint remover.
25. Use the special tool to separate the ball joint and knuckle.
NOTE: If necessary, apply penetrating type lubricant to loosen the ball joint.
26. Pull the knuckle outward and remove the driveshaft outboard joint from the knuckle by tapping
the driveshaft end with a plastic hammer, then
remove the knuckle.
NOTE: Replace the bearing with a new one after removal.
27. Separate the wheel hub from the knuckle using the special tools and a hydraulic press.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
- Hold onto the wheel hub to keep it from falling when pressed clear.
- To prevent damage to the tool, make sure the threads are fully engaged before pressing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6860
28. Remove the circlip and the splash guard from the knuckle.
29. Press the wheel bearing out of the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
30. Press the wheel bearing inner race from the wheel hub using the special tools, a bearing
separator, and a press as shown.
NOTE: Wash the knuckle and wheel hub thoroughly in high flash point solvent before reassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6861
31. Press a new wheel bearing into the knuckle using the special tools and a press as shown.
NOTE: Place the wheel bearing on the knuckle with the pack seal (metal color) toward the inside.
Be careful not to damage the sleeve of the pack seal.
32. Install the circlip securely in the knuckle groove.
33. Install the splash guard and tighten the screws.
34. Install the wheel hub on the knuckle using the special tools shown and a hydraulic press as
shown.
CAUTION: Take care not to distort the splash guard.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6862
35. Install the knuckle in the reverse order of removal, and pay particular attention to the following
items:
a. Be careful not to damage the ball joint boots when installing the knuckle. b. Torque all mounting
hardware to the specified torque values. c. Torque the castle nuts to the lower torque
specifications, then tighten them only far enough to align the slot with the pin hole. Do not align the
castle nut by loosening.
d. Install new cotter pins on the castle nuts after torquing. e. Avoid twisting the sensor wires when
installing the wheel sensor. f.
Before installing the brake disc, clean the mating surfaces of the front wheel hub and the inside of
the brake disc.
g. Before installing the wheel, clean the mating surface of the brake disc and the inside of the
wheel. h. Check the front wheel alignment, and adjust it if necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Suspension > Page 6863
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Suspension
The rear bearing is to be serviced with the wheel wheel hub as one unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Rear
Spindle Nut ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................... 181 Nm (134 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Wheel Nut ............................................................................................................................................
................................................... 110 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Conditioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Air Mix Control Motor
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Air Mix Control Motor
Below Right Side of Center Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Air Mix Control Motor > Page 6880
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Mode Control Motor
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Air Mix Control Motor > Page 6881
Behind Left Side of Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Air Mix Control Motor > Page 6882
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Recirculation Control Motor
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Air Mix Control Motor > Page 6883
Behind Glove Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6884
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Mode Control Motor
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Testing and Inspection Mode Control Motor
1. Disconnect the 7P connector from the mode control motor. 2. Connect battery power to the No.1
terminal, and ground the No.7 terminal.
CAUTION: Never connect the battery in the opposite direction.
3. Using a jumper wire, connect the No. terminal individually to the No.2, 3, 4, 5 and 6 terminals in
that order. Each time the connection is made, the
mode control motor should run smoothly and stop.
NOTE: If the mode control motor does not run when jumping the first terminal, jump that terminal
again after jumping the other terminals. The mode control motor is OK if it runs when jumping the
first terminal again.
4. If the mode control motor does not run in step 3, remove it, then check the mode control linkage
and doors for smooth movement. If they move
smoothly, replace the mode control motor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Mode Control Motor > Page 6887
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Testing and Inspection Recirculation Control Motor
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the recirculation control motor. 2. Connect battery power to
the No.1 terminal, and ground the No.2 and No.4 terminals; the recirculation control motor should
run smoothly.
CAUTION: Never connect the battery in the opposite direction.
3. Disconnect the No.2 or No.4 terminals from ground; the recirculation control motor should stop at
FRESH or RECIRCULATE.
NOTE: Don't cycle the recirculation control motor for a long time.
4. If the recirculation control motor does not run in step 2, remove it, then check the recirculation
control linkage and door for smooth movement. If
they move smoothly, replace the recirculation control motor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fresh Air/Recirculation Actuator
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Fresh Air/Recirculation Actuator
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the recirculation control motor, and remove the wire harness
clip from it. 2. Remove the two self-tapping screws and the recirculation control motor. 3. Install in
the reverse order of removal. After installation, make sure the recirculation control motor rung
smoothly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Fresh Air/Recirculation Actuator > Page 6890
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Control Motor
1. Disconnect the 7P connector from the mode control motor. 2. Remove the rod from the arm of
the mode control motor. 3. Remove the two self-tapping screws and the mode control motor. 4.
Install in the reverse order of removal. After installation, make sure the mode control motor runs
smoothly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Air Door Cable: Locations
Illustrated Index
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) components are located in this area. Review the SRS
component locations, precautions, and procedures in Air Bag Systems before performing repairs or
service.
Defroster-activated A/C System
Turning the defroster on activates the A/C and sets the air flow mode to FRESH. It is possible to
change the air flow to RECIRCULATE by pressing the A/C button or the FRESH/RECIRCULATE
by pressing the A/C button or the FRESH/RECIRCULATE button.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6894
Air Door Cable: Adjustments
1. From under the hood, disconnect the heater valve cable from the heater valve.
2. From under the dash, disconnect the air mix control cable housing from the cable clamp. 3. Set
the temperature control lever to MAX. COOL. 4. With the air mix control cable attached to the air
mix control arm, gently pull on the outer cable housing to fully close the door and to remove any
slack in the cable. Don't pull to hard, or the temperature control lever will move.
5. Hold the air mix control arm against the stop, then snap the air mix control cable housing into the
cable clamp.
6. From under the hood, move the heater valve arm to the fully closed position, then attach the
heater valve cable to the heater valve arm. 7. Hold the heater valve arm in the closed position, and
gently pull on the heater cable outer housing to take up any slack, then install the heater valve
cable housing into the cable clamp.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6895
Air Door Cable: Service and Repair
1. Cut the inner cable on the lever side of the cable holder, then remove both pieces of the inner
cable. 2. Using a sharp knife, cut completely through the end of the cable housing at the two
locations. 3. Slide the large section of the cable housing out of the cable holder, being careful not to
damage the cable stops. 4. Carefully remove the cut pieces of the cable housing with a small flat
tip screwdriver. 5. Hook the tip of the new air mix control cable to the temperature control lever,
then push the cable housing into the cable holder until it locks into
place.
NOTE: After assembly, check that the temperature control lever slides smoothly through the full
stroke from right to left.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V, 3W - 18W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39 °F (2 - 4 °C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41 °F (4 - 5 °C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43 °F (4 - 6 °C) or less, and should come
on at 43 - 45 °F (6 - 7 °C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Blower (Heater) Motor Gets Hot and Blows A Fuse
Blower Motor: Technical Service Bulletins Blower (Heater) Motor Gets Hot and Blows A Fuse
SOURCE: Honda Service News November 2003
TITLE: Heater Blower Motor Gets Hot or Blows a Fuse
APPLIES TO: 1990-04 Accords, 1992-04 Civics, 1997-04 CR-Vs, 2003 Elements, 2000-04
Insights, 1995-04 Odysseys, 1996-02 Passports, 2003-04 Pilots, 1997-01 Preludes, and 2000-04
S2000s
SERVICE TIP: A blocked cooling hose for the heater blower motor can cause the motor to
overheat, draw more current, blow a fuse, or even melt its plastic impeller. Before you order a
replacement blower motor, make sure the cooling hose isn't blocked. On some models, you'll find
the cooling hose molded into the blower motor housing; on other models, it's a separate piece.
Check the S/M for the vehicle you're working on to determine the actual location of the cooling
hose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Blower
Motor
Blower Motor: Locations Blower Motor
Below Right Side Of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Blower
Motor > Page 6905
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6908
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6909
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6910
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6911
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6912
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6913
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6914
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6915
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6916
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6917
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6918
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6919
Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6920
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6921
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6922
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6923
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6924
Blower Motor: Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor (Part 1 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6925
Blower Motor (Part 2 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
6926
Blower Motor (Part 3 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Blower Unit
Removal and Installation
SRS Main Harness
CAUTION: All SRS electrical wiring harnesses are covered with yellow outer insulation. Before
disconnecting the SRS wire harness, install the short connector (5) on the airbag (5). Replace the
entire affected SRS harness assembly it it has an open circuit or damaged wiring.
1. Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
2. Remove the glove box and glove box frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit > Page 6929
3. Remove the tapping screws (2) and remove the heater duct.
4. Remove the A/C band and the evaporator.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit > Page 6930
5. Remove the mounting bolts (3).
6. Disconnect the connectors from the blower motor. resistor then remove the blower. 7. Install the
blower in the reverse order of removal and make sure there is no air leakage.
NOTE: Before assembly make cure that the air door and linkage moves smoothly without binding.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit > Page 6931
Blower Unit Components Replacement
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit > Page 6932
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Blower Motor
NOTE: The blower motor, recirculation control motor, end resistor can be replaced without
removing the blower assembly
SRS Main Harness
CAUTION: All SRS electrical wiring harnesses are covered with yellow outer insulation. Before
disconnecting the SRS wire harness, install the short connector (5) on the airbag (5). Replace the
entire affected SRS harness assembly it it has an open circuit or damaged wiring.
1. Disconnect the battery negative terminal.
2. Remove the glove box and glove box frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Unit > Page 6933
6. Disconnect the connectors from the blower motor. resistor then remove the blower. 7. Install the
blower in the reverse order of removal and make sure there is no air leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 6937
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 6940
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor High Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor high relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6948
Blower Motor Switch: Connector Locations
Underside of Heater Control Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Blower Motor Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6951
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6952
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6953
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6954
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6955
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6956
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6957
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6958
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6959
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6960
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6961
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6962
Blower Motor Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6963
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6964
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6965
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6966
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6967
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6968
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Compressor Clutch: Component Locations
Left Front Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6974
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Nippondenso Compressor
Compressor Clutch: Testing and Inspection Nippondenso Compressor
- Check the plated parts of the pressure plate for color changes, peeling or other damage. If there
is damage, replace the clutch set.
- Check the pulley bearing play and drag by rotating the pulley by hand. Replace the clutch set with
a new one if it is noisy or has excessive play/drag.
- Measure the clearance between the pulley and the pressure plate all the way around. If the
clearance is not within specified limits, the pressure plate must be removed and shims added or
removed as required, following the procedure.
Clearance: 0.5 ± 0.15 mm (0.020 ± 0.006 in)
NOTE: The shims are available in three thicknesses: 0.1 mm, 0.3 mm and 0.5 mm.
- Check resistance of the field coil. If resistance is not within specifications, replace the field coil.
Field Coil Resistance: 3.4 to 3.8 Ohms at 20 °C (68 °F)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6977
Compressor Clutch: Testing and Inspection Sanden Compressor
- Check the plated parts of the armature plate for color changes, peeling or other damage. If there
is damage, replace the clutch set.
- Check the rotor pulley bearing play and drag by rotating the rotor pulley by hand. Replace the
clutch set with a new one if it is noisy or has excessive play/drag.
- Measure the clearance between the rotor pulley and the armature plate all the way around. If the
clearance is not within specified limits, the armature plate must be removed and shims added or
removed as required, following the procedure.
Clearance: 0.5 ± 0.15 mm (0.020 ± 0.006 in)
NOTE: The shims are available in four thicknesses: 0.1 mm, 0.2 mm, 0.4 mm and 0.5 mm
- Release the field coil connector from the holder, then disconnect it. Check the thermal protector
for continuity. If there is no continuity, replace the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6978
thermal protector.
NOTE: The thermal protector will have no continuity above 251.6 to 262.4 °F (122 to 128 °C).
When the temperature drops below 240.8 to 219.8 °F (116 to 104 °C), the thermal protector will
have continuity.
- Check resistance of the field coil.
Field Coil Resistance: 3.05 to 3.35 Ohms at 68 °F (20 °C)
If resistance is not within specifications, replace the field coil.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Nippondenso Compressor
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair Nippondenso Compressor
1. Remove the center bolt while holding the pressure plate with the special tool.
2. Remove the pressure plate and shims, taking care not to lose the shims.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6981
3. Remove the snap ring B with snap ring pliers, then remove the pulley. Be careful not to damage
the pulley and compressor.
4. Remove the screw from the field coil ground terminal. Remove the snap ring A with snap ring
pliers, then remove the field coil. Be careful not to
damage the field coil and compressor.
5. Reassemble the compressor clutch in the reverse order of disassembly, and note these items:
- Install the field coil with the wire side facing down.
- Clean the pulley and compressor sliding surfaces with non-petroleum solvent.
- Install new snap rings, and make sure they are fully seated in the groove.
- Make sure that the pulley turns smoothly after it's reassembled.
- Route and clamp the wires properly or they can be damaged by pulley.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6982
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair Sanden Compressor
1. Remove the center nut while holding the armature plate with the tool.
2. Remove the armature plate by pulling it up by hand.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6983
3. Remove snap ring B with snap ring pliers.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the rotor pulley and compressor during removal/installation.
- Once snap ring B is removed, replace it with a new one.
4. Remove the rotor pulley from the shaft with a puller and the special tool.
NOTE: Place the claws of the puller on the back of the rotor pulley, not on the belt area; otherwise
the rotor pulley can be damaged.
5. Remove the screw from the field coil ground terminal then disconnect the field coil connector.
Remove snap ring A with snap ring pliers, then
remove the field coil.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the field coil and compressor during remove/installation.
- Once snap ring A is removed, replace it with a new one.
- When installing the field coil, align the boss on the field coil with the hole in the compressor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Nippondenso Compressor > Page 6984
6. Position the rotor pulley squarely over the field coil. Press the rotor pulley onto the compressor
boss with the special tool. If the rotor pulley does
not press on straight, remove it, and check the rotor pulley and compressor boss for burrs or
damage.
CAUTION: Maximum press load: 39,200 kPa 1400 kg/sq.cm, 5,690 psi)
7. Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly. Make note of the following items.
- Install the field coil with the wire side facing down.
- Clean the rotor pulley and compressor sliding surfaces with non-petroleum solvent.
- Make sure the snap rings are fully seated in the groove.
- Make sure that the rotor pulley turns smoothly after it's reassembled.
- Route and clamp the wires properly or they can be damaged by the rotor pulley.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6989
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6990
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6991
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
When the ECM/PCM receives a demand for cooling from the air conditioning system, it delays the
compressor from being energized, and enriches the mixture to assure smooth transition to the A/C
mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6992
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
A/C compressor clutch relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
1. Recover the refrigerant with a recovery/recycling/charging station.
2. Disconnect the condenser fan connector from the A/C wire harness, then remove the A/C wire
harness from the condenser fan shroud.
3. Remove the bolts, then disconnect the discharge and condenser lines from the condenser.
NOTE: Plug or cap the lines immediately after disconnecting them to avoid moisture and dust
contamination.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 6996
4. Remove the bolt from the suction hose bracket, and remove the two bolts and the upper mount
bracket. Remove the condenser assembly by lifting
it up.
NOTE: Be careful not to damage the condenser fins when removing the condenser assembly.
5. Install in the reverse order of removal. Make note of the following items.
- If you're installing a new condenser, add refrigerant oil (SANDEN, SP-10 or DENSO, ND-OIL 8).
- Replace the O-rings with new ones at each fitting, and apply a thin coat of refrigerant oil before
installing them.
NOTE: Be sure to use the right O-rings for HFC-134a (R-134a) to avoid leakage.
- Be careful not to damage the condenser fins when installing the condenser assembly.
- Charge the system and test its performance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Specifications
Condenser Fan: Specifications Condenser Fan
Condenser Fan
Mounting Bolt Torque 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7000
Condenser Fan: Locations
Lower Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Condenser Fan: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7003
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7004
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7005
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7006
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7007
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7008
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7009
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7010
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7011
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7012
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7013
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7014
Condenser Fan: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7015
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7016
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7017
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7018
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7019
Condenser Fan: Description and Operation
Radiator Fan
Voltage is provided at all times to the radiator fan relay (contacts) through fuse 57. With the ignition
switch in ON (II), voltage is provided to the coil of the relay through fuse 17.
The radiator fan relay can be grounded through either the engine coolant temperature switch or the
engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The engine coolant temperature switch grounds the radiator fan relay (coil) when the engine
coolant temperature exceeds 199 °F (83 °C). The switch opens when coolant temperature
decreases 3 ° - 8 °C.
Condenser Fan
Voltage is provided at all times to the condenser fan relay (contacts) through fuse 56. With the
ignition switch in ON (II), voltage is provided to the coil of the relay through fuse 17. When you
push the A/C switch and put the heater fan switch in 1, 2, 3, or 4 position, the A/C thermostat
comes on, the condenser fan relay energizes, and the condenser fan motor runs.
A/C Thermostat
The A/C thermostat is located on the evaporator housing. The A/C thermostat turns off the A/C
compressor clutch if the temperature at the evaporator goes below 3 °C (37 °F). This prevents
condensation from freezing on the evaporator fins and blocking the air delivery into the passenger
compartment. If the temperature goes below 3 °C (37 °F) turning off the A/C thermostat, ground will
be removed from the condenser fan relay. This will deenergize the relay and remove voltage from
the condenser fan motor causing the fan to stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7020
Condenser Fan: Testing and Inspection
Condenser Fan (Part 1 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7021
Condenser Fan (Part 2 Of 3)
Condenser Fan(Part 3 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 7026
Fan Controls
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations > Component Locations > Page 7027
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Motor Relay, HVAC > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7028
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Condenser fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative
Condenser Fan Shroud: Customer Interest A/C Condenser Fan Motor - Inoperative
98-028
September 29, 1998
Applies To: 1996-98 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative (Supersedes 98-028, dated April 14, 1998)
SYMPTOM The No.56 (20A) fuse in the under-hood fuse/relay box is blown, the condenser fan
does not work, or the A/C performs poorly.
PROBABLE CAUSE The slope angle of the condenser fan shroud allows water to puddle at the
bottom of the shroud. During the winter months the standing water freezes, causing the condenser
fan motor to stall.
VEHICLES AFFECTED 1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic - ALL except Japan Production with factory A/C
1998 Civic Ohio Production with factory A/C:
2-door EX - thru VIN 1HGEJ....WL064136 4-door LX and EX - thru VIN 1HGEJ....WL025004
Canada Production with factory A/C:
4-door LX and EX - thru VIN 2HGEJ....WH561523
Dealer Installed A/C: ALL
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the condenser fan motor and, if necessary, the shroud with the
parts listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 80161-S04-000 H/C 4780243
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B02
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
PARTS INFORMATION Condenser Fan Motor:
P/N 80151-SR3-013, H/C 4323192
Condenser Fan Shroud:
P/N 80161-504-000, H/C 4780243
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative > Page 7037
REPAIR PROCEDURE
*1. Under the hood, remove these items:*
*2. Remove the condenser fan shroud upper mounting bolts, and disconnect the connectors and
wire harness clips:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative > Page 7038
*3. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. Move the splash shield out of the way.*
*4. From under the vehicle, disconnect the connectors and wire harness clips:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative > Page 7039
*5. Remove the condenser fan shroud:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative > Page 7040
6. Check the slope angle at the bottom of the condenser fan shroud.
^ If the condenser fan shroud has the original slope angle, replace both the condenser fan shroud
and the condenser fan motor with the parts listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
^ If the condenser fan shroud has the revised slope angle, replace only the condenser fan motor
with the part listed under PARTS INFORMATION, and continue with normal troubleshooting to find
the cause of the fan motor failure.
*7. Reinstall the condenser fan shroud in reverse order of removal.
8. Operate the A/C to confirm that the condenser fan works and the A/C performs properly.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan
Motor - Inoperative
Condenser Fan Shroud: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C Condenser Fan Motor - Inoperative
98-028
September 29, 1998
Applies To: 1996-98 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Condenser Fan Motor Inoperative (Supersedes 98-028, dated April 14, 1998)
SYMPTOM The No.56 (20A) fuse in the under-hood fuse/relay box is blown, the condenser fan
does not work, or the A/C performs poorly.
PROBABLE CAUSE The slope angle of the condenser fan shroud allows water to puddle at the
bottom of the shroud. During the winter months the standing water freezes, causing the condenser
fan motor to stall.
VEHICLES AFFECTED 1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic - ALL except Japan Production with factory A/C
1998 Civic Ohio Production with factory A/C:
2-door EX - thru VIN 1HGEJ....WL064136 4-door LX and EX - thru VIN 1HGEJ....WL025004
Canada Production with factory A/C:
4-door LX and EX - thru VIN 2HGEJ....WH561523
Dealer Installed A/C: ALL
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the condenser fan motor and, if necessary, the shroud with the
parts listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 80161-S04-000 H/C 4780243
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B02
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
PARTS INFORMATION Condenser Fan Motor:
P/N 80151-SR3-013, H/C 4323192
Condenser Fan Shroud:
P/N 80161-504-000, H/C 4780243
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan
Motor - Inoperative > Page 7046
REPAIR PROCEDURE
*1. Under the hood, remove these items:*
*2. Remove the condenser fan shroud upper mounting bolts, and disconnect the connectors and
wire harness clips:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan
Motor - Inoperative > Page 7047
*3. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. Move the splash shield out of the way.*
*4. From under the vehicle, disconnect the connectors and wire harness clips:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan
Motor - Inoperative > Page 7048
*5. Remove the condenser fan shroud:*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser Fan Shroud > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Condenser Fan Shroud: > 98-028 > Sep > 98 > A/C Condenser Fan
Motor - Inoperative > Page 7049
6. Check the slope angle at the bottom of the condenser fan shroud.
^ If the condenser fan shroud has the original slope angle, replace both the condenser fan shroud
and the condenser fan motor with the parts listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
^ If the condenser fan shroud has the revised slope angle, replace only the condenser fan motor
with the part listed under PARTS INFORMATION, and continue with normal troubleshooting to find
the cause of the fan motor failure.
*7. Reinstall the condenser fan shroud in reverse order of removal.
8. Operate the A/C to confirm that the condenser fan works and the A/C performs properly.*
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7054
Control Assembly: Connector Locations
Underside of Heater Control Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Assembly: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7057
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7058
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7059
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7060
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7061
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7062
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7063
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7064
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7065
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7066
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7067
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7068
Control Assembly: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7069
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7070
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7071
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7072
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7073
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7074
Control Assembly: Description and Operation
The air delivery system directs the flow of air used by the heater and air conditioner systems.
Mode Selection Mode selection is controlled by the mode switches in the heater control panel and
the mode control motor. When you select a specific mode, voltage is applied through the dimming
circuit to the LED, which comes ON, indicating the mode selected. Ground is provided to the mode
control motor through that mode switch. The motor then runs until the air control door reaches the
proper position.
Fresh/Recirculation Selection When you press the fresh or recirculation button, a ground signal is
sent from the heater control panel to the recirculation control motor. The motor then runs until the
recirculation door reaches the proper position. Battery voltage is also applied through the dimming
circuit to the corresponding LED, and the LED comes ON.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 7075
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover, the glove box and the center dashboard lower
cover . 2. Disconnect the air mix control cable from the heater unit. 3. Remove the rear window
defogger switch, the hazard warning switch and the audio unit.
4. Disconnect the connectors from the heater control panel. Remove the five self-tapping screws
and the center panel together with the heater control
panel.
NOTE: The locking tabs are on the bottom of the connectors.
5. Remove the four self-tapping screws and the heater control panel. 6. Install in the reverse order
to removal. Adjust the air mix control cable and the heater valve cable .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7078
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Module HVAC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7083
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7084
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7085
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7086
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7087
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7088
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7089
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7090
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7091
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7092
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7093
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7094
Control Module HVAC: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7095
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7096
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7097
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7098
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7099
Control Module HVAC: Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor Speed (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7100
Blower Motor Speed (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Specifications
Evaporator Case: Specifications Evaporator case
Evaporator case
Mounting Torque 10 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation
Evaporator Case: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
1. Move the temperature control to "HOT."
'96-98: Slide the temperature control lever. '99-00: Turn the ignition switch ON (II), then turn the
temperature control knob. Turn the ignition switch off.
2. Remove the battery. 3. Recover the refrigerant with a recovery/recycling/charging station .
4. Remove the bolts, then disconnect the suction and receiver lines from the evaporator.
NOTE: Plug or cap the lines immediately after disconnecting them to avoid moisture and dust
contamination.
5. Remove the glove box . 6. Remove the self-tapping screw and the passenger's dashboard lower
cover. Remove the bolt, the nut and the knee bolster, then remove the five
bolts and the glove box frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7109
7. Disconnect the connector from the A/C thermostat, and remove the wire harness from the
evaporator. Remove the four self-tapping screws, the
mounting bolt and the mounting nut. Disconnect the drain hose, then remove the evaporator.
8. Install in the reverse order of removal. Make note of the following items.
- If you're installing a new evaporator, add refrigerant oil (SANDEN, SP-10 or DENSO, ND-OIL 8).
- Replace the O-rings with new ones at each fitting, and apply a thin coat of refrigerant oil before
installing them.
NOTE: Be sure to use the right O-rings for HFC-134a (R-134a) to avoid leakage.
- Apply sealant to the grommets.
- Make sure that there is no air leakage.
- Charge the system and test its performance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7110
Evaporator Case: Service and Repair Overhaul
1. Pull out the A/C thermostat sensor from the evaporator fins. 2. Remove the self-tapping screws
and clamps from the housings. 3. Carefully separate the housings, then remove the evaporator. 4.
If necessary, remove the expansion valve.
NOTE: When loosening the expansion valve nuts, use a second wrench to hold the expansion
valve or the evaporator pipe. Otherwise, they can be damaged.
5. Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly. Make note of following items.
- Replace the O-rings with new ones at each fitting, and apply a thin coat of refrigerant oil before
installing them.
NOTE: Be sure to use the right O-rings for HFC-134a (R-134a) to avoid leakage.
- Install the expansion valve capillary tube so that it is in direct contact with the suction line. Then
wrap with tape.
- Reinstall the A/C thermostat sensor to its original location.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Specifications
Evaporator Core: Specifications
SANDEN Lubricant type SP - 10 (P/N 38897 - P13 - A01AH or 38899 -P13 -A01) (For Refrigerant:
HFC-134a (R-134a))
Lubricant capacity 45 Nm
NIPPONDENSO Lubricant type ND - OIL 8 (P/N 38899 - PR7 - 003 (For Refrigerant: HFC-134a
(R-134a))
Lubricant capacity 60 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Photo 82
Behind Right Side Of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7117
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
The A/C thermostat is located on the evaporator housing. The A/C thermostat turns OFF the A/C
compressor clutch if the temperature at the evaporator goes below 3°C (37°F). This prevents
condensation from freezing on the evaporator fins and blocking the air delivery into the passenger
compartment. The blower motor will keep running when the sensor turns OFF the compressor. If
the temperature goes below 3°C (37°F) turning OFF the A/C thermostat, ground will be removed
from the condenser fan relay. This will deenergize the relay and remove voltage from voltage from
the condenser fan motor causing the fan to stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7118
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V,3 W-18 W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39°F (2 - 4°C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41°F (4 - 5°C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43°F (4 - 5°C) or less, and should come on
at 43 - 45°F (6 - 7°C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and discharge A/C system using refrigerant recovery
equipment. 2. Disconnect receiver and suction lines from evaporator and plug lines. 3. Remove
glove box and frame. 4. Disconnect electrical connector from thermostat switch.
Fig. 22 Removing Evaporator Housing Supports
5. Remove self-tapping screws and bands, Fig. 22.
Fig. 23 Evaporator Housing Removal
6. Remove mounting bolts and evaporator housing, Fig. 23. 7. Remove evaporator sensor from the
evaporator fins. 8. Separate housings, then remove evaporator cover. 9. The expansion valve can
be removed after the evaporator has been lifted out of the case.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7122
9. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Use new O-rings when installing expansion valve and connecting refrigerant lines. b. Install
expansion valve and secure valve sensor against suction line with tape. c. Reinstall evaporator
sensor in its original location. d. Ensure there is no air leakage in the evaporator housing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve Cable >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows Hot Air
Heater Control Valve Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows
Hot Air
Heater Blows Cold Air; A/C Blows Warm Air
NOTE:
This article applies to all A/C-equipped Honda models that use a heater valve cable. Got a vehicle
in your shop that blows cold air from the heater or warm air from the A/C? The problem could just
be the heater valve cable has slipped off the heater valve arm.
There's a real easy fix for this problem. Slip the heater valve cable back onto the heater valve arm.
Then cut yourself a 10 mm length of 3.5 mm vacuum hose (P/N 95005-35008-10M, H/C 2325058),
and slide it onto the arm. This holds the cable on the arm nice and snug so it won't slip off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve Cable >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air/A/C Blows Hot Air > Page 7128
Heater Control Valve Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Blows Cold Air, A/C Blows
Warm Air
SOURCE: Honda Service News
TITLE: Heater Blows Cold Air, A/C Blows Warm Air
APPLIES TO: all A/C-equipped Honda models that use a heater valve cable.
SERVICE TIP:
Got a vehicle in your shop that blows cold air from the heater or warm air from the A/C ? The
problem could just be the heater valve cable has slipped off the heater valve arm. There's a real
easy fix for this problem. Slip the heater valve cable back onto the heater valve arm. Then cut
yourself a 10 mm length of 3.5 mm vacuum hose and slide it onto the arm. This holds the cable on
the arm nice and snug so it won't slip off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Control Valve > Heater Control Valve Cable >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7129
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Locations
Heater Core: Locations
96-98 Models
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Defroster-activated A/C System
Turning the defroster on activates the A/C and sets the air flow mode to FRESH. It is possible to
turn the A/C off or to change the air flow to RECIRCULATE by pressing the A/C button or the
FRESH/RECIRCULATE button.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Heater Core: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7135
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7136
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7137
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7138
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7139
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7140
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7141
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7142
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7143
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7144
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7145
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7146
Heater Core: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7147
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7148
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7149
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7150
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7151
Heater Core: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable, then drain cooling system.
3. Snap open cable clip, then disconnect heater valve cable from heater valve.
4. Disconnect heater hoses at heater, then remove heater unit mounting nut from engine
compartment side. 5. Remove instrument panel. 6. Remove heat duct or evaporator and steering
column bracket.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7152
7. Remove clip, heater mounting nuts and heater assembly.
Fig. 16 Heater Core Removal
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
7153
8. Remove heater core cover attaching screws, then the cover, Fig. 16. 9. Remove pipe clamp and
damper arm attaching screws.
10. Pull heater core from heater housing. Ensure care is taken not to bend inlet and outlet pipes
during removal. 11. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Do not interchange inlet and outlet hoses. b. Connect all cables and ensure they are properly
adjusted.
12. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming procedures.
On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for system
disarming and arming procedures.
13. After refilling cooling system, bleed cooling system.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation
Heater Core Case: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
2. From under the hood, open the clamp, then disconnect the heater valve cable from the heater
valve arm. Turn the heater valve arm to the fully
opened position as shown.
3. When the engine is cool, drain the engine coolant from the radiator.
WARNING: Do not remove the radiator cap when the engine is hot; the engine coolant is under
pressure and could severely scald you.
4. Disconnect the heater hoses from the heater unit.
CAUTION: Engine coolant will damage paint. Quickly rinse any spilled engine coolant from painted
surfaces.
NOTE: Engine coolant will run out when the hoses are disconnected; drain it into a clean drip pan.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7158
5. Remove the mounting nut from the heater unit.
NOTE: When removing the mounting nut, take care not to damage or bend the fuel lines, the brake
lines, etc.
6. Remove the dashboard. 7. Remove the heater duct or evaporator.
8. Disconnect the connectors from the mode control motor and air mix control motor ('99 - 00
models), then remove the wire harness clips and wire
harness from the heater unit. Remove the clip from the heater duct, then remove the two mounting
nuts and the heater unit.
9. Install in the reverse order of removal. Make note of the following items.
- Apply sealant to the grommets.
- Do not interchange the inlet and outlet heater hoses. Make sure that the clamps are secure.
- Refill the cooling system with engine coolant.
- Connect all cables, and make sure they are properly adjusted.
- Make sure that there is no air leakage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core Case > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal and Installation > Page 7159
Heater Core Case: Service and Repair Overhaul
1. Remove the two self-tapping screws and the heater core cover. 2. Pull out the grommet from the
heater core pipes. 3. Remove the self-tapping screw and the clamp. 4. Pull out the heater core
from the heater unit.
NOTE: Be careful not to bend the inlet and outlet pipes during heater core removal.
5. Assemble in the reverse order of disassembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compressor (Nippondenso)
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor (Nippondenso)
1. Recover the refrigerant with a recovery/recycling/charging station.
2. Remove the relief valve and the O-ring. Plug the opening to keep foreign matter from entering
the system and the compressor oil from running out. 3. Clean the mating surfaces. 4. Replace the
O-ring with a new one at the relief valve, and apply a thin coat of refrigerant oil before installing it.
5. Remove the plug, and install and tighten the relief valve. 6. Charge the system and test its
performance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compressor (Nippondenso) > Page 7164
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor (Sanden)
1. Remove the relief valve and the O-ring.
NOTE: Do not let the compressor oil run out.
- Make sure that no foreign matter enters the system.
2. Clean the mating surfaces. 3. Replace the O-ring with a new one at the relief valve, and apply a
thin coat of refrigerant oil before installing it.
NOTE: To avoid contamination, do not return the oil to the container once dispensed, and never mix it with
other refrigerant oils.
- Immediately after using the oil, replace the cap on the container, and seal it to avoid moisture
absorption.
- Do not spill the refrigerant oil on the vehicle; it may damage the paint; if the refrigerant oil contacts
the paint, wash it off immediately.
4. Install and tighten the relief valve. 5. Charge the system and test its performance.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications
Hose/Line HVAC: Mechanical Specifications
Discharge hose to the compressor 9.8 Nm
6 x 1.00 mm
Discharge hose to the condenser 9.8 Nm
Condenser pipe to the condenser 9.8 Nm
Condenser pipe to the receiver/dryer 9.8 Nm
Receiver pipe A to the receiver/dryer 9.8 Nm
Receiver pipe B to the receiver pipe A 13 Nm
Receiver pipe C to the receiver pipe B 13 Nm
Receiver pipe C to the Evaporator 9.8 Nm
Suction pipe B to the Evaporator 9.8 Nm
Suction pipe A to the Suction pipe B 31 Nm
Suction hose to the Suction pipe A 31 Nm
Suction hose to the Compressor 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications > Page 7169
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications > Page 7170
Hose/Line HVAC: Capacity Specifications
SANDEN Line or hose 10 mL
NIPPONDENSO Line or hose 10 mL
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Specifications
Receiver Dryer: Specifications
SANDEN Lubricant Capacity 10 mL
NIPPONDENSO Lubricant Capacity 10 mL
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection
07-030
October 12, 2007
Applies To: ALL Vehicles With Conventional A/C Compressors
A/C Leak Detection
(Supersedes 07-030, dated June 15, 2007, to update the information marked by asterisks)
The OPTIMAX Jr. (TM)A/C Leak Detection Kit for Honda vehicles, P/N TRP124893, is a new
required tool. The kit is used to add small amounts of dye to A/C systems to help locate smaller
leaks that an electronic leak detector might not find.
When searching for leaks, always begin by using an electronic leak detector. Refer to Service
Bulletin 97-027, Denso HLD-100 Halogen Leak Detector; for tips on using this tool, then follow up
with the OPTIMAX Jr.
This new detection kit complements but does not replace the electronic detector.
The kit contains:
^ TRP8640CS, OPTIMAX Jr. (TM) cordless, fluorescent leak detection flashlight lamp (includes 3
standard AA batteries)
^ TRP38600601, (6) 0.06 oz. (1.7 g) Tracer-Stick(R) R134a/PAG A/C dye capsules with ID labels
^ TRP3887, R-134a Universal Connect Set(TM)
^ TRP120884, GLO-AWAY(TM) dye cleaner
^ TRP9940, fluorescence-enhancing glasses
^ TRP1143, (1) empty Tracer-Stick dye capsule
ORDERING INFO
*One OPTIMAX Jr. A/C Leak Detection Kit was shipped to each current dealer as a required
special tool. Additional kits and replacement capsules may be ordered through the Honda Tool and
Equipment Program. On the iN, click on Service, Service Bay, Tool and Equipment Program,
Online Catalog tab, and Air Conditioning Equipment, or call.*
NOTICE
^ Do not use leak-trace dye in any Honda hybrid vehicle equipped with a dual-scroll compressor
This can increase the chance of electric shock. The compressor is easily identified by the orange
high-voltage cable that is connected to the compressor body.
^ Only Tracer-Stick single-dose fluorescent dye capsules from Tracer Products (Tracerline(R)) are
approved for use in Honda vehicles. Other dyes contain solvents that may contaminate the
system's refrigerant oil, leading to component failure.
^ Adding excessive amounts of dye can lead to compressor damage and failure.
USING THE OPTIMAX JR.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 7178
1. Before adding any leak-detection dye, check to see if there is dye in the system now.
^ Check for a label in the engine compartment indicating that fluorescent leak-detection dye has
been added to the system.
^ Dye may have been added even though no label is present. To confirm this:
- Put on the fluorescence-enhancing glasses, and remove the low-side service port sealing cap.
- Direct the ultraviolet lamp into the valve stem area. If dye has been previously added, the
lubricant traces will have a bright yellow fluorescent glow. You may need to press the port's valve
stem briefly to release some lubricant and dye from the system.
^ If there is no dye in the system, go to step 2.
^ If there is dye in the system, go to step 5. Do not add more dye.
2. Add the dye.
NOTE:
Air and moisture must be evacuated from the universal connect set if it is being used for the first
time, or if it has been stored with the control valve open. If the air and moisture have been
evacuated, go to step 3; otherwise do the following:
(a) Attach the empty dye capsule (provided in the dye kit) to the control valve fitting.
(b) Attach the service valve fitting (provided in the kit) to the empty dye capsule.
(c) Attach the low-side hose of the A/C recovery and charging station, and open the quick coupler's
hand-wheel valve. Then open the control valve (black knob) on the universal connect set.
(d) Following the manufacturer's instructions for your recovery and charging station, evacuate the
universal connect set for approximately 3 minutes.
(e) When evacuation is complete, be sure the set's control valve is closed (finger tight), and
disconnect the NC recovery and charging station.
(f) Remove the service valve fitting and the empty dye capsule from the set, and store them for
future use.
NOTE:
^ Check the refrigerant charge level. There must be enough refrigerant in the system to operate the
A/C compressor and to circulate refrigerant oil.
^ If the refrigerant charge is too low, recover the remaining amount and recharge the system before
adding any dye.
(g) Start the vehicle and operate the A/C system. Follow your A/C refrigerant recovery and
charging station's operating instructions for low-side charging to install the dye.
* NOTE:
Only 0.05 lb (0.02 kg) of refrigerant is needed to push the dye into the A/C system.*
(h) Once the refrigerant charge is programmed, open the control valve on the set to allow the dye
to enter the system.
(i) After the dye capsule clears, allow the low-side of the A/C system to reach its lowest operating
pressure, then quickly close both the service equipment's low-side coupler valve and the control
valve on the set.
(j) Remove the set from the vehicle by releasing its quick coupler. Remove the empty dye capsule
from the service valve fitting. Return the hose, control valve, and service-valve fitting to the storage
case.
* NOTE:
Store the hose with the control valve closed. This will retain a small amount of refrigerant in the
hose so it does not have to be evacuated the next time you use it.*
(k) Fill out an identification label (provided in the kit), and attach it to a location near the A/C charge
label.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 7179
3. Connect the universal connect set and the Tracer- Stick dye capsule:
(a) Be sure the quick coupler and control valves on the set are closed.
(b) Remove the low-side service port sealing cap, and connect the set to the low-side service port
using the quick coupler.
(c) Hold a new dye capsule so that the embossed arrow is pointing up. Remove the black end cap,
and carefully attach the capsule to the control valve fitting.
NOTE:
The capsule must be held with the embossed arrow pointing up or the dye will leak out of the
capsule.
(d) Turn the capsule so the embossed arrow is pointing down. Remove the orange end cap, and
carefully attach the service valve fitting provided in the kit (finger tight).
NOTE:
The capsule must be held with the embossed arrow pointing down or the dye will leak out.
4. Connect the NC service equipment:
With the universal connect set and dye capsule attached to the vehicle's low-side service port,
connect the A/C refrigerant recovery and charging station's low-side hose quick coupler to the
service valve fitting. Open the blue hand-wheel valves on both quick couplers. Leave the control
valve (black knob) on the universal connect set closed.
NOTE:
* ^ If you have recovered refrigerant to weigh it as part of your diagnostics, or if there is a low
charge, it is more efficient to recharge the system using normal procedures before installing the
universal connect set. Dye can then be added using approximately 0.05 lb (0.02 kg) of refrigerant.*
^ You do not need to connect the service equipment's high-side hose to the vehicle to install the
dye. If the high-side hose is connected, make sure its coupler valve is closed before proceeding.
^ Do not use the A/C recovery and charging station to recover or evacuate the A/C system when a
full dye capsule is attached. The dye will be drawn into the service equipment instead of being
added to the vehicle's A/C system.
5. Inspect the A/C system for leaks:
(a) Run the A/C system for at least 15 minutes to circulate the dye through the system. Large leaks
will be seen immediately as a fluorescent yellow glow. Smaller leaks may require at least 24 hours
of vehicle operation before they become visible. Operate the A/C system as much as possible
during this time to keep the dye circulating.
(b) Stop the vehicle's engine and inspect the system for leaks using the ultraviolet (UV) lamp and
fluorescence-enhancing glasses from the kit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Leak Detection > Page 7180
Low ambient light conditions (a dark work area) will aid in locating the leak.
NOTE:
Not all UV lamps work well with all types of fluorescent dye. Use only the lamp provided in the kit to
inspect for leaks.
(c) Inspect the entire system. Be sure to check these locations:
^ damaged and corroded areas
^ fittings
^ hose-to-line couplings
^ refrigerant controls
^ service ports
^ brazed or welded areas
^ areas near attachment points
(d) Check for evaporator leaks by illuminating the evaporator drain tube area with the UV lamp and
glasses.
(e) After repairing a leak, remove any fluorescent residue using the GLO-AWAY dye cleaner from
the kit and hot water (follow the instructions on the bottle).
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
A/C Refrigerant Capacity 550 +0 -50 g
A/C Refrigerant Type R-134a
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7183
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
A/C Refrigerant Capacity 550 +0 -50 g
A/C Refrigerant Type R-134a
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Condensor 20 mL
Evaporator 45 mL
Line or hose 10 mL
Receiver/Dryer 10 mL
Leakage Repair 25 mL
Compressor (Sanden) 130 mL
Remove oil from new compressor equal to the amount drained
from the old compressor but not more than 50 ml.
Compressor (Denso) 130 mL
Remove oil from new compressor equal to the amount drained
from the old compressor but not more than 50 ml.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 7188
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Refrigerant Oil Type ............................................................................................................................
......................................................................... SP-10 Honda PN .......................................................
........................................................................................................................................
38897-P13-A01AH Honda Code .........................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... 5023627
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Component Locations
Left Front Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7193
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7194
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Battery voltage is supplied through fuse 56 to the A/C compressor clutch relay contacts at all times.
With the ignition switch in ON (II), voltage is applied to the coil of the A/C compressor clutch relay
through fuse 17. When you push the A/C switch ON , and the heater fan switch is in position 1, 2,
3, or 4, a "ground" input is provided to the engine control module (ECM) or powertrain control
module (PCM) through the A/C thermostat and the A/C pressure switch.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is grounded by the engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain
Control Module (PCM). When energized, the A/C compressor clutch relay allows battery voltage to
turn on the A/C compressor clutch.
The A/C ON indicator light comes on when the A/C system is requested.
A/C Pressure Switch
The A/C pressure switch is located in the condenser outlet line where refrigerant is in a high
temperature/high pressure liquid state. The switch will sense abnormally high or low pressure, and
open the circuit. This removes ground, and the compressor will stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7199
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Blower Motor Relay > Page 7202
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Blower Motor High Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Blower motor high relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7207
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7208
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7209
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
When the ECM/PCM receives a demand for cooling from the air conditioning system, it delays the
compressor from being energized, and enriches the mixture to assure smooth transition to the A/C
mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7210
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
A/C compressor clutch relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7215
Fan Controls
Right Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7216
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Condenser Fan Motor Relay,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7217
Condenser Fan Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Condenser fan relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Module HVAC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7222
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7223
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7224
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7225
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7226
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7227
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7228
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7229
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7230
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7231
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7232
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7233
Control Module HVAC: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7234
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7235
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7236
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7237
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7238
Control Module HVAC: Testing and Inspection
Blower Motor Speed (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7239
Blower Motor Speed (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Air Conditioning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V, 3W - 18W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39 °F (2 - 4 °C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41 °F (4 - 5 °C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43 °F (4 - 6 °C) or less, and should come
on at 43 - 45 °F (6 - 7 °C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7251
Blower Motor Switch: Connector Locations
Underside of Heater Control Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Blower Motor Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7254
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7255
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7256
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7257
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7258
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7259
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7260
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7261
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7262
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7263
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7264
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7265
Blower Motor Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7266
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7267
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7268
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7269
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7270
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7271
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Coolant Temperature Sensor
/ Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Coolant Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Right Side of Engine
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Photo 82
Behind Right Side Of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7278
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
The A/C thermostat is located on the evaporator housing. The A/C thermostat turns OFF the A/C
compressor clutch if the temperature at the evaporator goes below 3°C (37°F). This prevents
condensation from freezing on the evaporator fins and blocking the air delivery into the passenger
compartment. The blower motor will keep running when the sensor turns OFF the compressor. If
the temperature goes below 3°C (37°F) turning OFF the A/C thermostat, ground will be removed
from the condenser fan relay. This will deenergize the relay and remove voltage from voltage from
the condenser fan motor causing the fan to stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7279
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the A/C thermostat. 2. Connect battery power to the No.3 terminal, ground the No.2
terminal, and connect a test light between the No.1 and No.3 terminals.
NOTE: Use a 12 V,3 W-18 W test light.
3. Dip the A/C thermostat into a cup filled with ice water, and check the test light.
Serpentine-type evaporator The light should go off at 36 - 39°F (2 - 4°C) or less, and should come
on at 39 - 41°F (4 - 5°C) or more.
Laminate-type evaporator The light should go off at 39 - 43°F (4 - 5°C) or less, and should come on
at 43 - 45°F (6 - 7°C) or more.
If the light doesn't come on and go off as specified, replace the A/C thermostat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Component Locations
Left Front Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7284
Wiring/Connector Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 7285
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Battery voltage is supplied through fuse 56 to the A/C compressor clutch relay contacts at all times.
With the ignition switch in ON (II), voltage is applied to the coil of the A/C compressor clutch relay
through fuse 17. When you push the A/C switch ON , and the heater fan switch is in position 1, 2,
3, or 4, a "ground" input is provided to the engine control module (ECM) or powertrain control
module (PCM) through the A/C thermostat and the A/C pressure switch.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is grounded by the engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain
Control Module (PCM). When energized, the A/C compressor clutch relay allows battery voltage to
turn on the A/C compressor clutch.
The A/C ON indicator light comes on when the A/C system is requested.
A/C Pressure Switch
The A/C pressure switch is located in the condenser outlet line where refrigerant is in a high
temperature/high pressure liquid state. The switch will sense abnormally high or low pressure, and
open the circuit. This removes ground, and the compressor will stop running.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ventilation Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Thermal Limiting Fuse > Component Information > Locations
Thermal Limiting Fuse: Locations
Left Front Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Thermal Limiting Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7292
Thermal Limiting Fuse: Description and Operation
Battery voltage is supplied through fuse 56 to the A/C compressor clutch relay contacts at all times.
With the ignition switch in ON (II), voltage is applied to the coil of the A/C compressor clutch relay
through fuse 17. When you push the A/C switch ON , and the heater fan switch is in position 1, 2,
3, or 4, a "ground" input is provided to the engine control module (ECM) or powertrain control
module (PCM) through the A/C thermostat and the A/C pressure switch.
The A/C compressor clutch relay is grounded by the engine control module (ECM) or Powertrain
Control Module (PCM). When energized, the A/C compressor clutch relay allows battery voltage to
turn on the A/C compressor clutch.
The A/C ON indicator light comes on when the A/C system is requested.
Thermal Protector
The thermal protector, located on the A/C compressor, opens and turns the compressor off if it
senses high temperature. Once the compressor cools, the switch will close and the compressor will
begin running again.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Thermal Limiting Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7293
Thermal Limiting Fuse: Service and Repair
1. Remove the bolt, the ground terminal and the holder. Disconnect the field coil connector, then
remove the thermal protector.
2. Replace the thermal protector with a new one, and apply silicone sealant to the top of the
thermal protector. 3. Install in the reverse order of removal.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ventilation Switch > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Locations > Page 7302
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7305
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7306
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact > Page 7309
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7310
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Specifications
Air Bag: Specifications Airbag Assembly
Airbag Assembly
Drivers Side Torx Bolt(s) 9.8 Nm
Passengers Side Lower Mounting Nut(s) 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7314
Air Bag: Locations
Behind Right Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7317
Air Bag: Service Precautions Precautions For Electrical Inspections
When using electrical test equipment, insert the probe of the tester into the wire side of the
connector. Do not insert the probe of the tester into the terminal side of the connector, and do not
tamper with the connector. Inserting the probe into the terminal side of the connector, and
tampering the connector could cause malfunction of the SRS system or an error in inspection.
Use a probe with a tapered tip. Do not insert the probe forcibly.
Use specified service connectors in troubleshooting. Using tools which are not specified standard
design could cause an error in inspection due to poor metal-to-metal contact.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7318
Air Bag: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 7319
Air Bag: Description and Operation
SRS Airbag
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Airbag Replacement
After a collision in which the airbags were deployed, the airbag assemblies and the SRS unit must
be replaced.
WARNING: Store a removed airbag with the pad surface up. If the airbag is improperly stored face
down, accidental deployment could propel the unit with enough force to cause serious injury.
CAUTION:
- Always disconnect the airbag connector(s) when the harness is disconnected. - Do not
disassemble or tamper with the airbag.
NOTE:
- Do not install used SRS parts from another vehicle. When repairing, use only new SRS parts. Carefully inspect the airbag before you install it. Do not install an airbag that shows signs of being
dropped or improperly handled, such as dents,
cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag connector(s):
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the
driver's airbag and cable reel.
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
3. Remove the airbag(s):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7322
Remove the two Torx bolts using a Torx T30 bit, then remove the driver's airbag.
CAUTION: Be sure to install the SRS wiring so that it is not pinched or interfering with other parts.
4. Install the new airbag(s):
Place the driver's airbag into the steering wheel, and secure it with new Torx bolts.
5. Reconnect the airbag connector(s).
Connect the driver's airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, then install the access
panel on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7323
6. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable.
7. After installing the airbag, confirm proper system operation:
- Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator light should come on for about six seconds and
then go off.
- Make sure both horn buttons work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7324
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Airbag Replacement
After a collision in which the airbags were deployed, the airbag assemblies and the SRS unit must
be replaced.
WARNING: Store a removed airbag with the pad surface up. If the airbag is improperly stored face
down, accidental deployment could propel the unit with enough force to cause serious injury.
CAUTION:
- Always disconnect the airbag connector(s) when the harness is disconnected. - Do not
disassemble or tamper with the airbag.
NOTE:
- Do not install used SRS parts from another vehicle. When repairing, use only new SRS parts. Carefully inspect the airbag before you install it. Do not install an airbag that shows signs of being
dropped or improperly handled, such as dents,
cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag connector(s):
Disconnect the 2P connector between the front passenger's airbag and SRS main harness.
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
3. Remove the airbag(s):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7325
- Remove the three mounting nuts from the bracket, then remove the harness clip.
- Lift the front passenger's airbag out of the dashboard by covering the lid and dashboard with a
cloth, and prying carefully with a flat-tip screwdriver.
NOTE: The lid of the airbag has pawls on its side which attach it to the dashboard.
CAUTION: Be sure to install the SRS wiring so that it is not pinched or interfering with other parts.
4. Install the new airbag(s):
- Place the front passenger's airbag into the dashboard.
- Tighten the front passenger's airbag mounting nuts
5. Reconnect the airbag connector(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7326
Attach the airbag connector to the connector holder, then reinstall the glove box.
6. Connect the battery positive cable, then connect the negative cable.
7. After installing the airbag, confirm proper system operation:
- Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator light should come on for about six seconds and
then go off.
- Make sure both horn buttons work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7327
Air Bag: Service and Repair Airbag Assembly Disposal and Deployment
Damaged Airbag/Tensioner Special Procedure
Before scrapping any airbags (including those in a whole vehicle to be scrapped), the airbags must
be deployed. If the vehicle is still within the warranty period, before you deploy the airbags, the
Honda District Service Manager must give approval and/or special instructions. Only after the
airbags have been deployed (as the result of vehicle collision, for example), can they be scrapped.
If the airbags appear intact (not deployed), treat them with extreme caution. Follow this procedure:
Damaged Airbag Special Procedure
WARNING: If an airbag cannot be deployed, it should not be treated as normal scrap; it should still
be considered a potentially explosive device that can cause serious injury.
1. If installed in a vehicle, follow the removal procedure . 2. In all cases, make a short circuit by
twisting together the two airbag inflator wires. 3. Package the airbag in exactly the same packaging
that the new replacement part came in. 4. Mark the outside of the box "DAMAGED AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED" so it does not get confused with your parts stock. 5. Contact your Honda District
Service Manager for how and where to return it for disposal.
Deployed Air Bag Handling
When handling a deployed air bag assembly, a face shield and rubber gloves should be worn.
Vehicle interior and A/C, vent, defroster and heater ducts should be vacuumed. If sinus or throat
irritation is encountered during air bag removal, exit vehicle and breathe fresh air. If skin irritation is
encountered, flush effected area with cool water. If sinus, throat, skin or any other type of irritation
continues, consult a physician. After handling a deployed air bag assembly, wash hands and rinse
thoroughly with water.
An air bag that has been deployed should be removed from the vehicle. Prior to removing a
deployed air bag assembly, place tape over air bag exhaust vents. After unit has been removed, it
should be placed in a heavy duty plastic bag and sealed securely. The sealed plastic bag should
then be placed with automotive scrap. An air bag assembly that has not been deployed, must be
deployed prior to disposal.
Driver's Air Bag
Before scrapping any airbags (including those in a whole vehicle to be scrapped), the airbags must
be deployed. If the vehicle is still within the warranty period, before you deploy the airbags, the
Honda District Service Manager must give approval and/or special instructions. Only after the
airbags have been deployed (as the result of vehicle collision, for example), can they be scrapped.
If the airbags appear intact (not deployed), treat them with extreme caution. Follow this procedure:
Deploying the Airbags: In-vehicle
NOTE: If an SRS vehicle is to be entirely scrapped, its airbags should be deployed while still in the
vehicle. The airbags should not be considered as salvageable parts and should never be installed
in another vehicle.
WARNING: Confirm that each airbag assembly is securely mounted; otherwise, severe personal
injury could result from deployment.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable. 2. Confirm that the
special tool is functioning properly by following the check procedure on the tool label.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7328
3. Remove the access panel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the
cable reel.
4. Cut off the airbag connector, strip the ends of the airbag wires, and connect the deployment tool
alligator clips to the airbag. Place the deployment
tool at least thirty feet (10 meters) away from the airbag.
5. Connect a 12 volt battery to the tool:
- If the green light on the tool comes on, the air-bag igniter circuit is defective and cannot deploy
the airbag. Go to Damaged Airbag Special Procedure.
- If the red light on the tool comes on, the airbag is ready to be deployed.
6. Push the tool's deployment switch. The airbag should deploy (deployment is both highly audible
and visible; a loud noise and rapid inflation of the
bag, followed by slow deflation). If the airbags deploy and the green light on the tool comes on, continue with this procedure.
- If an airbag doesn't deploy, yet the green light comes ON, its igniter is defective. Go to Damaged
Airbag Special Procedure.
WARNING: During deployment, the airbag assembly can become hot enough to burn you. Wait
thirty minutes after deployment before touching the assembly.
7. Dispose of the complete airbag assembly. No part of it can be reused. Place it in a sturdy plastic
bag, and seal it securely.
CAUTION: Wear a face shield and gloves when handling a deployed airbag.
- Wash your hands and rinse them well with water after handling a deployed airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7329
Passenger's Air Bag
Before scrapping any airbags (including those in a whole vehicle to be scrapped), the airbags must
be deployed. If the vehicle is still within the warranty period, before you deploy the airbags, the
Honda District Service Manager must give approval and/or special instructions. Only after the
airbags have been deployed (as the result of vehicle collision, for example), can they be scrapped.
If the airbags appear intact (not deployed), treat them with extreme caution. Follow this procedure:
Deploying the Airbags: In-vehicle
NOTE: If an SRS vehicle is to be entirely scrapped, its airbags should be deployed while still in the
vehicle. The airbags should not be considered as salvageable parts and should never be installed
in another vehicle.
WARNING: Confirm that each airbag assembly is securely mounted; otherwise, severe personal
injury could result from deployment.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable. 2. Confirm that the
special tool is functioning properly by following the check procedure on the tool label.
3. Remove the glove box, then disconnect the 2P connector between the front passenger's airbag
and SRS main harness.
4. Cut off the airbag connector, strip the ends of the airbag wires, and connect the deployment tool
alligator clips to the airbag. Place the deployment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7330
tool at least thirty feet (10 meters) away from the airbag.
5. Connect a 12 volt battery to the tool:
- If the green light on the tool comes on, the air- bag igniter circuit is defective and cannot deploy
the airbag. Go to Damaged Airbag Special Procedure.
- If the red light on the tool comes on, the airbag is ready to be deployed.
6. Push the tool's deployment switch. The airbag should deploy (deployment is both highly audible
and visible; a loud noise and rapid inflation of the
bag, followed by slow deflation). If the airbags deploy and the green light on the tool comes on, continue with this procedure.
- If an airbag doesn't deploy, yet the green light comes ON, its igniter is defective. Go to Damaged
Airbag Special Procedure.
WARNING: During deployment, the airbag assembly can become hot enough to burn you. Wait
thirty minutes after deployment before touching the assembly.
7. Dispose of the complete airbag assembly. No part of it can be reused. Place it in a sturdy plastic
bag, and seal it securely.
CAUTION: Wear a face shield and gloves when handling a deployed airbag.
- Wash your hands and rinse them well with water after handling a deployed airbag.
Deploying Airbags/Tensioner (Outside Vehicle)
Before scrapping any airbags (including those in a whole vehicle to be scrapped), the airbags must
be deployed. If the vehicle is still within the warranty period, before you deploy the airbags, the
Honda District Service Manager must give approval and/or special instructions. Only after the
airbags have been deployed (as the result of vehicle collision, for example), can they be scrapped.
If the airbags appear intact (not deployed), treat them with extreme caution. Follow this procedure:
Deploying the Airbag: Out-of-Vehicle
NOTE: If an intact airbag has been removed from a scrapped vehicle, or has been found defective
or damaged during transit, storage or service, it should be deployed as follows:
WARNING: Position the airbag face up, outdoors on flat ground at least thirty feet (10 m) from any
obstacles or people.
1. Confirm that the special tool is functioning properly by following the check procedure listed or on
the tool label.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7331
2. Cut off the airbag connector, strip the ends of the airbag wires, and connect the deployment tool
alligator clips to the airbag. Place the deployment
tool at least thirty feet (10 meters) away from the airbag.
3. Connect a 12 volt battery to the tool:
- If the green light on the tool comes on, the air-bag igniter circuit is defective and cannot deploy
the airbag. Go to Damaged Airbag Special Procedure.
- If the red light on the tool comes on, the airbag is ready to be deployed.
4. Push the tool's deployment switch. The airbag should deploy (deployment is both highly audible
and visible; a loud noise and rapid inflation of the
bag, followed by slow deflation). If the airbags deploy and the green light on the tool comes on, continue with this procedure.
- If an airbag doesn't deploy, yet the green light comes ON, its igniter is defective. Go to Damaged
Airbag Special Procedure.
WARNING: During deployment, the airbag assembly can become hot enough to burn you. Wait
thirty minutes after deployment before touching the assembly.
5. Dispose of the complete airbag assembly. No part of it can be reused. Place it in a sturdy plastic
bag, and seal it securely.
CAUTION: Wear a face shield and gloves when handling a deployed airbag.
- Wash your hands and rinse them well with water after handling a deployed airbag.
Deployment Tool Check Procedure
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7332
Deployment Tool: Check Procedure
1. Connect the yellow clips to both switch protector handles on the tool; connect the tool to a
battery. 2. Push the operation switch: green means the tool is OK; red means the tool is faulty. 3.
Disconnect the battery and the yellow clips.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Driver Airbag Replacement > Page 7333
Air Bag: Service and Repair Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications
Air Bag Control Module: Specifications SRS Unit
SRS Unit
Torx Bolt(s) 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7337
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Behind Left Side of Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7338
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7339
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Take extra care when painting or doing body work in the area below the dashboard. Avoid direct
exposure of the SRS unit or wiring to heat guns, welding, or spraying equipment.
Disconnect the airbag connector(s) before disconnecting SRS harness connectors.
After any degree of frontal body damage, or after a collision without airbag deployment, inspect the
SRS unit for physical damage. If it is dented, cracked, or deformed, replace it.
Be sure the SRS unit is installed securely.
Do not disassemble the SRS unit.
Store the SRS unit in a cool (less than about 104 °F / 40 °C) and dry (less than 80% humidity, no
moisture) place. Do not spill water or oil on the SRS unit, and keep it away from dust.
During installation or replacement, be careful not to bump (impact wrench, hammer, etc.) the area
around the SRS unit. The airbag(s) could accidentally deploy and cause damage or injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7340
Air Bag Control Module: Application and ID
96 - 97 Model SRS Units
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7341
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7342
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Before disconnecting any part of the SRS wire harness, disconnect the airbag connector(s).
- During installation or replacement, do not bump (impact wrench, hammer etc.) the area near the
SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not damage the SRS unit terminals or connectors.
- Do not disassemble the SRS unit; it has no serviceable parts.
- Store the SRS unit in a clean, dry area.
- Do not use any SRS unit which has been subjected to water or shows signs of being dropped or
improperly handled, such as dents, cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag connector(s):
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
Driver's Side Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector
between the driver's airbag and cable reel.
Front Passenger's Side Disconnect the 2P connector between the front passenger's airbag and
SRS main harness.
3. Remove the right side cover from the SRS unit.
4. Remove the left side cover from the SRS unit, then disconnect the SRS main harness 18P
connector from the SRS unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7343
5. Remove the four Torx bolts from the SRS unit, then pull out the SRS unit from the driver's side.
6. Install the new SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not reuse a torx bolt that has red threads. Replace the bolt with a new one.
7. Connect the SRS main harness 8P connector to the SRS unit; push it into position until it clicks.
8. Install the SRS unit covers (right and left). Make sure the covers snap together in the middle. 9.
Reconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, then reinstall the
access panel on the steering wheel.
10. Reconnect the front passenger's airbag connector to the SRS main harness. 11. Reconnect the
battery positive cable, then the negative cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7344
12. After installing the SRS unit, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II);
the SRS indicator light should come on for about
six seconds and then go off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Specifications
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Specifications Cable Reel
Cable Reel
Airbag Assembly Torx Bolt(s) 9.8 Nm
Steering Wheel Steering Wheel Nut 50 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions General Precautions
WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible injury, always disconnect the driver's and
front passenger's airbag connectors (automatically shorted) before working near any SRS wiring.
CAUTION: Whenever the ignition switch is ON(II) , or has been turned OFF for less than three
minutes, be careful not to bump the SRS unit; the airbags could accidentally deploy and cause
damage or injuries.
WARNING: Do not use test equipment on the yellow SRS wires and connectors in the steering
column, console, dashboard, and floor. You could unintentionally set off the airbags, which could
cause injury to you and others.
While working on other systems, be careful not to damage SRS wiring or components. Damage
could make the airbags inoperative, which could lead to the driver's or the passenger's injury or
death it the car were in a severe frontal collision.
NOTE: - If an intact airbag assembly has been removed from a scrapped vehicle or has been found
defective or damaged during transit, storage or service, it
should be deployed.
- Before removing the steering gearbox, remove the driver's airbag assembly and steering wheel. After installing the steering gearbox, check the wheel alignment and adjust if necessary. - SRS
components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures in Air Bags and Seat Belts before
performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions > Page 7350
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions > Page 7351
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions > Page 7352
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions Precautions For Electrical Inspections
When using electrical test equipment, insert the probe of the tester into the wire side of the
connector. Do not insert the probe of the tester into the terminal side of the connector, and do not
tamper with the connector. Inserting the probe into the terminal side of the connector, and
tampering the connector could cause malfunction of the SRS system or an error in inspection.
Use a probe with a tapered tip. Do not insert the probe forcibly.
Use specified service connectors in troubleshooting. Using tools which are not specified standard
design could cause an error in inspection due to poor metal-to-metal contact.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions > Page 7353
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service Precautions Steering-Related Precautions
Steering Column Removal
Steering Column Removal
CAUTION: Before removing the steering column, disconnect the connector between the cable reel and the
SRS main harness.
- If the steering column is going to be removed with-out dismounting the steering wheel, lock the
steering by turning the ignition key to 0-LOCK position, or remove the key from the ignition switch
so that the steering wheel will not turn.
NOTE: When the airbag and cable reel are disconnected, don't reconnect the battery cable. If the battery
is reconnected and the ignition switch is turned ON (II), the SRS unit will store this as an open in
the driver's airbag inflator, and the SRS indicator light will come on.
- For disconnecting the spring-loaded lock type connector.
Do not replace the original steering wheel with any other design because it will make it impossible
to properly install the airbag (only use genuine Honda replacement parts).
After reassembly, confirm the wheels are still turned straight ahead and that the steering wheel
spoke angle is correct. If minor spoke angle adjustment is necessary, do so only by adjusting the
tie-rods, not by removing and repositioning the steering wheel.
Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
NOTE: To avoid misalignment of the steering wheel on reassembly, make sure the wheels are
turned straight ahead before removing the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > General Precautions > Page 7354
Rotate the cable reel clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise (approximately two
and a half turns) until the arrow mark on the cable reel label points straight up.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7355
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Adjustments
Steering Wheel and Cable Reel Alignment
NOTE: To avoid misalignment of the steering wheel on reassembly, make sure the wheels are
turned straight ahead before removing the steering wheel.
Rotate the cable reel clockwise until it stops. Then rotate it counterclockwise (approximately two
and a half turns) until the arrow mark on the cable reel label points straight up.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7356
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
WARNING: Store a remove airbag assembly with the pad surface up. If the airbag is improperly
stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the unit with enough force to cause serious
injury.
CAUTION:
- Always disconnect the airbag connector(s) when the harness is disconnected. - Do not
disassemble or tamper with the airbag.
NOTE: Carefully inspect the airbag assembly before installing it. Do not install an airbag that shows
signs of being dropped or improperly handled, such as dents, cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes.
2. Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between
the driver's airbag and cable reel.
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
3. Make sure the wheels are aligned straight ahead.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 5. Remove the two Torx bolts from the steering
wheel, and disconnect the horn connector. Then remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7357
6. Disconnect the connectors from the horn and cruise control set/resume switches, then remove
the steering wheel nut.
7. Remove the steering wheel using a steering wheel puller.
8. Remove the column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7358
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and cable reel sub-harness, and
the 2P connector between the cable reel and SRS main
harness.
10. Remove the cable reel from the column.
NOTE: Before installing the steering wheel, the front wheels should be aligned straight ahead.
- Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
- After reassembly, confirm that the wheels are still turned straight ahead and that the steering
wheel spoke angle is correct (road test). If minor spoke angle adjustment is necessary, do so only
by adjusting the tie-rods, not by removing and repositioning the steering wheel.
11. Set the cancel sleeve so that the projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7359
12. Carefully install the cable reel on the steering column shaft. Then connect the 3P connector to
the cable reel sub-harness, and connect the 2P
connector to the SRS main harness.
13. Install the steering column covers.
14. If necessary, center the cable reel. (New replacement cable reels come centered.) Do this by
first rotating the cable reel clockwise until it stops.
Then rotate it counterclockwise (approximately two and a half turns) until the arrow mark on the
cable reel label points straight up.
15. Install the steering wheel, then connect the horn connector and cruise control set/resume
switch connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Service Precautions > Page 7360
16. Install the steering wheel nut, and connect the horn connector to the steering wheel. Then
install the driver's airbag.
17. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connector to the connector holder. Then install the driver's
dashboard lower cover. 18. Reconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P
connector and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel. 19. Reconnect the battery positive
cable, then the negative cable. 20. After installing the cable reel, confirm proper system operation:
- Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator light should come on for about six seconds and
then go off.
- Make sure both horn buttons work.
- Make sure the headlight and wiper switches work.
- Go for a test drive, and make sure the cruise control switches work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Diagnostic Connector, Air Bag > Component
Information > Locations
Diagnostic Connector: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The impact sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Safing Sensor, Air Bag > Component Information >
Locations
Safing Sensor: Locations
The safing sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Locations
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Locations
SRS Indicator Light Power Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Power Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Control Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Control Circuit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7375
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7376
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7377
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7378
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7379
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7380
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7381
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7382
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7383
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7384
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7385
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7386
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7387
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7388
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7389
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7390
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7391
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
SRS Indicator Light Power Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Power Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Control Circuit
SRS Indicator Light Control Circuit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 7392
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Description and Operation
Self-diagnosis System
A self-diagnosis circuit is built into the SRS unit; when the ignition switch is turned ON (II), the SRS
indicator light comes on and goes off after about six seconds if the system is operating normally.
If the light does not come on, or does not go off after six seconds, or if it comes on while driving, it
indicates an abnormality in the system. The system must be inspected and repaired as soon as
possible.
For better serviceability, the memory will store the cause of the malfunction, and the data link circuit
passes on the information from the memory to the data link connector (DLC). This information can
be read with the Honda PGM Tester connected to the DLC (16P).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Testing and Inspection SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On.
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On (Part 1 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7395
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On (Part 2 Of 3)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7396
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On (Part 3 Of 3)
CAUTION: Whenever the ignition switch is ON (II), or has been turned OFF for less than three
minutes, be careful not to bump the SRS unit; the airbag(s) could accidentally deploy and cause
damage or injuries.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7397
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Testing and Inspection SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off 96 - 97 Models
CAUTION: Whenever the ignition switch is ON (II), or has been turned OFF for less than three
minutes, be careful not to bump the SRS unit; the airbags could accidentally deploy and cause
damage or injuries.
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off - '96 - 97 Models (Part 1 Of 5)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7398
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off - '96 - 97 Models (Part 2 Of 5)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7399
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off - '96 - 97 Models (Part 3 Of 5)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7400
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off - '96 - 97 Models (Part 4 Of 5)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Come On > Page 7401
The SRS Indicator Light Doesn't Go Off - '96 - 97 Models (Part 5 Of 5)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair
Child Seat: Service and Repair
Child Seat Anchor Plate
2 Door/4 Door
3 Door
Attachment points are provided for a rear seat mounted child restraint system which uses a top
tether. The attachment points are located on the rear shelf or rear trim panel, just behind the rear
seat-back. When using a child seat with a top tether, install the child seat anchor plates securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7405
NOTE:
- Do not remove the toothed washer from the child seat anchor plate. Use the child seat anchor
plate with the toothed washer attached to it.
- When installing a child seat on the rear seat, follow the instructions of the manufacturer of the
child seat.
- Additional anchor plates are available.
WARNING:
- Do not use the child seat anchor plate for any other purpose; it is designed exclusively for
installation of a child seat.
- Make sure the rear seat-back is locked firmly when installing a child seat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Knee Diverter: > 95055 > Dec > 95 > Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash Cover
Knee Diverter: Customer Interest Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash Cover
Bulletin No. 95-055
Issue Date DEC 18, 1995
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under BODY
Rattle From the Driver's Lower Dashboard Cover
SYMPTOM
A rattle from the driver's lower dashboard cover when the car is driven on a rough road.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Vibration of the knee bolster against the dashboard cover.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 10T:
P/N 06992-SA5-000, H/C 2086668
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 510001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 77893-S01-A00 H/C 4849840
Contention code: B07
Defect code: 045
Template ID: 95-055A
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 10T to the knee bolster.
NOTE:
SRS components are located near the repair area. Before you begin, review section 24 of the 1996
Civic Service Manual for SRS component locations, precautions, and procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Knee Diverter: > 95055 > Dec > 95 > Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash Cover > Page
7414
1. Remove the driver's lower dashboard cover.
2. Remove the knee bolster.
3. Cut two 20 x 20 mm pieces of EPT Sealer 10T.
4. Peel oft the backing, and attach the EPT Sealer 10T to the areas on opposite sides of both
bolster clips.
5. Reinstall the bolster and tighten its two bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
6. Reinstall the driver's lower dashboard cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Knee Diverter: > 95055 > Dec > 95 > Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash
Cover
Knee Diverter: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash Cover
Bulletin No. 95-055
Issue Date DEC 18, 1995
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under BODY
Rattle From the Driver's Lower Dashboard Cover
SYMPTOM
A rattle from the driver's lower dashboard cover when the car is driven on a rough road.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Vibration of the knee bolster against the dashboard cover.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 10T:
P/N 06992-SA5-000, H/C 2086668
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 510001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 77893-S01-A00 H/C 4849840
Contention code: B07
Defect code: 045
Template ID: 95-055A
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 10T to the knee bolster.
NOTE:
SRS components are located near the repair area. Before you begin, review section 24 of the 1996
Civic Service Manual for SRS component locations, precautions, and procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Knee Diverter: > 95055 > Dec > 95 > Interior - Rattle from Driver's Side Lower Dash
Cover > Page 7420
1. Remove the driver's lower dashboard cover.
2. Remove the knee bolster.
3. Cut two 20 x 20 mm pieces of EPT Sealer 10T.
4. Peel oft the backing, and attach the EPT Sealer 10T to the areas on opposite sides of both
bolster clips.
5. Reinstall the bolster and tighten its two bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
6. Reinstall the driver's lower dashboard cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 7421
Knee Bolster / Dashboard Lower Cover
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Knee Diverter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 7422
Knee Diverter: Description and Operation
Knee Bolster
The knee bolsters are used to absorb energy to protect knees and control the forward movement of
the vehicle's front seat occupants during a frontal crash, by limiting leg movement.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications
Air Bag Control Module: Specifications SRS Unit
SRS Unit
Torx Bolt(s) 9.8 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7427
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Behind Left Side of Front Console
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7428
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7429
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
Take extra care when painting or doing body work in the area below the dashboard. Avoid direct
exposure of the SRS unit or wiring to heat guns, welding, or spraying equipment.
Disconnect the airbag connector(s) before disconnecting SRS harness connectors.
After any degree of frontal body damage, or after a collision without airbag deployment, inspect the
SRS unit for physical damage. If it is dented, cracked, or deformed, replace it.
Be sure the SRS unit is installed securely.
Do not disassemble the SRS unit.
Store the SRS unit in a cool (less than about 104 °F / 40 °C) and dry (less than 80% humidity, no
moisture) place. Do not spill water or oil on the SRS unit, and keep it away from dust.
During installation or replacement, be careful not to bump (impact wrench, hammer, etc.) the area
around the SRS unit. The airbag(s) could accidentally deploy and cause damage or injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7430
Air Bag Control Module: Application and ID
96 - 97 Model SRS Units
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7431
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7432
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Before disconnecting any part of the SRS wire harness, disconnect the airbag connector(s).
- During installation or replacement, do not bump (impact wrench, hammer etc.) the area near the
SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not damage the SRS unit terminals or connectors.
- Do not disassemble the SRS unit; it has no serviceable parts.
- Store the SRS unit in a clean, dry area.
- Do not use any SRS unit which has been subjected to water or shows signs of being dropped or
improperly handled, such as dents, cracks or deformation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect the positive cable from the battery, and
wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag connector(s):
NOTE: When disconnected, the airbag connector is automatically shorted.
Driver's Side Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector
between the driver's airbag and cable reel.
Front Passenger's Side Disconnect the 2P connector between the front passenger's airbag and
SRS main harness.
3. Remove the right side cover from the SRS unit.
4. Remove the left side cover from the SRS unit, then disconnect the SRS main harness 18P
connector from the SRS unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7433
5. Remove the four Torx bolts from the SRS unit, then pull out the SRS unit from the driver's side.
6. Install the new SRS unit.
NOTE: Do not reuse a torx bolt that has red threads. Replace the bolt with a new one.
7. Connect the SRS main harness 8P connector to the SRS unit; push it into position until it clicks.
8. Install the SRS unit covers (right and left). Make sure the covers snap together in the middle. 9.
Reconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, then reinstall the
access panel on the steering wheel.
10. Reconnect the front passenger's airbag connector to the SRS main harness. 11. Reconnect the
battery positive cable, then the negative cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7434
12. After installing the SRS unit, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II);
the SRS indicator light should come on for about
six seconds and then go off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Locations > Page 7439
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7442
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 7443
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact > Page 7446
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7447
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Specifications
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Specifications Child Restraint
Child Restraint
Anchor Plate 22 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7452
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation
Attachment points are provided for a rear seat mounted child restraint system which uses a top
tether. The attachment points are located on the rear shelf, just behind the rear seat-back. When
using a child seat with a top tether, install the child seat anchor plates securely.
WARNING: Do not use the child seat anchor plate for any other purpose; it is designed exclusively
for installation of a child seat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 7453
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
2 Door / 4 Door
Child Seat Anchor Plate Attachment points are provided for a rear seat mounted child restraint
system which uses a top tether. The attachment points are located on the rear shelf or rear trim
panel, just behind the rear seat-back. When using a child seat with a top tether, install the child
seat anchor plates securely.
NOTE: Remove the plug covers from the attachment points of the rear shelf.
NOTE: - Do not remove the toothed washer from the child seat anchor plate. Use the child seat
anchor plate with the toothed washer attached to it. - When installing a child seat on the rear seat,
follow the instructions of the manufacturer of the child seat. - Additional anchor plates are available.
- Do not use the child seat anchor plate for any other purpose, it is designed exclusively for
installation of a child seat
- Make sure the rear seat-back is locked firmly when installing a child seat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
Seat Belt: Customer Interest Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
03-062
September 16, 2003
Applies To: ALL
Seat Belt Slow to Retract (Replaces 91-030, dated January 22, 1996)
SYMPTOM
The seat belt will not retract all the way, or retracts slowly.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Dirt on the seat belt webbing and guide.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Clean the seat belts and guides with a mild soap and water solution, or isopropyl alcohol. This
applies only to three-point active and passive seat belt systems, not to motorized systems.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Required only for three-point passive seat belts.
Teflon Tape (ten pieces per package):
P/N 81496-SH3-505, H/C 4008041
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
This repair is covered by the Lifetime Seat Belt Limited Warranty.
Failed Part: P/N 818AD-SM1-A05ZB
H/C 3478047
Defect Code: L11
Contention Code: B99
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE Three-Point Active Seat Belts
1. Use either isopropyl alcohol, or prepare a solution of 5 ounces of mild dishwashing liquid in a
gallon of warm water.
NOTICE
Do not use strong cleaning solutions, upholstery cleaners or commercial automotive interior
cleaners. They can affect the durability of the webbing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract > Page 7462
2. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner. Insert the cloth between the seat belt and metal loop on the
upper anchor. Use a credit card or similar item to help insert the cloth into the loop. Work the cloth
back and forth to clean the dirt out of the inside of the loop.
3. Pull the seat belt out fully. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner, and clean both sides of the seat belt
webbing. Dry the webbing thoroughly with a clean cloth. Do not use a hair dryer or similar device.
4. Test the belt for proper retraction by pulling the latch plate down to the floor of the vehicle and
then releasing it. The belt should retract fully in 4 seconds or less.
Three-Point Passive Seat Belts
1. Clean the metal loop in the upper anchor as described for Three-Point Active Seat Belts.
2. Remove the door panel and the seat belt guide. Refer to the appropriate service manual.
3. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner, and clean both sides of the seat belt webbing. Dry the webbing
thoroughly with a clean cloth. Do not use a hair dryer or similar device.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract > Page 7463
4. Clean and dry the seat belt guide, then put a piece of teflon tape on the inside. Use the teflon
tape specified in this service bulletin; other brands or types of tape may eventually peel off and
restrict seat belt movement.
5. Install the seat belt guide and the door panel.
6. Test the belt for proper retraction by pulling the latch plate down to the floor of the vehicle and
then releasing it. The belt should retract fully in four seconds or less.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt: > 93033 > Jun > 96 > Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button Broken
Seat Belt: Customer Interest Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button Broken
Bulletin No. 93-033
Issue Date JUNE 3, 1996
Model: 1992 and Later [NEW]
Applicable To: ALL except PASSPORT [NEW]
File Under: BODY
Broken Seat Belt Tongue Stopper Button (Supersedes 93-033, dated October 22, 1993)
PROBLEM
The seat belt tongue stopper button is broken, allowing the tongue to slide down to the floor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install a new seat belt tongue stopper button listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
1. Slide the seat belt tongue up the seat belt past the tongue stopper button hole. Temporarily
secure the seat belt tongue to the belt fabric with masking tape.
2. Insert the male section of the button through the hole in the belt fabric. Align and install the
female section of the stopper to the male section.
3. Preset the closed gap on a pair of vise-grip pliers to 4.5 mm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt: > 93033 > Jun > 96 > Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button Broken > Page
7468
4. Place the flat portion of the jaws over the tongue stopper, and squeeze until the vise-grip jaws
lock and deform the stopper shaft.
PARTS INFORMATION
Seat Belt Tongue Stopper:
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Warranty Coverage:
Seat belts that fail to function properly during normal use are covered under warranty for the useful
life of the car.
Warranty Does Not Cover:
^ Malfunction due to abuse, alteration, accidental damage or damage resulting from a collision or
misuse.
^ Replacement of a properly functioning seat belt for cosmetic or comfort reasons.
Operation number: 854125
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour (one or two sides)
Failed part: P/N 04814-SM1-AO2ZA [NEW] H/C 3919289
Defect code: L18
Contention code: A02
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
Seat Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
03-062
September 16, 2003
Applies To: ALL
Seat Belt Slow to Retract (Replaces 91-030, dated January 22, 1996)
SYMPTOM
The seat belt will not retract all the way, or retracts slowly.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Dirt on the seat belt webbing and guide.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Clean the seat belts and guides with a mild soap and water solution, or isopropyl alcohol. This
applies only to three-point active and passive seat belt systems, not to motorized systems.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Required only for three-point passive seat belts.
Teflon Tape (ten pieces per package):
P/N 81496-SH3-505, H/C 4008041
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
This repair is covered by the Lifetime Seat Belt Limited Warranty.
Failed Part: P/N 818AD-SM1-A05ZB
H/C 3478047
Defect Code: L11
Contention Code: B99
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE Three-Point Active Seat Belts
1. Use either isopropyl alcohol, or prepare a solution of 5 ounces of mild dishwashing liquid in a
gallon of warm water.
NOTICE
Do not use strong cleaning solutions, upholstery cleaners or commercial automotive interior
cleaners. They can affect the durability of the webbing.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
> Page 7474
2. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner. Insert the cloth between the seat belt and metal loop on the
upper anchor. Use a credit card or similar item to help insert the cloth into the loop. Work the cloth
back and forth to clean the dirt out of the inside of the loop.
3. Pull the seat belt out fully. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner, and clean both sides of the seat belt
webbing. Dry the webbing thoroughly with a clean cloth. Do not use a hair dryer or similar device.
4. Test the belt for proper retraction by pulling the latch plate down to the floor of the vehicle and
then releasing it. The belt should retract fully in 4 seconds or less.
Three-Point Passive Seat Belts
1. Clean the metal loop in the upper anchor as described for Three-Point Active Seat Belts.
2. Remove the door panel and the seat belt guide. Refer to the appropriate service manual.
3. Soak a clean cloth in the cleaner, and clean both sides of the seat belt webbing. Dry the webbing
thoroughly with a clean cloth. Do not use a hair dryer or similar device.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt: > 03-062 > Sep > 03 > Interior - Seat Belts Slow to Retract
> Page 7475
4. Clean and dry the seat belt guide, then put a piece of teflon tape on the inside. Use the teflon
tape specified in this service bulletin; other brands or types of tape may eventually peel off and
restrict seat belt movement.
5. Install the seat belt guide and the door panel.
6. Test the belt for proper retraction by pulling the latch plate down to the floor of the vehicle and
then releasing it. The belt should retract fully in four seconds or less.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt: > 93033 > Jun > 96 > Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button
Broken
Seat Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button Broken
Bulletin No. 93-033
Issue Date JUNE 3, 1996
Model: 1992 and Later [NEW]
Applicable To: ALL except PASSPORT [NEW]
File Under: BODY
Broken Seat Belt Tongue Stopper Button (Supersedes 93-033, dated October 22, 1993)
PROBLEM
The seat belt tongue stopper button is broken, allowing the tongue to slide down to the floor.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install a new seat belt tongue stopper button listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
1. Slide the seat belt tongue up the seat belt past the tongue stopper button hole. Temporarily
secure the seat belt tongue to the belt fabric with masking tape.
2. Insert the male section of the button through the hole in the belt fabric. Align and install the
female section of the stopper to the male section.
3. Preset the closed gap on a pair of vise-grip pliers to 4.5 mm.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt: > 93033 > Jun > 96 > Seat Belt - Tongue Stopper Button
Broken > Page 7480
4. Place the flat portion of the jaws over the tongue stopper, and squeeze until the vise-grip jaws
lock and deform the stopper shaft.
PARTS INFORMATION
Seat Belt Tongue Stopper:
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Warranty Coverage:
Seat belts that fail to function properly during normal use are covered under warranty for the useful
life of the car.
Warranty Does Not Cover:
^ Malfunction due to abuse, alteration, accidental damage or damage resulting from a collision or
misuse.
^ Replacement of a properly functioning seat belt for cosmetic or comfort reasons.
Operation number: 854125
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour (one or two sides)
Failed part: P/N 04814-SM1-AO2ZA [NEW] H/C 3919289
Defect code: L18
Contention code: A02
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7481
Seat Belt: Specifications Seat Belt Replacement
Seat Belt Replacement
Front Seat Belts Seat Belt Guide Bolts 9.8 Nm
Upper Anchor Bolt 32 Nm
Retractor Bolt 32 Nm
Retractor Mounting Bolt 9.8 Nm
Lower Anchor Bolt 32 Nm
Seat Belt Buckle Center Anchor Bolt 32 Nm
Rear Seat Belts Center Anchor Bolts 32 Nm
Retractor Bolt 32 Nm
Retractor Mounting Bolt 9.8 Nm
Seat Belt Buckle Center Anchor Bolt 32 Nm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7482
Seats And Seat Belts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7483
Seat Belt: Testing and Inspection
In-vehicle:
1. Check that the seat belt is not twisted or caught on anything. 2. After installing the anchors,
check for free movement on the anchor bolts. If necessary, remove the anchor bolts and check that
the washers and
other parts are not damaged or improperly installed.
3. Check the seat belts for damage or discoloration. Clean with a shop towel if necessary. Use only
soap and water to clean.
NOTE: Dirt build-up in the metal loops of the upper anchors can cause the seat belts to retract
slowly. Wipe the inside of the loops with a clean cloth dampened in isopropyl alcohol.
4. Check that the seat belt does not lock when pulled Out slowly. The seat belt is designed to lock
only during a sudden stop or impact. 5. Make sure that the seat belt will retract automatically when
released. 6. For each passenger's seat belt, make sure that the locking mechanism in the seat belt
retractor will engage when the seat belt is pulled all the way
out.
7. Replace the seat belt with a new one if there is any abnormality.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Front
CAUTION: Check the front seat belts for damage, and replace them if necessary. Be careful not to
damage them during removal and installation.
Front seat belt removal (4D):
1. Slide the front seat forward fully. 2. Remove the center pillar lower trim panel.
3. Remove the upper anchor cover and lower anchor cap. 4. Remove all the anchor bolts and the
retractor bolt, remove the retractor mounting bolt, then remove the front seat belt and retractor. 5.
Remove the center pillar upper trim.
6. Remove the shoulder anchor adjuster.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7486
Upper Anchor Bolt Construction
Lower Anchor Bolt Construction
Retractor Bolt Construction
7. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Check that the retractor locking mechanism functions as described.
- Make sure you assemble the washers and collars on the upper and lower anchor bolts as shown.
- Before installing the anchor bolts, make sure there are no twists or kinks in the front seat belt.
Front seat belt removal (2D/3D):
1. Slide the front seat forward fully. 2. Remove:
- Rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Rear center shelf and rear side shelf (3D)
- Rear trim panel (3D)
- Side trim panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7487
3. Remove the upper anchor cover and lower anchor cap. 4. Remove all the anchor bolts and the
retractor bolt, remove the retractor mounting bolt, then remove the front seat belt and retractor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7488
Upper Anchor Bolt Construction/Lower Anchor Bolt Construction/Retractor Bolt Construction
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Check that the retractor locking mechanism functions as described.
- Make sure you assemble the washers and collars on the upper and lower anchor bolts as shown.
- Before installing the anchor bolts, make sure there are no twists or kinks in the front seat belt.
Seat belt buckle removal:
1. Remove the front seat through the door opening. 2. Remove the center cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7489
3. Remove the center anchor bolt, then remove the seat belt buckle.
Center Anchor Bolt Construction
4. Driver's: Detach the seat belt switch connector and harness clip from the seat cushion. Remove
the seat cushion mounting bolts from the inner seat
track, and move the inner seat track, then pull the seat belt switch harness out.
NOTE: Take care not to damage the hinge bracket.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure you assemble the washers and bearing on the center anchor bolt as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7490
Seat Belt: Service and Repair Rear Seat Belt
CAUTION: Check the rear seat belts for damage, and replace them if necessary. Be careful not to
damage them during removal and installation.
Rear seat belt removal (2D/4D):
1. Remove:
- Rear seat cushion
- Rear seat-back (2D)
- Side trim panel (2D)
- Rear shelf
- Rear trim panel
- Trunk side trim, Japan-produced
- Trunk trim panel, USA-produced
2. Remove all the anchor bolts and retractor bolt, then remove the rear seat belt and retractor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7491
Upper Anchor Bolt Construction/Lower Anchor Bolt Construction/Retractor Bolt Construction
3. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Check that the retractor locking mechanism functions as described.
- Make sure you assemble the washers and collar on the upper anchor bolt as shown.
- Before installing the anchor bolt, make sure there are no twists or kinks in the rear seat belt.
Rear seat belt removal (3D):
1. Remove:
- Rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Rear center shelf and rear side shelf
- Rear trim panel and side trim panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7492
2. Remove the upper anchor cover.
3. Remove all the anchor bolts and retractor bolt, then remove the rear seat belt and retractor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7493
Upper Anchor Bolt Construction/Lower Anchor Bolt Construction/Retractor Bolt Construction
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Check that the retractor locking mechanism functions as described.
- Make sure you assemble the washers and collars on the upper anchor bolt as shown.
- Before installing the anchor bolt, make sure there are no twists or kinks in the rear seat belt.
Seat belt buckle/Center belt tongue removal:
1. Remove the rear seat cushion.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7494
2 Door/4 Door
3 Door
Center Anchor Bolt Construction
2. Remove the center anchor bolts, then remove the seat belt buckles and center belt tongue. 3.
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Before attaching the seat-back and seat cushion, make sure there are no twists or kinks in
the center belts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Seat Belt Buckle
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Front Seat Belt Buckle
1. Remove the front seat through the door opening. 2. Remove the center cover. 3. Remove the
center anchor bolt, then remove the seat belt buckle. 4. Driver's: Detach the seat belt switch
connector and harness clip from the seat cushion. Remove the seat cushion mounting bolts from
the inner seat
track, and move the inner seat track, then pull the seat belt switch harness out.
NOTE: Take care not to damage the hinge bracket.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure you assemble the washers and bearing on the center anchor bolt as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front Seat Belt Buckle > Page 7499
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Rear Seat Belt Buckle
2 Door / 4 Door Coupe-Sedan
Seat Belt Buckle / Center Belt Tongue
1. Remove the rear seat cushion. 2. Remove the center anchor bolts, then remove the seat belt
buckles and center belt tongue. 3. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Before attaching the seat-back and seat cushion, make sure there are no twists or kinks in
the center belts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7504
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7505
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7506
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7507
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7508
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7509
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7510
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7511
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7512
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7513
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7514
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7515
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7516
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7517
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7518
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7519
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7520
Seat Belt And Ignition Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 7521
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is applied to the seat belt reminder
light. When the seat belt is not buckled, the seat belt reminder/key-ON beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit senses ground through the closed seat belt switch. The seat belt reminder
light comes ON and stays ON, and the beeper beeps for 6 seconds. The reminder light and beeper
will stop when the seat belt is buckled or the timer circuit deactivates them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Seat Belt Retractor: Testing and Inspection
4 Door
2 Door / 4 Door
Retractor Inspection
1. Before installing the retractor, check that the seat belt can be pulled out freely. 2. Make sure that
the seat belt does not lock when the retractor is leaned slowly up to 150 from the mounted position.
The seat belt should lock when
the retractor is leaned over 400.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to disassemble the retractor.
3. Replace the seat belt with a new one if there is any abnormality.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
The impact sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Safing Sensor, Air Bag >
Component Information > Locations
Safing Sensor: Locations
The safing sensor is located inside the SRS Unit, refer to SRS Unit / Service and Repair.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Mast > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Antenna Mast: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect the connector between the antenna lead and sub antenna lead. 2. Remove the two
mounting screws, then remove the mast antenna.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations
Alarm Module: Locations
Rear of Radio
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm Module, (Vehicle
Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada > Page 7543
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Alarm System Transmitter: Service and Repair
Storing Transmitter Codes
- The codes of up to four transmitters can be stored in the control unit. (If a fifth code is stored, the
code which was stored first will be erased.)
- When the system enters the registration mode, all previously stored codes will be erased.
- The system leaves the registration mode and returns to the normal mode if you turn the valet switch OFF, or
- turn the ignition switch OFF, or
- do not press the transmitter button for more than 10 seconds.
Procedure
NOTE: It is important to maintain the time limits between steps.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Antitheft Lighting Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Lighting Relay: Locations
Upper Left Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Antitheft Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Antitheft Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7553
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7558
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7562
Keyless Entry Receiver: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the audio unit, then disconnect the A and B connectors.
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7563
Disconnect the A and B connectors from the audio unit.
Reconnect the B connector only to the audio unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Customer Interest Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function > Page 7572
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 98-011 Date: 040220
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
98-011
February 20, 2004
Applies To: ALL
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information (Supersedes 98-011, dated February 6, 2003)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and a black bar.
This service bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering,
and transmitter batteries. A remote transmitter quick reference guide is shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7578
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7579
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7580
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7581
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7582
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7583
Remote Transmitter Quick Reference Guide
90-93 Accord, 92-93 Civic & Prelude, 93 Del SOL
1990-93 Accord (2-door and 4-door) with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1993 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7584
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip in place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Press the reset button next to the ROM chip.
9. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter and install it in the new one.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
5319. This ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Order the additional transmitter from
American Honda.
If you have questions about how to order a four ROM chip set, call Alpine's parts department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7585
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Accord, Civic, Del SOL, Prelude & 95 Odyssey
1994-95 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
1995 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes, and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during this procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
column cover flashes when the system is in programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. Check that the parking lights flash to confirm that the
transmitter's code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. Check that the parking lights flash
after each transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
96-98 Civic EX & Except EX, Civic
1996-98 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7586
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to four transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM and CD/TAPE
buttons) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during this procedure, or
programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that you're in the
programming mode.
3. Within 5 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the transmitter. Check that the power
door locks cycle to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each of the remaining transmitters.
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit
programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Civic, 03-04 Accord, Element, Pilot
1999-00 Civic Value Package with factory-installed keyless entry system
1999-04 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*1999-03 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2002-04 Civic Si with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Civic Hybrid with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2004 Civic (except LX & EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Civic LX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7587
2003-04 Accord DX with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Element with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Element EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot EX models with factory-installed security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
91-93 Accord 5-D00R EX
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7588
1991-93 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry or dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
The transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the iN system. The
transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
91-93 Accord 5-Door LX
1991-93 Accord 5-door LX with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA only by authorized Honda dealers. Send
a completed order form (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer Parts
Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.) to this address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90501-5745
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7589
On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at (500)
552-4690, or fax them at (310) 595-1029 (weekdays from 5:30A.M. thru 4:00 P.M. Pacific time).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your dealership COD. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
94-97 Accord 5-Door EX, 95-98 Odyssey EX
1994-97 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1995-98 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
^ The system accepts up to two transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Push the driver's power door lock switch to the unlock position and hold it. (Continue to hold the
switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, then remove it. Repeat this four more times (five times
total) within 10 seconds. (You must complete steps 3 and 4 within 10 seconds or the system will
exit the programming mode.)
4. Insert the key into the ignition switch. After you insert the key, make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in the programming mode.
5. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. All the power door locks (except the
driver's door) should cycle to confirm that the system accepted the transmitter's code.
6. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter.
7. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
96-04 Accord, CRV, DelSOL, Ody., Prelude, S2000, Insight, Pilot
1996-02 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1998-02 Accord DX & LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7590
1997-01 CR-V with dealer-installed security system
1996-97 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1996-98 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
*1999-04 Odyssey LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
1996-01 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
*2000-04 S2000 with dealer-installed security system
2000-04 Insight with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7591
1997 Accord SE With Factory-Installed Security System
1997 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Accord EX & 00-02 Accord SE
1998-02 Accord EX with factory-installed security system
2000 and 2002 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7592
(Not interchangeable with CR-V and S2000 remote transmitter)
Transmitter Identification
The transmitter for the 1995-99 Accord and the 2000-02 Accord look identical, but they are not
interchangeable. The 1995-99 transmitter works the doors of a 2000-02 Accord, but it does not
open the trunk. If you are not sure which transmitter you have, press and hold the trunk release
button while looking at the LED. The LED on the 1995-99 transmitter comes on in about 1.1
seconds. The LED on the 2000-02 transmitter comes on in about 0.5 second.
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
03-04 Accord LX and EX
2003-04 Accord LX and EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7593
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1616. Each transmitter uses one battery.
97-04 CR-V & 00-04 S2000
*1997-04 CR-V LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1998-04 CR-V EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-01 CR-V SE with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-04 S2000 with factory-installed keyless entry system
2002-04 CR-V with dealer-installed security system*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7594
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete each step within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode. Program the transmitters within 10 seconds.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Odyssey EX
1999-00 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*2001-04 Odyssey EX models with factory- installed security system*
*Transmitter Identification
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7595
The 1999-00 transmitter is not interchangeable with the 2001-04 transmitter. To tell them apart,
look at the FCC ID on the back.
1999-00 - FCC ID: E4EG8DN
2001-04 - FCC ID: OUCG8D-440H-A*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from exiting
the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-01 Prelude With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
1999-01 Prelude with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7596
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
88-91 Prelude With Dealer-Installed Security System
1988-91 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7597
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
This transmitter is no longer available.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
97-99 EV Plus With Factory-Installed Security System
1997-99 EV Plus with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only through Tech Line.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
00-04 Insight With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
2000-04 Insight with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7598
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Passport (Except 1995-1/2)
1994-95 Passport (except 19951A) with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitters can be
accepted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7599
Programming the Transmitter
1. Locate the security system control unit under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst. This confirms that the system is in programming mode. The siren
then emits prompting chirps at 3-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If you
wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter, or wait
more than 30 seconds between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps and the
system exits the programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
9. Test all the transmitters.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7600
96-97 Passport With Dealer-Installed Security System
1996-97 Passport with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to two transmitters. If you program a
third transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter two times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only two transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
Programming the Transmitter
1. Move the driver's seat forward. Locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Use a pen or pencil to press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control
unit. When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front sidemarker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK, then to ON.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7601
6. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit until the LED on the
instrument panel begins to flash, then release the button. (Steps 6 and 7 must be done within 5
seconds of each other.)
7. Press and release the bottom button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps twice, and the front sidemarker lights flash twice to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. Test the transmitter you just programmed. If it doesn't work
repeat steps 2 thru 7.
9. If you have another transmitter to program, repeat steps 2 thru 7.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Passport With Factory-Installed Security System
1998-02 Passport with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
To program the transmitters, use one of these two procedures:
^ Procedure One cancels all learned transmitter codes and adds one new transmitter. None of the
previously programmed transmitters will work. Use this programming procedure only if all
transmitters were lost or stolen, or if a new control unit has been installed.
^ Procedure Two adds additional transmitters without cancelling any of the previously learned
codes. The system will accept up to four transmitters.
Procedure One (cancels all codes, adds one new transmitter)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position five times. Close and
open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks cycle
once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Procedure Two (adds transmitters)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7602
system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. Close
and open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Turning the Audible Chirp On/Off (1998-99 only)
NOTE:
On '00-02 Passports, the audible chirp sounds only when you push the LOCK button on the
transmitter a second time.
1. Open the driver's door, then insert the key in the driver's door lock.
2. Turn the key to the "LOCK" position, then to the "UNLOCK" position. Repeat this two more
times. (Complete this procedure within 10 seconds.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Within 10 seconds, turn the key to the "LOCK" position, and then to the "UNLOCK" position,
three times. Close and open the door once. Verify that the power door locks cycle once to confirm
that the chirp has been turned on/off.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
Keyless Entry Transmitter: All Technical Service Bulletins Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not
Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function > Page 7607
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-046 Date: 961021
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Bulletin No. 96-046
Issue Date OCT 21, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To Refer to the list below
File Under ACCESSORIES
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information
This Service Bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering*,
and transmitter batteries. A transmitter quick reference guide is included.
Use this index to find the information for the vehicle you are working on.
Vehicle: Procedure Number:
Civic
1992-93 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 8
del Sol
1993 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 7
Accord
1990-93 (except Wagon) 2
1991-93 EX Wagon 3
1991-93 LX Wagon 4
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1994-97 EX Wagon 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Prelude
1988-91 1
1992-93 (with optional security system) 2
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Odyssey
1995 (with optional security system) 5
1995-97 EX 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Passport
1994-95 (with optional security system,
not applicable to 1995.5 model) 9
1996-97 (with optional security system) 10
*Transmitter prices are subject to change without notice.
PARTS INFORMATION
Transmitter ordering information and battery part numbers are in each transmitter section.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7612
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This Service Bulletin is for information only.
TRANSMITTER QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE
Procedure 1
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7613
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Alpine of America by authorized Honda Dealers only.
Send a completed order form (found in Parts Information Bulletin A91 -0031) along with a dealer
check for $59.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this address:
Honda/Alpine V.S.S. P.O. Box 2859 Torrance, CA 90509
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 2
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7614
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip into place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter, and install it in the new one.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
8319. For each set ordered, send a dealer check for $24.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this
address:
Alpine Electronics of America 19145 Gramercy Place Torrance, CA 90501 Attention: Al Sula
(Parts)
Alpine's ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Additional transmitters can be ordered
from American Honda using normal parts ordering procedures.
If you have questions on how to order the four ROM chip set, call Alpine's Parts Department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7615
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 3
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the HONDANET 2000
system. The transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
Procedure 4
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7616
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA by authorized Honda Dealers only. Send
a completed order form,* (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer
Parts Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.), to this
address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90801-5745
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at
(800)852-4690, or Fax them at (310) 898-1029 (weekdays, from 8:30 A.M. thru 4:00 PM., PST).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your Dealership C.O.D. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
*On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
Procedure 5
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during the procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
wheel cover flashes when the system is in the programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. The parking lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's
code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. The parking lights flash after each
transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7617
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 6
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Press and hold the driver's door master power door lock switch up in the unlock position.
(Continue to hold the switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key in the ignition switch and remove it. Repeat this four more times within 10
seconds, then leave the key in the switch. Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that the
system is in the programming mode. (This step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
system will exit the programming mode.)
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that all power door locks
(except the driver's) cycle to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the system.
5. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter. (You can program two transmitters per vehicle.)
6. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 7
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7618
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on one of the transmitters. (A non-programmed
transmitter can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times with the transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
6. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the same transmitter. Check that the power door
locks cycle to confirm that you're in the programming mode.
7. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on each transmitter. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle) Check that the power door locks cycle after you push each transmitter
button, confirming that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 8
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7619
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM button and the
CD/TAPE button) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during the
procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm
that you're in the programming mode.
3. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the power door locks cycle
to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on all other transmitters. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle.)
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the
programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 9
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7620
1. Locate the security system control unit mounted under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst to confirm that you're in the programming mode. The siren then emits
prompting chirps at three-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to let you know that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If
you wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter or
between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps, and the system exits the
programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
9. Push all the function buttons on each transmitter to make sure they work correctly.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 10
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7621
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times,
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Move the driver's seat forward, and locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor,
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch on.
3. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit with a pen or pencil.
When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Check that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front marker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by
the control unit.
5. If you have other transmitters to program, repeat steps 3 and 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch off to exit the programming mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7622
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. One battery per transmitter is needed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 98-011 Date: 040220
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
98-011
February 20, 2004
Applies To: ALL
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information (Supersedes 98-011, dated February 6, 2003)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and a black bar.
This service bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering,
and transmitter batteries. A remote transmitter quick reference guide is shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7628
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7629
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7630
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7631
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7632
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7633
Remote Transmitter Quick Reference Guide
90-93 Accord, 92-93 Civic & Prelude, 93 Del SOL
1990-93 Accord (2-door and 4-door) with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1993 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7634
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip in place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Press the reset button next to the ROM chip.
9. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter and install it in the new one.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
5319. This ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Order the additional transmitter from
American Honda.
If you have questions about how to order a four ROM chip set, call Alpine's parts department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7635
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Accord, Civic, Del SOL, Prelude & 95 Odyssey
1994-95 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
1995 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes, and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during this procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
column cover flashes when the system is in programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. Check that the parking lights flash to confirm that the
transmitter's code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. Check that the parking lights flash
after each transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
96-98 Civic EX & Except EX, Civic
1996-98 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7636
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to four transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM and CD/TAPE
buttons) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during this procedure, or
programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that you're in the
programming mode.
3. Within 5 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the transmitter. Check that the power
door locks cycle to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each of the remaining transmitters.
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit
programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Civic, 03-04 Accord, Element, Pilot
1999-00 Civic Value Package with factory-installed keyless entry system
1999-04 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*1999-03 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2002-04 Civic Si with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Civic Hybrid with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2004 Civic (except LX & EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Civic LX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7637
2003-04 Accord DX with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Element with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Element EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot EX models with factory-installed security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
91-93 Accord 5-D00R EX
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7638
1991-93 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry or dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
The transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the iN system. The
transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
91-93 Accord 5-Door LX
1991-93 Accord 5-door LX with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA only by authorized Honda dealers. Send
a completed order form (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer Parts
Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.) to this address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90501-5745
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7639
On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at (500)
552-4690, or fax them at (310) 595-1029 (weekdays from 5:30A.M. thru 4:00 P.M. Pacific time).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your dealership COD. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
94-97 Accord 5-Door EX, 95-98 Odyssey EX
1994-97 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1995-98 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
^ The system accepts up to two transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Push the driver's power door lock switch to the unlock position and hold it. (Continue to hold the
switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, then remove it. Repeat this four more times (five times
total) within 10 seconds. (You must complete steps 3 and 4 within 10 seconds or the system will
exit the programming mode.)
4. Insert the key into the ignition switch. After you insert the key, make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in the programming mode.
5. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. All the power door locks (except the
driver's door) should cycle to confirm that the system accepted the transmitter's code.
6. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter.
7. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
96-04 Accord, CRV, DelSOL, Ody., Prelude, S2000, Insight, Pilot
1996-02 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1998-02 Accord DX & LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7640
1997-01 CR-V with dealer-installed security system
1996-97 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1996-98 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
*1999-04 Odyssey LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
1996-01 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
*2000-04 S2000 with dealer-installed security system
2000-04 Insight with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7641
1997 Accord SE With Factory-Installed Security System
1997 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Accord EX & 00-02 Accord SE
1998-02 Accord EX with factory-installed security system
2000 and 2002 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7642
(Not interchangeable with CR-V and S2000 remote transmitter)
Transmitter Identification
The transmitter for the 1995-99 Accord and the 2000-02 Accord look identical, but they are not
interchangeable. The 1995-99 transmitter works the doors of a 2000-02 Accord, but it does not
open the trunk. If you are not sure which transmitter you have, press and hold the trunk release
button while looking at the LED. The LED on the 1995-99 transmitter comes on in about 1.1
seconds. The LED on the 2000-02 transmitter comes on in about 0.5 second.
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
03-04 Accord LX and EX
2003-04 Accord LX and EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7643
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1616. Each transmitter uses one battery.
97-04 CR-V & 00-04 S2000
*1997-04 CR-V LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1998-04 CR-V EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-01 CR-V SE with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-04 S2000 with factory-installed keyless entry system
2002-04 CR-V with dealer-installed security system*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7644
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete each step within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode. Program the transmitters within 10 seconds.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Odyssey EX
1999-00 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*2001-04 Odyssey EX models with factory- installed security system*
*Transmitter Identification
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7645
The 1999-00 transmitter is not interchangeable with the 2001-04 transmitter. To tell them apart,
look at the FCC ID on the back.
1999-00 - FCC ID: E4EG8DN
2001-04 - FCC ID: OUCG8D-440H-A*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from exiting
the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-01 Prelude With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
1999-01 Prelude with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7646
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
88-91 Prelude With Dealer-Installed Security System
1988-91 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7647
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
This transmitter is no longer available.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
97-99 EV Plus With Factory-Installed Security System
1997-99 EV Plus with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only through Tech Line.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
00-04 Insight With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
2000-04 Insight with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7648
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Passport (Except 1995-1/2)
1994-95 Passport (except 19951A) with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitters can be
accepted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7649
Programming the Transmitter
1. Locate the security system control unit under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst. This confirms that the system is in programming mode. The siren
then emits prompting chirps at 3-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If you
wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter, or wait
more than 30 seconds between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps and the
system exits the programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
9. Test all the transmitters.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7650
96-97 Passport With Dealer-Installed Security System
1996-97 Passport with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to two transmitters. If you program a
third transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter two times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only two transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
Programming the Transmitter
1. Move the driver's seat forward. Locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Use a pen or pencil to press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control
unit. When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front sidemarker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK, then to ON.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7651
6. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit until the LED on the
instrument panel begins to flash, then release the button. (Steps 6 and 7 must be done within 5
seconds of each other.)
7. Press and release the bottom button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps twice, and the front sidemarker lights flash twice to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. Test the transmitter you just programmed. If it doesn't work
repeat steps 2 thru 7.
9. If you have another transmitter to program, repeat steps 2 thru 7.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Passport With Factory-Installed Security System
1998-02 Passport with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
To program the transmitters, use one of these two procedures:
^ Procedure One cancels all learned transmitter codes and adds one new transmitter. None of the
previously programmed transmitters will work. Use this programming procedure only if all
transmitters were lost or stolen, or if a new control unit has been installed.
^ Procedure Two adds additional transmitters without cancelling any of the previously learned
codes. The system will accept up to four transmitters.
Procedure One (cancels all codes, adds one new transmitter)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position five times. Close and
open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks cycle
once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Procedure Two (adds transmitters)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 7652
system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. Close
and open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Turning the Audible Chirp On/Off (1998-99 only)
NOTE:
On '00-02 Passports, the audible chirp sounds only when you push the LOCK button on the
transmitter a second time.
1. Open the driver's door, then insert the key in the driver's door lock.
2. Turn the key to the "LOCK" position, then to the "UNLOCK" position. Repeat this two more
times. (Complete this procedure within 10 seconds.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Within 10 seconds, turn the key to the "LOCK" position, and then to the "UNLOCK" position,
three times. Close and open the door once. Verify that the power door locks cycle once to confirm
that the chirp has been turned on/off.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-046 Date: 961021
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Bulletin No. 96-046
Issue Date OCT 21, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To Refer to the list below
File Under ACCESSORIES
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information
This Service Bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering*,
and transmitter batteries. A transmitter quick reference guide is included.
Use this index to find the information for the vehicle you are working on.
Vehicle: Procedure Number:
Civic
1992-93 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 8
del Sol
1993 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 7
Accord
1990-93 (except Wagon) 2
1991-93 EX Wagon 3
1991-93 LX Wagon 4
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1994-97 EX Wagon 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Prelude
1988-91 1
1992-93 (with optional security system) 2
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Odyssey
1995 (with optional security system) 5
1995-97 EX 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Passport
1994-95 (with optional security system,
not applicable to 1995.5 model) 9
1996-97 (with optional security system) 10
*Transmitter prices are subject to change without notice.
PARTS INFORMATION
Transmitter ordering information and battery part numbers are in each transmitter section.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7657
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This Service Bulletin is for information only.
TRANSMITTER QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE
Procedure 1
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7658
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Alpine of America by authorized Honda Dealers only.
Send a completed order form (found in Parts Information Bulletin A91 -0031) along with a dealer
check for $59.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this address:
Honda/Alpine V.S.S. P.O. Box 2859 Torrance, CA 90509
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 2
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7659
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip into place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter, and install it in the new one.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
8319. For each set ordered, send a dealer check for $24.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this
address:
Alpine Electronics of America 19145 Gramercy Place Torrance, CA 90501 Attention: Al Sula
(Parts)
Alpine's ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Additional transmitters can be ordered
from American Honda using normal parts ordering procedures.
If you have questions on how to order the four ROM chip set, call Alpine's Parts Department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7660
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 3
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the HONDANET 2000
system. The transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
Procedure 4
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7661
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA by authorized Honda Dealers only. Send
a completed order form,* (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer
Parts Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.), to this
address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90801-5745
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at
(800)852-4690, or Fax them at (310) 898-1029 (weekdays, from 8:30 A.M. thru 4:00 PM., PST).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your Dealership C.O.D. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
*On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
Procedure 5
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during the procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
wheel cover flashes when the system is in the programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. The parking lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's
code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. The parking lights flash after each
transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7662
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 6
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Press and hold the driver's door master power door lock switch up in the unlock position.
(Continue to hold the switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key in the ignition switch and remove it. Repeat this four more times within 10
seconds, then leave the key in the switch. Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that the
system is in the programming mode. (This step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
system will exit the programming mode.)
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that all power door locks
(except the driver's) cycle to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the system.
5. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter. (You can program two transmitters per vehicle.)
6. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 7
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7663
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on one of the transmitters. (A non-programmed
transmitter can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times with the transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
6. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the same transmitter. Check that the power door
locks cycle to confirm that you're in the programming mode.
7. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on each transmitter. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle) Check that the power door locks cycle after you push each transmitter
button, confirming that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 8
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7664
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM button and the
CD/TAPE button) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during the
procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm
that you're in the programming mode.
3. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the power door locks cycle
to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on all other transmitters. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle.)
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the
programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 9
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7665
1. Locate the security system control unit mounted under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst to confirm that you're in the programming mode. The siren then emits
prompting chirps at three-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to let you know that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If
you wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter or
between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps, and the system exits the
programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
9. Push all the function buttons on each transmitter to make sure they work correctly.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 10
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7666
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times,
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Move the driver's seat forward, and locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor,
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch on.
3. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit with a pen or pencil.
When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Check that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front marker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by
the control unit.
5. If you have other transmitters to program, repeat steps 3 and 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch off to exit the programming mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless
Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 7667
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. One battery per transmitter is needed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7668
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- If the doors unlock or lock with the transmitter, but the LED on the transmitter does not come on,
the LED is faulty; replace the transmitter.
- If any door is open, you cannot lock or unlock the door with the transmitter.
- If you unlocked the doors with the transmitter, but do not open any of the doors within 30
seconds, the doors relock automatically.
- The doors do not lock or unlock with the transmitter if the ignition key is inserted in the ignition
switch.
1. Using a keyless entry checker (07MAJ - SP00300):
- Place the transmitter on the keyless entry checker, and press the transmitter button. If the indicator light does not come on, check for: a dead or low battery
- Faulty transmitter
- If the ray indicator light comes on, the transmitter is OK.
NOTE: After a transmitter battery has been replaced, aim the transmitter at the receiver, and press
the transmitter button six times. Confirm you can hear the sound of the door lock actuators when
you press the sixth time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry >
Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7669
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair
Storing Transmitter Codes
- The codes of up to four transmitters can be stored in the control unit. (If a fifth code is stored, the
code which was stored first will be erased.)
- When the system enters the registration mode, all previously stored codes will be erased.
- The system leaves the registration mode and returns to the normal mode if you turn the valet switch OFF, or
- turn the ignition switch OFF, or
- do not press the transmitter button for more than 10 seconds.
Procedure
NOTE: It is important to maintain the time limits between steps.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
DVD Player: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Adhesive Labels or Protective Disc Covers on CDs or
DVDs:
A Big Taboo
NOTE:
This article applies to all Honda models with a factory- or dealer-installed CD/DVD player or
changer.
We can't emphasize this enough: Never put adhesive labels or protective disc covers on
recordable CDs or DVDs to be used in automotive CD/DVD players or changers. Here's why:
^ Recordable CDs and DVDs are actually thicker than their pre-recorded brethern. Automotive
players and changers use rollers to draw the disc into the
unit. The added thickness of an adhesive label or a protective disc cover can cause the disc to jam
when it's loaded into or ejected from the unit.
^ CD/DVD players or changers are exposed to high temperatures inside the vehicle. High
temperature can cause the label adhesive to soften. This can
cause the label to curl on the edges and even form bubbles. Curled edges can catch on the rollers
and bubbles add thickness to the disc. Either one can cause the disc to jam.
To cut down on customer-caused damage, all '05 and later 0/Ms include this notice:
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the CD to jam in the unit.
Anytime a service customer comes in with a loading or ejecting problem for a CD/DVD player or
changer, ask if he or she used any discs with adhesive labels or protective disc covers. If the
answer is yes, contact your DPSM for possible goodwill assistance. If the answer is no, then
replace the audio unit under normal warranty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7680
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7681
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7682
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7683
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7684
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7685
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7686
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7687
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7688
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7689
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7690
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7691
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7692
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7693
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7694
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7695
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7696
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7697
Integrated Control Unit: Electrical Diagrams
Integrated Control Unit Part 1 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7698
Integrated Control Unit Part 2 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7699
Integrated Control Unit (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7700
Integrated Control Unit (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7701
Integrated Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
All Systems
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7702
Intermittent Wiper System
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes
Compact Disc Player (CD): Customer Interest Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes
00-015
March 14, 2000
Applies To: All with CD Player/Changer
Audio Unit Error Codes (Replaces 91-007, dated October 6, 1997)
*If the audio unit displays an error code, use the troubleshooting tables in this service bulletin to
troubleshoot the problem. Refer to service bulletin 98-019 for CD Player/Changer exchange
information.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7712
CD Changer Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
CD Player Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Radio Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7713
CD Player/Changer Troubleshooting (Passport only)
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (All except Passport)
One-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the rear cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed disc.
3. If a disc is jammed between the player and the magazine, turn the loading gear until the disc
returns to the player mechanism. Do not attempt to reload the disc back into the magazine.
4. After the disc is loaded into the player mechanism, turn the changer so that the front is facing
you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7714
5. Insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1-1/2" from the right
side of the opening.
6. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
7. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed tray.
3. If a tray is stuck in the player, reinstall the cover and replace the changer. If all the trays are in
the magazine, insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from
the right side of the opening.
4. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
5. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7715
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (Passport only)
One-piece door model:
1. Open the changer door.
2. Check to see if all the trays are in the magazine.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and inspect for a jammed tray.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Handling and Inspecting Compact Discs
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit
with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7716
^ Handle a CD by its edges; never touch the flat surfaces. Contamination from fingerprints, liquids,
felt-tip pens, and labels can cause the CD to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
^ When cleaning a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside.
Do not wipe the disc in a circular motion.
^ A new CD may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this
roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other
problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or
pen.
^ Various accessories are available to protect CDs and improve the sound quality of CDs. These
accessories increase the thickness or diameter of the discs, and should not be used in CD
changers.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > SN051000-07 > Oct > 05 > Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Adhesive Labels or Protective Disc Covers on CDs or
DVDs:
A Big Taboo
NOTE:
This article applies to all Honda models with a factory- or dealer-installed CD/DVD player or
changer.
We can't emphasize this enough: Never put adhesive labels or protective disc covers on
recordable CDs or DVDs to be used in automotive CD/DVD players or changers. Here's why:
^ Recordable CDs and DVDs are actually thicker than their pre-recorded brethern. Automotive
players and changers use rollers to draw the disc into the
unit. The added thickness of an adhesive label or a protective disc cover can cause the disc to jam
when it's loaded into or ejected from the unit.
^ CD/DVD players or changers are exposed to high temperatures inside the vehicle. High
temperature can cause the label adhesive to soften. This can
cause the label to curl on the edges and even form bubbles. Curled edges can catch on the rollers
and bubbles add thickness to the disc. Either one can cause the disc to jam.
To cut down on customer-caused damage, all '05 and later 0/Ms include this notice:
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the CD to jam in the unit.
Anytime a service customer comes in with a loading or ejecting problem for a CD/DVD player or
changer, ask if he or she used any discs with adhesive labels or protective disc covers. If the
answer is yes, contact your DPSM for possible goodwill assistance. If the answer is no, then
replace the audio unit under normal warranty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer Error Codes
00-015
March 14, 2000
Applies To: All with CD Player/Changer
Audio Unit Error Codes (Replaces 91-007, dated October 6, 1997)
*If the audio unit displays an error code, use the troubleshooting tables in this service bulletin to
troubleshoot the problem. Refer to service bulletin 98-019 for CD Player/Changer exchange
information.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7726
CD Changer Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
CD Player Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Radio Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7727
CD Player/Changer Troubleshooting (Passport only)
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (All except Passport)
One-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the rear cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed disc.
3. If a disc is jammed between the player and the magazine, turn the loading gear until the disc
returns to the player mechanism. Do not attempt to reload the disc back into the magazine.
4. After the disc is loaded into the player mechanism, turn the changer so that the front is facing
you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7728
5. Insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1-1/2" from the right
side of the opening.
6. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
7. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed tray.
3. If a tray is stuck in the player, reinstall the cover and replace the changer. If all the trays are in
the magazine, insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from
the right side of the opening.
4. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
5. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7729
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (Passport only)
One-piece door model:
1. Open the changer door.
2. Check to see if all the trays are in the magazine.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and inspect for a jammed tray.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Handling and Inspecting Compact Discs
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 00-015 > Mar > 00 > Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 7730
^ Handle a CD by its edges; never touch the flat surfaces. Contamination from fingerprints, liquids,
felt-tip pens, and labels can cause the CD to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
^ When cleaning a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside.
Do not wipe the disc in a circular motion.
^ A new CD may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this
roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other
problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or
pen.
^ Various accessories are available to protect CDs and improve the sound quality of CDs. These
accessories increase the thickness or diameter of the discs, and should not be used in CD
changers.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Compact Disc Player
(CD): > SN051000-07 > Oct > 05 > Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Adhesive Labels or Protective Disc Covers on CDs or
DVDs:
A Big Taboo
NOTE:
This article applies to all Honda models with a factory- or dealer-installed CD/DVD player or
changer.
We can't emphasize this enough: Never put adhesive labels or protective disc covers on
recordable CDs or DVDs to be used in automotive CD/DVD players or changers. Here's why:
^ Recordable CDs and DVDs are actually thicker than their pre-recorded brethern. Automotive
players and changers use rollers to draw the disc into the
unit. The added thickness of an adhesive label or a protective disc cover can cause the disc to jam
when it's loaded into or ejected from the unit.
^ CD/DVD players or changers are exposed to high temperatures inside the vehicle. High
temperature can cause the label adhesive to soften. This can
cause the label to curl on the edges and even form bubbles. Curled edges can catch on the rollers
and bubbles add thickness to the disc. Either one can cause the disc to jam.
To cut down on customer-caused damage, all '05 and later 0/Ms include this notice:
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the CD to jam in the unit.
Anytime a service customer comes in with a loading or ejecting problem for a CD/DVD player or
changer, ask if he or she used any discs with adhesive labels or protective disc covers. If the
answer is yes, contact your DPSM for possible goodwill assistance. If the answer is no, then
replace the audio unit under normal warranty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Radio/Stereo: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio Display is Blank/Does Not Function
Radio/Stereo: Customer Interest Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Radio/Stereo: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio Display is Blank/Does Not Function > Page 7744
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Radio/Stereo: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
Radio/Stereo: All Technical Service Bulletins Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Radio/Stereo: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function > Page 7750
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A
Radio/Stereo: Locations Connector A
Rear of Radio
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A > Page 7753
Radio/Stereo: Locations Connector B
Rear of Radio
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radio/Stereo: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7756
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7757
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7758
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7759
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7760
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7761
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7762
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7763
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7764
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7765
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7766
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7767
Radio/Stereo: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7768
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7769
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7770
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7771
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7772
Radio/Stereo: Connector Views
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7773
Stereo Radio Tuner Terminals
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7774
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7775
Radio/Stereo: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7776
Part 2 of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7777
Radio/Stereo: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the audio unit, then disconnect the A and B connectors.
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7778
Disconnect the A and B connectors from the audio unit.
Reconnect the B connector only to the audio unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coded Theft Protection Audio Units
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair Coded Theft Protection Audio Units
NOTE:The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
- disconnecting the battery.
- removing the radio fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box.
- removing the radio.
After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word "CODE" is displayed,
enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio operation.
For information on how to obtain the code in the event the customer does not have the code please
refer to the TSB below.
TSB # 98-026
April 15, 1998
Applies To: ALL with Anti-Theft Audio Units
Audio Unit Anti-Theft Code Labels
BACKGROUND
This service bulletin describes where to attach the audio unit anti-theft labels that come in the glove
box of vehicles equipped with anti-theft audio systems.
If a vehicle has an anti-theft audio system, there are three peel-off labels in the glove box. Two of
the labels have both the anti-theft code and the audio unit's serial number, and a third label
contains only the serial number for the audio unit.
During Pre Delivery Inspection, stick the label with only the serial number on the glove box. If the
radio code ever needs to be retrieved through the HONDANET 2000 system, this will save you the
time and labor of removing the audio unit to record the serial number.
NOTES:
- Also perform this procedure when installing an accessory audio unit that is equipped with an
anti-theft system.
- If a remanufactured audio unit is installed in a vehicle, remove the old labels and install new ones
on the glove box, Radio Identification Card, and the vehicle's service records.
- If the glove box is ever replaced, transfer the labels from the old glove box to the new one.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This bulletin is for information only.
Skill level: Maintenance Technician
PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coded Theft Protection Audio Units > Page 7781
1. Stick the label containing only the serial number information on the glove box.
2. Stick the remaining two labels on the Anti-Theft Radio Identification Card and on the vehicle's
service records.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coded Theft Protection Audio Units > Page 7782
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair Stereo Radio Tuner
1. Remove the center dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the two mounting bolts, and pull the
stereo radio tuner out.
3. Disconnect the 16P connectors, sub antenna lead and DIN cord (with cassette player), then
remove the stereo radio tuner.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Coded Theft Protection Audio Units > Page 7783
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair Cassette Player
1. Remove the front console panel. 2. Remove the DIN cord from the stereo radio tuner.
3. Remove the four mounting bolts, then remove the cassette player.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Speaker: Service and Repair
Front speaker:
1. Remove the speaker cover. 2. Remove the three screws from the speaker. 3. Disconnect the 2P
connector, and remove the door speaker.
Tweeter:
1. Remove the door panel. 2. Disconnect the 2P connector from the tweeter. 3. Remove the mirror
garnish. 4. Remove the two screws, then remove the tweeter.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7787
Hatchback/Coupe/Sedan
Rear speaker:
1. Remove the rear side shelf or rear shelf. 2. Disconnect the 2P connector from the speaker. 3.
Remove the four screws, then remove the speaker.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Locations
Alarm Module: Locations
Rear of Radio
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Alarm Module, (Vehicle Antitheft) > Component Information > Diagrams > Canada > Page 7794
Security Control Unit
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antitheft Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Lighting Relay: Locations
Upper Left Kick Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antitheft Relay > Component Information > Locations
Antitheft Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antitheft Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7801
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7807
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7808
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7809
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7810
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7811
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7812
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7813
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7814
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7815
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7816
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7817
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7818
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7819
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7820
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7821
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7822
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7823
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7824
Integrated Control Unit: Electrical Diagrams
Integrated Control Unit Part 1 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7825
Integrated Control Unit Part 2 0f 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7826
Integrated Control Unit (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 7827
Integrated Control Unit (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7828
Integrated Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
All Systems
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Integrated Control Unit <--> [General Module] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7829
Intermittent Wiper System
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7833
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Locations
Integrated Control Unit: Locations
Rear Of Under-dash Fuse/Relay Box
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Integrated Control Unit: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7841
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7842
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7843
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7844
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7845
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7846
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7847
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7848
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7849
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7850
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7851
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7852
Integrated Control Unit: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7853
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7854
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7855
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Integrated Control Unit <--> [Body Control Module]
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7856
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > System Information > Description and Operation
Front Bumper: Description and Operation
Bumper and Door Reinforcement Beams
Bumper and door reinforcement beams used on Honda automobiles are made from high strength
steel.
Should high strength steel be heated, the strength of the steel will be reduced. If high strength steel
is damaged, as in an accident where the bumper or door reinforcement beams are bent, the beams
may crack should any attempt be made to straighten them.
For this reason, bumper and door reinforcement beams should never be repaired; they should be
replaced if they become damaged.
NOTE: If a door beam is damaged, the whole door panel assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > System Information > Description and Operation
> Page 7861
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > System Information > Description and Operation
Rear Bumper: Description and Operation
Bumper and Door Reinforcement Beams
Bumper and door reinforcement beams used on Honda automobiles are made from high strength
steel.
Should high strength steel be heated, the strength of the steel will be reduced. If high strength steel
is damaged, as in an accident where the bumper or door reinforcement beams are bent, the beams
may crack should any attempt be made to straighten them.
For this reason, bumper and door reinforcement beams should never be repaired; they should be
replaced if they become damaged.
NOTE: If a door beam is damaged, the whole door panel assembly should be replaced.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > System Information > Description and Operation
> Page 7865
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation
Cowl: Description and Operation
Description
Impact damage to the windshield lower area may spread to the back of the panel and wiper
mounting area, calling for replacement of the affected skins.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7869
Cowl: Service and Repair
Replacement
1. Remove the related parts.
- Wiper arm and motor
- Windshield
- Right and left front fenders
- Right and left front door opening trims
- Front pillar trim
- Hood
- Wire harnesses and electrical accessories
- Steering column
- Dashboard, etc
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7870
2. Cut the windshield lower and separate the welded flange.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints.
- Drill holes with a spot cutter through the nuggets.
- Peel off the welding flange using a chisel.
- Level off and finish the burrs of the pried-off spot welds with a sander
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cuffing or
grinding.
3. Set the new windshield lower.
- Apply an undercoat and body paint to the inside.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Sand off the undercoat down to the metal from both flanges to be welded.
- Clamp the new windshield lower in place with vise- grips and squill vises.
NOTE: Apply the spot sealer to the welding surface when spot welding.
- Install the new windshield and check for proper installation and alignment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7871
4. Tack weld the new windshield lower.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and burns when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
- Remove the vise-grips and install the fender and hood. Check for differences in level and
clearance.
5. Perform the main welding.
- Make 20% to 30% more spot welds than there were holes drilled.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
6. Finish the welding section.
Smooth the mating surface with the windshield with a hammer and dolly.
7. Apply the sealer.
Apply sealer to the upper dashboard, pillars, etc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7872
8. Install the front fender and hood.
Check the front fender and hood for differences in level and clearance.
9. Apply the paint.
See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
10. Apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the windshield lower and dashboard upper.
11. Install the related parts.
Install in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Take care not damage the windshield and the paint finishes.
12. Inspect and clean.
- Check the windshield for water leaks.
- After installing the dashboard, check the lights, gauges, etc. for proper operation.
- Clean the interior.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door
Front Door Handle: Service and Repair Front Door
NOTE: Raise the glass fully.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Pull out the retainer clip.
3. Remove the bolts, then remove the cylinder protector, lock cylinder and outer handle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door > Page 7880
4. Pull out the outer handle. Pry the outer handle rod out of its joint using diagonal cutters.
NOTE: To ease reassembly, note location (A) of the outer handle rod on the joint before disconnecting it.
- Take care not to bend the outer handle rod.
- Use a shop towel to protect the opening in the door.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the door locks and opens properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door > Page 7881
Front Door Handle: Service and Repair Door
NOTE: Raise the glass fully.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Pull out the retainer clip.
3. Remove the bolts, then remove the cylinder protector, lock cylinder and outer handle.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Door > Page 7882
4. Pull out the outer handle. Pry the outer handle rod out of its joint using diagonal cutters.
NOTE: To ease reassembly, note location (A) of the outer handle rod on the joint before disconnecting it.
- Take care not to bend the outer handle rod.
- Use a shop towel to protect the opening in the door.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the door locks and opens properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Front Door
NOTE: Raise the glass fully.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
- Outer handle
2. Remove the bolt, then move the center lower channel forward.
3. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip from the door. Remove the latch through
the hole in the door.
NOTE: Take care not to bend the inner handle rod, outer handle rod, cylinder rod and lock rod.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the inner handle rod and connector are connected properly.
- Make sure the door locks and opens properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door > Page 7887
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair Door
NOTE: Raise the glass fully.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
- Outer handle
2. Remove the rod protector.
3. Remove the bolts and move the center lower channel.
NOTE: Take care not to bend the inner handle rod and lock rods.
4. Remove the inner handle, then remove the latch through the hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Front Door > Page 7888
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the door locks and opens properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair
Front Door Index - 4 Door (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7892
Front Door Index - 4 Door (Part 2 Of 2)
Door Panel Replacement
CAUTION: Take care not to scratch the door panel and other parts.
1. Remove:
- Inner handle.
- Mirror mount cover panel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7893
2. If applicable, remove the regulator handle by pulling the clip out with a wire hook.
3. Remove the door grip cover and speaker cover, then remove the screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7894
4. Release the clips that hold the door panel. Remove the door panel by pulling it upward.
NOTE: Remove the door panel with as little bending as possible to avoid creasing or breaking it.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Striker >
System Information > Adjustments
Front Door Striker: Adjustments
Make sure the door latches securely without slamming. If it needs adjustment:
NOTE: The striker nuts are fixed, but the striker can be adjusted slightly up or down, and in or out.
1. Loosen the screws, then insert a shop towel between the body and striker. 2. Lightly tighten the
screws. 3. Wrap the striker with a shop towel, then adjust the striker by tapping it with a plastic
hammer.
CAUTION: Do not tap the striker too hard.
4. Loosen the screws, and remove the shop towel. 5. Lightly tighten the screws. 6. Hold the outer
handle out, and push the door against the body to be sure the striker allows a flush fit. If the door
latches properly, tighten the
screws and recheck.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments
Front Door Window Glass: Adjustments
Glass Adjustment
NOTE:
- Place the vehicle on a firm, level surface when adjusting the glass.
- Check the weatherstrips and glass run channel for damage or deterioration, and replace them if
necessary.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Adjust the glass.
4D: a. Raise the glass fully. b. Loosen the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting
bolts. c. Push the glass rearward (front door glass) or forward (rear door glass).
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7901
Rear
d. Tighten the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting bolts. e. Loosen the front
channel mounting bolts (front door) or rear channel mounting bolt (rear door). f.
Lower the glass.
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7902
Rear
g. Push the front or rear channels against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
2D/3D: a. Raise the glass as far up as possible, and hold it against the glass run channel.
b. Loosen the roller guide bolts, and adjust the glass so it is parallel with the glass run channel. c.
Tighten the roller guide bolts. d. Loosen the front channel bolts. e. Lower the glass.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7903
f. Push the front channel against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
3. Check that the glass moves smoothly. 4. Raise the glass fully and check for gaps.
5. Check the glass operation.
NOTE: Check that the glass contacts the glass run channel evenly.
6. Check for water leaks.
Spray water over the roof and on the sealing area as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7904
NOTE: Adjust the water pressure as shown.
- Do not squeeze the tip of the hose.
7. Attach the plastic cover, then install the door panel.
8. Install the regulator handle so it points forward and up at a 45 degree angle with the glass
closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7905
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them. Carefully pull the glass
out through the window slot.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7906
3. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
4. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown. 5. Installation is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass
> System Information > Adjustments > Page 7907
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor
> Component Information > Locations
Front Door Window Motor: Locations
Front of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
Glass/Regulator Replacement
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them. Carefully pull the glass
out through the window slot.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7914
3. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
4. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown. 5. Installation is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7915
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Exterior
Handle: > 00-013 > Feb > 00 > Rear Doors - Hard To Open
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Customer Interest Rear Doors - Hard To Open
00-013
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All 4-door models
Rear Doors Are Hard to Open
SYMPTOM One or both rear doors are difficult to open. The door handle needs to be lifted
abnormally high to release the latch.
PROBABLE CAUSE The rear outer handle rods are misadjusted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Adjust the appropriate rear outer handle rod.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 818306
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour - one door
Failed Part: P/N 75411-634-000 H/C 0564898
Detect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 00-013A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear door panel and pull the plastic cover down to access the door handle.
2. Remove the three latch mounting screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Rear Door Exterior
Handle: > 00-013 > Feb > 00 > Rear Doors - Hard To Open > Page 7926
3. Pull the latch assembly down, and remove the door handle mounting bolts.
4. Pull the outer handle away from the door. Do not disconnect the outer handle rod. Place a shop
towel in the door handle opening to protect the door from getting scratched.
5. Turn the outer handle assembly counterclockwise to adjust the outer handle rod. The end of the
rod should be flush with the joint or no more than 1 mm beyond it.
6. Reinstall the outer door handle. Torque the door handle mounting bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the door latch assembly. Torque the latch mounting screws to 6.0 Nm (4.0 lb-ft).
8. Reinstall the plastic cover and the door panel.
9. Open and close the door several times to make sure it opens normally.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > 00-013 > Feb > 00 > Rear Doors - Hard To Open
Rear Door Exterior Handle: All Technical Service Bulletins Rear Doors - Hard To Open
00-013
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All 4-door models
Rear Doors Are Hard to Open
SYMPTOM One or both rear doors are difficult to open. The door handle needs to be lifted
abnormally high to release the latch.
PROBABLE CAUSE The rear outer handle rods are misadjusted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Adjust the appropriate rear outer handle rod.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 818306
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour - one door
Failed Part: P/N 75411-634-000 H/C 0564898
Detect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 00-013A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear door panel and pull the plastic cover down to access the door handle.
2. Remove the three latch mounting screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > 00-013 > Feb > 00 > Rear Doors - Hard To Open > Page 7932
3. Pull the latch assembly down, and remove the door handle mounting bolts.
4. Pull the outer handle away from the door. Do not disconnect the outer handle rod. Place a shop
towel in the door handle opening to protect the door from getting scratched.
5. Turn the outer handle assembly counterclockwise to adjust the outer handle rod. The end of the
rod should be flush with the joint or no more than 1 mm beyond it.
6. Reinstall the outer door handle. Torque the door handle mounting bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the door latch assembly. Torque the latch mounting screws to 6.0 Nm (4.0 lb-ft).
8. Reinstall the plastic cover and the door panel.
9. Open and close the door several times to make sure it opens normally.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > Page 7933
Rear Door Exterior Handle: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-013 Date: 000201
Rear Doors - Hard To Open
00-013
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All 4-door models
Rear Doors Are Hard to Open
SYMPTOM One or both rear doors are difficult to open. The door handle needs to be lifted
abnormally high to release the latch.
PROBABLE CAUSE The rear outer handle rods are misadjusted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Adjust the appropriate rear outer handle rod.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 818306
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour - one door
Failed Part: P/N 75411-634-000 H/C 0564898
Detect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 00-013A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear door panel and pull the plastic cover down to access the door handle.
2. Remove the three latch mounting screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > Page 7934
3. Pull the latch assembly down, and remove the door handle mounting bolts.
4. Pull the outer handle away from the door. Do not disconnect the outer handle rod. Place a shop
towel in the door handle opening to protect the door from getting scratched.
5. Turn the outer handle assembly counterclockwise to adjust the outer handle rod. The end of the
rod should be flush with the joint or no more than 1 mm beyond it.
6. Reinstall the outer door handle. Torque the door handle mounting bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the door latch assembly. Torque the latch mounting screws to 6.0 Nm (4.0 lb-ft).
8. Reinstall the plastic cover and the door panel.
9. Open and close the door several times to make sure it opens normally.
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 00-013 Date: 000201
Rear Doors - Hard To Open
00-013
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > Page 7935
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - All 4-door models
Rear Doors Are Hard to Open
SYMPTOM One or both rear doors are difficult to open. The door handle needs to be lifted
abnormally high to release the latch.
PROBABLE CAUSE The rear outer handle rods are misadjusted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Adjust the appropriate rear outer handle rod.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 818306
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour - one door
Failed Part: P/N 75411-634-000 H/C 0564898
Detect Code: 074
Contention Code: B99
Template ID: 00-013A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the rear door panel and pull the plastic cover down to access the door handle.
2. Remove the three latch mounting screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Exterior Handle: > Page 7936
3. Pull the latch assembly down, and remove the door handle mounting bolts.
4. Pull the outer handle away from the door. Do not disconnect the outer handle rod. Place a shop
towel in the door handle opening to protect the door from getting scratched.
5. Turn the outer handle assembly counterclockwise to adjust the outer handle rod. The end of the
rod should be flush with the joint or no more than 1 mm beyond it.
6. Reinstall the outer door handle. Torque the door handle mounting bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
7. Reinstall the door latch assembly. Torque the latch mounting screws to 6.0 Nm (4.0 lb-ft).
8. Reinstall the plastic cover and the door panel.
9. Open and close the door several times to make sure it opens normally.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair
NOTE: Raise the glass fully.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
- Outer handle
2. Remove the lock crank and clip.
3. Remove the rear channel collar.
NOTE: Take care not to bend the lock rod and inner handle rod.
4. Remove the latch through the hole in the door. 5. Installation is the reverse of the removal
procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the door locks and opens properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair
Front Door Index - 4 Door (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7943
Front Door Index - 4 Door (Part 2 Of 2)
Door Panel Replacement
CAUTION: Take care not to scratch the door panel and other parts.
1. Remove:
- Inner handle.
- Mirror mount cover panel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7944
2. If applicable, remove the regulator handle by pulling the clip out with a wire hook.
3. Remove the door grip cover and speaker cover, then remove the screws.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7945
4. Release the clips that hold the door panel. Remove the door panel by pulling it upward.
NOTE: Remove the door panel with as little bending as possible to avoid creasing or breaking it.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Striker > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Striker: Adjustments
Make sure the door latches securely without slamming. If it needs adjustment:
NOTE: The striker nuts are fixed, but the striker can be adjusted slightly up or down, and in or out.
1. Loosen the screws, then insert a shop towel between the body and striker. 2. Lightly tighten the
screws. 3. Wrap the striker with a shop towel, then adjust the striker by tapping it with a plastic
hammer.
CAUTION: Do not tap the striker too hard.
4. Loosen the screws, and remove the shop towel. 5. Lightly tighten the screws. 6. Hold the outer
handle out, and push the door against the body to be sure the striker allows a flush fit. If the door
latches properly, tighten the
screws and recheck.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Window Glass: Adjustments
Glass Adjustment
NOTE:
- Place the vehicle on a firm, level surface when adjusting the glass.
- Check the weatherstrips and glass run channel for damage or deterioration, and replace them if
necessary.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Adjust the glass.
4D: a. Raise the glass fully. b. Loosen the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting
bolts. c. Push the glass rearward (front door glass) or forward (rear door glass).
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7952
Rear
d. Tighten the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting bolts. e. Loosen the front
channel mounting bolts (front door) or rear channel mounting bolt (rear door). f.
Lower the glass.
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7953
Rear
g. Push the front or rear channels against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
2D/3D: a. Raise the glass as far up as possible, and hold it against the glass run channel.
b. Loosen the roller guide bolts, and adjust the glass so it is parallel with the glass run channel. c.
Tighten the roller guide bolts. d. Loosen the front channel bolts. e. Lower the glass.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7954
f. Push the front channel against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
3. Check that the glass moves smoothly. 4. Raise the glass fully and check for gaps.
5. Check the glass operation.
NOTE: Check that the glass contacts the glass run channel evenly.
6. Check for water leaks.
Spray water over the roof and on the sealing area as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7955
NOTE: Adjust the water pressure as shown.
- Do not squeeze the tip of the hose.
7. Attach the plastic cover, then install the door panel.
8. Install the regulator handle so it points forward and up at a 45 degree angle with the glass
closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7956
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7957
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 7958
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Door Window Motor: Locations
Front of Left Rear Door (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
Glass/Regulator Replacement
Rear Door
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7965
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 7966
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Fuel Door Release Cable >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Door Release Cable: Locations
Opener Cable/Opener and Latch/Wiper and Washer - 2 Door/3 Door/4 Door
Opener Cable/Opener and Latch/Wiper and Washer - 3 Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Fuel Door Release Cable >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7971
Fuel Door Release Cable: Service and Repair
NOTE:
- When removing the clips, use a clip remover.
- Take care not to bend the opener cables.
Hood opener cable:
NOTE: Remove the front bumper and inner fender.
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the hood opener cable is routed and connected properly.
- Make sure the hood opens properly.
Clip, Cable Cushion Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Fuel Door Release Cable >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7972
Trunk lid/Fuel lid opener cable (2D/4D):
NOTE: Remove the following parts from the left side of the vehicle, then pull the carpet back, as
necessary.
- Rear seat cushion
- Rear seat side bolster (4D)
- Rear seat-back (2D)
- Center pillar lower trim panel (4D)
- Lower anchor bolt from the front seat belt (2D)
- Side trim
- Seat side trim (4D)
- Side trim panel (2D)
- Trunk mat and spare tire lid
- Rear trim panel
- Trunk side trim, Japan-produced
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Fuel Door > Fuel Door Release Cable >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7973
- Trunk trim panel, USA-produced
Hatch/Fuel lid opener cable (3D):
NOTE: Remove the following parts, then pull the carpet back as necessary.
- Rear seat cushion and rear seat-back
- Lower anchor bolt from the front seat belt
- Side trim
- Spare tire lid
- Rear center shelf and rear side shelf
- Rear trim panel
- Side trim panel
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure each opener cable is routed and connected properly.
- Make sure the hatch and fuel lid open properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hood Latch: > 00-004 > Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads
Hood Latch: Customer Interest Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads
00-004
March 6, 2001
*Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 2001 Civic 4-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L041276
- 4-door from VIN 2HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 2HGES....1L511373
- 2-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L035953*
Rattle From the Hood (Supersedes 00-004, dated January 25, 2000)
SYMPTOM
A rattle from the front of the vehicle when driving over rough roads or small bumps.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Excessive striker-to-latch clearance.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the hood edge cushions and the hood latch.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Adjust each hood edge cushion so only one thread is showing and the "80" on the top is in the
position shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hood Latch: > 00-004 > Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads >
Page 7983
2. Loosen the hood latch mounting bolts, and adjust the latch so it is flush with the top of the
bulkhead.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hood Latch: > 00-004 > Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on
Rough Roads
Hood Latch: All Technical Service Bulletins Hood - Rattles on Rough Roads
00-004
March 6, 2001
*Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - ALL 2001 Civic 4-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L041276
- 4-door from VIN 2HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 2HGES....1L511373
- 2-door from VIN 1HGES....1L000001 thru VIN 1HGES....1L035953*
Rattle From the Hood (Supersedes 00-004, dated January 25, 2000)
SYMPTOM
A rattle from the front of the vehicle when driving over rough roads or small bumps.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Excessive striker-to-latch clearance.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Adjust the hood edge cushions and the hood latch.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Adjust each hood edge cushion so only one thread is showing and the "80" on the top is in the
position shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hood Latch: > 00-004 > Mar > 01 > Hood - Rattles on
Rough Roads > Page 7989
2. Loosen the hood latch mounting bolts, and adjust the latch so it is flush with the top of the
bulkhead.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7990
Hood Latch: Service and Repair
Hood Release Handle/Hood Latch
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7991
Trunk Lid Of Hatch/Fuel Lid Opener
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7992
Striker (3D)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7993
Fuel Lid Latch
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7994
Trunk Lid Latch/Lock Cylinder
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7995
Hatch Latch/Lock Cylinder
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 > Hood
Release Handle - Broken
Hood Latch Release: Customer Interest Hood Release Handle - Broken
99-089
November 23, 1999
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - 2-Door thru VIN 1HGEJ6...YL028945
- 4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ8...YL022085 - 3-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6...YH102606 - 4-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6...YH525584
Hood Release Handle Breaks
PROBLEM The hood release handle is broken.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the hood opener cable with an improved part.
PARTS INFORMATION Hood Opener Cable:
P/N 74130-S01-A01, H/C 4797486
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 812125
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 74130-S01-A01 H/C 4797486
Defect code: 018
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 99-089A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the front bumper (see the appropriate service manual).
2. Remove the left inner fender (see the appropriate service manual).
3. Remove the power steering reservoir.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 > Hood
Release Handle - Broken > Page 8004
4. Release the four clips that attach the hood opener cable to the front bulkhead. Remove the clips
from the opener cable; retain the clips.
5. Detach the opener cable from the electrical harness clip behind the left front headlight.
6. Release the two clips that attach the opener cable to the frame. Remove the clips from the
cable; retain the clips.
7. Remove the driver's kick panel, then remove the hood release handle (two bolts).
8. '98-00 models only: Remove the hood latch cover.
9. Detach the opener cable from the hood latch.
10. From inside the passenger compartment, pull out the opener cable rubber grommet, then pull
the opener cable out through the hole in the body. Discard the opener cable and its rubber
grommet.
11. Route the end of the new opener cable through the hole in the body, into the fenderwell,
through the hole in the body near the left front headlight, and out to the hood latch.
12. Install the hood release handle. Torque the bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
13. Press the opener cable rubber grommet into place. Reinstall the driver's kick panel.
14. Attach the cable end to the hood latch.
15. '98-00 models only: Reinstall the hood latch cover.
16. Attach the two clips to the opener cable, and snap the clips into the mounting holes in the
frame.
17. Attach the opener cable to the electrical harness clip behind the left front headlight.
18. Attach the four clips to the opener cable, and snap the clips into the mounting holes in the front
bulkhead.
19. Reinstall the power steering reservoir.
20. Reinstall the left inner fender.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 > Hood
Release Handle - Broken > Page 8005
21. Reinstall the front bumper.
22. Pull the hood release handle, and make sure the hood opens and closes properly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 >
Hood Release Handle - Broken
Hood Latch Release: All Technical Service Bulletins Hood Release Handle - Broken
99-089
November 23, 1999
Applies To: 1996-00 Civic - 2-Door thru VIN 1HGEJ6...YL028945
- 4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ8...YL022085 - 3-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6...YH102606 - 4-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6...YH525584
Hood Release Handle Breaks
PROBLEM The hood release handle is broken.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the hood opener cable with an improved part.
PARTS INFORMATION Hood Opener Cable:
P/N 74130-S01-A01, H/C 4797486
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 812125
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 74130-S01-A01 H/C 4797486
Defect code: 018
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 99-089A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the front bumper (see the appropriate service manual).
2. Remove the left inner fender (see the appropriate service manual).
3. Remove the power steering reservoir.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 >
Hood Release Handle - Broken > Page 8011
4. Release the four clips that attach the hood opener cable to the front bulkhead. Remove the clips
from the opener cable; retain the clips.
5. Detach the opener cable from the electrical harness clip behind the left front headlight.
6. Release the two clips that attach the opener cable to the frame. Remove the clips from the
cable; retain the clips.
7. Remove the driver's kick panel, then remove the hood release handle (two bolts).
8. '98-00 models only: Remove the hood latch cover.
9. Detach the opener cable from the hood latch.
10. From inside the passenger compartment, pull out the opener cable rubber grommet, then pull
the opener cable out through the hole in the body. Discard the opener cable and its rubber
grommet.
11. Route the end of the new opener cable through the hole in the body, into the fenderwell,
through the hole in the body near the left front headlight, and out to the hood latch.
12. Install the hood release handle. Torque the bolts to 9.8 Nm (7.2 lb-ft).
13. Press the opener cable rubber grommet into place. Reinstall the driver's kick panel.
14. Attach the cable end to the hood latch.
15. '98-00 models only: Reinstall the hood latch cover.
16. Attach the two clips to the opener cable, and snap the clips into the mounting holes in the
frame.
17. Attach the opener cable to the electrical harness clip behind the left front headlight.
18. Attach the four clips to the opener cable, and snap the clips into the mounting holes in the front
bulkhead.
19. Reinstall the power steering reservoir.
20. Reinstall the left inner fender.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hood Latch Release: > 99-089 > Nov > 99 >
Hood Release Handle - Broken > Page 8012
21. Reinstall the front bumper.
22. Pull the hood release handle, and make sure the hood opens and closes properly.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations
Center of Trunk Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hatch Trim
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hatch Trim > Page 8021
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Underside of Hatch Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Side Sill Panel Replacement
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Side Sill Panel Replacement > Page 8039
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Side Sill Panel Replacement > Page 8040
Lower Side Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair Door and Side Moldings Replacement
Door molding removal:
The following materials and tools are required to repair the door moldings.
NOTE: Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
Materials: (Reference)
- Stripe remover 3M 08907
- Stripe adhesive remover 3M 08908
- Adhesive tape
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Side Sill Panel Replacement > Page 8041
3M Super Automotive Attachment Tape
Tools:
- Protective tape
- Knife or Cutter
- Sponge or Shop towel
- Infrared dryer
- Film
- Putty knife
- Alcohol
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
1. Remove the door panel, and pull back the plastic cover.
2. Apply protective tape on and around the molding.
3. Release the clips from inside of the door. Carefully cut the adhesive tape with a knife or cutter
while pulling the edge of the molding away from the
door as shown.
NOTE: Take care not to scratch or bend the molding.
Door molding installation:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Lower Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Side Sill Panel Replacement > Page 8042
1. Glue the new adhesive tape to the moldings as shown. 2. Install the clips on the molding. 3. Heat
the bonding surface of the door and door molding with an infrared dryer.
Door: 104 - 140 °F (40 - 60 °C) Molding: 68 - 86 °F (20 - 30 °C)
NOTE: Use care when heating to prevent deformation of the molding.
4. Align the molding with the clip locations, and set the molding. Lightly push on the molding until its
edge is fully seated on the adhesive tape.
NOTE: Do not spray water on the molding within the first 24 hours after installation.
5. Reassemble all removed parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Upper Side Moulding / Trim > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Fender Liner: > 96043 > Sep > 96 > Body - Inner Fender Liner
Comes Loose
Front Fender Liner: Customer Interest Body - Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
Bulletin No. 96-043
Issue Date SEP 9, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
PROBLEM
The right front inner fender liner may be pulled away from the fender when backing away from a
low curb or similar object, allowing it to dangle and hit the right front wheel.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
4-door - All Coupe - All 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.. .TH126156
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Add an extra mounting screw to the inner fender liner.
1. Inspect the inner fender liner. If it is damaged, replace it with a new one.
2. Install a self-tapping screw (see PARTS INFORMATION) through the existing hole in the front of
the fender liner. Screw it into the bottom of the bumper.
PARTS INFORMATION
Self-tapping screw, 5x16 mm:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Fender Liner: > 96043 > Sep > 96 > Body - Inner Fender Liner
Comes Loose > Page 8056
P/N 90126-SR4-000, H/C 4100947
Inner fender liner, right front:
P/N 74101-504-000, H/C 4779401
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 74101-S04-000 H/C 4779401
Defect code: 074
Contention code: A99
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > 96043 > Sep > 96 > Body - Inner
Fender Liner Comes Loose
Front Fender Liner: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
Bulletin No. 96-043
Issue Date SEP 9, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
PROBLEM
The right front inner fender liner may be pulled away from the fender when backing away from a
low curb or similar object, allowing it to dangle and hit the right front wheel.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
4-door - All Coupe - All 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.. .TH126156
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Add an extra mounting screw to the inner fender liner.
1. Inspect the inner fender liner. If it is damaged, replace it with a new one.
2. Install a self-tapping screw (see PARTS INFORMATION) through the existing hole in the front of
the fender liner. Screw it into the bottom of the bumper.
PARTS INFORMATION
Self-tapping screw, 5x16 mm:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > 96043 > Sep > 96 > Body - Inner
Fender Liner Comes Loose > Page 8062
P/N 90126-SR4-000, H/C 4100947
Inner fender liner, right front:
P/N 74101-504-000, H/C 4779401
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 74101-S04-000 H/C 4779401
Defect code: 074
Contention code: A99
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > Page 8063
Front Fender Liner: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 96043 Date: 960909
Body - Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
Bulletin No. 96-043
Issue Date SEP 9, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
PROBLEM
The right front inner fender liner may be pulled away from the fender when backing away from a
low curb or similar object, allowing it to dangle and hit the right front wheel.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
4-door - All Coupe - All 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.. .TH126156
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Add an extra mounting screw to the inner fender liner.
1. Inspect the inner fender liner. If it is damaged, replace it with a new one.
2. Install a self-tapping screw (see PARTS INFORMATION) through the existing hole in the front of
the fender liner. Screw it into the bottom of the bumper.
PARTS INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > Page 8064
Self-tapping screw, 5x16 mm:
P/N 90126-SR4-000, H/C 4100947
Inner fender liner, right front:
P/N 74101-504-000, H/C 4779401
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 74101-S04-000 H/C 4779401
Defect code: 074
Contention code: A99
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Technical Service Bulletin # 96043 Date: 960909
Body - Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
Bulletin No. 96-043
Issue Date SEP 9, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Inner Fender Liner Comes Loose
PROBLEM
The right front inner fender liner may be pulled away from the fender when backing away from a
low curb or similar object, allowing it to dangle and hit the right front wheel.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
4-door - All Coupe - All
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > Page 8065
3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.. .TH126156
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Add an extra mounting screw to the inner fender liner.
1. Inspect the inner fender liner. If it is damaged, replace it with a new one.
2. Install a self-tapping screw (see PARTS INFORMATION) through the existing hole in the front of
the fender liner. Screw it into the bottom of the bumper.
PARTS INFORMATION
Self-tapping screw, 5x16 mm:
P/N 90126-SR4-000, H/C 4100947
Inner fender liner, right front:
P/N 74101-504-000, H/C 4779401
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 74101-S04-000 H/C 4779401
Defect code: 074
Contention code: A99
Out of warranty:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Fender Liner: > Page 8066
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8067
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Description and Operation
Rear Cross-Member: Description and Operation
Description
The rear floor cross-member position is critical for rear wheel alignment. During replacement,
check the position of the rear beam and the rear damper base, and position the rear floor
cross-member properly. Weld securely following the welder manufacturer's instructions to maintain
rigidity. Use of the positioning jig is recommended.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Subframe > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sub-frame Torque Sequence
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair
Grille: Service and Repair
Front Grille
Hood Edge Protector
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Carpet: Service and Repair
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove:
- Front seat
- Rear seat cushion
- Kick panel
- Center pillar lower trim panel (4D)
- Front seat belt lower anchor (2D/3D)
- Side trim
- Front and rear consoles
- Console panel
2. Remove the SRS unit covers.
3. Cut areas (A) and (B) in the carpet, then pull it back as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 8083
4. Remove the footrest and parking brake lever mounting bolts, and detach the clips, then remove
the carpet. 5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: -
Take care not to damage, wrinkle or twist the carpet.
- Make sure the wire harnesses are routed correctly.
- If necessary, replace any damaged clips.
- Slip the carpet under the seat side trim 4D or side trim panel 2D/3D on each side properly.
- Reattach the cut areas (A) and (B) in the carpet with wire ties.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations > Page 8091
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8094
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8095
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In
Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In
Short Contact > Page 8098
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 8099
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove Box Rattles
Glove Compartment: Customer Interest Interior - Glove Box Rattles
Bulletin No. 96-013
Issue Date: Feb. 12, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To: See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Glove Box Rattle
SYMPTOM
A rattle coming from the area of the glove box when driving on rough roads.
PROBABLE CAUSE
A gap between the glove box door and the latch allows them to rattle against each other.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
Coupe - Thru VIN 1HGEJ....TL007788 3-Door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.....TH108383 4-Door - Thru VIN
1HGEJ.....TL031610
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install wool felt between the glove box and latch.
1. Open the glove box.
2. Remove the latch assembly from the glove box door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove Box Rattles
> Page 8108
3. On the outside of the glove box door, draw a line between the centers of the two latch mounting
holes.
4. Cut a 10 mm by 30 mm piece of wool felt (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
5. Install the wool felt on the glove box door with the top edge of the wool felt along the line you just
drew.
6. Reinstall the latch assembly.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Wool felt:
P/N 06993-SA5-000, H/C 2086676
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 841360
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove Box Rattles
> Page 8109
Failed part: P/N 77500-SO1-A01ZB H/C 4797973
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-013A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove
Box Rattles
Glove Compartment: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Glove Box Rattles
Bulletin No. 96-013
Issue Date: Feb. 12, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To: See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under BODY
Glove Box Rattle
SYMPTOM
A rattle coming from the area of the glove box when driving on rough roads.
PROBABLE CAUSE
A gap between the glove box door and the latch allows them to rattle against each other.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
Coupe - Thru VIN 1HGEJ....TL007788 3-Door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ.....TH108383 4-Door - Thru VIN
1HGEJ.....TL031610
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install wool felt between the glove box and latch.
1. Open the glove box.
2. Remove the latch assembly from the glove box door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove
Box Rattles > Page 8115
3. On the outside of the glove box door, draw a line between the centers of the two latch mounting
holes.
4. Cut a 10 mm by 30 mm piece of wool felt (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
5. Install the wool felt on the glove box door with the top edge of the wool felt along the line you just
drew.
6. Reinstall the latch assembly.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Wool felt:
P/N 06993-SA5-000, H/C 2086676
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 841360
Flat rate time: 0.2 hour
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Glove Compartment: > 96013 > Feb > 96 > Interior - Glove
Box Rattles > Page 8116
Failed part: P/N 77500-SO1-A01ZB H/C 4797973
Defect code: 043
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-013A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Headliner: > 97-056 > Nov > 97 > Interior - Sagging Headliner
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-056 Date: 971103
Interior - Sagging Headliner
97-056
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic 2-door
November 3, 1997
Sagging Headliner
SYMPTOM The headliner sags in the front.
PROBABLE CAUSE The headliner is too long.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the headliner with the new part listed under
PARTS INFORMATION Headliner Assembly:
DX, HX-P/N 83200-S02-A01ZA, H/C 5030366
EX-P/N 83200-502-A11ZA, H/C 5030374
REQUIRED MATERIALS Wool Felt: P/N 06993-SA5-000, H/C 2086676
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: DX, HX-P/N 83200-S02-A01ZA H/C 5030366 EX - P/N 83200-S02-A11ZA H/C
5030374
Defect code: 061
Contention code: A01
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Remove the headliner from the car. Refer to page 20-64 of the 1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
2. Inspect the front of the new headliner.
- If the front edge of the headliner already has strips of wool felt installed, go to step 5.
- If the front edge of the headliner does not have strips of wool felt, continue to step 3.
3. Cut three 150 x 15 mm strips of wool felt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Headliner: > 97-056 > Nov > 97 > Interior - Sagging Headliner > Page 8125
4. Apply the strips of wool felt to the front of the headliner as shown.
5. Install the new headliner in the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Headliner: > 97-056 > Nov > 97 > Interior - Sagging Headliner
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-056 Date: 971103
Interior - Sagging Headliner
97-056
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic 2-door
November 3, 1997
Sagging Headliner
SYMPTOM The headliner sags in the front.
PROBABLE CAUSE The headliner is too long.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the headliner with the new part listed under
PARTS INFORMATION Headliner Assembly:
DX, HX-P/N 83200-S02-A01ZA, H/C 5030366
EX-P/N 83200-502-A11ZA, H/C 5030374
REQUIRED MATERIALS Wool Felt: P/N 06993-SA5-000, H/C 2086676
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: DX, HX-P/N 83200-S02-A01ZA H/C 5030366 EX - P/N 83200-S02-A11ZA H/C
5030374
Defect code: 061
Contention code: A01
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Remove the headliner from the car. Refer to page 20-64 of the 1996-97 Civic Service Manual.
2. Inspect the front of the new headliner.
- If the front edge of the headliner already has strips of wool felt installed, go to step 5.
- If the front edge of the headliner does not have strips of wool felt, continue to step 3.
3. Cut three 150 x 15 mm strips of wool felt.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Headliner: > 97-056 > Nov > 97 > Interior - Sagging Headliner > Page
8131
4. Apply the strips of wool felt to the front of the headliner as shown.
5. Install the new headliner in the car.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8132
Headliner: Service and Repair
CAUTION: When prying with a flat-tip screwdriver, wrap it with protective tape to prevent damage.
NOTE:
- Take care not to bend and scratch the headliner.
- Be careful not to damage the dashboard and other interior trim.
1. Remove:
4D: Front pillar trim (both sides)
- Center pillar lower trim panel (both sides)
- Upper anchor bolt from the front seat belt (both sides)
- Center pillar outer trim and center pillar upper trim
- Ceiling light
- Rearview mirror
3D: Front pillar trim (both sides)
- Right rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Rear center shelf
- Rear side shelf and side trim panel (right side)
- Upper anchor bolts from the front and rear seat belts (right side)
- Quarter trim panel (right side)
- Ceiling light
- Rearview mirror
2D: Front pillar trim (both sides)
- Right rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Side trim panel (right side)
- Upper anchor bolt from the front seat belt (right side)
- Quarter trim panel (right side)
- Ceiling light
- Rearview mirror
2. Remove the sunvisor and holder from each side.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8133
3. Remove the grab handles and coat hanger.
2 Door/3 Door/4 Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8134
3 Door
2 Door
4. Remove the rear roof trim and clips, and remove the roof trim and socket plug (moonroof model).
5. 4D: Lower the rear pillar trim on both sides.
3D: Remove the upper anchor bolts from the front and rear seat belts, then lower the quarter trim
panel on left side. 2D: Remove the upper anchor bolt from the front seat belt, then lower the
quarter trim panel on left side.
6. Lower the headliner. 7. Carefully remove the headliner through the passenger's door opening
(2D/4D) or hatch opening (3D). 8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: When inserting the headliner through the opening, be careful not to fold or bend it. Also, be careful
not to scratch the body.
- Check that both sides of the headliner are securely attached to the trim.
- When installing the roof trim, install the joint toward the right side (moonroof model).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate
Door Locks: Technical Service Bulletins Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate
99-025
April 13, 1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic - 4-door DX thru VIN 1 HGEJ6...XL025605
- 4-door DX thru VIN 2HGEJ6.. .XH545281
Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard to Operate
SYMPTOM The lock tab on the rear door is hard to push down and pull up.
PROBABLE CAUSE The lock crank is distorted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the lock crank.
PARTS INFORMATION Rear Door Lock Crank:
P/N 72630-SM4-003, H/C 3286911
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 72630-SM4-003 H/C 3286911
Detect code: 004
Contention code: B02
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the door panel (see page 20-10 of the 1996-99 Civic Service Manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate > Page 8140
2. Remove the screw from the lock crank, and pry the lock crank from the door.
3. Disconnect the lock rod and the lock tab from the lock crank. Discard the lock crank.
4. Connect the lock rod and the lock tab to the new lock crank. Secure the lock crank to the door
with the original screw.
5. Reinstall the door panel.
6. Lock and unlock the door with the lock tab several times to make sure the lock mechanism
operates smoothly and easily.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Starting System - Unable To Key In Ignition Switch
Can't Turn Ignition Switch? Check for Locked Steering
Got a service customer complaining he or she can't turn the ignition switch to start the engine? The
reason could just be the steering column lock pin is engaged with the front wheels turned. Here's
what typically happens:
Some folks use the steering wheel to help support themselves while climbing in or out of the
vehicle. This is very common among elderly or disabled drivers. Doing this turns the front wheels,
which twists the tires against the ground. The twisted tires apply torque to the steering column.
With the ignition switch in LOCK (0), the steering column lock pin is engaged. But the applied
torque on the steering column binds the lock pin, making it tough to turn the ignition switch. The
ignition switch won't turn to ON (II) if the lock pin isn't disengaged from the steering column.
Tell your customer there's nothing wrong with the ignition switch itself. All he or she needs to do is
turn the steering wheel from side to side while turning the switch. This usually releases the lock pin
so the engine can be started. In some cases, though, your customer may need to give a good tug
on the wheel. This could easily happen when parking on a hill and the wheels are turned sharply
before the engine is shut off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Module > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 8149
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information
> Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 8153
Keyless Entry Receiver: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the audio unit, then disconnect the A and B connectors.
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Receiver > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 8154
Disconnect the A and B connectors from the audio unit.
Reconnect the B connector only to the audio unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not
Function
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Customer Interest Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 97-080 > Nov > 97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not
Function > Page 8163
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 98-011 Date: 040220
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
98-011
February 20, 2004
Applies To: ALL
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information (Supersedes 98-011, dated February 6, 2003)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and a black bar.
This service bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering,
and transmitter batteries. A remote transmitter quick reference guide is shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8169
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8170
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8171
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8172
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8173
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8174
Remote Transmitter Quick Reference Guide
90-93 Accord, 92-93 Civic & Prelude, 93 Del SOL
1990-93 Accord (2-door and 4-door) with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1993 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8175
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip in place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Press the reset button next to the ROM chip.
9. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter and install it in the new one.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
5319. This ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Order the additional transmitter from
American Honda.
If you have questions about how to order a four ROM chip set, call Alpine's parts department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8176
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Accord, Civic, Del SOL, Prelude & 95 Odyssey
1994-95 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
1995 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes, and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during this procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
column cover flashes when the system is in programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. Check that the parking lights flash to confirm that the
transmitter's code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. Check that the parking lights flash
after each transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
96-98 Civic EX & Except EX, Civic
1996-98 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8177
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to four transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM and CD/TAPE
buttons) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during this procedure, or
programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that you're in the
programming mode.
3. Within 5 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the transmitter. Check that the power
door locks cycle to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each of the remaining transmitters.
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit
programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Civic, 03-04 Accord, Element, Pilot
1999-00 Civic Value Package with factory-installed keyless entry system
1999-04 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*1999-03 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2002-04 Civic Si with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Civic Hybrid with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2004 Civic (except LX & EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Civic LX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8178
2003-04 Accord DX with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Element with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Element EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot EX models with factory-installed security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
91-93 Accord 5-D00R EX
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8179
1991-93 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry or dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
The transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the iN system. The
transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
91-93 Accord 5-Door LX
1991-93 Accord 5-door LX with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA only by authorized Honda dealers. Send
a completed order form (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer Parts
Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.) to this address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90501-5745
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8180
On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at (500)
552-4690, or fax them at (310) 595-1029 (weekdays from 5:30A.M. thru 4:00 P.M. Pacific time).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your dealership COD. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
94-97 Accord 5-Door EX, 95-98 Odyssey EX
1994-97 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1995-98 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
^ The system accepts up to two transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Push the driver's power door lock switch to the unlock position and hold it. (Continue to hold the
switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, then remove it. Repeat this four more times (five times
total) within 10 seconds. (You must complete steps 3 and 4 within 10 seconds or the system will
exit the programming mode.)
4. Insert the key into the ignition switch. After you insert the key, make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in the programming mode.
5. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. All the power door locks (except the
driver's door) should cycle to confirm that the system accepted the transmitter's code.
6. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter.
7. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
96-04 Accord, CRV, DelSOL, Ody., Prelude, S2000, Insight, Pilot
1996-02 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1998-02 Accord DX & LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8181
1997-01 CR-V with dealer-installed security system
1996-97 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1996-98 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
*1999-04 Odyssey LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
1996-01 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
*2000-04 S2000 with dealer-installed security system
2000-04 Insight with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8182
1997 Accord SE With Factory-Installed Security System
1997 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Accord EX & 00-02 Accord SE
1998-02 Accord EX with factory-installed security system
2000 and 2002 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8183
(Not interchangeable with CR-V and S2000 remote transmitter)
Transmitter Identification
The transmitter for the 1995-99 Accord and the 2000-02 Accord look identical, but they are not
interchangeable. The 1995-99 transmitter works the doors of a 2000-02 Accord, but it does not
open the trunk. If you are not sure which transmitter you have, press and hold the trunk release
button while looking at the LED. The LED on the 1995-99 transmitter comes on in about 1.1
seconds. The LED on the 2000-02 transmitter comes on in about 0.5 second.
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
03-04 Accord LX and EX
2003-04 Accord LX and EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8184
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1616. Each transmitter uses one battery.
97-04 CR-V & 00-04 S2000
*1997-04 CR-V LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1998-04 CR-V EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-01 CR-V SE with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-04 S2000 with factory-installed keyless entry system
2002-04 CR-V with dealer-installed security system*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8185
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete each step within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode. Program the transmitters within 10 seconds.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Odyssey EX
1999-00 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*2001-04 Odyssey EX models with factory- installed security system*
*Transmitter Identification
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8186
The 1999-00 transmitter is not interchangeable with the 2001-04 transmitter. To tell them apart,
look at the FCC ID on the back.
1999-00 - FCC ID: E4EG8DN
2001-04 - FCC ID: OUCG8D-440H-A*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from exiting
the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-01 Prelude With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
1999-01 Prelude with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8187
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
88-91 Prelude With Dealer-Installed Security System
1988-91 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8188
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
This transmitter is no longer available.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
97-99 EV Plus With Factory-Installed Security System
1997-99 EV Plus with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only through Tech Line.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
00-04 Insight With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
2000-04 Insight with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8189
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Passport (Except 1995-1/2)
1994-95 Passport (except 19951A) with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitters can be
accepted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8190
Programming the Transmitter
1. Locate the security system control unit under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst. This confirms that the system is in programming mode. The siren
then emits prompting chirps at 3-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If you
wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter, or wait
more than 30 seconds between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps and the
system exits the programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
9. Test all the transmitters.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8191
96-97 Passport With Dealer-Installed Security System
1996-97 Passport with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to two transmitters. If you program a
third transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter two times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only two transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
Programming the Transmitter
1. Move the driver's seat forward. Locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Use a pen or pencil to press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control
unit. When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front sidemarker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK, then to ON.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8192
6. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit until the LED on the
instrument panel begins to flash, then release the button. (Steps 6 and 7 must be done within 5
seconds of each other.)
7. Press and release the bottom button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps twice, and the front sidemarker lights flash twice to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. Test the transmitter you just programmed. If it doesn't work
repeat steps 2 thru 7.
9. If you have another transmitter to program, repeat steps 2 thru 7.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Passport With Factory-Installed Security System
1998-02 Passport with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
To program the transmitters, use one of these two procedures:
^ Procedure One cancels all learned transmitter codes and adds one new transmitter. None of the
previously programmed transmitters will work. Use this programming procedure only if all
transmitters were lost or stolen, or if a new control unit has been installed.
^ Procedure Two adds additional transmitters without cancelling any of the previously learned
codes. The system will accept up to four transmitters.
Procedure One (cancels all codes, adds one new transmitter)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position five times. Close and
open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks cycle
once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Procedure Two (adds transmitters)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb >
04 > Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8193
system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. Close
and open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Turning the Audible Chirp On/Off (1998-99 only)
NOTE:
On '00-02 Passports, the audible chirp sounds only when you push the LOCK button on the
transmitter a second time.
1. Open the driver's door, then insert the key in the driver's door lock.
2. Turn the key to the "LOCK" position, then to the "UNLOCK" position. Repeat this two more
times. (Complete this procedure within 10 seconds.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Within 10 seconds, turn the key to the "LOCK" position, and then to the "UNLOCK" position,
three times. Close and open the door once. Verify that the power door locks cycle once to confirm
that the chirp has been turned on/off.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function
Keyless Entry Transmitter: All Technical Service Bulletins Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not
Function
97-080
November 17, 1997
Applies To: 1996-97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Radio Display Is Blank
SYMPTOM
The radio display is blank, and the functions do not work. The keyless remote transmitter may also
be inoperable. The symptoms may be intermittent.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The crystal oscillator inside the radio is contaminated.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
2-door:
EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL050389 (U.S. production) HX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ7...VL050796 (U.S.
production)
4-door:
EX-Thru VIN 2HGEJ8...VH541409 (Canada production) EX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ8...VL015811 (U.S.
production) LX-Thru VIN 1HGEJ6...VL015720 (U.S. production)
DIAGNOSIS
1. Record the customer's pre-set frequency selections.
2. Remove the radio Backup fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box for 10 seconds to clear the
radio's memory.
3. Reinstall the fuse, then check the operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter. If both the radio and transmitter work, see CORRECTIVE ACTION.
- If the radio and transmitter do not work, check all fuses and electrical connections for other
possible causes. If the radio works after checking all fuses and electrical connections, then
disregard this Service Bulletin. If the radio and transmitter still do not work, see CORRECTIVE
ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the radio with a remanufactured unit. (See S/B89-029 for details.) Once the radio has
been replaced, check operation of the radio and the keyless remote transmitter.
PARTS INFORMATION
Radio: P/N 39110-S01-A01RM, H/C 4923447
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty:
The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 010150
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 39110-S01-A01 H/C 4811279
Defect code: 032
Contention code: F05
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 97-080 > Nov >
97 > Radio - Display is Blank/Does Not Function > Page 8198
Template ID: 97-080A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty:
Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill consideration by the
District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration, and get a decision,
before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-046 Date: 961021
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Bulletin No. 96-046
Issue Date OCT 21, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To Refer to the list below
File Under ACCESSORIES
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information
This Service Bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering*,
and transmitter batteries. A transmitter quick reference guide is included.
Use this index to find the information for the vehicle you are working on.
Vehicle: Procedure Number:
Civic
1992-93 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 8
del Sol
1993 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 7
Accord
1990-93 (except Wagon) 2
1991-93 EX Wagon 3
1991-93 LX Wagon 4
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1994-97 EX Wagon 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Prelude
1988-91 1
1992-93 (with optional security system) 2
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Odyssey
1995 (with optional security system) 5
1995-97 EX 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Passport
1994-95 (with optional security system,
not applicable to 1995.5 model) 9
1996-97 (with optional security system) 10
*Transmitter prices are subject to change without notice.
PARTS INFORMATION
Transmitter ordering information and battery part numbers are in each transmitter section.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8203
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This Service Bulletin is for information only.
TRANSMITTER QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE
Procedure 1
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8204
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Alpine of America by authorized Honda Dealers only.
Send a completed order form (found in Parts Information Bulletin A91 -0031) along with a dealer
check for $59.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this address:
Honda/Alpine V.S.S. P.O. Box 2859 Torrance, CA 90509
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 2
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8205
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip into place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter, and install it in the new one.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
8319. For each set ordered, send a dealer check for $24.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this
address:
Alpine Electronics of America 19145 Gramercy Place Torrance, CA 90501 Attention: Al Sula
(Parts)
Alpine's ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Additional transmitters can be ordered
from American Honda using normal parts ordering procedures.
If you have questions on how to order the four ROM chip set, call Alpine's Parts Department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8206
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 3
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the HONDANET 2000
system. The transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
Procedure 4
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8207
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA by authorized Honda Dealers only. Send
a completed order form,* (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer
Parts Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.), to this
address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90801-5745
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at
(800)852-4690, or Fax them at (310) 898-1029 (weekdays, from 8:30 A.M. thru 4:00 PM., PST).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your Dealership C.O.D. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
*On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
Procedure 5
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during the procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
wheel cover flashes when the system is in the programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. The parking lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's
code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. The parking lights flash after each
transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8208
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 6
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Press and hold the driver's door master power door lock switch up in the unlock position.
(Continue to hold the switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key in the ignition switch and remove it. Repeat this four more times within 10
seconds, then leave the key in the switch. Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that the
system is in the programming mode. (This step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
system will exit the programming mode.)
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that all power door locks
(except the driver's) cycle to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the system.
5. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter. (You can program two transmitters per vehicle.)
6. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 7
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8209
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on one of the transmitters. (A non-programmed
transmitter can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times with the transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
6. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the same transmitter. Check that the power door
locks cycle to confirm that you're in the programming mode.
7. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on each transmitter. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle) Check that the power door locks cycle after you push each transmitter
button, confirming that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 8
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8210
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM button and the
CD/TAPE button) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during the
procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm
that you're in the programming mode.
3. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the power door locks cycle
to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on all other transmitters. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle.)
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the
programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 9
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8211
1. Locate the security system control unit mounted under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst to confirm that you're in the programming mode. The siren then emits
prompting chirps at three-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to let you know that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If
you wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter or
between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps, and the system exits the
programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
9. Push all the function buttons on each transmitter to make sure they work correctly.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 10
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8212
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times,
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Move the driver's seat forward, and locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor,
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch on.
3. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit with a pen or pencil.
When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Check that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front marker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by
the control unit.
5. If you have other transmitters to program, repeat steps 3 and 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch off to exit the programming mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct >
96 > Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8213
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. One battery per transmitter is needed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 98-011 Date: 040220
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information
98-011
February 20, 2004
Applies To: ALL
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information (Supersedes 98-011, dated February 6, 2003)
Updated information is shown by asterisks and a black bar.
This service bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering,
and transmitter batteries. A remote transmitter quick reference guide is shown below.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8219
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8220
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8221
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8222
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8223
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8224
Remote Transmitter Quick Reference Guide
90-93 Accord, 92-93 Civic & Prelude, 93 Del SOL
1990-93 Accord (2-door and 4-door) with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1993 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1992-93 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8225
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip in place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Press the reset button next to the ROM chip.
9. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter and install it in the new one.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
5319. This ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Order the additional transmitter from
American Honda.
If you have questions about how to order a four ROM chip set, call Alpine's parts department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8226
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Accord, Civic, Del SOL, Prelude & 95 Odyssey
1994-95 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Civic with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1994-95 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
1995 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes, and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during this procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
column cover flashes when the system is in programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. Check that the parking lights flash to confirm that the
transmitter's code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. Check that the parking lights flash
after each transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
96-98 Civic EX & Except EX, Civic
1996-98 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1996-98 Civic with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8227
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to four transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM and CD/TAPE
buttons) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during this procedure, or
programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that you're in the
programming mode.
3. Within 5 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the transmitter. Check that the power
door locks cycle to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each of the remaining transmitters.
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit
programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Civic, 03-04 Accord, Element, Pilot
1999-00 Civic Value Package with factory-installed keyless entry system
1999-04 Civic EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*1999-03 Civic (except EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2002-04 Civic Si with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Civic Hybrid with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2004 Civic (except LX & EX) with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Civic LX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8228
2003-04 Accord DX with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Element with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system
2004 Element EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot EX models with factory-installed security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
91-93 Accord 5-D00R EX
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8229
1991-93 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry or dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
The transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the iN system. The
transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
91-93 Accord 5-Door LX
1991-93 Accord 5-door LX with dealer-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA only by authorized Honda dealers. Send
a completed order form (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer Parts
Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.) to this address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90501-5745
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8230
On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at (500)
552-4690, or fax them at (310) 595-1029 (weekdays from 5:30A.M. thru 4:00 P.M. Pacific time).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your dealership COD. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
94-97 Accord 5-Door EX, 95-98 Odyssey EX
1994-97 Accord 5-door EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
1995-98 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
^ The system accepts up to two transmitters.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Push the driver's power door lock switch to the unlock position and hold it. (Continue to hold the
switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, then remove it. Repeat this four more times (five times
total) within 10 seconds. (You must complete steps 3 and 4 within 10 seconds or the system will
exit the programming mode.)
4. Insert the key into the ignition switch. After you insert the key, make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in the programming mode.
5. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. All the power door locks (except the
driver's door) should cycle to confirm that the system accepted the transmitter's code.
6. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter.
7. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
96-04 Accord, CRV, DelSOL, Ody., Prelude, S2000, Insight, Pilot
1996-02 Accord with dealer-installed security system
1998-02 Accord DX & LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8231
1997-01 CR-V with dealer-installed security system
1996-97 del Sol with dealer-installed security system
1996-98 Odyssey with dealer-installed security system
*1999-04 Odyssey LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
1996-01 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
*2000-04 S2000 with dealer-installed security system
2000-04 Insight with dealer-installed security system
2003-04 Pilot LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system or security system*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8232
1997 Accord SE With Factory-Installed Security System
1997 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Accord EX & 00-02 Accord SE
1998-02 Accord EX with factory-installed security system
2000 and 2002 Accord SE with factory-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8233
(Not interchangeable with CR-V and S2000 remote transmitter)
Transmitter Identification
The transmitter for the 1995-99 Accord and the 2000-02 Accord look identical, but they are not
interchangeable. The 1995-99 transmitter works the doors of a 2000-02 Accord, but it does not
open the trunk. If you are not sure which transmitter you have, press and hold the trunk release
button while looking at the LED. The LED on the 1995-99 transmitter comes on in about 1.1
seconds. The LED on the 2000-02 transmitter comes on in about 0.5 second.
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
03-04 Accord LX and EX
2003-04 Accord LX and EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8234
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1616. Each transmitter uses one battery.
97-04 CR-V & 00-04 S2000
*1997-04 CR-V LX with dealer-installed keyless entry system
1998-04 CR-V EX with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-01 CR-V SE with factory-installed keyless entry system
2000-04 S2000 with factory-installed keyless entry system
2002-04 CR-V with dealer-installed security system*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8235
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete each step within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode. Program the transmitters within 10 seconds.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-04 Odyssey EX
1999-00 Odyssey EX with factory-installed keyless entry system or dealer-installed security system
*2001-04 Odyssey EX models with factory- installed security system*
*Transmitter Identification
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8236
The 1999-00 transmitter is not interchangeable with the 2001-04 transmitter. To tell them apart,
look at the FCC ID on the back.
1999-00 - FCC ID: E4EG8DN
2001-04 - FCC ID: OUCG8D-440H-A*
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from exiting
the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
99-01 Prelude With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
1999-01 Prelude with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8237
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
88-91 Prelude With Dealer-Installed Security System
1988-91 Prelude with dealer-installed security system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8238
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering a Transmitter
This transmitter is no longer available.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
97-99 EV Plus With Factory-Installed Security System
1997-99 EV Plus with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only through Tech Line.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
00-04 Insight With Factory-Installed Keyless Entry System
2000-04 Insight with factory-installed keyless entry system
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8239
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system accepts up to three transmitters. The transmitter codes are stored in a stacking-type
memory. If a fourth transmitter code is programmed, the code for the first transmitter is erased.
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all of the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
^ You must complete steps 1-6 within 4 seconds of the previous step to keep the system from
exiting the programming mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
2. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on one of the transmitters. (An unprogrammed transmitter
can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
4. Repeat steps 1 2, and 3 two more times using the same transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch to ON (II).
6. Press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on the same transmitter. Make sure the power door locks
cycle to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
7. Within 10 seconds, press the "Lock" or "Unlock" button on each transmitter. Make sure the
power door locks cycle after you press each transmitter button to confirm that the system accepted
the transmitter's code.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0) to exit the programming mode.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
94-95 Passport (Except 1995-1/2)
1994-95 Passport (except 19951A) with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitters can be
accepted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8240
Programming the Transmitter
1. Locate the security system control unit under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst. This confirms that the system is in programming mode. The siren
then emits prompting chirps at 3-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If you
wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter, or wait
more than 30 seconds between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps and the
system exits the programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch to ON, then turn it to LOCK.
9. Test all the transmitters.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8241
96-97 Passport With Dealer-Installed Security System
1996-97 Passport with dealer-installed security system
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to two transmitters. If you program a
third transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter two times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only two transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
Programming the Transmitter
1. Move the driver's seat forward. Locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON.
3. Use a pen or pencil to press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control
unit. When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front sidemarker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
5. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK, then to ON.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8242
6. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit until the LED on the
instrument panel begins to flash, then release the button. (Steps 6 and 7 must be done within 5
seconds of each other.)
7. Press and release the bottom button on the transmitter. Verify that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps twice, and the front sidemarker lights flash twice to confirm that the transmitter's code was
accepted by the control unit.
8. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. Test the transmitter you just programmed. If it doesn't work
repeat steps 2 thru 7.
9. If you have another transmitter to program, repeat steps 2 thru 7.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
98-02 Passport With Factory-Installed Security System
1998-02 Passport with factory-installed security system
Programming the Transmitter
To program the transmitters, use one of these two procedures:
^ Procedure One cancels all learned transmitter codes and adds one new transmitter. None of the
previously programmed transmitters will work. Use this programming procedure only if all
transmitters were lost or stolen, or if a new control unit has been installed.
^ Procedure Two adds additional transmitters without cancelling any of the previously learned
codes. The system will accept up to four transmitters.
Procedure One (cancels all codes, adds one new transmitter)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position five times. Close and
open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks cycle
once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Procedure Two (adds transmitters)
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. (This
step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 98-011 > Feb > 04 >
Keyless Entry - Remote Transmitter Information > Page 8243
system will not enter the programming mode.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC position and then to the LOCK position three times. Close
and open the door. (Complete this process within 10 seconds.) Verify that the power door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system is in programming mode.
5. Within 20 seconds, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter you are programming. Verify that
the door locks cycle once.
6. Within 20 seconds, press the "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Verify that the door locks
cycle once to confirm that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Turning the Audible Chirp On/Off (1998-99 only)
NOTE:
On '00-02 Passports, the audible chirp sounds only when you push the LOCK button on the
transmitter a second time.
1. Open the driver's door, then insert the key in the driver's door lock.
2. Turn the key to the "LOCK" position, then to the "UNLOCK" position. Repeat this two more
times. (Complete this procedure within 10 seconds.)
3. Within 10 seconds, close and open the door two times.
4. Within 10 seconds, turn the key to the "LOCK" position, and then to the "UNLOCK" position,
three times. Close and open the door once. Verify that the power door locks cycle once to confirm
that the chirp has been turned on/off.
Ordering a Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Technical Service Bulletin # 96-046 Date: 961021
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information
Bulletin No. 96-046
Issue Date OCT 21, 1996
Model ALL
Applicable To Refer to the list below
File Under ACCESSORIES
Keyless Remote Transmitter Information
This Service Bulletin gives you information about keyless remote transmitters for most Honda
vehicles. Each procedure describes transmitter programming (if applicable), transmitter ordering*,
and transmitter batteries. A transmitter quick reference guide is included.
Use this index to find the information for the vehicle you are working on.
Vehicle: Procedure Number:
Civic
1992-93 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 8
del Sol
1993 2
1994-95 5
1996-97 7
Accord
1990-93 (except Wagon) 2
1991-93 EX Wagon 3
1991-93 LX Wagon 4
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1994-97 EX Wagon 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Prelude
1988-91 1
1992-93 (with optional security system) 2
1994-95 (with optional security system) 5
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Odyssey
1995 (with optional security system) 5
1995-97 EX 6
1996-97 (with optional security system) 7
Passport
1994-95 (with optional security system,
not applicable to 1995.5 model) 9
1996-97 (with optional security system) 10
*Transmitter prices are subject to change without notice.
PARTS INFORMATION
Transmitter ordering information and battery part numbers are in each transmitter section.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8248
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
None. This Service Bulletin is for information only.
TRANSMITTER QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE
Procedure 1
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8249
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Alpine of America by authorized Honda Dealers only.
Send a completed order form (found in Parts Information Bulletin A91 -0031) along with a dealer
check for $59.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this address:
Honda/Alpine V.S.S. P.O. Box 2859 Torrance, CA 90509
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 2
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
This system uses ROM chips that match the transmitter to the security system control unit. When
replacing a lost or stolen transmitter, you need to use the three ROM chips (provided with the new
transmitter) to match the old transmitter with the new transmitter and the control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8250
1. Remove the rear cover from the old transmitter and the new one.
2. Remove the ROM chip from the old transmitter by sliding its socket holder toward the ROM chip.
3. Insert a new ROM chip into the socket holder, then slide the socket holder toward the socket to
lock the chip into place.
4. Repeat step 3 to install a ROM chip into the new transmitter.
5. Reinstall the rear covers on the transmitters.
6. Remove the security system control unit from under the driver's seat.
7. Open the access cover on the control unit, and replace the ROM chip. (Use the same procedure
as in steps 2 and 3.)
8. Close the access cover, and reinstall the control unit.
If you are replacing a damaged transmitter, don't replace the ROM chips in the transmitters and the
control unit; just remove the chip from the old transmitter, and install it in the new one.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
If your customer wants to add a third transmitter to the system, you need to order a four ROM chip
set directly from Alpine Electronics of America. The Alpine part number for the four ROM chip set is
8319. For each set ordered, send a dealer check for $24.00 (payable to Alpine of America), to this
address:
Alpine Electronics of America 19145 Gramercy Place Torrance, CA 90501 Attention: Al Sula
(Parts)
Alpine's ROM chip set does not come with a transmitter. Additional transmitters can be ordered
from American Honda using normal parts ordering procedures.
If you have questions on how to order the four ROM chip set, call Alpine's Parts Department at
(800) 421-2284, extension 8885.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8251
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 3
Programming the Transmitter
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. To order a transmitter, you need
the vehicle's VIN, the code number from the power door lock control unit, and the ignition key code
number.
The power door lock code number is a five-digit number etched into the plastic case of the control
unit (mounted under the driver's seat). The ignition key code number is a four-digit number
stamped on the metal shank of all five original keys delivered with the car.
Replacement transmitters are manufactured to match the code of the keyless entry system. The
new ignition key is cut to match the vehicle's ignition switch, front door locks, tailgate lock, and
glove compartment lock.
To order this transmitter, use the controlled parts ordering screen on the HONDANET 2000
system. The transmitters are manufactured in Japan; delivery takes 4 to 6 weeks.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery is not replaceable.
Procedure 4
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8252
This transmitter is not programmable.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered directly from Kenwood USA by authorized Honda Dealers only. Send
a completed order form,* (copy it from the Accessory Replacement Parts section of the Dealer
Parts Price List) along with a dealer check for $30.00 (payable to Kenwood U.S.A. Corp.), to this
address:
Kenwood Service Corp. P.O. Box 22745 Long Beach, CA 90801-5745
If you need a transmitter shipped overnight, fill out the order form, then call Kenwood at
(800)852-4690, or Fax them at (310) 898-1029 (weekdays, from 8:30 A.M. thru 4:00 PM., PST).
You will need to give the information on the order form to the Kenwood representative. The
transmitter will be sent to your Dealership C.O.D. Additional shipping and handling charges will be
applied to the order.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR1220. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
*On the order form, you must include the serial number of the keyless control unit or the number
from one of the original transmitters.
Procedure 5
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the system's memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer
work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the dashboard lower cover. (Continue to hold the
button during the procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) The LED on the upper steering
wheel cover flashes when the system is in the programming mode.
3. Press the top button on the transmitter. The parking lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's
code was accepted.
4. Press the top button on each of the remaining transmitters. The parking lights flash after each
transmitter code is accepted.
5. Release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8253
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 6
Programming the Transmitter
NOTE:
Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you are in the
programming mode.
1. Open the driver's door.
2. Press and hold the driver's door master power door lock switch up in the unlock position.
(Continue to hold the switch during this procedure.)
3. Insert the key in the ignition switch and remove it. Repeat this four more times within 10
seconds, then leave the key in the switch. Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm that the
system is in the programming mode. (This step must be completed within 10 seconds, or the
system will exit the programming mode.)
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that all power door locks
(except the driver's) cycle to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by the system.
5. To program a second transmitter, press its "LOCK" or UNLOCK" button within 10 seconds of
programming the first transmitter. (You can program two transmitters per vehicle.)
6. Release the master power door lock switch to exit the programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2016. Each transmitter uses two batteries.
Procedure 7
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8254
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
2. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on one of the transmitters. (A non-programmed
transmitter can be used for this step.)
3. Turn the ignition switch OFF (0).
4. Repeat steps 1, 2, and 3 two more times with the transmitter used in step 2.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
6. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the same transmitter. Check that the power door
locks cycle to confirm that you're in the programming mode.
7. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on each transmitter. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle) Check that the power door locks cycle after you push each transmitter
button, confirming that the system has accepted the transmitter's code.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 8
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ Entering the programming mode cancels all learned transmitter codes, so none of the previously
programmed transmitters will work. You must reprogram all the transmitters once you're in the
programming mode.
^ To keep the system from exiting the programming mode, complete each step within 5 seconds of
the previous step, and program the transmitters within 10 seconds of each other.
1. Turn the ignition switch ON (II).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8255
2. Press and hold the Valet-Disarm button on the radio (between the AM/FM button and the
CD/TAPE button) to enter the programming mode. (Continue to hold the button during the
procedure, or programming will be cancelled.) Check that the power door locks cycle to confirm
that you're in the programming mode.
3. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the power door locks cycle
to confirm that the code was accepted.
4. Press the "LOCK" or "UNLOCK" button on all other transmitters. (You can program up to four
transmitters per vehicle.)
5. After all the transmitters have been programmed, release the Valet-Disarm button to exit the
programming mode.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. Each transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 9
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times.
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
Programming the Transmitter
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8256
1. Locate the security system control unit mounted under the driver's seat.
2. Rub your finger over the label on the top of the control unit until you find the depression. Once
you find it, push your finger through the label to expose the hole underneath. Inside the hole is a
square, yellow button; this is the programming button.
3. Turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
4. Press and hold the programming button. Check that the security siren emits four separate chirps
followed by a five-chirp burst to confirm that you're in the programming mode. The siren then emits
prompting chirps at three-second intervals.
5. Release the programming button.
6. After a prompting chirp, press the "LOCK" button on the transmitter. Check that the siren emits a
confirmation chirp to let you know that the transmitter's code was accepted by the control unit. If
you wait more than 30 seconds after the prompting chirp before programming a transmitter or
between programming transmitters, the siren emits three chirps, and the system exits the
programming mode.
7. To program additional transmitters, wait for another prompting chirp, then press the "LOCK"
button. (You can program up to four transmitters per vehicle.)
8. To exit the programming mode, turn the ignition switch on, then turn it off.
9. Push all the function buttons on each transmitter to make sure they work correctly.
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is 23-144 (Radio Shack), A-23 (Eveready), or MS-21/MN-21 (Duracell). Each
transmitter uses one battery.
Procedure 10
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8257
Programming the Transmitter
NOTES:
^ The system uses a stacking-type memory that accepts up to four transmitters. If you program a
fifth transmitter, the memory for the first transmitter is pushed out, and it will no longer work.
^ To clear a lost or stolen transmitter from the system's memory, program a transmitter four times,
This will remove the missing transmitter from memory, since only four transmitter codes can be
accepted.
^ Another way to clear a lost or stolen transmitter is to erase all transmitter codes and then
reprogram them. To do this, refer to the security system owner's manual.
1. Move the driver's seat forward, and locate the security system control unit mounted on the floor,
underneath the seat.
2. Turn the ignition switch on.
3. Press and hold the green programming button on the side of the control unit with a pen or pencil.
When the security system LED on the instrument panel comes on, release the programming
button. (Steps 3 and 4 must be done within 5 seconds of each other.)
4. Press and release the top button on the transmitter. Check that the LED goes out, the siren
chirps once, and the front marker lights flash to confirm that the transmitter's code was accepted by
the control unit.
5. If you have other transmitters to program, repeat steps 3 and 4.
6. Turn the ignition switch off to exit the programming mode.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Keyless Entry Transmitter: > 96-046 > Oct > 96 >
Keyless Entry - Transmitter Programming Information > Page 8258
Ordering the Transmitter
Transmitters can be ordered only by authorized Honda Dealers. Order them from American Honda
using normal parts ordering procedures.
Batteries for the Transmitter
The battery number is CR2025. One battery per transmitter is needed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8259
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection
NOTE:
- If the doors unlock or lock with the transmitter, but the LED on the transmitter does not come on,
the LED is faulty; replace the transmitter.
- If any door is open, you cannot lock or unlock the door with the transmitter.
- If you unlocked the doors with the transmitter, but do not open any of the doors within 30
seconds, the doors relock automatically.
- The doors do not lock or unlock with the transmitter if the ignition key is inserted in the ignition
switch.
1. Using a keyless entry checker (07MAJ - SP00300):
- Place the transmitter on the keyless entry checker, and press the transmitter button. If the indicator light does not come on, check for: a dead or low battery
- Faulty transmitter
- If the ray indicator light comes on, the transmitter is OK.
NOTE: After a transmitter battery has been replaced, aim the transmitter at the receiver, and press
the transmitter button six times. Confirm you can hear the sound of the door lock actuators when
you press the sixth time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8260
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair
Storing Transmitter Codes
- The codes of up to four transmitters can be stored in the control unit. (If a fifth code is stored, the
code which was stored first will be erased.)
- When the system enters the registration mode, all previously stored codes will be erased.
- The system leaves the registration mode and returns to the normal mode if you turn the valet switch OFF, or
- turn the ignition switch OFF, or
- do not press the transmitter button for more than 10 seconds.
Procedure
NOTE: It is important to maintain the time limits between steps.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative
Power Door Lock Actuator: Customer Interest Power Door Lock - Inoperative
Bulletin No. 96-030
Issue Date JUNE 10, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under ELECTRICAL
Power Door Lock Is Inoperative
SYMPTOM
One or more of the power door locks are inoperative.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The power door lock actuator connectors C556 and C557 are partially connected, or the door lock
actuator is faulty.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
Ohio produced - thru VIN 1HGEJ....TL037213 Canada produced - thru VIN 2HGEJ....TH523520
DIAGNOSIS
Operate the door lock, and listen for the door lock actuator motor to run.
^ If the motor runs, but the door lock will not lock, go to CORRECTIVE ACTION.
^ If the motor does not run, check connectors C556 (driver's side front door) and C557
(passenger's side front door) for loose connections.
^ If the connectors are loose, reconnect the connectors until they lock and check the door lock for
proper operation. If the door lock operates properly, the repair is completed.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the affected door lock actuator with one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
NOTE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative > Page
8270
The illustrations show the driver's side; the same procedure applies for the passenger's side.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative > Page
8271
4-Door (Rear) - Removing the Door Latch Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative > Page
8272
2-Door - Removing the Door Latch Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative > Page
8273
Replacing the Door Lock Actuator
Reinstalling the Door Latch Assembly
1. Reinstall the door latch assembly and all parts removed in reverse order of removal.
NOTE:
Replace the bushing in the outer door handle before reattaching the rod joint.
2. Cycle the door locks several times to verify proper operation.
PARTS INFORMATION
Door lock actuator:
4-Door
Right front - P/N 72115-S04-A02, H/C 4778841 Left front
- P/N 72155-S04-A02, H/C 4812251
Right rear - P/N 72615-S04-J02, H/C 4779146
Left rear - P/N 72655-S04-J02, H/C 4779187
2-Door
Right - P/N 72115-S00-A01, H/C 4846523
Left - P/N 72155-S00-A01, H/C 4891578
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock - Inoperative > Page
8274
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Failed part: P/N 72155-S00-A01 H/C 4891578
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative
Power Door Lock Actuator: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Door Lock - Inoperative
Bulletin No. 96-030
Issue Date JUNE 10, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To See VEHICLES AFFECTED
File Under ELECTRICAL
Power Door Lock Is Inoperative
SYMPTOM
One or more of the power door locks are inoperative.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The power door lock actuator connectors C556 and C557 are partially connected, or the door lock
actuator is faulty.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
Ohio produced - thru VIN 1HGEJ....TL037213 Canada produced - thru VIN 2HGEJ....TH523520
DIAGNOSIS
Operate the door lock, and listen for the door lock actuator motor to run.
^ If the motor runs, but the door lock will not lock, go to CORRECTIVE ACTION.
^ If the motor does not run, check connectors C556 (driver's side front door) and C557
(passenger's side front door) for loose connections.
^ If the connectors are loose, reconnect the connectors until they lock and check the door lock for
proper operation. If the door lock operates properly, the repair is completed.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the affected door lock actuator with one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
NOTE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative > Page 8280
The illustrations show the driver's side; the same procedure applies for the passenger's side.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative > Page 8281
4-Door (Rear) - Removing the Door Latch Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative > Page 8282
2-Door - Removing the Door Latch Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative > Page 8283
Replacing the Door Lock Actuator
Reinstalling the Door Latch Assembly
1. Reinstall the door latch assembly and all parts removed in reverse order of removal.
NOTE:
Replace the bushing in the outer door handle before reattaching the rod joint.
2. Cycle the door locks several times to verify proper operation.
PARTS INFORMATION
Door lock actuator:
4-Door
Right front - P/N 72115-S04-A02, H/C 4778841 Left front
- P/N 72155-S04-A02, H/C 4812251
Right rear - P/N 72615-S04-J02, H/C 4779146
Left rear - P/N 72655-S04-J02, H/C 4779187
2-Door
Right - P/N 72115-S00-A01, H/C 4846523
Left - P/N 72155-S00-A01, H/C 4891578
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 96030 > Jun > 96 > Power Door Lock Inoperative > Page 8284
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Failed part: P/N 72155-S00-A01 H/C 4891578
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > SN051000-07 > Oct
> 05 > Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - CD/DVD Precautions
Adhesive Labels or Protective Disc Covers on CDs or
DVDs:
A Big Taboo
NOTE:
This article applies to all Honda models with a factory- or dealer-installed CD/DVD player or
changer.
We can't emphasize this enough: Never put adhesive labels or protective disc covers on
recordable CDs or DVDs to be used in automotive CD/DVD players or changers. Here's why:
^ Recordable CDs and DVDs are actually thicker than their pre-recorded brethern. Automotive
players and changers use rollers to draw the disc into the
unit. The added thickness of an adhesive label or a protective disc cover can cause the disc to jam
when it's loaded into or ejected from the unit.
^ CD/DVD players or changers are exposed to high temperatures inside the vehicle. High
temperature can cause the label adhesive to soften. This can
cause the label to curl on the edges and even form bubbles. Curled edges can catch on the rollers
and bubbles add thickness to the disc. Either one can cause the disc to jam.
To cut down on customer-caused damage, all '05 and later 0/Ms include this notice:
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can curl up and cause the CD to jam in the unit.
Anytime a service customer comes in with a loading or ejecting problem for a CD/DVD player or
changer, ask if he or she used any discs with adhesive labels or protective disc covers. If the
answer is yes, contact your DPSM for possible goodwill assistance. If the answer is no, then
replace the audio unit under normal warranty.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer Error Codes
00-015
March 14, 2000
Applies To: All with CD Player/Changer
Audio Unit Error Codes (Replaces 91-007, dated October 6, 1997)
*If the audio unit displays an error code, use the troubleshooting tables in this service bulletin to
troubleshoot the problem. Refer to service bulletin 98-019 for CD Player/Changer exchange
information.*
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8294
CD Changer Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
CD Player Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Radio Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8295
CD Player/Changer Troubleshooting (Passport only)
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (All except Passport)
One-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the rear cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed disc.
3. If a disc is jammed between the player and the magazine, turn the loading gear until the disc
returns to the player mechanism. Do not attempt to reload the disc back into the magazine.
4. After the disc is loaded into the player mechanism, turn the changer so that the front is facing
you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8296
5. Insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1-1/2" from the right
side of the opening.
6. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
7. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed tray.
3. If a tray is stuck in the player, reinstall the cover and replace the changer. If all the trays are in
the magazine, insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from
the right side of the opening.
4. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
5. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8297
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (Passport only)
One-piece door model:
1. Open the changer door.
2. Check to see if all the trays are in the magazine.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and inspect for a jammed tray.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Handling and Inspecting Compact Discs
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8298
^ Handle a CD by its edges; never touch the flat surfaces. Contamination from fingerprints, liquids,
felt-tip pens, and labels can cause the CD to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
^ When cleaning a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside.
Do not wipe the disc in a circular motion.
^ A new CD may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this
roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other
problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or
pen.
^ Various accessories are available to protect CDs and improve the sound quality of CDs. These
accessories increase the thickness or diameter of the discs, and should not be used in CD
changers.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8308
CD Changer Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
CD Player Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Radio Troubleshooting (All except Passport)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8309
CD Player/Changer Troubleshooting (Passport only)
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (All except Passport)
One-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the rear cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed disc.
3. If a disc is jammed between the player and the magazine, turn the loading gear until the disc
returns to the player mechanism. Do not attempt to reload the disc back into the magazine.
4. After the disc is loaded into the player mechanism, turn the changer so that the front is facing
you.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8310
5. Insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1-1/2" from the right
side of the opening.
6. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
7. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and look for a jammed tray.
3. If a tray is stuck in the player, reinstall the cover and replace the changer. If all the trays are in
the magazine, insert a thin stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from
the right side of the opening.
4. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
5. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8311
Manually Removing a Jammed Magazine (Passport only)
One-piece door model:
1. Open the changer door.
2. Check to see if all the trays are in the magazine.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Two-piece door model:
1. Remove the changer from the vehicle.
2. Remove the top cover plate from the changer, and inspect for a jammed tray.
^ If a tray is stuck in the changer, replace the changer.
^ If all the trays are in the magazine, place the changer in a horizontal position, and insert a thin
stainless steel ruler or a "Slim Jim" under the magazine, about 1/2" from the right side of the
opening.
3. Push the ruler in until it presses against the eject lever at the back of the unit.
4. Slowly remove the ruler and magazine at the same time.
Handling and Inspecting Compact Discs
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Actuator: > 00-015 > Mar > 00 >
Audio Unit with CD Player/Changer - Error Codes > Page 8312
^ Handle a CD by its edges; never touch the flat surfaces. Contamination from fingerprints, liquids,
felt-tip pens, and labels can cause the CD to not play properly, or possibly jam in the drive.
^ When cleaning a disc, use a clean soft cloth. Wipe across the disc from the center to the outside.
Do not wipe the disc in a circular motion.
^ A new CD may be rough on the inner and outer edges. The small plastic pieces causing this
roughness can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the disc, causing skipping or other
problems. Remove these pieces by rubbing the inner and outer edges with the side of a pencil or
pen.
^ Various accessories are available to protect CDs and improve the sound quality of CDs. These
accessories increase the thickness or diameter of the discs, and should not be used in CD
changers.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Door Lock Actuator
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Door Lock Actuator
Rear of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Door Lock Actuator > Page 8315
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Rear Door Lock Actuator
Rear of Left Rear Door (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Driver's Door
Power Door Lock Actuator: Testing and Inspection Driver's Door
1. Remove the driver's door panel.
2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the actuator.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each knob switch position according to the table.
4. Check actuator operation by connecting power and ground according to the table. To prevent
damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only
momentarily.
5. If the actuator fails to work properly, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Driver's Door > Page 8318
Power Door Lock Actuator: Testing and Inspection Passenger's Door
1. Remove the passenger's door panel.
2. Disconnect the 2P connector from the actuator.
NOTE: The front passenger's door lock actuator is shown; the left rear and right rear door lock
actuators are similar.
3. Check actuator operation by connecting power and ground according to the table. To prevent
damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only
momentarily.
4. If the actuator fails to work properly, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Front of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless)
With Keyless
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless) > Page 8324
Keyless Door Lock Control Unit (USA Only)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8325
Power Door Lock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8326
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the inner handle.
2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the door lock switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Actuator <--> [Power Mirror Motor] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Power Mirror Actuator: Testing and Inspection
1. Pry out the cover panel. 2. Disconnect the 8P connector from the power mirror.
3. Check actuator operation by connecting power and ground according to the tables.
Defogger Test:
4. Check for continuity between the No.3 and No.4 terminals of the 8P connector.
There should be continuity.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Actuator <--> [Power Mirror Motor] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8334
Power Mirror Actuator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the power mirror from the door and disconnect the 8P connector.
2. Remove the mirror base cover from the mirror housing. 3. Remove the mirror holder from the
mirror housing. Gently pull it out by hand.
4. Remove the three screws from the actuator and the two screws from the bracket at the base of
the assembly. 5. Remove the bracket from the housing.
6. Remove the two screws, cut the wire harness, and remove the actuator. 7. Record the terminal
locations and wire colors.
8. Route the wire harness of the new actuator through the hole in the bracket. Be sure to pass the
wire under the bracket clip.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Actuator <--> [Power Mirror Motor] > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8335
9. Pass the connector boot over the wire harness.
10. Insert the terminals into the connector in the original arrangement (recorded in step 7), as
shown. 11. Apply tape to seal the intersection of the connector boot and the wire harness. 12.
Reassemble in the reverse order of disassembly. Be careful not to break the mirror when
reinstalling it to the actuator. 13. Reinstall the mirror assembly to the door. 14. Operate the power
mirror to check that the actuator works smoothly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Connector A
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector A
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Connector A > Page 8340
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector B
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8341
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Without Defogger
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Without Defogger
1. Remove the switch as described in Function Test .
2. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Without Defogger > Page 8344
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection With Defogger
1. Pry the switch out of the dashboard driver's lower cover. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector from
the switch.
Mirror Switch
Defogger Switch
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage
Paint: Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage
99-062
January 15, 2007
Applies To: ALL
Paint Damage From Environmental Fallout
(Supersedes 99-062, dated October 12, 1999 to update the information marked by the black bars
and asterisks)
SYMPTOM
The exterior paint surface does not feel smooth after the vehicle is washed.
PROBABLE CAUSE
Environmental fallout (airborne metallic particles, tree sap, paint overspray, road tar, insect residue,
etc.) has adhered to the exterior paint surface.
NOTE:
This form of paint damage should not be confused with acid rain damage. Unlike environmental
fallout damage, acid rain damage appears on the paint surface as pits or water spots-possibly
black or brown in the center-which may feel smooth to the touch.
PREVENTION
The shipping wax/wrap guard applied to the vehicle at the factory provides the best protection for
the paint finish from environmental fallout and acid rain damage. American Honda strongly
recommends that you leave the shipping wax/wrap guard on the vehicle for as long as possible.
Your dealership is responsible for maintaining the vehicle's finish after the shipping wax/ wrap
guard is removed.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Select a product line from one of the manufacturers listed in REQUIRED MATERIALS to clean the
paint surface and to wax it after cleaning. Make sure you follow the manufacturer's instructions for
each of the products you use.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Each of the clays listed should do at least three vehicles.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8350
In warranty: American Honda will reimburse for this repair only under these conditions:
^ It is done during PDI
^ No more than 30 days have elapsed since the vehicle was received at the dealership (according
to the date noted on the motor carrier's bill of lading)
Operation number: 812355
Flat rate time: 1.0 hour
Failed P/N: PDI-PAINT, H/C 3173994
*Defect code: 08103
Symptom code 08811*
Skill level: Repair Technician
*NOTE:
When submitting the claim, make sure you enter the vehicle's date of receipt in the customer
contention comment section. The claim will be rejected without this information.*
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Wash and dry the vehicle out of direct sunlight.
2. Tear off a piece of clay. Shape the piece with your hands into a flat disk about 3 inches in
diameter.
3. Spray a 2-to 3-square-foot area of the affected panel with the manufacturer's lubricant.
4. Clean a 1-square-foot section of the sprayed area by rubbing it with the clay.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8351
5. Check your work by running your fingers over the cleaned and lubricated surface to feel for any
remaining contamination.
^ If you feel any particles on the cleaned surface fold the clay in half, knead it back into a disk
shape, clean the section again, and recheck your work.
^ If the cleaned surface feels smooth, fold the clay in half, knead it back into a disk shape, and go
to step 6.
NOTE:
You must carefully fold and knead the clay to keep a clean side next to the paint surface. Never
use clay that has fallen on the ground. Any small pieces of dirt or sand that imbed in the clay will
scratch the paint surface. If the clay falls on the ground, discard it and get a fresh piece.
6. Clean the remaining sections of the sprayed area (repeat steps 4 and 5).
7. Wipe the lubricant from all the cleaned sections with a clean terry cloth towel.
8. Clean the rest of the affected panel and any additional panels that need cleaning (repeat steps 3
thru 7).
9. Apply the manufacturer's recommended wax or glaze to all the cleaned panels.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8352
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-028 Date: 970331
Body - Minor Paint Finish Repair
97-028
Applies To: ALL Models
March 31, 1997
Minor Paint Finish Repair
The first thing a new vehicle owner sees when he or she takes delivery of a new vehicle is the paint
finish. Therefore, making the vehicle look good is very important. However, customer feedback has
pointed out that many new vehicles are delivered with scratches and swirl marks. This is especially
true with dark colored vehicles.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the paint finish using the tools, supplies, and procedures
recommended for the type of damage (scratches, swirl marks, etc.) and for the color of the paint
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION None: Information only.
RECOMMENDED TOOLS AND SUPPLIES To repair the paint finish, you should use these tools
and supplies:
Tools and Safety Equipment Mil gauge (film thickness gauge) *
Pro Gauge II, or equivalent
* ETG (Electronic Thickness Gauge), or equivalent These mil gauges are commercially available.
They can be purchased from Pro Motorcar Products at 800-334-2843.
- Variable speed electric polisher
- Dual action orbital polisher (electric or pneumatic)
- Eye protection (face shield or safety goggles)
Supplies 9" Foam polishing pads (do not use wool type)
- Clean, 100% cotton terry cloth towels or soft flannel cloth
- Wet/dry sandpaper (1500 - 2000 grit)
- Soft sanding pad
- 50/50 Solution of isopropyl alcohol and water
While we cannot recommend one manufacturer over another, any of the manufacturers listed here
can provide you with quality products through their nationwide distributor network. Contact them for
your paint repair supply needs, choose one, and then use the system of only that one
manufacturer. If you need to know how to use the products, ask the manufacturer for training.
3M Automotive Trades Division 22100 Telegraph Road P.O. Box 358 Southfield, MI 48037-0358
Phone Number: 800-521-8180 Ext. 6890
Meguiar's 17991 Mitchell South Irvine, CA 92714 Phone Number: 800-347-5700
MOC Products 12306 Montague Street Pacoima, CA 91331 Phone Number: 818-896-2258
Repair Procedure
The following procedures may not apply to all conditions or colors. Use the procedure that best
suits the condition and color of the vehicle you're
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8353
repairing.
Repairing and Polishing the Painted Surface
The goal of a minor paint repair is to correct the damage to the upper layer of the painted surface.
This is done by removing a thin layer of paint (no more than 0.5 mil) and then restoring the luster
by polishing the repaired surface. A quick way to determine the depth of a scratch in the paint is to
run your fingernail across the scratch. If your fingernail catches on the scratch, the area will need to
be wet sanded and polished.
When doing scratch or swirl mark repairs, use only quality products from one manufacturer. Each
manufacturer has its own set of paint repair products that have matching materials. Mixing
materials from different manufacturers, or using inexpensive products, compromises the repair
quality.
An electric polisher with an adjustable rpm control set between 1,500 and 1,800 rpm is best for
polishing. When using a polisher, faster is not better. Too much polisher speed and too much
applied force can cause swirl marks or may even burn the paint.
Removing Swirl Marks
Most swirl marks can be removed by using a foam polishing pad and polishing material. Use the
polisher at 1,500 to 1,800 rpm with a small amount of polishing material on the pad. Always begin
with the finest polishing material. If necessary, progress to the next coarser material only when the
fine materials are ineffective.
When polishing, work in small sections (approximately 24" x 24"). Avoid running the polishing pad
over edges of a body panel or body lines where the paint is more susceptible to burning through.
Let the cleaner do the work. Do not apply too much force! Forcing the polishing pad could cause
deep cuts into the paint and might damage the surface so badly that it would need to be repainted.
Polishing Dark Colors
This additional procedure, after the polishing process described above, is important to reduce any
chance of swirl marks, which show more on dark colors. When polishing is completed, use the
same type of foam polishing pad on a random orbital polisher. Apply the finest polishing material to
a 24" x 24" work area. Start the polisher, and make three to four passes over the work area.
Remove the glaze residue with a cotton terry cloth or soft flannel cloth.
Wet Sanding
This process is used to repair scratches and acid rain damage deeper than 0.2 mil. The object is to
remove as little paint material as possible. When wet sanding, stop frequently and dry the work
area. This will allow you to see if the wet sanding has removed the damage.
Start by soaking a 1500 or 2000 grit wet/dry sanding paper in water for 15 minutes. Wrap the
soaked wet/dry sanding paper around a soft sanding pad. Lightly sand in one direction across (90
degrees) the scratched surface to highlight the surface damage. Flush the area with clean water.
To remove any sanding scratches left by the wet sanding process, use a foam polishing pad and a
polishing material. Refer to Removing Swirl Marks.
Final Inspection
When the polishing process is done, the paint surface may look perfect, but residue can hide very
fine scratches that will become apparent after a few washings. This is especially true for darker
colors.
Start the final inspection by spraying a 50/50 solution of isopropyl alcohol and water on the work
area and then wiping it dry.
NOTE: Avoid spraying the solution on any unpainted plastic parts such as taillights, turn signal
lenses, reflectors, etc. The solution can cause cracking.
Inspect the repaired area, and repeat the polishing process if necessary. Finish the inspection by
waxing the completed vehicle with a high quality wax. Use the wax recommended by the paint
repair supplies manufacturer you have chosen.
Preventive Maintenance
Avoiding scratches and dents while the vehicle is in your dealership inventory requires some
preventive maintenance. To help reduce the occurrence of scratches and dents, follow these
recommendations: Park vehicles far enough apart to prevent door dents and dings.
- Leave the exterior shipping protection on the vehicle until it is ready to be sold.
- Implement and use an inventory age control system.
- Use deionized water to reduce water spotting.
- Wash the vehicles with deionized water, soap, and a wash mitt at least once a week.
NOTE: Using a wash mitt will remove any residual dirt from the paint surface. If a wash mitt is not
used, the residual dirt on the painted surface will scratch the paint when the surface is dried with a
chamois or towel.
- Use a clean chamois or terry cloth towel to dry the vehicles.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8354
Paint: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Paint Codes
Bulletin No. 95-058
Issue Date December 18, 1995
Model 1996
Applicable To ALL
File Under BODY
1996 Honda Paint Codes
Paint formulations are determined by each paint company. For questions about formulas or
matching, contact your local paint distributor or the paint company's nearest regional office. The
information provided is for reference only. American Honda does not endorse any paint company
or type of paint.
The original paint is acrylic enamel. Paint codes with "M" are metallic colors; those with P are
pearlescent colors.
NOTE:
Herberts Standox uses the Honda Paint Code as its paint intermix code.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8355
Japan-Produced Cars
Canada-Produced Civics, paint code ends in -4
U.S.-Produced (Marysville) Accords, paint code ends in -3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Paint - Industrial Fallout Paint Damage > Page 8356
U.S.-Produced (East Liberty) Civics, paint code ends in -5 (East Liberty uses waterborne paints)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8357
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 8358
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > ABS / PC Resin Parts
Paint: Description and Operation ABS / PC Resin Parts
General
The door mirror, and license plate trim are made ABS resin. They can be repaired if the damage or
deformation is minor in nature. This section covers ABS repair. Repairing ABS is different from
other resins such as PP and urethane.
NOTE:
- The ABS resin is the copolymer resin consisting of the three monomers of acrylonitrile, butadiene,
and styrene.
- Polycarbonate is a generic name for high polymers which have the carbonic ester structure in the
structural unit. The most prominent feature of polycarbonate is its tensile strength which shows the
same level of yielding point as metals in the normal temperature. It also has outstanding impact
strength compared to other plastics.
NOTE: The following repair procedures also apply to the PC resin and NEPDMIS resin.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8361
Paint: Description and Operation Polypropylene (PP) Resin Parts
General
The front bumper, rear bumper, front grille, and side sill panel are made of polypropylene (PP)
resin. They can be repaired if the damage or deformation is minor in nature. This section covers PP
repair. Repairing PP is different from other resins such as ABS and urethane.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8362
Paint: Description and Operation 3C.3B (3-Coat.3-Bake) Paint
General
3C.3B paint finish gives the Civic a deep gloss and stunning finish. This manual provides
information on paint defect repair and refinishing. Throughout, the objective has been to explain in
a simple yet comprehensive manner the basic items you should know about pain repairs. Select
the correct material for the defect and repaint or refinish in the correct manner a described.
WARNING: Most paints contain substances that are harmful if inhaled or swallowed. Read the paint label
before opening the container. Spray paint only in a well ventilated area.
- Cover spilled paint with sand, or wipe it up at once.
- Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate clothing when painting.
Avoid contact with skin.
- If paint gets in your mouth or on your skin, rinse or wash thoroughly with water. If paint gets in
your eyes, flush with water and get prompt medical attention.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
Basic Rules in Repairing a 3C.3B paint finish
To repair paint damage, always use the 2-part acrylic urethane paints designated; polish and bake
each of the three coats, as in production, to maintain the original film thickness, and to assure the
same quality as the original finish.
Outline of Factory Painting Process:
Features in Each Work Process
1. Pretreatment and Electrodeposition
In the pretreatment process, the entire body is degreased, cleaned, and coated with zinc
phosphate by dipping. After the body has been cleaned with pure water, it is placed in an
electrolytic bath of soluble primer (Cationic Electrodeposition). This produces a thorough corrosion
inhibiting coating on the inner surfaces and corners of the body, pillars, sills and panel joints.
Chipping primer is then applied to the most susceptible areas (see page 8-13).
2. Intermediate coat
The intermediate coat is applied to the prepared surface for further protection against damage.
3. Top coat
Enamel paint and either polyester or acrylic resin paint are used in the top coat for higher solidity,
smoothness, brightness, and weather resistance.
Sectional View of Paint Coats:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Description and
Operation > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8363
Paint: Description and Operation Soft Chipping Guard Primer Coat
General
General
The removal of paint and undercoating by stones and gravel immediately exposes metal to the
atmosphere, causing it to rust. The thickness of this rust increases if the process continues
unchecked. The soft chipping guard primer protects against damage due to the impact of flying
objects. The purpose of this guide is to provide information you will find useful when repairing
damage to the protective coating. Refer to the Soft Chipping Primer Undercoating Diagram.
The soft chipping guard primer is applied over the E.D. (Electrostatically Deposited) primer. It is
followed by guide coating and top coating.
The soft chipping guard primer produces a smooth surface when dry. It should be sprayed so the
thickness of the protective film is 20 microns.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts
Paint: Service and Repair ABS / PC Resin Parts
Repair Procedures
Repair Procedures
A. Deep scratches, when filling:
1. Sand the damage section. (#12O-#24O) 2. Apply the filler and dry. 3. Sand the filler
(#24O-#4OO) 4. Coat with the primer/primer surfacer and dry. 5. Sand the primer surfacer.
(#6OO-#8OO) 6. Top coating.
B. Shallow scratches:
1. Coat with the primer/primer surfacer. 2. Sand the primer surfacer. (#6OO-#8OO) 3. Top coating.
C. Repaint:
1. Sand the primer surfacer. (#6OO-#8OO) 2. Top coating.
Refinishing Procedures
Refinishing Procedures
1. Base material reconditioning (sanding)
-1. Repaint and replacement part
Lightly sand the part with #400, #600 or #800.
-2. Slight scores or scratches
Use a flexible sanding block and wet sand the damaged section with #400, #600.
NOTE: Sand level to remove damage.
-3. Deep scratches, when filling.
Use a flexible sanding block and wet sand the damaged section with #240, #400.
2. Degreasing and cleaning
Clean the repaired area with wax and grease remover, then blow with air dry.
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
NOTE: Wipe dust off surface with a tack cloth.
3. Filling, drying and sanding
Apply the filler in several thin coats.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8366
NOTE: Mix and apply the filler according to the manufacturer's instructions.
-1. Dry the filler with an infrared dryer for 5 or 6 minutes.
Be sure to keep the dryer 40-50 cm (16-20 in) away from the surface.
-2. Scratch the filled surface with your nail. If the surface is white when scratched, dry sand and wet
sand with the #240-#400 paper. Be sure to
sand level.
4. Cleaning with compressed air, and degreasing
Blow the entire area to be coated with compressed air, then clean with wax and grease remover.
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2-1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
NOTE: Clean the whole surface to the help the masking tape adhere securely.
5. Masking
Use the masking tape and paper to mask the area that should not be sprayed.
6. Coat with primer/primer surfacer, drying and sanding.
- Spray the primer surfacer over the filled area.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
- The coating thickness should be 20-25 microns.
NOTE: Follow the primer/primer surfacer manufacturers instructions.
-1. Drying
- Let the primer surfacer dry naturally for 5 to 10 minutes then dry with a infrared dryer.
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury. Do
not touch parts being dried.
- Be sure to keep the dryer 40-50 cm (16-20 in) away from the paint film.
-2. Sanding
Lightly dry sand the whole area to be painted with #600, #800 sandpaper
7. Blow off with compressed air, then clean with wax and grease remover
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
NOTE: Clean the whole surface to help the masking tape adhere securely.
8. Top coating
- Remove dust with a tack cloth before spraying.
- Spray the top coating. Spray until the primer surfacer is covered.
- The coating thickness should be 30-35 microns.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8367
NOTE: For the recommended top coat paint, refer to "Example of repair materials". Solid color:
Color enamel + color clear coat Metallic: Metallic enamel + clear coat Pearl: Pearl enamel + clear
coat
9. Drying
After top coating for about 10 minutes, then dry with an infrared dryer.
NOTE: Follow the paint manufacturer's specification to dry properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8368
Paint: Service and Repair Polypropylene (PP) Resin Parts
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8369
Refinishing Procedures
Refinishing Procedures
1. Sanding damaged areas
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8370
Shallow scratch: Level and finish damaged areas with #240- #400 sandpaper.
- Polish the leveled area with #400 sandpaper.
NOTE: Use a flexible block to sand the surface evenly.
- Do not remove too much material.
Deep groove/tear: Level and finish burrs and other irregularities with #240 sandpaper. Keep the surface as even as
possible.
2. Degreasing/cleaning
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm,30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
- Clean with wax and grease remover and dry with compressed air.
- Wipe off all lint and other foreign particles from the surface with a tack cloth.
NOTE: Be sure to use a tack cloth. Dust and dirt are electrostatically drawn to the surface.
3. Applying bumper primer (clear type).
- Stir thoroughly before applying the primer. Use a spray gun or brush depending on working
conditions
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Cover as wide an area as possible, except for shallow grooves (2-3 coats).
NOTE: Do not dilute the primer with thinner.
- Warm the primer if the outside temperature is below 50 degrees F(10 degrees C).
- Apply the primer to the back of the bumper if the damage is a tear or hole.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8371
4. Drying bumper primer.
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury.Do
not touch parts being dried.
- Dry the primer thoroughly with an infrared dryer or other dryer suitable for the purpose.
- If the damage or groove is shallow, heat the entire surface evenly. Apply heat locally if the
bumper is gouged or torn open.
NOTE: Use a dryer whenever possible.
- Do not allow temperature to exceed 158 degrees F (70 degrees C) or the bumper will deform
5. Apply filler (BOND QUICK MENDER.)
Mix the mender (A) into the hardener (B) in the ratio of I to I, and stir until they are thoroughly
mixed.
-1. Apply the mixture over the damaged area with a putty knife using light pressure. -2. Even out
the surface to match the contour of the bumper. -3. If there is a hole, cover it with a masking tape
from the back, and apply the filler over the outside surface.
After the filler has been dried, remove the tape and apply filler to the side that was taped.
NOTE: Apply filler so it extends over more than the damaged area.
6. Drying filler
7. Sanding filler
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding.
Wet sand first with #240 sandpaper then with #400 sandpaper.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8372
NOTE: Sand the surface evenly, particularly at the area where the PP resin and mender meet.
8. Degreasing/Cleaning
- Blow off the sanded surface, then clean with wax and grease remover.
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm,30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
Remove all dust and dirt with a tack cloth.
9. Spraying dual-Liquid bumper primer surfacer (gray)
NOTE: Use the urethane bumper primer.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
Spray the primer surfacer over a wider area than the filler and the exposed surfaces of bumper
primer.
NOTE: Spray 2-3 coats to get 20-25 microns of thickness.
10. Drying and polishing
Force dry the primer surfacer with infrared lamps or other industrial dryer.
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury.Do
not touch parts being dried.
NOTE: Use a dryer whenever possible.
- Do not allow the temperature to exceed 158 degrees F (70 degrees C).
-1. After force drying, wet sand the primer surface with #600 sandpaper.
NOTE: Use #600 or finer sandpaper as any paper coarser than this might scratch the surface.
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
-2. Air blow the surface to be repaired, then degrease with a wax and grease remover. -3. Also
clean and degrease where masking tape will be attached.
11. Intermediate coating
NOTE: Intermediate coating is recommended for bright colors.
- Use the top coat enamel.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most Paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed Read the paint label before
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8373
opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Mix the additive into the solid enamel color, metallic enamel or pearl enamel color in the ratio of 1
to 5 (by weight).
- Mix the hardener into the mixture of pigment and additive described above in the ratio of 1 to 4
(by weight).
NOTE: Keep the correct ratio, especially of the additive. Excessive additive takes longer to dry.
- Adjust to the proper viscosity for spray by adding the thinner specified for the primer into the
mixture of primer additive and hardener.
Viscosity: 68 degrees F (20 degrees C) 11-13 sec.
NOTE: It is not necessary to apply the clear coat.
- Spray 2-3 coats of the top coat enamel to get 15-20 microns of thickness. The primer surfacer
(gray) should not show through the top coat.
NOTE: Apply the top coat enamel to the repaired surface.
- Apply the top coat enamel to the entire surface of the primer surfacer when replacement is
necessary.
12. Degreasing and Cleaning
Air dry the entire surface, then clean with wax and grease remover (for USA usage-Dupont 38125
Enamel Reducer).
NOTE: For shading or spot painting, polish the area with a polishing compound. Also sand with a
#1500 paper to make a better bonding surface for the paint.
13. Masking
- Remove all existing masking paper, then mask with new paper.
- Use a heat resistant type masking tape (SCOTCH TAPE) where tape is attached directly to the
bumper.
- Use brown paper or masking roll paper to cover.
NOTE: Mask the area completely to prevent overspray.
- Protect resin parts with aluminum foil under the brown paper or masking paper to prevent damage
due to heat during baking.
14. Top Coating
- Air dry and degrease the surface before spraying the paint Also clean the surface with a tack
cloth.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Remove dust and dirt from the surface to be coated with compressed air, then use a tack cloth.
- Use a strainer when filling the cup with paint.
- Spray the paint evenly over the surface so the replacement part is completely covered.
- For application of the top coating refer to step "11 Intermediate coating".
NOTE: Do not try to cover the surface with one heavy coat. Apply several thin coats.
- With solid color (2-coat type), metallic color and pearl color enamels, allow final coat to flash-off
(5-20 minutes) before applying clear coat.
- Mix the additive into the clear in the ratio of 1 to 5. Adding the hardener and adjusting viscosity
should be done the same way as described on the previous page.
Viscosity: 68 degrees F (20 degrees C) 13-15 sec.
Mixing Ratio (weight)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8374
15. Drying top coat
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury. Do
not touch parts being dried.
- Before force drying, let it air dry for 5-10 minutes.
- Force dry the sprayed surface under the infrared lamps for 60-90 minutes.
- Keep the drying temperature between 140 degrees F (60 degrees C) and 158 degrees F (70
degrees C).
NOTE: Take care not to let the heat deform the part during the drying process.
16. Polishing and Buffing
- Let the paint dry gradually, then polish the surface carefully using a polishing compound and
sponge buff.
- To remove lint or dirt, wet sand the surface with #2000 or finer paper first, then polish with
compound.
NOTE: Polish all roughness caused by sanding thoroughly. To do this, first polish with very fine
compound, then with ultra fine compound.
- After polishing, remove the masking paper and tape and wash the entire vehicle thoroughly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8375
Paint: Service and Repair Soft Chipping Guard Primer Coat
Repair Material and Tools
Repair Materials and Tools
WARNING:
- Most paints contain substances that are harmful if inhaled or swallowed. Read the paint label
before opening the container.
- Spray paint only in a well ventilated area.
- Cover spilled paint with sand, or wipe it up at once.
- Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate clothing when painting.
Avoid contact with skin.
- If paint gets in your mouth or on your skin, rinse or wash thoroughly with water. If paint gets in
your eyes, flush with water and get prompt medical attention.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
Coating Procedures
Coating Procedures
NOTE: This section covers the application of the soft chipping primer to the replacement part.
1. Sanding the replacement part
WARNING: Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye Injury.
Sand the area to be painted with #240-#400 sandpaper.
NOTE: Do not oversand the edges or corners of the part.
- Do not expose bare metal.
2. Air blowing/degreasing
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
- Paint thinner is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or
cigarettes.
Clean the surface with compressed air and wax and grease remover.
3. Masking
- Place masking tape or paper around the surface to be painted.
- Cover as wide an area as possible with tape or paper to keep primer from spreading.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8376
4. Spraying chipping guard primer
- Stir the primer thoroughly.
- Put the primer in a beaker and weigh the needed amount of primer to be used.
- Mix the hardener into the primer, following the manufacturer's instructions.
NOTE: Measure the primer and hardener so they are in correct ratio.
- Add the specified thinner to the mixture of hardener and primer to attain the proper viscosity for
spraying.
2C 68 degrees F (20 degrees C) 18 sec ± 1
- These substances are not available in the U.S.A. Honda recommends using DuPont's 123 Vinyl
Coating, or Sherwin-Williams Vinyl Gravel Guard.Follow the manufacturer's instructions for
application.
- Once mixed with the hardener and thinner, the primer must be used within the times shown.
WARNING: Most paints contain substances that are harmful if inhaled or swallowed. Read the paint label
before opening the container. Spray paint only in a well ventilated area.
- Cover spilled paint with sand, or wipe it up at once.
- Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate clothing when painting.
Avoid contact with skin.
- If paint gets in your mouth or on your skin, rinse or wash thoroughly with water. If paint gets in
your eyes, flush with water and get prompt medical attention.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Fill the gun's paint cup with the primer. Use a strainer when pouring the primer into the cup.
- Primer should never be applied to a dirty or greasy surface. Before spraying, blow dust and dirt off
the surface and clean with wax and grease remover.
(Method of spraying) Do not try to cover the surface with one heavy coat. Apply several thin coats.
NOTE: Spray coat 4-5 coats to get 20 microns of thickness, as one coat deposits 5-7 microns.
- Spray the primer at 250-300 kPa (2.5-3.0 kgf/sq.cm , 35.6-42.7 psi) pressure. Spraying with
improper air pressure will cause imperfections.
- Open the gun 3-4 turns.
- Wipe up unwanted primer immediately with thinner.
5. Cleaning spray gun
- After spraying, be sure to clean the spray gun thoroughly with thinner or solvent.
- The gun will be permanently clogged if the primer is allowed to dry.
6. Drying
- After spraying the chipping guard primer, air-dry for 7-10 minutes to evaporate the thinner in the
primer. Then dry it with infrared lamps at
176 degrees F (80 degrees C) for 30-40 minutes.
NOTE: Insufficient baking may cause pinholes if the primer coat is too thick.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8377
- The temperature lamps and drying time recommendations should be followed closely.
7. Intermediate and Top coating
- Sand the chipping guard primer film with #280-#400 sandpaper.
- Follow the intermediate/top coating procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8378
Paint: Service and Repair 3C.3B (3-Coat.3-Bake) Paint
Paint Refinishing
Paint Refinishing
Paint damage can appear in any form. Before making a repair, check the damaged area carefully,
and determine the procedure best suited to the type. The following relates paint refinishing
methods to various types of paint damage of damage or defects.
Defects and Refinishing Processes
Defects and Refinishing Processes
WARNING:
- Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
A. Damage or defects that have gone through to the metal surface
Rusting or deformation:
Steps: 1. Featheredge the damaged area. 2. Prepare the metal surface. 3. Apply a chemical
coating to metal surface. Metal conditioner, Precoat, A.C.P treatment 4. Apply an undercoat (primer
surfacer) 5. Apply an intermediate coat (color matched to top enamel paint). 6. Apply a top coat
(body color paint).
Solid color: Enamel top coat paint Metallic color: Metallic enamel paint + Clear top coat Pearl color:
Pearl enamel paint + Clear top coat
B. Damage or defects up to undercoat or intermediate coat
External damage or blisters:
1. Perform Steps (4) through (6) under Item A.
C. Damage or defects that have not gone through to intermediate coats (only in top coat)
Shallow scratches or score marks: 1. If damage has gone through to the metallic paint, spray
metallic enamel, then apply top coat wet on wet. 2. If damage has not reached the metallic paint
and remained in the clear top coat, polish the damaged surface or-spray clear top coat alone.
NOTE: Try to repair by polishing as much as possible if the damage has not reached metallic paint.
D. Replacement of Parts
-1. Welded parts
Rear side outer panel, etc.
1. Perform Step (1) through (6) if the damaged area is covered with filler or welded with
reinforcement plate. 2. Perform Step (5) and (6) for undercoats except those on joints (Intermediate
coat for replacement parts). 3. On inner panels, apply paint where the undercoats is burned by heat
of welding. Follow this with a rust preventive treatment.
-2. Single Parts Painting of outer and inner hood, door, trunk lid, hatch, etc. Perform Step (5) and (6) of Item A.
- Painting of inside of front fender.
- Only enamel top coat paint may be used:
- Solid color enamel. Metallic enamel or Pearl enamel.
- After spraying enamel paint, perform rust preventive treatment (apply inner or outer rust
preventive agent).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8379
Refinishing Procedures
Refinishing Procedures
1. Featheredging (polishing damaged areas)
-1. Damage to metal surface Sand the damaged area flat and smooth with a double action sander and #60 or #80 disc paper.
- Sand the boundary between the metal surface and undercoat with a double action sander and
#180 or #280 disc paper. Try to sand a larger area than the damage.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8380
NOTE: Make sure there is no height difference between the metal surface and undercoat.
- If double action sander is not available, use a rubber block and wrap sandpaper around it to sand
the surface
WARNING: To prevent eye Injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding.
-2. Damage to Undercoat
Intermediate coat Top coat Paint coat on replacement parts
Sand the damaged surface flat and smooth with a double action sander and #280 or #320 paper.
NOTE: If double action sander is not available, use a rubber pad and wet or dry sand the surface with
#280, #320, #400 or #600 sandpaper.
- After sanding, check that the surface is flat and smooth.
- Perform the operations in Item 1-1 above for the areas where parts are welded to the body.
2. Preparation of metal surface.
Remove all corrosion from the damaged area using a #180 or #280 paper.
3. Air Blowing/degreasing
Air blow the sanded area, then degrease with a wax and
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure: Use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30psi)air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
4. Treatment of metal surface
- Brush or spray a solution of chrome phosphate or washer primer on the exposed metal surface.
- Use the following materials to treat the metal surface:
- Metal conditioner (Kamsai Paint)
- ACP agent (Nippon Paint)
- Precoat (Isam Paint)
NOTE: Follow the manufacturer's instructions.
- Treat the metal surface, as much as possible, to provide a better bonding surface for the
subsequent paint.
5. Application of Filler
Drying Sanding
- Small cracks or pinholes in the sheet metal should be repaired with a filler and sanded flat and
smooth.
NOTE: Mix the putty with the hardener in the correct ratio.
- Follow the filler manufacturer's instructions.
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury. Do
not touch parts being dried.
- Allow the filler to air dry for about 5-6 minutes, then force dry with an infrared lamp.
NOTE: Keep the lamp 40-50 cm (16-20 in) from the filler while drying.
- Stop drying the filler if a white mark appears when the surface is scratched with your nail. Wet or
dry sand the surface flat and smooth with a #280 or #320 paper.
6. Air Blowing/Degreasing
Air blow the surface to be repaired, then degrease with a wax and grease remover.
NOTE: Also clean and degrease surfaces where masking tape will be attached.
7. Masking
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8381
Mask the areas surrounding the damage to prevent overspray from the primer.
8. Application and Drying of Primer/Drying
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Spray the primer over the filler and surface (use epoxy or 2-part primer)
2-part primer). Spray : 2-3 coats.
- Use the following materials: 615SPrimer Surfacer (Dupont)
- Primer Surfacer EP (Akzo)
- NPS735 Urethane Primer Surfacer (R-M)
- Let the primer air dry for 5-10 minutes, then force dry with a infrared lamp.
NOTE: Keep the dryer 40-50 cm (16-20 in) from the surface.
9. Application of Polishing Undercoat
- Remove the masking paper and tape.
- Check that the undercoat has dried thoroughly, then dry or wet sand the surface with a #280 or
#320 paper.
NOTE: Use a rubber block and sand flat and smooth.
- Sand the entire surface to be refinished.
10. Air Blowing/Degreasing
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
Air blow all the surfaces, then degrease with wax and grease remover (for USA usage-DuPont
38125 Enamel Reducer).
NOTE: Also degrease the surfaces where masking tape will be attached.
11. Masking
Mask the undamaged areas surrounding the damage to prevent overspray from primer surfacer
(undercoat).
NOTE: Use masking tape and paper to mask the body. A vinyl cover may also be used to
effectively mask the body.
12. Application of Intermediate Coat (same color as enamel) top coat spraying/Drying
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Use the same color paint as the top coat. Spray it over the surface until the undercoat (primer
surfacer) is fully covered.
- Spray the paint slightly thicker than normal to allow for loss during subsequent polishing.
- Super ponacle II (R-M)
- Super Centri (Dupont)
- Auto cryl (Akzo)
13. Polishing of Intermediate Coat
- Check that the paint coat has dried thoroughly, then dry or wet sand the surface with a #600 and
#800 paper.
NOTE: Use a rubber block and sand flat and smooth, being careful not to expose the undercoat.
Polishing of Top Coat (if damaged):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Service and
Repair > ABS / PC Resin Parts > Page 8382
Use the same technique described above.
14. Air Blowing/Degreasing
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
- Air blow the entire surface, then degrease with wax and grease remover.
- For shading or spot painting, polish the area with a polishing compound. Sand with a #2000 paper
to give a better bonding surface for the subsequent paint.
15. Masking
- Remove all existing masking paper, then mask with new paper.
- Use a heat resistant type masking tape (SCOTCH TAPE) where tape is attached directly to the
body.
- Use brown paper or masking roll paper to cover.
NOTE: Mask the area surrounding the damage sufficiently to prevent overspray. It is also a good practice
to use a vinyl cover to protect other areas.
- Protect resin parts with aluminum foil under the brown paper or masking paper to prevent damage
due to heat during baking.
16. Application of Top Coat Spraying/Drying
- Prior to putting the car in the painting booth, thoroughly clean the interior and spray water over the
floor Be careful about blowing dust and dirt.
WARNING: Do not use high air pressure; use only an approved, 210 kPa (2.1 kgf/sq.cm, 30 psi) air nozzle.
- Wear goggles or safety glasses to prevent eye injury.
- Air blow and degrease the surface before spraying the paint Also clean the surface with a tack
cloth.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Spray color matched top coat over the prepared surface. Apply 2-3 coats in two directions until
the intermediate coat is fully covered.
NOTE: For application of the top coat, refer to step 12 "Application of Intermediate Coat."
Solid color: Color enamel + Color clear coat Metallic color: Metallic enamel + Clear coat Pearl
color: Pearl enamel + Clear coat
WARNING: Body parts being dried with an industrial dryer can get hot enough to cause injury.
Do not touch parts being dried.
- After spraying, allow the paint to settle for about 10 minutes, then force dry with an infrared lamp.
NOTE: Follow the paint manufacturers instructions.
17. Polishing/Buffing
- Let the paint dry gradually, then polish the surface carefully using a polishing compound and
sponge buff.
- To remove lint or dirt, wet sand the surface with #2000 paper or finer first, then polish with
compound.
NOTE: Polish all roughness caused by sanding thoroughly. To do this, first polish with very fine
compound, then with ultra fine compound.
- After polishing, remove the masking paper and tape, then wash the entire vehicle thoroughly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Radiator Support > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Support: Description and Operation
Description
The front bulkhead is joined to the front wheelhouse and the front side frame. It forms the base for
the headlights and other parts and maintains the rigidity of the front section of the body. Pay
particular attention to twists and parallelism, and check the mounting of related parts when welding.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8390
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control Module
> Component Information > Locations
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations
Dashboard/Door
Front of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control Module
> Component Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless)
With Keyless
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control Module
> Component Information > Diagrams > Power Door Lock Control Unit (With Keyless) > Page 8396
Keyless Door Lock Control Unit (USA Only)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control Module
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8397
Power Door Lock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's door panel. 2. Disconnect the 12P connector from the control unit.
3. inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control Module
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8398
Disconnect the 12P connector from the power door lock control unit.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the actuator, apply battery voltage only momentarily.
Reconnect the 12P connector to the power door lock control unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay
Moonroof Close Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay > Page 8404
Moonroof Open Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof Close Relay
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Close Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof close relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <-->
[Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof Close Relay > Page 8407
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Open Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof open relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Cable Housing <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Cable Housing] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof/Moonroof Cable Housing: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
1. Remove the frame. 2. Remove the motor and glass bracket.
3. Remove the nuts, and lift off each guide rail, then remove the cable assembly with sliders
attached.
NOTE: Take care not to bend the cable tubes and guide rails.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Damaged parts should be replaced.
- Grease the sliding portion with Super High Temp Urea Grease, P/N 08758 - 9002.
- Fill the groove in each grommet with sealant.
- Install the frame seal securely.
- Before installing the motor, make sure both sliders are parallel.
- Before installing the motor, install the frame and glass, then check the opening drag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Locations
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8416
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Be careful not to damage the seats, dashboard and other interior trim.
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Disconnect the motor connector and glass position switch connector.
NOTE: When removing the motor, detach the connector from the frame, remove the bolts and nuts,
then remove the motor.
3. Remove the glass. 4. Disconnect the drain tubes, and detach the ceiling light harness. 5.
Remove the frame mounting bolts.
NOTE: An assistant is helpful when removing the bolts.
- Remove the front bolts last.
6. Detach the rear hooks by moving the frame forward, then remove the frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page 8417
7. Pull the drain tubes out the front and rear pillars.
NOTE: Before pulling out the drain tube, tie a string to the end of it so it can be reinstalled.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: -
Before installing the frame, clear the drain tubes and drain valves by using compressed air.
- Check the frame seal.
- Clean the surface of the frame.
- When installing the frame, first attach the rear hooks into the body holes.
- When connecting the drain tube, slide it over the frame nozzle at least 10 mm (0.39 in.).
- Install the tube clip as shown.
9. Check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay
Moonroof Close Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams > Moonroof Close Relay >
Page 8423
Moonroof Open Relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof
Close Relay
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Close Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof close relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Relay] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Moonroof
Close Relay > Page 8426
Sunroof/Moonroof Relay: Testing and Inspection Moonroof Open Relay
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Five-terminal type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.5 terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.2 and No.4 terminals when power is disconnected.
Moonroof open relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Open/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch > Page 8431
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Tilt/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8432
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Adjustments
Switch Plate Adjustment (Fully Closed Position)
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Using the moon roof wrench, close the glass fully.
NOTE: Check the glass fit to the roof panel.
3. Using an open-end wrench, loosen the switch plate mounting bolts. 4. Adjust position of the
switch plate (switch cam) as shown. 5. Check the operation of the glass (from tilt-up position to fully
closed position, from the fully open position to the fully closed position) by
operating the moonroof switch.
NOTE: Check the glass height.
6. Close the glass fully, and check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof >
Sunroof/Moonroof Track <--> [Sunroof / Moonroof Track] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof/Moonroof Track: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
1. Remove the frame. 2. Remove the motor and glass bracket.
3. Remove the nuts, and lift off each guide rail, then remove the cable assembly with sliders
attached.
NOTE: Take care not to bend the cable tubes and guide rails.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Damaged parts should be replaced.
- Grease the sliding portion with Super High Temp Urea Grease, P/N 08758 - 9002.
- Fill the groove in each grommet with sealant.
- Install the frame seal securely.
- Before installing the motor, make sure both sliders are parallel.
- Before installing the motor, install the frame and glass, then check the opening drag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Drain: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Be careful not to damage the seats, dashboard and other interior trim.
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Disconnect the motor connector and glass position switch connector.
NOTE: When removing the motor, detach the connector from the frame, remove the bolts and nuts,
then remove the motor.
3. Remove the glass. 4. Disconnect the drain tubes, and detach the ceiling light harness. 5.
Remove the frame mounting bolts.
NOTE: An assistant is helpful when removing the bolts.
- Remove the front bolts last.
6. Detach the rear hooks by moving the frame forward, then remove the frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Drain > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8439
7. Pull the drain tubes out the front and rear pillars.
NOTE: Before pulling out the drain tube, tie a string to the end of it so it can be reinstalled.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: -
Before installing the frame, clear the drain tubes and drain valves by using compressed air.
- Check the frame seal.
- Clean the surface of the frame.
- When installing the frame, first attach the rear hooks into the body holes.
- When connecting the drain tube, slide it over the frame nozzle at least 10 mm (0.39 in.).
- Install the tube clip as shown.
9. Check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Be careful not to damage the seats, dashboard and other interior trim.
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Disconnect the motor connector and glass position switch connector.
NOTE: When removing the motor, detach the connector from the frame, remove the bolts and nuts,
then remove the motor.
3. Remove the glass. 4. Disconnect the drain tubes, and detach the ceiling light harness. 5.
Remove the frame mounting bolts.
NOTE: An assistant is helpful when removing the bolts.
- Remove the front bolts last.
6. Detach the rear hooks by moving the frame forward, then remove the frame.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8443
7. Pull the drain tubes out the front and rear pillars.
NOTE: Before pulling out the drain tube, tie a string to the end of it so it can be reinstalled.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: -
Before installing the frame, clear the drain tubes and drain valves by using compressed air.
- Check the frame seal.
- Clean the surface of the frame.
- When installing the frame, first attach the rear hooks into the body holes.
- When connecting the drain tube, slide it over the frame nozzle at least 10 mm (0.39 in.).
- Install the tube clip as shown.
9. Check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
00-095
March 26, 2002
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord With Moonroof - ALL 1996-02 Civic EX - ALL
Squeak From the Moonroof Seal (Supersedes 00-095, dated December 12, 2000)
SYMPTOM
The moonroof squeaks when the sunshade is open, the moonroof glass is closed, and the vehicle
is moving.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install Honda Squeak Reduction Tape around the moonroof opening.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Honda Squeak Reduction Tape (One roll repairs about 12 vehicles): P/N 70200-ALL-999, H/C
6656557
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 514007
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour
Failed Part: P/N 70200-S54-A01 H/C 5441241
Defect Code: 042
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-095A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. With a clean towel, wipe down the moon roof opening with isopropyl alcohol. This surface must
be free of any dirt and grease; otherwise, the tape will not stick.
2. Lay a clean shop towel along each moonroof track to prevent grease from getting on your hands
or the tape.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8452
3. Wash your hands thoroughly before applying the tape.
4. Measure and cut off a 270 cm (106 inches) piece of tape.
5. Peel oft about 5 cm (2 inches) of backing. Hold the tape at the very end of the exposed section.
6. Start at the middle of either the right or left side of the moonroof opening and apply 2.5 cm (1
inch) of the tape at the top edge of the moonroof opening. Do not apply the portion you touched
with your finger or apply the tape above the edges of the opening.
NOTE:
Leave enough space to cut oft the section of tape that you touched with your finger.
7. Remove the contaminated portion you touched with your finger.
8. Hold the tape up to the roof opening, and peel the backing away from the tape as you move
along the opening. Apply about 7.5 cm (3 inches) at a time. Do not apply the tape above the edge
of the opening.
9. Carefully slide the thumb of your free hand along the tape, removing any air bubbles.
10. Repeat steps 5 and 9 until you have applied the tape around the entire opening and until the
ends of the tape butt together. Do not overlap the ends of the tape. Cut off any excess tape.
11. Open and close the moonroof several times to ensure that it operates smoothly.
NOTE:
Do not apply grease to the moonroof seal. The seal makes noise only when moved excessively.
When the vehicle is driven, the glass does not
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8453
move enough to cause noise.
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Bulletin No. 96-023
Issue Date APRIL 15, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To EX
File Under BODY
Wind Noise or Water Leaks From the Moonroof
SYMPTOM
Water leaks or wind noise at highway speeds from the front or rear edge of the moon roof.
PROBABLE CAUSE
There is a gap between the roof and the weatherstrip on the edge of the moon roof.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 5T (see REQUIRED MATERIALS) between the weatherstrip and moonroof
frame.
1. With the moonroof closed, inspect the front and rear edges for gaps between the weatherstrip
and the roof. Note the location and length of any gaps.
2. If the gap is in the front, slide the moonroof all the way back. If the gap is in the rear, tilt up the
moon roof.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8458
3. Cut a strip of EPT Sealer 5T the same length as the gap noted in step 1. Trim the strip so it is 5
mm wide.
4. Lift up the weatherstrip along the gap area. Clean the moonroof frame under the weatherstrip
with isopropyl alcohol.
5. Remove the backing from the EPT Sealer 5T. Apply the EPT to the moon roof frame in the area
of the gap.
6. Open and close the moon roof several times, then verify that there is no longer a gap.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 5T:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8459
P/N 06991-SA5-000, H/C 2086650
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 814301
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 70200-S04-003 H/C 4846333
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-023A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
00-095
March 26, 2002
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord With Moonroof - ALL 1996-02 Civic EX - ALL
Squeak From the Moonroof Seal (Supersedes 00-095, dated December 12, 2000)
SYMPTOM
The moonroof squeaks when the sunshade is open, the moonroof glass is closed, and the vehicle
is moving.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install Honda Squeak Reduction Tape around the moonroof opening.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Honda Squeak Reduction Tape (One roll repairs about 12 vehicles): P/N 70200-ALL-999, H/C
6656557
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 514007
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour
Failed Part: P/N 70200-S54-A01 H/C 5441241
Defect Code: 042
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-095A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. With a clean towel, wipe down the moon roof opening with isopropyl alcohol. This surface must
be free of any dirt and grease; otherwise, the tape will not stick.
2. Lay a clean shop towel along each moonroof track to prevent grease from getting on your hands
or the tape.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8465
3. Wash your hands thoroughly before applying the tape.
4. Measure and cut off a 270 cm (106 inches) piece of tape.
5. Peel oft about 5 cm (2 inches) of backing. Hold the tape at the very end of the exposed section.
6. Start at the middle of either the right or left side of the moonroof opening and apply 2.5 cm (1
inch) of the tape at the top edge of the moonroof opening. Do not apply the portion you touched
with your finger or apply the tape above the edges of the opening.
NOTE:
Leave enough space to cut oft the section of tape that you touched with your finger.
7. Remove the contaminated portion you touched with your finger.
8. Hold the tape up to the roof opening, and peel the backing away from the tape as you move
along the opening. Apply about 7.5 cm (3 inches) at a time. Do not apply the tape above the edge
of the opening.
9. Carefully slide the thumb of your free hand along the tape, removing any air bubbles.
10. Repeat steps 5 and 9 until you have applied the tape around the entire opening and until the
ends of the tape butt together. Do not overlap the ends of the tape. Cut off any excess tape.
11. Open and close the moonroof several times to ensure that it operates smoothly.
NOTE:
Do not apply grease to the moonroof seal. The seal makes noise only when moved excessively.
When the vehicle is driven, the glass does not
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8466
move enough to cause noise.
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water
Leaks
Bulletin No. 96-023
Issue Date APRIL 15, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To EX
File Under BODY
Wind Noise or Water Leaks From the Moonroof
SYMPTOM
Water leaks or wind noise at highway speeds from the front or rear edge of the moon roof.
PROBABLE CAUSE
There is a gap between the roof and the weatherstrip on the edge of the moon roof.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 5T (see REQUIRED MATERIALS) between the weatherstrip and moonroof
frame.
1. With the moonroof closed, inspect the front and rear edges for gaps between the weatherstrip
and the roof. Note the location and length of any gaps.
2. If the gap is in the front, slide the moonroof all the way back. If the gap is in the rear, tilt up the
moon roof.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8471
3. Cut a strip of EPT Sealer 5T the same length as the gap noted in step 1. Trim the strip so it is 5
mm wide.
4. Lift up the weatherstrip along the gap area. Clean the moonroof frame under the weatherstrip
with isopropyl alcohol.
5. Remove the backing from the EPT Sealer 5T. Apply the EPT to the moon roof frame in the area
of the gap.
6. Open and close the moon roof several times, then verify that there is no longer a gap.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 5T:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8472
P/N 06991-SA5-000, H/C 2086650
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 814301
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 70200-S04-003 H/C 4846333
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-023A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair
Child Seat: Service and Repair
Child Seat Anchor Plate
2 Door/4 Door
3 Door
Attachment points are provided for a rear seat mounted child restraint system which uses a top
tether. The attachment points are located on the rear shelf or rear trim panel, just behind the rear
seat-back. When using a child seat with a top tether, install the child seat anchor plates securely.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Child Seat > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
8477
NOTE:
- Do not remove the toothed washer from the child seat anchor plate. Use the child seat anchor
plate with the toothed washer attached to it.
- When installing a child seat on the rear seat, follow the instructions of the manufacturer of the
child seat.
- Additional anchor plates are available.
WARNING:
- Do not use the child seat anchor plate for any other purpose; it is designed exclusively for
installation of a child seat.
- Make sure the rear seat-back is locked firmly when installing a child seat.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Interior - Fabric Upholstery Wrinkle Information
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Fabric Upholstery Wrinkle Information
Use a Steamer to Smooth Out Fabric Upholstery
A garment steamer and a stiff-bristle brush make a great team for removing those nasty wrinkles,
lines, or impressions in fabric upholstery. You can buy an inexpensive, small, hand-held garment/
fabric steamer from a number of different manufacturers. Some of these units even come with a
handy built-in brush.
Once you've got your steamer, follow the manufacturer's instructions to get it ready for use. Then
apply a generous amount of steam to the problem area. Keep the steamer moving slowly over the
area until it's hot and moist.
A Word of Caution: Go easy on the steam if you're cleaning the front passenger seat in a vehicle
with side airbags. Moisture can adversely affect or damage the OPDS sensors in the seatback.
While the area is hot and moist, use a stiff-bristle brush, or the built-in brush if your steamer has
one, to work the fabric back and forth and up and down. Stubborn areas might need more steam
and brushing, so be patient and stay with it. It's worth the effort.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Front Seat
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
NOTE: Take care not to tear the seams or damage the seat covers.
Seat-back cover removal:
1. Release the hook, and fold back the seat-back cover. 2. Release all inside springs, then fold
back the seat- back cover. 3. Remove the headrest.
4. Remove the headrest guide, then remove the seat-back cover. 5. Installation is the reverse of
the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seatback cover, make sure the material is stretched
evenly over the pad before securing the inside springs and hook.
Seat cushion cover removal:
1. Remove the seat cushion.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat > Page 8484
2. Remove the clips from under the seat cushion, then loosen the seat cushion cover.
3. Pull back the edge of the seat cushion cover all the way around, then release the clips, and
remove the seat cushion cover.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seat cushion cover, make sure the material is stretched
evenly over the pad before securing the clips.
- Replace the released clips with new ones.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat > Page 8485
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Rear Seat
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
NOTE: Take care not to tear the seams or damage the seat covers.
Seat-back cover removal:
2D/4D: 1. Remove the seat-back.
2. Loosen the seat-back cover by releasing all the clips.
3. Pull back the edge of the seat-back cover all the way around, then release the clips. 4.
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seat cushion cover, make sure the material is stretched
evenly over the pad before securing the clips.
- Replace the released clips with new ones.
3D: 1. Remove the seat-back.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat > Page 8486
2. Loosen the seat-back cover by releasing all the clips.
NOTE: Remove the lock knob, lock collar and latch cover.
3. Pull back the edge of the seat-back cover all the way around, then release the clips. 4.
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seat-back cover, make sure the material is stretched evenly
over the pad before securing the clips.
- Replace the released clips with new ones.
Seat side bolster cover removal (4D):
1. Remove the seat side bolster.
2. Loosen the seat side bolster cover by releasing all the clips, then remove it. 3. Installation is the
reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seat side bolster cover, make sure the material is stretched
evenly over the pad before securing the clips.
- Replace the released clips with new ones.
Seat cushion cover removal:
1. Remove the seat cushion.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat > Page 8487
4 Door
2 Door/3 Door
2. Loosen the seat cushion cover by releasing all the clips.
3. Pull back the edge of the seat cushion cover all the way around, release the clips, and remove
the seat cushion cover.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Seat > Page 8488
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: To prevent wrinkles when installing a seat cushion cover, make sure the material is stretched
evenly over the pad before securing the clips.
- Replace the released clips with new ones.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Latch: Service and Repair
2 Door/4 Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Latch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
8492
3 Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the inner handle.
2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the door lock switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector A
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Connector A > Page 8501
Power Mirror Switch: Locations Connector B
Driver's Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8502
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Without Defogger
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection Without Defogger
1. Remove the switch as described in Function Test .
2. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Without Defogger > Page 8505
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection With Defogger
1. Pry the switch out of the dashboard driver's lower cover. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector from
the switch.
Mirror Switch
Defogger Switch
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock Switch: Locations
Center of Trunk Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Open/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Open/Close Switch > Page 8513
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations Tilt/Close Switch
Underside of Roof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8514
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Adjustments
Switch Plate Adjustment (Fully Closed Position)
1. Remove the headliner. 2. Using the moon roof wrench, close the glass fully.
NOTE: Check the glass fit to the roof panel.
3. Using an open-end wrench, loosen the switch plate mounting bolts. 4. Adjust position of the
switch plate (switch cam) as shown. 5. Check the operation of the glass (from tilt-up position to fully
closed position, from the fully open position to the fully closed position) by
operating the moonroof switch.
NOTE: Check the glass height.
6. Close the glass fully, and check for water leaks.
NOTE: Do not use high-pressure water.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations
Underside of Hatch Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Spoiler: Service and Repair
NOTE: Take care not to scratch the hatch and body.
1. Remove the hatch upper trim.
2. Remove the nuts, and detach the clip, then lift the hatch spoiler up. 3. Disconnect the high mount
brake light connector and rear window washer tube, then remove the hatch spoiler.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Spoilers, Flaps, and Air Dams > Spoiler > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8522
4. If necessary, remove the spoiler trim from the spoiler frame.
NOTE: The hatch spoiler trim for Canada produced cars cannot be disassembled.
5. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: If necessary, replace any damaged clips.
- Make sure the connector and washer tube are connected properly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation
Front Strut / Shock Tower: Description and Operation
Description
The front wheelhouse component is constructed as a unit with the front damper housing.
Therefore, replacement of the component affects the front wheel alignment. When assembling it,
either use a positioning jig or follow dimensions on the frame repair chart for positioning. Weld
carefully.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8527
Front Strut / Shock Tower: Service and Repair
Replacement
1. Remove the related parts.
- Parts to be removed when removing the front bulkhead
- Parts on passenger side of lower dashboard which are especially flammable
- Electrical accessories in engine compartment and wire harnesses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8528
2. Pull out and straighten the damaged area to approximately the original shape.
- Attach the car to the frame straightener by tightening the underbody clamps at the horizontal
pinch weld points.
- Before cutting off the damaged sections, pull them out so that they are restored to the original
shape.
- Do not pull out more than necessary.
- Pull out and straighten the damaged area of the lower dashboard, front pillar, and other parts.
- After pulling, check the damper housing position using the body dimensional drawings and
positioning jig.
NOTE: Check the condition of the door and hinges.
3. Peel off the undercoat.
Heat the undercoat at the weld areas of the wheelhouse and front side frame with a gas torch, and
peel off the undercoat with a metal spatula.
CAUTION: Be careful not to burn the fittings inside the passenger compartment and dashboard
insulator when heating.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8529
4. When replacing the front wheelhouse.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints on the front side frame and damper housing.
- Drill holes in the center punched areas using a spot cutter.
- Using a chisel, pry off the welded flange.
- Level and finish the burrs on the welding surfaces with a sander.
5. When replacing the damper housing and front wheelhouse as an assembly.
-1 Remove the wheelhouse upper member.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints.
- Use the special spot cutter to drill holes at the spot weld nuggets.
- Remove the MIG weld flange with a disc sander.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding.
- Using a chisel, pry off the welded flange from the front pillar and damper housing.
NOTE: Remove the wheelhouse upper member carefully so they can be reused.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8530
-2 Using a spot cutter, drill holes in the spot welded area on the front side frame and dashboard
upper side member.
-3 From the passenger compartment side, drill holes in the spot welded area with as mm (0.2 in).
NOTE: Drill holes completely through the parts since the replacement damper housing will be
welded by MIG welding.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8531
6. Mold the related parts.
- Level and finish the burrs left on the welding surfaces with a sander.
- Fill all drilled holes by MIG or gas welding.
- Use a hammer and dolly to even out the welded areas of the lower dashboard, front side frame
and dashboard upper side member.
7. Set the new front wheelhouse and damper housing.
- Apply body paint to both sides of the new front wheelhouse and damper housing.
- See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Remove the undercoat from both sides of the welding section and expose the steel plate using a
disc sander
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cutting or
grinding
- Clamp to the front side frame with vise-grips and squill vises.
NOTE: Apply the spot sealer to the welding surface when spot welding.
- Clamp the front bulkhead with vise-grips.
- Measure the front compartment diagonally.
NOTE: Use of a positioning jig is recommended.
- Spot weld several points in the clamped sections, and temporarily attach the front wheelhouse
and damper housing
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8532
8. Check the dimensions, temporarily install the hood, front fender and headlight, and check for
differences in level and clearance.
- Check the engine and transmission mount brackets position.
9. Perform the main welding.
- Weld as much as possible with the jig still mounted.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
- Make 20% to 30% more spot welds than there were holes drilled.
- Plug weld the holes areas of the dashboard lower and damper housing with a MIG welder.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Strut / Shock Tower > Front Strut / Shock Tower > System Information >
Description and Operation > Page 8533
10. Weld the wheelhouse upper member.
When the upper member is to be reused, make MIG welds at the drilled holes.
11. Finish the welded area.
Use a hammer and dolly to even out the side bulkhead and front side frame flanges for close fit
with the surface of the front wheelhouse and damper housing.
12. Apply the sealer.
Apply sealer to the mating surfaces of the lower dashboard and front side frame, etc.
13. Apply the paint.
See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
14. Apply the undercoat.
Undercoat the front floor, etc, and apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the welding section of the
front side frame, lower dashboard, and upper member.
15. Install the related parts.
Install in the reverse order in which they were removed.
16. Inspect, check and make adjustment.
- Measure the front wheel alignment.
- Inspect the brake system.
- Adjust the headlight aim.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Rear
Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate
Tailgate: Technical Service Bulletins Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate
99-025
April 13, 1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic - 4-door DX thru VIN 1 HGEJ6...XL025605
- 4-door DX thru VIN 2HGEJ6.. .XH545281
Rear Door Lock Tab Is Hard to Operate
SYMPTOM The lock tab on the rear door is hard to push down and pull up.
PROBABLE CAUSE The lock crank is distorted.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Replace the lock crank.
PARTS INFORMATION Rear Door Lock Crank:
P/N 72630-SM4-003, H/C 3286911
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Failed part: P/N 72630-SM4-003 H/C 3286911
Detect code: 004
Contention code: B02
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Remove the door panel (see page 20-10 of the 1996-99 Civic Service Manual).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Tailgate > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Rear
Door Lock Tab Is Hard To Operate > Page 8538
2. Remove the screw from the lock crank, and pry the lock crank from the door.
3. Disconnect the lock rod and the lock tab from the lock crank. Discard the lock crank.
4. Connect the lock rod and the lock tab to the new lock crank. Secure the lock crank to the door
with the original screw.
5. Reinstall the door panel.
6. Lock and unlock the door with the lock tab several times to make sure the lock mechanism
operates smoothly and easily.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation
Cowl: Description and Operation
Description
Impact damage to the windshield lower area may spread to the back of the panel and wiper
mounting area, calling for replacement of the affected skins.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 8543
Cowl: Service and Repair
Replacement
1. Remove the related parts.
- Wiper arm and motor
- Windshield
- Right and left front fenders
- Right and left front door opening trims
- Front pillar trim
- Hood
- Wire harnesses and electrical accessories
- Steering column
- Dashboard, etc
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 8544
2. Cut the windshield lower and separate the welded flange.
- Center punch around the spot weld imprints.
- Drill holes with a spot cutter through the nuggets.
- Peel off the welding flange using a chisel.
- Level off and finish the burrs of the pried-off spot welds with a sander
WARNING: To prevent eye injury, wear goggles or safety glasses whenever sanding, cuffing or
grinding.
3. Set the new windshield lower.
- Apply an undercoat and body paint to the inside.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
- Sand off the undercoat down to the metal from both flanges to be welded.
- Clamp the new windshield lower in place with vise- grips and squill vises.
NOTE: Apply the spot sealer to the welding surface when spot welding.
- Install the new windshield and check for proper installation and alignment.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 8545
4. Tack weld the new windshield lower.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and burns when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
- Remove the vise-grips and install the fender and hood. Check for differences in level and
clearance.
5. Perform the main welding.
- Make 20% to 30% more spot welds than there were holes drilled.
WARNING: To prevent eye injury and bums when welding, wear an approved welding helmet,
gloves and safety shoes.
6. Finish the welding section.
Smooth the mating surface with the windshield with a hammer and dolly.
7. Apply the sealer.
Apply sealer to the upper dashboard, pillars, etc.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 8546
8. Install the front fender and hood.
Check the front fender and hood for differences in level and clearance.
9. Apply the paint.
See Paint Repair section.
WARNING: Ventilate when spraying paint. Most paint contains substances that are harmful if inhaled or
swallowed. Read the paint label before opening the paint container.
- Avoid contact with skin. Wear an approved respirator, gloves, eye protection and appropriate
clothing when painting.
- Paint is flammable. Store it in a safe place, and keep it away from sparks, flames or cigarettes.
10. Apply anti-rust agent to the inside of the windshield lower and dashboard upper.
11. Install the related parts.
Install in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Take care not damage the windshield and the paint finishes.
12. Inspect and clean.
- Check the windshield for water leaks.
- After installing the dashboard, check the lights, gauges, etc. for proper operation.
- Clean the interior.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body Moonroof Seal Squeaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
00-095
March 26, 2002
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord With Moonroof - ALL 1996-02 Civic EX - ALL
Squeak From the Moonroof Seal (Supersedes 00-095, dated December 12, 2000)
SYMPTOM
The moonroof squeaks when the sunshade is open, the moonroof glass is closed, and the vehicle
is moving.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install Honda Squeak Reduction Tape around the moonroof opening.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Honda Squeak Reduction Tape (One roll repairs about 12 vehicles): P/N 70200-ALL-999, H/C
6656557
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 514007
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour
Failed Part: P/N 70200-S54-A01 H/C 5441241
Defect Code: 042
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-095A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. With a clean towel, wipe down the moon roof opening with isopropyl alcohol. This surface must
be free of any dirt and grease; otherwise, the tape will not stick.
2. Lay a clean shop towel along each moonroof track to prevent grease from getting on your hands
or the tape.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8556
3. Wash your hands thoroughly before applying the tape.
4. Measure and cut off a 270 cm (106 inches) piece of tape.
5. Peel oft about 5 cm (2 inches) of backing. Hold the tape at the very end of the exposed section.
6. Start at the middle of either the right or left side of the moonroof opening and apply 2.5 cm (1
inch) of the tape at the top edge of the moonroof opening. Do not apply the portion you touched
with your finger or apply the tape above the edges of the opening.
NOTE:
Leave enough space to cut oft the section of tape that you touched with your finger.
7. Remove the contaminated portion you touched with your finger.
8. Hold the tape up to the roof opening, and peel the backing away from the tape as you move
along the opening. Apply about 7.5 cm (3 inches) at a time. Do not apply the tape above the edge
of the opening.
9. Carefully slide the thumb of your free hand along the tape, removing any air bubbles.
10. Repeat steps 5 and 9 until you have applied the tape around the entire opening and until the
ends of the tape butt together. Do not overlap the ends of the tape. Cut off any excess tape.
11. Open and close the moonroof several times to ensure that it operates smoothly.
NOTE:
Do not apply grease to the moonroof seal. The seal makes noise only when moved excessively.
When the vehicle is driven, the glass does not
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 > Body Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8557
move enough to cause noise.
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Bulletin No. 96-023
Issue Date APRIL 15, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To EX
File Under BODY
Wind Noise or Water Leaks From the Moonroof
SYMPTOM
Water leaks or wind noise at highway speeds from the front or rear edge of the moon roof.
PROBABLE CAUSE
There is a gap between the roof and the weatherstrip on the edge of the moon roof.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 5T (see REQUIRED MATERIALS) between the weatherstrip and moonroof
frame.
1. With the moonroof closed, inspect the front and rear edges for gaps between the weatherstrip
and the roof. Note the location and length of any gaps.
2. If the gap is in the front, slide the moonroof all the way back. If the gap is in the rear, tilt up the
moon roof.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8562
3. Cut a strip of EPT Sealer 5T the same length as the gap noted in step 1. Trim the strip so it is 5
mm wide.
4. Lift up the weatherstrip along the gap area. Clean the moonroof frame under the weatherstrip
with isopropyl alcohol.
5. Remove the backing from the EPT Sealer 5T. Apply the EPT to the moon roof frame in the area
of the gap.
6. Open and close the moon roof several times, then verify that there is no longer a gap.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 5T:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 > Moonroof Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8563
P/N 06991-SA5-000, H/C 2086650
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 814301
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 70200-S04-003 H/C 4846333
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-023A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 >
Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks
00-095
March 26, 2002
Applies To: 1998-02 Accord With Moonroof - ALL 1996-02 Civic EX - ALL
Squeak From the Moonroof Seal (Supersedes 00-095, dated December 12, 2000)
SYMPTOM
The moonroof squeaks when the sunshade is open, the moonroof glass is closed, and the vehicle
is moving.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Install Honda Squeak Reduction Tape around the moonroof opening.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
Honda Squeak Reduction Tape (One roll repairs about 12 vehicles): P/N 70200-ALL-999, H/C
6656557
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 514007
Flat Rate Time: 0.4 hour
Failed Part: P/N 70200-S54-A01 H/C 5441241
Defect Code: 042
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-095A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. With a clean towel, wipe down the moon roof opening with isopropyl alcohol. This surface must
be free of any dirt and grease; otherwise, the tape will not stick.
2. Lay a clean shop towel along each moonroof track to prevent grease from getting on your hands
or the tape.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 >
Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8569
3. Wash your hands thoroughly before applying the tape.
4. Measure and cut off a 270 cm (106 inches) piece of tape.
5. Peel oft about 5 cm (2 inches) of backing. Hold the tape at the very end of the exposed section.
6. Start at the middle of either the right or left side of the moonroof opening and apply 2.5 cm (1
inch) of the tape at the top edge of the moonroof opening. Do not apply the portion you touched
with your finger or apply the tape above the edges of the opening.
NOTE:
Leave enough space to cut oft the section of tape that you touched with your finger.
7. Remove the contaminated portion you touched with your finger.
8. Hold the tape up to the roof opening, and peel the backing away from the tape as you move
along the opening. Apply about 7.5 cm (3 inches) at a time. Do not apply the tape above the edge
of the opening.
9. Carefully slide the thumb of your free hand along the tape, removing any air bubbles.
10. Repeat steps 5 and 9 until you have applied the tape around the entire opening and until the
ends of the tape butt together. Do not overlap the ends of the tape. Cut off any excess tape.
11. Open and close the moonroof several times to ensure that it operates smoothly.
NOTE:
Do not apply grease to the moonroof seal. The seal makes noise only when moved excessively.
When the vehicle is driven, the glass does not
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 00-095 > Mar > 02 >
Body - Moonroof Seal Squeaks > Page 8570
move enough to cause noise.
DISCLAIMER
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 >
Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water
Leaks
Bulletin No. 96-023
Issue Date APRIL 15, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To EX
File Under BODY
Wind Noise or Water Leaks From the Moonroof
SYMPTOM
Water leaks or wind noise at highway speeds from the front or rear edge of the moon roof.
PROBABLE CAUSE
There is a gap between the roof and the weatherstrip on the edge of the moon roof.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Apply EPT Sealer 5T (see REQUIRED MATERIALS) between the weatherstrip and moonroof
frame.
1. With the moonroof closed, inspect the front and rear edges for gaps between the weatherstrip
and the roof. Note the location and length of any gaps.
2. If the gap is in the front, slide the moonroof all the way back. If the gap is in the rear, tilt up the
moon roof.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 >
Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8575
3. Cut a strip of EPT Sealer 5T the same length as the gap noted in step 1. Trim the strip so it is 5
mm wide.
4. Lift up the weatherstrip along the gap area. Clean the moonroof frame under the weatherstrip
with isopropyl alcohol.
5. Remove the backing from the EPT Sealer 5T. Apply the EPT to the moon roof frame in the area
of the gap.
6. Open and close the moon roof several times, then verify that there is no longer a gap.
REQUIRED MATERIALS
EPT Sealer 5T:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 96023 > Apr > 96 >
Moonroof - Wind Noise or Water Leaks > Page 8576
P/N 06991-SA5-000, H/C 2086650
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Operation number: 814301
Flat rate time: 0.4 hour
Failed part: P/N 70200-S04-003 H/C 4846333
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 96-023A
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Trunk / Liftgate Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control) <--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] >
Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control) <--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8584
Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations > Page
8588
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch (M/T)
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8592
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Locations > Photo 18
Cruise Control Actuator: Locations Photo 18
Left Front Corner Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Locations > Photo 18 > Page 8597
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Locations > Page 8598
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Actuator Test
Cruise Control Actuator: Testing and Inspection Actuator Test
1. Disconnect the actuator cable from the actuator rod and the 4P connector. 2. Connect battery
power to the No.4 terminal and ground to the No.1, No.2 and No.3 terminals.
3. Connect a vacuum pump to the vacuum hose. Then apply vacuum to the actuator.
4. The actuator rod should pull in completely. It the rod pulls in only part-way or not at all, check for
a leaking vacuum line or defective solenoid.
5. With voltage and vacuum still applied, try to pull the actuator rod out by hand. You should not be
able to pull it out. If you can, it is defective. 6. Disconnect ground from the No.3 terminal. The
actuator rod should return. If it does not return, but the vent hose and filter are not plugged, the
solenoid valve assembly is defective.
7. Repeat steps 2 through 5, and disconnect ground from the No.1 terminal. The actuator rod
should return. If it does not return, but the vent hose and
filter are not plugged, the solenoid valve assembly is defective.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Actuator Test > Page 8601
8. If you replace the solenoid valve assembly, be sure to use new O-rings on each solenoid. 9.
Disconnect power and ground from the 4P connector. Disconnect the vent hose from the actuator.
Connect a vacuum pump to the actuator vent
hose port, and apply vacuum. The actuator rod should pull in completely. If not, the vacuum valve
is stuck open. Replace the actuator.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Actuator Test > Page 8602
Cruise Control Actuator: Testing and Inspection Actuator Solenoid Test
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the actuator.
2. Check for resistance between the terminals according to the table.
NOTE: Resistance will vary slightly with temperature; specified resistance is at 70 °F (20 °C).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Actuator Disassembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Actuator <--> [Cruise Control Servo] > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Actuator Disassembly > Page 8605
Cruise Control Actuator: Service and Repair Actuator Replacement
1. Pull back the boot, and loosen the locknut. Then disconnect the cable from the bracket.
2. Disconnect the cable end from the actuator rod 3. Disconnect the 4P connector from the
actuator. 4. Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vacuum tank. Pull out the vent hose.
5. Remove the three mounting bolts and the actuator with the bracket. 6. If necessary, disconnect
the cable end from the linkage over the accelerator pedal, then turn the grommet 90° in the
bulkhead, and remove the
cable.
7. Install in the reverse order of removal, and adjust free play at the actuator rod after connecting
the cable.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Actuator Cable <--> [Cruise Control Servo Cable] > Component Information >
Specifications
Actuator Cable: Specifications
Locknut Free Play 11 +/- 1.0 mm
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Actuator Cable <--> [Cruise Control Servo Cable] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8609
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Actuator Cable <--> [Cruise Control Servo Cable] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8610
Actuator Cable: Adjustments
1. Check that the actuator cable operates smoothly with no binding or sticking. 2. Start the engine.
Hold the engine at 3,000 rpm with no load (A/T in [N] or [P], M/T in neutral) until the radiator fan
comes on, then let it idle.
3. Measure the amount of movement of the actuator rod until the cable pulls on the accelerator
lever (engine speed starts to increase). Free play
should be 11 ± 1.0 mm (0.43 ± 0.04 in.).
4. If free play is not within specs, loosen the locknut, and turn the adjusting nut as required.
NOTE: If necessary, check the throttle cable free play, then recheck the actuator rod free play.
5. Retighten the locknut, and recheck the free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Actuator Cable <--> [Cruise Control Servo Cable] > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 8611
Actuator Cable: Service and Repair
Actuator/Cable Replacement
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable.
Fig. 44 Actuator Cable Components
3. Pull back boot and loosen locknut, then disconnect cable from bracket, Fig. 44. 4. Disconnect
cable end from actuator rod. 5. Disconnect 4-P connector. 6. Pull ventilation hose from grommet. 7.
Disconnect vacuum hose from check valve. 8. Remove two actuator mount attaching bolts, then
the actuator with bracket and reservoir. 9. Disconnect cable end from linkage over accelerator
pedal, then turn grommet 90° in firewall and remove cable.
10. Reverse procedure to install, adjusting actuator cable as necessary. 11. On models equipped
with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for system disarming
and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Main Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8617
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8618
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Main
Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Main
Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8621
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Main
Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8622
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Vacuum Reservoir > Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
Cruise Control Module: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8630
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control)
<--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] > Component Information > Locations
Cruise Control
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control)
<--> [Brake Switch (Cruise Control)] > Component Information > Locations > Page 8635
Brake Lamp Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect the 4P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8639
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
Clutch Switch (M/T)
1. Disconnect the 2P connector from the switch.
2. Check for continuity between the terminals according to the table. 3. If necessary, replace the
switch or adjust pedal height.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8645
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8646
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Main Switch Test/Replacement
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Carefully push out the switch from behind the
dash-board.
3. Disconnect the connector from the switch.
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
If there is no continuity, replace the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8649
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Set/Resume Switch Test/Replacement
1. Make sure you have the anti-theft code for the radio, then write down the frequencies for the
radio's preset buttons. ('99 - 00 models). 2. Disconnect the battery negative cable, then disconnect
the positive cable, and wait at least three minutes. 3. Disconnect the driver's airbag connector. 4.
Remove the dashboard driver's lower cover.
5. Disconnect the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector from the main wire harness.
6. Check for continuity between the terminals of the cable reel sub-harness 3P connector in each
switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, the switch is OK.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, go to step 7.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Main Switch Test/Replacement > Page 8650
7. Remove the two screws, then remove the switch.
8. Check for continuity between the terminals in switch position according to the table.
- If there is continuity, and it matches the table, replace the cable reel.
- If there is no continuity in one or both positions, replace the switch.
9. If all tests prove OK, reconnect the cable reel and cable reel sub-harness connector, then
reinstall the steering column covers.
10. Reconnect the driver's airbag connector, and reinstall the access panel on the steering wheel.
11. Reconnect the battery positive cable, then the negative cable. 12. After connecting the airbag
connectors, confirm proper system operation: Turn the ignition switch ON (II); the SRS indicator
light should come on
for about six seconds and then go off.
13. Enter the anti-theft code for the radio, then enter the customer's radio station presets. ('99 - 00
models).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation
ABS Light: Description and Operation
1. The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) indicator light comes on when the ABS control unit detects a
problem in the system. However, even though
the system is normal, the ABS indicator light can come on, too, under the following conditions: Signal disturbance
- Wheel spin
- Only drive wheels rotate
- Battery voltage fluctuates
2. When a problem is detected and the ABS indicator light comes on, the indicator light can stay on
until the ignition switch is turned off, or it can
automatically go off, depending on the mode. Light stays on until the ignition switch is turned off: When the system is in the system down mode.
- Light automatically goes off: When the system is in the control inhibition mode.
3. The ABS indicator light stays on when the system is reactivated without erasing the Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC), but it goes off after starting
the vehicle. When the wheel sensor system is faulty and the ABS indicator light comes on, the
algorithm of the system automatically turns off the ABS indicator light after the wheel speed signal
returns to the normal speed. Also, when the DTC is erased, the CPU is reset and the ABS indicator
light goes off when the system checked out normal by the initial diagnosis. Therefore, test-drive the
vehicle after servicing the wheel sensor system, and be sure that the ABS indicator light does not
come on.
4. When the ABS control unit outputs battery voltage to gauge assembly, the ABS indicator light
goes off.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Audible Warning Device: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8659
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8660
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8661
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8662
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8663
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8664
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8665
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8666
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8667
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8668
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8669
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8670
Audible Warning Device: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8671
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8672
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8673
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8674
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8675
Seat Belt And Ignition Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Charge Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Charge Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
Charging System Light Test
Part 1 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Charge Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 8679
Part 2 Of 2
If the charging system light does not come on or does not go off, or the battery is dead or low, test
the following items in the order listed below:
1. Battery 2. Charging system light 3. Voltage 4. Alternator control system (USA) 5.
Alternator/regulator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations > Page 8684
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8687
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8688
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact > Page 8691
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air
Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 8692
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8698
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8699
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8700
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8701
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8702
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8703
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8704
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8705
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8706
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8707
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8708
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8709
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8710
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8711
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8712
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8713
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8714
Dash Lights Brightness Controller
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashlight Brightness Controller <-->
[Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8715
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: The control unit is built into the dash brightness controller.
1. Carefully pry the controller out of the dashboard. 2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the
controller.
3. Inspect the connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. -
If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the controller must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Rear Door Switch > Page 8720
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks
Fuel Gauge: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks
Bulletin No. 96-020
Issue Date MAR 18, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To 3-DOOR CX thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH113925
File Under ELECTRICAL
Fuel Gauge Sticks
SYMPTOM
The fuel gauge needle sticks in the full or empty position.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The fuel gauge sending unit binds on the baffle inside the fuel tank.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Reposition the fuel gauge sending unit.
1. Record the radio station presets (if applicable), then disconnect the negative cable from the
battery.
2. Relieve the fuel pressure from the system. (Refer to page 11-139 of the Service Manual.)
3. Carefully remove the drain plug from the fuel tank, and drain the fuel into an approved container.
4. Remove the rear seat cushion (one bolt, then lift the rear of the cushion).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks > Page 8729
5. Remove the access panel (four screws and one connector).
6. Loosen the five 6 mm mounting nuts for the fuel gauge sending unit. Do not remove the nuts.
7. Rotate the fuel gauge sending unit in a clockwise direction as far as possible. Make sure that the
base gasket is not twisted or pinched.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks > Page 8730
8. Using the sequence shown, tighten the five 6 mm nuts on the fuel gauge sending unit to 5.9 Nm
(4.3 lb-ft).
9. Connect the negative cable to the battery, then turn the ignition switch ON.
^ If the fuel gauge reads empty, reinstall the drain plug with a new 12 mm sealing washer (see
PARTS INFORMATION), and continue to step 10.
^ If the fuel gauge reads full, replace the fuel tank with the one listed under PARTS
INFORMATION. (Refer to page 11-148 of the Service Manual.)
10. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and fill the fuel tank. Turn the ignition switch ON.
^ If the fuel gauge reads full, continue to step 11.
^ If the full gauge does not read full, replace the fuel tank with the one listed under PARTS
INFORMATION. (Refer to page 11-148 of the Service Manual.)
11. Check for any fuel leaks around the fuel sending unit.
12. Reinstall the access panel and the rear seat cushion.
13. If applicable, enter the customer's radio station presets and reset the clock.
PARTS INFORMATION
Fuel tank: P/N 17500-S01-A30, H/C 4810339
Sealing washer, 12 mm: P/N 94109-12000, H/C 0171868
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks > Page 8731
Failed part: P/N 78130-S01-A01 H/C 4798112
Defect code: 039
Contention code: B99
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > SN030314 > Mar > 03 > Fuel Gauge & Low
Fuel Indicator Accuracy Check
Fuel Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Gauge & Low Fuel Indicator Accuracy Check
SOURCE: Honda Service News March 2003
TITLE: Charting the Fuel Gauge and the Low Fuel Indicator
APPLIES TO: 1998-03 Accord, 1996-03 Civic, or 1999-03 Odyssey
SERVICE TIP: If an owner is leery of the fuel gauge or low fuel indicator accuracy and worries
about running out of fuel, you may be able to restore faith in the accuracy of this hardware by
charting the operation.
If the fuel gauge, the low fuel indicator, or both doesn't give your customer a warm, fuzzy feeling,
don't replace the fuel gauge or the sending unit until you've first charted the fuel gauge needle
position and low fuel indicator status. You rarely improve accuracy by replacing fuel gauges and
sending units. To chart the fuel gauge needle position and the low fuel indicator status, do this:
1. Have your customer bring in the vehicle when the fuel tank is nearly empty.
2. Drain any remaining fuel from the tank.
3. Park the vehicle on a flat surface, and add 2 gallons of fuel to the tank with the ignition switch
turned to LOCK (0).
4. Start the engine, and note the fuel gauge needle position after 2 minutes. Draw a picture of the
fuel gauge showing the position of the needle. Also note on your drawing if the low fuel indicator is
on or off. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
5. Add 2 more gallons of fuel to the tank. Start the engine, and note the position of the needle after
2 minutes. Draw another picture of the fuel gauge showing the current position of the needle. Note
the status of the low fuel indicator. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
6. Repeat step 5 until the fuel tank is full. Then give your customer all of the pictures you've drawn.
They're usually enough to convince even the staunchest Doubting Thomas.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Sticks
Fuel Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Sticks
Bulletin No. 96-020
Issue Date MAR 18, 1996
Model 1996 CIVIC
Applicable To 3-DOOR CX thru VIN 2HGEJ6...TH113925
File Under ELECTRICAL
Fuel Gauge Sticks
SYMPTOM
The fuel gauge needle sticks in the full or empty position.
PROBABLE CAUSE
The fuel gauge sending unit binds on the baffle inside the fuel tank.
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Reposition the fuel gauge sending unit.
1. Record the radio station presets (if applicable), then disconnect the negative cable from the
battery.
2. Relieve the fuel pressure from the system. (Refer to page 11-139 of the Service Manual.)
3. Carefully remove the drain plug from the fuel tank, and drain the fuel into an approved container.
4. Remove the rear seat cushion (one bolt, then lift the rear of the cushion).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Sticks > Page 8741
5. Remove the access panel (four screws and one connector).
6. Loosen the five 6 mm mounting nuts for the fuel gauge sending unit. Do not remove the nuts.
7. Rotate the fuel gauge sending unit in a clockwise direction as far as possible. Make sure that the
base gasket is not twisted or pinched.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Sticks > Page 8742
8. Using the sequence shown, tighten the five 6 mm nuts on the fuel gauge sending unit to 5.9 Nm
(4.3 lb-ft).
9. Connect the negative cable to the battery, then turn the ignition switch ON.
^ If the fuel gauge reads empty, reinstall the drain plug with a new 12 mm sealing washer (see
PARTS INFORMATION), and continue to step 10.
^ If the fuel gauge reads full, replace the fuel tank with the one listed under PARTS
INFORMATION. (Refer to page 11-148 of the Service Manual.)
10. Turn the ignition switch OFF, and fill the fuel tank. Turn the ignition switch ON.
^ If the fuel gauge reads full, continue to step 11.
^ If the full gauge does not read full, replace the fuel tank with the one listed under PARTS
INFORMATION. (Refer to page 11-148 of the Service Manual.)
11. Check for any fuel leaks around the fuel sending unit.
12. Reinstall the access panel and the rear seat cushion.
13. If applicable, enter the customer's radio station presets and reset the clock.
PARTS INFORMATION
Fuel tank: P/N 17500-S01-A30, H/C 4810339
Sealing washer, 12 mm: P/N 94109-12000, H/C 0171868
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 96020 > Mar > 96 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Sticks > Page 8743
Failed part: P/N 78130-S01-A01 H/C 4798112
Defect code: 039
Contention code: B99
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > SN030314 > Mar > 03 > Fuel Gauge & Low Fuel
Indicator Accuracy Check
Fuel Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Gauge & Low Fuel Indicator Accuracy Check
SOURCE: Honda Service News March 2003
TITLE: Charting the Fuel Gauge and the Low Fuel Indicator
APPLIES TO: 1998-03 Accord, 1996-03 Civic, or 1999-03 Odyssey
SERVICE TIP: If an owner is leery of the fuel gauge or low fuel indicator accuracy and worries
about running out of fuel, you may be able to restore faith in the accuracy of this hardware by
charting the operation.
If the fuel gauge, the low fuel indicator, or both doesn't give your customer a warm, fuzzy feeling,
don't replace the fuel gauge or the sending unit until you've first charted the fuel gauge needle
position and low fuel indicator status. You rarely improve accuracy by replacing fuel gauges and
sending units. To chart the fuel gauge needle position and the low fuel indicator status, do this:
1. Have your customer bring in the vehicle when the fuel tank is nearly empty.
2. Drain any remaining fuel from the tank.
3. Park the vehicle on a flat surface, and add 2 gallons of fuel to the tank with the ignition switch
turned to LOCK (0).
4. Start the engine, and note the fuel gauge needle position after 2 minutes. Draw a picture of the
fuel gauge showing the position of the needle. Also note on your drawing if the low fuel indicator is
on or off. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
5. Add 2 more gallons of fuel to the tank. Start the engine, and note the position of the needle after
2 minutes. Draw another picture of the fuel gauge showing the current position of the needle. Note
the status of the low fuel indicator. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0).
6. Repeat step 5 until the fuel tank is full. Then give your customer all of the pictures you've drawn.
They're usually enough to convince even the staunchest Doubting Thomas.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8749
Fuel Gauge: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Fuel Gauge
The fuel gauge has two intersecting coils wound around a permanent magnet rotor. Voltage
applied to the coils, through fuse 25, generates a magnetic field. The magnetic field, controlled by
the fuel gauge sending unit, causes the rotor to rotate and the gauge needle to move. As the
resistance in the sending unit varies, current through the gauge coils changes. The gauge needle
moves toward the coil with the strongest magnetic field. The fuel gauge sending unit's resistance
varies from about 2 - 5 ohms at full, to about 110 ohms at empty. When you turn the ignition switch
off, the gauge remains at the last reading until you turn the ignition switch to ON (II) or START (III)
again.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8750
Fuel Gauge: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
NOTE: Refer to fuel gauge system circuit.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fusel relay box before testing.
2. Remove the access panel from the floor. 3. Disconnect the 3P connector from the fuel gauge
sending unit. 4. Connect the voltmeter positive probe to the No.2 terminal and the negative probe
to the No.1 terminal, then turn the ignition switch ON (II). There
should be between 5 and 8 V. If the voltage is as specified, go to step 5.
- If the voltage is not as specified, check for: an open in the YEL/BLK or BLK wire.
- poor ground (G552).
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 6. Attach a jumper wire between the No.1 and No.2 terminals, then
turn the ignition switch ON (II). 7. Check that the pointer of the fuel gauge starts moving toward the
"F" mark.
CAUTION: Turn the ignition switch OFF before the pointer reaches "F" on the gauge dial. Failure to
do so may damage the fuel gauge.
NOTE: The fuel gauge is a bobbin (cross-coil) type, hence the fuel level is continuously indicated
even when the ignition switch is OFF, and the pointer moves more slowly than that of a bimetal
type.
- If the pointer of the fuel gauge does not move at all, replace the gauge.
- If the gauge is OK, inspect the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8751
8. Remove the fuel gauge sending unit as shown.
9. Measure the resistance between the No.1 and No.2 terminals at E (EMPTY), 1/2 (HALF FULL)
and F (FULL) by moving the float.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8752
If the resistance readings are beyond the range, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Float Position E 1/2 F
USA,Canada Produced (ceramic Board Type) 105 - 108 ohms 29.5 - 35.5 ohms 3.5 - 5 ohms
Japan Produced (wire -Wound Type) 105 - 110 ohms 29.5 - 39.5 ohms 2 - 5 ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8756
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8757
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
NOTE: Refer to fuel gauge system circuit.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fusel relay box before testing.
2. Remove the access panel from the floor. 3. Disconnect the 3P connector from the fuel gauge
sending unit. 4. Connect the voltmeter positive probe to the No.2 terminal and the negative probe
to the No.1 terminal, then turn the ignition switch ON (II). There
should be between 5 and 8 V. If the voltage is as specified, go to step 5.
- If the voltage is not as specified, check for: an open in the YEL/BLK or BLK wire.
- poor ground (G552).
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 6. Attach a jumper wire between the No.1 and No.2 terminals, then
turn the ignition switch ON (II). 7. Check that the pointer of the fuel gauge starts moving toward the
"F" mark.
CAUTION: Turn the ignition switch OFF before the pointer reaches "F" on the gauge dial. Failure to
do so may damage the fuel gauge.
NOTE: The fuel gauge is a bobbin (cross-coil) type, hence the fuel level is continuously indicated
even when the ignition switch is OFF, and the pointer moves more slowly than that of a bimetal
type.
- If the pointer of the fuel gauge does not move at all, replace the gauge.
- If the gauge is OK, inspect the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8758
8. Remove the fuel gauge sending unit as shown.
9. Measure the resistance between the No.1 and No.2 terminals at E (EMPTY), 1/2 (HALF FULL)
and F (FULL) by moving the float.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8759
If the resistance readings are beyond the range, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Locations
With Front Passenger's Airbag
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Locations > Page 8764
Without Front Passenger's Airbag (Part Of Canada Model)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Airbag Handling and Storage
Do not try to disassemble the airbag assembly. It has no serviceable parts. Once an airbag has
been operated (deployed), it cannot be repaired or reused.
For temporary storage of the airbag assembly during service, please observe the following
precautions:
Store the removed airbag assembly with the pad surface up. The driver's (and front passenger's)
airbag connector(s) has (have) a built-in short contact.
WARNING: If the airbag is improperly stored face down, accidental deployment could propel the
unit with enough force to cause serious injury
Store the removed airbag assembly on a secure flat surface away from any high heat source
(exceeding 212 °F / 100 °C) and free of any oil, grease, detergent or water.
CAUTION: Improper handling or storage can internally damage the airbag assembly, making it
inoperative. If you suspect the airbag assembly has been damaged, install a new unit, and refer to
the Deployment/Disposal procedures for disposing of the damaged airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8767
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Wiring Precautions
Never attempt to modify, splice or repair SRS wiring.
NOTE: SRS wiring can be identified by special yellow outer protective covering.
Be sure to install the harness wires so that they are not pinched or interfering with other parts.
Make sure all SRS ground locations are clean and grounds are securely fastened for optimum
metal-to- metal contact. Poor grounding can cause intermittent problems that are difficult to
diagnose.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service Precautions > Airbag Handling and Storage > Page 8768
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service Precautions Radio "Code" Theft Protection
NOTE: The original radio has a coded theft protection circuit. Be sure to get the customer's code
number before
a. Disconnecting the battery. b. Removing the fuse from the under-hood fuse/relay box. c.
Removing the radio. d. After service, reconnect power to the radio and turn it on. When the word
"CODE" is displayed, enter the customer's 5-digit code to restore radio
operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In
Short Contact
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With
Built-In Short Contact
Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In Short Contact
The driver's airbag (and front passenger's) airbag has (have) a spring-loaded lock connector with a
built-in short contact. When this connector is disconnected, the power terminal and the ground
terminal in the airbag connector are automatically shorted.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Spring-Loaded Lock Connector With Built-In
Short Contact > Page 8771
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Description and Operation System Description
The SRS is a safety device which, when used in conjunction with the seat belt, is designed to help
protect the driver (and front passenger) in a frontal impact exceeding a certain set limit. The system
consists of the SRS unit (including safing sensor and impact sensor), the cable reel, the driver's
airbag (and front passenger's airbag).
Operation
The main circuit in the SRS unit senses and judges the force of impact and, if necessary, ignites
the inflator charge(s). If battery voltage is too low or power is disconnected due to the impact, the
voltage regulator and the back-up power circuit respectively will keep voltage at a constant level.
For the SRS to operate:
1. The impact sensor must activate, and send electric signals to the microprocessor. 2. The
microprocessor must compute the signals, and must send signals to the airbag inflator(s). 3. The
inflator(s) must ignite and deploy the airbag(s).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 8772
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
To prevent accidental airbag deployment, turn the ignition switch OFF, disconnect the negative
battery cable, and wait three minutes before disconnecting any SRS connectors.
- Before disconnecting the SRS main harness (A) from the SRS unit, disconnect both airbags
(C,D).
- Before disconnecting the cable reel 2P connector (B), disconnect the driver's airbag 2P connector
(C).
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, and wait at least three minutes. 2. Disconnect the airbag
connector(s).
Driver's 2p Connector
Driver's Side:
Remove the access panel from the steering wheel, then disconnect the driver's airbag 2P
connector and cable reel 2P connector.
Passenger's 2p Connector
Front Passenger's Side:
Remove the glove box, then disconnect the front passenger's airbag 2P connector and SRS main
harness 2P connector.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Panel
Illumination Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Key Reminder Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8780
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8781
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8782
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8783
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8784
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8785
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8786
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8787
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8788
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8789
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8790
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8791
Key Reminder Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8792
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8793
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8794
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8795
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8796
Seat Belt & Ignition Key Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8797
Key Reminder Switch: Description and Operation
Ignition Key Warning
Battery voltage is supplied at all times to the seat belt reminder/key-on beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit. When you turn on the ignition key switch the integrated control unit senses
ground. If you open the driver's door, the door switch closes, causing the beeper to sound until the
door is closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8802
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8803
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8804
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8805
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8806
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8807
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8808
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8809
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8810
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8811
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8812
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8813
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8814
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8815
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8816
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8817
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8818
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8819
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Service Precautions
WARNING:
Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from the work area. Drain
fuel only into an approved container.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8820
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from the work
area. Drain fuel only into an approved container.
A thermistor is mounted in the fuel tank unit. When the thermistor is cool, its resistance is very high.
When the thermistor's temperature increases, its resistance decreases. Fuel in the fuel tank
transfers heat away from the thermistor fast enough to keep it cool so the thermistor's resistance
stays high and the low fuel indicator light does not come on. When the fuel level drops below the
thermistor, the thermistor's temperature increases. Without the fuel to cool it, the thermistor's
resistance decreases, allowing current to flow through the low fuel indicator light and the thermistor
to ground, and the low fuel indicator light comes on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8821
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: For the low fuel indicator circuit diagram, refer to the gauge assembly circuit diagram.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the driver's under-dash fuse/relay box before testing. 2. Park the
vehicle on level ground. 3. Drain the fuel into an approved container. Reinstall the fuel tank drain
bolt with a new washer. 4. Add less than 4L (1.1 U.S. Gal, 0.9 Imp. Gal) of fuel, and turn the
ignition switch ON (II). The low fuel indicator light should come on within
four minutes. If the light comes on within four minutes, go to step 8.
- If the light does not come on within four minutes, go to step 5.
5. Remove the access panel from the floor. 6. Turn the ignition switch OFF, then disconnect the
fuel tank sending unit 3P connector.
7. Connect the fuel tank sending unit 3P terminals No.1 and No.3 with a jumper wire.
- If the light comes on, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
- If the light does not come on, check for: An open in the GRN/YEL wire between the fuel gauge sending unit and the fuel gauge.
- A blown bulb.
- A poor ground (G552)
8. Add 4L (1.1 U.S. Gal, 0.9 Imp. Gal) of fuel. The light should go off within four minutes.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
If equipped with maintenance reminder flag:
After completing the required service, the maintenance flags may be reset by inserting the ignition
key into the appropriate slot, on the instrument below the indicator flag. When the ignition key is
inserted into the slot, the indicator flag should change to green.
If equipped with maintenance reminder lamp:
1. Turn off the engine. 2. Press and hold the select/reset button(s) on the instrument panel, then
turn the ignition switch ON (Position II). 3. Hold the button(s) for at least 10 seconds, until the
indicator resets.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Customer Interest Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow
Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr > 99 >
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 8833
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr >
99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: All Technical Service Bulletins Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON
With Blow Fuse 15
99-029
April 20,1999
Applies To: 1996-99 Civic-4-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6.. .XL009798
-4-door thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .XH518131 -2-door thru VIN 1HGEJ6. . .XL021343 -3-door thru VIN
2HGEJ6.. .XH102598
MIL Is On With Blown Fuse 15
SYMPTOM The MIL is on with a DTC of P1298 (electrical load detector), P0135 (primary heated
oxygen sensor), P0141 (secondary heated oxygen sensor), or P0501 (vehicle speed sensor)
stored. Fuse 15 in the under-dash fuse box is blown.
PROBABLE CAUSE The engine wire harness is rubbing on the intake manifold bracket.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Repair the damaged wires, and protect the harness with corrugated
tubing.
PARTS INFORMATION Corrugated Tubing:
P/N 17132-P2E-999, H/C 6182760
7.5 A Fuse:
P/N 98200-40750, H/C 4853412
REQUIRED MATERIALS Electrical Tape: 3M P/N 54007-06132
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 737001
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 17132-P2E-A00 H/C 4776399
Defect code: 064
Contention code: B99
Template ID: 99-029A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Write down the customer's radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
3. Raise the car on the hoist.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Malfunction Indicator Lamp: > 99-029 > Apr >
99 > Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) ON With Blow Fuse 15 > Page 8839
4. Remove the intake manifold bracket.
5. Disconnect the engine wire harness from the intake manifold bracket.
6. Tape any damaged wires in the harness going to C115 (see REQUIRED MATERIALS).
7. Install the corrugated tubing over the harness. Tape the tubing to the harness to hold it in
position.
8. Reinstall the engine wire harness to the intake manifold bracket. Reinstall the bracket to the
engine. Torque the bolts to 24 N.m (17 lb-ft).
9. Lower the car.
10. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
11. Enter the customer's radio station presets. Set the clock.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8840
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Does Not Come ON
NOTE: If this symptom is intermittent, check for a loose fuse No.25 (METER 7.5 A) in the
under-dash fuse/relay box, a poor connection at ECM/PCM terminal A18, or an intermittent open in
the GRN/ORN wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 8843
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection MIL Stays ON
Part 1 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 8844
Part 2 Of 3
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > MIL Does Not Come ON > Page 8845
Part 3 Of 3
NOTE:
- When there is no Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) stored, the MIL will stay on if the SCS service
connector is connected and the ignition switch is on.
- If this symptom is intermittent, check for: A loose FIE/M (15 A) fuse in the under-hood fuse/relay box
- A loose No.13 FUEL PUMP fuse (15 A) in the under-dash fuse/relay box
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (C7) and the service check connector
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (A18) and the gauge assembly
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D4) and the MAP sensor
- An intermittent short in the wire between the ECM/PCM (D10), the TP sensor, the EGR valve lift
sensor (D16Y5 engine) and/or the Fuel tank pressure sensor ('96 D16Y8 engine (coupe), '97
D16Y7 engine (coupe: KL model, sedan: KL (LX model), '97 D16Y8 engine (coupe: all models,
sedan: KL model), '98-all models)
- PGM-FI main relay See the OBD II scan tool or Honda PGM Tester user's manuals for specific operating instructions.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Odometer: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Speedometer and Odometer
The odometer and speedometer drive circuits receive pulses from the vehicle speed sensor (VSS).
The pulse rate increases as the car accelerates. The frequency and duration of these input pulses
are measured and displayed by the speedometer, odometer and tripmeter.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8856
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8857
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8858
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8859
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8860
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8861
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8862
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8863
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8864
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8865
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8866
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8867
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8868
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8869
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8870
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8871
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8872
Oil Pressure Indicator Light
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel >
Panel Illumination Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8884
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8885
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8886
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8887
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8888
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8889
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8890
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8891
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8892
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8893
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8894
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8895
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8896
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8897
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8898
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8899
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8900
Seat Belt And Ignition Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8901
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is applied to the seat belt reminder
light. When the seat belt is not buckled, the seat belt reminder/key-ON beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit senses ground through the closed seat belt switch. The seat belt reminder
light comes ON and stays ON, and the beeper beeps for 6 seconds. The reminder light and beeper
will stop when the seat belt is buckled or the timer circuit deactivates them.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Locations
Dashboard
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8908
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8909
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8910
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8911
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8912
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8913
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8914
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8915
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8916
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8917
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8918
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8919
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8920
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8921
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8922
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8923
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 8924
Dash Lights Brightness Controller
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8925
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: The control unit is built into the dash brightness controller.
1. Carefully pry the controller out of the dashboard. 2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the
controller.
3. Inspect the connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. -
If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the controller must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch > Page 8930
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Float Position E 1/2 F
USA,Canada Produced (ceramic Board Type) 105 - 108 ohms 29.5 - 35.5 ohms 3.5 - 5 ohms
Japan Produced (wire -Wound Type) 105 - 110 ohms 29.5 - 39.5 ohms 2 - 5 ohms
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 8934
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 8935
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: Do not smoke while working on the fuel system. Keep open flame away from your work
area.
NOTE: Refer to fuel gauge system circuit.
1. Check the No.25 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fusel relay box before testing.
2. Remove the access panel from the floor. 3. Disconnect the 3P connector from the fuel gauge
sending unit. 4. Connect the voltmeter positive probe to the No.2 terminal and the negative probe
to the No.1 terminal, then turn the ignition switch ON (II). There
should be between 5 and 8 V. If the voltage is as specified, go to step 5.
- If the voltage is not as specified, check for: an open in the YEL/BLK or BLK wire.
- poor ground (G552).
5. Turn the ignition switch OFF. 6. Attach a jumper wire between the No.1 and No.2 terminals, then
turn the ignition switch ON (II). 7. Check that the pointer of the fuel gauge starts moving toward the
"F" mark.
CAUTION: Turn the ignition switch OFF before the pointer reaches "F" on the gauge dial. Failure to
do so may damage the fuel gauge.
NOTE: The fuel gauge is a bobbin (cross-coil) type, hence the fuel level is continuously indicated
even when the ignition switch is OFF, and the pointer moves more slowly than that of a bimetal
type.
- If the pointer of the fuel gauge does not move at all, replace the gauge.
- If the gauge is OK, inspect the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 8936
8. Remove the fuel gauge sending unit as shown.
9. Measure the resistance between the No.1 and No.2 terminals at E (EMPTY), 1/2 (HALF FULL)
and F (FULL) by moving the float.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Specifications > Page 8937
If the resistance readings are beyond the range, replace the fuel gauge sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Key Reminder Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8942
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8943
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8944
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8945
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8946
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8947
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8948
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8949
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8950
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8951
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8952
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8953
Key Reminder Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8954
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8955
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8956
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8957
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8958
Seat Belt & Ignition Key Reminders
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8959
Key Reminder Switch: Description and Operation
Ignition Key Warning
Battery voltage is supplied at all times to the seat belt reminder/key-on beeper circuit in the
integrated control unit. When you turn on the ignition key switch the integrated control unit senses
ground. If you open the driver's door, the door switch closes, causing the beeper to sound until the
door is closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel
> Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Indicator: Locations
SRS components are located in this area Review the SRS component locations precautions and
procedures in the SRS before performing repairs or service.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8968
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8969
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8970
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8971
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8972
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8973
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8974
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8975
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8976
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8977
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8978
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8979
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8980
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8981
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8982
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8983
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8984
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram
CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8985
Except CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8986
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8987
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
With the ignition switch in ON (II) or START (III), voltage is applied to the A/T gear position
indicator. The A/T gear position switch provides a ground for each position. As an input is
grounded, its indicator light comes ON. If you select R, for example, ground will be provided to the
input of the A/T gear position indicator, and the R indicator will come ON.
With the headlight switch in PARK or HEAD, voltage is applied to the RED/BLK wire terminal. This
changes the indicator panel illumination from fixed to controlled by the dash lights dimmer input
through the RED wire.
When the Powertrain (except HX) or Transmission (HX) Control Module (PCM or TCM) detects an
abnormality in the automatic transmission control system, or when you request diagnostic trouble
codes through the service check connector, the PCM or TCM will make the D4 (D for HX) indicator
light blink.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 8990
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 8991
Shift Indicator: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 8992
Shift Indicator: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D4]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detent and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Page 8993
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral". 4. Move the shift lever
to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting nuts. 6.
Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when the shift
lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Speedometer Head: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Speedometer and Odometer
The odometer and speedometer drive circuits receive pulses from the vehicle speed sensor (VSS).
The pulse rate increases as the car accelerates. The frequency and duration of these input pulses
are measured and displayed by the speedometer, odometer and tripmeter.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tachometer > Tachometer Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Tachometer Connector: Locations
Left Rear Corner Of Of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations
Gauge Assembly
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9004
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
When the ignition switch is in ON (II) or START (III), battery voltage is supplied through fuse 25 to
the gauges in the gauge assembly.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
The engine coolant temperature gauge has two intersecting coils wound around a permanent
magnet rotor. Voltage applied to the coils, through fuse 25, generates a magnetic field. The
magnetic field, controlled by the coolant temperature sending unit, causes the rotor to rotate and
the gauge needle to move. As the resistance in the sending unit varies, current through the gauge
coils changes. The gauge needle moves toward the coil with the strongest magnetic field.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9005
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
1. Check No. 15 (10A) fuse in under dash fuse/relay box before testing.
Fig. 1 Engine Coolant Temperature Unit
2. Ensure ignition switch is in Off position, then disconnect yellow/green wire from coolant
temperature sending unit, Fig. 1, and ground it with a
jumper wire.
3. Turn ignition switch to On position. 4. Check as needle of coolant temperature gauge starts
moving toward H mark. Turn ignition switch to Off position before pointer reaches H
mark on gauge dial. Failure to do so may damage gauge.
5. If pointer of gauge does not move, check the following:
a. Blown fuse in under dash fuse/relay box. b. Open in yellow/green wire, yellow or red wire. c. If
fuse and wiring are satisfactory, replace coolant temperature gauge.
6. If gauge is satisfactory, inspect sending unit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) >
Component Information > Locations
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Right Front of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Testing and Inspection
Indicator Input Test
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9012
Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard, and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly. 2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Locations
A/T Gear Position Indicator
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9018
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9019
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9020
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9021
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9022
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9023
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9024
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9025
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9026
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9027
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9028
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9029
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9030
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9031
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9032
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9033
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9034
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
A/T Gear Position Indicator - CVT
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9035
A/T Gear Position Indicator - A/T
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Indicator Input Test
1. Remove the gauge assembly from the dashboard and disconnect the 14P connector from the
gauge assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 9038
2. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the 14P connector. If a test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, but the indicator is faulty, replace the printed circuit board
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Indicator Input Test > Page 9039
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection Switch Test
1. Remove the front console. 2. Disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
- Move the shift lever back and forth without pushing the shift lever at each switch position, and
check for continuity within the range of free play of the shift lever.
- If there is no continuity within the range of free play, adjust the position of the switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9040
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Adjustments
1. Shift to the [P] position, and loosen the nuts. 2. Slide the switch in the direction of [D4] or [D]
position [within 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)] so that there is continuity between the No.1 and No.7
terminals in the range of free play of the shift lever.
3. Recheck for continuity between each of the terminals.
NOTE: If adjustment is not possible, check for damage to the shift lever detect and/or the bracket. If there
is no damage, replace the console switch.
- The engine should start when the shift lever is in position [N] in the range of free play.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9041
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front console, then disconnect the 14P connector from the A/T gear position switch.
2. Remove the two mounting nuts. 3. Position the switch slider to "Neutral" as shown. 4. Move the
shift lever to "Neutral", then slip the switch into position. 5. Attach the switch with the two mounting
nuts. 6. Test the switch in the [P] and [N] position of the shift lever. The engine should start when
the shift lever is in position [P] anywhere in the range of
free play.
7. Connect the 14P connector, clamp the harness, and install the front console.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Right Side of Engine Compartment (M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T) > Page 9048
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (SI)
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Light Bulb > Component Information >
Specifications
Backup Light Bulb: Specifications
Back-Up Light 21 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information >
Specifications
Brake Light Bulb: Specifications
Brake Light 21 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Brake Light Bulb > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 9056
Brake Light Bulb: Description and Operation
The brake system indicator light comes ON to alert the driver that the parking brake is applied, or
that the brake fluid level is low. It also comes ON as a bulb test when the engine is cranked.
Bulb Check With the ignition switch in START (III) and clutch pedal depressed or A/T gear selector
in PARK (P) or NEUTRAL (N), voltage is applied through fuse 31 to the brake bulb check circuit.
The brake bulb check circuit closes, allowing current to flow through the brake system light and
bulb check circuit to ground. The brake system light then comes ON to test the bulb.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect wiring at switch. 2. Loosen locknut and remove switch. 3. Reverse procedure to
install. Allow 0.039-0.196 inch (1-5 mm) brake pedal freeplay.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Coupe/Sedan
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Coupe/Sedan
High Mount Brake Light Replacement
1. Remove the rear shelf.
2. Remove the two screws, then remove the high mount brake light from the rear shelf.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Coupe/Sedan > Page 9065
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Service and Repair Hatchback
High Mount Brake Light Replacement
1. Loosen the two screws, then remove the high mount brake light. Be careful not to damage the
hatch spoiler.
2. Remove the bulb socket from the light.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Interior Lights
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Courtesy Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9071
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9072
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9073
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9074
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9075
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9076
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9077
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9078
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9079
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9080
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9081
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9082
Courtesy Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9083
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9084
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9085
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9086
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9087
Courtesy Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
Interior Lights (Without Spotlights)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9088
Interior Lights (With Spotlights)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9089
Courtesy Lamp: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn the light switch OFF. 2. Pry off the lens. 3. Remove the two mounting nuts (or a bolt) from
the housing, then remove the housing. 4. Disconnect the connector(s) from the housing.
5. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
with moonroof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9090
without moonroof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9095
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9096
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9097
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
Daytime Running Lights Control Unit Input Test (Canada)
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the connectors from
the daytime running lights control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Resistor > Component
Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Resistor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9101
Daytime Running Lamp Resistor: Testing and Inspection
Test (Canada)
CAUTION: The daytime running lights resistor becomes very hot when the daytime running lights
are on; do not touch it or the attaching hardware immediately after the lights have been turned off.
1. Disconnect the 3P connector from the resistor. 2. Measure the resistance between the resistor
terminals (No.1 and No.2) and the power terminal No.3.
Resistance: 1.6 Ohms ± 0.08 Ohms
3. Replace the resistor with a new one if any of the resistances are beyond specification.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Resistor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9102
Daytime Running Lamp Resistor: Service and Repair
Daytime Running Lights Resistor Test (Canada)
Replacement
CAUTION: Halogen headlights become very hot in use; do not touch them or the attaching
hardware immediately after they have been turned off.
1. Remove the front bumper. 2. Remove the mounting bolts. 3. Disconnect each connector, then
remove the headlight/front turn signal/parking light assembly.
HEADLIGHT: 60/55 W FRONT TURN SIGNAL/PARKING LIGHT: 21/5 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Locations
Dashboard
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9108
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9109
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9110
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9111
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9112
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9113
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9114
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9115
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9116
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9117
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9118
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9119
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9120
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9121
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9122
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9123
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9124
Dash Lights Brightness Controller
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dashlight Brightness Controller <--> [Dimmer Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 9125
Dashlight Brightness Controller: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: The control unit is built into the dash brightness controller.
1. Carefully pry the controller out of the dashboard. 2. Disconnect the 3P connector from the
controller.
3. Inspect the connector terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the input tests shown in the table at the connector. -
If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the controller must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Component Location Index
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9129
Dome Lamp: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn the light switch OFF. 2. Pry off the lens. 3. Remove the two mounting nuts (or a bolt) from
the housing, then remove the housing. 4. Disconnect the connectors from the housing.
With Moonroof
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Component Information > Locations > Page 9130
Without Moonroof
5. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch >
Page 9135
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side Of Dash Panel - Photo 69
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Hazard Flasher Relay: Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9144
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Flasher Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9145
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Hazard Warning Flasher: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9150
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9151
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9152
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9153
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9154
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9155
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9156
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9157
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9158
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9159
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9160
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9161
Hazard Warning Flasher: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9162
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9163
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9164
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9165
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9166
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9170
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9171
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the hazard warning switch or the center outlet panel when
prying the switch out.
1. Pry the hazard warning switch out of the center outlet panel. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the hazard warning switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information >
Specifications
Headlamp Bulb: Specifications
Headlights 60/55 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9180
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9181
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9182
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9183
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9184
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9185
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9186
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9187
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9188
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9189
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9190
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9191
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9192
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9193
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9194
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9195
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9196
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9197
Part 2 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9198
Part 3 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9199
Part 4 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9200
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlight <--> [Headlamp] > Headlamp Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9201
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hi-Beam Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate
View
Horn Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate
View > Page 9210
Horn
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate
View > Page 9211
Horn Relay: Locations Picture Location
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9212
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Horn relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9218
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9219
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9220
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9221
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9222
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9223
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9224
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9225
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9226
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9227
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9228
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9229
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9230
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9231
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9232
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9233
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9234
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9235
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9236
License Plate Lamp: Service and Repair
1. Remove the two screws from the license plate light, and pull the light out part of the way. 2.
Disconnect the 2P connector from the light.
3. Take the lens off, then replace the bulb.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Spotlight: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9241
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9242
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9243
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9244
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9245
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9246
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9247
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9248
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9249
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9250
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9251
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9252
Spotlight: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9253
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9254
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9255
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9256
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9257
Spotlight: Electrical Diagrams
Circuit Diagram (Without Spotlights)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9258
Circuit Diagram (With Spotlights)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spotlight <--> [Map Light] > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
9259
Spotlight: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn the spotlight switch OFF. 2. Pry off the lens. 3. Remove the two screws and the housing. 4.
Disconnect the 1P connector from the housing.
5. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Light Bulb > Component Information >
Specifications
Parking Light Bulb: Specifications
Parking Light 5 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Dashboard (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 9268
Lighting System (Part 1 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 9269
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 9270
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Testing and Inspection
Daytime Running Lights Control Unit Input Test (Canada)
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the connectors from
the daytime running lights control unit.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Locations
Behind Left Side Of Dash Panel - Photo 69
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Hazard Flasher Relay: Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9277
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Flasher Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9278
Hazard Flasher Relay: Testing and Inspection
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View
Horn Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9283
Horn
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9284
Horn Relay: Locations Picture Location
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9285
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Horn relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9290
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9291
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9292
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (M/T)
Right Side of Engine Compartment (M/T)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Back-Up Light Switch (M/T) > Page 9298
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations Back-Up Light Switch (SI)
Lower Front of Transmission
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect wiring at switch. 2. Loosen locknut and remove switch. 3. Reverse procedure to
install. Allow 0.039-0.196 inch (1-5 mm) brake pedal freeplay.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9310
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9311
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9312
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9313
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 >
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9314
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9320
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9321
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9322
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9323
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 >
Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9324
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 9327
Combination Switch: Connector Locations
Combination Light Switch Connector A
Left Side of Steering Column
Combination Light Switch Connector B
Left Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9328
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9329
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
-
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch.
- If there is no continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9330
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
Combination Switch Replacement
Honda does not provide a service procedure for this component.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch
Door Switch: Locations Rear Door Switch
Left Rear Door Striker Area (Right Similar)
Left of Rear Seat (Sedan Shown, Others Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Rear Door Switch > Page 9335
Door Switch: Locations Door Switch
At Driver's Door Striker Area (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9339
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9340
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the hazard warning switch or the center outlet panel when
prying the switch out.
1. Pry the hazard warning switch out of the center outlet panel. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the hazard warning switch.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9345
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9346
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9347
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9348
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9349
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9350
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9351
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9352
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9353
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9354
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9355
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9356
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9357
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9358
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9359
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9360
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9361
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9362
Part 2 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9363
Part 3 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9364
Part 4 Of 4
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9365
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9366
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9370
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Spot Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9375
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9376
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9377
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9378
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9379
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9380
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9381
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9382
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9383
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9384
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9385
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9386
Spot Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9387
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9388
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9389
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9390
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9391
Spot Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9392
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Spot Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9393
Spot Lamp: Testing and Inspection
1. Turn the spotlight switch OFF. 2. Pry off the lens. 3. Remove the two screws and the housing. 4.
Disconnect the 1p connector from the housing.
5. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Tail Light Bulb > Component Information > Specifications
Tail Light Bulb: Specifications
Taillight 5 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Trunk Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9402
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9403
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9404
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9405
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9406
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9407
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9408
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9409
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9410
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9411
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9412
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9413
Trunk Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9414
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9415
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9416
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9417
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9418
Trunk Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
Part 1 of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 9419
Part 2 Of 2
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trunk Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9420
Trunk Lamp: Testing and Inspection
1. Open the trunk light cover from the housing. 2. Pry out the light assembly. 3. Disconnect the 2P
connector from the housing.
4. Make sure that the bulb is OK. Check for continuity between the No.1 (+) and No.2 (-) terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel. > Page 9430
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel. > Page 9431
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel. > Page 9432
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel. > Page 9433
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn Signal Does
Not Cancel. > Page 9434
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel.
Technical Service Bulletin # 97-007 Date: 981215
Lighting - Turn Signal Does Not Cancel.
97-007
December 15, 1998
Applies To: 1996 - 97 Civic - See VEHICLES AFFECTED
Turn Signal Does Not Cancel (Supersedes 97-007, dated March 10, 1997)
SYMPTOMS [NEW]
The customer complains of one or more of the following.
^ Low power assist while turning
^ A "notchy" feeling when turning the steering wheel, or looseness in the steering
^ A clicking sound while turning the steering wheel
^ The turn signal switch does not cancel after making a turn
PROBABLE CAUSE
The cancel sleeve inside the combination switch shrinks and sticks to the combination switch
assembly.
VEHICLES AFFECTED
1996 Civic - ALL
1997 Civic:
2-door - Thru VIN 1HGEJ8. . .VL049149 3-door - Thru VIN 2HGEJ6. . .VH111461 4-door - Thru
VIN 1HGEJ6. . .VL015491
- Thru VIN 2HGEJ8. . .VH540019 - Thru VIN JHMEJ6. . .VS037746 [NEW] - Thru VIN JHMEJ8. .
.VS005454 [NEW]
CORRECTIVE ACTION
Replace the combination switch assembly with the one listed under PARTS INFORMATION.
PARTS INFORMATION
Combination Switch Assembly:
P/N 35251-S04-A81, H/C 4790218
Steering Wheel Nut:
P/N 90163-S04-000, H/C 4852794
Torx Bolt (2 required):
P/N 90134-504-A81, H/C 4794996
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 728102
Flat rate time: 0.8 hour
Failed part: P/N 35251-504-A81 H/C 4790218
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9440
Defect code: 032
Contention code: B01
Template ID: 97-007A
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
Repair Procedure
1. Write down the radio station presets.
2. Disconnect the negative cable from the battery, then disconnect the positive cable, and wait at
least three minutes before continuing.
3. With the front wheels aligned straight ahead, remove the access panel from the back of the
steering wheel, then disconnect the 2P connector between the driver's airbag and the cable reel.
NOTE:
Disconnecting the 2P connector automatically shorts the airbag wires; a shorting connector is not
needed.
4. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover.
5. Remove the two bolt covers from the back of the steering wheel. Then remove and discard the
two Torx bolts, disconnect the horn connector, and remove the driver's airbag.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9441
6. Disconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control set/resume switch connector (if
equipped).
7. Remove the steering wheel nut, and discard it. Then remove the steering wheel by rocking it
side-to-side as you pull steadily with both hands.
8. Remove the upper and lower column covers.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9442
9. Disconnect the 3P connector between the main wire harness and the cable reel sub-harness,
and disconnect the 2P connector between the cable reel and the SRS main harness. Then remove
the cable reel.
NOTE:
The edges of the knee bolster are sharp. Be careful when you are working near it.
10. Disconnect the 4P and 7P connectors from the headlight switch. Then disconnect the 8P and
6P connectors from the wiper/washer switch.
11. Remove and retain the four screws that secure the combination switch assembly, then remove
the assembly from the steering column.
12. Remove the headlight and wiper/washer switches from the old combination switch assembly
and install them on the new one (see PARTS INFORMATION).
13. Reconnect the headlight and wiper/washer switch connectors, then reinstall the combination
switch assembly with the original screws.
14. Set the cancel sleeve so its projections are aligned vertically.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9443
15. Carefully reinstall the cable reel on the steering column with the original screws. Then
reconnect the 3P connector to the cable reel sub-harness and the 2P connector to the SRS main
harness, and reinstall the connectors in their holders.
16. Reinstall the steering column covers with the original screws.
17. Center the cable reel by first rotating it clockwise until it stops and then rotating it
counterclockwise about 2-1/2 turns until the arrow on the label points straight up.
18. Reinstall the steering wheel. Then reconnect the horn switch connector and the cruise control
set/resume switch connector (if equipped). Route the wires in their clips on the steering wheel.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Combination Switch: > 97-007 > Dec > 98 > Lighting - Turn
Signal Does Not Cancel. > Page 9444
19. Install a new steering wheel nut (see PARTS INFORMATION). Torque it to 50 N.m (36 lb-ft).
20. Reconnect the airbag horn connector to the steering wheel, and reinstall the airbag with two
new Torx bolts (see PARTS INFORMATION). Tighten the bolts to 10 N.m (7 lb-ft), then reinstall the
bolt covers.
21. Attach the cable reel 2P and 3P connectors to the connector holder. Then reinstall the driver's
dashboard lower cover.
22. Reconnect the airbag 2P connector to the cable reel 2P connector, and reinstall the access
panel on the steering wheel.
23. Reconnect the positive cable to the battery, and reconnect the negative cable.
24. Check the operation of the SRS: When you turn the ignition switch ON (II), the SRS light comes
on and then goes off after six seconds.
25. Check the operation of the cable reel, the headlight switch, the wiper/washer switch, and both
horn buttons.
26. Reset the radio station presets, and set the clock.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 9447
Combination Switch: Connector Locations
Combination Light Switch Connector A
Left Side of Steering Column
Combination Light Switch Connector B
Left Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9448
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9449
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
-
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch.
- If there is no continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Combination Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9450
Combination Switch: Service and Repair
Combination Switch Replacement
Honda does not provide a service procedure for this component.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Turn Signal Flasher: Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Identification For In-Line and Fuse Box Connectors
C324
To see the configuration of a connector's cavities, look up its view number in Diagrams/Connector
Views. Each view includes the color of the connector, where it is located, and what it connects to.
Use the Connector Views to help locate the proper cavity when you need to probe a connector. It
can be especially helpful if the connector has more than one wire of the same color. Connector
views can also be used to help diagnose multiple symptoms in separate circuits which could be
caused by a single problem in a connector shared by those circuits. Here's how:
1. Pick one of the multiple symptoms and look up the schematic for that circuit. 2. Make a list of all
the in-line and fuse box connectors in that schematic. 3. Then, in the Connector Views, look up
each connector on your list to see if circuits related to the other symptoms run through one of them.
If they
do, inspect that connector for the problem.
Example: The blower, rear window defogger, and the windshield wiper don't work. List all in-line
and fuse box connectors in the blower controls circuit and then check the Connector View (sample
below). You find that C324 is common to the rear window defogger circuit and wiper/washer circuit,
so you inspect C324 and find the problem, bent terminals.
Circuit Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9455
Each schematic represents one circuit. A circuit's wires and components are arranged to show
current flow, from power at the top, to ground at the bottom.
Shared Circuits
Other circuits may share power or ground terminals or wiring with the circuit shown. A wire that
connects one circuit to another, for example, is cut short and has an arrowhead at the end of it
pointing in the direction of current flow. Next to the arrowhead is the name of the circuit or
component which shares that wiring. To quickly check shared wiring, check the operation of a
component it serves. If that component works, you know the shared wiring is OK.
Connectors
All in-line and fuse box connectors are numbered (C725, C416, etc.). Component connectors are
not numbered but are identified by the name of the component. If a component has more than one
connector, each connector is assigned a letter (A B, C, etc.). Below most connector numbers and
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9456
component names are PHOTO and VIEW numbers. The PHOTO number refers to a photo that
shows the connector's location on the car. The VIEW number refers to an illustration that shows
the connector face, wire colors, connector cavity numbers, and other details. The connector cavity
numbering sequence begins at the top left corner of the connector. Disregard any numbers molded
into the connector housing. . Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing..
Disregard any numbers molded into the connector housing.
Wires
Wires are identified by the abbreviated names of their colors; the second color is the color of the
stripe. Wires are also identified by their location in a connector. The number "2" next to the male
and female wire terminals at C416, for example, means those terminals join in cavity 2 of connector
C416.
Symbols
A complete description of schematic symbols is given in wire color abbreviations.
Component Locations
To see where a component or connector is located on the car, look up its photo number in the
Location/Components section. The photo will also tell you the color of the connector, and how
many cavities it has.
If there is no photo number below or beside a component name or a connector, ground, or terminal
number, look up that name or number in the Connector-to-Harness Index. The chart lists how many
cavities a connector has, where it's located, and what it connects to. The related illustration shows
the connector's location on the harness, and the harness routing.
Ground Distribution Schematics
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9457
This sample Ground Distribution schematic shows all of the components that share two ground
points.
Power Distribution Schematics
Power Distribution schematics show how power is supplied from the positive battery terminal to
various circuits in the car. Refer to the Power Distribution section to get a more detailed picture of
how power is supplied to the circuit you're working on.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9458
From Battery to Ignition Switch, Fuses, and Relays
Individual circuit schematics begin with a fuse. The first half of Power Distribution, however, shows
the wiring "upstream" between the battery and the fuses.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9459
From Fuses to Relays and Components
The second half of Power Distribution shows the wiring "From Fuses to Relays and Components."
This can speed your troubleshooting by showing which circuits share fuses. If Power Distribution
shows that an inoperative circuit and another circuit share a fuse, check a component in the other
circuit. If it works, you know the fuse is good and power is available to the inoperative circuit.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9460
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9461
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9462
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9463
Wire Color Abbreviations
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics: BLK ...............
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Black BLU .........................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ Blue BRN ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................ Brown GRN ............................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. Green
GRY .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... Gray LT BLU ............................................................
......................................................................................................................................................
Light Blue LT GRN ..............................................................................................................................
................................................................................. Light Green ORN ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... Orange PNK ........................................................................................................................
......................................................................................................... Pink PUR ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............................. Purple RED ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................... Red WHT ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... White YEL .................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................ Yellow
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9464
Wire Color Codes
The following abbreviations are used to identify wire colors in the circuit schematics:
WHT..........White YEL..........Yellow BLK..........Black BLU..........Blue GRN..........Green
RED..........Red ORN..........Orange PNK..........Pink BRN..........Brown GRY..........Gray
PUR..........Purple LT BLU.......
Light Blue
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9465
LT GRN....... Light Green
The wire insulation has one color or one color with another color stripe. The second color is the
stripe.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9466
Turn Signal Flasher: Diagnostic Aids
Five Step Troubleshooting
1. Verify The Complaint
Turn on all the components in the problem circuit to check the accuracy of the customer complaint.
Note the symptoms. Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
problem area.
2. Analyze The Schematic
Look up the schematic for the problem circuit. Determine how the circuit is supposed to work by
tracing the current paths from the power source through the circuit components to ground. Also,
trace circuits that share wiring with the problem circuit. The names of circuits that share the same
fuse, ground, or switch, and so on, are referred to in each circuit schematic. Try to operate any
shared circuits you didn't check in step 1. If the shared circuits work, the shared wiring is OK, and
the cause must be in the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If several circuits fail at the same
time, the fuse or ground is a likely cause. Based on the symptoms and your understanding of the
circuit's operation, identify one or more possible causes.
3. Isolate The Problem By Testing The Circuit
Make circuit tests to check the diagnosis you made in step 2. Keep in mind that a logical, simple
procedure is the key to efficient troubleshooting. Test for the most likely cause of failure first. Try to
make tests at points that are easily accessible.
4. Fix The Problem
Once the specific problem is identified, make the repair. Be sure to use proper tools and safe
procedures.
5. Make Sure The Circuit Works
Turn on all components in the repaired circuit in all modes to make sure you've fixed the entire
problem. If the problem was a blown fuse, be sure to test all of the circuits on that fuse. Make sure
no new problems turn up and the original problem does not recur.
Troubleshooting Precautions
Before Troubleshooting
1. Check the main fuse and the fuse box. 2. Check the battery for damage, state of charge, and
clean and tight connections.
CAUTION: Do not quick-charge a battery unless the battery ground cable has been disconnected, or you will
damage the alternator diodes.
- Do not attempt to crank the engine with the ground cable disconnected or you will severely
damage the wiring.
While You're Working
1. Make sure connectors are clean, and have no loose terminals or receptacles.
2. Make sure that connectors without wire seals are packed with dielectric (silicone) grease. Part
Number: 08798-9001. 3. When connecting a connector, push it until it "clicks" into place.
CAUTION: Do not pull on the wires when disconnecting a connector. Pull only on the connector housings.
- Most circuits include solid-state devices. Test the voltages in these circuits only with a 1O
megaohm or higher impedance digital multimeter. Never use a test light or analog meter on circuits
that contain solid-state devices. Damage to the devices may result.
Testing For A Short With A Self-Powered Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the battery and load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9467
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) (switched to the
lowest "OHMS" range) to the fuse terminal on the
load side.
3. Connect the other lead to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the
harness. Continue this at convenient points about six inches apart while watching the test light or
DVOM. 5. If the self-powered test light goes on or the DVOM displays a low reading or no reading
(zero), there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Testing For a Short With a Short Circuit Locator (Short Finder)
1. Remove the blown fuse. Leave the battery connected.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9468
2. Connect the short finder across the battery terminals and the load (component) side of the fuse
terminal. 3. Close all switches in the circuit you're testing. 4. Turn on the short tinder. This creates a
pulsing magnetic field around the wiring between the fuse box and the short. 5. Beginning at the
fuse box, slowly move the short finder along the circuit wiring. The meter will show current pulses
through sheet metal and body
trim. As long as the meter is between the fuse and the short, the needle will move with each current
pulse. Once you move the meter past the point of the short, the needle will stop moving. Check the
wiring and connectors in this area to locate the cause of the short.
Testing For A Short With A Test Light or DVOM
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9469
2. Connect a test light or digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM), switched to the appropriate DC volts
range, across the fuse terminals to make sure voltage
is present. You might have to turn the ignition switch to ON; check the schematic to see.
3. Beginning near the fuse box, wiggle the harness. Continue this at convenient points about six
inches apart while watching the test light or DVOM. 4. Where the test light goes off, or the DVOM
voltage drops to zero, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that point.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Continuity
When testing for continuity at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
1. Disconnect the negative cable from the car battery. If you're using a DVOM, place it in the lowest
"OHMS" range.
2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or DVOM to one end of the part of the circuit you
want to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there
is continuity. If you're using a DVOM, a low reading or no reading (zero), means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage
Testing for Voltage
When testing for voltage at a connector without wire seals, you do not have to separate the two
halves of the connector. Instead, probe the connector from the back. Always check both sides of
the connector because dirty, corroded, and bent terminals can cause problems (no electrical
contact = an open).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9470
1. Connect one lead of the test light to a known good ground, or, if you're using a digital volt
ohmmeter (DVOM), place it in the appropriate DC
volts range, and connect its negative lead to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or DVOM to the point you want to check. 3. If the test light
glows, there is voltage present. If you're using a DVOM, note the voltage reading. It should be
within one volt of measured battery
voltage. A loss of more than one volt indicates a problem.
NOTE: Always use a DVOM on high impedance circuits. A test light may not glow (even with
battery voltage present).
Testing For Voltage Drop
Wires, connectors, and switches are designed to conduct current with a minimum loss of voltage. A
voltage drop of more than one volt indicates a problem.
1. Place the digital volt/ohmmeter (DVOM) in the appropriate DC volts range. Connect the positive
lead to the end of the wire (or to the connector or
switch) closest to the battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connector or
switch). 3. Turn on the components in the circuit. 4. The DVOM will show the difference in voltage
between the two points. A difference, or drop, of more than one volt indicates a problem. Check
the circuit for loose, dirty, or bent terminals.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9471
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Turn Signal Bulb > Component
Information > Specifications
Turn Signal Bulb: Specifications
Turn Signal Light 21 W
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Alternate View
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Alternate View > Page 9480
Lighting System (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Alternate View > Page 9481
Turn Signal Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9482
Turn Signal Relay: Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the turn signal/hazard relay from the under-dash fuse/relay box.
2. Inspect the relay and fuse/relay box socket terminals to be sure they are all making good
contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the fuse/relay box socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the turn signal/ hazard relay must be faulty; replace it.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and steering column covers. 2. Disconnect the 4P
and 7P connectors from the switch.
3. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose, or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, check for continuity between them in each switch position according to
the tables. If there is no continuity between any of them, check for continuity in the switch harness.
If there is continuity in the switch harness, replace the combination light switch. If there is no
continuity in the switch harness, replace it.
Headlight/Dimmer/Passing Switch:
Turn Signal Switch:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9486
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper and lower covers. 5. Disconnect switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove two switch
attaching screws, then slide switch assembly out of housing. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9493
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9494
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Power Relay Test
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Rear window defogger relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rear window defogger switch or the center panel when
prying the switch out.
NOTE: Before testing, check for blown No.16 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fuse/relay box.
1. Pry the switch out of the center panel. 2. Disconnect the 5P connector from the switch.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and check the voltage between the BLK/BLU (+) and the BLK (-)
terminals. There should be battery voltage.
- If there is no voltage, check for an open in the BLK/BLU wire.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Connect a jumper wire between the BLK/BLU and the BLU/YEL terminals. 5. Turn the ignition
switch ON (II), and check that the rear window defogger works; if it does, replace the defogger
switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger > Rear Defogger Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate View
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Alternate View > Page 9507
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations Photo
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9508
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Power Relay Test
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test.
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.2 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.3 terminals when power is disconnected.
Rear window defogger relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Power Windows
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Power Window Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9518
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9519
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Power window relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Heated Glass Element Switch: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rear window defogger switch or the center panel when
prying the switch out.
NOTE: Before testing, check for blown No.16 (7.5 A) fuse in the under-dash fuse/relay box.
1. Pry the switch out of the center panel. 2. Disconnect the 5P connector from the switch.
3. Turn the ignition switch ON (II), and check the voltage between the BLK/BLU (+) and the BLK (-)
terminals. There should be battery voltage.
- If there is no voltage, check for an open in the BLK/BLU wire.
- If there is battery voltage, go to step 4.
4. Connect a jumper wire between the BLK/BLU and the BLU/YEL terminals. 5. Turn the ignition
switch ON (II), and check that the rear window defogger works; if it does, replace the defogger
switch.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9527
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
Power Windows
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Front Door Window Motor: Locations
Front of Driver's Door (Frt. Pass. Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Door Window Motor: Locations
Front of Left Rear Door (Right Similar)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations
Power Window Relay: Locations
Dashboard (Part 2 Of 2)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9542
Behind Left Side of Dash Panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 9543
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: See Turn Signal/Hazard Relay Input Test
Normally-open type:
Check for continuity between the terminals.
- There should be continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power and ground are
connected to the No.3 and No.4 terminals.
- There should be no continuity between the No.1 and No.2 terminals when power is disconnected.
Type 1
Power window relay
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations
Dashboard/Door
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9547
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments
Front Door Window Glass: Adjustments
Glass Adjustment
NOTE:
- Place the vehicle on a firm, level surface when adjusting the glass.
- Check the weatherstrips and glass run channel for damage or deterioration, and replace them if
necessary.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Adjust the glass.
4D: a. Raise the glass fully. b. Loosen the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting
bolts. c. Push the glass rearward (front door glass) or forward (rear door glass).
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9552
Rear
d. Tighten the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting bolts. e. Loosen the front
channel mounting bolts (front door) or rear channel mounting bolt (rear door). f.
Lower the glass.
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9553
Rear
g. Push the front or rear channels against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
2D/3D: a. Raise the glass as far up as possible, and hold it against the glass run channel.
b. Loosen the roller guide bolts, and adjust the glass so it is parallel with the glass run channel. c.
Tighten the roller guide bolts. d. Loosen the front channel bolts. e. Lower the glass.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9554
f. Push the front channel against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
3. Check that the glass moves smoothly. 4. Raise the glass fully and check for gaps.
5. Check the glass operation.
NOTE: Check that the glass contacts the glass run channel evenly.
6. Check for water leaks.
Spray water over the roof and on the sealing area as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9555
NOTE: Adjust the water pressure as shown.
- Do not squeeze the tip of the hose.
7. Attach the plastic cover, then install the door panel.
8. Install the regulator handle so it points forward and up at a 45 degree angle with the glass
closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9556
Front Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them. Carefully pull the glass
out through the window slot.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9557
3. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
4. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown. 5. Installation is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9558
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Locations
Quarter Glass
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair Quarter Glass
3D
Removal
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Use seat covers to avoid damaging any surfaces.
1. To remove the quarter glass, first remove the:
- Rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Rear center shelf and rear side shelf
- Rear trim panel and side trim panel
- Upper anchor bolts from the front and rear seat belts
- Quarter trim panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9564
Upper Portion/Lower Portion/Pillar Portion
2. From inside the car, use a knife to cut through the quarter glass adhesive all the way around.
NOTE: If the clip on the rear edge is broken, the quarter glass can be reinstalled using butyl tape .
- Apply protective tape along the edge of the entire quarter glass opening flange.
3. Carefully remove the quarter glass.
NOTE: Check the quarter glass trim and clips for damage, and replace them if necessary.
Installation
1. Using a knife, scrape the old adhesive smooth to a thickness of about 2 mm (0.08 in.) on the
bonding surface around the entire quarter glass
opening flange.
NOTE: Do not scrape down to the painted surface of the body; damaged paint will interfere with proper
bonding.
- Remove the rubber dams from the body.
- If any of the clips are broken, remove them from the body.
- Mask off surrounding surfaces before applying primer.
2. Clean the body bonding surface with a sponge dampened in alcohol.
NOTE: After cleaning, keep oil, grease and water from getting on the surface.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9565
3. If the quarter glass is to be reinstalled, use a putty knife to scrape off all traces of old adhesive,
then clean the quarter glass surface with alcohol
where adhesive is to be applied.
NOTE: Make sure the bonding surface is kept free of water, oil and grease.
CAUTION: Avoid setting the quarter glass on its edges: small chips may later develop into cracks.
NOTE: Clean the shadowed area.
4. Glue the upper and lower rubber dams to the inside face of the quarter glass, as shown, to
contain the adhesive during installation.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the quarter glass where adhesive will be applied.
5. Install the quarter glass trim on the quarter glass, then glue the upper and lower clips as shown.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the quarter glass where adhesive will be applied.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9566
6. If the old quarter glass is to be reinstalled (and the clip on the rear edge is broken off), apply a
light coat of primer (3M C-100, or equivalent), then
apply butyl tape to the quarter glass, as shown, and seal the body hole with piece of urethane tape.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the quarter glass where adhesive will be applied.
- Do not peel the separator off the butyl tape.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9567
7. With a sponge, apply a light coat of glass primer to the inside face of the quarter glass, as
shown, then lightly wipe it off with gauze or cheesecloth.
NOTE: Do not apply body primer to the quarter glass, and do not get body and glass primer sponges
mixed up.
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands. If you do, the adhesive may not bond to the
quarter glass properly, causing a leak after the quarter glass is installed.
- Keep water, dust, and abrasive materials away from the primed surface.
8. With a sponge, apply a light coat of body primer to the original adhesive remaining around the
quarter glass opening flange. Let the body primer
dry for at least 10 minutes.
NOTE: Do not apply glass primer to the body, and be careful not to mix up glass and body primer sponges.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9568
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands.
- Mask off the rear side trim panel before painting the flange.
9. Thoroughly mix the adhesive and hardener together on a glass or metal plate with a putty knife.
NOTE: Clean the plate with a sponge and alcohol before mixing.
- Follow the instructions that came with the adhesive.
10. Before filling a cartridge, cut the end of the nozzle as shown.
11. Pack adhesive into the cartridge without air pockets to ensure continuous delivery. Put the
cartridge in a caulking gun, and run a bead of adhesive
around the edge of the quarter glass as shown.
NOTE: If the old quarter glass is to be reinstalled, peel the separator off the butyl tape after applying the
adhesive.
- Apply the adhesive within 30 minutes after applying the glass primer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9569
12. Use suction cups to hold the quarter glass over the opening, align the clips, and set it down on
the adhesive. Lightly push on the quarter glass until
its edges are fully seated on the adhesive all the way around.
NOTE: Do not open or close the doors until the adhesive is dry.
13. Scrape or wipe the excess adhesive off with a putty knife or towel.
NOTE: To remove adhesive from a painted surface or the quarter glass, wipe with a soft shop
towel dampened with alcohol.
14. Let the adhesive dry for at least one hour, then spray water over the quarter glass and check
for leaks. Mark the leaking areas, let the quarter glass
dry, then seal with sealant.
NOTE: Let the car stand for at least four hours after quarter glass installation. If the car has to be
used within the first four hours, it must be driven slowly.
15. Reinstall all remaining removed parts.
NOTE: Advise the customer not to do the following things for two to three days: Slam the doors with all the windows rolled up.
- Twist the body excessively (such as when going in and out of driveways at an angle or driving
over rough, uneven roads).
2D
Removal
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Use seat covers to avoid damaging any surfaces.
1. To remove the quarter glass, first remove the:
- Rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Side trim panel
- Rear shelf
- Upper anchor bolt from the front seat belt
- Quarter trim panel
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9570
Upper Portion/Rear Edge Portion/Pillar Portion
2. From inside the car, use a knife to cut through the quarter glass adhesive all the way around.
NOTE: If the quarter glass is to be reinstalled, take care not to damage the molding.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9571
- Apply protective tape along the edge of the entire quarter glass opening flange.
3. Carefully remove the quarter glass.
NOTE: Check the molding for damage, and replace it if necessary.
Installation
1. Using a knife, scrape the old adhesive smooth to a thickness of about 2 mm (0.08 in.) on the
bonding surface around the entire quarter glass
opening flange.
NOTE: Do not scrape down to the painted surface of the body; damaged paint will interfere with proper
bonding.
- Remove the fastener from the body.
- If any of the clips are broken, remove them from the body.
- Mask off surrounding surfaces before applying primer.
2. Clean the body bonding surface with a sponge dampened in alcohol.
NOTE: After cleaning, keep oil, grease and water from getting on the surface.
3. If the quarter glass is to be reinstalled, use a putty knife to scrape off all traces of old adhesive,
then clean the quarter glass surface with alcohol
where adhesive is to be applied.
NOTE: Make sure the bonding surface is kept free of water, oil and grease.
CAUTION: Avoid setting the quarter glass on its edges; small chips may later develop into cracks.
NOTE: Clean the shadowed area.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9572
4. Install the molding around the edge of the quarter glass as shown.
NOTE: If the old molding is to be reinstalled, scrape off the old adhesive tape from the molding, and clean
the molding surface with alcohol where new adhesive tape is to be applied. Apply the double-faced
adhesive tape to the molding and quarter glass as shown.
- Be careful not to touch the quarter glass where adhesive will be applied.
Adhesive tape A (3M 4215, or equivalent) Thickness: 0.4 mm (0.02 in.) Width: 5 mm (0.2 in.)
Length: 440 mm (17.3 in.)
Adhesive tape B (NITTO 501, or equivalent) Thickness: 0.16 mm (0.006 in.) Width: 8 mm (0.3 in.)
Length: 440 mm (17.3 in.)
Adhesive tape C (3M 4213, or equivalent) Thickness: 0.8 mm (0.03 in.) Width: 5 mm (0.2 in.)
Length: 30 mm (1.2 in.)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9573
5. If the old quarter glass is to be reinstalled, glue the upper and lower clips and fastener as shown.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the quarter glass where adhesive will be applied.
6. Glue the fastener to the body as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9574
7. With a sponge, apply a light coat of glass primer to the inside face of the quarter glass, as
shown, then lightly wipe it off with gauze or cheesecloth.
NOTE: Do not apply body primer to the quarter glass, and do not get body and glass primer sponges
mixed up.
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands. If you do, the adhesive may not bond to the
quarter glass properly, causing a leak after the quarter glass is installed.
- Keep water, dust, and abrasive materials away from the primed surface.
8. With a sponge, apply a light coat of body primer to the original adhesive remaining around the
quarter glass opening flange. Let the body primer
dry for at least 10 minutes.
NOTE: Do not apply glass primer to the body, and be careful not to mix up glass and body primer sponges.
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands.
- Mask off the rear side trim panel before painting the flange.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9575
9. Thoroughly mix the adhesive and hardener together on a glass or metal plate with a putty knife.
NOTE: Clean the plate with a sponge and alcohol before mixing.
- Follow the instructions that came with the adhesive.
10. Before filling a cartridge, cut the end of the nozzle as shown.
11. Pack adhesive into the cartridge without air pockets to ensure continuous delivery. Put the
cartridge in a caulking gun, and run a bead of adhesive
around the edge of the quarter glass as shown.
NOTE: If the old quarter glass is to be reinstalled, peel the separator off the butyl tape after applying the
adhesive.
- Peel the separator off the adhesive tape after applying the adhesive.
- Apply the adhesive within 30 minutes after applying the glass primer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9576
12. Use suction cups to hold the quarter glass over the opening, align the clips, and set it down on
the adhesive. Lightly push on the quarter glass until
its edges are fully seated on the adhesive all the way around.
NOTE: Do not open or close the doors until the adhesive is dry.
13. Scrape or wipe the excess adhesive off with a putty knife or towel.
NOTE: To remove adhesive from a painted surface or the quarter glass, wipe with a soft shop
towel dampened with alcohol.
14. Let the adhesive dry for at least one hour, then spray water over the quarter glass and check
for leaks. Mark the leaking areas, let the quarter glass
dry, then seal with sealant.
NOTE: Let the car stand for at least four hours after quarter glass installation. If the car has to be
used within the first four hours, it must be driven slowly.
15. Reinstall all remaining removed parts.
NOTE: Advise the customer not to do the following things for two to three days: Slam the doors with all the windows rolled up.
- Twist the body excessively (such as when going in and out of driveways at an angle or driving
over rough, uneven roads).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9577
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair Rear Door Glass, Quarter Glass and Regulator
Replacement
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9578
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Quarter Glass > Page 9579
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments
Rear Door Window Glass: Adjustments
Glass Adjustment
NOTE:
- Place the vehicle on a firm, level surface when adjusting the glass.
- Check the weatherstrips and glass run channel for damage or deterioration, and replace them if
necessary.
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Adjust the glass.
4D: a. Raise the glass fully. b. Loosen the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting
bolts. c. Push the glass rearward (front door glass) or forward (rear door glass).
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9583
Rear
d. Tighten the glass mounting bolts (front door) and regulator mounting bolts. e. Loosen the front
channel mounting bolts (front door) or rear channel mounting bolt (rear door). f.
Lower the glass.
Front
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9584
Rear
g. Push the front or rear channels against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
2D/3D: a. Raise the glass as far up as possible, and hold it against the glass run channel.
b. Loosen the roller guide bolts, and adjust the glass so it is parallel with the glass run channel. c.
Tighten the roller guide bolts. d. Loosen the front channel bolts. e. Lower the glass.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9585
f. Push the front channel against the glass, then tighten the mounting bolts.
3. Check that the glass moves smoothly. 4. Raise the glass fully and check for gaps.
5. Check the glass operation.
NOTE: Check that the glass contacts the glass run channel evenly.
6. Check for water leaks.
Spray water over the roof and on the sealing area as shown.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9586
NOTE: Adjust the water pressure as shown.
- Do not squeeze the tip of the hose.
7. Attach the plastic cover, then install the door panel.
8. Install the regulator handle so it points forward and up at a 45 degree angle with the glass
closed.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9587
Rear Door Window Glass: Service and Repair
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9588
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 9589
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
Glass/Regulator Replacement
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them. Carefully pull the glass
out through the window slot.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9594
3. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
4. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown. 5. Installation is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9595
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Quarter Window Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Regulator: Service and Repair
Glass/Regulator Replacement
Rear Door
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Quarter Window Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9599
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Quarter Window Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9600
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
Glass/Regulator Replacement
Rear Door
1. Remove:
- Door panel
- Plastic cover
2. Carefully move the glass until you can see the bolts, then remove them.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
3. Carefully lower the glass. Remove the bolts and screw from the rear channel, then remove the
glass from the rear channel.
NOTE: Take care not to drop the glass inside the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9604
4. Carefully remove the glass from the window slot.
5. Remove the outer molding, then remove the quarter glass.
6. Disconnect the connector, and detach the harness clip, then remove the regulator through the
hole in the door.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator >
System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9605
7. Grease all the sliding surfaces of the regulator where shown.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the power window motor from the regulator.
- Before removing the power window motor, scribe a line across the sector gear and regulator.
8. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Roll the glass up and down to see if it moves freely without binding. Also make sure that
there is no clearance between the glass and glass run channel when the glass is closed. Adjust the
position of the glass as necessary .
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Window Seal: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
Window Seal: Customer Interest Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
00-021
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1995-00 Civic - ALL
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Replaces 95-056, dated March 2, 1999)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds. The molding may also be deformed or loose.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 824003
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 73150-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect Code: 056
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-021A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant:
(3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner:
(3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verify the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, and around the corners.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Window Seal: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle) > Page 9614
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire masked-off area.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. After five minutes, remove the masking tape. Clean up any excess sealant with 3M General
Purpose Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
Window Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
00-021
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1995-00 Civic - ALL
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Replaces 95-056, dated March 2, 1999)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds. The molding may also be deformed or loose.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 824003
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 73150-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect Code: 056
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-021A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant:
(3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner:
(3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verify the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, and around the corners.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle) >
Page 9620
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire masked-off area.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. After five minutes, remove the masking tape. Clean up any excess sealant with 3M General
Purpose Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Windshield: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
Windshield: Customer Interest Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
00-021
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1995-00 Civic - ALL
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Replaces 95-056, dated March 2, 1999)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds. The molding may also be deformed or loose.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 824003
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 73150-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect Code: 056
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-021A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant:
(3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner:
(3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verify the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, and around the corners.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Windshield: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle) > Page 9629
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire masked-off area.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. After five minutes, remove the masking tape. Clean up any excess sealant with 3M General
Purpose Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Windshield: > 95-056 > Sep > 97 > Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield
Windshield: Customer Interest Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield
Bulletin No. 95-056
Issue Date SEP 8, 1997
Model 1995-97 [NEW] CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under BODY
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Supersedes 95-056, dated December 18, 1995)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 824003
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 731 50-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 97-001A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant: (3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner: (3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verity the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, continue with the CORRECTIVE ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Windshield: > 95-056 > Sep > 97 > Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield > Page 9634
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, between the left and right roof moldings.
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. Remove the masking tape, then clean up any excess sealant with 3M General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle)
00-021
February 1, 2000
Applies To: 1995-00 Civic - ALL
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Replaces 95-056, dated March 2, 1999)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds. The molding may also be deformed or loose.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION
In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation Number: 824003
Flat Rate Time: 0.5 hour
Failed Part: P/N 73150-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect Code: 056
Contention Code: B07
Template ID: 00-021A
Skill Level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant:
(3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner:
(3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verify the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, go to REPAIR PROCEDURE.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, and around the corners.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-021 > Feb > 00 > Windshield - Wind Noise (Whistle) > Page 9640
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire masked-off area.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. After five minutes, remove the masking tape. Clean up any excess sealant with 3M General
Purpose Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Disclaimer
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 95-056 > Sep > 97 > Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield
Bulletin No. 95-056
Issue Date SEP 8, 1997
Model 1995-97 [NEW] CIVIC
Applicable To ALL
File Under BODY
Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield (Supersedes 95-056, dated December 18, 1995)
SYMPTOM A whistling or howling noise coming from the top, middle of the windshield at highway
speeds.
PROBABLE CAUSE Vibration of the upper windshield molding.
WARRANTY CLAIM INFORMATION In warranty: The normal warranty applies.
Operation number: 824003
Flat rate time: 0.5 hour
Failed part: P/N 731 50-S04-003 H/C 4779385
Defect code: 056
Contention code: B07
Template ID: 97-001A
Skill level: Repair Technician
Out of warranty: Any repair performed after warranty expiration may be eligible for goodwill
consideration by the District Service Manager or your Zone Office. You must request consideration,
and get a decision, before starting work.
REQUIRED MATERIALS 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant: (3M P/N 051135-08662)
3M General Purpose Adhesive Cleaner: (3M P/N 051135-08984)
DIAGNOSIS Drive the car at highway speeds to verity the noise. If you hear the noise, and its
frequency or volume changes when you push on the top of the windshield in front of the rear view
mirror, continue with the CORRECTIVE ACTION.
CORRECTIVE ACTION Apply sealant under the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
REPAIR PROCEDURE
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 95-056 > Sep > 97 > Body - Wind Whistle at the Top of the Windshield > Page
9645
1. Protect the roof by applying 2-inch-wide masking tape along the edge of the upper windshield
molding, between the left and right roof moldings.
2. Pull the rear edge of the upper windshield molding away from the roof (use a cotter pin puller or
similar tool), and apply a liberal amount of 3M Black Super Silicone Sealant underneath it. Apply
sealant along the entire length of the upper windshield molding.
3. Push on the molding to smooth it out and to form a good seal.
4. Remove the masking tape, then clean up any excess sealant with 3M General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner.
5. To give the sealant time to cure, tell the customer not to wash the windshield for 24 hours.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9646
Windshield (2 Door/3 Door/4 Door)
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9647
Windshield: Service and Repair
Removal
CAUTION:
- Put on gloves to protect your hands.
- Use seat covers to avoid damaging any surfaces.
1. To remove the windshield, first remove the:
- Rearview mirror
- Sunvisors and holders
- Front pillar trim
- Windshield wiper arms and cowl cover
2. Peel off the molding, and remove the glass brackets.
NOTE: When molding removal is difficult, cut the molding with a knife.
3. Pull down the front of the headliner.
CAUTION: Take care not to bend the headliner excessively.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9648
4. Apply protective tape along the edge of the dashboard and body as shown. Using an awl, make
a hole through the rubber dam and adhesive from
inside the car. Push the piano wire through the hole, and wrap each end around a piece of wood.
5. With a helper on the outside, pull the piano wire back and forth in a sawing motion, and carefully
cut through the rubber dam and adhesive around
the entire windshield.
CAUTION: Hold the piano wire as close to the windshield as possible to prevent damage to the
body and dashboard.
6. Carefully remove the windshield.
Installation
1. Using a knife, scrape the old adhesive smooth to a thickness of about 2 mm (0.08 in.) on the
bonding surface around the entire windshield opening
flange.
NOTE: Do not scrape down to the painted surface of the body; damaged paint will interfere with proper
bonding.
- Remove the rubber dams and fasteners from the body.
- Mask off surrounding surfaces before painting.
2. Clean the body bonding surface with a sponge dampened in alcohol.
NOTE: After cleaning, keep oil, grease and water from getting on the surface.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9649
3. If the old windshield is to be reinstalled, use a putty knife to scrape off all traces of old adhesive,
then clean the windshield surface with alcohol
where new adhesive is to be applied.
NOTE: Make sure the bonding surface is kept free of water, oil and grease.
CAUTION: Avoid setting the windshield on its edges; small chips may later develop into cracks.
NOTE: Clean the shadowed area.
- Clean area (A) as shown.
4. Glue the rubber dam and fasteners to the inside face of the windshield as shown.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the windshield where adhesive will be applied.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9650
5. Align and glue the molding to the edge of the windshield.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the windshield where adhesive will be applied.
6. Install the glass brackets and fasteners as shown.
NOTE: The numbers after the part names show the quantities of the parts used.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9651
7. Set the windshield on the glass brackets, then center it in the opening. Make alignment marks
across the windshield and body with a grease pencil
at the four points shown.
NOTE: Be careful not to touch the windshield where adhesive will be applied.
8. Remove the windshield.
9. With a sponge, apply a light coat of glass primer around the edge of the windshield as shown,
then lightly wipe it off with gauze or cheesecloth.
NOTE: Do not apply body primer to the windshield, and do not get body and glass primer sponges mixed
up.
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands. If you do, the adhesive may not bond to the
windshield properly, causing a leak after the windshield is installed.
- Keep water, dust, and abrasive materials away
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9652
10. With a sponge, apply a light coat of body primer to the original adhesive remaining around the
windshield opening flange. Let the body primer dry
for at least 10 minutes.
NOTE: Do not apply glass primer to the body, and be careful not to mix up glass and body primer sponges.
- Never touch the primed surfaces with your hands.
- Mask off the dashboard before painting the flange.
11. Thoroughly mix the adhesive and hardener together on a glass or metal plate with a putty knife.
NOTE: Clean the plate with a sponge and alcohol before mixing.
- Follow the instructions that come with the adhesive.
12. Before filling a cartridge, cut the end of the nozzle as shown.
13. Pack adhesive into the cartridge without air pockets to ensure continuous delivery. Put the
cartridge in a caulking gun, and run a bead of adhesive
around the edge of the windshield as shown.
NOTE: Apply the adhesive within 30 minutes after applying the glass primer.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 9653
14. Use suction cups to hold the windshield over the opening, align it with the alignment marks
made in step 7, and set it down on the adhesive.
Lightly push on the windshield until its edge is fully seated on the adhesive all the way around.
NOTE: Do not open or close the doors until adhesive is dry.
15. Scrape or wipe the excess adhesive off with a putty knife or towel.
NOTE: To remove adhesive from a painted surface or the windshield, wipe with a soft shop towel
dampened with alcohol.
16. Let the adhesive dry for at least one hour, then spray water over the windshield and check for
leaks. Mark the leaking areas, let the windshield dry,
then seal with sealant.
NOTE: Let the car stand for at least four hours after windshield installation. If the car has to be used within
the first four hours, it must be driven slowly.
- Keep the windshield dry for the first hour after installation.
- Check that the ends of the side molding are set under the cowl cover.
17. Reinstall all remaining removed parts.
NOTE: Install the rearview mirror rubber damper after the adhesive has dried thoroughly.
- Advise the customer not to do the following things for two to three days: Slam the doors with all the windows rolled up.
- Twist the body excessively (such as when going in and out of driveways at an angle or driving
over rough, uneven roads).
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp Wiper Relay > Component Information > Locations
Wipers/Washers
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Headlamp
Wiper Relay > Component Information > Locations
Wipers/Washers
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Wiper Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Integrated Control Unit Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
All Systems:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9665
Intermittent Wiper System:
Key-in/Seat Belt Reminder, Lights-on Reminder System:
Bulb Check System (Brake System Light):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Testing and Inspection
Washer Level Switch Test (Canada)
1. Remove the front bumper.
2. Disconnect the 2P connectors from the washer.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each float position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9673
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Remove instrument panel lower cover. 3. Remove upper and lower steering column covers from
steering column. 4. Disconnect 8-P and 6-P connectors from wiper switch. 5. Remove two
attaching screws and slide wiper switch out of housing. 6. Reverse procedure to install. 7. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Right Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9677
Wiper/Washer Switch
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9678
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9679
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable. 3. Remove dashboard lower cover. 4. Remove steering
column upper cover. 5. Disconnect electrical connectors. 6. Remove wiper/washer switch attaching
screws, then the switch. 7. Reverse procedure to install. 8. On models equipped with radio coded
theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Testing and Inspection
Washer Level Switch Test (Canada)
1. Remove the front bumper.
2. Disconnect the 2P connectors from the washer.
3. Check for continuity between the terminals in each float position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Hose: Service and Repair
Washer Tube Replacement
NOTE:
- To remove the windshield washer tube, remove the left inner fender.
- To remove the rear window washer tube (3D), remove the following parts from the left side of the
vehicle. Inner fender
- Kick panel and side trim
- Rear seat-back and rear seat cushion
- Spare tire lid
- Rear center shelf and rear side shelf
- Rear trim panel and side trim panel
- Quarter trim panel
- Rear roof trim
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Hose > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 9686
- Hatch spoiler
Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Take care not to pinch the washer tubes.
- If necessary, replace any damaged clips.
- After installing, adjust the aim of the washer nozzles.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information >
Locations
Windshield Washer Motor: Locations
Behind Left Side of Front Bumper
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 9690
Windshield Washer Motor: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the front bumper.
2. Disconnect the 2P connectors from the washer.
3. Test the washer motor by connecting battery power and ground according to the table.
- If the motor fails to run smoothly, replace it.
- If the motor runs smoothly, but little or no washer fluid is pumped, check for a disconnected or
blocked washer hose, or a clogged pump outlet in the motor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
1. Remove front bumper, then disconnect washer hose and 2-P connectors from front and rear
washer motors. 2. Remove three mounting bolts and washer reservoir. 3. Reverse procedure to
install.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
1. Remove the front bumper.
2. Disconnect the connectors and washer tubes from the washer motors. 3. Remove the bolts then
remove the washer reservoir. 4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: -
Make sure the washer motor connectors and washer tubes are connected properly.
- Check the washer motor operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Windshield Washer Spray Nozzle: Service and Repair
Windshield Wiper/Washer:
1. Adjust the wiper arms so that their park positions match the illustration.
2. By inserting a tack and moving it as necessary, adjust the washer nozzles so that they aim at
positions A, A', B, and B' shown in the illustration.
NOTE: The fluid jets should hit within a 50 mm (2.0 in.) radius around each of points A, A', B, and
B'.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer (3D):
1. Adjust the rear window wiper arm so that its park position matches the illustration. 2. By inserting
a tack and moving it as necessary, adjust the washer nozzle so that it aims at position C as shown
in the illustration.
NOTE: The fluid jet should hit within a 50 mm (2.0 in.) radius around point C.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9703
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
1. On models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage
Warnings for system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
2. Remove instrument panel lower cover. 3. Remove upper and lower steering column covers from
steering column. 4. Disconnect 8-P and 6-P connectors from wiper switch. 5. Remove two
attaching screws and slide wiper switch out of housing. 6. Reverse procedure to install. 7. On
models equipped with radio coded theft protection system, refer to Vehicle Damage Warnings for
system disarming and arming
procedures. On models equipped with airbag system, refer to Technician Safety Information for
system disarming and arming procedures.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments
Wiper Arm: Adjustments
Windshield Wiper/Washer:
1. Adjust the wiper arms so that their park positions match the illustration.
2. By inserting a tack and moving it as necessary, adjust the washer nozzles so that they aim at
positions A, A', B, and B' shown in the illustration.
NOTE: The fluid jets should hit within a 50 mm (2.0 in.) radius around each of points A, A', B, and
B'.
Rear Window Wiper/Washer (3D):
1. Adjust the rear window wiper arm so that its park position matches the illustration. 2. By inserting
a tack and moving it as necessary, adjust the washer nozzle so that it aims at position C as shown
in the illustration.
NOTE: The fluid jet should hit within a 50 mm (2.0 in.) radius around point C.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Front
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
NOTE: Take care not to scratch the hood and body.
1. Remove the windshield wiper arms, then remove the hood seal and cowl cover.
Japan/Canada-Produced
USA-Produced
2. Disconnect the connector, then remove the wind shield wiper linkage assembly.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front > Page 9709
3. Separate the windshield wiper linkage and windshield wiper motor.
Japan/Canada-Produced
NOTE: Scribe a line across the link and windshield wiper linkage to show the original adjustment.
USA-Produced
NOTE: Scribe a line across the link and windshield wiper motor to show the original adjustment.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the connector is connected properly.
- If necessary, replace any damaged clips.
- Install the windshield wiper arms.
- Check the windshield wiper motor operation.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front > Page 9710
- Grease the moving parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Front > Page 9711
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Rear
1. Remove the hatch trim panel.
2. Remove the rear window wiper arm and wiper motor as shown. 3. Installation is the reverse of
the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the connector is connected properly.
- Install the rear window wiper arm.
- Check the rear window wiper motor operation.
- Grease the moving parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Wiper Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Integrated Control Unit Input Test
SRS components are located in this area. Review the SRS component locations, precautions, and
procedures before performing repairs or service.
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover and knee bolster. 2. Disconnect the 10P connector
from the integrated control unit. 3. Remove the integrated control unit from the under-dash
fuse/relay box.
4. Inspect the connector and socket terminals to be sure they are all making good contact.
- If the terminals are bent, loose or corroded, repair them as necessary, and recheck the system.
- If the terminals look OK, make the following input tests at the connector and the fuse/relay box
socket. If any test indicates a problem, find and correct the cause, then recheck the system.
- If all the input tests prove OK, the control unit must be faulty; replace it.
All Systems:
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control Module > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 9715
Intermittent Wiper System:
Key-in/Seat Belt Reminder, Lights-on Reminder System:
Bulb Check System (Brake System Light):
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Windshield Wiper Motor
Wiper Motor: Locations Front Windshield Wiper Motor
Left Rear Corner of Engine Compartment
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Front
Windshield Wiper Motor > Page 9720
Wiper Motor: Locations Rear Window Wiper Motor
Underside of Hatch Lid
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Front Wiper Motor
Wiper Motor: Testing and Inspection Front Wiper Motor
1. Open the hood, and remove the cap nuts. Carefully remove the wiper arms so that they do not
touch the hood. 2. Remove the cowl cover by prying out the trim clips.
3. Disconnect the 5P connector from the windshield wiper motor.
4. Test the motor by connecting battery power and ground according to the table.
If the motor does not run or fails to run smoothly, replace it.
5. Connect an analog voltmeter between the No.5 (+) and No.3 (-) terminals, and run the motor at
low or high speed.
The voltmeter should indicate 0 V and 4 V or less alternately.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Front Wiper Motor > Page 9723
Wiper Motor: Testing and Inspection Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Motor Test (Hatchback)
1. Remove the hatch lower trim panel.
2. Disconnect the 4P connector from the wiper motor assembly. 3. Test the motor by connecting
battery power to the No.1 terminal and ground to the No.3 terminal.
If the motor does not run or fails to run smoothly, replace it.
4. Reconnect the 4P connector to the wiper motor. 5. Connect an analog voltmeter between the
No.4 (+) and No.2 (-) terminals. 6. Run the motor by turning the wiper switch ON.
The voltmeter should indicate 0 V and 4 V or less alternately.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 9724
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair
1. Remove the hatch trim panel.
2. Remove the rear window wiper arm and wiper motor as shown. 3. Installation is the reverse of
the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the connector is connected properly.
- Install the rear window wiper arm.
- Check the rear window wiper motor operation.
- Grease the moving parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Motor Linkage: Service and Repair
CAUTION: Put on gloves to protect your hands.
NOTE: Take care not to scratch the hood and body.
1. Remove the windshield wiper arms, then remove the hood seal and cowl cover.
Japan/Canada-Produced
USA-Produced
2. Disconnect the connector, then remove the wind shield wiper linkage assembly.
3. Separate the windshield wiper linkage and windshield wiper motor.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor Linkage > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 9728
Japan/Canada-Produced
NOTE: Scribe a line across the link and windshield wiper linkage to show the original adjustment.
USA-Produced
NOTE: Scribe a line across the link and windshield wiper motor to show the original adjustment.
4. Installation is the reverse of the removal procedure.
NOTE: Make sure the connector is connected properly.
- If necessary, replace any damaged clips.
- Install the windshield wiper arms.
- Check the windshield wiper motor operation.
- Grease the moving parts.
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
Wiper Switch: Locations
Right Side of Steering Column
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9732
Wiper/Washer Switch
Honda Civic Sedan Workshop Manual (L4-1.6L SOHC (VTEC) (1996))
Honda Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9733
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove the driver's dashboard lower cover. 2. Remove the steering column covers.
3. Disconnect the 8P and 6P connectors from the switch, remove the two screws, and pull out the
switch.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Switch
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch
4. Check for continuity between the terminals in each switch position according to the table.